0% found this document useful (0 votes)
698 views

Alarm List

Uploaded by

benjaminkerr13
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
698 views

Alarm List

Uploaded by

benjaminkerr13
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 712

Serial No.

300416

Original Instructions

PARAMETER LIST
ALARM LIST
M-CODE LIST

.d
HCN-6000

ve
HCN-6800

er
HCN-8800

s
re
HCN-10800
-8800

ts
-10800

gh
Manual No.: H272HA0046E

ri
ll
.A
NC: MAZATROL SmoothG

N
O
Serial No.:

TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

Before using this machine and equipment, fully understand the contents of this
al

manual to ensure proper operation. Should any questions arise, please ask the
ri

ZA
Se

nearest Technical Center or Technology Center.


A
IM
K
ZA

IMPORTANT NOTICE
A

1. Be sure to observe the safety precautions described in this manual and the contents of the
M

safety plates on the machine and equipment. Failure may cause serious personal injury or
YA

material damage. Please replace any missing safety plates as soon as possible.
3

2. No modifications are to be performed that will affect operation safety.


01

3. For the purpose of explaining the operation of the machine and equipment, some illustrations
)2

may not include safety features such as covers, doors, etc. Before operation, make sure all
(c

such items are in place.


ht

4. This manual was considered complete and accurate at the time of publication, however, due to
ig
yr

our desire to constantly improve the quality and specification of all our products, it is subject
op

to change or modification. If you have any questions, please contact the nearest Technical
C

Center or Technology Center.


5. Always keep this manual near the machinery for immediate use.
6. If a new manual is required, please order from the nearest Technical Center or Technology
Center with the manual No. or the machine name, serial No. and manual name.
7. The export of machining programs may be restricted to prevent them from being used for
military purposes. The machining programs you prepared are your property, so you should
manage them yourself in accordance with the law.
Issued by Manual Publication Section, YAMAZAKI MAZAK CORPORATION, Japan

03.2019

Copyright (C) 2017 YAMAZAKI MAZAK CORPORATION. All Rights Reserved.


C
op
yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 30
K 04
C
O 16
Serial No. 300416

R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 300416

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Preface
Safety precautions relating to the CNC unit (in the remainder of this manual, referred to simply as
the NC unit) that is provided in this machine are explained below. Not only the persons who
create programs, but also those who operate the machine must thoroughly understand the
contents of this manual to ensure safe operation of the machine.
Read all these safety precautions, even if your NC model does not have the corresponding
functions or optional units and a part of the precautions do not apply.

.
Rule

d
ve
er
1. This section contains the precautions to be observed as to the working methods and states

s
usually expected. Of course, however, unexpected operations and/or unexpected working

re
states may take place at the user site.

ts
During daily operation of the machine, therefore, the user must pay extra careful attention to

gh
its own working safety as well as to observe the precautions described below.

ri
ll
2. Although this manual contains as great an amount of information as it can, since it is not

.A
rare for the user to perform the operations that overstep the manufacturer-assumed ones,

N
not all of “what the user cannot perform” or “what the user must not perform” can be fully

O
TI
covered in this manual with all such operations taken into consideration beforehand.
16

It is to be understood, therefore, that functions not clearly written as “executable” are


A
R
04

“inexecutable” functions.
PO
30

3. The meanings of our safety precautions to DANGER, WARNING, and CAUTION are as
R
o.

follows:
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

: Failure to follow these instructions could result in loss of life.


A
IM

DANGER
K
ZA

: Failure to observe these instructions could result in serious harm to a human


A

life or body.
M

WARNING
YA
3
01

: Failure to observe these instructions could result in minor injuries or serious


)2

machine damage.
CAUTION
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

HGENPA0102E S-1
Serial No. 300416

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Basics

 After turning power on, keep hands away from the keys, buttons, or switches of the
operating panel until an initial display has been made.

WARNING  Before proceeding to the next operations, fully check that correct data has been entered
and/or set. If the operator performs operations without being aware of data errors,
unexpected operation of the machine will result.
 Before machining workpieces, perform operational tests and make sure that the machine
operates correctly. No workpieces must be machined without confirmation of normal
operation. Closely check the accuracy of programs by executing override, single-block,
and other functions or by operating the machine at no load. Also, fully utilize tool path

d.
check, Virtual Machining, and other functions, if provided.

ve
er
 Make sure that the appropriate feed rate and rotational speed are designated for the

s
re
particular machining requirements. Always understand that since the maximum usable

ts
feed rate and rotational speed are determined by the specifications of the tool to be used,

gh
those of the workpiece to be machined, and various other factors, actual capabilities differ

ri
from the machine specifications listed in this manual. If an inappropriate feed rate or

ll
rotational speed is designated, the workpiece or the tool may abruptly move out from the

.A
machine.

N
O
 Before executing correction functions, fully check that the direction and amount of

TI
16

correction are correct. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if a correction
A
R
04

function is executed without its thorough understanding.


PO
30

 Parameters are set to the optimum standard machining conditions prior to shipping of the
R
o.

machine from the factory. In principle, these settings should not be modified. If it becomes
O
N

absolutely necessary to modify the settings, perform modifications only after thoroughly
al

understanding the functions of the corresponding parameters. Modifications usually affect


ri

ZA
Se

any program. Unexpected operation of the machine will result if the settings are modified
A

without a thorough understanding.


IM
K

Remarks on the Cutting Conditions Recommended by the NC


ZA
A
M

 Before using the following cutting conditions:


YA

• Cutting conditions that are the result of the MAZATROL Automatic Cutting Conditions
3

Determination Function
01

WARNING
)2

• Cutting conditions suggested by the Machining Navigation Function


(c

• Cutting conditions for tools that are suggested to be used by the Machining Navigation
ht

Function
ig
yr

Confirm that every necessary precaution in regards to safe machine setup has been taken
op

– especially for workpiece fixturing/clamping and tool setup.


C

 Confirm that the machine door is securely closed before starting machining.
Failure to confirm safe machine setup may result in serious injury or death.

S-2
Serial No. 300416

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Programming

 Fully check that the settings of the coordinate systems are correct. Even if the designated
program data is correct, errors in the system settings may cause the machine to operate
in unexpected places and the workpiece to abruptly move out from the machine in the
WARNING
event of contact with the tool.
 During surface velocity hold control, as the current workpiece coordinates of the surface
velocity hold control axes approach zeroes, the spindle speed increases significantly. For
the lathe, the workpiece may even come off if the chucking force decreases. Safety speed
limits must therefore be observed when designating spindle speeds.
 Even after inch/metric system selection, the units of the programs, tool information, or

d .
parameters that have been registered until that time are not converted. Fully check these

ve
data units before operating the machine. If the machine is operated without checks being

ser
performed, even existing correct programs may cause the machine to operate differently

re
from the way it did before.

ts
gh
 If a program is executed that includes the absolute data commands and relative data

ri
commands taken in the reverse of their original meaning, totally unexpected operation of

ll
the machine will result. Recheck the command scheme before executing programs.

.A
N
 If an incorrect plane selection command is issued for a machine action such as arc

O
interpolation or fixed-cycle machining, the tool may collide with the workpiece or part of

TI
16

the machine since the motions of the control axes assumed and those of actual ones will
A
R
04

be interchanged. (This precaution applies only to NC units provided with EIA/ISO


PO
30

functions.)
R
o.

 The mirror image, if made valid, changes subsequent machine actions significantly. Use
N

the mirror image function only after thoroughly understanding the above. (This precaution
al

K
ri

applies only to NC units provided with EIA/ISO functions.)


ZA
Se

 If machine coordinate system commands or reference position returning commands are


IM

issued with a correction function remaining made valid, correction may become invalid
K

temporarily. If this is not thoroughly understood, the machine may appear as if it would
ZA

operate against the expectations of the operator. Execute the above commands only after
A

making the corresponding correction function invalid. (This precaution applies only to NC
M

units provided with EIA/ISO functions.)


YA

 The barrier function performs interference checks based on designated tool data. Enter
3
01

the tool information that matches the tools to be actually used. Otherwise, the barrier
)2

function will not work correctly.


(c

 The system of G-code and M-code commands differs, especially for turning, between the
ht

machines of INTEGREX i/e-Series and the other turning machines.


ig

Issuance of the wrong G-code or M-code command results in totally non-intended


yr

machine operation. Thoroughly understand the system of G-code and M-code commands
op
C

before using this system.

Sample program Machines of INTEGREX i/e-Series Turning machines


–1
S1000M3 The milling spindle rotates at 1000 min . The turning spindle rotates at 1000 min–1.
–1
S1000M203 The turning spindle rotates at 1000 min . The milling spindle rotates at 1000 min–1.

S-3
Serial No. 300416

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

 For the machines of INTEGREX i/e-Series, programmed coordinates can be rotated using
an index unit of the MAZATROL program and a G68 command (coordinate rotate com-
mand) of the EIA/ISO program. However, for example, when the B-axis is rotated through
WARNING
180 degrees around the Y-axis to implement machining with the turning spindle No. 2, the
plus side of the X-axis in the programmed coordinate system faces downward and if the
program is created ignoring this fact, the resulting movement of the tool to unexpected
positions may incite collisions.
To create the program with the plus side of the X-axis oriented in an upward direction, use
the mirror function of the WPC shift unit or the mirror imaging function of G-code
command (G50.1, G51.1).
 After modifying the tool data specified in the program, be sure to perform the tool path

d.
check function, the Virtual Machining function, and other functions, and confirm that the

ve
er
program operates properly. The modification of tool data may cause even a field-proven

s
machining program to change in operational status.

re
If the user operates the machine without being aware of any changes in program status,

ts
interference with the workpiece could arise from unexpected operation.

gh
For example, if the cutting edge of the tool during the start of automatic operation is

ri
present inside the clearance-including blank (unmachined workpiece) specified in the

ll
.A
common unit of the MAZATROL program, care is required since the tool will directly move

N
from that position to the approach point because of no obstructions being judged to be

O
present on this path.

TI
For this reason, before starting automatic operation, make sure that the cutting edge of
16

A
R
the tool during the start of automatic operation is present outside the clearance-including
04

PO

workpiece specified in the common unit of the MAZATROL program.


30

R
o.

O
N

 If axis-by-axis independent positioning is selected and simultaneously rapid feed selected


C
al

for each axis, movements to the ending point will not usually become linear. Before using
K
ri

ZA

these functions, therefore, make sure that no obstructions are present on the path.
Se

CAUTION
A

 Before starting the machining operation, be sure to confirm all contents of the program
IM

obtained by conversion. Imperfections in the program could lead to machine damage and
K

operator injury.
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

S-4
Serial No. 300416

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Operations

 Single-block, feed hold, and override functions can be made invalid using system
variables #3003 and #3004. Execution of this means the important modification that
makes the corresponding operations invalid. Before using these variables, therefore, give
WARNING
thorough notification to related persons. Also, the operator must check the settings of the
system variables before starting the above operations.
 If manual intervention during automatic operation, machine locking, the mirror image
function, or other functions are executed, the workpiece coordinate systems will usually be
shifted. When making machine restart after manual intervention, machine locking, the
mirror image function, or other functions, consider the resulting amounts of shift and take

d.
the appropriate measures. If operation is restarted without any appropriate measures

ve
being taken, collision with the tool or workpiece may occur.

ser
 Use the dry run function to check the machine for normal operation at no load. Since the

re
feed rate at this time becomes a dry run rate different from the program-designated feed

ts
gh
rate, the axes may move at a feed rate higher than the programmed value.

ri
 After operation has been stopped temporarily and insertion, deletion, updating, or other

ll
commands executed for the active program, unexpected operation of the machine may

.A
result if that program is restarted. No such commands should, in principle, be issued for

N
the active program.

O
TI
16

A
 During manual operation, fully check the directions and speeds of axial movement.
R
04

PO
30

 For a machine that requires manual homing, perform manual homing operations after
R

turning power on. Since the software-controlled stroke limits will remain ineffective until
o.

CAUTION
O
N

manual homing is completed, the machine will not stop even if it oversteps the limit area.
C
al

As a result, serious machine damage will result.


ri

ZA
Se

 Do not designate an incorrect pulse multiplier when performing manual pulse handle feed
A

operations. If the multiplier is set to 1000 times and the handle operated inadvertently,
IM

axial movement will become faster than that expected.


K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

S-5
Serial No. 300416

REQUEST TO THE USER

REQUEST TO THE USER

Request for Saving Data of Machining Programs


Machining programs saved on the local disk of the NC unit may not be read out in the event of
accidental local disk trouble. The user, therefore, is earnestly requested to back up and store
every machining program of importance at regular intervals onto an external memory (USB
memory, SD card, etc.).

 The procedure for data storage is detailed in the Operating Manual, Part 3
(OPERATING NC UNIT AND PREPARATION FOR AUTOMATIC
OPERATION), Chapter 10, (DISPLAYS RELATED TO DATA STORAGE).

d.
 Always use an initialized USB memory or SD card. The USB connector and

ve
er
the SD card slot are located on the right side of the machine operating panel.

s
re
ts
gh
ri
USB memory SD card

ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

 On machines with a random ATC feature, each actual ATC operation changes the tool
data (in pocket numbers). Be sure not to run the machine after loading the externally
stored data of the TOOL DATA display without having confirmed the data’s
CAUTION correspondence to the current tooling on the magazine. Otherwise the machine cannot be
be guaranteed to operate normally.

S-6
Serial No. 300416

BEFORE USING THE NC UNIT

BEFORE USING THE NC UNIT

Limited Warranty
The warranty of the manufacturer does not cover any trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its
non-intended purpose. Take notice of this when operating the unit.
Examples of the trouble arising if the NC unit is used for its non-intended purpose are listed
below.
1. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available software
products (including user-created ones)
2. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any Windows operating systems

d.
ve
3. Trouble associated with and caused by the use of any commercially available computer

er
equipment

s
re
ts
Operating Environment

gh
ri
1. Ambient temperature

ll
.A
During machine operation: 0° to 50°C (32° to 122°F)

N
O
2. Relative humidity

TI
16

A
During machine operation: 10 to 75% (without bedewing)
R
04

PO

Note : As humidity increases, insulation deteriorates causing electrical component parts to


30

deteriorate quickly.
o.

O
N

C
al

Network Setting
ri

ZA
Se

The NC unit operates using dedicated network adapters.


A
IM

Note 1: Do not change the settings of the following two network adapters. Any changes will
K

prevent the NC unit from operating normally.


ZA

 Ethernet_NC (IP address:192.168.100.2)


A

 NC Trainer Virtual Network (IP address:192.168.202.10)


M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

S-7
Serial No. 300416

BEFORE USING THE NC UNIT

Note 2: Use “Ethernet_PC” to connect the NC to an intra-factory network and other systems.
Do not use, however, the following network addresses: “192.168.100.xxx” and
“192.168.202.xxx”

 If the setting of the network adapter “Ethernet_PC” is changed, other systems


connected to the network may not operate normally. So, be sure to check the
settings of the other systems on the network as well. Here are some
examples of systems connected to the network.
Other systems Sections describing how to configure network settings
Smooth PMC Operating Manual of the Smooth PMC
“Network Setting for the MAZATROL at the Machine”
TOOL HIVE Operating Manual & Maintenance Manual of the Extended
TOOL HIVE

d .
“How to Change Network Settings”

ve
Magazine display unit for Operating Manual of the Visual Tool ID/Data Management

er
Tool ID (touch panel) “CONNECTING TO THE LOCAL AREA NETWORK”

s
re
ts
Note 3: If you configure network settings for the NC unit, using Internet Information Services

gh
(IIS) on Windows, do not use the following port numbers.

ri

ll
21

.A
 683

N
 43816

O
 55555

TI

16

55556 A

R
04

57400
PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

S-8 E
Serial No. 300416

CONTENTS

1 INTRODUCTION .................................................................................. 1-1

2 PARAMETER ....................................................................................... 2-1

2-1 Outline ................................................................................................................ 2-1

2-1-1 Types of parameters ............................................................................................... 2-1

d .
2-1-2 Precautions ............................................................................................................. 2-2

ve
s er
2-2 Parameter List .................................................................................................... 2-3

re
ts
gh
2-2-1 User parameter ....................................................................................................... 2-3

ri
ll
2-2-2 Machine parameter ............................................................................................... 2-34

.A
N
2-2-3 Data I/O parameter ............................................................................................... 2-69

O
TI
16

A
2-3 Detailed Description ......................................................................................... 2-73
R
04

PO
30

2-3-1 Structure of the parameter list .............................................................................. 2-73


o.

O
N

C
al

2-3-2 User parameter POINT (D) ................................................................................ 2-75


ri

ZA
Se

2-3-3 User parameter LINE/FACE/3D (E) ................................................................. 2-106


IM
K

2-3-4 User parameter EIA/ISO (F) ............................................................................. 2-140


ZA
A
M

2-3-5 User parameter SOFT LIMIT (I) ....................................................................... 2-234


YA

2-3-6 User parameter SYSTEM (SU) ........................................................................ 2-240


3
01
)2

2-3-7 User parameter TURNING (TC) ....................................................................... 2-267


(c
ht

2-3-8 User parameter SOLID (SD) ............................................................................ 2-269


ig
yr
op

2-3-9 User parameter DISPLAY STRUCTURE (US)................................................. 2-279


C

2-3-10 Machine parameter CALL MACRO (J) ............................................................. 2-283

2-3-11 Machine parameter MEASURE (K) .................................................................. 2-297

2-3-12 Machine parameter TABLE (L) ........................................................................ 2-350

2-3-13 Machine parameter FEED VEL. (M) ................................................................ 2-392

C-1
Serial No. 300416

2-3-14 Machine parameter TIME CONST. (N) ............................................................ 2-410

2-3-15 Machine parameter ANOTHER (S) .................................................................. 2-420

2-3-16 Machine parameter SPINDLE (SA) .................................................................. 2-434

2-3-17 Machine parameter BARRIER (BA) ................................................................. 2-458

2-3-18 Data I/O parameter CMT parameter (CMT) ..................................................... 2-488

2-3-19 Data I/O parameter TAPE parameter (TAP) .................................................... 2-490

d .
ve
2-3-20 Data I/O parameter DNC parameter (DNC) ..................................................... 2-501

s er
re
2-3-21 Data I/O parameter OTHER (IOP/DPR/IDD).................................................... 2-509

ts
gh
3 ALARM ................................................................................................. 3-1

ri
ll
.A
3-1 Outline ................................................................................................................ 3-1

N
O
TI
16

3-1-1 Alarm display .......................................................................................................... 3-1


A
R
04

PO
30

3-1-2 Precautions ............................................................................................................. 3-2


R
o.

O
N

3-2 Detailed Description ........................................................................................... 3-3


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

3-2-1 Structure of the alarm list ........................................................................................ 3-3


A
IM

3-2-2 No. 1 - No. 99, No. 1000 - No. 1099 (System/Drive error) ...................................... 3-4
K
ZA
A

3-2-3 No. 100 - No. 199, No. 1100 - No. 1199 (CNC machine control error) ................. 3-18
M
YA

3-2-4 No. 200 - No. 399, No. 1200 - No. 1399 (PLC machine control error) .................. 3-39
3
01

3-2-5 No. 400 - No. 499, No. 1400 - No. 1499 (CNC screen operation error)................ 3-53
)2
(c
ht

3-2-6 No. 500 - No. 599, No. 1500 - No. 1599 (I/O error) .............................................. 3-78
ig
yr

3-2-7 No. 600 - No. 699, No. 1600 - No. 1699 (MAZATROL program error) ................. 3-93
op
C

3-2-8 No. 700 - No. 799, No. 1700 - No. 1799 (MAZATROL program error) ............... 3-110

3-2-9 No. 800 - No. 899, No. 1800 - No. 1899 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-124

3-2-10 No. 900 - No. 999, No. 1900 - No. 1999 (EIA/ISO program error) ...................... 3-142

3-2-11 No. 2000 - No. 2099 (3D setup error) ................................................................. 3-158

C-2
Serial No. 300416

3-2-12 No. 2100 - No. 2199 (Interference error) ............................................................ 3-164

3-2-13 No. 2200 - No. 2299 (CAM data output error) .................................................... 3-168

3-2-14 No. 2600 - No. 2699 (CNC screen operation error) ............................................ 3-170

4 M-CODE LIST....................................................................................... 4-1

d.
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

C-3
C
op
yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 30
K

C-4 E
04
C
O 16
Serial No. 300416

R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 300416

INTRODUCTION 1
1 INTRODUCTION
This manual describes the meaning and setting of various parameters, and the meaning and
elimination procedure of various alarms used for the MAZATROL Smooth System. This
document also gives the list of M-codes.
For detailed description of the MAZATROL Smooth System, refer to the Operating Manual of the
machine.
Read this manual and the Operating Manual of the machine carefully in order to make the best
use of the possibilities of the MAZATROL Smooth System.

.
d
ve
ser
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

1-1
1

C
op
yr
INTRODUCTION

ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 30
K

1-2 E
04
C
O 16
Serial No. 300416

R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2 PARAMETER

2-1 Outline
1. Scope of this chapter
This chapter describes the parameters you can change as required. How to read the list is
described in the beginning. Always refer to this list to change parameters.
2. Precautions on this chapter
This chapter also gives parameters relating to optional functions. Accordingly, the list
includes parameters which cannot be changed. Check the type of machine purchased by
you and its specifications before you read the list.

.
d
ve
Note 1: The contents of this list are subjected to change without notice, for NC unit or machine

er
improvement.

s
re
Note 2: Any questions about the contents of this list should be communicated to Mazak

ts
Technical Center or Technology Center.

gh
ri
2-1-1 Types of parameters

ll
.A
Parameters, which refer to constants specific to the NC machines and equipment and the data

N
necessary for cutting operations, possess a very important meaning.

O
TI
Parameters can be broadly divided into the following three types according to their meaning.
16

A
R
 User parameters
04

PO
30

The data required for processes such as point machining, line machining, plane machining,
R

turning, and EIA/ISO programmed machining, is registered. The USER PARAMETER display
o.

O
N

is used to register the user parameters.


C
al

 Machine parameters
ri

ZA
Se

Constants related to the servomotors and spindle motors, machine status data etc. are
A

registered. The MACHINE PARAMETER display is used to register the machine parameters.
IM

 Data I/O parameters


K
ZA

The data required for connection to external units such as a CMT unit and a tape unit, is
A

registered. The DATA I/O PARAMETER display which can be selected on the DATA I/O
M

display is used to register the data I/O parameters.


YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-1
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-1-2 Precautions
1. Details of the parameters may differ according to the machine used, the presence/absence
of an option(s), the production time of the NC machines and equipment, etc. Therefore, do
not use the parameters of other machines.
2. The parameter list is supplied in the form of data sheets within the NC electronic cabinet at
shipment of the machines. Be careful not to lose the list.
3. Before making changes to details of a parameter, make sure that the parameter is the one
to be changed.
4. If details of the parameter to be changed cannot be clearly understood, contact the nearest
Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

d .
5. When changing details of a parameter, maintain records of the old and new data.

ve
er
6. If the particular machine is not used for a long time, then the battery to protect the parameter

s
re
memory will run down. (Battery alarm)

ts
In that case, errors will occur in the parameters and thus machine malfunctions may result.

gh
To prevent this, first check the existing details of the parameters closely against the

ri
separate parameter list and then make the necessary changes to the parameters.

ll
.A
7. In addition to the parameters listed in this document, those related to PLC (Programmable

N
Logic Controller) are also available; refer to the OPERATING MANUAL of the machine for

O
details of the PLC-related parameters and the PLC Parameter List in the ELECTRIC

TI
16

WIRING DIAGRAM. A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-2
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-2 Parameter List

2-2-1 User parameter

1. POINT (D)

Address
Outline
(bit)

D1 Height of the second R-point during point machining

D2 Nominal diameter of spot-machining tool

d .
D3 Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom in spot-machining cycle

ve
s er
D4 Maximum allowable spot-chamfering hole diameter element

re
ts
D5 Prehole through speed during inversed spot-facing

gh
ri
D6 Drill-machining cycle setting element

ll
.A
D7 Drill-machining cycle setting element

N
O
TI
D8 Maximum diameter of holes machinable on one drill
16

A
R
04

D9 Maximum diameter of holes machinable on two drills


PO
30

R
o.

D10 Maximum diameter of holes machinable on three drills


O
N

C
al

D11 Through-hole/tap-prehole machining overshoot


ri

ZA
Se

D12 Stop-hole machining hole-bottom clearance


IM
K

D13 Spot-machining hole diameter (fixed value)


ZA
A

D14 Depth-of-cut setting element for drilling (ALMINUM)


M
YA

D15 Depth-of-cut setting element for drilling (except AL)


3

Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom for chamfering cutter or spot-machining tool in chamfering
01

D16
cycle
)2
(c

D17 Interference clearance of chamfering cutter


ht
ig

D18 Return feed rate for reaming or boring (cycle 3)


yr
op

D19 Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom for end milling
C

D20 Radial depth-of-cut setting element for end milling

D21 Reference bottom-finishing allowance for end milling

D22 Tapping-cycle dwell time

D23 Prehole clearance for end milling

2-3
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

D24 Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom for boring

D25 Boring-bar tip relief

D26 Returning distance from hole bottom for boring or back-boring

D28 Bottom-finishing amount of boring

D29 Chip removal time

. d
D30 Number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle

ve
er
D31 Tapper elongation amount for tapping

s
re
ts
D32 Number of spindle revolutions until spindle CCW rotation begins in tapping cycle

gh
ri
D33 Back-boring tool tip relief

ll
.A
D35 Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for reamer (drilling)

N
O
D36 Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for reamer (boring)

TI
16

A
R
04

D37 Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for reamer (end milling)


PO
30

D38 Reamer-prehole diameter setting element for boring or end milling


o.

O
N

C
al

D39 Reamer-prehole diameter setting element for end milling


K
ri

ZA
Se

D40 Number of revolutions during dwell at spot-faced hole bottom for inversed spot-facing
A
IM

D41 R-point height during point-machining


K
ZA

D42 Height of the third R-point during point machining


A
M
YA

D43 Number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle for piped screw


3
01

D44 Selecting an automatic calculation method for the amount of chamfer with the tapping unit
)2

D45 Gradual decrements in drilling depth


(c
ht

D46 Minimum gradual drilling depth


ig
yr
op

D47 Reamer-prehole machining overshoot


C

D48 Feed override for the section to be chamfered in the planetary tapping cycle

D49 Amount of return at hole bottom during the planetary tapping cycle

D50 Auto-set feed rate for pre-hole machining in the planetary tapping cycle

D51 Auto-set feed rate for planetary tapping cycle

D52 Reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate during a very-deep-hole drilling cycle

2-4
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Number of times of pecking up to the return of the tool to a position near the starting point of the
D53
very-deep-hole drilling cycle of a drilling or turning-drilling unit

D54 Deceleration rate at cutting start for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle

D55 Drilling return distance for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle

Number of revolutions during dwell at chip ejection position and hole bottom for very-deep-hole drilling
D56
cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle

D57 Return speed for very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle

Feed rate reduction distance ratio at cutting start of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental

.
D58

d
very-deep-hole machining cycle

ve
Surface speed reduction ratio at cutting end of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole

er
D59
machining cycle

s
re
D60 Automatic setting ratio of axial cutting feed rate during chamfering

ts
gh
D61 Nominal diameter of chamfering cutter, set during automatic tool development for a point machining unit

ri
ll
.A
D62 Maximum number of times automatic pecking is to be performed by MAZATROL programs

N
Reduction ratio for the G00 feed rate from the chip ejection position to the return position during a deep-hole

O
D66
drilling/very-deep-hole drilling cycle

TI
16

D73 - D77 Learning of cutting conditions (DEP-Z range)


A
R
04

PO
30

D78 - D82 Learning of cutting conditions (WID-R range)


R
o.

O
N

D91 0 M04 is output/not output after the tool has dwelled at the hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

D91 1 The tool dwells/does not dwell after M04 has been output at the hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
A
IM

D91 2 The tool dwells/does not dwell after it has been returned to the R-point during a tapping cycle.
K
ZA

D91 3 If a drill is used in the pre-machining of the centering drill cycle, the R-point height is set to D1 or not.
A
M

D91 4 The finishing tool path is shortened/not shortened during a true-circle processing cycle (end milling).
YA

D91 5 The tool path is shortened/not shortened during a true-circle processing cycle (chamfering).
3
01

If a pre-machining tool sequence is included in the same unit, the R-point height of the drill is set/not set to D1
)2

D91 6
or D42.
(c

The R-point height of the chamfering cutter during the cycle 2 is set to D42 or not.
ht

D91 7 The R-point height of the spot-machining tool during the chamfering cycle (cycle 2) is set to D42 or not.
ig

R-point height selection for smooth chamfering (point machining)


yr
op

D92 0 During a true-circle processing (end milling) cycle, E17 is used for axial feed or not.
C

D92 1 The R1-point height of the back spot facing is set to D1 or not.

If a chamfering cutter is included in the premachining tool sequence of the same unit, the R-point height of the
D92 2
reamer is set to D1 or not.
If a chamfering cutter is included in the pre-machining tool sequence of the same unit, the R-point height of
D92 3
the tapping is set to D1 or not.
The position cleared radially or axially by D17 from the workpiece section concerned is subjected to check for
D92 4
interference or not.

D92 5 Dwell time designation for synchronous tapping in a MAZATROL program valid/invalid

2-5
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

D92 6 During planetary tapping, chips are ejected/not ejected automatically prior to the threading process.

Whether or not to generate alarm 650 CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE if idle cutting takes place during
D92 7
chamfering in point-machining unit

D93 Unidirectional positioning for point-machining

D94 Unidirectional positioning for point-machining

D95 Auto-setting method for tapping

.
D96 0 Surface speed calculation for spot drill used

d
ve
er
D96 1 Element that determines the counterboring pattern

s
re
D96 2 Setting of the amount of chamfer in the spot drill tool sequence

ts
gh
Menu display setting of RGH BCB (inversed faced hole machining), BK-CBORE (back boring) and

ri
D96 3 CBOR-TAP (counterbore tapping), as well as BACKSPOT FACER (inversed spot-facing tool) and BACK

ll
BORING BAR (back boring) in the tool sequence data

.A
D96 7 Cutting depth in deep-hole tapping/high-speed deep-hole tapping cycle

N
O
TI
D97 0 Cutting drawing method for circular milling unit on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
16

A
R
04

Action to be taken when the number of times pecking has been performed has reached the set maximum
D98 0
PO

count
30

R
o.

D98 1 Execution of the INDEX unit when the PRI.No. is set in the MANUAL PROGRAM
O
N

C
al

D100 0 fixed value


ri

ZA
Se

D105 0 Handling the X-axial coordinates of non-turning TPC relay points


IM

D105 1 Tap high-speed deep-hole cycle menu display/hidden


K
ZA

D106 0 Machine operation when machining units are not preceded by an indexing unit
A
M
YA

D106 1 Execution of an index command after the second or subsequent work coordinate command in WPC unit
3
01

D106 2 T-code output during indexing before the end unit


)2

D106 4 Selection of rotational axis command system by table selection


(c
ht

D106 5 Alarm output timing when the first machining unit is not preceded by an index unit
ig
yr
op

D107 1 Fixed value


C

D107 2 Alarm output when 3D coordinate conversion mode cancel is specified in the manual program unit

D107 3 Unit of feed rate for the feed per minute command in manual program units for the inch system

D107 4 Calculation method for mill spindle speed when spot chamfering

D130 Chip ejection distance in deep-hole drilling cycle

D131 G00 feed-in speed override for deep-hole boring cycle

2-6
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

D141 0 Chip ejection operation during deep-hole drilling cycle

D141 1 Feed-in operation selection for deep-hole boring cycle

D141 2 Circular milling unit: Circular processing selection method switch

D143 0 WPC unit/WPC shift unit

D143 1 Selection of approach after ATC in initial point type program

d .
ve
2. LINE/FACE/3D (E)

er
Address

s
Outline

re
(bit)

ts
E1 Closed-pattern cutting start point and escape point setting element

gh
ri
E2 Cutting start point and escape point setting element (the first clearance)

ll
.A
E4 Reference allowance of finishing in radial direction

N
O
TI
E5 Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point (the second clearance)
16

A
R
04

E6 Reference allowance of finishing in axial direction


PO
30

R
o.

E7 Allowance of cutting start point in axial direction (the second clearance)


O
N

C
al

E8 Radial interference clearance of chamfering cutter


ri

ZA
Se

E9 Allowance of axial-cutting start position (the first clearance)


IM

E10 Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element (Face milling, End milling-top, End milling-step)
K
ZA

E11 Axial interference clearance of chamfering cutter


A
M

E12 Radial interference clearance of face milling unit and angular face milling unit
YA
3

E13 Tool path setting element for end milling-top unit


01
)2

E14 Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element (Pocket milling, Pocket milling-mountain, Pocket milling-valley)
(c
ht

E15 Tool path setting element for face milling-top unit (reciprocating short)
ig
yr

E16 Peripheral-cutting feed rate override for end milling-mountain unit


op
C

E17 Axial-cutting feed rate override

E18 Override in case of the overall width cutting for pocket-machining

E19 Returning feed rate override in case of bidirectional cutting for rough-machining of the end milling-slot unit.

E20 Axial cutting feed override during Z-axial cutting in the pecking mode of face machining

E21 Wall-cutting overlap in closed figure

2-7
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

E22 Override value of automatic corner over-riding

E23 Effective removal allowance (upper limit) of automatic corner overriding

E24 Effective removal allowance (lower limit) of automatic corner overriding

E25 Effective angle (upper limit) of automatic corner overriding

E26 Calculation coefficient for the finishing feed of line milling

E27 Radial direction feed rate calculation reference diameter for finish cutting in line machining unit

.
d
ve
er
E28 Finishing feed rate calculation reference feed rate in line machining unit

s
re
E29 Selection of whether the cutting conditions in the shape sequence during VFC mode are to be modified

ts
gh
An element that determines the starting point and escape point of radial cutting when CLOSED is specified
E30
for the wall attributes at the starting point and ending point of open-pattern line machining

ri
ll
E31 Element that determines the amount of OPEN attribute wall protrusion in pocket-machining shape units

.A
N
E32 Element used for automatically determining the approach radius in a Z-direction helical approach

O
TI
Element used for automatically determining the amount of in-feed per revolution in the Z-axis direction in a
16

E33
Z-direction helical approach
A
R
04

PO
30

E34 Element that automatically determines an approaching distance in a Z-direction tapered approach scheme
R
o.

O
N

E35 Approaching gradient for a Z-direction tapered approach scheme


C
al

K
ri

ZA

E36 Element that automatically determines an escape distance in the Z-direction tapered escape scheme
Se

A
IM

E37 The amount of return of pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode of face machining
K

E38 The returning feed rate of pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode of face machining
ZA

Element that automatically determines the depth-of-cut-R (Pocket milling, Pocket milling-mountain, Pocket
A

E39
M

milling-valley, End milling-slot)


YA

E40 Element used for automatically determining the approach radius in a Z-direction helical approach (helical 2)
3
01

Element used for automatically determining the amount of in-feed per revolution in the Z-axis direction in a
E41
Z-direction helical approach (helical 2)
)2
(c

E43 Magnification factor of surface speed in helical approach


ht
ig

E55 3-D, Axial cutting-feed overriding


yr
op

E56 3-D, Inversion check of curved-surface pattern


C

E57 3-D, Severity check of cutting pitch

E58 3-D, Tool-diameter compensation

E59 3-D, Allowance of axial-cutting start position

E60 3-D, Normal cutting allowance

E61 3-D, Search length for parallel cutting

2-8
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

E62 3-D, Search length for right-angle cutting

E63 3-D, Pattern display division segment (FL direction)

E64 3-D, Pattern display division segment (GL direction)

E65 3-D, Radial cutting allowance for area check

E66 3-D, Axial cutting allowance for area check

E67 - E75 3-D, Processing error tolerance

d .
ve
er
E76 3-D, Entire-width override

s
re
E77 3-D, Radial cutting allowance for high-speed rough processing (workpiece size appointment)

ts
gh
E78 3-D, Multiplying factor set for tolerance

ri
ll
E83 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing (offset appointment)

.A
N
E84 3-D, Region of axial machining during high-speed rough processing (offset appointment)

O
TI
16

E85 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: –X (workpiece size appointment)
A
R
04

PO
30

E86 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: +X (workpiece size appointment)
R
o.

E87 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: –Y (workpiece size appointment)
N

C
al

E88 3-D, Region of radial machining during high-speed rough processing: +Y (workpiece size appointment)
ri

ZA
Se

E89 3-D, Region of axial machining during high-speed rough processing (workpiece size appointment)
IM
K

E91 Tool-path pattern selection for end milling-mountain unit


ZA

E92 Tool-path pattern selection for pocket milling unit


A
M
YA

E93 Tool-path pattern selection for pocket milling-mountain unit


3
01

E94 Tool-path pattern selection for pocket milling-valley unit


)2

E95 Tool-path pattern selection for line-machining unit


(c
ht

E96 1 R-point height for end milling-slot unit


ig
yr

E96 2 Approach method selection for 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting in end milling-slot unit
op
C

E96 4 Approach point for 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting in end milling-slot unit

E96 5 Returning feed rate override of the end milling-slot unit

Smooth chamfering (end milling-slot): Switching of restrictions according to the cutting edge angle of the
E96 7
chamfering tool

E97 Tool-path pattern selection for end milling-top unit

E98 Cutting method selection for end milling-mountain, pocket milling-valley unit

2-9
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

E99 0 Milling feed rate specification range for the shape sequence of the MAZATROL program

E99 1 Bottom/wall simultaneous finishing mode for pocket machining

E99 3 Interference check between the approach point and the cutting starting point of face machining

E99 4 Alarm generating condition during the approach or escape for line machining

Machining start point calculation method after automatic determination of approach point in line machining
E99 6
unit

E104 0 Cutting method to be used after an approach point is automatically determined during line/face machining

d .
ve
E104 1 Returning position during face machining

s er
re
E104 2 Returning position during line machining

ts
gh
E104 3 Infeed position when a CLOSED attribute is assigned to the wall of line machining

ri
ll
E104 4 Method of connecting between shapes during line machining

.A
N
E104 5 Method of connecting between shapes during wall finish of face machining

O
TI
16

E104 6 Calculation of the ZC machining feed rate A


R
04

PO

E104 7 Tool change command output selection


30

R
o.

E105 0 B-axis user-defined angle setting during C-axis central line machining
N

C
al

E105 1 Machining shape specification method in line machining in ZC mode/on C-axis


ri

ZA
Se

E105 7 Operation when tool path generation using WID-R specified for pocket milling fails
IM

E106 1 Selection of a relay point to be used before TPC escapement (line/face machining unit)
K
ZA

Display of a warning message when a corner radius is automatically inserted to a shape during intelligent
E108 0
A

pocket milling (IPM) path creation


M

Display of a warning message when an uncut residue remains due to nose R during intelligent pocket milling
YA

E108 1
(IPM) path creation
3
01

E108 4 Execution of a full-circle path movement after helical approach in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
)2

E108 5 Operation on failure of tool entry during intelligent pocket milling (IPM)
(c
ht

E108 7 Multiple approach point specification in intelligent pocket milling (IPM)


ig
yr
op

E109 Allowable limits of engage angle in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining
C

E110 Maximum radius of arc inserted for intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining

E111 Element that determines the tool paths in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining (Pocket milling-valley)

E112 Maximum wall avoidance distance in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining

E113 Bottom face avoidance distance/clearance for recovering surface speed in plane machining

E115 Magnification factor of the minimum arc of trochoid cycle in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining

2-10
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

E116 Feedrate override for non-cutting feed in intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining

E129 Amount of overlapping in groove expanding operation in the end milling-slot unit

E131 Element that automatically determines depth-of-cut-R (line machining)

E132 Radial interference clearance of round bar face milling unit

E133 Surface speed change position in helical approach

E134 Clearance in the tool axial direction in engraving units

d .
ve
E141 1 Face milling-/end milling-top unit: Cutting start point determination method at manual approach point setting

s er
re
E141 5 Surface speed change mode selection in helical approach

ts
gh
Selection of calculation formula for automatic determination of approach point in finishing on a line machining
E141 6
unit when finishing allowance - Z = 0

ri
ll
E141 7 Operation upon specifying a figure of eight for free closed pattern of line/face machining unit

.A
N
E142 0 Cylindrical surface machining method in initial-point scheme C-axis line machining unit

O
TI
16

A
3. EIA/ISO (F)
R
04

PO
30

Address
R

Outline
o.

(bit)
O
N

F1 G61.1 corner deceleration coefficient (%)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F2 G61.1 arc-clamping speed coefficient (%)


A
IM

F3 For high-speed smoothing control


K
ZA

F4 Distance to judge the shape formed by 3 axes under tool tip point control in the 5-axis fairing function
A
M

F5 Distance to judge the shape formed by rotary 2 axes in the 5-axis fairing function
YA
3

F6 Minimum allowable height of stepped sections for deceleration in high-speed smoothing control mode
01
)2

F7 Fixed value (0)


(c
ht

F8 Corner deceleration speed coefficient for high-speed smoothing control


ig
yr

F9 Circular cutting clamp speed coefficient for high-speed smoothing control


op
C

F10 Return amount during tap high-speed deep-hole cycle

F11 Vector constant for 3-D, tool-diameter compensation

F12 Return amount of pecking in drill high-speed deep-hole cycle or in G73

F13 Allowance amount of rapid-feed stop in deep-hole drilling cycle or in G83/G283

F14 Rotation center of coordinates (axis of abscissa)

2-11
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F15 Rotation center of coordinates (axis of ordinate)

F16 Horizontal length of coordinate rotation

F17 Vertical length of coordinate rotation

F18 Angle of coordinate rotation

F19 Maximum permissible difference in arc radius

.
F20 Fixed value of scaling factor

d
ve
er
F21 Maximum inside-corner angle available with automatic corner override (G62)

s
re
F22 Deceleration area of automatic corner overriding (G62)

ts
gh
F27 Handling of G92 (spindle speed clamp value) command at restart

ri
ll
.A
F28 Threading chamfering angle

N
O
F29 Override value of automatic corner overriding (G62)

TI
16

F30 G-code type selection


A
R
04

PO
30

F31 Selection of a roughing priority type for program layout


R
o.

O
N

F32 Operation when argument R is omitted from the maximum/minimum spindle speed setting
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F33 0 Incorporation of the MAZATROL tool length into the current position counter valid/invalid
A
IM

F33 2 Tool management function


K
ZA

F33 3 Selection of check in the course of automatic operation when data is input/output through network
A
M

F33 4 Selection of restart setting method in the MAZATROL program


YA

F33 6 Modal indication for G-code group No. 1 in the fixed cycle mode
3
01
)2

F33 7 Modal indication on “radius data input for X-axis” in the mode of 3D coordinate conversion (G68.5)
(c
ht

F34 0 Cancellation of the ram spindle offset command (G52.1) when the RESET key is pressed valid/invalid
ig
yr

F34 1 Representation on the POSITION display for G49 (only for the INTEGREX e Series)
op
C

F34 2 Parts count override in the middle of automatic operation

F34 4 Programming type for inclined-surface machining

F34 6 Compensating movement for a T-code with a movement command in one block

F34 7 Application of Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values for the tape operation mode

Selection whether or not multiple material pieces can be arranged on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D
F35 0
MONITOR display

2-12
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Automatic setting of the material model for a MAZATROL program of initial-point scheme on the VIRTUAL
F35 1
MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display
When assigning G-code for a cutting function not to be represented with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
F35 2
being selected for automatic operation, operation is continued/alarm state
When a program prepared and stored for the Hard Disk operation is called up as a subprogram with the
F35 3
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being selected for automatic operation, operation is continued/alarm state

F35 4 Representation of cutting-off or parting operation on the VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D MONITOR displays

Alarming/No alaming when the feed-overriding value has been changed in the flow of automatic operation
F35 7
with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being active

.
F36 1 Automatic M-code setting in EIA/ISO program modal restarting mode

d
ve
er
F36 2 Automatic S-code setting in EIA/ISO program modal restarting mode

s
re
F36 3 Error check function in cases where numerical data is omitted in the EIA program or in MDI mode

ts
gh
Display of the chuck and tailstock areas for an EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK
F36 4

ri
display

ll
Number of effective decimal digits in the tool axis vector components (I, J, K) for tool tip point control type 2

.A
F36 6
(G43.5) and cutting point command type 2 (G43.9)

N
O
F36 7 Rotational axis prefiltering

TI
16

F37 1
A
Subprogram call given in manual program unit (for turning machines only)
R
04

PO
30

F37 2 Tool length compensation in MDI operation


R
o.

O
N

F37 3 Timing of clearing #3006 (stop) message


al

K
ri

ZA

Operation when running programs in the hard disk or through Ethernet with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
Se

F37 5
SHIELD enabled for automatic operation
A
IM

F37 6 Operation when “ATC” is not specified in end unit


K
ZA

F38 0 Options displayed in the tool model type selection window according to the tool type
A
M

F38 1 Handling of tool index numbers (after tool data exchange)


YA

F38 2 Font size setting for EIA/ISO PROGRAM display and EIA MONITOR display
3
01
)2

F38 4 Negative tool diameter setting


(c
ht

F38 5 Reverse pattern display/hidden for milling tool rotation direction


ig
yr

F39 Plane to be used for an EIA/ISO program (called by a subprogram unit) and a manual program unit
op
C

F40 Operating method selection in tape mode

F41 Threading termination waiting time processing

F42 Deceleration area r during Z-axis measurement

F43 Measurement area d during Z-axis measurement

F44 Measuring speed f

2-13
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F47 - F66 Common variable name

F68 0 G53.1 acceleration selection during pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration

Current position counter indication selection at 1-point measurement for manual measurement display on the
F68 1
setup screen

F68 4 Addition of tool position offset to the current position, enabled/disabled

F69 EIA/ISO program restart method

.
F70 Availability of multiple-machining and designated number of repetitions in the EIA/ISO subprogram

d
ve
er
F71 Machining order control

s
re
F72 Selection of the shape correction function of the MAZATROL program

ts
gh
F73 M-code execution time for time study

ri
ll
.A
F74 S-code execution time for time study

N
O
F75 T-code execution time for time study

TI
16

F76 B-code execution time for time study


A
R
04

PO
30

F77 Basis rate for tool life judgment


R
o.

O
N

F78 Selection of separating ratio of graphic display


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F79 0 Holding of memory monitor address valid/invalid


A
IM

F79 1 Selection of menu display


K
ZA

F79 2 Key history function valid/invalid


A
M

F79 3 Tool search method


YA

F79 4 Selection of tap gear


3
01
)2

F79 5 Display of tools currently in use valid/invalid


(c
ht

F79 6 Initial value of synchronous/asynchronous tapping during tapping tool registration


ig
yr

F79 7 Display of a MAZATROL monitor window valid/invalid


op
C

F80 0 MAZATROL function valid/invalid

F80 1 Automatic display of the navigation window on the occurrence of an alarm valid/invalid

F80 2 MAINTENANCE CHECK display at power on, displayed/not displayed

F80 3 Third page of the MAINTENANCE CHECK display, displayed/not displayed

F80 4 GRAPHIC MAINTENANCE display on the occurrence of an alarm, displayed/not displayed

2-14
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

F80 5 Learning of cutting conditions valid/invalid

F80 6 Editing on the CUTTING CONDITION LEARN display valid/invalid

F80 7 Destination of spare tool correction by the workpiece measurement

F81 0 Program editing prohibited (in 9000’s)

F81 1 Program displaying prohibited (in 9000’s)

.
F81 2 Fixed value (0)

d
ve
er
F81 3 Add-in MAZATROL valid/invalid

s
re
F81 4 Program editing prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)

ts
gh
F81 5 Program displaying prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)

ri
ll
.A
F81 6 Retaining the program transfer settings valid/invalid

N
O
F81 7 Input error prevention function valid/invalid

TI
16

F82 0
A
Characteristics estimation result graph, displayed/not displayed
R
04

PO
30

Selection of inch/metric representation in POSITION display, TOOL DATA display, and TOOL OFFSET
F82 1
R

display modes valid/invalid


o.

O
N

F82 2 Basis for tool life judgment


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F82 3 —
A
IM

F82 4 X-axis diameter display on the POSITION display valid/invalid


K
ZA

F82 5 —
A
M

F82 6 Automatic setting of the grooving tool length


YA

F82 7 Index tool wear correction setup during automatic operation


3
01
)2

F83 0 Output of the alarm history data as text data valid/invalid


(c
ht

F83 1 Operation record function valid/invalid


ig
yr

F83 2 —
op
C

F83 3 —

F83 4 —

F83 5 —

F83 6 —

F83 7 —

2-15
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)
Selection of whether or not the tool offset data is taken into account for the POSITION counter during the
F84 0
execution of EIA/ISO programs

F84 1 Switching of arguments B and J in a fixed cycle

F84 2 Spare tool search method for EIA/ISO programs

F84 3 Timing to validate new workpiece offset data specified with a system variable

F84 4 Machine coordinate system (G92) selection

.
F84 5 Incremental/absolute data command in high-speed machining mode

d
ve
er
F84 6 Tape run method

s
re
F84 7 Operation executed/not executed when the tool data has not bee set

ts
gh
F85 0 Table rotational machining

ri
ll
.A
F85 1 Radial interference check

N
O
F85 2 Type of coordinate system for controlling the tool tip point

TI
16

F85 3 Tool tip point control scheme


A
R
04

PO
30

F85 4 Fixed value (0)


R
o.

O
N

F85 5 Reset to cancel G68.2, valid/invalid


al

K
ri

ZA

Display of surface definition 


Se

F85 6
A
IM

F86 2 Override scheme for G0 during tool tip point control


K
ZA

F86 4 Display of the PART SHAPE window


A
M

F86 5 Override scheme for G1 during tool tip point control


YA

F86 6 Selection of rotary axis reference position for tool tip point control
3
01
)2

F87 0 Selection of whether or not the machine is to be offset by each change only in the deviation vector
(c

Selection of whether or not the check for mismatch of the workpiece origin and table rotation center is to be
ht

F87 1
conducted
ig
yr

F87 2 Data alteration checking function valid/invalid (tool-related function)


op
C

F87 3 Feed rate display method for the superposition system

F87 4 Single-block mode cancellation during fixed cycle invalid/valid

F87 5 Common variables (#500 and on) are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid

F87 6 Local variables are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid

F87 7 Common variables (#100 to #199) are cleared by resetting or at the program end, invalid/valid

2-16
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

F88 Specifications related to the conversion from MAZATROL program into an EIA program

F89 0 [For EIA conversion] Output of shape data

F89 1 [For EIA conversion] G-codes for synchronous tapping: G74/G84 or G84.2/G84.3

F89 2 [For EIA conversion] Output of F command

F89 3 [For EIA conversion] Mill-turning unit conversion, alarm/shifted path

.
F89 4 [For EIA conversion] Output destination, standard area/ backup area

d
ve
er
F89 5 —

s
re
F89 6 [For EIA conversion] Returning to the second zero point before tool change (output of G30)

ts
gh
F89 7 Fixed value (0)

ri
ll
.A
F91 0 In response to move command without decimal point, tool moves by 1/tool moves by 10

N
O
F91 1 Coordinate system shift using a MAZATROL program, valid/invalid

TI
16

F91 2
A
Stroke inside check before movement/Stroke outside check before movement
R
04

PO
30

F91 3 —
R
o.

O
N

F91 4 Metric (Initial G20 is valid/invalid)/Inch


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F91 5 In response to move command without decimal point:


A
IM

F91 6 G00 interpolation/non-interpolation


K
ZA

F91 7 G33E command is for the number of threads per inch/command is for thread cutting with precise lead
A
M

F92 0 Modal at power-on or at reset (G17 or G19/G18)


YA

F92 1 Modal at power-on or at reset (G17 or G19/G18)


3
01
)2

F92 2 Dwell command method


(c
ht

F92 3 Tool-length compensation (G43, G44) axis for milling tools


ig
yr

F92 4 Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42) start up/cancel type


op
C

F92 5 Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42) interference check

F92 6 Fixed-cycle hole-drilling axis

F92 7 ACT-/NOSE-R in the TOOL DATA display for an EIA/ISO program, invalid/valid

F93 0 Modal at power-on or at reset (G96/G97)

F93 1 Modal at power-on or at reset (G94/G95 for machining centers, G98/G99 for lathes)

2-17
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F93 2 Modal at power-on or at reset (G91/G90)

F93 3 Tool length of tool data for an EIA/ISO program, invalid/valid

F93 4 Feed rate during machine lock

F93 5 Middle point during reference-point return

F93 6 Single-block operation mode at user macro operation instruction

.
F93 7 Fixed value (0)

d
ve
er
F94 0 Movement to hole-drilling position in fixed-cycle mode

s
re
F94 1 External deceleration signal valid/invalid

ts
gh
F94 2 Tool length offset cancellation upon zero point return by G28/G30 or manual operation, enabled/disabled

ri
ll
.A
F94 3 Modal at power-on or at reset (G01/G00)

N
O
F94 4 Tool command method using T-codes

TI
16

F94 5 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

F94 6 Fixed value (1)


R
o.

O
N

F94 7 Tool offset amount effectuated in an EIA/ISO program


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F95 0 Interrupt function using user macro instruction, valid/invalid


A
IM

F95 1 Handling of macroprogram interruption and call


K
ZA

F95 2 Automatic return position to restart the program (Fixed to 1)


A
M

F95 3 G00 (positioning) command feed rate for dry run


YA

F95 4 Wear offset check scheme with the input error prevention function enabled
3
01
)2

F95 5 Alarm display when the slave or adaptor unit is not connected
(c
ht

F95 6 Manual-pulse interrupt amount cancellation with the RESET key, valid/invalid
ig
yr

F95 7 Coordinate system corresponding to G54 set with the RESET key, valid/invalid
op
C

F96 0 Selection of variable number for tool offset amount

F96 1 Fairing function valid/invalid

F96 2 Processing for arc command blocks in high-speed machining mode, nonuniform feed/uniform feed

F96 3 —

F96 4 Selection of a corner judgment criterion in high-speed machining mode

2-18
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

F96 5 Selection of a cutting feed clamping speed in high-speed machining mode

F96 6 Rotational axis shape correction valid/invalid

F96 7 —

F97 Selection of G-code of the coordinates system to be used in the EIA conversion function

F98 Number of macro variable to be used in the EIA conversion function

Offset amount for the subprogram WNo. to the main WNo. concerned in case of output with subprogram in

.
F99

d
the EIA conversion function

ve
er
F100 Spline cancel length

s
re
F101 Spline cancel angle

ts
gh
F102 Fine spline interpolation curve error (Block including the point of inflection)

ri
ll
.A
F103 Spline interpolation fairing block length, 5-axis spline interpolation small block length

N
Fine spline interpolation curve error (block including no inflection point), 5-axis spline interpolation curve error,

O
F104
5-axis fairing command error

TI
16

F107 Small block judgment length


A
R
04

PO
30

F108 Corner deceleration angle increment value


R
o.

O
N

F109 Number of common variables between turrets (#100 onward)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F110 Number of common variables between turrets (#500 onward)


A
IM

F111 1 Use/disuse of dry run during thread cutting


K
ZA

F111 2 Use/disuse of feed hold during thread cutting


A
M

F111 3 Direction of rotation of the C-axis during C-axial threading with G01.1
YA

F111 5 Tool correction amount selection for EIA/ISO programs


3
01
)2

F111 6 Execution mode selection for a fixed turning cycle


(c
ht

F111 7 Form of single-block stop during a fixed turning cycle


ig
yr

F112 Selection of measurement data items to be printed out


op

Counting all types of use under the same tool number for the tool life management on the TOOL DATA
C

F113 0
display executed/not executed

F113 1 Data handling on the milling tool of a group that has expired in tool life

F113 2 Data handling on the turning tool of a group that has expired in tool life

F113 3 Tool life management of the FLASH tool

F113 4 Tool life management — Life time

2-19
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F113 5 Tool life management — Maximum available wear offset data X

F113 6 Tool life management — Maximum available wear offset data Y

F113 7 Tool life management — Maximum available wear offset data Z

F114 0 Selection of the maximum C-axial cutting feed rate for the inch system

Selection of the operation occurring during the control of the tool tip point when command G49 is issued
F114 1
(when the tool length offset value is canceled)

.
F114 3 Moving axes by using G49 (tool length cancel) in G43 (tool length offset) mode, valid/invalid

d
ve
er
F114 4 Selecting a rethreading function

s
re
F114 5 Output timing of a tool life alarm

ts
gh
F114 6 Initial setting of G53.5

ri
ll
.A
F114 7 Judging tool life from the count of machined workpieces, valid/invalid

N
O
F116 Feed rate of the threading runout — X-axis

TI
16

F117 Feed rate of the threading runout — Y-axis


A
R
04

PO
30

F118 Feed rate of the threading runout — Z-axis


R
o.

O
N

F119 Runout feed rate for the inside diameter threading cycle
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F120 Clamping speed for the threading cycle — X-axis


A
IM

F121 Clamping speed for the threading cycle — Y-axis


K
ZA

F122 Clamping speed for the threading cycle — Z-axis


A

Processing of work offset specified with G53.1 for the machine whose table rotary axis is not an axis that
M

F123 1 rotates around the Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine specification featuring both the tool rotary axis
YA

and the table rotary axis)


3
01

F123 2 Shape drawing: Validity of a mirroring command specified in the M CODE unit
)2

F123 3 MDI tool change enable/disable for tools with no tool data
(c
ht

F123 7 EIA conversion sequence number output


ig
yr
op

F124 Permissible data alteration amount 1 for input error prevention function
C

F125 Permissible data alteration amount 2 for input error prevention function

F126 Maximum wear offset setting with the input error prevention function enabled

F128 5-axis spline interpolation angular error, 5-axis fairing angular error

F129 5-axis spline interpolation corner deceleration coefficient

F130 5-axis spline interpolation arc-clamping speed coefficient

2-20
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

F135 Tool-drawing accuracy on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display

F136 Amount of offset for dummy workpiece shape on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display

F137 Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for No. 1 turning spindle

F138 Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for No. 2 turning spindle

Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for the No. 1
F139
turning spindle
Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for the No. 2

.
F140

d
turning spindle

ve
er
F142 Background color of spindle override window displayed when the external override function is used

s
re
Operation when workpiece counting is made valid while the automatic operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY
F143 0

ts
SHIELD is enabled

gh
F143 1 Status of [STORE WORKPCE MATERIAL] when the power is turned on

ri
ll
.A
F143 2 —

N
O
F143 6 Display of WPC during inclined-surface machining on the POSITION display

TI
16

F143 7 G43 modal cancel selection with the RESET key


A
R
04

PO
30

F144 1 Selection of table rotary axis reference position for inclined-surface machining
R
o.

O
N

F144 2 Resetting of a tool life alarm with the alarm clear button
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F144 3 Setting a minus value for argument Q in hobbing, valid/invalid


A
IM

F144 5 Selection of operation by the G49 command immediately after a macro variable command
K
ZA

F144 6 Deletion of unnecessary codes during EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers
A
M

F144 7 Deletion of G92.5 blocks during EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers
YA

F145 Rapid feed override when data alteration is detected


3
01

Selection of the material model’s part to be taken off (hidden) on the VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D
)2

F146
MONITOR displays in the flow of turning operation under synchronization of both spindles
(c
ht

F148 Compensation amount for G41/G42 given in a manual program (MANL PRG) unit
ig
yr

F149 Operation between blocks when single block mode is switched from ON to OFF during automatic operation
op
C

F150 Output data offset of NC basic information for field network

F151 1 Fixed value

Switching of the material geometry when execution of a program is returned to the head during continuous
F151 2
program run

F151 7 Time stamp used at the time of read/write command to macro variable #3001 (power-on time)

F152 Fixed value (0)

2-21
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F153 SMART font display, valid/invalid

F154 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

F155 3 Operation when argument I is omitted from the tap cycle command having argument Q

The operating status and the drawing on the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with
F156 0
rotary axis movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid
The operating status and the drawing on the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with
F156 1
rotary axis movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid
Separation between rotary axis and linear axis when moving axes during workpiece placement error

.
F156 2

d
correction

ve
er
F156 3 Selection of solution to workpiece placement error correction (primary rotary axis sign prioritized)

s
re
F156 4 Pitch division in the case when the arc length exceeds the maximum value during helical/spiral interpolation

ts
gh
F156 5 Single-block stop when the VFC key is pressed with override set to 100%

ri
ll
.A
F156 6 Fixed value (0)

N
O
F156 7 Geometric deviation compensation function, valid/invalid

TI
16

F157 0 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

F157 1 Geometry compensation/modal spline tolerance (chord error) input, valid/invalid


R
o.

O
N

F157 2 EIA tip position memory


al

K
ri

ZA

MAZATROL table selection unit (2 tables) on the VIRTUAL MACHINING, 3D MONITOR, or 3D SETUP
Se

F157 3
display
A
IM

Switching of the axis directions for the VTC machine model on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR
F157 4
display
K
ZA

F157 5 Add-in EIA function


A
M

F158 0 Tool length/tool diameter check function after tool change


YA

F158 1 Output timing of MSTB command after a movement command under geometry compensation
3
01

Selection of wear offset direction when the tool length compensation (G43P3) and 3D coordinate conversion
)2

F158 7
functions are used together
(c

Timing of data creation for the MACHINING NAVIGATION - RESULT display with workpiece counting made
ht

F159 0
valid
ig
yr

F159 1 Modal selection at power on or at reset (G64/G61.1)


op
C

F159 2 Fixed value

F159 3 Fixed value

F159 4 Whether or not to display on the POSITION display a spindle output diagram stored in the setting file

F160 1 Feedrate display during tool tip point control

F160 2 Fixed value

2-22
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

F160 7 Priority change when erasing the tool path from the TOOL PATH CHECK display or TRACE display

F161 0 Shape/wear offset number separation, valid/invalid

F161 1 Shape offset handling

F161 2 Tool offset timing

F161 3 Tool offset vector handling if reset function is executed

.
F161 4 Shape offset handling if offset number 0 is entered

d
ve
er
F161 5 Simplified wear offset, valid/invalid

s
re
F161 6 C/Z offset when a MAZATROL program is called from an EIA program

ts
gh
F161 7 C/Z offset when an EIA program is called from a MAZATROL program

ri
ll
Movement/No movement according to the particular amount of offset during independent start of tool tip point

.A
F162 0
control

N
O
F162 1 Type of passage of tool tip point through singular point

TI
16

F162 2 Chamfer/corner R-command address selection


A
R
04

PO
30

F162 3 Fixed hole-machining cycle return selection


R
o.

O
N

F162 4 6 digits in T-command for turning


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F162 5 Use of the M Pro scheme as the method of selecting the Length correction axis bit
A
IM

F162 6 MAZATROL program check for missing Z-offset, valid/invalid


K
ZA

F162 7 Encoder polarity selection


A
M

F163 0 Bar feeder scheduling function, valid/invalid


YA

F163 1 Incorporation of wear offset data into the current position display in EIA/ISO program mode, valid/invalid
3
01
)2

F163 2 Incorporation of wear offset data into the current position display in MAZATROL program mode, valid/invalid
(c
ht

F163 3 Position of thread turning tool nose on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display
ig
yr

F163 4 Barrier check on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display valid/invalid


op
C

F163 6 Menu on the DATA I/O display (tape), displayed/hidden

F163 7 Menu on the DATA I/O display (CMT), displayed/hidden

F164 0 Automatic tool data setting conditions Magazine (turret) tool

F164 2 PROGRAM LAYOUT display save function selection

F164 4 Automatic tool data setting conditions Invalid tools

2-23
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F164 5 Automatic tool data setting conditions Broken tools

F164 6 Automatic tool data setting conditions Expired tools

F164 7 Automatic tool data setting conditions Life warning tools

F165 0 High-speed synchronous tapping function, valid/invalid

F165 1 X-axis movement to minus side during polar coordinate interpolation, enabled/disabled

.
F165 2 Polar coordinate interpolation of the C-axis, in radius/diameter

d
ve
er
F165 3 C-axis indexing when EIA subprogram is called from MAZATROL program

s
re
F165 4 Modal or non-modal state of Q command in deep-hole drilling cycle

ts
gh
F165 5 Conversion of tool set data for milling tool based on head swivel angle when G53.5 is commanded

ri
ll
.A
F165 6 Behavior of automatic operation of an EIA program when Z-offset is not set

N
O
F165 7 Setting at CONTI. of the end unit during tool path check, valid/invalid

TI
16

F166 0
A
Alteration of tool set value (tool length) on the TOOL DATA display in the automatic operation mode,
R
04

enabled/disabled
PO
30

F166 1 Type of wear offset indicated in the milling tool list on the TOOL DATA display
R
o.

O
N

F166 2 ID No./Tool name selection on the TOOL DATA display


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F166 3 Selection whether the selected plane on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK display is to be held
A
IM

Operation conducted when [RESTART] is tapped following completion of the search in EIA modal restarting
F166 4
mode
K
ZA

F166 5 Tool diameter auto-setting for the end mill, face mill, and ball end mill on the TOOL DATA display
A
M

F166 7 Automatic backup function


YA

F167 0 Threading (by turning) shift angle (Q-command) unit


3
01
)2

F167 1 Handling the diameter/radius of point R during the hole-machining fixed cycle
(c
ht

F167 2 Handling the tool measured using the G137H command


ig
yr

F167 3 Handling the single-process mode when operation is completed/reset


op
C

F167 4 Connecting the path linearly/Alarm, if the arc internal correction value is greater than the arc radius

F167 5 Handling the X-axis command in G68.5

F167 6 Wear correction direction

F167 7 Updating the current position by a press of the RESET key in manual operation mode

F168 0 Selection of operation to perform when dynamic offset II is canceled

2-24
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Rotational center offset is added/not added to the tool length when the tool axial tool length offset command
F168 2
(G43.1) is issued.

F168 3 Axis for the milling tool wear correction and TOOL EYE compensation amount for the B-axis rotational turret

F168 4 Conversion of 3D coordinate conversion into inclined-surface machining

F168 5 Holding the amount of manual handle pulse interruption

F168 6 [RESTART2 NONMODAL] during stop of an EIA program execution invalid/valid

.
F168 7 Correction pattern for the groove/protrusion width measurement

d
ve
er
F169 1 Rapid feed overlapping function

s
re
The function to restart machine operation after the detection of collision by the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
F169 2

ts
SHIELD function

gh
ri
F169 3 Fixed value (0)

ll
.A
F169 4 Handling of smooth corner control setting width when G61.1 is specified in MAZATROL programs

N
O
F169 5 Calling of the program specified in the end unit upon reaching the target part count, enabled/disabled

TI
16

F169 7 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

F170 0 Consideration of the offset amount of dynamic offsetting II at the current position
R
o.

O
N

F170 2 Tool offset changed in an EIA program in a tool path check


al

K
ri

ZA

Continuous diameter display of the X-axis coordinates on the displays/Diameter value input in the X-axis
Se

F170 3
direction for tip position memory on the TOOL DATA display
A
IM

Inclusion of the MAZATROL tool length in the tool length offset displayed on the POSITION screen
F170 4
(machining centers)
K
ZA

F241 Operation when address P is omitted in G297/G298 command


A
M

F269 Fixed value (1)


YA

F270 Smooth corner control function: Setting width


3
01
)2

F271 Smooth corner control function: Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient
(c
ht

F272 Smooth corner control function: Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient for high-speed smooth control
ig
yr

F273 Smooth corner control function: Cancellation angle


op
C

F274 Cutting feedrate override rate in the tool axial direction for the EIA/ISO engraving function

F275 Character depth for the EIA/ISO engraving function

F276 Character height for the EIA/ISO engraving function

F277 Retraction height for the EIA/ISO engraving function

F300 INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD: Cutting accuracy

2-25
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

F301 INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD: Tool path accuracy for collision check processing

F302 Allowance in rapid feed stop in deep-hole boring cycle

F303 G01 feed-in speed for deep-hole boring cycle

F304 Alarm wait time during [CUT] restarting search during VIRTUAL MACHINING

F326 Automatic operation intelligent safety shield (ISS)/virtual machining interference check selection

.
F328 Real time tuning II Number of buffers for calculating the average of optimum time constants

d
ve
er
F329 0 Operation at specification of undefined SMC data number

s
re
F329 3 Automatic M code output for smooth restart

ts
gh
F329 4 Operation to return to the restarting position for smooth restart

ri
ll
.A
F330 0 Hobbing selection

N
O
F330 1 Hobbing axis (V-axis) clamping speed selection in hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)

TI
16

F330 2
A
Machine coordinate display of hobbing axis (V-axis) and workpiece spindle (C-axis) in hobbing II (position
R
04

controlled hobbing)
PO
30

F330 7 Life count for multiple tools with the same tool number and different tool names
R
o.

O
N

F331 1 Synchronized tapping feed command mode


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

F331 3 Safe spindle speed calculation


A
IM

F331 4 Shape sequence specification at restart in a MAZATROL program


K
ZA

F331 5 Outputting alarm upon specification of shaping (G41.1/G42.1) in the geometry compensation mode (G61.1)
A

Action to take when the part count is set using the program with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD enabled
M

F335 7
for automatic operation
YA

F336 2 Variable acceleration control G0


3
01
)2

F336 6 Variable acceleration control


(c
ht

F336 7 Super-high-speed machining


ig
yr
op

4. SOFT LIMIT (I)


C

Address
Outline
(bit)

I1 Shift amount of unidirectional positioning (G60)

I2 Upper (plus direction) user soft-limit

I3 Lower (minus direction) user soft-limit

I5 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable override: Minimum value

2-26
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

I7 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area (lower limit side)

I8 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area (upper limit side)

I9 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area lower limit

I10 Function for making the G0 speed variable, Variable control area upper limit

I11 Rotary center of a workpiece

.
I12 Clamping value for the amount of handle interruption

d
ve
er
I13 0 Execution of G28 (reference-point return)

s
re
I13 1 Manual zero-point return operation

ts
gh
I13 2 Axis display when a control axis is removed

ri
ll
.A
I13 6 Removal of control axes, valid/invalid

N
O
I14 0 Mirror image with respect to the machine zero point, valid/invalid

TI
16

I14 1 —
A
R
04

PO
30

I14 2 User software limits (I2, I3) valid/invalid


R
o.

O
N

Tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining (boring or
C

I14 3
al

back-boring), valid/invalid
K
ri

ZA

Direction of tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining
Se

I14 4
(boring or back-boring)
A
IM

I14 5 —
K
ZA

I14 6 —
A
M

I14 7 —
YA

I17 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 0°)
3
01
)2

I18 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 45°)
(c
ht

I19 Amount of work hand rotational error correction (Work hand angle: 90°)
ig
yr

I21 Fixed point 1 specified by the user


op
C

I22 Fixed point 2 specified by the user

5. SYSTEM (SU)
Address
Outline
(bit)

SU1 Axis setting I for plane selection

SU2 Axis setting I for plane selection

2-27
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SU3 Axis setting I for plane selection

SU4 Axis setting J for plane selection

SU5 Axis setting J for plane selection

SU6 Axis setting J for plane selection

SU7 Axis setting K for plane selection

.
SU8 Axis setting K for plane selection

d
ve
er
SU9 Axis setting K for plane selection

s
re
SU10 Selection of tool change command output position

ts
gh
ri
SU11 Movement of axes during approach

ll
.A
SU12 Rotating position specified in the indexing unit after tool change

N
O
SU13 Axis name of the transfer axis

TI
16

SU14
A
Tool nose mark display color on the TOOL PATH CHECK display/TRACE display
R
04

PO
30

SU15 Name of thrust axis for servo axis


R
o.

O
N

SU16 Movement to C-axis index swivel position when Z-offset scheme is used
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SU17 Background color for the MDI window


A
IM

SU18 Character color for the MDI window


K
ZA

Selecting the method of axis movement to the tool change command output position or to the position
SU19
designated at RETURN of the end unit
A
M

SU20 Coefficient for polygonal machining spindle acceleration


YA

Selection of returning operation after the execution of the workpiece transfer unit corresponding to the work
3

SU21
hand angle to be changed
01
)2

SU23 Cutting feed rate reduction rate in composite-type fixed cycle


(c
ht

SU24 Spindle speed multiplication factor in the execution of a composite-type fixed cycle
ig
yr

SU29 Specification of an axis (linear axis) on a plane during polar coordinate interpolation
op
C

SU30 Specification of an axis (rotary axis) on a plane during polar coordinate interpolation

SU49 Delay timer for the parts catcher

SU50 Tool turning clearance (radial value) in X-axis

SU51 Tool turning clearance in Z-axis

SU52 Lower-turret retraction function - Tool number of the retraction tool 1

2-28
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

SU53 Lower-turret retraction function - Tool number of the retraction tool 2

SU55 Wait time for accessing the programs in the hard disk operation area/Ethernet operation area

SU56 For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value

SU97 -
Lower-turret retraction function - Fixed point of the retraction position
SU100

SU102 Return distance at wall during rough cutting in bar machining or in corner machining of EIA/ISO program

.
SU103 Cutting depth in the composite-type fixed cycle

d
ve
er
SU104 Pecking return distance in grooving of EIA/ISO program

s
re
SU105 Cut depth (diametral value) for final cut in composite-type thread cutting cycle of EIA/ISO program

ts
gh
Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial value) in composite-type thread cutting cycle G276 of EIA/ISO
SU106

ri
program

ll
.A
SU107 Safety clamp speed

N
O
SU108 Safeguarding strength

TI
16

SU109 Tip mass


A
R
04

PO
30

SU110 -
Tool length setting range check function - settable data range
R

SU113
o.

O
N

SU114 Feed-in speed reduction distance for composite-type fixed cycle


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SU123 Admissible motion range on the primary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
A
IM

SU124 Admissible motion range on the secondary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
K
ZA

SU125 Fixed value


A

Retraction position of the upper and lower turrets at the end of the two-workpiece machining sequence
M

SU128
(X-axis)
YA

Retraction position of the upper and lower turrets at the end of the two-workpiece machining sequence
SU129
3

(Z-axis)
01
)2

SU153 0 M-code selection for tapping cycle


(c

SU153 1 Display of BUFFER on the POSITION display


ht
ig
yr

SU153 2 Display of REMAIN on the POSITION display


op
C

SU153 3 Display of POSITION on the POSITION display

SU153 4 Automatic retraction of the lower turret for MAZATROL programs

“C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs (line/linear machining for the C-axis CYLIND
SU153 5
mode)

SU153 6 MAZATROL point machining with C-axis clamped (M210)

“C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs (line/linear machining for the C-axis FACE
SU153 7
mode)

2-29
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SU154 0 Displaying tool-setting values for ATC-type turret

SU154 1 Tool length setting range check function

SU154 2 Displaying the “next distance” during execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4

SU154 3 Displaying the “remaining distance” during execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4

SU154 4 Displaying the “current position” during execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4

.
SU154 5 Display of BUFFER during G17.1 - G17.5 mode

d
ve
er
SU154 6 Display of REMAIN during G17.1 - G17.5 mode

s
re
SU154 7 Display of POSITION during G17.1 - G17.5 mode

ts
gh
SU155 0 Fixed value (1)

ri
ll
Correction timing of the touch sensor tool length during EIA/ISO programmed or MDI operation

.A
SU155 1
(for machining center specifications only)

N
O
SU155 2 Operation at an EIA subprogram call from a MAZATROL program

TI
16

SU155 3
A
Judgment method for tool change command output during MAZATROL programmed operation
R
04

PO
30

SU155 4 Tool change command output at the start of MAZATROL programmed operation
R
o.

O
N

SU155 7 Reference value for judging tool breakage during laser tool measurement
al

K
ri

ZA

SU156 4 Type of deep-hole drilling cycle G83/G87


Se

A
IM

SU156 5 Fixed value (0)


K

Execution of the restarting search for a block in the mode of G68 when tool length compensation (G43/G44)
ZA

SU156 6
remains valid with a turning tool mounted
A
M

SU156 7 Execution of the restarting search for a block after the cancellation of the cross command
YA

The scheme of axis movement during an approach and during movement to the tool change command output
SU157 1
3

position for machining at the work hand side


01
)2

SU157 2 Conditions for returning to the tool change command output position in the manual program unit (MANL PRG)
(c
ht

SU157 3 Movement to the tool rotating position for tool change command for the same TNo.
ig
yr

SU157 4 Operation to be performed if either TURN POS X, Y, or Z of the indexing unit is left blank.
op

Preparatory C-axis positioning to 0° for a manual program unit (MANL PRG) with a milling tool after a turning
C

SU157 5
unit
Selection of whether or not the B-axis rotation radius is to be included into the “clearance position” for
SU157 7
changing the indexed cutting edge on one and the same FLASH tool
Checking the rotational axes’ correction values in workpiece placement error correction for MAZATROL
SU158 2
programs

SU158 3 Handling of G43P0 tool length compensation with a touch sensor

SU158 4 Fixed value (0)

2-30
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

SU158 7 Manual tool measurement tool wear offset clear function

SU159 0 “TOOL NAME ORDER” display/hidden with random ATC machines

SU159 1 Selection of whether or not to consider the tool length for tip position memory on the WORK OFFSET display

SU161 0 Buffer block limit for tool diameter compensation/tool nose radius offset in manual program units

SU165 0 Current position display for milling tool with B-axis angle reflected in manual operation mode

. d
6. TURNING (TC)

ve
er
Address

s
Outline
(bit)

re
ts
TC3 Acceleration rate in up-going wall slope (90°) for rough cutting in bar machining unit

gh
ri
Selection of chamfering pattern in rough external turning cycle G71 (G271) or rough edge-machining cycle
TC4
G72 (G272)

ll
.A
TC72 Number of times of roughing in the composite-type fixed cycle (G273, G73)

N
O
TI
TC117 Composite-type fixed cycle — G273 amount of X-axial release
16

A
R
04

TC118 Composite-type fixed cycle — G273 amount of Z-axial release


PO
30

TC141 0 Use/disuse of acceleration in up-going slope during rough cutting cycle in bar machining unit
o.

O
N

C
al

7. SOLID (SD)
ri

ZA
Se

Address
Outline
IM

(bit)
K

SD49 Machine coordinate selection


ZA
A

SD50 Table type


M
YA

SD51 Round table axis direction


3
01

SD53 Smoothness selection for arcs in the tool path check/shape check
)2
(c

SD56 Table type of the second additional table


ht
ig

SD57 Round table axis direction for the second additional table
yr
op

SD58 QUICK MAZATROL product shape display accuracy


C

SD74 Fixed value

SD97 Distance of model movement per time

SD98 Amount of model rotation per time

SD125 Minimum table dimension X

2-31
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SD126 Maximum table dimension X

SD127 Minimum table dimension Y

SD128 Maximum table dimension Y

SD129 Minimum table dimension Z

SD130 Maximum table dimension Z

.
SD131 Amount of table chamfer

d
ve
er
SD136 Table dimension of the second table Minimum table dimension X

s
re
SD137 Table dimension of the second table Maximum table dimension X

ts
gh
ri
SD138 Table dimension of the second table Minimum table dimension Y

ll
.A
SD139 Table dimension of the second table Maximum table dimension Y

N
O
SD140 Table dimension of the second table Minimum table dimension Z

TI
16

A
R
SD141 Table dimension of the second table Maximum table dimension Z
04

PO
30

SD142 Amount of table chamfer for the second table


R
o.

O
N

SD165 1 Tool data setting using QUICK MAZATROL


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SD166 0 Registration of rotary tool holder model data for turning tools
A
IM

SD167 1 Sampling data automatic save function on occurrence of an INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) alarm
K
ZA

8. DISPLAY STRUCTURE (US)


A
M

Address
YA

Outline
(bit)
3
01

US1 0 Menu highlighting method


)2
(c

US1 1 Selection of operation for automatic determination of cutting conditions when tool data is not input
ht
ig

US1 2 MAZA-CHECK input support function log output, parameter reference


yr
op

US1 4 Directory selection function in the WORK No. SELECT window


C

US1 5 Project function in the WORK No. SELECT window/PROGRAM FILE display

US1 6 Alarm window display selection while displaying Smooth application manager

US1 7 Selection of display position for the block being executed on the EIA MONITOR display

US37 Data guard function: Maximum number of users

US39 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (DRILL)

2-32
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (BOR BAR, B-B
US40
BAR and BCK FACE)
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Element that automatically determines “FR” (FCE MILL, END
US41
MILL)

US42 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Reference shank diameter (BAR, CPY, CORNER)

Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose radius when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY,
US43
CORNER and FACING)
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool width when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY and
US44
CORNER)
Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose angle when tool data is not input (BAR, CPY,

.
US45

d
CORNER and FACING)

ve
er
US46 Automatic determination of cutting conditions Tool nose width when tool data is not input (T.GROOVE)

s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-33
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-2-2 Machine parameter

1. CALL MACRO (J)

Address
Outline
(bit)

J1 - J40 G-code macroprogram call

J41 - J80 M-code macroprogram call (J44, J48, J52, J56, J60: Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited)

J89 - J107 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

.
J108 Maximum number of retrials to update the model with the SAFETY SHIELD function

d
ve
er
J109 - J112 Barrier setup chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side/NC tailstock position

s
re
J113 - J116 Barrier setup chuck reference position 2 on the No. 2 spindle side

ts
gh
J119 - J120 Barrier-setting/cancelling M-code to be used for barrier teaching

ri
ll
Amount of offset for height axis rotational center offset (K124, K128) of the rotary axis for the tool (tool tip

.A
J121
point control)

N
Setting the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid during automatic

O
J131 - J140
operation

TI
16

J141
A
Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
R
04

during automatic operation


PO
30

Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
J142 0
R

during automatic operation


o.

O
N

Selecting whether to output the M-code for making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid
C

J142 1
during automatic operation
al

K
ri

ZA

Output selection of M codes for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY
J142 2
Se

SHIELD function in automatic operation


A
IM

Output selection of M codes for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY
J142 3
SHIELD function in automatic operation
K

Method to handle the tool offset data when the program is returned to a MAZATROL program with the tool
ZA

J143 0
offset function set valid in an EIA/ISO subprogram
A

In reference point return operation (G28, G30, G30.1), tool change command is executed with or without
M

J143 2
waiting the completion of middle-point return
YA

J143 5 Modal at power-on or at reset (G23/G22)


3
01
)2

J143 7 For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value


(c

J144 0 Tool interference check type


ht
ig
yr

J144 2 Tool life data overwrite during automatic operation


op
C

J145 - J184 M-code macroprogram call

J235 Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for OD (both sides), X-axis offset for protrusion width)

J236 Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for OD (both sides), Y-axis offset for protrusion width)

J237 Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for ID (both sides), X-axis offset for groove width)

J238 Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for ID (both sides), Y-axis offset for groove width)

2-34
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

J239 Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for protrusion width, offset for ID protrusion width)

J240 Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for groove width, offset for ID groove)

J251 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (1st set of axes)

J252 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (2nd set of axes)

J253 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (3rd set of axes)

.
J254 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the separating direction (4th set of axes)

d
ve
er
J261 0 Arithmetic operation after G code

s
re
J265 - J424 G-code macroprogram call

ts
gh
J433 - J472 G-code macroprogram call

ri
ll
.A
J473 - J512 M-code macroprogram call

N
O
J513 - J530 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

TI
16

J533 - J540 For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value


A
R
04

PO
30

M code setting for temporarily disabling/canceling disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
J550 - J551
R

function in automatic operation


o.

O
N

C
al

2. MEASURE (K)
ri

ZA
Se

Address
A

Outline
(bit)
IM
K

K1 Rotational radius of the C-axis


ZA
A

K2 Minimum rotational angle


M
YA

K3 Identification number of the shaping control axis


3
01

K7 Unbalanced axis
)2
(c

K10 Fixed value


ht
ig

K11 Selection of language to be displayed


yr
op

K12 Fixed value (0)


C

K13 Measurement skip feed rate (X-axis, Z-axis)

K14 Measurement approach speed (X-axis, Z-axis)

K15 Measurement skip speed (C-axis)

K16 Measurement approach speed (C-axis)

K17 Specification of measuring tolerance (lower limit) [valid only for L106 bit 6 = 1]

2-35
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

K18 Specification of measuring tolerance (upper limit) [valid only for L106 bit 6 = 1]

K19 Measurement stroke for workpiece measurement

K20 Measurement stroke for tool nose measurement

K21 Coefficient to determine rotation angle when retrying measurement C reference face

K22 Measurement retry frequency when retrying reference face C measurement

.
K23 Retry frequency for workpiece measurement

d
ve
er
K24 - K28 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

s
re
K29 Simultaneous control: Delay counter for automatic correction of synchronizing errors

ts
gh
K30 Approach speed for laser tool length measurement

ri
ll
.A
K31 Approach speed for laser tool diameter measurement

N
O
K32 Pre-measuring speed for laser tool length measurement

TI
16

K33
A
Pre-measuring speed for laser tool diameter measurement
R
04

PO
30

K34 Pre-measuring spindle speed for laser tool length measurement


R
o.

O
N

K35 Pre-measuring spindle speed for laser tool diameter measurement


al

K
ri

ZA

Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited


Se

K36
A
IM

K37 External deceleration speed


K
ZA

K38 Work number called during S-code macroprogram appointment


A
M

K39 Work number called during T-code macroprogram appointment


YA

K40 Work number called during second auxiliary function macroprogram appointment
3
01
)2

K41 G31 skipping speed


(c
ht

K42 G31.1 skipping speed


ig
yr

K43 G31.2 skipping speed


op
C

K44 G31.3 skipping speed

K45 G31.4 skipping speed

K46 Excessive pressing error spread (Amount of drooping)

K48 Spindle FB alarm detection method

K49 First number of the standby M-codes

2-36
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

K50 Total number of the standby M-codes

K51 M-code during workpiece measurement retry operation

K52 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

K53 Vocal output language selection

K54 Vocal output sound level

.
K55 Vocal output warning reference value

d
ve
er
K56 Name of second auxiliary function

s
re
K57 Type of S-code macroprogram appointment call

ts
gh
K58 Type of T-code macroprogram appointment call

ri
ll
.A
K59 Type of second auxiliary function macroprogram appointment call

N
O
K60 Fixed value (4)

TI
16

K61 Fixed value (1)


A
R
04

PO
30

K62 Fixed value (1)


R
o.

O
N

K63 Fixed value (1)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K64 Fixed value (2)


A
IM

K65 Fixed value (1)


K
ZA

K66 Fixed value (1)


A
M

K67 Fixed value (1)


YA

Coordinate system with reference to which the offset amounts are to be used in tool length offset for the
K68 0
3

selected machining surface (For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)


01
)2

K68 3 Fixed value (0)


(c
ht

K68 4 Fixed value (0)


ig
yr

K68 5 Override/dryrun speed valid/invalid when the G31 command is issued


op

Whether all the barrier cancel data in the program is to be cleared by executing the MMS unit in a
C

K68 7
MAZATROL program

K69 0 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-2

K69 1 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-10

K69 2 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-3

K69 3 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-11

2-37
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

K69 4 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-5

K69 5 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-13

K69 6 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-6

K69 7 G31.1 skip condition SKIP-14

K70 0 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-2

.
K70 1 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-10

d
ve
er
K70 2 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-3

s
re
K70 3 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-11

ts
gh
K70 4 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-5

ri
ll
.A
K70 5 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-13

N
O
K70 6 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-6

TI
16

K70 7 G31.2 skip condition SKIP-14


A
R
04

PO
30

K71 0 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-2


R
o.

O
N

K71 1 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-10


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K71 2 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-3


A
IM

K71 3 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-11


K
ZA

K71 4 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-5


A
M

K71 5 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-13


YA

K71 6 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-6


3
01
)2

K71 7 G31.3 skip condition SKIP-14


(c
ht

K72 G31.4 skip conditions


ig
yr

K73 G4 skip conditions


op
C

K74 Emergency stop contactor cutoff time (Safety supervisory function)

K75 Contactor control output device 1 (Safety supervisory function)

K76 Contactor control output device 2 (Safety supervisory function)

K77 Door switch input device (Safety supervisory function)

K78 Number of door switches (Safety supervisory function)

2-38
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

K79 Supervisory speed filtering time during servo-off (Safety supervisory function)

K80 Warning reference value (Vocal output)

K81 Timer for machining management

K82 Fixed value

K83 Maximum amount of compensation for workpiece thermal expansion

.
K84 Maximum allowable amount of compensation for workpiece thermal expansion in each interpolating cycle

d
ve
er
K85 Special linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for threading

s
re
K87 - K89 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

ts
gh
K90 Return override during synchronous tapping

ri
ll
.A
K91 Alternative M-code for M96

N
O
K92 Alternative M-code for M97

TI
16

K93 Fixed value (2)


A
R
04

PO
30

K94 0 Selection of whether menu function is to be made invalid after operation has been stopped by [ATC STOP]
R
o.

O
N

K94 1 Indexing in measurement unit


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K94 3 W-axis command code selection for the MDI mode


A
IM

K94 5 Display/no display of a block start interlock alarm if tool life of a tool specified in the block has expired
K

Selection whether the difference in angle between the upper and lower turrets is to be incorporated into the
ZA

K95 0
current C-axis position display of HD2
A
M

K95 1 Fixed value (0)


YA

K95 2 Tool position compensation during T-command execution, performed/not performed


3
01
)2

K95 3 Coordinate system update during handle pulse interrupt, performed/not performed
(c
ht

K95 4 Fixed value (0)


ig
yr

K95 5 Acceleration/deceleration time constant for handle pulse feed


op
C

K95 6 Software limits for G30 execution valid/invalid

K95 7 In-position check valid/invalid

K96 0 G0 command in-position check valid/invalid

K96 1 Timing of manual free feed finish signal

K96 2 Fixed value (0)

2-39
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

K96 3 Axis/Cutting interlock alarm display, valid/invalid

K96 4 Suppression of lost motion in modes other than the G1 command mode, valid/invalid

K96 5 Fixed value (0)

K96 6 Fixed value (0)

K96 7 Fixed G0 inclination

.
K97 B-axis misalignment correction, name of parallel axis

d
ve
er
K98 B-axis misalignment correction, name of orthogonal axis

s
re
K99 Dynamic offset, name of rotational axis

ts
gh
K100 Dynamic offset, name of parallel axis

ri
ll
.A
K101 Dynamic offset, name of orthogonal axis

N
O
K102 0 Fixed value (0)

TI
16

K102 1 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

K102 2 Fixed value (0)


R
o.

O
N

Compensation method for the sensing tool’s eccentricity and stylus radius in workpiece measurement and
C

K102 3
coordinate measurement, M Pro compatible/New scheme
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K102 4 Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay points of a measurement unit
A
IM

K102 5 Selection of setup data (jaw data and tailstock position) to be used in EIA/ISO programs
K
ZA

K102 6 Setting the direction of rotation for milling tools mounted on the turret
A
M

K102 7 Fixed value (0)


YA

K103 0 Handling of the sign assigned to hobbing address D


3
01
)2

K103 1 Synchronous control error auto-correction valid/invalid


(c
ht

K103 2 Fixed value


ig
yr

K103 3 DDB micron unit


op
C

K103 4 Fixed value

K103 5 Output of S-code and T-code at restart

K103 6 —

K103 7 Whether FIXED PT can be selected at RETURN of the end unit of the MAZATROL program

K104 0 Output of a laser measurement B-axis 0-degree command after ATC, valid/invalid

2-40
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

K104 1 Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring instrument (L16/K104 bit 2)

K104 2 Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring instrument (Parallel to the Y-axis/X-axis)

K104 3 Voice Adviser (Vocal output function) valid/invalid

K104 4 Type of voice

K104 5 Vocal guidance for warm-up operation

.
K104 6 Rapid feed command when cutting feed override is set to 0%, operation is executed/alarm state

d
ve
er
K104 7 Feed rate for an approach to the starting point in EIA modal restarting mode

s
re
K105 1 Fixed value (1)

ts
gh
K105 2 S-code macro call invalid/valid

ri
ll
.A
K105 3 T-code macro call invalid/valid

N
O
K105 4 Second auxiliary function macro call invalid/valid

TI
16

K105 5 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

K105 6 Handling of the shaping control axis


R
o.

O
N

K105 7 Fixed value (0)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K106 0 Execution conditions for user macroprogram interrupt


A
IM

K106 1 Start timing for user macroprogram interrupt


K
ZA

K106 2 Fixed value (0)


A
M

K106 3 Fixed value


YA

K106 4 Fixed value (0)


3
01
)2

K106 5 Fixed value (0)


(c
ht

K106 6 Fixed value (0)


ig
yr

K106 7 Fixed value (0)


op
C

K107 0 Fixed value (0)

Switching of measurement unit used to read parameters for error compensation of rotation center of the tilt
K107 3
table with inch-specification machines

K107 5 Motion distance in the manual pulse feed mode for the axis whose position is displayed in diameter value

K107 6 Deceleration for arc valid/invalid

K107 7 Fixed value (0)

2-41
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

K108 Permissible error range for synchronous control

K110 Judgment angle near a singular point

K111 Clamping speed in safety supervisory mode 3

K113 Machine type

K114 Axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate system

.
K115 Axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate system

d
ve
er
K116 Axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate system

s
re
K117 Rotational direction of the rotary axis

ts
gh
K121 Axis number of the first rotary axis

ri
ll
.A
K122 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis

N
O
K123 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis

TI
16

K124
A
Height axis rotational center offset of the first rotary axis
R
04

PO
30

K125 Axis number of the second rotary axis


R
o.

O
N

K126 Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K127 Vertical axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
A
IM

K128 Height axis rotational center offset of the second rotary axis
K
ZA

K129 Position deviation 1 of the first rotary axis


A
M

K130 Position deviation 2 of the first rotary axis


YA

K131 Position deviation 1 of the second rotary axis


3
01
)2

K132 Position deviation 2 of the second rotary axis


(c
ht

K133 X-axis position deviation at the spindle center position


ig
yr

K134 Y-axis position deviation at the spindle center position


op
C

K135 Angle deviation 1 of the first rotary axis centerline

K136 Angle deviation 2 of the first rotary axis centerline

K137 Angle deviation 1 of the second rotary axis centerline

K138 Angle deviation 2 of the second rotary axis centerline

K139 X-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline

2-42
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

K140 Y-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline

K242 Axis name of the spindle to be rotated in orbit machining

K243 M code number of the forward rotation command for orbit machining

K244 M code number of the reverse rotation command for orbit machining

K245 M code number of the rotation stop command for orbit machining

.
K246 Permissible error at involute interpolation end point

d
ve
er
K247 Involute interpolation permissible acceleration

s
re
K248 Involute interpolation minimum feedrate

ts
gh
K249 Involute interpolation override lower limit

ri
ll
.A
K250 Wait time before turning ON of zero-speed signal upon ending hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)

N
O
K252 Fixed value

TI
16

K253
A
Angle that sets the mill spindle tool tip in the +X-axis direction in orbit machining
R
04

PO
30

K257 0 Fixed value (1)


R
o.

O
N

K257 2 Fixed value


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

K257 3 Direction of mill spindle rotation in orbit machining


A
IM

K257 4 Speed clamp alarm display in orbit machining


K
ZA

K257 5 Fixed value


A
M

K257 6 Fixed value (0)


YA

K257 7 Fixed value (1)


3
01
)2

K258 0 Spindle speed override unit switching function


(c
ht

K258 1 MDI input support function


ig
yr

K258 5 HANDLE INTERUPT window preset function


op
C

K259 0 Hobbing: Axis configuration discrimination function

K259 1 Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Quasi constant inclination control

K280 0 Fixed value

K280 1 Fixed value

K280 2 Fixed value

2-43
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

K280 6 Fixed value

K280 7 Fixed value

3. TABLE (L)
Address
Outline
(bit)

L1 Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component)

d .
ve
L2 Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (Y-component)

ser
L3 Radius of stylus ball of touch sensor (X-component)

re
ts
L4 Radius of stylus ball of touch sensor (Y-component)

gh
ri
L5 Z-axis stroke for tip position memory (TEACH function)

ll
.A
N
L6 Tool breakage judgment distance (for laser measurement)

O
TI
L7 Tool-breakage restoration mode (for M35 external tool breakage detection or tool measurement unit)
16

A
R
04

PO

L8 Skipping stroke limit for MMS


30

R
o.

L9 Selection of random ATC specifications


N

C
al

L10 Interval between magazine pockets


ri

ZA
Se

L11 Touch sensor’s interference direction


IM
K

L12 Tolerance for manual measurement


ZA
A

L13 Allowable angle for parallelism and right angle in manual measurement
M
YA

L14 Escapement for straightness measurement


3
01

L15 Macro program number for straightness measurement


)2
(c

L16 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited


ht
ig

L17 Minimum angle of head indexing command (only for INTEGREX j)


yr
op

L18 Presence/absence of tailstock


C

L19 Number of electric steady rests

L21 Output type of index (rotary) table

L22 Data of the tool nose measurement sensor, Sensor width along the X-axis

L23 Data of the tool nose measurement sensor, Sensor width along the Z-axis

L24 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, X-axis

2-44
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

L25 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, Z-axis

L26 Tool nose measurement sensor reference position, Y-axis

L27 Timer setting for manual TOOL EYE measurement

L28 Amount of Z-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE measurement

L29 Machine efficiency

.
L30 Selection of machining navigation case introduction messages

d
ve
er
L31 - L34 Use in machine manufacturer macro

s
re
L37 Minimum index angle of index table

ts
gh
L38 M/B-code for index of index table

ri
ll
.A
L39 Selection of execution/non execution of indexing unit

N
O
L40 Availability of specification of index table angle in end unit

TI
16

L41 Simultaneous operation of indexing unit with ATC


A
R
04

PO
30

L42 Initial value of index table angle


R
o.

O
N

L43 Indication of index table angle


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L44 Selection of automatic setting on/off for nose position correction of a drilling tool
A
IM

L45 Index table angle command


K
ZA

L46 Maximum number of pallets in pallet changing unit


A
M

L47 To prepare or not to prepare next pallet change


YA

L48 Number of long boring bars


3
01
)2

L49 Simultaneous operation of pallet change with ATC


(c
ht

L50 Rewriting of head number


ig
yr

L51 Tool command system in MDI operation


op
C

L52 Writing of machining management data with macro variable

L53 Showing of program number in PALLET MANAGEMENT display

L54 Selection of automatic operation mode

L55 Spindle load meter display type

L56 Method of measurement of coordinates by tool edge memorizing function (TEACH)

2-45
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

L57 Rewriting of tool data during automatic operation

L58 Head index angle indication system

L59 Input selection for HEAD OFFSET display

L60 Head quantity

L61 Output timing of AHC and APC

.
L62 Head relay point X1

d
ve
er
L63 Head relay point Y1

s
re
L64 Head relay point X2

ts
gh
L65 Head relay point Y2

ri
ll
.A
L66 Return/No return to head indexing point Z

N
O
L67 Length between the end surface of the spindle and the center of head rotation

TI
16

L68 Head correction value X


A
R
04

PO
30

L69 Head correction value Y


R
o.

O
N

L70 Axis movement from machining face on escapement


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L71 Shift of basic coordinate for oblique face machining


A
IM

L72 5-axis spline interpolation geometry compensation software acceleration/deceleration filter 2 time constant
K
ZA

L73 Time constant for shape correction acceleration/deceleration filter 2


A
M

L74 Cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational acceleration/deceleration control


YA

L75 Time constant for pre-interpolational linear control during cutting feed rate acceleration/deceleration
3
01
)2

L76 Acceleration rate for high-speed cutting


(c
ht

L77 Angle for deceleration at corner before interpolation


ig
yr

L78 Amount of X-axial retreat from the approach point for TOOL EYE measurement
op
C

L79 In-position width for changeover of the synchronized-tapping gain

L80 Linear to arc deceleration rate

L81 Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited

L82 Table thickness

L83 Spindle head radius

2-46
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

L84 Correction value of alignment deviation X (Upper face)

L85 Correction value of alignment deviation Y (Upper face)

L86 Correction value of alignment deviation X (0-degree face)

L87 Correction value of alignment deviation Y (0-degree face)

Correction value of alignment deviation X (90-degree face)


L88
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component for B-axis at 90-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)
Correction value of alignment deviation Y (90-degree face)

.
L89

d
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (Y-component for B-axis at 90-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)

ve
Correction value of alignment deviation X (180-degree face)

er
L90
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (X-component for B-axis at 180-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)

s
re
Correction value of alignment deviation Y (180-degree face)
L91

ts
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor (Y-component for B-axis at 180-degree position) (for INTEGREX series)

gh
L92 Correction value of alignment deviation X (270-degree face)

ri
ll
.A
L93 Correction value of alignment deviation Y (270-degree face)

N
O
L94 X/Y travel distance during EIA-programmed tool measurement

TI
16

L95
A
Offset number auto-setting for EIA-programmed tool measurement
R
04

PO
30

L96 Amount of shifting during offset number auto-setting for EIA-programmed tool measurement
R
o.

O
N

L97 M-code to be output when selecting menu function for the MDI tool designation
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L98 Max. tool length for laser tool length measurement


A
IM

L99 Cycle time for saving the operational status management data
K
ZA

L100 Laser sensor position X


A
M

L101 Laser sensor position Y


YA

L102 Laser sensor position Z


3
01
)2

L103 Approach point X for laser tool diameter measurement


(c
ht

L104 Approach point Y for laser tool diameter measurement


ig
yr

L105 Approach point Z for laser tool diameter measurement


op
C

L106 0 Measuring equipment selection

L106 1 Selection of a rotational reference coordinate system for WPC-th

L106 2 Selection of measuring equipment

Selection of whether workpiece measurement results and tool measurement results are to be stored into tool
L106 3
data of the lower turret

L106 4 Selection of whether to enable or disable the fixed amount compensation function

2-47
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)
B-axis user-defined angle setting in the coordinate measurement unit and workpiece measurement unit
L106 5
invalid/valid
Non-compensation area for the tool measurement and execution timing of tool and workpiece measurement
L106 6
operation

L106 7 Selection of laser measuring menu display

L107 0 Tool path drawing

L107 1 Tailstock function valid/invalid

.
L107 2 Tailstock type

d
ve
er
L107 3 Whether tail thrust is also to be displayed in pounds (lbs)

s
re
L107 4 LBB No. setting for the grooving I.D. tool, threading I.D. tool, or touch sensor, valid/invalid

ts
gh
L107 5 XYZ-axis operation for the first T-command after cycle start

ri
ll
.A
L107 6 A-axis operation for the first T-command after cycle start

N
O
L107 7 Heavy tool designation valid/invalid

TI
16

L108 0 Fixed value (0)


A
R
04

PO
30

L108 1 Fixed value (0)


R
o.

O
N

L108 2 Fixed value (0)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L108 3 Fixed value (0)


A
IM

L108 4 Fixed value (0)


K

Incorporating the C-axis coordinate into the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and SHAPE CHECK displays of
ZA

L108 5
the VRX machine
A
M

L108 6 Fixed value (0)


YA

L108 7 Displaying the milling tool nose in the MAZATROL program of the TOOL PATH CHECK display
3
01

Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
)2

L109 0
(1st set of axes)
(c

Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
ht

L109 1
(2nd set of axes)
ig

Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
yr

L109 2
(3rd set of axes)
op

Axial direction of the two axes to be checked by the software limit relative position check function
C

L109 3
(4th set of axes)

L109 4 Formula selection for calculating horsepower and thrust on the TOOL DATA display with [AUTO SET]

L109 6 Fixed value

L109 7 Fixed value

L110 0 Opposed-spindle lathe specifications

2-48
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

L110 1 Vertically inverted spindle specifications

L110 2 Axis name of the secondary spindle

L110 3 Whether to disable or enable the display of “section to be machined” in the milling tool sequence

L110 4 RAM spindle specification

L110 5 Correction axis for LENGTH B

.
L110 6 Vertical lower turret specification

d
ve
er
L110 7 Z-axis direction

s
re
L111 5 T-code in the index unit to be executed before the pallet change unit

ts
gh
L111 6 Fixed value (1)

ri
ll
.A
L112 0 Whether traction tailstock is present or absent

N
O
L112 1 Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 1 is present or absent

TI
16

L112 2
A
Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 2 is present or absent
R
04

PO
30

L112 3 Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 3 is present or absent


R
o.

O
N

L112 4 Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 4 is present or absent


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L112 5 —
A
IM

L112 6 —
K
ZA

L112 7 —
A
M

L113 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (1st set of axes)
YA

L114 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (2nd set of axes)
3
01
)2

L115 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (3rd set of axes)
(c
ht

L116 Software limit relative position check – Check reference axis (4th set of axes)
ig
yr

L117 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (1st set of axes)
op
C

L118 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (2nd set of axes)

L119 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (3rd set of axes)

L120 Software limit relative position check – Check target axis (4th set of axes)

L121 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (1st set of axes)

L122 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (2nd set of axes)

2-49
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

L123 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (3rd set of axes)

L124 Software limit relative position check – Limit distance in the approaching direction (4th set of axes)

L125 Rotational axis prefiltering time constant

L126 Positioning direction of the head rotation - -axis for oblique plane indexing

L129 Acceleration/deceleration filter (1st stage), G1 time constant

.
L130 Acceleration/deceleration filter (1st stage), G0 time constant

d
ve
er
L131 Acceleration/deceleration filter (2nd stage), G1 time constant

s
re
L132 Acceleration/deceleration filter (2nd stage), G0 time constant

ts
gh
<For tool tilt type>

ri
Tool control rotary axis offset First rotary axis horizontal offset
L133

ll
<For table tilt type (B-axis tilting table specifications)>

.A
B-axis rotation center displacement (X-axis direction)

N
<For tool tilt type>

O
Tool control rotary axis offset First rotary axis vertical offset

TI
L134
16

<For table tilt type (A-axis tilting table specifications)>


A
A-axis rotation center displacement (Y-axis direction)
R
04

PO

<For tool tilt type> Tool control rotary axis offset First rotary axis height offset
30

L135
<For table tilt type> (A-(B-)axis rotation center displacement (Z-axis direction)
R
o.

O
N

L136 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, horizontal axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
C
al

K
ri

ZA

L137 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, vertical axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
Se

A
IM

L138 <For tool tilt type> Tool rotational axis offset, height axis offset amount for the 2nd rotational axis
K
ZA

L139 Minimum usable tool diameter of the measurable chamfering tool


A
M

L140 Waiting time for the completion signal of M35 (tool breakage detection) from PLC
YA

L141 Software limit relative position check (for auxiliary equipment axis) – Task delay period
3
01

L145 Smooth corner control function: Cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational acceleration/deceleration control
)2
(c

Smooth corner control function:


L146
ht

Time constant for pre-interpolational linear control during cutting feed rate acceleration/deceleration
ig
yr

L147 Smooth corner control function: Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (1st stage)
op
C

L148 Smooth corner control function: Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (2ndt stage)

L151 Small-diameter table thickness

L152 Number of retries in machining management work number search

L171 1 Selection of [PALLET No.SET] menu item display

L270 Feedrate for clamping the acceleration in orbit machining

2-50
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

L271 Time constant for clamping the acceleration in orbit machining

4. FEED VEL. (M)

Address
Outline
(bit)

M1 Rapid feed rate

M2 Feed rate for initial zero-point return

. d
ve
M3 Cutting feed rate limit

er
s
re
M4 Offset of machine coordinates system

ts
gh
M5 Second zero-point coordinating value

ri
ll
M6 Third zero-point coordinating value

.A
N
M7 Fourth zero-point coordinating value

O
TI
16

M8 Maximum software limit specified by manufacturer (+ direction)


A
R
04

PO

M9 Maximum software limit specified by manufacturer (– direction)


30

R
o.

M10 Command unit


N

C
al

M11 Coding of address of axis


ri

ZA
Se

M12 Coding of incremental axis


IM
K

M13 Axis name (for display)


ZA
A

M14 Shifting distance of the watchdog-less home position


M
YA

M15 Axis name (for axis name changing)


3
01

M16 Zero-point shift amount/grid shift amount


)2
(c

M17 0 —
ht
ig

M17 1 Unit of output from MCP to servo amplifier


yr
op

M17 2 Direction of machine zero-point return


C

M17 3 Error correction schema with servo on

M17 4 Type of axis

M17 5 Rotational direction of servo motor (for movement in (+) direction)

M17 6 —

2-51
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

M17 7 Alarm/No alarm with axis removed

M18 0 Spindle C-axis

M18 2 Machine zero-point position

M18 3 Virtual axis with dog

M18 4 Dog-less axis

.
M18 5 X-axis current position display in radius/diameter

d
ve
er
M18 6 Automatic/manual simultaneous absolute-value updating

s
re
M18 7 Absolute-value detection

ts
gh
M19 0 Transmission of rapid feed rate value to SV69/SV70

ri
ll
.A
M19 3 In-position checking method

N
Parameter for system internal setting

O
M19 4
Setting prohibited

TI
16

M19 5 Zero-point operation starting position check


A
R
04

PO
30

M19 7 Backlash scheme to be adopted for dog-type returning to zero point


R
o.

O
N

M20 0 Rotational direction of the rotation axis (Dynamic offset II)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

M20 1 KOMET tool axis specification


A
IM

M20 2 Method of jog/rapid feed stopping when the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD is valid
K
ZA

M20 4 Warning check for alarm 67 HI-SPEED SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM


A
M

M20 5 Multi-axis integrated type amplifier specification


YA

M20 6 Switching between zero-point shift amount and grid shift amount
3
01
)2

M21 0 Rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Linear acceleration/deceleration


(c
ht

M21 1 Rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration type, First-order lag


ig
yr

M21 2 Rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Second-order lag


op
C

M21 3 Rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Exponential acceleration/linear deceleration

M21 4 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Linear acceleration/deceleration

M21 5 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type. First-order lag

M21 6 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Second-order lag

M21 7 Cutting-feed acceleration/deceleration type, Exponential acceleration/linear deceleration

2-52
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

M22 0 Deceleration time constant for rapid-feed exponential acceleration/linear deceleration

M22 1 Type of stroke-end stop

M22 2 Type of stroke-end stop

M22 3 —

M22 4 —

.
M22 5 —

d
ve
er
M22 6 —

s
re
M22 7 —

ts
gh
M23 0 Selection of NC control axes/PLC control axes

ri
ll
.A
M23 1 MP scale offset method

N
O
M25 Illegal axis area upper limits

TI
16

M26 Illegal axis area lower limits


A
R
04

PO
30

M27 Optimum acceleration control: Target speed


R
o.

O
N

M29 Rapid feed clamping speed 1 for superposition control


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

M30 Rapid feed clamping speed 2 for superposition control


A
IM

M31 Cutting feed clamping speed for superposition control


K
ZA

M32 Safety speed for Safety supervisory mode 2


A
M

M33 Safety speed for Safety supervisory mode 3


YA

M34 Safety clamping speed for Safety supervisory mode 2


3
01
)2

M35 Safety clamping speed for Safety supervisory mode 3


(c
ht

M36 Speed supervisory door selection


ig
yr

M37 Safety clamping speed reduction judgment coefficient


op
C

M38 Interference check distances for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD, primary check distance

M39 Interference check distances for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD, secondary check distance

M40 Ram spindle stored stroke end, upper limit

M41 Ram spindle stored stroke end, lower limit

M42 Interference check distance for INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD during automatic operation

2-53
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

M45 Selection of a door for signal input on the drive side (servo) in safety supervisory mode

M61 Fixed value

M66 Variable acceleration control: Cutting feed rate

M67 Rapid traverse rate limit in orbit machining

M68 Cutting feedrate limit in orbit machining

.
M70 Fixed value

d
ve
er
M72 0 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant selection

s
re
ts
5. TIME CONST. (N)

gh
ri
Address
Outline

ll
(bit)

.A
N
N1 Rapid-feed time constant (linear acceleration/deceleration)

O
TI
N2 Cutting-feed time constant (linear acceleration/deceleration)
16

A
R
04

N3 Rapid-feed time constant (First-order lag)


PO
30

R
o.

N4 Time constant for post-interpolation rapid feed acceleration/deceleration filter


O
N

C
al

N5 Cutting-feed time constant (First-order lag)


K
ri

ZA
Se

N7 OT time
A
IM

N8 Creeping speed during initial zero-point return


K
ZA

N9 Amount of grid ignorance during initial zero-point return


A
M

N10 Grid spacing


YA
3

N12 Machine dependent specific value


01
)2

N13 Machine dependent specific value


(c
ht

N15 Machine dependent specific value


ig
yr

N16 Machine dependent specific value


op
C

N17 Servo amplifier channel number

N18 Servo amplifier rotary switch number

N19 Axis system number

N21 0 Linear-type rotational axis

N21 1 Rotational axis shortcut Invalid/Valid

2-54
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

N21 2 Fixed value (0)

N21 3 Fixed value

N21 4 Reference axis for superposition control

N21 5 Superposition axis for superposition control

N21 6 Relative polarity of control axis

N21 7 Current position immediately after cross machining

d .
ve
Axis selection for 3D interference check during automatic operation and for positioning on the VIRTUAL
N22 0

er
MACHINING display

s
re
N22 3 Fixed value

ts
gh
N22 4 Fixed value

ri
ll
N25 Time constant for deceleration rate calculation

.A
N
N26 Accuracy coefficient for deceleration rate calculation

O
TI
N27 Rapid feed time constant for superposition
16

A
R
04

PO

N28 Cutting feed time constant for superposition


30

R
o.

N29 Time constant for shape correction rapid feed acceleration/deceleration filter
O
N

C
al

N30 Time constant for cutting feed (for M881)


ri

ZA
Se

N31 Time constant for cutting feed (for M882)


IM

N32 Time constant for cutting feed (for M883)


K
ZA

N33 Time constant for cutting feed (for M884)


A
M

N34 Time constant for cutting feed (for M885)


YA
3

N35 Time constant for cutting feed (for M886)


01
)2

N36 Multi-turn counter increment with absolute position rotary-type rotational axis in special gear ratio
(c

Rotational speed after multi-turn counter increment with absolute position rotary-type rotational axis in special
ht

N37
gear ratio
ig
yr

N38 Fixed value


op
C

N57 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, maximum value

N58 Real time tuning II Minimum inertia ratio

N60 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, minimum value

N61 Real time tuning II Maximum inertia ratio

N63 Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, range of change

2-55
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

N66 Variable acceleration control: Cutting feed time constant

N67 0 Axis with a 2-character axis name

N67 1 Fixed value

6. ANOTHER (S)

Address
Outline
(bit)

. d
ve
S3 Feed forward gain for the MAZAK Precision Rapid Boring Tornado Option

s er
S4 Feed forward gain

re
ts
S5 Rotational center of the table

gh
ri
S6 Absolute position detection parameter

ll
.A
S7 Upper limit (on Z-axis) of machining range for table rotating machining 

N
O
TI
S8 Feed-forward gain G00
16

A
R
04

S10 Axis of rotation of the tilting table


PO
30

S11 Corner position of the tilting table


o.

O
N

S12 Axis of rotation of the tilting table (Used for the automatic program origin calculation function)
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

S13 G00 in-position width


A
IM

S14 G01 in-position width


K
ZA

S15 Fixed value


A
M

S16 Unbalanced axis torque offset


YA

Torque limit buffer reduction ratio 1


3

S17
01
)2

S18 Torque limit buffer reduction ratio 2


(c
ht

S19 Tool change completion position of the long boring bar end tool
ig
yr

S20 APC completion position


op
C

S21 Completion position of gantry robot operation

S22 Cutting feed clamping speed during tool tip point control

S23 Reference workpiece zero point

Central position on the upper surface of the tilt table (VARIAXIS)


S25
Central position of table upper surface (other machining centers)

S26 Central position of tilt table rotation (VARIAXIS)

2-56
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

S27 Ram spindle offset amount

S28 Center of the workpiece to be directly mounted on the table of the machines equipped with an additional table

S29 Position of the work hand rotating axis in relation to the machine zero point

S30 Distance from the axis of rotation of the work hand to the reference position of the vice for the work hand

S31 Specification of the machine coordinates of the floating reference point

S32 Rapid traverse speed for the mode of tool tip point control

d .
ve
Reference position X for the TEACH function, to be used for setting the LENGTH B item of an angular tool

er
S33
(For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)

s
re
S34 Amount of offset for rotary head misalignment (only for Maza-Check)

ts
gh
S35 Rotational center of the second table

ri
ll
S36 Position of the center of the second additional table on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display

.A
N
S37 Distance from the spindle side face to the center of head

O
TI
16

S38 A
Time-out period for releasing the emergency stop status during powering on
R
04

PO
30

S45 0 Non-target axis setting for indexing unit (rotational axis)


R
o.

O
N

S45 1 Setting of an axis not displayed on the counter


C
al

K
ri

Rapid feed overlapping function disabled axis


ZA

S45 2
Se

S49 Rapid feed overlapping function: G0 in-position width


IM
K

S50 Rapid feed overlapping function: G1 in-position width


ZA
A

S51 Distance to the small-diameter table


M
YA

S66 Center of table rotation (additional A-axis)


3
01

S70 Fixed value


)2
(c

S71 0 Smart safety monitoring alarm (for servo axis)


ht
ig

S72 0 Fixed value


yr
op

S72 1 Fixed value


C

7. SPINDLE (SA)

Address
Outline
(bit)

SA1 - SA8 Maximum spindle speed in each speed range (range 1 to 8)

SA9 - SA16 Constants for calculating each gear speed of the spindle (range 1 to 8)

2-57
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SA17 - SA24 Maximum spindle speed during tapping cycle (range 1 to 8)

SA25 - SA28 Spindle speed during gear shifting (range 1 to 4)

SA29 Load meter reference output scaling factor (high-speed coil)

SA30 Load meter reference output base rotational speed (high-speed coil)

SA31 Load meter reference output scaling factor (low-speed coil)

SA32 Load meter reference output base rotational speed (low-speed coil)

d .
ve
er
SA33 - SA40 Acceleration/deceleration time constant for the synchronous tapping (range 1 to 8)

s
re
SA41 Spindle orientating speed

ts
gh
SA42 Minimum spindle speed

ri
ll
SA43 Channel number for the spindle amplifier

.A
N
SA44 Spindle amplifier rotary switch number

O
TI
Spindle speed range changing method, in relation to switching the torque factors for auto-pecking of the
16

SA45 0
cutting load detection type
A
R
04

PO

Spindle speed range changing method, in relation to switching the torque factors for auto-pecking of the
30

SA45 1
cutting load detection type 2
R
o.

O
N

SA45 2 Homing direction for synchronous tapping


C
al

K
ri

ZA

SA45 3 Homing direction for synchronous tapping


Se

SA45 4 Defines the specified direction as the Z-phase detection direction


IM
K

SA45 5 Spindle index gear correction


ZA
A

SA45 6 Selection of spindle removal


M
YA

SA46 0 Direction of orientation


3
01

SA46 1 Direction of orientation


)2
(c

SA46 2 C-axis position control changeover type


ht
ig

SA46 3 Synchronous tapping position control changeover type


yr
op

SA46 4 Z-phase detection direction


C

SA46 5 C-axis homing direction

SA46 6 C-axis homing direction

SA46 7 Synchronous tapping command polarity

SA47 0 —

SA47 1 —

2-58
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

SA47 2 —

SA47 3 —

SA47 4 —

SA47 5 —

SA47 6 —

.
SA47 7 Considering/Ignoring the spindle/motor gear ratio

d
ve
er
SA48 Encoder signal input destination

s
re
SA49 Speed attainment detection width

ts
gh
SA50 Spindle type

ri
ll
.A
SA51 Number of gears on spindle

N
O
SA52 Turning spindle type

TI
16

SA53
A
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — L coils
R
04

PO
30

SA54 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — H coils
R
o.

O
N

SA55 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Spindle gear position 3
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SA56 Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Spindle gear position 4
A
IM

SA57 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 1
K
ZA

SA58 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 2
A
M

SA59 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 3
YA

SA60 Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 4
3
01
)2

SA61 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 1
(c
ht

SA62 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 2
ig
yr

SA63 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 3
op
C

SA64 Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type — Range 4

SA65 Cutting force calculation filter for auto-pecking of the cutting load detection type

SA66 Maximum permissible speed of the rotational axis for polygonal/hobbing machining

Rotational speed in the following spindle output diagrams: MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING


SA67 - SA73
NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION
Output in the following spindle output diagrams MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING
SA74 - SA80
NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION

2-59
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SA81 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 1

SA82 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 2

SA83 Spindle limit speed selection for spindle position control time constants — Limit speed 3

SA84 Spindle position control time constants — Time constant 1

SA85 Spindle position control time constants — Time constant 2

.
SA86 Spindle position control time constants — Time constant 3

d
ve
er
SA87 Spindle speed operating time constant changeover revolutions 1

s
re
SA88 Spindle speed operating time constant changeover revolutions 2

ts
gh
SA89 Spindle speed operating time constant 1

ri
ll
.A
SA90 Spindle speed operating time constant 2

N
O
SA91 Spindle speed operating time constant 3

TI
16

SA92 Z-phase detection speed


A
R
04

PO
30

SA93 Amount of synchronous tapping zero point shifting


R
o.

O
N

SA94 Homing speed for synchronous tapping


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SA95 Maximum revolutions in manual operation mode


A
IM

SA96 Amount of orientation position shifting


K
ZA

SA97 Reduction ratio of the synchronous tapping time constant for high-speed synchronous tapping
A
M

SA99 Orientation time constant


YA

SA100 - Rotational speed in the following spindle output diagrams at continuous rating: MACHINING
3

SA106 NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION


01

SA107 - Output in the following spindle output diagrams at continuous rating: MACHINING
)2

SA113 NAVIGATION-RESULT/MACHINING NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION/Monitoring Functions/POSITION


(c
ht

SA114 Spindle speed supervisory mode 2 for safety supervision


ig
yr

SA115 Spindle speed supervisory mode 3 for safety supervision


op
C

SA116 Spindle safety clamping mode 2 for safety supervision

SA117 Spindle safety clamping mode 3 for safety supervision

SA118 Selecting the spindle door of the spindle whose speed is to be monitored

SA119 Deceleration judgment coefficient on safety speed clamping of the spindle to be supervised for safety

SA120 PLG pulse rate for spindle index gear tooth correction

2-60
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

SA121 Amount of branching [1] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

SA122 Amount of branching [2] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

SA123 Amount of branching [3] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

SA124 Amount of branching [4] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

SA125 Amount of branching [5] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

.
SA126 Amount of branching [6] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

d
ve
er
SA127 Amount of branching [7] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

s
re
SA128 Amount of branching [8] point correction for spindle index gear tooth

ts
gh
SA129 #1 notch filter frequency for cutting-load detection pecking cycle

ri
ll
.A
SA130 #1 notch filter depth for cutting-load detection pecking cycle

N
O
SA131 #2 notch filter frequency for cutting-load detection pecking cycle

TI
16

SA132
A
#2 notch filter depth for cutting-load detection pecking cycle
R
04

PO
30

SA133 Breakage detection torque for cutting-load detection pecking cycle


R
o.

O
N

SA134 Maximum spindle orientation speed


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

SA136 Selection of signal input door on the safety monitor drive side (spindle)
A
IM

SA138 Number of spindle gears


K
ZA

SA139 Number of motor gears


A
M

SA140 Turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side (only for MULTIPLEX)
YA

SA142 0 Initial C-axis position control changeover with deceleration to stop setting
3
01
)2

SA142 1 Spindle speed clamp selection with stepless spindle gear


(c
ht

SA143 1 Waiting for phase compensation completion at the start of high-speed synchronous tapping
ig
yr

SA143 3 Spindle speed for the orient command given during spindle rotation
op
C

SA143 4 Fixed value

SA143 5 Fixed value

SA143 6 Fixed value

SA144 3 Warning check for alarm 67 HI-SPEED SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM (for spindle C-axis)

SA144 4 Positive threading spindle rotational direction and encoder polarity

2-61
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

SA144 5 Gear conversion during spindle rotation valid

SA144 6 Spindle gear changeover valid

SA144 7 Turret indexing valid

Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Spindle speed limit for time constant selection 1 for quasi constant
SA224
inclination control
Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Spindle speed limit for time constant selection 2 for quasi constant
SA225
inclination control
Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Spindle speed limit for time constant selection 3 for quasi constant

.
SA226

d
inclination control

ve
er
SA227 Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Time constant 1 for quasi constant inclination control

s
re
SA228 Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Time constant 2 for quasi constant inclination control

ts
gh
SA229 Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing), Time constant 3 for quasi constant inclination control

ri
ll
.A
SA242 Fixed value

N
O
SA243 1 Smart safety monitoring alarm (for spindle)

TI
16

SA244 0 Fixed value


A
R
04

PO
30

SA244 1 Fixed value


R
o.

O
N

C
al

8. BARRIER (BA)
ri

ZA
Se

Address
A

Outline
(bit)
IM
K

BA1 Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 1 turning spindle
ZA
A

BA2 Chuck width (for chuck barrier) — No. 1 turning spindle


M
YA

BA3 Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 1 turning spindle
3
01

BA4 EIA program workpiece outside diameter


)2
(c

BA5 Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle
ht
ig

BA6 Chuck width (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle


yr
op

BA7 Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier) — No. 2 turning spindle
C

BA8 Tail body outside diameter (for tail barrier)

BA9 Tail body length (for tail barrier)

BA10 Tail spindle outside diameter (for tail barrier)

BA11 Length with tail spindle at back end (for tail barrier)

2-62
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

BA12 Tail head outside diameter (for tail barrier)

BA13 Tail head length (for tail barrier)

BA14 Tail head taper angle (for tail barrier)

BA15 Tail head biting diameter (for tail barrier)

BA16 Tail barrier, tail extruding length

.
d
BA17 Tail barrier, workpiece length

ve
er
BA18 Tail barrier, tail reversing position Z

s
re
ts
BA19 Distance from the Z-axis machine zero point to the spindle edge — No. 1 turning spindle

gh
ri
BA20 Distance from the Z-axis machine zero point to the spindle edge — No. 2 turning spindle

ll
.A
BA21 Jaw number for EIA program barrier — No. 1 turning spindle

N
O
BA22 Jaw number for EIA program barrier — No. 2 turning spindle

TI
16

A
R
BA23 Turret outside diameter (turret type tool post)
04

PO
30

BA24 Turret width (turret type tool post)


R
o.

O
N

BA25 Turret reference position X (turret type tool post)


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

BA26 Turret reference position Z (turret type tool post)


A
IM

BA27 Tool holder mounting position — Type 1


K
ZA

BA28 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 1


A
M

BA29 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 1


YA

BA30 Tool holder mounting position — Type 2


3
01
)2

BA31 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 2


(c
ht

BA32 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 2


ig
yr

BA33 Tool holder mounting position — Type 3


op
C

BA34 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 3

BA35 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 3

BA36 Tool holder mounting position — Type 4

BA37 Tool holder width in X-axis direction — Type 4

BA38 Tool holder width in Z-axis direction — Type 4

2-63
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

BA39 EIA tool barrier, tool holder mounting position

BA40 EIA tool barrier, tool holder width X

BA41 EIA tool barrier, tool holder width Z

BA42 Barrier type

BA43 First tool number (in the 1st set of tools)

.
BA44 Number of tools (in the 1st set of tools)

d
ve
er
BA45 First tool number (in the 2nd set of tools)

s
re
BA46 Number of tools (in the 2nd set of tools)

ts
gh
BA47 Turret type

ri
ll
.A
BA48 Axis name of the head to be rotated

N
O
BA49 Axis number of the inclined axis

TI
16

BA50 Fundamental axis number


A
R
04

PO
30

BA51 Inclined-axis control, vector of virtual Y


R
o.

O
N

BA52 Inclined-axis control, vector of real X


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

BA53 Inclined-axis control, vector of real Y


A
IM

BA54 Selection of work spindle for hobbing


K
ZA

BA55 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D1)


A
M

BA56 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D2)


YA

BA57 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D3)


3
01
)2

BA58 Turning spindle number for polygonal machining (D4)


(c
ht

BA59 Spindle forward rotation M-code for tapping cycle


ig
yr

BA60 Spindle reverse rotation M-code for tapping cycle


op
C

BA61 Amount of runout of the B-axis center

BA62 Amount of offset for the B-axis — spindle distance

BA63 Holder angle of angle tool holder

BA64 B-axis tool reference position X

BA65 B-axis tool reference position Z

2-64
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

BA66 Deceleration area Z

BA67 Measuring area Z

BA68 Deceleration area X

BA69 Measuring area X

BA70 Distance between the reference points on both turrets

.
BA71 System number to be used when argument L is omitted from G112

d
ve
er
BA72 Feed override for retracting the tap

s
re
BA73 Barrier valid/invalid 1 (chuck, sub-chuck, tailstock)

ts
gh
BA74 Barrier valid/invalid 2 (Lower turret, steady rest)

ri
ll
.A
BA75 - BA78 Barrier setup turret reference position

N
O
BA79 - BA82 Barrier setup chuck reference position 1

TI
16

BA83 - BA86 Barrier setup chuck reference position 2


A
R
04

PO
30

BA87 - BA90 Barrier reference position for a powered tailstock


R
o.

O
N

BA91 Distance from spindle edge to partition plate


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

BA92 Central position X when viewed from machine zero point


A
IM

BA93 Upper/lower turret tool angle difference (HD1)


K
ZA

BA94 Upper/lower turret tool angle difference (HD2)


A
M

BA95 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the X-axis


YA

BA96 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the Z-axis


3
01
)2

BA97 Tool nose measurement, X-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point


(c
ht

BA98 Tool nose measurement, Y-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point


ig
yr

BA99 Tool nose measurement, Z-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point


op
C

BA100 Tool nose measurement, X-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)

BA101 Tool nose measurement, Y-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)

BA102 Tool nose measurement, Z-coordinate of the sensor’s reference point (for lower turret/HD2)

BA103 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the X-axis (for lower turret/HD2)

BA104 Tool nose measurement, sensor width along the Z-axis (for lower turret/HD2)

2-65
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

BA105 Adjustment “FdT” for servo axis thrust hold

BA106 Dead zone

BA107 Filter

BA108 Servo axis thrust hold droop

BA109 Offset amount (X) during automatic tool setting value calculation

.
BA110 Offset amount (Z) during automatic tool setting value calculation

d
ve
er
BA111 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M881)

s
re
BA112 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M882)

ts
gh
BA113 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M883)

ri
ll
.A
BA114 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M884)

N
O
BA115 Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M885)

TI
16

BA116
A
Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for time constant changeover M-code (M886)
R
04

PO
30

BA117 Outside diameter of the turret for Virtual Machining


R
o.

O
N

BA118 Width of the turret for Virtual Machining


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

BA119 Selecting a head having a lower-turret TOOL EYE


A
IM

BA120 Mounting position X for an assembly tool model


K
ZA

BA121 Mounting position Z for an assembly tool model


A
M

BA122 Turret reference position X (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display)


YA

BA123 Turret reference position Z (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display)


3
01
)2

BA124 Fixed value (0)


(c
ht

BA125 0 EIA tailstock barrier, tailstock usage valid/invalid


ig
yr

BA125 1 Tailstock present/absent


op
C

BA125 2 EIA tool barrier, tool holder present/absent

BA125 3 Barrier tool nose position (EIA, automatic)

BA125 4 Setting of BA11 is handled as tailstock extruding length, valid/invalid

BA125 5 Output of spindle revolution M-code specified in same block as synchronous tapping, valid/invalid

BA125 6 Alarm stop when [BARRIER CANCEL] is selected at the start of the automatic operation, valid/invalid

2-66
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

BA125 7 Alarm stop when jaw Nos. are not specified at the start of the automatic operation, valid/invalid

BA126 0 System to be made valid without system selection for queuing

BA126 1 Y-axis interference type

BA126 2 Y-axis moving range display

BA126 3 Tool command scheme

.
BA126 4 FLASH tool valid/invalid

d
ve
er
BA126 5 Milling spindle orientation command (M219), output/no output

s
re
BA126 6 System without turret

ts
gh
BA126 7 Shape of the tailstock center for Virtual Machining, single stage/twin stage

ri
ll
M249 command for preparing for tool change before moving the tool to the tool change position using a

.A
BA127 0
MAZATROL program, output/no output

N
O
BA127 1 For programs of Z-offset scheme: Fixed value (1) For other programs: Invalid

TI
16

BA127 2 Simultaneous output of TTM6M200 and TTM6M202


A
R
04

PO
30

BA127 3 NC tailstock (servo axis thrust control)


R
o.

O
N

BA127 4 M90/M91 output for machines with turret


al

K
ri

ZA

Type of the clamping and unclamping M-codes that the NC automatically output for machines equipped with a
Se

BA127 5
spindle head of swiveling type
A
IM

BA127 6 —
K

Whether or not to read the current settings (tailstock position) on the SET UP MANAG. display at the
ZA

BA127 7
beginning of the execution of each program
A
M

BA128 0 NC tailstock pushing direction


YA

BA128 1 Method of automatic determination of the virtual nose point for a tool measuring unit
3
01
)2

BA128 2 Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the first set of tool data (BA43, BA44)
(c
ht

BA128 3 Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the second set of tool data (BA45, BA46)
ig
yr

BA128 6 Turret lathe with an ATC unit


op
C

BA128 7 Display of [TURRET UNCLAMP] for machines with an ATC-type turret

BA129 0 Output of tool change preparation M code (M109/M249) when executing tool change

BA129 1 Fixed value

BA129 2 Fixed G0 inclination control in the G68/G68.5 mode

BA129 3 Selection of whether or not to measure the milling tool length with the tool measuring unit

2-67
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

BA129 4 Display of [BARRIER CANCEL] with [BARRIER CANCEL TEACH] selected

Handling of measurement speed of 1 in/min or higher during laser tool length/diameter measurement with
BA129 5
inch-specification machines

BA130 1 Fixed value

BA131 0 Multi-magazine number display

BA241 Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing) Hobbing axis allocation

d .
ve
ser
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-68
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-2-3 Data I/O parameter

1. TAPE parameter (TAP)

Address
Outline
(bit)

TAP1 Type of terminator

TAP2 Terminator code 1

TAP3 Terminator code 2

.
TAP4 Output of CR during ISO code punching

d
ve
er
TAP5 DC code parity

s
re
TAP6 Feed section DC code output

ts
gh
TAP7 DSR output flow control selection

ri
ll
.A
TAP9 “[” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA

N
O
TAP10 “]” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA

TI
16

TAP11 “#” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


A
R
04

PO
30

TAP12 “” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


R
o.

O
N

TAP13 “=” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


al

K
ri

ZA

TAP14 “:” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


Se

A
IM

TAP15 “(” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


K
ZA

TAP16 “)” code for paper tape reader/puncher for EIA


A
M

TAP25 Paper tape puncher parity-V check


YA

TAP26 0 Data transfer of a paper tape program which has been punched by M2
3
01
)2

TAP26 1 Types of data to be punched onto paper tape during all punching
(c

TAP26 2 Input/output of the program name during paper tape reading/punching


ht
ig
yr

TAP26 3 Number of digits of work No. output


op
C

TAP26 4 Input/output of material data during punching/reading

TAP26 5 Setup data to add when outputting an EIA/ISO program through tape I/O

TAP27 Bit parameter related to program end code (M) for paper tape reader

TAP29 Number of characters in feed section for paper tape puncher

TAP30 Number of characters in the space between O-number and program for paper tape puncher

2-69
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

TAP31 Number of characters in the space between programs for paper tape puncher

2. DNC parameter (DNC)

Address
Outline
(bit)

DNC1 Type of terminator

DNC2 Terminator code 1

d .
ve
DNC3 Terminator code 2

ser
DNC5 DC code parity

re
ts
DNC9 Number of NC transmission retries during DNC file transfer

gh
ri
DNC10 Number of NC reception retries during DNC file transfer

ll
.A
N
DNC11 Number of NC transmission/reception retries during DNC command message transfer

O
TI
DNC12 @ waiting time during DNC transmission
16

A
R
04

PO

DNC13 “”, TEXT waiting time during DNC transmission


30

R
o.

DNC14 EOT waiting time during DNC transmission


N

C
al

DNC15 NC stop time after reception of !


ri

ZA
Se

DNC16 NC reset time after digital-out


IM
K

DNC17 NC stop time from reception


ZA
A

DNC18 DNC command reply message waiting time


M
YA

DNC19 DNC machine number


3
01

DNC20 NC transmission stop time of DNC (from reception to transmission)


)2
(c

DNC21 NC transmission stop time of DNC (from transmission to transmission)


ht

Type of processing to be executed if the tool quantity data within the NC memory mismatches that which has
ig

DNC25 0
been transferred from the DNC memory
yr
op

DNC25 1 —
C

DNC25 2 Handling of tool data and tool files in the M PLUS format, valid/invalid

DNC25 3 —

DNC25 4 —

DNC25 5 —

DNC25 6 —

2-70
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Address
Outline
(bit)

DNC25 7 —

DNC26 0 After program reception, a search is made/not made for the work number of that program.

DNC26 1 Details of an alarm occurring in DNC are displayed or not.

Loading of programs having the same work number as that of the registered program in NC becomes
DNC26 2
impossible or not.

DNC26 3 The function of the PROGRAM LOCK/ ENABLE switch is released or not.

.
DNC26 4 —

d
ve
er
DNC26 5 Three digit G-format and G10 format codes input/output for MAZAK data transfer protocol

s
re
DNC26 6 Binary to ASCII format input/output of MAZAK data transfer protocol

ts
gh
All programs having work numbers smaller than No. 9000 are erased/not erased at the start of program
DNC26 7

ri
reception.

ll
.A
DNC27 0 Interpretation of message for DNC macro variable transmission

N
O
DNC29 Number of retry times with detection of a physical error

TI
16

DNC30 Tool data/tool file message format


A
R
04

PO
30

DNC31 Waiting time for a response from the COM port driver
R
o.

O
N

C
al

3. Other (IOP/DPR/IDD)
ri

ZA
Se

Address
A

Outline
(bit)
IM
K

IOP2 0 Handling of TPC data when loading programs created with the MATRIX series
ZA
A

IOP2 1 Handling of TPC data when loading programs created with the MATRIX series
M
YA

IOP4 0 Mazak data library function


3
01

IOP4 1 Outputting of Version.txt at saving on the DATA I/O display


)2
(c

IOP4 2 Parameter load error prevention function


ht

Overwriting registration judgment criteria when entering tool data text with machines allowing registration of
ig

IOP4 3
multiple tools
yr
op

IOP5 1 Tool data count check during tool data loading


C

Selection of the sign for the start point Z of point machining (XC, XY mode) when loading a Z offset scheme
IOP5 2
program

IOP5 6 Overwriting associated with loading of the program of the same work number

IOP5 7 Overwriting associated with loading of the tool model of the same name

IOP6 1 Program name change upon program conversion

IOP7 0 Serial port used for communication with the magazine-side display unit

2-71
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Address
Outline
(bit)

IOP7 1 Serial port used for communication with the magazine-side display unit

IOP7 2 Fixed value

IOP7 3 Fixed value

IOP7 4 (Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier type

IOP7 5 (Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier type

.
IOP7 6 (Magazine-side display unit) Tool mounting/removing timing

d
ve
er
IOP7 7 (Magazine-side display unit) Tool mounting/removing timing

s
re
IOP8 0 (Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool count/time data clear setting

ts
gh
IOP8 1 (Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool life count/time data clear setting

ri
ll
.A
IOP8 3 B-axis tilt table compatible program conversion menu

N
O
IOP9 Fixed value (0)

TI
16

IOP13
A
Mazak data library function: Connection port number
R
04

PO
30

IOP14 MAZA-CARE function


R
o.

O
N

DPR1 Baud rate


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

DPR2 Stop bit


A
IM

DPR4 Data bit


K
ZA

DPR8 ISO code CR output and the output file size


A
M

DPR9 Method of handshaking


YA

DPR10 DC code parity


3
01
)2

DPR11 Feed section DC code output


(c
ht

DPR12 Waiting time


ig
yr

DPR13 Output format


op
C

DPR14 Selection of an output destination port

DPR15 Number of characters or the number of lines in feed section

2-72
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3 Detailed Description

2-3-1 Structure of the parameter list


Each parameter list is written in the following format:

Classification [1] Display title [2]

Address Meaning Description

. d
ve
[4]

s er
re
[3] [9]

ts
gh
Program type [5]

ri
Conditions [6]

ll
.A
Unit [7]

N
Setting range [8]

O
TI
16

[1] Classification of parameters (USER, MACHINE or DATA I/O)


A
R
04

[2] Characters displayed at the upper part of the screen


PO
30

[3] Parameter address displayed on the screen


R
o.

O
N

 Bit input type parameters have the bit No. shown in the parentheses below address.
C
al

Example :
ri

ZA
Se

Setting value for parameter


A

P1 (bit 0) is indicated here


Address
IM

P1 P1
K

(bit 0)
ZA

Bit 0
Bit 1
A
M

Bit 2
YA

Bit 3
Bit 4
3

Bit 5
01

Bit 6
)2

Bit 7
(c

[4] Meaning of the parameter


ht
ig

[5] Applicable program


yr
op

M ················Effective only for MAZATROL programs


C

E ················Effective for EIA/ISO programs


M, E ············Effective for MAZATROL programs and EIA/ISO programs

2-73
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

[6] Conditions under which a changed parameter becomes valid


Example 1: “Immediate” designates that new parameter value becomes effective upon
parameter change.
Example 2: “At power on” designates that new parameter value will become effective after
procedure below.
1. Change parameter setting value.
(By procedure similar to changing of ordinary data)

2. Shut off power supply to the NC.

3. Press power on button on the operation panel.

d.
ve
Example 3: If “At I/O startup” is specified

er
The system operates at the parameter data entered before the start of I/O. If the

s
re
parameter data is modified during I/O operation, the new data will not become

ts
valid until the I/O operation has been completed.

gh
Example 4: If “After stop of movement” is specified

ri
When the movement of the machine is completed, the program will operate with

ll
.A
the new parameter value. Changing the parameter during the machine movement

N
will not make the new parameter value valid during the movement.

O
TI
Example 5: If “Next block” is specified
16

A
When the next block is loaded, the program will operate with the new parameter
R
04

value. Changing the parameter while the block is being loaded will not make the
PO
30

new parameter value valid in that block.


R
o.

O
N

Example 6: If “After resetting” is specified: The new parameter setting takes effect after
C
al

resetting.
K
ri

ZA
Se

[7] Units of data displayed


A
IM

[8] Allowable range of data


[9] Details or meaning of the parameter
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-74
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-2 User parameter POINT (D)

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Height of the second R-point

Initial point

D1
Second R-point

d .
ve
MPL001

er
Height of the second R-point during point

s
machining The height of the R-point during point machining is basically D41,

re
D1 however, it is changed to D1 under the following conditions.

ts
Tool sequence Conditions

gh
 Bit 6 of parameter D91 is set to 1 (D1 valid).

ri
Drill  There is a spot drill in the pre-machining tool

ll
sequence of the same unit.

.A
 Bit 2 of parameter D92 is set to 1 (D1 valid).

N

O
Reamer There is a chamfering cutter in the

TI
pre-machining tool sequence of the same
16

A unit.
Program type M
R
04

PO

However, when a drill is included in the pre-machining tool sequence in


30

Conditions Immediate
case of a drilling tool sequence, the height is changed to D42.
R

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


o.

(D42)
O
N

Setting range –999 to 999


C
al

The nominal diameter of a spot-machining tool that is automatically set


ri

ZA

during automatic tool development.


Se

Example :
A
IM

SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP


Nominal diameter of spot-machining tool
1 CTR-DR 20. 10. 
K
ZA

D2 
D2
A
M
YA

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit mm/0.1 in
)2

Setting range 0 to 99
(c

Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in a spot-machining cycle. Set
ht

this time in spindle revolutions.


ig

When the spot-machining tool reaches


yr

Number of revolutions during dwell at hole the hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
op

bottom in spot-machining cycle moving until the spindle makes D3


C

revolutions, and then return to the


D3
original position at the rapid feed rate.

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Revolutions
(Stops at hole bottom.)
Setting range 0 to 9 MPL002

2-75
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Element used to set the maximum spot-chamfering hole diameter (d)


during automatic tool development
Spot-chamfering occurs if
D2 d  D2 – D4.
Maximum allowable spot-chamfering hole If d > D2 – D4, the chamfering
d
diameter element cutter is developed automatically.
D4

Chamfering
Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in MPL003

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
The feed rate of a tool as it is being passed through the prehole during an

gh
inversed spot-facing cycle

ri
Note : 0.5 mm/rev if this parameter setting is 0.

ll
Prehole through speed during inversed

.A
spot-facing

N
D5

O
TI
At the feedrate of D5
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
MPL004
R
o.

Unit 100 mm/min / 10 in/min


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99
al

Element used to automatically set drill-machining cycles during automatic


ri

ZA

tool development
Se

A
IM

Machining cycle Conditions


Drill-machining cycle setting element
K

DEP TH
Drilling cycle  D6
ZA

D6 DIA
D7
A

High-speed deep-hole DEP TH


M

D6 <  D7
drilling cycle DIA
YA

Program type M
DEP TH
3

Deep-hole drilling cycle D7 <


Conditions Immediate
01

DIA
Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 9
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-76
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Element used to automatically set the number of drills which are


automatically developed according to the hole diameter of the drill unit

Maximum diameter of holes machinable on Number of drills


Conditions
one drill developed
1 DIA  D8
D8
2 D8 < DIA  D9
3 D9 < DIA  D10
Program type M Alarm D10 < DIA

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit mm/0.1 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
gh
ri
ll
Maximum diameter of holes machinable on

.A
two drills

N
D9

O
TI
16

Program type M
A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit mm/0.1 in
o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 99
C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Maximum diameter of holes machinable on


three drills
K

D10
ZA
A
M

Program type M
YA

Conditions Immediate
3

Unit mm/0.1 in
01

Setting range 0 to 99
)2
(c

Element used to automatically set the hole-drilling, endmilling, and boring


depths during automatic tool development of inversed spot-facing,
ht

tapping, back-boring, through-hole drilling, through-hole counter-boring,


ig

and spot-faced tapping units


yr
op

Through-hole/tap-prehole machining
C

DEPTH DEPTH
overshoot
D11
D11 D11
MPL005

Example :
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
Program type M 1 CTR-DR 10. 10. 21.
Conditions Immediate 
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in (DEPTH + D11)
Setting range 0 to 99 Note : See also parameter D30 for tapping units.

2-77
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Element used to automatically set the hole-drilling depth during automatic


tool development of stop-hole counter-boring and stop-hole boring units

DEPTH
Stop-hole machining hole-bottom clearance
MPL006
D12 D12
Example :
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP

d .
ve
1 DRILL 10. 10. 19.
Program type M 

er
(DEPTH – tool tip compensation – D12)

s
Conditions Immediate

re
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Note :

ts
Setting range 0 to 99 This parameter is invalid when the residual hole diameter is not 0.

gh
Hole diameter is automatically set during automatic tool development

ri
when spot-chamfering is not to be performed.

ll
.A
D13

N
Spot-machining hole diameter

O
(fixed value)

TI
16

D13 A MPL007
R
04

PO
30

Example :
R

Program type M SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP


o.

O
N

Conditions Immediate 1 CTR-DR 20. 10. 


C
al

Unit mm/0.1 in D13


K
ri

ZA

Setting range 0 to 99
Se

Element used to automatically set the depth-of-cut per drilling operation


IM

during automatic tool development


HOLE- × D14 : when the material of the stock workpiece is AL
K

(aluminum) in article MAT. 6


ZA

Depth-of-cut setting element for drilling


(ALMINUM) HOLE- × D15 : when the material of the stock workpiece is other than
A

AL in article MAT. 6
M

D14
YA
3
01

Program type M
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit 0.1
ht

Setting range 0 to 10
ig
yr
op
C

Depth-of-cut setting element for drilling


(except AL)

D15

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1
Setting range 0 to 10

2-78
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in the chamfering cycle of
chamfering cutter or spot-machining tool. Set this time in spindle
revolutions.

Number of revolutions during dwell at hole When the chamfering cutter reaches the
bottom for chamfering cutter or hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
spot-machining tool in chamfering cycle moving until the spindle makes D16
revolutions, and then return to the original
D16
position at the rapid feed rate.
Note :
This parameter is invalid for

.
Program type M

d
chamfering with true-circle processing.

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit Revolutions

s
(Stops at hole bottom.)

re
Setting range 0 to 9 MPL008

ts
The clearance in order to prevent tool interference with a wall of the

gh
workpiece or with the hole bottom during a chamfering cycle

ri
Use in the case of D92 bit 4 = 0:

ll
The safety clearance (D17) is radially or axially used only when an

.A
interference could actually occur.

N
Note :

O
A tip of the tool is allowed to enter the safety clearance area as long as

TI
16

there remains ever so short a clearance.


A
R
D17
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

Interferes.
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K

Interference clearance of chamfering cutter D17


ZA

Interferes. MPL009
D17
A
M

Use in the case of D92 bit 4 = 1:


YA

The safety clearance (D17) is radially or axially used for restrictively


shifting the position of that workpiece section which is subjected to check
3

for interference.
01

Note :
)2

No tip of the tool is allowed to enter the safety clearance area.


(c

D17 D17
ht
ig
yr
op
C

Judged as an
interference

D17
Program type M D17
MPL009’
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 99

2-79
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

The feed rate at which the tool is returned from the hole bottom during
reaming or boring.

D18
Return feed rate for reaming or boring
(cycle 3)

D18 MPL010
Note :
1. Valid only when the setting of DEPTH for the reamer (tool

.
sequence) is G01.

d
Program type M

ve
2. Valid only when the setting of PRE-DIA for the boring tool (tool
Conditions Immediate

er
sequence) is CYCLE 3.

s
Unit 100 mm/min / 10 in/min 3. If this parameter is 0, the tool is returned at the same feed rate as

re
Setting range 0 to 9 that of cutting.

ts
Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in an end milling cycle. Set this

gh
time in spindle revolutions.

ri
ll
When the end mill reaches the hole

.A
Number of revolutions during dwell at hole bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop
bottom for end milling moving until the spindle makes D19

N
revolutions, and then return to the

O
D19 original position at the rapid feed rate.

TI
16

A
R
04

Note :
PO

Program type M
30

This parameter is invalid for


R

Conditions Immediate true-circle processing.


o.

O
N

Unit Revolutions (Stops at hole bottom.) MPL011


C
al

Setting range 0 to 999


K
ri

ZA

Element used to automatically set the radial depth-of-cut per end milling
Se

operation
A
IM

Depth-of-cut = nominal diameter × D20


Depth-of-cut is automatically set according to the value of this parameter
K

Radial depth-of-cut setting element for end


when nominal diameter of the end mill is input.
ZA

milling
Example :
D20
A
M

SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP PRE-DIA PRE-DEP RGH


DEPTH
YA

1 END MILL 20. 40. 10. 30.  0. 12.

Program type M (NOM- × D20)


3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 100


ht

The reference value for calculation of a bottom-finishing allowance which


ig

corresponds to the roughness level of the end milling (tool sequence). The
yr

finishing allowance in the case of roughness level 4 becomes the value of


op

this parameter, and the values for all other roughness levels are set using
C

Reference bottom-finishing allowance for the expressions listed in the table below.
end milling
Roughness Bottom-finishing allowance
D21 0 to 3 0.0
4 D21
5 D21 × 0.7
Program type M 6 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7
7 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Conditions Immediate
8 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in 9 D21 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7
Setting range 0 to 99

2-80
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Dwell time at the hole bottom or at the R-point. This value is valid when 1
is set for bit 0, 1 or 2 of parameter D91.

Tapping-cycle dwell time

D22

Program type M Note :

d .
This parameter is valid only when the setting for roughness (RGH) of

ve
Conditions Immediate
tapping (tool sequence) is FIX.

er
Unit 0.01 s

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
The excess amount of prehole diameter over nominal diameter that is

gh
used to specify whether the Z-axis is to be moved at a rapid feed rate or at
a cutting feed rate during true-circle processing with the end mill

ri
ll
.A
Prehole clearance for end milling
D23 D23

N
D23

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Cutting feed Rapid feed MPL012


R
o.

Unit mm/0.1 in
O
N

Setting range 0 to 99
al

Z-axis feed dwell time at the hole bottom in a boring cycle. Set this time in
ri

ZA

spindle revolutions.
Se

When the boring bar reaches the hole


IM

bottom, the Z-axis will firstly stop moving


Number of revolutions during dwell at hole until the spindle makes D24 revolutions,
K

bottom for boring and then the spindle orientation will be


ZA

D24 performed.
A

Note :
M

This parameter is invalid if the roughness


YA

(RGH) of the boring (tool sequence) is 0.


Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit Revolutions
)2

(Stops at hole bottom.) MPL013


Setting range 0 to 9
(c
ht

The amount of relief provided for the tip of a boring bar to be kept clear of
the hole wall after spindle orientation
ig
yr

D25
op
C

Boring-bar tip relief

D25

During boring During returning MPL014


Note :
Program type M
1. Valid only when the setting for the prehole diameter of the boring
Conditions Immediate (tool sequence) is CYCLE 1.
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in 2. For the relief direction of the tool tip, see the description of bit 3 and
Setting range 0 to 99 bit 4 of I14.

2-81
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

The distance which the boring or back-boring tool is returned at the same
feed rate and milling spindle speed as for the preceding operation after
the tool has reached the hole bottom

Returning distance from hole bottom for


boring or back-boring

D26
D26
MPL015
[1] Has reached the [2] Returned at the [3] Returned at a
Program type M

.
hole bottom. same feedrate. rapid feedrate.

d
ve
Conditions Immediate Note :

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Not valid if the setting for the roughness (RGH) of the boring (tool

s
sequence) is 1.

re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
The distance which the boring bar is fed in at 70% of the original feed rate

gh
and milling spindle speed to finish the hole bottom

ri
ll
.A
Bottom-finishing amount of boring

N
D28

O
D28
MPL016

TI
16

A
The feed rate is reduced to 70% of the original value before the hole
R
04

Program type M bottom is reached.


PO
30

Note :
Conditions Immediate
R

Not valid if the setting for the roughness (RGH) of the boring (tool
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


O

sequence) is 1.
N

Setting range 0 to 99
al

The time required for a chip removal tool to complete a chip removal
ri

ZA
Se

operation after the tool has been positioned to the hole


A
IM

Chip removal time


K
ZA

D29
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit
)2

s
Setting range 0 to 99
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-82
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

To set number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle for metric screws


and unified screws. In tapping, internal thread is tapped extra for the depth
of (D30 × pitch) in the direction of Z.
This is also used as an element for automatically determining hole-drilling
depth (HOLE-DEP) in the automatic tool development of the tapping unit.

Number of incomplete threads in tapping


cycle DEPTH

D30 D30 × Pitch

d .
D11 MPL017

ve
Example :

s er
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP

re
Program type M
1 DRILL 10. 10. 19.

ts
Conditions Immediate
{DEPTH + D11 + (D30 × pitch)} 

gh
Unit Thread
[Related parameter]

ri
Setting range 0 to 9 D43: Number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle for piped screws

ll
Excess amount of tool return due to elongation of the tapper during

.A
tapping cycle

N
Set this value in spindle revolutions.

O
TI
16

Tapper elongation amount for tapping A


R
04

D31 D31 × Pitch


PO

R-point
30

R
o.

O
N

Program type M
al

Conditions Immediate
ri

ZA
Se

Unit Revolutions MPL018


A

Setting range 0 to 9
IM

The number of inertial turns in tapping cycle that the spindle has rotated
K

clockwise during the time from output of a spindle CCW rotation command
ZA

to the start of spindle CCW rotation


Number of spindle revolutions until spindle
A
M

CCW rotation begins in tapping cycle


YA

D32
3
01

Program type M
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit Revolutions
ht

Setting range 0 to 99
ig
yr

The amount of relief provided for a back-boring tool tip to be kept clear of
op

the prehole walls as it is being passed through the prehole in the oriented
state of the spindle
C

D33
Back-boring tool tip relief

D33

[1] During back-boring [2] During passage MPL019


Program type M
Note :
Conditions Immediate
For the relief direction of the tool tip, see the description of bit 3 and bit 4
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in of I14.
Setting range 0 to 99

2-83
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Element used to automatically set the prehole-drilling diameter during


automatic tool development of the reamer unit (When the pre-machining
process is drilling.)
DIA
Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for
reamer (drilling)
D35 DIA – D35

Program type M MPL020

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Example :

er
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-

s
1 DRILL 10. 10.  (DIA – D35)

re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
Element used to automatically set the prehole-drilling diameter during

gh
automatic tool development of the reamer unit (When the pre-machining
process is boring.)

ri
DIA

ll
Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for

.A
reamer (boring)

N
D36 DIA – D36

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M MPL020


PO
30

Conditions Immediate Example :


R
o.

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in


O

SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-


N

Setting range 0 to 999 1 DRILL 10. 10.  (DIA – D36)


al

Element used to automatically set the prehole-drilling diameter during


ri

ZA

automatic tool development of the reamer unit (When the pre-machining


Se

process is end milling.)


IM

DIA
Prehole-drilling diameter setting element for
K

reamer (end milling)


ZA

D37 DIA – D37


A
M
YA

MPL020
Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate Example :


)2

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-


1 DRILL 10. 10.  (DIA – D37)
(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-84
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

1. In automatic tool development of the reamer unit, if the pre-machining


process is boring:
DIA

Reamer-prehole diameter setting element


for boring or end milling Boring-hole diameter
= DIA – D38
D38

MPL021

d .
Program type M

ve
Example :
Conditions Immediate

er
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-

s
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in
1 BOR BAR 10. 10.  (DIA – D38)

re
Setting range 0 to 999
2. In automatic tool development of the reamer unit, if the pre-machining

ts
process is end milling:

gh
DIA

ri
ll
.A
First end milling hole diameter
Reamer-prehole diameter setting element = DIA – D39

N
for end milling
Second end milling hole diameter

O
D39 = DIA – D38

TI
16

A MPL022
R
04

PO
30

Program type M Example :


R
o.

Conditions Immediate SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE-


N

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in 1 END MILL 15. 20.  (DIA – D39)


al

Setting range 0 to 999 2 END MILL 10. 21.  (DIA – D38)


ri

ZA
Se

Z-axis feed dwell time at the spot-faced hole bottom in an inversed spot
A

facing cycle. Set this time in spindle revolutions.


IM

When the inversed spot-facing tool


K

Number of revolutions during dwell at reaches the hole bottom, firstly the
ZA

spot-faced hole bottom for inversed Z-axis will stop moving until the
spot-facing spindle makes D40 revolutions, and
A

D40 then the rotational direction of the


M

spindle will reverse.


YA

(Feeding stops at
hole bottom.)
3

MPL023
01

Program type M
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit Revolutions
ht

Setting range 0 to 9
ig

R-point height of each tool in the point-machining unit


yr

Example :
op
C

Initial point
R-point height during point-machining

D41 R-point
D41
Machining surface
MPL024
Program type M
Note :
Conditions Immediate For the inversed spot-facing unit or the back-boring unit, this parameter
Unit mm/0.1 in can also be used for setting the clearance amount at the hole bottom.
Setting range 0 to 99 (D1, D42)

2-85
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Height of the third R-point

Initial point

D42
Third R-point

MPL001

d .
ve
Height of the third R-point during point
machining The height of the R-point during point machining is basically D41,

er
however it is changed to D42 under the following conditions.

s
D42

re
ts
Tool sequence Conditions

gh
 Bit 6 of parameter D91 is set to 1 (D42 valid).

ri
Drill  There is a drill in the pre-machining tool

ll
sequence of the same unit.

.A
 Bit 7 of parameter D91 is set to 1 (D42 valid).

N
Chamfering
 CYCLE 2 is selected for the machining

O
cutter
cycle.

TI
16

A  Bit 7 of parameter D91 is set to 1 (D42 valid).


Program type M
R
04

Spot  CYCLE 2 in the chamfering cycle is selected


PO

Conditions Immediate for the machining cycle.


30

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


R
o.

Setting range –999 to 999


N

C
al

To set number of incomplete threads in tapping cycle for piped screws


K
ri

(PT, PF, PS). In tapping, internal thread is tapped extra for the depth of
ZA
Se

(D43 × pitch) in the direction of Z.


A

This is also used as an element for automatically determining hole-drilling


IM

depth (HOLE-DEP) in the automatic tool development of the tapping unit.


Number of incomplete threads in tapping
K

cycle for piped screw


ZA

DEPTH
D43
A
M

D43 × Pitch
YA

D11 MPL017
3

Program type M Example :


01

Conditions Immediate SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP


)2

Unit Thread 1 DRILL 10. 10. 19.


(c

Setting range 0 to 9 {DEPTH + D11 + (D43 × pitch)} 


ht

Select an automatic calculation method for the amount of chamfer with the
ig

tapping unit.
yr
op

0: Following calculation expression is used:


C

Selecting an automatic calculation method (MAJOR- + 2 × PITCH) – PRE-DIA


for the amount of chamfer with the tapping Amount of chamfer = 2
unit
1: Following calculation expression is used (same as M32):
D44
MAJOR- – PRE-DIA
Amount of chamfer = 2
Note :
Program type M
Select 1 if a loss of the threaded section is likely due to overchamfering
Conditions Immediate as compared with a small TAP-DEP value.
Unit — Example : Sheet metal tapping
Setting range 0, 1

2-86
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

q1 1st time

i-th time
Drilling qi
depth
q1

d.
q2

ve
Gradual decrements in drilling depth qn

ser
D45

re
qi

ts
b

gh
qn

ri
ll
.A
1 2 i n Number of

N
times

O
q1: 1st drilling depth

TI
qi : i-th drilling depth
16

Aqn: Residual hole depth


b : Minimum drilling depth D46
R
04

Program type M qi = q1 – D45 × (i – 1) (If qi  b)


PO
30

Conditions Immediate qi = b (If qi < b)


R
o.

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 9999 (D46)


al

Set the minimum gradual drilling depth.


ri

ZA
Se

However, if the residual hole depth is smaller than D46, actual drilling
A

depth will be the same as the residual hole depth.


IM

Minimum gradual drilling depth


K
ZA

D46
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in


(D45)
(c

Setting range 0 to 9999


ht

Element used to automatically set the hole depth (HOLE-DEP) of drilling,


ig

end milling and boring during automatic tool development of the reamer
yr

unit
op
C

Reamer-prehole machining overshoot DEPTH DEPTH

D47 D47 D47

For drilling For end milling or boring MPL025


Program type M
Example :
Conditions Immediate SNo. TOOL NOM- No. HOLE- HOLE-DEP
Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in 1 DRILL 10. 10. 21.  (DEPTH + D47)
Setting range 0 to 999

2-87
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Feed override for the section to be chamfered in the planetary tapping


cycle
Chamfering feed =
Pre-hole machining feed in tapping tool sequence × D48/100
Feed override for the section to be
chamfered in the planetary tapping cycle
D48

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Chamfering section

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
The amount of return at hole bottom during the planetary tapping cycle

gh
Specify data by the number of threads.
Amount of return = Tapping pitch × D49/10

ri
ll
Amount of return at hole bottom during the

.A
planetary tapping cycle

N
D49

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Amount of return


R
o.

Unit 0.1 thread


O
N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

The feed rate for pre-hole machining will be auto-set to D50 when the
ri

ZA

planetary tapping cycle is selected.


Se

A
IM

Auto-set feed rate for pre-hole machining SNo. TOOL NOM- No.HOLE- HOLE-DEP PRE-DIA PRE-DEP RGH DEPTH C-SP FR M M
in the planetary tapping cycle
K

1 TAP M10. 10. 23.7 PLANET 0.15 FIX P1.5 50 1.5



ZA

D50 D50
A
M
YA

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01

0.01 mm/rev
Unit
0.001 in/rev
)2

Setting range 0 to 9999


(c
ht

The feed rate will be auto-set to D51 when the planetary tapping cycle is
selected.
ig
yr

SNo. TOOL NOM- No.HOLE- HOLE-DEP PRE-DIA PRE-DEP RGH DEPTH C-SP FR M M
op

Auto-set feed rate for planetary tapping 1 TAP M10. 10. 23.7 PLANET 0.15 FIX P1.5 50 0.04
cycle 
C

D51
D51

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
0.01 mm/rev
Unit
0.001 in/rev
Setting range 0 to 9999

2-88
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Set the reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate during the
very-deep-hole drilling in a drilling or turning-drilling unit.

Cutting feed
Reduction ratio for the G00-based relief rate
during a very-deep-hole drilling cycle Rapid feed (G00)

D52

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 100

ts
Set the number of times of pecking to be executed before returning the

gh
tool to a position near the starting point of the very-deep-hole drilling cycle
of a drilling or turning-drilling unit.

ri
Example : If D53 = 3:

ll
.A
Cutting feed
Rapid feed

N
O
Starting

TI
point
16

A
R
04

PO

Number of times of pecking up to the return After pecking has been


30

of the tool to a position near the starting repeated three times, the
R

tool returns to a position


o.

point of the very-deep-hole drilling cycle of


O

near the starting point.


N

a drilling or turning-drilling unit


C

D53
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M

Ending point
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit Times
)2

Setting range 0 to 9999


(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-89
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

D54
F’= F × 100 F : Specified feed rate
F' : Feed rate at cutting start

End point Programmed


start point

 Drill D

d.
ve
Deceleration rate at cutting start for
very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental

er
very-deep-hole machining cycle

s
re
D54

ts
gh
Feed rate at F' over distance  from the NM211-00268
programmed start point

ri
ll
D

.A
= (0° <  < 180°)
2 × tan/2

N
=0 (  180°)

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 100


al

K
ri

D55 D55 D55


ZA
Se

A
IM

G1
Drilling return distance for very-deep-hole
G0
K

drilling cycle/decremental very-deep-hole


ZA

machining cycle
D55
A

P2 P1
M
YA

D4 D3 D2 D1
Program type M
3

P1: Start point NM211-00252


01

Conditions Immediate
P2: End point
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Dn (n = 1 to 4) = Cut depth


(c

Setting range 0 to 9999


ht

Set the number of revolutions of the milling spindle during dwell time at
ig

the chip ejection position and the hole bottom for the very-deep-hole
yr

drilling cycle or the decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle.


Number of revolutions during dwell at chip
op

ejection position and hole bottom for


C

very-deep-hole drilling cycle/decremental


very-deep-hole machining cycle
D56

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Revoluitons
Setting range 0 to 255

2-90
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Set the return speed for the very-deep-hole drilling cycle or the
decremental very-deep-hole machining cycle.

Return speed for very-deep-hole drilling


cycle/decremental very-deep-hole
machining cycle
D57

Program type M

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
0.001 mm/rev
Unit

er
0.0001 in/rev

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999

ts
Set the feed rate reduction distance from the reference point at cutting

gh
start of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle (blind hole, through hole) during the
point machining. Specify the ratio with respect to the drill diameter.

ri
If the nominal diameter of the drill is D, the feed rate reduction distance L

ll
.A
at cutting start is calculated using the following calculation expression:
L = D × D58/100

N
O
The feed rate is reduced by the ratio specified in D54 (feed rate reduction

TI
ratio at cutting start) by the distance L from the reference point (R).
16

Feed rate reduction distance ratio at cutting A


start of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle (blind
R
04

hole, through hole)


PO
30

D58
R
o.

R
O
N

Clearance
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L = D × Feed rate reduction


A

distance ratio
IM

Program type M
K
ZA

Conditions After movement stop


A

Unit %
M

Setting range 0 to 300


YA

Set the surface speed reduction ratio at cutting end of a very-deep-hole


drilling cycle (through hole) during the point machining.
3
01

If the surface speed during drilling is S, the surface speed S’ at cutting end
)2

is calculated using the following calculation expression:


(c

S’ = S × D59/100
ht

The surface speed is reduced to S’ by “speed reduction distance


ig

Surface speed reduction ratio at cutting end immediately before the hole bottom” (hb specified in the program).
yr

of a very-deep-hole drilling cycle (through


op

hole)
D59
C

Distance to the
hole bottom

hb
Program type M
Conditions After movement stop
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100

2-91
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Set the ratio between automatic setting value for the feed rate in the axial
cutting and that in the radial cutting during chamfering in the point
machining.

Automatic setting ratio of axial cutting feed


rate during chamfering
D60

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions After movement stop

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 100

ts
Set the nominal diameter of a chamfering cutter that is automatically set

gh
during automatic tool development for a point machining unit of
MAZATROL programs.

ri
Nominal diameter of chamfering cutter, set

ll
.A
during automatic tool development for a
point machining unit

N
D61

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

Set the maximum number of times automatic pecking can be performed


ri

ZA

by MAZATROL programs.
Se

* The setting “0” is regarded as a setting of 9999 times.


IM

Maximum number of times automatic


pecking is to be performed by MAZATROL
K

programs
ZA

D62
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 9999


(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-92
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Sets the reduction ratio for the G00 feed rate used for axis travel from the
chip ejection position to the return position during a deep-hole
drilling/very-deep-hole drilling cycle.
When either 0 or 100 is set, the feed rate is not reduced.

Start
point
Retraction feed rate = G00 feed rate  D52 / 100

.
Reduction ratio for the G00 feed rate from

d
ve
the chip ejection position to the return
position during a deep-hole drilling/

er
very-deep-hole drilling cycle

s
D66

re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
Feed rate used for axis travel from the

N
chip ejection position to the return position

O
= G00 feed rate  D66 / 100

TI
16

A
R
Program type M
04

PO

Cutting feed
30

Conditions Immediate
Rapid feed (G00)
R

Unit %
o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 100


C
al

Specify DEP-Z range for the end mill and the face mill from the learning
ri

ZA

data of cutting conditions.


Se

When learning data on the condition that DEP-Z is in the following range
IM

has been stored in the memory, learning is not effectuated again.


Learning of cutting conditions
(DEP-Z range) For a DEP-Z range of the end mill, set a value of “DEPTH/NOM-” (at a
D73
K

unit of 0.1%).
ZA

to 0 to D73 .................. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 1


A

D77 D73 to D74 .............. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 2


M

D74 to D75 .............. DEP-Z range (for end mill) 3


YA

Program type M For a DEP-Z range of the face mill, set a value of “DEPTH” (at a unit of
0.1 mm or 0.01 in).
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.1% (0.1 mm/0.01 in) 0 to D76 .................. DEP-Z range (for face mill) 1
)2

D76 to D77 .............. DEP-Z range (for face mill) 2


Setting range 0 to 1000
(c

Specify WID-R range for the boring bar, back boring bar and end mill from
ht

the learning data of cutting conditions.


ig

When learning data on the condition that WID-R is in the following range
yr

has been stored in the memory, learning is not effectuated again.


op

Learning of cutting conditions For a WID-R range of the boring bar and back boring bar, set a value of
C

D78 (WID-R range)


“DEPTH” (at a unit of 0.1 mm/0.01 in).
to 0 to D78 .................. WID-R range (for boring bar and back boring bar) 1
D82 D78 to D79 .............. WID-R range (for boring bar and back boring bar) 2
For a WID-R range of the end mill, set a value of “DEPTH/NOM-” (at a
unit of 0.1%).
Program type M
0 to D80 .................. WID-R range (for end mill) 1
Conditions Immediate
D80 to D81 .............. WID-R range (for end mill) 2
Unit 0.1% (0.1 mm/0.01 in) D81 to D82 .............. WID-R range (for end mill) 3
Setting range 0 to 1000

2-93
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

76543210 (1: Execution, 0: No execution)

M04 is output after the tool has dwelled at the


hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
The tool dwells after M04 has been output at the
hole bottom during a tapping cycle.
The tool dwells after it has been returned to the
R-point during a tapping cycle.
If a drill is used in the pre-machining of the
centering drill cycle, the R-point height is set to

d .
D1.

ve
The finishing tool path is shortened during a

er
— true-circle processing cycle (end milling).

s
re
The tool path is shortened during a true-circle
D91

ts
processing cycle (chamfering).

gh
If a pre-machining tool sequence is included in
the same unit, the R-point height of the drill is set

ri
to D1 or D42.

ll
.A
1. The R-point height of the chamfering cutter
during the cycle 2 is set to D42.

N
O
2. The R-point height of the spot-machining tool

TI
during the chamfering cycle (cycle 2) is set to
16

A D42.
R
04

3. R-point height selection for smooth


PO

chamfering (point machining)


30

Program type M
R

0 : The R-point height is set to TC39.


o.

Conditions Immediate 1 : The R-point height is set to D42.


N

C
al

Unit —
K
ri

ZA

Setting range Binary, eight digits


Se

1: Used
IM

0: Not used
K
ZA

During a true-circle processing (end milling)


cycle, E17 is used/not used for axial feed
A
M

D92
YA

(bit 0)
3
01

Program type M
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig

1: Set
yr

0: Not set
op
C

The R1-point height of the back spot facing


is set/not set to D1

D92
(bit 1)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-94
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

1: Set
0: Not set

If a chamfering cutter is included in the


pre-machining tool sequence of the same
unit, the R-point height of the reamer is
set/not set to D1
D92
(bit 2)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
1: Set

gh
0: Not set

ri
If a chamfering cutter is included in the

ll
pre-machining tool sequence of the same

.A
unit, the R-point height of the tap is set/not

N
set to D1
D92

O
TI
(bit 3)
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

1: Subjected
ri

ZA
Se

0: Not subjected
A
IM

The position cleared radially or axially by


D17 from the workpiece section concerned
K

is subjected/not subjected to check for


ZA

interference
D92
A
M

(bit 4)
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

1: Valid
ig

0: Invalid
yr

Note :
op

Dwell time designation for synchronous Timing of dwell execution of bit 5 is determined by settings in bit 0 to 2 of
C

tapping in the MAZATROL program parameter D91.


D92
(bit 5)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-95
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

1: Ejected
0: Not ejected

During planetary tapping, chips are


ejected/not ejected automatically prior to
the threading process
D92
(bit 6)

Program type M

. d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
1: Generate

gh
0: Do not generate

ri
Whether or not to generate alarm 650

ll
CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE if idle cutting

.A
takes place during chamfering in

N
D92 point-machining unit

O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Unidirectional positioning for point-machining


ZA
Se

76543210 (1: Execution, 0: No execution)


A
IM

CTR-DR (Spot-machining tool)



K

DRILL (Drill)
ZA

REAMER (Reamer)
D93
A

TAP (Tap)
M

BCK FACE (Inversed spot-facing tool)


YA

BOR BAR (Boring tool)


Program type M
3

B-B BAR (Back-boring tool)


01

Conditions Immediate
CHAMFER (Chamfering cutter)
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range Binary, eight digits


ht

Unidirectional positioning for point-machining


ig

76543210 (1: Execution, 0: No execution)


yr
op

END MILL (End mill)


C

— Planetary tapping
Tornado cycle
D94

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-96
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Selection of the auto-setting method to be used for the MAZATROL


program data items of the tapping unit (TAPPING and CBOR-TAP) and
the diameter item of pipe taps on the TOOL DATA display.
76543210
For pipe-tapping items
0: Conventional method
1: The text file concerned is referred to for the
auto-setting of pipe-tapping data items in a
MAZATROL program as well as on the
Auto-setting method for tapping TOOL DATA display.

d .
ve
D95 For unified thread items

er
0: Conventional method

s
1: The text file concerned is referred to for the

re
auto-setting of the pre-hole diameter

ts
(PRE-DIA) within a tapping unit (for unified

gh
thread).

ri
For metric thread items

ll
0: Conventional method

.A
1: The text file concerned is referred to for the
Program type M

N
auto-setting of the pre-hole diameter

O
Conditions Immediate (PRE-DIA) within a tapping unit (for metric

TI
Unit — thread).
16

A
R
Setting range Binary, eight digits
04

PO
30

Surface speed calculation for spot drill used


R

0: Based on machining hole diameter


o.

O
N

1: Based on nominal diameter of the tool


C
al

Surface speed calculation for spot drill used


ri

ZA
Se

D96
A

(bit 0)
IM
K
ZA

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
A
M

Unit —
YA

Setting range 0, 1
3

Element that determines the counterboring pattern (whether to execute


01

diameter enlarging)
)2

0: Determines the counterboring pattern from the nominal diameter in tool


(c

data and the hole diameter in the program.


ht

Counterboring pattern 1: Determines the counterboring pattern from the tool diameter in the tool
data and the hole diameter in the program.
ig

D96
yr

(bit 1)
op
C

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-97
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

The amount of chamfer in the spot drill tool sequence


0: Cannot be specified
1: Can be specified
Setting of the amount of chamfer in the spot
drill tool sequence
D96
(bit 2)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
RGH BCB (inversed faced hole machining), BK-CBORE (back boring),

gh
and CBOR-TAP (counterbore tapping) are displayed in the menu in the
Menu display setting of RGH BCB (inversed
point-machining unit.

ri
faced hole machining), BK-CBORE (back
BACKSPOT FACER (inversed spot-facing tool) and BACK BORING BAR

ll
boring) and CBOR-TAP (counterbore

.A
tapping), as well as BACKSPOT FACER (back boring) are displayed in the tool menu for tool sequence data in the
(inversed spot-facing tool) and BACK point-machining unit.

N
D96 BORING BAR (back boring) in the tool 0: Invalid (not displayed)

O
(bit 3) sequence data

TI
1: Valid (displayed)
16

A
R
04

Program type M * Even if the menu display is disabled, the menu is enabled and
PO
30

Conditions At power on displayed in the expert mode, i.e. when the SMART mode is canceled.
R
o.

Unit
O


N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Used to select the mode of operation when the cutting depth is not
ZA
Se

specified or is set to 0 in the deep-hole tapping or high-speed deep-hole


A

tapping cycle.
IM

0: Perform tapping without pecking


Cutting depth in deep-hole tapping/
K

high-speed deep-hole tapping cycle 1: Alarm


ZA

D96
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions
01

Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select the cutting drawing method for circular milling unit on the VIRTUAL
ig

MACHINING display.
yr

0: Detailed drawing
op

(Cutting is drawn according to the specified pitch.)


Cutting drawing method for circular milling
C

unit on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display 1: Simple drawing


D97 (Cutting is drawn using approximate geometries regardless of the
specified pitch. Cutting is performed from the start point to the end
(bit 0) point by one single rotation and another rotation at the end point.)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-98
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Stop with an alarm


1: Invalid
(The control moves to the next machining process.)
Action to be taken when the number of 0: Valid
times pecking has been performed has
reached the set maximum count (The alarm 980 MACRO USER ALARM 1 occurs.)
D98
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

. d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set if the INDEX unit is executed or not.

gh
0: Not executed (Conventional scheme)

ri
1: Executed

ll
Execution of the INDEX unit when the

.A
PRI.No. is set in the MANUAL PROGRAM

N
D98

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Fixed value
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

D100
A

(bit 0)
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c
ht

0: Radius value
ig

1: Diameter value
yr
op

Handling the X-axial coordinates of


C

non-turning TPC relay points


D105
(bit 0)

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-99
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Tap high-speed deep-hole cycle menu


0: Hidden
1: Display
Tap high-speed deep-hole cycle menu
display/hidden
D105
(bit 1)

Program type M

. d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether or not to generate alarm 1602 SET INDEX UNIT BEFORE

gh
MACHINING when the following unit is not preceded by an index unit.
[Units]

ri
Point machining, line machining, chamfering, face machining, C-axis

ll
Machine operation when the first machining

.A
point machining, C-axis line machining, C-axis chamfering, turning,
unit is not preceded by an index unit
EIA/ISO subprogram, manual program, MMS, pallet change, workpiece

N
D106 measurement, tool measurement

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

0: No alarm A
R
1: Alarm
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Do not execute
ri

ZA
Se

1: Execute
A
IM

Execution of an index command after the


second or subsequent work coordinate
K

command in WPC unit


ZA

D106
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

T-code in index unit to be executed before the end unit


ig

0: Output
yr

1: Do not output
op

T-code output during indexing before the


C

end unit
D106
(bit 2)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-100
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Selection of rotational axis command system by table selection

0: Table selection invalid


Selection of rotational axis command 1: Table selection valid
system by table selection Specify the rotational axis in the table selection unit when table
D106 selection is valid.
(bit 4)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Timing of outputting alarm 1602 SET INDEX UNIT BEFORE MACHINING

gh
when bit 0 of parameter D106 is set to 1

ri
0: Output before executing a machining unit

ll
Alarm output timing when the first 1: Alarm output immediately after the cycle start button is pressed

.A
machining unit is not preceded by an index
unit

N
D106

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

D107
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

When a 3D coordinate conversion mode cancel code (G69 for machining


ig

centers and G69.5 for turning centers) is specified in the manual program
yr

unit, alarm 714 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA is:


op

Alarm output when 3D coordinate 0: Not output


C

conversion mode cancel is specified in the 1: Output


manual program unit
D107
(bit 2)

Program type M
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-101
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

0 : 0.01 [in/min]
1 : 1 [in/min]

Unit of feed rate for the feed per minute


command in manual program units for the
inch system
D107
(bit 3)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Calculating based on C-SP and NOM- in the tool sequence

gh
(conventional operation)
< With mm specification >

ri
–1

ll
Mill spindle speed (min ) =

.A
Surface speed (m/min)  1000 / (Nominal diameter (mm)  )

N
< With inch specification >

O
–1
Mill spindle speed (min ) =

TI
Surface speed (ft/min)  12 / (Nominal diameter (in)  )
16

Calculation method for mill spindle speed A


R
04

when spot chamfering


PO

D107 1: Calculating based on C-SP in the tool sequence and the diameter at
30

the cutting position (NOM-  (1/2))


(bit 4)
R
o.

< With mm specification >


O
N

–1
Mill spindle speed (min ) =
al

Surface speed (m/min)  1000 / (Nominal diameter (mm)  1/2  )


K
ri

ZA

< With inch specification >


Se

–1
A

Mill spindle speed (min ) =


IM

Surface speed (ft/min)  12 / (Nominal diameter (in)  1/2  )


Program type M
K
ZA

Conditions Immediate
Unit —
A
M

Setting range 0, 1
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-102
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Sets the chip ejection distance for deep-hole drilling cycles.


When a deep-hole drilling cycle is selected using a drill (tool sequence)
with bit 0 of D141 enabled, the tool is retracted to the point determined
according to the setting of D130 during machining, instead of the R-point.

Chip ejection distance


D130
Chip ejection distance in deep-hole drilling R-point
cycle

d .
D130

ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
Note : If “0” is set, the R-point is used.

ll
Program type M

.A
Conditions Immediate [Related parameters]

N
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in D106 bit 3

O
TI
Setting range 0 to 999
16

A
Sets the override for the G00 feed-in speed to the previous cutting point in
R
04

pecking during the deep-hole boring cycle.


PO
30

R
o.

O
N

G00
C
al

G00 feed rate  D131 / 100


ri

ZA
Se

F302 G01
A
IM

F302
K

G00 feed-in speed override for deep-hole


ZA

boring cycle
A

D131
M
YA
3

Note :
01

1. When “0” is set, the override is set to 100%.


)2

2. The D131 setting does not apply to any other G00 than that for the
(c

feed-in operation.
ht
ig
yr

Program type M
[Related parameters]
op

Conditions Immediate
F302 : Allowance in rapid feed stop in deep-hole boring cycle
C

Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100

2-103
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

Used to select whether the chip ejection distance set for parameter D130
is to be used during deep-hole drilling cycle or not.
0: Not used (use R-point)
1: Used
Chip ejection operation during deep-hole
drilling cycle
D141
(bit 0)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Feed-in operation during deep-hole boring cycle

gh
0 : G00

ri
1 : G01

ll
Feed-in operation selection for deep-hole

.A
boring cycle Note :
D141

N
1. When D141 bit 1 = “0”, the G00 feed-in speed override can be set

O
(bit 1) with D131.

TI
16

2. When D141 bit 1 = “1”, the G01 feed-in speed can be set with F303.
A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Select the circular processing selection method for circular milling unit.
ri

ZA
Se

0 : Automatic selection based on “HOLE-”, “PRE-DIA” and “DEPTH” in


A

tool sequence data of the program


IM

1 : Circular processing B
Circular milling unit: Circular processing
K

selection method switch


ZA

D141
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

0: Invalid
ig

1: Valid
yr
op

WPC unit/WPC shift unit


C

D143
(bit 0)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-104
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title POINT

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Selection of approach after ATC in initial * This parameter is valid only for machining centers not equipped with a
point type program B-axis swivel type turret, such as VRX and HCN.
D143
(bit 1)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-105
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-3 User parameter LINE/FACE/3D (E)

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Element used to set cutting start point and escape point for closed-pattern
line- or face-machining
Example :
Defined closed pattern Defined closed
Closed-pattern cutting start point and pattern
escape point setting element SRV-R
E1 E2 E2

. d
ve
E1 Cutting Escape E1

er
start point point MPL026

s
Program type M

re
Conditions Immediate [Applicable units]

ts
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in  LINE OUT, LINE IN, CHMF OUT and CHMF IN

gh
Setting range 0 to 999  Wall finishing of STEP, POCKET, PCKT MT and PCKT VLY

ri
ll
Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point for line- or

.A
face-machining (the first clearance)

N
Example :

O
NOM-/2  SRV-R

TI
16

A E2
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

SRV-R
N

Cutting Escape point


C

E2
start point
al

Cutting start point and escape point setting


ri

NOM-/2 < SRV-R


ZA

element (the first clearance)


Se

E2
A

E2
IM
K
ZA

Cutting Escape point


start point E2 SRV-R MPL027
A
M

[Applicable units]
YA

 All line-machining units


3

 Face-machining units other than FCE MILL, TOP EMIL, and SLOT
01

Note :
)2

Program type M 1. See the diagram of parameter E1 also.


(c

Conditions Immediate 2. Positioning of E2 at the escape point can be selected using E95, but
ht

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in only for line-machining units.


ig

Setting range 0 to 999


yr
op
C

2-106
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The reference value of each finishing allowance R (FIN-R) which is


automatically set when the roughness levels of the line- or face-machining
units have been set
The finishing allowance R in the case of roughness level 4 becomes the
value of this parameter, and the values for all other roughness levels are
calculated using the expressions listed in the table below.
Reference allowance of finishing in radial
direction Roughness FIN-R
E4 0 to 3 0.0
4 E4

. d
5 E4 × 0.7

ve
6 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7

s er
Program type M 7 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7

re
Conditions Immediate 8 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7

ts
9 E4 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7

gh
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

ri
Setting range 0 to 999

ll
Element used to set the cutting start point and escape point (the second

.A
clearance)

N
E2 is used generally as a clearance on the X-Y plane, however, E5 is used

O
when the condition meets both of 1. and 2. mentioned below.

TI
Element used to set the cutting start point 1. There is pre-machining in the same unit.
16

and escape point (the second clearance) A


2. The parameter (E91 to E95) that makes E5 effective is set to ON (1).
R
04

E5
PO

[Applicable units]
30

LINE OUT, LINE IN, STEP, POCKET, POCKT MT, PCKT VLY
R
o.

[Related parameters]
N

Program type M
E91 bit 3, E92 bit 3, E93 bit 3, E94 bit 3, E95 bit 7
al

Conditions Immediate
ri

* Parameter that effectuates E5 in the applicable unit.


ZA
Se

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


A

Setting range 0 to 999


IM

The reference value of each finishing allowance Z (FIN-Z) which is


K

automatically set when the roughness levels of the line- or face-machining


ZA

units have been set


The finishing allowance Z in the case of roughness level 4 becomes the
A

value of this parameter, and the values for all other roughness levels are
M

calculated using the expressions listed in the table below.


YA

Reference allowance of finishing in axial


direction
3

Roughness FIN-Z
01

E6 0 to 3 0.0
)2

4 E6
(c

5 E6 × 0.7
ht

6 E6 × 0.7 × 0.7
ig
yr

Program type M 7 E6 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7


op

Conditions Immediate 8 E6 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7


C

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in 9 E6 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7 × 0.7

Setting range 0 to 999

2-107
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Allowance of cutting start point in axial direction


For the line- or face-machining, E9 is used as an axial clearance for rapid
access to the machining point from the initial point, however, E7 is used
when the condition meets both of 1. and 2. mentioned below.
Allowance of cutting start point in axial 1. There is pre-machining in the same unit.
direction (the second clearance)
2. The parameter (E91 to E97) that makes E7 effective is set to ON (1).
E7 [Applicable units]
All line-/face-machining units except the face milling and angular face unit.

[Related parameters]
Program type M

d .
E91 bit 2, E92 bit 2, E93 bit 2, E94 bit 2, E95 bit 6, E96 bit 1, E97 bit 2

ve
Conditions Immediate
* Parameter that effectuates E7 in the applicable unit.

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
The amount of clearance that prevents interference of the chamfering

gh
cutter with the walls during face-machining

ri
E8

ll
Radial interference clearance of chamfering

.A
cutter

N
E8

O
TI
Interferes.
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Interference distance MPL028


R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

Element used to set the position in which the cutting feed in axial direction
ZA
Se

is to be started after the line- or face-machining tool has been moved from
A

the initial point toward the workpiece at a rapid feed rate


IM

Example :
Allowance of axial-cutting start position
K

(the first clearance) Initial point


ZA

E9 E9
A
M

SRV-Z
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
MPL029
)2

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

Element used to automatically set the radial depth-of-cut (WID-R) of the


ig

tool sequence in FCE MILL, TOP EMIL or STEP unit


yr

NOM - × E10
WID-R =
op

Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element 10


C

(Face milling, End milling-top, End Example :


milling-step)
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. APRCH-X APRCH-Y TYPE ZFD DEP-Z WID-R
E10
R1 FCE MILL 100A ? ? XBI  1. 19.


NOM- × E10
Program type M 10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9

2-108
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The amount of clearance that prevents interference of the chamfering


cutter with the bottom during chamfering

Axial interference clearance of chamfering


cutter

E11 E11

Interference depth Interferes. MPL030


Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 40

ts
The amount of clearance that prevents interference between the tool and

gh
the figure during face milling

ri
Example :

ll
Escape point Defined figure
Radial interference clearance of face milling

.A
unit and angular face milling unit

N
E12

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M Cutting


PO
30

start point
Conditions Immediate E12 E12
R

MPL031
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

Element used to set the tool path internal to the figure for end milling-top
ZA
Se

unit
A

Example :
IM

Tool path setting element for end milling-top


K

unit
ZA

Tool diameter × E13


E13 10
A
M

Tool diameter × E13


YA

10
Program type M Defined figure
3

MPL032
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 10%
(c

Setting range 1 to 9
ht

Element used to automatically set the radial depth-of-cut (WID-R) of the


ig

tool sequence in POCKET, PCKT MT or PCKT VLY unit


yr

NOM -× E14


WID-R =
op

Depth-of-cut-R automatic setting element 10


C

(Pocket milling, Pocket milling-mountain, Example :


Pocket milling-valley)
SNo. TOOL NOM- No. APRCH-X APRCH-Y TYPE ZFD DEP-Z WID-R
E14
R1 END MILL 20. ? ? CW G01 10. 12.

NOM -× E14
Program type M 10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9

2-109
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Element used to set the tool path external to the defined figure for
reciprocating-short machining with face milling unit
Example :
Tool path setting element for face
milling-top unit
Tool diameter × E15
(reciprocating short) 10
E15

Program type M
Tool diameter × E15

d .
Conditions Immediate 10

ve
Unit 10% Defined figure MPL033

s er
Setting range 1 to 9

re
Override value of the idle-cutting feed rate at which tool of end milling-

ts
mountain unit is to be moved around the outer form of the workpiece

gh
Note : Valid only when bit 0 of E91 is 1 and its bit 7 is 0.

ri
Example :
Peripheral-cutting feed rate override for end

ll
Defined figure

.A
milling-mountain unit

N
E16

O
E16
FR × 10

TI
FR
16

Program type M
A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit 10% MPL034


o.

O
N

Setting range 1 to 20
C
al

Override value of the feed rate at which the tool of a line- or


ri

ZA

face-machining unit (excluding face milling unit) is to be moved to the


Se

machining surface in an axial direction


A
IM

Note :
1. Valid only when ZFD (or AFD) of tool sequence is G01.
K

Axial-cutting feed rate override


2. Feed overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.
ZA

E17 Example :
A
M
YA
3

Program type M E17


01

FR × E9 SRV-Z
10
Conditions Immediate
)2

Machining
Unit 10%
(c

surface
MPL035
Setting range 0 to 9
ht
ig

Override value of feed rate when the pocket-machining radial depth-of-cut


yr

becomes equal to the tool diameter


op

Example :
C

Override in case of the overall width cutting FR × E18


10
for pocket-machining

E18

MPL036

Program type M Note :


Overriding for overall width cutting is not valid when this parameter is 0.
Conditions Immediate
[Applicable units]
Unit 10%
Rough-machining of POCKET, PCKT MT, PCKT VLY and STEP
Setting range 0 to 9

2-110
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Override value of tool returning feed rate in the rough-machining process


of the end milling-slot unit, when the bidirectional cutting is executed.
E19
FR × 100
Returning feed rate override in case of
bidirectional cutting for rough-machining of Note :
the end milling-slot unit.
The override value is invalid, when bit 5 of parameter E96 is set to OFF,
E19 or this parameter is set to 0.
[Applicable unit]
Returning path in rough-machining of SLOT
Program type M

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
Setting range 0 to 999

re
This parameter indicates the feed override value for axial pecking

ts
movement to the surface to be machined using a face-machining unit

gh
excepting a face milling unit.

ri
Axial cutting feed override during Z-axial E20

ll
Feed rate during pecking operation = FR × 10
cutting in the pecking mode of face

.A
machining

N
E20 Note :

O
TI
1. Valid only when G01 or a numeric value is set for ZFD (or AFD) and
16

A
[PECKING] is selected for TYPE in the tool sequence.
R
04

Program type M 2. The feed override function is invalid when “0” is assigned to this
PO
30

Conditions Immediate parameter.


R

Unit 10%
o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 40
C
al

The amount of overlap of the wall-cutting start and end areas in


ri

ZA

closed-pattern line- or face-machining


Se

Example :
IM

Defined closed pattern


Wall-cutting overlap in closed figure
K
ZA

E21
A
M

Escape point Cutting start


YA

E21 point
Program type M MPL037
3

[Applicable units]
01

Conditions Immediate
 LINE OUT, LINE IN, CHMF OUT and CHMF IN
)2

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


 Wall finishing of STEP, POCKET, PCKT MT, PCKT VLY and SLOT
(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

Override value of automatic corner overriding in line- or face-machining


ig

Example :
yr

FR × E22
op

10
Override value of automatic corner
C

over-riding FR
E22
MPL038
Note : Automatic corner overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.
Program type M
[Applicable units]
Conditions Immediate LINE RGT, LINE LFT, LINE OUT, LINE IN, STEP, POCKET, PCKT MT
Unit % and PCKT VLY

Setting range 0 to 99

2-111
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The range of removal allowances (upper and lower limits)


The automatic corner overriding becomes valid when the following line- or
face-machining conditions are met:

Effective removal allowance (upper limit) of Tool E24 Removal Tool E23
automatic corner overriding diameter × 100  allowance  diameter × 100

E23

Removal allowance
Program type M

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 1 to 99
MPL039

ts
gh
ri
ll
Effective removal allowance (lower limit) of Machining Removal allowance

.A
automatic corner overriding
Line-rough machining (SRV-R) – (FIN-R)

N
E24

O
Face-rough machining (WID-R)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
O
N

Setting range 1 to 99
al

The shape angle range (upper limit)


ri

ZA
Se

The automatic corner overriding becomes valid when the following line- or
A

face-machining conditions are met:


IM

Shape angle  E25


Effective angle (upper limit) of automatic
K

corner overriding Shape angle


ZA

E25
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate MPL040


01

Unit °
)2
(c

Setting range 1 to 179


ht

Axial feed rate calculation parameter for a line milling finish.


ig

Set the changing ratio of the axial feed rate with respect to the radial feed
yr

rate.
op

E26
Calculation coefficient for the finishing feed Axial feed rate = Radial feed rate × 100
C

of line milling
Tool
E26
Axial feed rate
Work-
Program type M Radial feed rate piece
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 999

2-112
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

These parameters, the roughness code, etc. determine the finishing feed
rate.

 If the radial-finishing feed rate is taken as F1, then:


Radial direction feed rate calculation
reference diameter for finish cutting in line D
E28 × × Kf × Z (D < E27 × )
machining unit F1 = E27 × 
E27 E28 × Kf × Z (D  E27 × )
D : Tool diameter
 : 0.1 (for metric specs.) or
Program type M 0.01 (for inch specs.)

d .
Kf : Roughness coefficient (Refer to the list below)

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Z : Number of teeth
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535 Roughness Roughness Roughness
Kf Kf Kf
code code code

ts
gh
 –3   3
K0 × 0.8 K0 K0 × 0.8

ri
1 4 7
  

ll
–2 4
Finishing feed rate calculation reference K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8

.A
2 5 8
feed rate in line machining unit
 –1  2  5
K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8 K0 × 0.8

N
3 6 9
E28

O
K0=Standard data 0.5

TI
16

Program type M
A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

0.001 mm/rev
o.

Unit
O

0.0001 in/rev
N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

ZA

Select whether the cutting conditions in the shape sequence during VFC
Se

mode are to be modified. The selection is valid only for milling.


A

0: Modification of the cutting conditions in the shape sequence


IM

Selection of whether the cutting conditions 1: No modification of the cutting conditions in the shape sequence
K

in the shape sequence during VFC mode


In the case of 0, only the cutting conditions in the tool sequence are
ZA

are to be modified modified. In the case of 1, both the cutting conditions in the tool sequence
E29
A

and the cutting conditions in the shape sequence are modified.


M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-113
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

An element that determines the starting point and escape point of radial
cutting when CLOSED is specified for the wall attributes at the starting
point and ending point of open-pattern line machining.
When OPEN is specified, E2 is used.

<CLOSED specified>

d .
ve
Radial clearance for wall attributes during

er
line machining E30 E30

s
E30

re
<OPEN specified>

ts
gh
E2 E2

ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

Element that determines the amount of OPEN attribute wall protrusion in


ri

ZA

pocket-machining shape units (POCKET, PCKT MT or PCKT VLY unit


Se

only)
IM

Protrusion Protrusion
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3

Element that determines the amount of


01

Protrusion
OPEN attribute wall protrusion for
)2

pocket-machining shape units


E31
(c

OPEN attribute wall


ht
ig
yr
op

CLOSED attribute wall


C

Tool dia. (Note) × E31


CLOSED attribute wall = 10
Note :
Nominal tool diameter in the tool sequence is used when tool data is
Program type M absent.
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9

2-114
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The approaching radius value to be used in the Z-direction helical


approach scheme for helical machining is automatically determined by the
parameter as follows:

Tool dia. × E32


Approaching radius = 100

 For helical approach (Helical circle 2 + 1/4)


Approaching radius
× (E33/100)

d .
ve
Element used for automatically determining
the approach radius in a Z-direction helical

er
approach Clearance Z

s
re
E32

ts
gh
Clearance Z

ri
+

ll
Cutting allowance Z

.A
N
O
TI
Approaching radius
16

A
R
04

[Related parameters]
PO

Program type M
30

Conditions After stop of movement E40, E41


R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 1 to 999


al

K
ri

ZA

The amount of in-feed per revolution in the Z-axis direction in a Z-direction


Se

helical approach is automatically determined using the parameter setting


A

as follows.
IM

Approaching radius × E33


Amount of in-feed in the Z-axis direction =
K

100
ZA
A

 For helical approach (Helical circle 2 + 1/4)


M
YA

Approaching radius
× (E33/100)
3

Element used for automatically determining


01

the amount of in-feed per revolution in the


)2

Z-axis direction in a Z-direction helical


Clearance Z
approach
(c

E33
ht
ig
yr

Clearance Z
op

+
Cutting allowance Z
C

Approaching radius

Program type M [Related parameters]


Conditions After stop of movement E40, E41
Unit %
Setting range 1 to 999

2-115
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The approaching distance value to be used in a Z-direction tapered


approach scheme for tapered machining is automatically determined by
the parameter as follows:

Tool dia. × E34


Approaching distance = 100
Element that automatically determines an
approaching distance in a Z-direction  For tapered approach (3 tapers)
tapered approach scheme
Approaching distance
E34 × (E35/100)

d .
ve
Clearance Z

ser
Clearance Z

re
+
Program type M Cutting allowance Z

ts
gh
Conditions After stop of movement

ri
Unit %
Approaching distance

ll
Setting range 1 to 999

.A
Approaching gradient value for a Z-direction tapered approach scheme

N
O
Distance in Z-direction

TI
Distance in XY-plane
16

A
R
04


PO

Approaching gradient for a Z-direction For tapered approach (3 tapers)


30

tapered approach scheme Approaching distance


R
o.

× (E35/100)
O

E35
N

C
al

Clearance Z
ri

ZA
Se

Clearance Z
A

+
IM

Program type M
Cutting allowance Z
Conditions After stop of movement
K
ZA

Unit %
Approaching distance
1 to 999
A

Setting range
M

The escape distance value to be used in the Z-direction tapered escape


YA

scheme after tapered machining is automatically determined by the


parameter as follows:
3
01

Element that automatically determines an


Tool dia. × E36
escape distance in the Z-direction tapered Escape distance =
)2

100
escape scheme
(c

E36
ht
ig
yr

Program type M Clearance Z


op

Conditions Immediate
C

Unit % Escape distance

Setting range 1 to 100

2-116
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

This parameter indicates the amount of return of pecking in the Z-axial


pecking mode of face machining.

Amount of return of pecking in the Z-axial


pecking mode of face machining

E37
E37

Program type M Pecking

.
E37

d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in MPL058

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the returning feed rate of the pecking in the Z-axial pecking mode

gh
during the face machining.

ri
[1] Feed rate
[1] Cutting (G1) F command

ll
Returning feed rate of pecking in the Z-axial

.A
[2] [2] Pecking (G1) E38
pecking mode of face machining [3]
[3] Cutting (G1) F command

N
O
E38

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO

Note : This value will be handled as100 if 0 is set here.


30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

0.01 mm/rev
O

Unit
N

0.001 in/rev
C
al

Setting range 0 to 9999


ri

ZA
Se

Set the element that automatically determines the depth-of-cut-R of tool


A

sequence in the pocket milling, pocket milling-mountain, pocket


IM

milling-valley and end milling-slot units.


Element that automatically determines the * This parameter is valid only when intelligent pocket milling (IPM)
K

depth-of-cut-R (Pocket milling, Pocket (CW/CCW) is selected for the tool sequence method.
ZA

milling-mountain, Pocket milling-valley, End


milling-slot)
A

E39 Depth-of-cut-R = NOM-  E39/100


M
YA
3

Program type M
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 1 to 100


ht
ig

The approach radius in Z-direction helical approach (helical 2 selected) is


yr

automatically determined using the parameter setting as follows.


op

Approaching radius = E40


C

Element used for automatically determining


the approach radius in a Z-direction helical
[Related parameters]
approach (helical 2)
E32, E33
E40

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 999

2-117
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The amount of in-feed per revolution in the Z-axis direction in a Z-direction


helical approach (helical 2 selected) is automatically determined using the
parameter setting as follows.
Element used for automatically determining Amount of in-feed in the Z-axis direction = E41
the amount of in-feed per revolution in the
Z-axis direction in a Z-direction helical
approach (helical 2) [Related parameters]
E41 E32, E33

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
Set the magnification factor of surface speed in helical approach.

gh
ri
Surface speed during helical approach = Surface speed in tool

ll
sequence  E43/100

.A
Magnification factor of surface speed in
helical approach * If a value outside the setting range is set, E43 = 100 is assumed.

N
O
E43

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 1 to 100


al

K
ri

ZA

Feed overriding for cutting a workpiece in an axial direction using a 3-D


Se

unit
A
IM

Example :
3-D
K

Axial cutting-feed overriding FR × E55 FR × E55


ZA

10 10
E55
A

E59
M
YA

Depth of cut
Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate High-speed rough processing Finish processing MPL041


)2

Unit 10% Note : Feed overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.


(c

Setting range 0 to 9
ht

This parameter is used to select whether or not an alarm message is to be


ig

displayed if the curved surface of a defined pattern points in the – Z


yr

direction (normally, processing becomes impossible).


op

0: No alarm
C

3-D 1: Alarm
Inversion check of curved-surface pattern
Example :
E56
The curved surface of a +Z
defined pattern points in
the – Z direction
Program type M
+X
Conditions Immediate MPL042
Unit — Note : This parameter is invalid during high-speed rough processing.
Setting range 0, 1

2-118
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

This parameter is used to select whether or not processing is to be


performed in strict accordance with the tool-sequence pitch data setting.
0: The pitch setting is not strictly observed.
1: The pitch setting is strictly observed.
3-D
Severity check of cutting pitch

E57

Note :
Program type M

d .
1. This parameter is invalid during high-speed rough processing.

ve
Conditions Immediate
2. The operation time becomes long if this parameter is set to 1.

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
This parameter is used to select whether or not 3-D tool-diameter

gh
compensation according to tool data is to be made for the curved surface
of a defined pattern

ri
0: Diameter compensation made

ll
3-D

.A
1: Diameter compensation not made
Tool-diameter compensation
Example :

N
Pattern Pattern
E58

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Diameter compensation Diameter compensation


Conditions Immediate made not made MPL043
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Element used to set the position in which the cutting feed in axial direction
Se

is to be started after the tool has been moved from the initial point toward
A

the workpiece at a rapid feed rate


IM

3-D Example :
K

Allowance of axial-cutting start position


ZA

E59
E59
A

Material height
M

E59
YA

Program type M Workpiece


3
01

Conditions Immediate Pattern


Normal-speed or high-speed
)2

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in rough processing Finish processing MPL044


(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

The 3-D finish processing (cutting) allowance in the direction of the normal
ig

with respect to the defined pattern of the curved surface


yr

Example :
op

E60
C

3-D
Normal cutting allowance
E60
E60

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in MPL045
Setting range 0 to 999

2-119
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The length of a short line segment which determines the next


approximation point for tool-path creation
Depending on the tool-sequence selected:
E61 is applicable for //-1 or //-2, or
3-D
E62 is applicable for -1 or -2
Search length for parallel cutting
This value will be handled as 0.1 mm (or 0.01 in) if 0 is set here.
E61

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
gh
ri
ll
3-D

.A
Search length for right-angle cutting

N
E62

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

The number of segments into which the defined pattern of a curved


ZA
Se

surface is to be divided for display of the curved-surface pattern on the


A

TOOL PATH CHECK display


IM

3-D Example :
K

Pattern display division segment


E64 E63
ZA

(FL direction)
E63
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit — GL or normal to FL
(c

Setting range 0 to 999 FL MPL046


ht

Note :
ig

This parameter is used for display of a curved-surface pattern, and thus


yr

the pattern displayed may slightly differ from the actual pattern of the
op

3-D curved surface to be machined.


C

Pattern display division segment


(GL direction)
E64

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999

2-120
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The allowance of cutting a workpiece along the wall of the area which has
been set using the area check function
Example :

3-D
Radial cutting allowance for area check

E65

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate E66

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
E66

re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
Pattern

gh
Min. E65 Max.

ri
E65

ll
3-D

.A
MPL047
Axial cutting allowance for area check

N
E66

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

The processing error tolerance with respect to a curved-surface pattern


ZA
Se

which corresponds to a #T setting (1 through 9) of the tool sequence


A
IM

#T 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

3-D Address E67 E68 E69 E70 E71 E72 E73 E74 E75
K

E67 Processing error tolerance


ZA

Example :
to
A
M

E75
YA

Program type M
3

Curved-surface
01

Conditions Immediate #T
pattern
)2

Unit 0.01 mm/0.001 in #T MPL048


(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

The override value which becomes valid in case that the depth-of-cut in a
ig

radial direction becomes equal to the entire width (diameter) of the tool
yr

Example :
op

3-D
C

Entire-width override

E76

Program type M
E76
Conditions Immediate Tool-sequence feed × MPL049
10
Unit 10% Note : Entire-width overriding is not valid when this parameter is 0.
Setting range 0 to 9

2-121
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The clearance of high-speed rough processing (workpiece size


appointment) between the tool and the figure
Workpiece
3-D
Radial cutting allowance for high-speed
rough processing (workpiece size
appointment)
E77

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Defined pattern

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in E77 E77 MPL050

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
0: 100%

gh
ri
ll
3-D

.A
Multiplying factor set for tolerance

N
E78

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 100


al

K
ri

ZA

That amount of offset from a curved-surface pattern which determines the


Se

region of high-speed rough processing (offset appointment) in a radial


A

direction
IM

3-D Region to be
Region of radial machining during machined
K

high-speed rough processing (offset


ZA

appoint-ment)
E83
A

Material height
M

Curved-surface
YA

pattern
Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in E83 MPL051


(c

Setting range 0 to 9999


ht

That distance from the bottom of a curved-surface pattern which


ig

determines the region of high-speed rough processing (offset


yr

appointment) in an axial direction


op

3-D Example :
C

Region of axial machining during


high-speed rough processing (offset Region to be machined
appoint-ment) Material height
E84

E84
Program type M
E83
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in Curved-surface pattern MPL052
Setting range 0 to 9999

2-122
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

The factor that determines the region of high-speed rough processing


(workpiece size appointment) in a radial direction

3-D
Region of radial machining during E88
high-speed rough processing: –X
(workpiece size appointment)
E85
E85 E86

Program type M Curved-surface

d .
pattern

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
+Y

re
Setting range 0 to 9999

ts
gh
E87
+X

ri
Region to be machined
3-D

ll
Region of radial machining during MPL053

.A
high-speed rough processing: +X

N
(workpiece size appointment)
E86

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


N

Setting range 0 to 9999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

3-D
Region of radial machining during
K

high-speed rough processing: –Y


ZA

(workpiece size appointment)


E87
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


(c

Setting range 0 to 9999


ht
ig
yr

3-D
op

Region of radial machining during


C

high-speed rough processing: +Y


(workpiece size appointment)
E88

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in
Setting range 0 to 9999

2-123
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

That distance from the bottom of a curved-surface pattern which


determines the region of high-speed rough processing (workpiece size
appointment) in an axial direction
Example :
3-D Region to be machined Curved-surface pattern
Region of axial machining during
high-speed rough processing Material
height
(workpiece size appointment)
E89
+Z

d .
E89

ve
er
+X
Program type M

s
re
Conditions Immediate E85 E86

ts
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

gh
MPL054
Setting range 0 to 9999

ri
ll
76543210

.A
0: Machining from inside to outside

N
1: Machining from outside to inside

O
0: Cutting direction inversed

TI
1: Cutting direction fixed
16

A 0: The R-point height is set always to E9.


R
04

1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when


PO
30

there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same unit,


R

respectively.
o.

O
N

0: The clearance on X-Y plane is set always to


C

E2.
al

1: The clearance on X-Y plane is set to E5 or E2


ri

ZA
Se

when there is or isn’t pre-machining in the


A

same unit, respectively.


IM

Tool-path pattern selection for end 1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
milling-mountain unit
K

0: Tool path based on inside shape


ZA

E91 1: Tool path based on outside shape


A
M

Note :
YA

1. If bit 0 = 0, tool path based on inside shape is selected


automatically, irrespective of value of bit 7.
3

2. If bit 0 = 1 and bit 7 = 0, fixed direction of cutting is selected


01

automatically, irrespective of value of bit 1.


)2

3. — 4 becomes valid only for two or more rounds of cutting.


(c

Bit 4 = 0 Bit 4 = 1
ht
ig

E9 Initial point
yr

E7
op
C

1st cutting
Program type M
2nd cutting
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
MPL055
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-124
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

76543210
0: Machining from inside to outside
1: Machining from outside to inside
Tool-path pattern selection for pocket 0: The R-point height is set always to E9.
milling unit 1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when
there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same unit,
E92 respectively.
0: The clearance on X-Y plane is set always to
E2.
Program type M 1: The clearance on X-Y plane is set to E5 or E2

d .
when there is or isn’t pre-machining in the

ve
Conditions Immediate
same unit, respectively.

er
Unit —
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9

s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits

ts
76543210

gh
ri
0: Machining from inside to outside
1: Machining from outside to inside

ll
.A
0: Cutting direction inversed
Tool-path pattern selection for pocket 1: Cutting direction fixed

N
O
milling-mountain unit
0: The R-point height is set always to E9.

TI
E93 1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when
16

A there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same unit,


R
04

respectively.
PO
30

0: The clearance on X-Y plane is set always to


R

E2.
o.

Program type M 1: The clearance on X-Y plane is set to E5 or E2


N

when there is or isn’t pre-machining in the


al

Conditions Immediate
K

same unit, respectively.


ri

ZA

Unit —
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
Se

Setting range Binary, eight digits


IM

76543210
K
ZA

0: Machining from inside to outside


1: Machining from outside to inside
A

0: Cutting direction inversed


M

1: Cutting direction fixed


YA

Tool-path pattern selection for pocket


milling-valley unit 0: The R-point height is set always to E9.
3

1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when


01

E94 there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same unit,


)2

respectively.
(c

0: The clearance on X-Y plane is set always to


E2.
ht

1: The clearance on X-Y plane is set to E5 or E2


ig

Program type M when there is or isn’t pre-machining in the


yr

Conditions Immediate same unit, respectively.


op

1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9


C

Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-125
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

76543210
In case of a collision in the line-machining
approach path:
0: Machining not aborted (conventional method)
1: Machining aborted
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:
0: Not via the approach point
1: Via the approach point
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:
0: Escape to the Z-axis initial point

d.
1: No escape on the Z-axis

ve
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9

er
1: Escape is set to a point where the tool comes

s
re
out of the removal allowance.
The R-point height for central, right hand, left

ts
hand, outside and inside linear machining is:

gh
0: Set always to E9

ri
1: Set to E7 or E9 when there is or isn’t

ll
pre-machining in the same unit, respectively.

.A
The X-Y plane clearance for outside and inside

N
linear machining is:

O
0: Set always to E2

TI
1: Set to E5 or E2 when there is or isn’t
16

A pre-machining in the same unit, respectively.


R
04

 Bit 2
PO
30

Bit 2 = 1 Bit 2 = 0
R
o.

Tool-path pattern selection for line


O

Initial point
N

machining unit
C
al

E95
K
ri

ZA
Se

1st removal allowance


A

2nd removal allowance


IM
K

Approach point Cutting start point MPL501


ZA

 Bit 3
A

Approach point Escape point


M
YA

Bit 3 = 0
Initial point
3
01
)2

1st removal allowance


(c

Bit 3 = 1 2nd removal allowance


ht

MPL502
ig
yr

 Bit 5
op

Bit 5 = 0 Bit 5 = 1
C

E2

Escape point E2
WID-R MPL503
Program type M Note :
Conditions Immediate 1. Bit 3 valid only for inside/outside line machining unit.
Unit — 2. When bit 3 is set to 1, “no escape on the Z-axis” is selected
Setting range Binary, eight digits regardless of bit 2 of parameter E104.

2-126
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

0: The R-point height is set always to E9.


1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when there is or isn’t
pre-machining in the same unit, respectively.

R-point height for end milling-slot unit


E96
(bit 1)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
For the 2nd and subsequent rounds of cutting:

gh
0: Not via the approach point

ri
1: Via the approach point

ll
Approach method selection for 2nd and

.A
subsequent rounds of cutting in end
milling-slot unit

N
E96

O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Rapid feed up to the cutting allowance + E9


Se

1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9


A
IM

Approach point for 2nd and subsequent


K

rounds of cutting in end milling-slot unit


ZA

E96
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Returning feed rate override of the end milling-slot unit disabled


ig

1: Returning feed rate override of the end milling-slot unit enabled


yr
op
C

Returning feed rate override of the end


milling-slot unit
E96
(bit 5)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-127
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Switching of restrictions according to the cutting edge angle of the


chamfering tool used for Smooth chamfering (end milling-slot)
0: Enables machining only when the cutting edge angle is 45° (Alarm if
Smooth chamfering (end milling-slot): the cutting angle edge is not 45°.)
Switching of restrictions according to the 1: Enables machining even when the cutting edge angle is not 45°.
cutting edge angle of the chamfering tool (Conventional scheme)
E96
(bit 7)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
76543210

gh
0: The R-point height is set always to E9

ri
1: The R-point height is set to E7 or E9 when

ll
Tool-path pattern selection for end there is or isn’t pre-machining in the same

.A
milling-top unit unit, respectively.

N
1: Rapid feed up to the intended surface + E9
E97

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

K
ri

ZA

76543210
Se

A
IM

1: The 1st cutting amount exceeds the


command value at end milling-mountain or
Cutting method selection for end
K

pocket valley-machining.
milling-mountain, pocket milling-valley unit
ZA

E98
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range Binary, eight digits


ht

Milling feed rate specification range for the shape sequence of the
ig

MAZATROL program
yr

0: Valid for roughing


op

Milling feed rate specification range for the 1: Valid for finishing
C

shape sequence of the MAZATROL


program
E99
(bit 0)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-128
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Bottom/wall simultaneous finishing mode for pocket machining


0: Sequential (Conventional scheme)
1: Simultaneous
Bottom/wall simultaneous finishing mode
for pocket machining
E99
(bit 1)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Interference check between the approach point and the cutting starting

gh
point of face machining

ri
0: Invalid
Interference check between the approach

ll
1: Valid

.A
point and the cutting starting point of face
machining

N
E99

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Set whether or not to display alarm 705 APPROACH POINT ERROR and
ri

ZA

stop operation when the amount of tool movement is 0 for the command in
Se

the last line of shape sequence in the right-hand/left-hand linear


IM

machining or right-hand/left-hand chamfering unit.


Alarm generating condition during the 0: Not set
K

approach or escape for line machining


1: Set
ZA

E99
(bit 4)
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Used to select the calculation method of the machining start point after
automatic determination of the approach point in line machining units.
ig
yr

0: Conventional scheme
op

Machining start point calculation method 1: Start machining near the automatically determined approach point
after automatic determination of approach
C

point in line machining unit


E99
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-129
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

0: Same operation before and after automatic determination


1: Operation by manual input after automatic determination

Cutting method to be used after an


approach point is automatically determined
during line/face machining
E104
(bit 0)

Program type M

.d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Tool retraction position after each cutting plunge in the Z-axis direction in

gh
the face machining unit

ri
0: R-point

ll
1: Initial point

.A
Approach point Escape point

N
Returning position during face machining.
E104 bit 1 = 1 Initial point

O
E104

TI
16

(bit 1) R-point
A E104 bit 1 = 0
(workpiece top face + E9)
R
04

PO
30

1st removal allowance


R
o.

Program type M 2nd removal allowance


O
N

Conditions Immediate
al

Unit —
ri

ZA
Se

Setting range 0, 1
A

Tool retraction position after each cutting plunge in the Z-axis direction in
IM

the line machining unit


K

0: R-point
ZA

1: Initial point
A

Approach point Escape point


M

E104 bit 2 = 1 Initial point


YA

Returning position during line machining.


3

E104 E104 bit 2 = 0 R-point


01

(bit 2) (workpiece top face + E9)


)2

1st removal allowance


(c

2nd removal allowance


ht
ig
yr

Program type M Note :


op

Conditions Immediate When bit 3 of parameter E95 is set to 1, “no escape on the Z-axis” is
C

selected.
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-130
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

0: Starting or ending point of shape + Tool radius + E30


1: Starting or ending point of shape

Selecting an infeed position when a


CLOSED attribute is assigned to the wall of
line machining
E104
(bit 3)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Select the method of connecting between shapes in line machining and

ts
wall finish of face machining.

gh
ri
E104 (bit 4) 0 1

ll
Method of connecting between shapes

.A
during line machining E105 (bit 5) 0 1 0 1

N
E104 Line machining
Linear Circular

O
(bit 4) (rough, finish)

TI
16

Face machining
A
(wall finish)
Linear Linear Circular
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate XY Circular


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Method of connecting between shapes Pattern Pattern


K

during wall finish of face machining


ZA

E104
(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: Calculation based on finishing surface (New scheme)


ht

1: Calculation based on the starting position of machining (MT Pro


ig

scheme)
yr
op

Calculation of ZC machining feed rate


C

E104
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-131
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Outputting of a tool change command when the next tool is the same tool.
0: Not output
1: Output

Tool change command output selection

E104
(bit 7)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Specifiable

gh
1: Not specifiable

ri
ll
Arbitrary B-axis angle during C-axis central

.A
line machining

N
E105

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Select the surface on which to describe a line machining shape with a


ZA
Se

Z-axis offset in the ZC mode.


A

0: Surface defined by SHIFT-R


IM

1: Surface defined by SHIFT-R + SRV-A


Machining shape specification method in
K

line machining in ZC mode/on C-axis


ZA

E105 Select the surface on which to describe a C-axis line machining of the
A

(bit 1) WPC workpiece scheme.


M

0: Surface defined by “Cylinder radius”


YA

1: Surface defined by “Cylinder radius” + “Allowance Z value”


Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Sets the operation when tool path generation using WID-R specified for
ig

pocket milling fails.


yr

0: Generating the alarm 709 CHECK DEPTH-R


op

Operation when tool path generation using 1: Generating a tool path using the tool radius
C

WID-R specified for pocket milling fails


E105 Note :
(bit 7) If this parameter is set to 1, the tool path is generated using the tool
radius instead of WID-R specified in the program, if tool generation
using WID-R fails, the machined shape does not conform to that
Program type M specified in the program.
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-132
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Select the operation to perform before moving to the TPC escape relay
point at the end of machining during line/face machining in a program of
initial-point scheme.
0: Initial point → TPC escape relay point
Selection of a relay point to be used before
TPC escapement (line/face machining unit) 1: R-point → TPC escape relay point
E106 * Valid only with the machines equipped with ATC-type turret and not
equipped with swiveling-type spindle head
(bit 1)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Display of a warning message when a corner radius is automatically

gh
inserted to a shape during intelligent pocket milling (IPM) path creation

ri
0: Not displayed
Display of a warning message when a

ll
corner radius is automatically inserted to a 1: Displayed

.A
shape during intelligent pocket milling (IPM)

N
E108 path creation

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Display of a warning message when an uncut residue remains due to nose


Se

R during intelligent pocket milling (IPM) path creation


A

0: Not displayed
IM

Display of a warning message when an 1: Displayed


K

uncut residue remains due to nose R during


ZA

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) path creation


E108
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Execution of a full-circle path movement after helical approach in


ig

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining


yr

0: Executed
op

Execution of a full-circle path movement 1: Not executed


C

after helical approach in intelligent pocket


milling (IPM) machining
E108
(bit 4)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-133
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

If two geometries are too close to each other and the tool cannot enter
while executing intelligent pocket milling (IPM);
0: Generates an alarm 706 ILLEGAL FIGURE DATA and continues
operation.
Operation on failure of tool entry during
intelligent pocket milling (IPM) 1: Generates an alarm 704 TOOL INTERFERENCE and stops operation.
E108
(bit 5)

Program type M

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
* Changing the setting of this parameter may change the path in

ll
Multiple approach point specification in intelligent pocket milling (IPM). When changing the parameter setting,

.A
intelligent pocket milling (IPM) carefully check for possible interference.

N
E108

O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Set the maximum difference in the radius between the start and end points
Se

of the circular arc path


A

The circular arc path is divided if this value is exceeded.


IM
K
ZA

Allowable limits of engage angle in


Increased
A

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining


engage angle
M

E109
YA
3
01
)2

Engage angle
(c

Program type M specified by


depth-of-cut-R
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

Unit %
yr

Setting range 0 to 99999


op
C

2-134
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Set the maximum radius of an arc to be inserted for intelligent pocket


milling (IPM) machining.

Maximum radius of arc inserted for E110


intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining

E110

d .
ve
er
s
re
Program type M E110

ts
Conditions Immediate

gh
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

ri
Setting range 0 to 99999

ll
.A
This determines the following conditions in intelligent pocket milling (IPM)
machining (Pocket milling-valley)

N
O
 Maximum amount of tool protrusion in valley-shape machining

TI
Element that determines the tool paths in  Amount of clearance in approaching into valley shape
16

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining



A
Ignoring the valley shape where a shape diminishes when the path is
R
04

(Pocket milling-valley)
offset inward by “E111 + Tool radius”
PO

E111
30

R
o.

O
N

Program type M
al

K
ri

ZA

Conditions Immediate
Se

Unit %
IM

Setting range 1 to 100


K

Set the maximum distance to avoid the wall in intelligent pocket milling
ZA

(IPM) machining.
In intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining, when a tool passes the wall
A
M

already machined again, tool movement to avoid the wall is performed


Maximum wall avoidance distance in using the set distance as the maximum avoidance distance.
YA

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining


3

E112
01
)2
(c

Program type M
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig
yr

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


op

Setting range 0 to 99999


C

2-135
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

In intelligent pocket milling (IPM), when a tool passes the


already-machined bottom face again, tool movement to avoid the bottom
face is implemented using the set distance as the avoidance distance.
Bottom face avoidance distance/clearance During helical approach for plane machining in end milling-mountain,
for recovering surface speed in plane pocket milling, pocket milling-mountain, and pocket milling-valley units, the
machining tool moves the set distance away from the hole bottom and changes its
E113 surface speed after the helical approach to the hole bottom. (*)

* This parameter is valid when E141 bit 5 = 0 and E43 > 0.


Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999

ts
Set the magnification factor of the minimum arc of trochoid cycle in

gh
intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining.

ri
ll
Magnification factor of the minimum arc of

.A
trochoid cycle in intelligent pocket milling
(IPM) machining

N
E115

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 5 to 50
al

K
ri

ZA

Set the feedrate override value to be applied during bottom face


Se

avoidance operation.
A

If “0” is set, the feedrate set in tool sequence is used.


IM

Feedrate override for non-cutting feed in


K

intelligent pocket milling (IPM) machining


ZA

E116
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

Set the amount of overlapping for expanding the groove width in the end
ig

milling-slot unit.
yr
op
C

Amount of overlapping in groove expanding


operation in the end milling-slot unit

E129

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 10%
Setting range 0 to 9

2-136
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

This is the element used for automatically determining the depth-of-cut R


in the tool sequence in the line machining unit.
(The set value is invalid for the LINE CTR unit.)

Element that automatically determines


depth-of-cut-R (line machining)

E131

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 10%

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9

ts
Sets the radial interference clearance during approach/retraction for the

gh
round bar face milling unit.

ri
ll
Example : Reciprocating milling in the Y-axis direction with wall

.A
N
O
E132
Radial interference clearance of round bar

TI
face milling unit
16

A
R
E132
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA

Program type M
Se

E132 Wall
A

Conditions Immediate
IM

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


K

Setting range 0 to 999


ZA

When a helical approach is set, the tool changes its surface speed to the
A

value set in the tool sequence after moving the distance set for parameter
M

E133 away from the hole bottom.


YA

Surface speed change position in helical


3

approach * This parameter is valid when E141 bit 5 = 1


01
)2

E133
(c
ht
ig

Program type M
yr

Conditions Immediate
op

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


C

Setting range 0 to 999

2-137
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

Sets the clearance from the machining face when carrying out the
machining for an engraving unit in a MAZATROL program.

Clearance in the tool axial direction in E134


engraving units
Machining
E134 face
Depth
Hole
bottom
Program type M

d .
Workpiece

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in

s
Setting range 0 to 999

re
ts
0: Start machining near the starting point of the shape

gh
1: Determine the starting point based on the quadrant near the approach
point

ri
Face milling-/end milling-top unit

ll
.A
Cutting start point determination method at
manual approach point setting
E141

N
O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Surface speed change mode in helical approach


ZA
Se

0: After the helical approach to the hole bottom, the tool moves the
A

distance set for E113 away from the hole bottom and changes its
IM

surface speed.
Surface speed change mode selection in
K

helical approach 1: After the helical approach to a position the distance set for E133 away
ZA

from the hole position, the tool changes its surface speed at that
E141
position.
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Calculate from E1 and E2 using FIN-R as the reference.


ig

1: Calculate from E1 and E2 using SRV-R as the reference.


yr
op

Selection of calculation formula for


automatic determination of approach point
C

in finishing on a line machining unit when


E141 finishing allowance - Z = 0
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-138
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title LINE/FACE/3D

Address Meaning Description

0: Continue machining with no alarm


1: Generating alarm 702 FIGURE DEFINITION ERROR

Operation upon specifying a figure of eight


for free closed pattern of line/face
machining unit
E141
(bit 7)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Cylindrical surface machining method in initial-point scheme C-axis LINE

gh
RGT, C-axis LINE LFT, C-axis CHMF RGT, and C-axis CHMF LFT units.

ri
0: Machine the side opposite the specified side with respect to the

ll
Cylindrical surface machining method in direction of travel

.A
initial-point scheme C-axis line machining 1: Machine the specified side with respect to the direction of travel
unit

N
E142

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-139
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-4 User parameter EIA/ISO (F)

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

When (L74/L75) × (F1/100) is assigned as the allowable acceleration


attained before corner deceleration is started, the theoretical value Vo of
the corner deceleration in G61.1 will be changed to the following Vo’
value:
G61.1 corner deceleration coefficient (%)
Vo’ = Vo × F1/100

F1

.
Note :

d
ve
The assigned value is invalid if minus. If 0 is assigned, the deceleration

er
Program type M, E coefficient will be regarded as 100, or if more than 500 is assigned, the

s
Conditions Immediate deceleration coefficient will be regarded as 500.

re
Unit %

ts
gh
Setting range 0 to 500

ri
When (L74/L75) × (F2/100) is assigned as the allowable acceleration
attained before arc radius speed clamping is started, the theoretical value

ll
.A
Vc of the arc radius clamping speed in G61.1 will be changed to the
following Vc’ value:

N
O
G61.1 arc-clamping speed coefficient (%)

TI
Vc’ = Vc × (F2/100)
16

F2
A
R
04

PO

Note :
30

The assigned value is invalid if minus. If 0 is assigned, the deceleration


R

Program type M, E
o.

coefficient will be regarded as 100, or if more than 500 is assigned, the


O
N

deceleration coefficient will be regarded as 500.


C

Conditions Immediate
al

Unit %
ri

ZA

Setting range 0 to 500


Se

0: High-speed smoothing control invalid


IM

1: High-speed smoothing control valid


K

(No deceleration at very slightly stepped sections)


ZA

3: High-speed smoothing control valid


High-speed smoothing control (Deceleration at very slightly stepped sections)
A
M
YA

F3
3
01

Program type E
)2

Conditions After stop of movement


(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1, 3
ig
yr
op
C

2-140
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set the distance, succeeding and preceding the point to be modified, to


judge the shape formed by the 3 axes under tool tip point control in the
5-axis fairing function
Note : When 0 is set, the distance is regarded as 1 mm/0.04 in.

Distance to judge the shape formed by 3 Example : When the setting is F4 = 5000 [0.5 mm (0.02 in)]
axes under tool tip point control in the 5-axis
fairing function
Point to be modified
F4 0.15 mm (0.006 in) 0.1 mm (0.004 in)

.
0.15 mm (0.006 in) 0.15 mm (0.006 in)

d
0.2 mm (0.01 in)

ve
0.2 mm (0.01 in)

er
Succeeding Preceding 0.2 mm (0.01 in)

s
distance distance

re
Z 0.5 mm 0.5 mm
Program type E
Y (0.02 in) (0.02 in)

ts
Conditions Immediate

gh
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in X

ri
Setting range 0 to 999999

ll
.A
Set the distance, succeeding and preceding the point to be modified, to
judge the shape formed by the rotary 2 axes in the 5-axis fairing function

N
O
Note : When 0 is set, the distance is regarded as 1°.

TI
Distance to judge the shape formed by
16

rotary 2 axes in the 5-axis fairing function


A
R
04

PO
30

F5
R
o.

O
N

Program type E
al

Conditions Immediate
ri

ZA
Se

Unit 0.0001°
A

Setting range 0 to 899999


IM

Specify the minimum height of stepped sections at which the axis feed is
K

not to be decelerated in high-speed smoothing control mode.


ZA
A

Minimum allowable height of stepped


M

sections for deceleration in high-speed


YA

smoothing control mode


3

F6
01
)2
(c

Program type E
ht

Conditions After stop of movement


ig

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


yr

Setting range 0 to 100


op
C

2-141
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)

F7

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Corner deceleration speed Vo determined by the optimal corner

gh
deceleration function is adjusted using the value set in this parameter.

ri
F8
Vo = Vo × 100

ll
.A
Corner deceleration speed coefficient for
The speed is not adjusted if 0 is set here. (Setting is handled as 100.)
high-speed smoothing control

N
Setting more than 2000 is disposed as 2000.

O
F8

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 2000


al

K
ri

ZA

Circular cutting clamp speed Vc is adjusted using the value set in this
Se

parameter.
A
IM

F9
Vc = Vc × 100
Circular cutting clamp speed coefficient for
K

high-speed smoothing control The speed is not adjusted if 0 is set here. (Setting is handled as 100.)
ZA

Setting more than 500 is disposed as 500.


A

F9
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 500


ht

Return amount of pecking in the tool path of tap high-speed deep-hole


ig

cycle
yr
op
C

Return amount during tap high-speed


deep-hole cycle

F10 F10

Pecking
Program type M, E F10
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-142
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

(I, J, K) I d
Machining x = x0 + ×
d F11 2
pattern
Vector J d
y = y0 + ×
Vector constant for 3-D tool-diameter normal F11 2
compensation to face K d
z = z0 + ×
F11 2
F11
Coordinates of
Coordinates of tool center
program (x0, y0, z0) (x, y, z) MPL057
Program type —

. d
Conditions Next block

ve
F11 = I2+J2+K2 if this parameter is 0.

er
0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Unit
(0.001°)

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Return amount of pecking in drill high-speed deep-hole cycle or in G73

gh
tool path

ri
ll
.A
Return amount of pecking in drill
high-speed deep-hole cycle or in G73

N
O
F12

TI
F12
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E Pecking


F12
R

Conditions Next block


o.

O
N

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


C

MPL058
al

Setting range 0 to 99999999


K
ri

ZA

The allowance amount provided for the tool to stop moving at rapid-feed
Se

just in front of the preceding hole during a deep-hole drilling cycle or


A
IM

during G83/G283 tool path


K

Allowance amount of rapid-feed stop in


ZA

deep-hole drilling cycle or in G83/G283


A

F13
M
YA

F13
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions Next block F13


)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in MPL059


(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

Rotation center of coordinates (axis of


abscissa)

F14

Program type —
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-143
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Rotation center of coordinates (axis of


ordinate)
F15

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

ts
Vector of coordinate rotation (axis of abscissa)

gh
ri
ll
.A
Horizontal length of coordinate rotation

N
F16

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

Vector of coordinate rotation (axis of ordinate)


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Vertical length of coordinate rotation


K
ZA

F17
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


(c
ht

Angle of coordinate rotation


ig
yr
op

Angle of coordinate rotation


C

F18

Program type —
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001°
Setting range 0 to ±180000

2-144
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Maximum radius difference that causes spiral interpolation to be


performed when the arc-drawing start point and end point radii that have
been specified in the arc command do not agree.

Specified end point R  F19: Spiral interpolation


Maximum permissible difference in arc R > F19: Alarm
radius
F19
R End point
according to
start point
Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Next block Center

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Start point MPL060

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999

ts
That fixed value of the scaling factor which becomes valid in the case that

gh
no value is set (using the address P) in the same block as that of G51.
b

ri
Scaling factor =
Machining a

ll
pattern

.A
Fixed value of scaling factor
b

N
F20

O
a

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Next command Program pattern


Scaling center MPL061
R
o.

Unit 1/1000000
O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

The automatic corner override using the G62 code becomes valid when
ri

ZA

the following condition of the shape angle is met:


Se

Shape angle  F21


IM

Maximum inside-corner angle available with Pattern angle


K

automatic corner override (G62)


ZA

F21
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Next command


01

Overriding occurs here. MPL062


Unit °
)2

Setting range 0 to 179


(c
ht

The area in which automatic corner overriding using the G62 code occurs
ig
yr

F22
op

Deceleration area of automatic corner


overriding (G62)
C

F22

Program type E
Conditions Next command
Overriding occurs here. MPL063
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit
(0.0001°)
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-145
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Only the last G92SsQqRr command is enabled.


1: All the G92SsQqRr commands are enabled.
2 to 8: Not used.
Handling of G92 (spindle speed clamp 9: The spindle speed clamp value is invalid at restart.
value) command at restart

F27

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9

ts
Set chamfering angle at thread portion in thread cutting cycle.

gh
G276 and G292 are used for thread cutting cycle, if F30 is set to 0.
G76 and G92 are used for thread cutting cycle, if F30 is set to 1.

ri
ll
.A
Threading chamfering angle
F28

N
F28

O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E Chamfering data NM211-00219


30

Note : Set 45 or 60.


R

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit °
C
al

Setting range 45, 60


K
ri

ZA

The override value of automatic corner overriding using the G62 code
Se

A
IM

F29
F× Specified feed rate F
100
Override value of automatic corner
K
ZA

overriding (G62)

F29
A
M
YA

MPL064

Program type E Note :


3
01

The automatic corner overriding is invalid when this parameter is 0.


Conditions Next command
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 100


ht

Select a G-code type.


ig

0: G-code series for machining centers


yr
op

1: G-code series for turning machines


C

Settings other than the above are all handled as 0.


G-code type selection

F30 Note :
Do not disturb the default setting. It is a fixed value for your machine
model.
Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit Decimal number
Setting range 0, 1

2-146
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Select a roughing priority type for program layout (Rearrangement of


milling tool sequence).

0: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that


order
1: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that
order
Further rearranging each tool with priority given to the same tool (with
roughing/finishing tool distinction)
2: Milling to be excluded from tool rearrangement.
Select a roughing priority type for program

.
layout 3: Rearranging each tool with priority given to the same tool (with

d
ve
roughing/finishing tool distinction)
F31

er
4: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that
order

s
re
Further rearranging normal tools in the order of spot drilling  drilling 
end milling  chamfering  boring  reaming  back spot facing 

ts
back boring  tapping

gh
5: Rearranging a roughing tool, a normal tool, and a finishing tool, in that

ri
order

ll
Further rearranging normal tools in the order of spot drilling  drilling 

.A
end milling  chamfering  boring  reaming  back spot facing 
Program type M

N
back boring  tapping

O
Conditions After stop of movement In addition, for the manual programming unit, assigning priority

TI
Unit Decimal number numbers, judged from the tools to be used
16

A
R
04

Setting range 0 to 5
PO
30

Select operation when argument R is omitted from the maximum/minimum


spindle speed setting.
R
o.

O
N

0: Alarm
C

Operation when argument R is omitted from 1: Handled as R1


al

the maximum/minimum spindle speed


ri

ZA

setting
Se

F32
IM
K
ZA

Program type E
A

Conditions Immediate
M

Unit —
YA

Setting range 0, 1
3

Select whether to make the incorporation of the tool length into


01

current-position counter Z valid when tool length correction is in a


)2

canceled status, irrespective of whether the program selected on the


POSITION display is EIA/ISO or MAZATROL.
(c

Incorporation of the MAZATROL tool length


ht

into the current position counter 0: Valid


ig

F33 1: Invalid
yr

(bit 0)
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-147
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Tool management function


F33
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Check during automatic operation

gh
1: Do not check during automatic operation

ri
* When “Do not check during automatic operation” is selected, data that

ll
Selection of check in the course of cannot be altered in the course of automatic operation can be altered via

.A
automatic operation when data is network.
input/output through network

N
F33

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Method of selecting the restart position in the MAZATROL program


Se

0: Selection from program layout


IM

1: By setting [WNo./UNo./SNo REPEAT]


Selection of restart setting method in the
K

MAZATROL program
ZA

F33
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: The indication at the selection of the fixed cycle remains as it is


ig

throughout the cycle. (No updating)


yr

1: The indication changes to show the actual modal condition of the cycle
op

operation.
C

Modal indication of modal group 1 in the


fixed cycle mode
F33
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-148
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: The indication at the G68.5 mode selection remains as it is.


1: G122.1 (radius data input for X-axis ON) is indicated during the G68.5
mode.
Modal indication on "radius data input for
“X-axis” in the mode of 3D coordinate
conversion (G68.5)
F33
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid (G52.1 hold)

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
Cancellation of the ram spindle offset

.A
command (G52.1) when the RESET key is
pressed, valid/invalid

N
F34

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

The data number and value for tool length offset on the POSITION display
Se

upon execution of a G49 (Tool length offset OFF) command


A
IM

0: Not changed at all


Representation on the POSITION display 1: Reset to zero (0)
K

by the G49 command


ZA

F34
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

To manually override the parts count (current number of machined


ig

workpieces) in the middle of automatic operation


yr
op

0: Impossible (The operation caused by the ATC and RETURN settings in


the end unit occurs with respect to the parts count.)
C

Parts count override in the course of


automatic operation 1: Possible (The operation caused by the ATC and RETURN settings in
F34 the end unit occurs irrespectively of the parts count.)
(bit 2)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-149
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Type A (5-axis machining available)


1: Type B (MPro compatible)

Programming type for inclined-surface


machining
F34
(bit 4)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: No compensating movement on an unspecified axis till completion of

gh
the specified movement

ri
1: Simultaneous compensating movement on all the axes including un-
specified one, on condition that the tool number is not changed

ll
.A
Compensating movement for a T-code with
* Bit 6 of F34 is valid only when G-code series T (Turning machines) is
a movement command in one block

N
selected and F161 bit 2 is set to 1.
F34

O
TI
(bit 6)
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
K
ri

ZA

0: Application of the Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values prepared for the


Se

program that is currently selected from the STANDARD PROGRAM


A

storage area for the automatic operation


IM

1: No application of the Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET values prepared on


K

Application of Z-OFFSET and C-OFFSET the SETUP INFORMATION display


ZA

values for the tape operation mode


F34
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether or not multiple material pieces can be arranged on the


ig

VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display.


yr
op

0: Arrangement of a single piece


Multiple material pieces arrangement on the
C

1: Arrangement of multiple pieces


VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR
display
F35
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-150
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Automatic setting of the material model for a MAZATROL program of


initial-point scheme on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR
display.
Automatic setting of the material model for
a MAZATROL program of initial-point 0: Valid
scheme on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 1: Invalid
F35 3D MONITOR display
(bit 1)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Machine status when assigning G-code for a cutting function not to be

gh
represented with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being selected for
automatic operation.

ri
Machine status when assigning G-code for

ll
a cutting function not to be represented with 0: Continuing the operation by canceling the interference check function

.A
the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being for material model
F35

N
selected for automatic operation 1: Alarm stop

O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Machine status when a program prepared and stored for the Hard Disk
ri

ZA

operation is called up as a subprogram with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY


Se

SHIELD being selected for automatic operation.


Machine status when a program prepared
IM

and stored for the Hard Disk operation is 0: Continuing the operation by canceling the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
called up as a subprogram with the SHIELD for automatic operation
K

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being 1: Alarm stop


ZA

F35
selected for automatic operation
A

(bit 3)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

[Related parameters]
Unit —
)2

F37 bit 5
Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Representation of cutting-off or parting operation on the VIRTUAL


MACHINING and 3D MONITOR displays
ig
yr

0: No representation
op

Taking off a material model’s part on the (Cut-off part remains shown in its original place and undergoes the
VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D MONITOR
C

interference check.)
displays
F35 1: Representation
(bit 4) (Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-151
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Select whether or not it is to be indicated by an alarm message that the


feed-overriding value has been changed in the flow of automatic operation
with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being active.
Alarming for a change of feed-overriding
value with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY 0: Alarming
SHIELD being active for automatic 1: No alarming
F35 operation
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
M-code displayed as search results in EIA/ISO program modal restarting

gh
mode

ri
0: Do not set automatically

ll
Automatic M-code setting in EIA/ISO 1: Set automatically (up to six M-codes preceding immediately)

.A
program modal restarting mode

N
F36

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

S-code displayed as search results in EIA/ISO program modal restarting


ZA
Se

mode
A

0: Do not set automatically


IM

Automatic S-code setting in EIA/ISO 1: Set automatically (immediately preceding S-code)


K

program modal restarting mode


ZA

F36
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Invalid
ig

1: Valid
yr

Example :
op

Error check function in cases where If numerical data is omitted, such as “G90G0X”, alarm 807 ILLEGAL
C

numerical data is omitted in the EIA


FORMAT is displayed.
program or in MDI mode
F36
(bit 3)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-152
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Whether or not the chuck and tailstock areas are to be displayed for an
EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK display

0: Not displayed
Display of the chuck and tailstock areas for
1: Displayed
an EIA/ISO program on the TRACE or
TOOL PATH CHECK display
F36
(bit 4)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
gh
System Command Minimum Maximum

ri
F36 bit 6
Number of effective decimal digits in the of units unit value value

ll
tool axis vector components (I, J, K) for tool

.A
mm 0.0001 –99999.9999 99999.9999
tip point control type 2 (G43.5) and cutting 0
F36

N
point command type 2 (G43.9) in 0.00001 –9999.99999 9999.99999

O
(bit 6) mm 0.0000001 –99.9999999 99.9999999

TI
1
16

A in 0.0000001 –99.9999999 99.9999999


R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Invalid
ri

ZA
Se

1: Valid
A
IM

Rotational axis prefiltering


K
ZA

F36
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

For turning machines only: Alarming for a subprogram call command


given in a manual program (MANL PRG) unit
ig
yr

0: No alarming
op

Subprogram call given in manual program 1: Alarming


C

unit (for turning machines only)


F37
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-153
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Z-axis movement immediately after ATC during MDI operation when the
MAZATROL tool length is valid (bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to 1)

0: Perform tool length compensation.


1: Do not perform tool length compensation.
Tool length compensation in MDI operation
F37
(bit 2)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select the timing of clearing the message that is displayed at #3006

gh
(stop).

ri
0: At the end of automatic operation

ll
1: At the execution of the next block

.A
Timing of clearing #3006 (stop) message

N
F37

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Used to select operation when running programs in the hard disk or


Se

through Ethernet with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD enabled for


A

automatic operation.
IM

Operation when running programs in the 0: Continue operation


hard disk or through Ethernet with the
K

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD enabled 1: Depend on the setting of bit 3 of parameter F35
ZA

F37 for automatic operation


A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
[Related parameters]
)2

Unit —
F35 bit 3
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Set the operation pattern when “ATC” is not set in end unit
ig
yr

0: Same operation as when “1” is set for “ATC”


op

(The tool is returned and the axes move to the returning position.)
Operation when “ATC” is not specified in
C

1: Same operation as when “0” is set for “ATC”


end unit (The tool is not returned.)
F37
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-154
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Options displayed in the tool model type selection window are limited
according to the selected tool type (milling tool or turning tool).

0: Not set
Options displayed in the tool model type 1: Set
selection window according to the tool type
F38
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Tool index number and that of the tool to change when [TOOLDATA

gh
MOVE] is selected on the TOOL DATA display for machining centers
(without multiple tool data registration specifications)

ri
ll
Handling of tool index numbers (after tool 0: Exchange

.A
data exchange) 1: Do not exchange

N
F38

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Large
Se

1: Small
A
IM

Font size setting for EIA/ISO program


K

display and EIA MONITOR display


ZA

F38
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions At power back on


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Negative tool diameter setting in tool data


ig

0: Impossible
yr

If a negative value is input, alarm 402 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT


op

occurs.
C

Negative tool diameter setting 1: Possible


F38
(bit 4) * When this parameter is set to “1”, alarm 654 TOOL DATA ERROR will
occur if a tool to which a negative tool diameter is input is used in the
MAZATROL program.
Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-155
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Displayed
1: Not displayed

Reverse pattern display/hidden for milling * This parameter is valid when bit 6 of parameter K102 is set to 1 (milling
tool rotation direction tool rotational direction setting enabled).
F38
(bit 5)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Default setting of the modal plane selection G-code to be used for an
EIA/ISO program (called by a subprogram unit) and a manual program

gh
unit.

ri
Plane to be used for an EIA/ISO program

ll
0: G17

.A
(called by a subprogram unit) and a manual 1: G18
program unit 2: G19

N
F39

O
Settings other than the above are all handled as 0.

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0 to 2
al

0: Tape operation
ri

ZA

1: Hard disc operation


Se

3: Ethernet operation
A
IM

Operating method selection in tape mode * Do not set value “2”.


K
ZA

F40
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1, 3
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-156
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set a threading termination waiting time.


F41 = 0
No waiting time
F41 = 1 to 255
Setting × 1.7 ms

X-axis
F41 < F41’ < F41”
Threading termination waiting time
processing Incomplete thread Complete thread

d .
F41

ve
F41

er
F41’

s
re
F41”
Z-axis

ts
Gradual deceleration Uniform feed

gh
on the Z-axis

ri
Note :

ll
An excessively high setting may cause the thread of the run-out section

.A
Program type M
to be destroyed.
Conditions Immediate

N
O
Unit 1.7 ms

TI
Setting range 0 to 255
16

A
R
04

Distance (r) between the starting point of movement at measuring speed


PO

and the measuring point


30

This data is used when argument R is omitted in G37 command format.


R
o.

O
N

Deceleration area r during Z-axis G37 Z_ Rr D_ F_;


C

measurement
al

(G37)
K
ri

ZA

F42
Se

A
IM

Program type E
K

Conditions After stop of movement


ZA

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


A
M

Setting range 0 to 99999999


YA

Range (d) where the tool should stop


This data is used when argument D is omitted in G37 command format.
3
01

G37 Z_ R_ Dd F_;
)2

Measurement area d during Z-axis


(G37)
(c

measurement
ht

F43
ig
yr
op

Program type E
C

Conditions After stop of movement


Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-157
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Measuring speed (f)


This data is used when argument F is omitted in G37 command format.

G37 Z_ R_ D_ Ff;
Measuring speed f (G37)

F44

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit mm/min/0.1 in/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 120000

ts
The name of the variable specified by the user macro SETVN is displayed

gh
(Name display only. No setting is possible on the PARAMETER display.)

ri
F47: Name of #500

ll
 

.A
Common variable name
F47 F66: Name of #519

N
to

O
F66
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range —
al

0: L74/L75
ri

ZA
Se

1: With modal G00, all the axes are accelerated/decelerated at the


A

smaller of the rates for the axes set for parameters M1/N1.
IM

With modal G01, all the axes are accelerated/decelerated at the


G53.1 acceleration selection during smaller rate between those for the axes set for parameters M3/N2.
K

pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration
ZA

F68 Note :
A

(bit 0) When F68 bit 0 = 1, the composite acceleration/deceleration speed for


M

G53.1 changes if either of the following conditions is satisfied.


YA

 G61.1 command
3

Program type E
 G61.2 command
01

Conditions Immediate
 G64 command (only for modal G00 while constant G00 inclination
)2

Unit — control is enabled)


(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig

When executing 1-point measurement at manual measurement display


yr

on the setup screen, after presetting the current position on the


POSITION screen, reflect the preset values in the current position display
op

Current position counter indication upon turning on of the touch sensor.


C

selection at 1-point measurement for 0: Invalid


manual measurement display on the setup
F68 screen 1: Valid

(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-158
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Addition of tool position offset to the current position


0: Added
1: Not added
Addition of tool position offset to the current
position, enabled/disabled
F68
(bit 4)

Program type E

.d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
This parameter is used to select the method of specifying the EIA/ISO

gh
program restarting position. Two methods are available:

ri
0: The whole program, including the subprograms, is subjected to this
processing. Set the sequence number, block number and number

ll
.A
EIA/ISO program restart method of times of repetition as searched from the beginning part of the
main program.

N
F69 1: The subprogram including the desired restart position can be

O
specified. After setting the work number of the corresponding

TI
16

program, set the sequence number, block number, and number of


A
times of repetition as searched from the beginning part.
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

When the EIA/ISO program is called up as a subprogram, this parameter


ri

ZA
Se

is used to validate/invalidate multiple-machining and the specified number


A

of times to restart the program.


IM

Availability of multiple-machining and 0: Multiple-machining is ineffective for the EIA/ISO subprogram.


designated number of repetitions in the Specified number of times to restart the EIA/ISO subprogram is
K

EIA/ISO subprogram effective.


ZA

F70 1: Multiple-machining is effective for the EIA/ISO subprogram.


A

Specified number of times to restart the EIA/ISO subprogram is


M

ineffective.
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Tool priority and multiple-machining priority selection


ig

0: Identical-tool priority function is executed first.


yr

1: Multiple-machining function is executed first.


op

Example : Multiple-machining of two workpieces using a spot drill


C

Machining order control F71 = 0 F71 = 1

F71

Program type M
MPL065
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-159
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

To select whether the shape correction function of the MAZATROL


program is always effective or ineffective.
0: Invalid
1: Shape correction function valid
Selection of the shape correction function of
the MAZATROL program

F72

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time an

ts
M-code is output.

gh
ri
ll
.A
M-code execution time for time study

N
F73

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.01 s
O
N

Setting range 0 to 10000


al

The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time an
ri

ZA

S-code is output.
Se

A
IM

S-code execution time for time study


K
ZA

F74
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.01 s
)2

Setting range 0 to 10000


(c

The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time a
ht

T-code is output.
ig
yr
op

T-code execution time for time study


C

F75

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.01 s
Setting range 0 to 10000

2-160
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

The tool-path check time study time that is accumulated each time a
B-code is output.

B-code execution time for time study

F76

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.01 s

s
re
Setting range 0 to 10000

ts
The basis rate for the NC to judge whether the tool is to be displayed in

gh
reverse display mode on the TOOL DATA display to indicate that the life
of that tool is approaching expiry.

ri
If bit 2 in F82 is 0:

ll
.A
Basis rate for tool life judgment When the rate of the operation time to the estimated life exceeds the
setting of the F77 parameter, the NC will judge the tool to be approaching

N
expiry.
F77

O
TI
If bit 2 in F82 is 1:
16

When the residual life decreases below the setting of the F77 parameter,
A
the NC will judge the tool to be approaching expiry.
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R

Note :
o.

Unit %, min The above judgment function is invalid if this parameter is set to 0.
N

Setting range 0 to 9999


al

K
ri

ZA

Selection of separation ratio between side view and front view (or rear
Se

view) when two split plane indication mode has been selected.
A

F78 = 0 .......................1:1
IM

F78 = 1 .......................2:1
Selection of separating ratio of graphic F78 = 2 .......................5:1
K

display
ZA

Example : F78 = 1
F78
A

Graphic display
M
YA

Side view Front view


Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit — NM211-00217
2:1
(c

Setting range 0, 1, 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-161
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Holding of memory monitor address
0: No
1: Yes
Selection of menu display
0: Menu for machining centers
1: Menu for turning centers
Key history function
0: Yes
1: No
Tool search method

d .
0: In order of TNo.

ve

1: In order of TNo. of tools currently in use

er
* Only bit 3 becomes valid after power-on.

s
F79

re
Selection of tap gear
0: M32 system

ts
1: M640M Pro system

gh
(M640M/M PLUS system)

ri
Display of tools currently in use

ll
0: No

.A
1: Yes
Initial value of synchronous/asynchronous tapping

N
during tapping tool registration

O
TI
0: Synchronous tapping
16

A 1: Asynchronous tapping
Program type M, E * This parameter is valid only when a sync
R
04

Immediate tapping option is provided.


PO

Conditions
30

(Bit 3: At power on) Display of a MAZATROL monitor window


R

0: Yes
o.

Unit —
O

1: No
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

K
ri

ZA

76543210 MAZATROL function


Se

0: Valid
IM

1: Invalid (Only EIA-related displays valid)


Automatic display of the navigation window on the
K

occurrence of an alarm
ZA

0: Display off
1: Display on
A
M

MAINTENANCE CHECK display at power on


0: Not displayed
YA

1: Displayed
3

Third page of the MAINTENANCE CHECK display


01

0: Not displayed

)2

1: Displayed
Automatic display of the GRAPHIC
(c

F80 MAINTENANCE display on the occurrence of an


ht

alarm
ig

0: Display off
yr

1: Display on
op

Learning of cutting conditions


0: Invalid
C

1: Valid
Editing on the CUTTING CONDITION LEARN
display
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Destination of spare tool correction by the
Program type M, E workpiece measurement
0: Tool length and tool diameter of the TOOL
Conditions Immediate DATA display
Unit — 1: Tool length and tool diameter correction of the
TOOL DATA display
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-162
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Program management function
0: Normal
1: Editing prohibited (in 9000’s)
Program management function
0: Normal
1: Displaying prohibited (in 9000’s)
Fixed value (0)
Add-in MAZATROL

.
— 0: Invalid

d
ve
1: Valid
F81

er
Program management function

s
0: Normal

re
1: Editing prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)

ts
Program management function

gh
0: Normal

ri
1: Displaying prohibited (in 8000, 9000’s)

ll
Retaining the program transfer settings

.A
0: Invalid
1: Valid

N
O
Program type M, E Input error prevention function

TI
Conditions At power on 0: Invalid
16

Unit —
A 1: Valid
R
04

PO

Setting range Binary, eight digits


30

76543210
o.

O
N

0: Characteristics estimation result graph display off


C

1: Characteristics estimation results graph display on


al

K
ri

Selection of inch/metric representation in POSITION


ZA
Se

display, TOOL DATA display, and TOOL OFFSET


A

display modes
IM

0: Invalid 1: Valid
Basis for tool life judgment
K

0: Whether the rate of the operation time to the


ZA

estimated life is greater than the setting of the F77


A

parameter
M

1: Whether the residual life is less than the setting of


YA

— the F77 parameter


X-axis diameter display on the POSITION display
F82
3

0: Invalid 1: Valid
01

Select whether to make the incorporation of tool nose


)2

width valid when grooving tool length is auto-set for


(c

the B-axis type of turret.


0: Invalid 1: Valid
ht

Index tool wear correction setup during automatic


ig

operation
yr

0: Impossible 1: Possible
op

Note :
C

1. Bit 1 in parameter F82 is valid only when an inch/metric unit system


change simplifying function (option) is provided.
Program type M 2. Bit 4 in parameter F82 is valid only for the X-axis for which bit 5 in
Conditions Immediate M18 is set to 0, and the diameter value is displayed in turning mode.
(Only for the INTEGREX e Series)
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-163
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210

Output of the alarm history data as text data


0: Valid
— 1: Invalid
Operation record function
F83 0: Invalid
1: Valid

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits

ts
Select whether or not the tool offset data is taken into account for the

gh
POSITION counter during automatic operation or virtual machining with
EIA/ISO programs

ri
Selection of whether or not the tool offset 0: Not taken into account

ll
data is taken into account for the POSITION

.A
1: Taken into account
counter during the execution of EIA/ISO

N
F84 programs

O
* In the tool path check, the tool offset value is not taken into account
(bit 0)

TI
disregarding the setting of this parameter.
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Switches the argument to be used in a fixed cycle program.


ZA
Se

0: B is used.
A

1: J is used.
IM

Switching of arguments B and J in a fixed


K

cycle
ZA

F84
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Group number assignment


ig

1: Tool number assignment


yr
op

Spare tool search method for EIA/ISO


C

programs
F84
(bit 2)

Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-164
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Valid when the workpiece offset is specified after a system variable is


entered.
1: Valid immediately after a system variable is entered.

Timing to validate new workpiece offset


data specified with a system variable
F84
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: M32, M PLUS, M640M, or M640M Pro system

gh
1: M2 system

ri
ll
.A
Machine coordinate system (G92) selection

N
F84

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: Always incremental data command


ZA
Se

1: Based on the modal G90/G91 command


A
IM

Incremental/absolute data command in


K

high-speed machining mode


ZA

F84
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Not operated until the buffer is full.


ig

1: Operated at a unit of EOB.


yr
op
C

Tape run method


F84
(bit 6)

Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-165
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

When no tool data has been set during EIA/ISO program execution with
the MAZATROL tool diameter data enabled (parameter F92 bit 7 = 1) or
the MAZATROL tool length data enabled (parameter F93 bit 3 = 1):
0: Operation is executed.
Operation executed/not executed when the
1: Causes alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR
tool data has not bee set
F84
(bit 7)
Note :
Whether the alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR occurs
Program type E

.
or not in the MDI mode depends on the setting of bit 3 of parameter

d
ve
Conditions At power on F123.

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Sets the condition where machining with table rotation is possible.

gh
0: Always possible

ri
1: Possible outside the area only

ll
.A
Table rotational machining
F85

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Enables/disables radial interference check


ri

ZA
Se

0: Enabled
A

1: Disabled
IM

Radial interference check


K

When 0 is set, the operation on detecting interference can be set for bit 5
ZA

F85 of parameter F92.


A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Sets the type of coordinate system for controlling the tool tip point.
ig

0: The table coordinate system that rotates according to the particular


yr

rotation of the C-axis is defined as the programming coordinate


op

system.
Type of coordinate system for controlling
C

the tool tip point 1: The work coordinate system is defined as the programming coordinate
F85 system.

(bit 2)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-166
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Sets the tool tip point control scheme.


0: Uni-axial rotation interpolation
1: Joint interpolation

 When 0 is set:

Y In the case of uni-axial rotational


R2 interpolation, the pivot point of
the machine moves as denoted

d .
RC1
by the arrow.

ve
The tool attitude vector moves in
R1 a plane including R1 and R2.

er
Tool tip
Z

s
re
ts
Tool tip point control scheme
Face horizontal to R1 and R2

gh
X
F85

ri
(bit 3)

ll
.A
 When 1 is set:

N
O
TI
In the case of joint interpolation,
16

A Y the pivot point of the machine


moves as denoted by the arrow.
R
04

RC2
The tool attitude vector moves
PO

R2
30

along a conical surface.


R
o.

R1
O
N

Tool tip Z
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Program type M, E
A

X Lateral face of the cone


IM

Conditions Immediate
Unit —
K
ZA

Setting range 0, 1
A

Fixed value (0)


M
YA
3


01

F85
)2

(bit 4)
(c
ht
ig

Program type —
yr

Conditions —
op

Unit —
C

Setting range —

2-167
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Sets whether G68.2 is canceled upon pressing the RESET key.


0: Valid
1: Invalid
G68.2 modal setting upon pressing the
RESET key
F85
(bit 5)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1
Sets whether surface definition  is to be displayed.

ts
gh
0 : Not displayed

ri
1 : Displayed

ll
.A
Display of surface definition 
F85

N
O
(bit 6)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Makes the override function valid for the movement of the tool tip
ri

ZA

point.
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M

Tool tip point


YA

Override scheme for G0 during tool tip point


control
F86
3

1: Makes the override function valid for the clamping speed at the
01

(bit 2) machine control point.


)2

If the moving speed of the axis exceeds the setting of machine


parameter M1 (i.e., the maximum rapid feed rate), the override
(c

function will work for that setting.


ht

Machine control point


ig
yr
op
C

Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-168
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

The plane for the display on the PART SHAPE window is:
0: X-Y plane
1: X-Z plane

Display of the PART SHAPE window


F86
(bit 4)

Program type M

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
0: Override valid for the movement of the tool tip point

ts
gh
1: Override valid for the clamping speed at the machine control point

ri
ll
Override scheme for G1 during tool tip point

.A
control
F86

N
O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Position during the start of tool tip point control


ri

ZA

1: Position with the rotary axis at 0 degrees


Se

A
IM

Selection of rotary axis reference position


for tool tip point control
K

F86
ZA

(bit 6)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-169
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210

Machine offset by each change in the deviation


vector
0: Valid
1: Invalid
Check for mismatch of the workpiece origin and
table rotation center
0: Valid (an alarm is output in case of a
mismatch)

d .
1: Invalid

ve
Data alteration checking function (tool-related

er
function)

s
re
0: Invalid
1: Valid

ts
gh
Select a feed rate display method for the
superposition system.

ri
0: Display in terms of moving speed of actual

ll
axis

.A
— 1: Display in terms of relative speed with respect

N
to the workpiece

O
F87 Single-block mode cancellation during fixed cycle

TI
0: Invalid (single-block stop occurs)
16

A 1: Valid (single-block stop does not occur)


R
04

PO

Common variables (#500 and on) are cleared by


30

resetting or at the program end.


R
o.

0: Invalid
O
N

1: Valid
C
al

Local variables are cleared by resetting or at the


ri

ZA

program end.
Se

0: Invalid
A

1: Valid
IM

Common variables (#100 to #199) are cleared by


K

resetting or at the program end.


ZA

0: Invalid
1: Valid
A
M

Note :
YA

Variables for tool path check are not cleared even if Bit 5, 6 or 7 in F87
is set to 1.
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c
ht

Setting range Binary, eight digits


ig
yr
op
C

2-170
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set this parameter to specify functions related to the conversion from


MAZATROL program into an EIA program.
76543210
Conversion of a part of program into sub-program
(See Note.)
Output method of G-code for point machining
0: G-code of fixed cycle
1: G-code in 1 digit
Output of G10 and G92.5 in conversion of WPC
data

.
0: Not to output

d
1: To output

ve
Output of tool diameter correction G-code

er
0: Not to output G-code

s
1: To output G-code

re
Tool path modification caused by tool diameter

ts
correction

gh
0: Correction is not included in path
1: Correction is included in path

ri
Fixed value (0)

ll
.A
Fixed value (1)

N
Note :

O
TI
When bit 0 of F88 is set to 1 on converting to the EIA program, the line
16

A
machining, groove machining, face machining portions in the
R
04

MAZATROL program are respectively programmed as subprograms.


PO
30

Example :
R

Note :
o.


O
N

1. Subprograms that can be called out of the


C

Common unit MAZATROL program are not


al

F88
K

[1]  reprogrammed as subprograms of the


ri

ZA

FCE MILL [4] EIA program.


Se

[2] 
A

2. Manual program mode unit is not


LINE CTR [5]
IM

programmed as subprogram.
[3] 
3. It can be selected to make a subprogram
K

END
with parameter.
ZA

1: To make subprogram
F88 bit 0
A

0: Not to make subprogram


M

Conversion into
EIA program
YA

Main program Subprogram


3
01

(WNo.1001); N1(UNo.2FACE-MILL);
G17G0G40G54G64G90G94;
)2

G0X5.Y2.;
G80; G1X50.; Unit of
(c

 [1]  [4] machining


N1(UNo.2FACE-MILL); G0X60.Y60.; units
ht

M98P1001H1; M99;
ig

G1Z-2;
yr

 N2(UNo.3LINE-CTR);
M98P1001H1; G2X10.Y10.R5.;
op

G0Z100; G1X50.; Unit of


machining
C

[2]  [5]
N2(UNo.3LINE-CTR); G2X40.Y10.R5.; units
M98P1001H2; M99;
G0Z-2; %

N3(UNo.4END);[3]

M30;
%
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note : Bit 2 and 3 of F88 are valid only for machining centers.

Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-171
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set this parameter to specify functions related to the conversion from


MAZATROL program into an EIA program.

76543210
Output of shape data
0: Not to output
1: To output
Synchronous tapping G-code
0: G74/G84
1: G84.2/G84.3
Output of F command

d .
0: To output

ve
— 1: Not to output

er
Whether to generate an output for EIA conversion

s
F89 of the mill-turning unit

re
0: Alarm (No output)

ts
1: Output of the path shifted through a distance

gh
equivalent to the tool radius

ri
EIA conversion output destination

ll
0: Standard area

.A
1: Backup area

N
Returning to the second zero point before tool

O
change (output of G30)

TI
0: Not to return
16

A 1: To return
Program type M, E
R
04

Fixed value (0)


PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


C
al

76543210
ri

ZA

In response to move command without decimal


Se

point:
A

0: Tool moves by 1/1.


IM

1: Tool moves by 10/1.


Coordinate system shift using a MAZATROL
K

program:
ZA

0: Invalid
A

1: Valid
M

0: Stroke inside check before movement


YA

1: Stroke outside check before movement


— Metric/inch system (Note)
3
01

0: Metric (Initial G20 is valid/invalid)


F91 1: Inch
)2

In response to move command without decimal


(c

point:
ht

0: Tool moves in 0.0001 mm (0.00001 in)


ig

increments.
yr

1: Tool moves in 1 mm (1 in) increments.


op

0: G00 interpolation
1: G00 non-interpolation
C

0: G33E command is for the number of threads


per inch
1: G33E command is for thread cutting with
Program type M, E precise lead
Conditions At power on Note :
Unit — Execute zero point return operation without fail before changing the
setting of bit 4 (metric/inch system selection).
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-172
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Modal at power-on or at reset (Initial G18)
0: G17 or G19
1: G18
Modal at power-on or at reset (Initial G19)
0: G17 or G18
1: G19
Dwell command method
0: Modal
1: Always based on the time command

.
Tool-length compensation (G43, G44) axis for

d
ve
milling tools
0: X-, Y-, Z-axes (Note)

er
— 1: Z-axis fixed

s
re
Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42) start
F92 up/cancel type

ts
0: Type A

gh
1: Type B

ri
Tool-diameter compensation (G41 or G42)

ll
interference check

.A
0: Alarm stop occurs to prevent overcutting.
1: Tool path is changed to prevent overcutting.

N
O
Fixed-cycle hole-drilling axis

TI
0: Plane selection using G17, G18 or G19
16

A 1: Z-axis fixed
R
04

ACT-/NOSE-R in the TOOL DATA display for an


PO

EIA/ISO program
30

0: Invalid
R

Program type M, E
o.

1: Valid
O
N

Conditions At power on
C

Note :
al

Unit —
K

In the case of tool offset type C, the value set for each axis on the TOOL
ri

ZA

Setting range Binary, eight digits OFFSET display is used for compensation.
Se

Modal at power-on or at reset.


IM

0: G97 (Constant surface speed control OFF)


K

1: G96 (Constant surface speed control ON)


ZA

Modal selection at power on or at reset


(G96/G97)
A

F93
M
YA

(bit 0)
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions At power on
(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr

Modal at power-on or at reset.


op

Machining centers
C

0: G94 (Feed per minute)


Modal selection at power on or at reset
1: G95 (Feed per revolution)
Machining centers: G94/G95
F93 Lathes: G98/G99
Lathes
(bit 1)
0: G98 (Feed per minute)
1: G99 (Feed per revolution)
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-173
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Modal at power-on or at reset.


0: G91 (Incremental-value command)
1: G90 (Absolute-value command)
Modal selection at power on or at reset
(G91/G90)
F93
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Tool length of tool data for an EIA/ISO program

gh
0: Invalid

ri
1: Valid

ll
Tool length of tool data for an EIA/ISO

.A
program
F93

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Feed rate during machine lock


ri

ZA
Se

0: Specified feed rate


A

1: Rapid feed rate


IM

Feed rate during machine lock


K
ZA

F93
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Middle point during reference-point return


ig

0: Return through middle point to reference point


yr

1: Return directly to reference point


op

Middle point during reference-point return


C

F93
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-174
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Single-block operation mode at user macro operation instruction


0: Single-block stop does not occur (for operation)
1: Single-block stop occurs (for test)
Single-block operation mode at user macro
operation instruction
F93
(bit 6)

Program type E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value (0)

gh
ri
ll
.A

F93

N
O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

0: According to the selected modal mode (G00 or G01)


ri

ZA
Se

1: Fixed as rapid traverse mode (G00)


A
IM

Movement to hole-drilling position in


K

fixed-cycle mode
ZA

F94
A

(bit 0)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

0: External deceleration signal enabled


ig

1: External deceleration signal disabled


yr
op

External deceleration signal valid/invalid


C

F94
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-175
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Cancel
1: Do not cancel

Tool length offset cancellation upon zero


point return by G28/G30 or manual
operation, enabled/disabled
F94
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: G01 (linear interpolation)

gh
1: G00 (positioning)

ri
ll
.A
Modal at power-on or at reset (G01/G00)
F94

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: To specify the group number on the TOOL DATA display


ri

ZA
Se

1: To specify the tool number (or pocket number)


A
IM

Tool command method using T-codes


K
ZA

F94
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Fixed value (0)


ig
yr
op


C

F94
(bit 5)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-176
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (1)


F94
(bit 6)

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
0: Offsets on the TOOL OFFSET display enabled

gh
1: EIA/ISO offsets on the TOOL DATA display enabled

ri
ll
Tool offset amount effectuated in an

.A
EIA/ISO program
F94

N
O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Interrupt function using user macro instruction


ri

ZA
Se

0: Invalid
A

1: Valid
IM

Interrupt function using user macro


K

instruction, valid/invalid
ZA

F95
A

(bit 0)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Handling of macro program interruption and call


ig

0: Handled as interruption
yr

1: Handled as subprogram call


op

Handling of macro program interruption and


C

call
F95
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-177
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Automatic return position to restart the program (Fixed to 1)


0: Manual return
1: Automatic return
Automatic return position to restart the
program (Fixed to 1)
F95
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
G00 (positioning) command feed rate for dry run

gh
0: Rapid feed rate

ri
1: Feed rate for dry run

ll
G00 (positioning) command feed rate for

.A
dry run

N
F95

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: Window scheme
ZA
Se

1: Alarm scheme
A
IM

Wear offset check scheme with the input [Related parameters]


K

error prevention function enabled F81 bit 7: Input error prevention function valid/invalid
ZA

F95 F125: Permissible data alteration amount 2 for input error prevention
A

(bit 4) function
M

F126: Maximum wear offset setting with the input error prevention
YA

function enabled
Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Alarm display when the slave or adaptor unit is not connected


ig

0: Displayed
yr

1: Not displayed
op

Alarm display when the slave or adaptor


C

unit is not connected


F95
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-178
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Manual-pulse interrupt amount cancellation with the RESET key


0: Invalid
1: Valid
Manual-pulse interrupt amount cancellation
with the RESET key, valid/invalid
F95
(bit 6)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
With the RESET key

gh
0: Coordinate system corresponding to G54

ri
1: Coordinate system unchanged

ll
G54 coordinate system with the RESET

.A
key, valid/invalid

N
F95

O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

76543210
Se

Selection of variable number for tool offset


A
IM

amount
0: 16001 to 16512, 17001 to 17512
K

1: 12001 to 12512, 13001 to 13512


ZA

Fairing function
0: Invalid
A

1: Valid
M

Processing for arc command blocks in high-speed


YA

machining mode
— 0: Nonuniform feed
3
01

1: Uniform feed
F96
)2

Selection of a corner judgment criterion in


high-speed machining mode
(c

0: Judgment from the angle relative to adjacent


ht

blocks
ig

1: Judgment by excluding the small block (if


yr

present between large-angle blocks)


op

Selection of a cutting feed clamping speed in


C

high-speed machining mode


0: Minimum clamping speed of movable axes
1: Clamping speed based on the radius of the
Program type M, E curvature
Conditions Immediate Rotational axis shape correction
0: Invalid
Unit —
1: Valid
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-179
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

To select G-code modal of the coordinates system to be used in the EIA


conversion function.

Coordinates Coordinates
Selection of G-code of the coordinates Setting value Setting value
system system
system to be used in the EIA conversion
function 1 G54 5 G58
F97 2 G55 6 G59
3 G56
4 G57 Others G54
Program type M, E

d .
Note : F97 is valid only for machining centers.

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
To specify the number of a macro variable to be used in the EIA

gh
conversion function.
If any macro variable is not used, set to 0.

ri
In case of output with a subprogram in the EIA conversion, the height of

ll
.A
cutting face is set with a macro variable. Set to F98 the number of the
macro variable to be used.

N
O
(M)

TI
(M) (S) (M)
(S)
16

A (S)
R
04

(S) (S)
(M) (M)
PO

(S) (M) Main program


30

(S) (S) (S) (S) Subprogram


R

(S)
o.

(M)
O

Rapid feed
N

(S)
C

(S) Cutting feed


al

(M) (S)
ri

ZA

(S) MPL504
Se

(S)
A
IM

Number of macro variable to be used in the


EIA conversion function Main program Subprogram
K

F98
ZA

 N_(_);
To the height of
G01Z_; 
A

cutting face
#_=_;
M

G00Z_; Return on Z-axis


Height of
YA

cutting face X_Y_; Moves to the start point


of the next machining
Macro variable (F98) G01Z#_; on Z-axis
3

M98P_H_; XY_;
01

  Machining on Z-axis
)2

M30; M99; specified with the variable


% %
(c
ht

[Units that use macro variables]


ig

FCE MILL (cutting in one direction), TOP EMIL, POCKET, PCKT MT,
yr

PCKT VLY
op

Note :
C

1. 3D machining cannot be output using subprograms.


2. Subprogram is output in the absolute mode (G90).
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
100 to 199
Setting range
500 to 999

2-180
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

In case of output with subprogram in the EIA conversion function:


Example :

Offset amount for the subprogram WNo. to WNo. 10


When F99 is “20”.
the main WNo. concerned in case of output
EIA conversion (The WNo. of the converted program is assumed to be
with subprogram in the EIA conversion
function 1000.)
F99 Main WNo. 1000
Sub WNo. 1020
Offset amount: 20
Program type M, E For the subprogram of the EIA conversion function, refer to F88 bit 0.

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 1 to 99999998

ts
If the commanded distance in a block exceeds the spline cancel length

gh
(F100), spline interpolation is not realized in this block even in the spline
interpolation mode.

ri
ll
Curve with spline interpolation

.A
Spline cancel length

N
F100

O
P3 P4

TI
P2
16

P5 (P3-P4) > F100


P1
A
R
04

Program type E P6
Straight line when the
PO
30

Conditions Immediate distance between P3 and P4


R

exceeds the value of F100.


o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

MPL505
C

Setting range 0 to 999999


al

K
ri

If the angle formed by two blocks exceeds the value set by the parameter
ZA
Se

F101, spline interpolation is not realized in these blocks even in the spline
A

interpolation mode.
IM

If F101 = 0 in the spline interpolation mode, the spline interpolation mode


is not canceled. In the 5-axis spline interpolation mode, this sets the spline
K

cancel angle at 60 degrees.


ZA
A
M

3 P4 P4
4
YA

P3 P3
Cornered
Spline cancel angle 2 P5 P5
3

4 F101 P2
01

F101 P2
 5 P6 P6
)2
(c

P1 6 P7 P1 P7
ht
ig

P4
yr

When F101 is not set.


op

P3
P5
C

P2
Program type E P6

Conditions Immediate
P1 P7
Unit °
MPL506
Setting range 0 to 179

2-181
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

During block checking in the fine spline interpolation mode, if the spline
curve of a specific block is judged to include an inflection point and the
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger
than the value of F102, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
Fine spline interpolation curve error the maximum chord error below the value of F102.
(Block including the point of inflection)
F102 Original spline curve

Modified spline curve

Program type E A B

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate F102 or less

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in D735S0001

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
If a block whose length is less than the value of F103 is detected during

gh
fine spline interpolation, that block will be skipped and integrated (faired)
into the preceding and succeeding blocks to create a spline curve.

ri
Suppose that the i-th block in the fine spline interpolation mode has a

ll
.A
block length of li:
If Ii – 1 is greater than F103 × 2

N
Ii is equal to or less than F103

O
TI
Ii + 1 is greater than F103 × 2
16

A
then the ending point of the “i – 1” th block and the starting point of the “i +
R
04

1” th block will be modified to the middle point of the i-th block and this
PO

block will be deleted. A spline curve will be created from the sequence of
30

points updated this way.


R
o.

Ii  F103
N

Spline interpolation fairing block length,


C

Ii – 1 > F103 × 2
5-axis spline interpolation small block Ii + 1 > F103 × 2
al

length
ri

ZA

F103
Se

After-modification
IM

of relay points
Created spline curve
K
ZA
A
M

D735S0002
YA

If the length of the starting block or ending block in the fine spline
interpolation mode is smaller than the value of F103, processing will
3
01

slightly differ from that described above.


This parameter is effective when bit 1 of F96 is 1.
)2
(c

Program type E If the distance between blocks is less than the value of F103 in the 5-axis
ht

Conditions Immediate spline interpolation mode, the 5-axis spline interpolation mode will be
ig

canceled only between these blocks. When F103 is set to 0, the value of
yr

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


parameter F104 is used.
op

Setting range 0 to 99999999


C

2-182
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

During block checking in the fine spline interpolation mode, if the spline
curve of a specific block is judged to include no inflection point and the
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger
than the value of F104, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
the maximum chord error below the value of F104.

Original spline curve


Modification Modified spline curve

A B

d .
F104 or less

ve
er
D735S0003

s
re
During block checking in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode, if the

ts
maximum chord error between the spline curve and the block is larger

gh
Fine spline interpolation curve error than the value of F104, the shape of the curve will be modified to reduce
the maximum chord error below the value of F104.

ri
(Block including no inflection point)
When F104 is set to 0, if the block is judged to include an inflection point,

ll
.A
the spline curve of the block will be modified to be linear, and if it is judged
5-axis spline interpolation curve error
to include no inflection point, it will not be modified (spline interpolation is

N
F104 realized).

O
5-axis fairing command error

TI
16

A
In 5-axis fairing, if the error between the command point and the point
R
04

after fairing for the tool tip 3 axes is larger the value of F104, the point
PO

after fairing is modified to reduce the error below the value of F104.
30

When F104 is set to 0, the point after fairing will not be modified.
o.

O
N

C
al

Point after fairing


ri

ZA

(with modification)
Se

F104 or less
A
IM
K
ZA

Z
Y
A

Point after fairing


M

(without modification)
X
YA

Program type E
: Paths after fairing
3

Conditions Immediate : Paths of command points


01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c

In a small-segment machining program, if a small block is present


ht

between large-angle blocks, optimum corner deceleration can be


ig

achieved by excluding the small block and then judging the total corner
yr

angle.
op

Judgment length for judging the small block


Small block judgment length
C

F107 Small block

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in This parameter is valid when bit 4 of F96 is 1.

Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-183
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Specify by what degrees the angle of corner deceleration is to be


incremented when the shape correction function is valid.

Corner deceleration angle increment value

F108

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit °

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the number of common variables which can be read and written

gh
between the turrets.

ri
Example :

ll
If 10 is set in F109
Number of common variables between

.A
turrets (#100 onward) #100 to #109: Common variables that are valid for both turrets

N
#110 to #199: Common variables that are valid only for one turret
F109

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit Number of variables


N

Setting range 0 to 100


al

K
ri

Set the number of common variables which can be read and written
ZA
Se

between the turrets.


A
IM

Example :
Number of common variables between If 10 is set in F110
K

turrets (#500 onward) #500 to #509: Common variables that are valid for both turrets
ZA

F110 #510 to #999: Common variables that are valid only for one turret
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit Number of variables


(c

Setting range 0 to 500


ht

F111 (bit 1) = 0:
ig

Disuse of dry run during thread cutting cycle


yr

F111 (bit 1) = 1:
op

Use of dry run during thread cutting cycle


C

Use/disuse of dry run during thread cutting


F111
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-184
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

F111 (bit 2) = 0:
The feed hold function causes the threading operation to stop after the
completion of chamfering at the thread end point.
F111 (bit 2) = 1:
Use/disuse of feed hold during thread The feed hold function starts chamfering at the position where the feed
cutting hold button is pressed and stops the threading operation at the completion
F111 of chamfering.
(bit 2)
Note :
With TC82 = 0, the same operation as that for setting 0 will occur even if
Program type M, E 1 is set for F111 bit 2.

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select the direction of rotation of the C-axis during C-axial threading

gh
based on G01.1.

ri
F111 (bit 3) = 0:
The C-axis rotates CW (forward).

ll
Direction of rotation of the C-axis during

.A
F111 (bit 3) = 1:
C-axial threading with G01.1
The C-axis rotates CCW (backward).

N
F111

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Select whether the wear correction data on the TOOL DATA display is to
ZA
Se

be added during execution of the EIA/ISO program when using the tool
A

length that has been entered on the TOOL DATA display.


IM

Tool correction amount selection for F111 (bit 5) = 0:


K

EIA/ISO programs Wear correction data is not added


ZA

F111 F111 (bit 5) = 1:


Wear correction data is added
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

In the fixed turning cycle mode (G290/G292/G294)


ig

F111 (bit 6) = 0:
yr

The fixed turning cycle is executed for each block (G66 type).
op

F111 (bit 6) = 1:
Execution mode selection for a fixed turning
C

The fixed turning cycle is executed only for movement blocks (G66.1
cycle
F111 type).

(bit 6)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-185
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

This parameter specifies whether single-block operation during a fixed


turning cycle (G290, G292 or G294) is to be stopped after the entire cycle
has been executed, or for each block.
F111 (bit 7) = 0:
Form of single-block stop during a fixed After execution of the cycle
turning cycle
F111 F111 (bit 7) = 1:
For each block
(bit 7)

Program type E

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Selection of printout items in measurement data printout

gh
76543210 (0: Not printout 1: Print out)

ri
ll
Selection of measurement data items to be Work No., Unit No.

.A
printed out Tool index number, work counter

N
F112 Measurement mode

O
Target data

TI
16

A Measured data
R
04

Program type M, E Offset data


PO
30

Conditions Immediate Tolerance upper/lower


R

Day and time of measurement


o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

F113 (bit 0) = 0:
ri

ZA
Se

Counting each type of use under the same tool number individually.
A
IM

Counting all types of use under the same F113 (bit 0) = 1:


tool number for the tool life management on Counting all types of use under the same tool number integratingly.
K

the TOOL DATA display


ZA

F113 executed/not executed


A

(bit 0)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

F113 (bit 1) = 0:
ig

Operation will be continued.


yr

F113 (bit 1) = 1:
op

Data handling on the milling tool of a group Operation will be stopped.


C

that has expired in tool life


F113
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-186
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

F113 (bit 2) = 0:
Operation will be continued.

F113 (bit 2) = 1:
Data handling on the turning tool of a group Operation will be stopped.
that has expired in tool life
F113
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether the FLASH tool that has been registered under the same

gh
tool number for the tool life management function is to be included in
spare tools.

ri
ll
F113 (bit 3) = 0:

.A
Tool life management of the FLASH tool The FLASH tool will be included in spare tools.

N
F113

O
F113 (bit 3) = 1:
(bit 3)

TI
The FLASH tool will not be included in spare tools.
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Select whether the life time on the TOOL DATA display is to be included
ZA
Se

in the life judgment items listed for the tool life management function.
A
IM

F113 (bit 4) = 0:
The life time will be included in the life judgment items.
Tool life management – Life time
K
ZA

F113 F113 (bit 4) = 1:


The life time will not be included in the life judgment items.
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether the maximum available wear offset data X on the TOOL
ig

DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
yr

life management function.


op

Tool life management – F113 (bit 5) = 0:


C

Maximum available wear offset data X The maximum available wear offset data X will be included in the life
F113 judgment items.
(bit 5) F113 (bit 5) = 1:
The maximum available wear offset data X will not be included in the life
judgment items.
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-187
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Select whether the maximum available wear offset data Y on the TOOL
DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
life management function.

Tool life management – F113 (bit 6) = 0:


Maximum available wear offset data Y The maximum available wear offset data Y will be included in the life
F113 judgment items.
(bit 6) F113 (bit 6) = 1:
The maximum available wear offset data Y will not be included in the life
judgment items.
Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether the maximum available wear offset data Z on the TOOL

gh
DATA display is to be included in the life judgment items listed for the tool
life management function.

ri
ll
Tool life management – F113 (bit 7) = 0:

.A
Maximum available wear offset data Z The maximum available wear offset data Z will be included in the life

N
F113 judgment items.

O
(bit 7)

TI
F113 (bit 7) = 1:
16

The maximum available wear offset data Z will not be included in the life
A
judgment items.
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Specify the maximum C-axial cutting feed rate that can be selected for the
ZA
Se

inch system.
A
IM

F114 (bit 0) = 0:
–1
Selection of the maximum C-axial cutting The maximum selectable C-axial cutting feed rate is 88 min .
K

feed rate for the inch system


ZA

F114 F114 (bit 0) = 1:


–1
The maximum selectable C-axial cutting feed rate is 400 min .
A

(bit 0)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select the type of operation occurring during the control of the tool tip
ig

point when command G49 is issued (when the tool length offset value is
yr

canceled).
op

Selection of the operation occurring during


F114 (bit 1) = 0:
C

the control of the tool tip point when


The axis moves according to the tool length offset value.
command G49 is issued (when the tool
F114 length offset value is canceled) F114 (bit 1) = 1:
(bit 1) The axis does not move.

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-188
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Moving axes by using G49 (tool length offset cancel) in G43 (tool length
offset) mode

F114 (bit 3) = 0:
Moving axes by using G49 (tool length Valid
offset cancel) in G43 (tool length offset)
mode F114 (bit 3) = 1:
F114
Invalid
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Selecting a rethreading function

gh
F114 (bit 4) = 0:

ri
Using the rethreading function

ll
.A
Rethreading function F114 (bit 4) = 1:
F114 Not using the rethreading function

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Output timing of a tool life alarm


ri

ZA
Se

F114 (bit 5) = 0:
A
IM

At the time of the next tool change

Output timing of a tool life alarm F114 (bit 5) = 1:


K
ZA

F114 When the program ends.


A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

F114 (bit 6) = 0:
Invalid. Initially, the G50-specified coordinate system is selected.
ig
yr

F114 (bit 6) = 1:
op

Valid. Initially, the MAZATROL coordinate system (G53.5) is selected.


Initial G53.5
C

F114
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-189
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

F114 (bit 7) = 0:
The life of the tool is judged from its machining count.

F114 (bit 7) = 1:
Judging tool life from the count of machined The life of the tool is not judged from its machining count.
workpieces
F114
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Specify the X-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.

gh
A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when

ri
this parameter is set to zero (0).

ll
.A
Feed rate of the threading runout – X-axis In case of M1 < F116, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.

N
F116

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit mm/min
O
N

Setting range 0 to 240000


al

Specify the Y-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.
ri

ZA
Se

A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
A

this parameter is set to zero (0).


IM

Feed rate of the threading runout – Y-axis In case of M1 < F117, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
K
ZA

F117
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit mm/min
)2

Setting range 0 to 240000


(c
ht

Specify the Z-axial feed rate for the runout of the threading cycle.
ig

A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
yr

this parameter is set to zero (0).


op

Feed rate of the threading runout – Z-axis In case of M1 < F118, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.
C

F118

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 240000

2-190
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Specify the runout feed rate for the inside diameter threading cycle.
This parameter is valid only when chamfering is not specified in the inside
diameter threading unit of the MAZATROL program.
A quarter (1/4) of the rapid traverse (as set in parameter M1) applies when
Runout feed rate for the inside diameter
threading cycle this parameter is set to zero (0).

F119 In case of M1 < F119, the feed rate will be clamped with the M1 value.

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit mm/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 240000

ts
Specify the X-axial clamping speed for the threading cycle.

gh
ri
ll
Clamping speed for the threading cycle –

.A
X-axis

N
F120

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit mm/min
O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Specify the Y-axial clamping speed for the threading cycle.


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Clamping speed for the threading cycle –


K

Y-axis
ZA

F121
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit mm/min
)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c
ht

Specify the Z-axial clamping speed for the threading cycle.


ig
yr
op

Clamping speed for the threading cycle –


C

Z-axis
F122

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-191
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Processing of work offset specified with G53.1 (tool axis direction control)
for the machine whose table rotary axis is not an axis that rotates around
Processing of work offset specified with the Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine specification featuring
G53.1 for the machine whose table rotary both the tool rotary axis and the table rotary axis)
axis is not an axis that rotates around the 0: Includes a holder length.
Z-axis on the INTEGREX type (the machine
F123 specification featuring both the tool rotary 1: Does not include a holder length.

(bit 1) axis and the table rotary axis)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Consideration of a mirroring command specified in the M CODE unit for

ts
shape drawing

gh
0: Not considered

ri
1: Considered

ll
Shape drawing: Validity of a mirroring

.A
command specified in the M CODE unit
F123

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Enables/disables tool change operation in the MDI mode for tools whose
ri

ZA

tool data has not been set, when bit 7 of parameter F84 is set to “1”.
Se

0: Stop operation with the alarm 953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS
IM

ERROR displayed
1: Single block stop after completing tool change with the alarm 1107
K

MDI tool change enable/disable for tools INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA displayed
ZA

with no tool data


F123
A
M

Note :
(bit 3)
YA

1. When bit 7 of parameter F92 is set to “1”:


The above mentioned alarm will be generated if the tool
3

diameter is not set for the specified tool.


01

E 2. When bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to “1”:


)2

Program type
Conditions Immediate The above mentioned alarm will be generated if the tool
(c

diameter, tool diameter A/B, or tool set X/Y is not set for the
ht

Unit —
specified tool.
ig

Setting range 0, 1
yr
op
C

2-192
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Sets the output position of sequence numbers during EIA conversion.


0: Output the sequence number after completing machining with each
tool sequence/shape sequence and immediately before the first tool
change command
EIA conversion sequence number output 1: Output the sequence number after completing machining with each
F123 tool sequence/shape sequence

(bit 7)

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
The data input in the following items are checked based on the

ts
permissible data alteration amount set in this parameter.

gh
TOOL DATA:

ri
LENGTH, ACT-, TOOL SET X, TOOL SET Z, LENG COMP., LENG.CO.,

ll
Permissible data alteration amount 1 for ACT-CO.

.A
input error prevention function
TOOL OFFFSET:

N
F124 GEOMETRIC OFFSET

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

The data input in the following items are checked based on the
ri

ZA

permissible data alteration amount set in this parameter.


Se

TOOL DATA:
IM

WEAR COMP. X, WEAR COMP. Y, WEAR COMP. Z


Permissible data alteration amount 2 for
TOOL OFFFSET:
K

input error prevention function


WEAR COMP.
ZA

F125
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c

When the absolute value of the value input for the following data exceeds
ht

the setting of this parameter, either a window prompting a check on the


ig

input value is displayed or the input value is discarded with an alarm


yr

generated, according to the setting of F95 bit 4.


op

Maximum wear offset setting with the input TOOL DATA: WEAR COMP.
C

error prevention function enabled


TOOL OFFFSET: WEAR COMP.
F126
[Related parameters]
F81 bit 7: Input error prevention function valid/invalid
Program type M, E
F95 bit 4: Wear offset check scheme with the input error prevention
Conditions Immediate function enabled
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-193
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

During rotary axis checking in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode, if the
error between the line that connects the start point and the end point and
the spline curve is larger than the value of F128, the shape of the curve
will be modified to reduce the error below the value of F128.
When F128 is set to 0, the angular spline shape will not be modified.
Angle  Original spline
curve

Time t
Modified spline
curve

d .
Modification

ve
End point angle

er
F128 or less

s
re
Start point

ts
angle

gh
ri
5-axis spline interpolation angular error

ll
During rotary axis checking in the 5-axis fairing mode, if the error between

.A
5-axis fairing angular error the point after fairing and the command point is larger than the value of

N
F128 F128, the point after fairing will be modified to reduce the error below the

O
value of F128.

TI
When F128 is set to 0, the point after fairing will not be modified.
16

A
R
04

PO

Point after fairing


30

(without modification)
R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Point after fairing


(with modification)
K

F128 or less
ZA

Angle
A
M

: Paths after fairing


YA

Program type E : Paths of command points


Time
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit 0.0001°
)2

Setting range 0 to 3600000


(c

Corner deceleration in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode is changed to


the following Vo’ with respect to the theoretical value Vo.
ht
ig

Vo’ = Vo × F129/100
yr

5-axis spline interpolation corner


op

deceleration coefficient The assigned value is invalid if minus. If 0 is assigned, it will be regarded
C

as 100, or if a value greater than 2000 is assigned, it will be regarded as


F129 2000.

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 2000

2-194
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Arc radius clamping speed in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode is


changed to the following Vc’ with respect to the theoretical value Vc.
Vc’ = Vc × (F130/100)
5-axis spline interpolation arc-clamping
The assigned value is invalid if minus.
speed coefficient
If 0 is assigned, it will be regarded as 100, or if a value greater than 500 is
F130 assigned, it will be regarded as 500.

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
Setting range 0 to 500

re
Specify tool-drawing accuracy on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D

ts
MONITOR display

gh
As the specified value is greater (maximum value: 9), accuracy increases

ri
progressively.

ll
Tool-drawing accuracy on the VIRTUAL

.A
MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display

N
F135

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0 to 9
al

It is possible to change the size of the workpiece created automatically on


ri

ZA

the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display.


Se

Y Workpiece automatically set by NC


IM

Amount of offset for dummy workpiece


shape on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D
K

F136
MONITOR display
ZA

F136
A

Workpiece displayed in
F136
M

solid display mode


YA

Program type M
X
3

Conditions Immediate
01

This offset function is valid for both


Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in X-axial and Y-axial directions.
)2

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


(c

Specify the number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D


ht

MONITOR display automatically. If 0 is entered, three jaws will be


ig

displayed as standard.
yr

Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL


op

MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for


C

No. 1 turning spindle


F137

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Jaws
Setting range 0 to 9

2-195
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Specify the number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D


MONITOR display automatically. If 0 is entered, three jaws will be
displayed as standard.

Number of jaws indicated on the VIRTUAL


MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display for
No. 2 turning spindle
F138

d .
Program type M

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit Jaws

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9

ts
Specify the amount of C-axial angle offset for the jaws indicated on the

gh
VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display automatically.

ri
ll
Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the

.A
VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR

N
display for the No. 1 turning spindle

O
F139

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1°
N

C
al

Setting range 0 to 3599


K
ri

ZA

Specify the amount of C-axial angle offset for the jaws indicated on the
Se

VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display automatically.


A
IM

Angle offset for the jaws indicated on the


K

VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR


ZA

display for the No. 2 turning spindle


F140
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1°
(c

Setting range 0 to 3599


ht

Select the background color of override window displayed when the


ig

external override function is used. This is valid in the automatic operation


yr

mode.
op

Background color of spindle override 0: Black


C

window displayed when the external 1: Red


override function is used
2: Blue
F142
3: Green

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 3

2-196
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Operation when workpiece counting is made valid while the automatic


operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) is enabled.
<Manual setting on the POSITION screen>
0: Workpiece counting is activated while the ISS is disabled, and the
automatic operation continues.
1: Workpiece counting is not activated, the alarm 1129 MEMORY
PROTECT (SAFETY SHIELD) is displayed and the automatic
operation continues.
<Setting using programs (#3901, #3902)> (Note 1) (Note 2)
Operation when workpiece counting is
0: Workpiece counting is activated while the ISS is disabled, and the
made valid while the automatic operation

d .
automatic operation continues.
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD is enabled

ve
F143 1: Workpiece counting is not activated, the alarm 1824 UNWRITABLE

er
(bit 0) SYSTEM VARIABLE (ISS) is displayed and the automatic operation

s
stops.

re
Note :

ts
1. When parameter F335 bit 7 = 0, operation follows the setting of

gh
F143 bit 0 upon overwriting the part count from the program while

ri
executing ISS (automatic).

ll
2. When parameter F335 bit 7 = 1, the part count is set upon

.A
overwriting the part count from the program while executing ISS

N
Program type M, E (automatic), regardless of the setting of F143 bit 0, and automatic

O
Conditions Immediate operation continues with ISS enabled.

TI
16

Unit — [Related parameters]


A
R
04

Setting range 0, 1 F335bit7


PO
30

Select the status [STORE WORKPCE MATERIAL] when the power is


R

turned on.
o.

O
N

0: Disabled
C

(The condition of the material model cut with the ISS enabled is not
al

Status of [STORE WORKPCE MATERIAL] maintained.)


ri

ZA

when the power is turned on


Se

F143 1: Enabled
A

(The condition of the material model cut with the ISS enabled is
IM

(bit 1) maintained.)
K
ZA

Program type M, E
A

Conditions At power on
M

Unit —
YA

Setting range 0, 1
3

Invalid
01
)2
(c
ht


ig

F143
yr
op

(bit 2)
C

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-197
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Display of WPC on the POSITION display during inclined-surface


machining
0: Display the work coordinate system that is selected before the
inclined-surface machining command.
Display of WPC during inclined-surface
machining on the POSITION display 1: Display the coordinate system that is selected after coordinate system
F143 rotation and zero point parallel movement according to the
inclined-surface machining command.
(bit 6)

Program type E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Cancel or hold G43 when the RESET key is pressed in G43 (tool length

gh
compensation) mode.

ri
0: Cancel

ll
G43 modal cancel selection with the 1: Hold

.A
RESET key
F143

N
O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Selection of table rotary axis reference position for inclined-surface


ri

ZA

machining
Se

0: Table rotary axis start position as the reference


IM

Selection of table rotary axis reference 1: Table rotary axis 0-degree position as the reference
K

position for inclined-surface machining


ZA

F144
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Resetting of a tool life alarm with the alarm clear button


ig

0: Not reset
yr

1: Reset
op

Resetting of a tool life alarm with the alarm


C

clear button
F144
(bit 2)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-198
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Setting a minus value for argument Q (module/diametral pitch) in hobbing


0: Invalid
1: Valid
Setting a minus value for argument Q in * If a minus value is set for argument Q in hobbing, while 0 is set for F144
hobbing, valid/invalid bit 3, alarm 809 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT will be caused.
F144
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
G49 command immediately after the macro variable command when bit 3

gh
of parameter F114 is set to 1 (no axis movement by the G49 command)

ri
0: No axis movement
Selection of operation by the G49 command

ll
1: Axis movement

.A
immediately after a macro variable
command

N
F144

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

G92.5 block, #3090 = 1, and G10.9 block in the EIA/ISO program


ZA
Se

converted for machining centers (parameter F30 is set to 0)


A

0: Output
IM

Deletion of unnecessary codes during 1: Do not output


K

EIA/ISO conversion for machining centers Note :


ZA

F144 For G92.5 block only, the setting at bit 7 of parameter F144 is used.
A

(bit 6)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

G92.5 block in the EIA/ISO program converted for machining centers


ig

(parameter F30 is set to 0)


yr

0: Output
op

Deletion of G92.5 blocks during EIA/ISO 1: Do not output


C

conversion for machining centers * Same as when bit 6 of parameter F144 is set to 1
F144
(bit 7)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-199
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

The rapid feed rate override is reduced to the value set here, when data
alteration is detected.
This value will be handled as100 if 0 is set here.

Rapid feed override when data alteration is


detected
F145

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 100

ts
Representation of cutting-off or parting operation under synchronization of

gh
both turning spindles on the VIRTUAL MACHINING and 3D MONITOR
displays

ri
0: Representation with the material at the head that operates as the

ll
Selection of the material model’s part to be

.A
master side in synchronization and the material at the other side cut
taken off (hidden) on the VIRTUAL
off

N
MACHINING and 3D MONITOR displays in
(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)

O
the flow of turning operation under

TI
synchronization of both spindles 1: Representation by taking-off the material from the 2nd spindle, with
F146
16

the material remaining on the 1st spindle


A
(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)
R
04

PO

2: Representation by taking-off the material from the 1st spindle, with the
30

material remaining on the 2nd spindle


R
o.

(Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)


O

Program type M, E
N

3: Representation with the material opposite the head that operates as


Conditions Immediate
al

the master side in synchronization left and the material at the other
K
ri

ZA

Unit — side cut off


Se

Setting range 0 to 3 (Cut-off part is hidden and excluded from the interference check.)
A
IM

Reference data for the calculation of compensation amount for G41/G42


given in a manual program unit
K

F148 = 0:
ZA

NOSE-R setting on the TOOL OFFSET display


A

Compensation amount for G41/G42 given


F148 = 1:
M

in a manual program (MANL PRG) unit


NOSE-R or ACT- setting on the TOOL DATA display
YA

F148
3
01
)2

Program type M
(c

Conditions Immediate
ht

Unit —
ig

Setting range 0, 1
yr
op
C

2-200
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Operation between blocks in the single block signal status when single
block mode is switched from ON to OFF during automatic operation

When the single block signal is When the single block signal is turned
turned from ON to OFF from OFF to ON and then to OFF

ON OFF ON OFF
Single block signal

F149=0
Execution block Next block Execution block Next block
Operation between blocks when single
block mode is switched from ON to OFF Stop between Stop between
during automatic operation blocks blocks

d .
F149

ve
ON OFF ON OFF

s er
F149=1 Execution block Next block Execution block Next block

re
No stop between Stop between

ts
blocks blocks

gh
ON OFF ON OFF

ri
ll
Program type M, E F149=2

.A
Execution block Next block Execution block Next block

Conditions Immediate No stop No stop

N
between blocks between blocks

O
Unit —

TI
Setting range 0 to 2
16

A
R
Set the top register R (R18176 to R18463) for output destination of NC
04

PO

basic information for field network.


30

R
o.

O
N

Example :
C

2. When F150 = 352


al

1. When F150 = 0
K
ri

Output side Output side


ZA
Se

Output data offset of NC basic information


Data output to
A

for field network slave/adaptor


NC basic information
IM

F150
K
ZA

Data output to NC basic information


slave/adaptor
A
M

Note :
YA

Program type M, E If a value set for F150 is out of the setting range or is an odd value,
3

alarm 528 FIELDNETWORK SETTING ERROR (4, , ) occurs and the


01

Conditions Immediate communication stops. NC basic information will not be output.


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 352


ht

Fixed value (0)


ig
yr
op
C


F151
(bit 1)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-201
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Returning of the material geometry to the initial geometry when execution


of a program is returned to the head during continuous program run in the
state the virtual machining function or the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
Switching of the material geometry when SHIELD function is valid
execution of a program is returned to the 0: Not returned to the initial geometry.
head during continuous program run
F151 1: Returned to the initial geometry.
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

.
Conditions Immediate

d
ve
Unit —

er
Setting range 0, 1

s
re
Data to be referenced or changed by macro variable #3001 (power-on

ts
time)

gh
0: Value indicated for POWER ON in the ACCUMULATED TIME window

ri
1: Value counted from the power-on timing
Time stamp used at the time of read/write

ll
F151 bit7 Value indicated for POWER ON in Value at #3001

.A
command to macro variable #3001
(power-on time) the ACCUMULATED TIME at the time the
F151

N
window at the time when the read power is turned

O
(bit 7) command to #3001 is specified on again

TI
0 Changed accordingly Not reset
16

1
A Not changed Reset to 0
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions Immediate [Related macro variable]


o.

#3040 : Power-on time in the ACCUMULATED TIME window (read only)


N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
K
ri

ZA

Fixed value (0)


Se

A
IM
K


ZA

F152
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Make SMART font display valid/invalid.


ig

0: Invalid
yr

1: Valid
op
C

SMART font display, valid/invalid


* This parameter is valid only when any language other than Japanese,
F153 Chinese (traditional/simplified), Korean, Russian or Bulgarian is
selected for the display language.

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-202
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Parameter for system internal setting


Setting prohibited

F154

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
Setting range —

re
Operation when argument I is omitted from the tap cycle command having

ts
argument Q

gh
0: Operation as a deep-hole cycle

ri
1: Operation as a high-speed deep-hole cycle

ll
Operation when argument I is omitted from

.A
the tap cycle command having argument Q
F155

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

The operating status and the switching of the drawing on the 3D


ri

ZA

MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with rotary axis


Se

movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid.


A
IM

The operating status and the drawing on


the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting
F156 bit 1
K

command associated with rotary axis


ZA

movement is specified with the automatic 0 1


F156
ISS valid
A

Continue operation with material cutting enabled


(bit 0) 0
M

only at the end position


YA

Continue operation Operation stopped


F156 bit 0 with material cutting with alarm message
3

Program type M, E
1 disabled 1139 ILLEGAL
01

Conditions Immediate COMMAND (SAFETY


)2

Unit — SHIELD) displayed


(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

The operating status and the switching of the drawing on the 3D


ig

MONITOR display when a cutting command associated with rotary axis


yr

movement is specified with the automatic ISS valid.


op

The operating status and the drawing on


C

the 3D MONITOR display when a cutting


command associated with rotary axis F156 bit 1
movement is specified with the automatic 0 1
F156
ISS valid Continue operation with material cutting enabled
(bit 1) 0
only at the end position
Continue operation Operation stopped
F156 bit 0 with material cutting with alarm message
Program type M, E
1 disabled 1139 ILLEGAL
Conditions Immediate COMMAND (SAFETY
Unit — SHIELD) displayed

Setting range 0, 1

2-203
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Separation between rotary axis and linear axis when moving axes during
workpiece placement error correction
0: Combine the movement of rotary axis and linear axis.
Separation between rotary axis and linear 1 : Separate the movement between rotary axis and linear axis.
axis when moving axes during workpiece
placement error correction
F156
(bit 2)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Selection of solution to workpiece placement error correction (primary

ts
rotary axis sign prioritized)

gh
0 : No priority according to the sign in the command (compliant with F162

ri
Selection of solution to workpiece bit 1)

ll
.A
placement error correction (primary rotary 1 : Priority according to the sign in the command in the program
axis sign prioritized)
F156

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Pitch division in the case when the arc length exceeds the maximum value
ri

ZA

during helical/spiral interpolation


Se

0: Invalid
IM

Pitch division in the case when the arc 1: Valid


length exceeds the maximum value during
K

helical/spiral interpolation
F156
ZA

Remark :
(bit 4)
A

Arc length [mm] = diameter [mm]    pitch [times]


M

Maximum arc length: 107374.1824 mm


YA

Program type E
* When this parameter is invalid, alarm 814 INTERPOLATION
3

Conditions Immediate
01

OVERFLOW will occur if the arc length has exceeded the maximum
Unit —
)2

length.
Setting range 0, 1
(c

Set a stop at the end of execution of a tool sequence block when the VFC
ht

key is pressed with override set to 100% during automatic operation.


ig

0: Single-block stop does not occur


yr
op

Single-block stop when the VFC key is 1: Single-block stop occurs


C

pressed with override set to 100%


F156
(bit 5)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-204
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)


F156
(bit 6)

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
Setting range —

re
Geometric deviation compensation function

ts
gh
0: Invalid

ri
1: Valid

ll
.A
Geometric deviation compensation function
F156

N
O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Fixed value (0)


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K

F157
ZA

(bit 0)
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c

The tolerance (chord error) specified function is made valid or invalid.


ht

0: Invalid
ig
yr

1: Valid
op

Geometry compensation/modal spline


C

tolerance (chord error), valid/invalid


F157
(bit 1)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-205
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Tip position memory setting in consideration of the tool length


compensation in the EIA tip position memory window on the WORK
OFFSET display when the MAZATROL tool length is not valid
0: Invalid
EIA tip position memory 1: Valid
F157
(bit 2) * This parameter is valid when parameter F30 is set to 0 and bit 3 of
parameter F93 is set to 0 (MAZATROL tool length invalid).

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
MAZATROL table selection unit (2 tables)

ll
.A
on the VIRTUAL MACHINING, 3D
MONITOR, or 3D SETUP display
F157

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

The direction of the set axes X/Z for the additional table of the machine
ri

ZA

model and that of the machine axes are:


Se

0: Opposite direction
IM

Switching of the axis directions for the VTC 1: Same direction


machine model on the VIRTUAL
K

MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display


ZA

F157
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Add-in EIA function


ig

0: Invalid
yr

1: Valid
op

Add-in EIA function


C

F157
(bit 5)

Program type E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-206
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Tool data check at tool length/tool radius compensation after ATC


operation.

0: Invalid
Tool length/tool diameter check function 1: Valid
after tool change
F158
Note :
(bit 0)
1. With F158 bit 0 = 1, if no tool data exists, the machine stops with the
alarm 193 NO TOOL IN MAGAZINE generated.
2. When F158 bit 0 = 1, if no tool data has been set with the

d .
Program type E

ve
MAZATROL tool diameter data enabled (F92 bit 7 = 1) or the
Conditions Immediate MAZATROL tool length data enabled (F93 bit 3 = 1), the machine

er
Unit — stops with the alarm 1107 INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA generated.

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Output timing of MSTB command after a movement command under

gh
geometry compensation

ri
0: Before completing axis movement

ll
Output timing of MSTB command after a

.A
1: After completing axis movement
movement command under geometry

N
compensation
F158

O
* When an MSTB command is specified in one of the consecutive cutting

TI
(bit 1) feed blocks such as G1 → G1M3, the operation will be equivalent to
16

that with F158 bit 1 = 0 and M3 will be output during movement initiated
A
R
04

by G1 before M3.
PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
K
ri

ZA

Selection of wear offset direction of MAZATROL tool data when the tool
Se

length compensation (G43P3) and 3D coordinate conversion (G68)


A

functions are used together, or during pinch-cutting/Y-axis turning in


IM

Selection of wear offset direction when the MAZATROL programs


tool length compensation (G43P3) and 3D
K

0: Actual axes (Machine coordinate system)


ZA

coordinate conversion functions are used


F158 together 1: Virtual axes (Program coordinate system)
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Set the timing of data creation for the MACHINING NAVIGATION -


ig

RESULT display when “1” is specified for both CONTI. and NUMBER
yr

items of the end unit (program repetition with workpiece counting made
op

valid).
Timing of data creation for the MACHINING
C

NAVIGATION - RESULT display with 0: At the end of the first piece machining
workpiece counting made valid
F159 1: At the end of the last piece machining
(bit 0)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-207
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Modal selection at power on or at reset


0: G64
1: G61.1
Modal selection at power on or at reset
(G64/G61.1)
F159
(bit 1)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

F159

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

Fixed value
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

F159
A

(bit 3)
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c
ht

When an output diagram is displayed for continuous rating in the spindle


load meter area of the POSITION display, a spindle output diagram
ig

registered in the setting file is:


yr
op

0: Not displayed
Whether or not to display on the POSITION (An output diagram is displayed using the values set with the
C

display a spindle output diagram stored in parameters SA67 to SA80.)


the setting file
F159 1: Displayed
(bit 4) (An output diagram is displayed using the values stored in the setting
file.)

Program type M, E Note :


Conditions Immediate This parameter is available only to models that allow the operator to
switch between load meter ratings and are capable of displaying a
Unit — spindle output diagram on the POSITION display.
Setting range 0, 1

2-208
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set how the feedrate is displayed on the POSITION screen during tool tip
point control.
0: Composite feedrate of the machine axes
1: Feedrate at the tool tip in reference to the workpiece
Feedrate display during tool tip point control
F160
(bit 1)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

F160

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

Priority when erasing the tool path from the TOOL PATH CHECK display
ri

ZA

or TRACE display
Se

0: Drawing first
IM

Priority change when erasing the tool path After the tool path is erased, the geometry will be drawn correctly.
from the TOOL PATH CHECK display or However, the tool path erasing time will be longer than that in the
K

TRACE display case when the setting value is “1”.


ZA

F160
1: Erasing time first
A

(bit 7)
M

The tool path erasing time will be shorter than that in the case when
the setting value is “0”. However, after the tool path is erased, the
YA

Program type M, E color of overlapping lines may change from the one before erasure.
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit — * The drawing color differs depending on the machine.


)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-209
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Lathing tool offset functions


76543210
Shape/wear offset number separation
0: Invalid
1: Valid
Shape offset handling
0: Coordinate shift
1: Tool movement
Tool offset timing
0: When move command is executed following

d .
T-code command

ve
1: When T-code command is executed

er
Tool offset vector handling if reset function is

s
executed

re
0: Vector cleared

ts
1: Vector not cleared

gh
Shape offset handling if offset number 0 is entered

ri
— 0: Offset cleared

ll
1: Offset not cleared

.A
F161 Simplified wear offset

N
0: Invalid

O
1: Valid

TI
C/Z offset when a MAZATROL program is called
16

A from an EIA program


R
04

0: C/Z offset set in the MAZATROL program is


PO
30

valid
1: C/Z offset set in the EIA program is valid
R
o.

O
N

C/Z offset when an EIA program is called from a


C

MAZATROL program
al

0: C/Z offset set in the EIA program is valid


ri

ZA

1: C/Z offset set in the MAZATROL program is


Se

valid
A
IM

F161 bit 0:
K

T command:
ZA

Program type M  For offset number separation


A

 is used for shape offset.  is used for wear offset.


M

Conditions Immediate
 For offset number non-separation
YA

Unit —
Offset number  is used for both shape offset and wear offset.
Setting range Binary, eight digits
3
01

During independent start of tool tip point control


)2

0: Movement according to the particular amount of offset


(c

1: No movement according to the particular amount of offset


ht

Movement/no movement according to the


ig

particular amount of offset during


yr

independent start of tool tip point control


F162
op

(bit 0)
C

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-210
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: The same primary rotary axis angle sign as that existing during the
start of tool tip point control is selected as the angle of the rotary axis
for implementing the tool axial vector specified during tool tip point
control.
Example :
B = positive B=0 B = positive

d .
B

ve
s er
re
C=0 C = 180

ts
1: The angle that provides a smaller amount of rotational movement of

gh
the secondary rotary axis on a singular point is selected as the angle
Type of passage of tool tip point through of the rotary axis for implementing the tool axial vector specified during

ri
singular point tool tip point control.

ll
F162 (Both positive and negative signs are available for the primary rotary

.A
(bit 1) axis.)

N
Example :

O
B = positive B=0 B = negative

TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA

C=0 C=0
Se

A
IM
K
ZA

Program type M, E
A

Conditions After stop of movement


M

Unit —
YA

Setting range 0, 1
3
01

Chamfer/corner R-command address selection


)2

0 : (I), (K), (R), (,R), (,C), (,A)


1 : (R), (C), (A)
(c
ht

Chamfer/corner R-command address


selection
ig

F162
yr
op

(bit 2)
C

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-211
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Fixed hole-machining cycle return selection


0: Initial point
1: R-point

Fixed hole-machining cycle return selection


F162
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movemen

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
6 digits in T-command for turning

ts
gh
0: Invalid

ri
1: Valid

ll
.A
6 digits in T-command for turning
F162

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Use of the M Pro scheme as the method of selecting the Length correction
ri

ZA

axis bit
Se

0: Invalid
IM

Use of the M Pro scheme as the method of 1: Valid


K

selecting the Length correction axis bit


F162
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

MAZATROL program check for missing Z-offset


ht

0: Valid
ig
yr

1: Invalid
op

MAZATROL program check for missing


C

Z-offset, valid/invalid
F162
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-212
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Encoder polarity selection


0: Pulse rate increase for forward rotation command
1: Pulse rate reduction for forward rotation command

Encoder polarity selection


F162
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
.A
Bar feeder scheduling function
F163

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Invalid
ri

ZA
Se

1: Valid
A
IM

Incorporation of wear offset data into the *1 This parameter is valid only for the models for which the G code type
current position display in EIA/ISO program
K

for machining centers (F30 = 0) is set and those equipped with the
mode, valid/invalid
ZA

F163 swivel type head.


*2 This parameter is valid in automatic operation and virtual machining,
A

(bit 1)
M

but not valid in tool path check.


YA

Program type E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

0: Invalid
ig

1: Valid
yr
op

Incorporation of wear offset data into the


C

current position display in MAZATROL


program mode, valid/invalid
F163
(bit 2)

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-213
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Position of thread turning tool nose on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display


0: Tool tip
1: Position measured using TOOL EYE
Position of thread turning tool nose on the
VIRTUAL MACHINING display
F163
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
Barrier check on the VIRTUAL

.A
MACHINING display valid/invalid
F163

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0 : Hidden
ri

ZA
Se

1 : Displayed
A
IM

Menu on the DATA I/O display (tape),


K

displayed/hidden
ZA

F163
A

(bit 6)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

0 : Hidden
ig

1 : Displayed
yr
op

Menu on the DATA I/O display (CMT),


C

displayed/hidden
F163
(bit 7)

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-214
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Enabled
1: Disabled

Automatic tool data setting conditions


Magazine (turret) tool
F164
(bit 0)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
When the layout has been saved on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display, the

gh
saved layout is retained or not if the WNo. is changed on the PROGRAM
display or the program is edited.

ri
0: Do not retain

ll
PROGRAM LAYOUT display save function

.A
selection 1: Retain
F164

N
O
(bit 2) Note :

TI
When F164 bit 2 = 1, the priority number cannot be written in the save
16

A
enabled status. The priority number cannot be written when the WNo.
R
04

Program type M on the PROGRAM display is changed in the save enabled status.
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Enabled
ri

ZA
Se

1: Disabled
A
IM

Automatic tool data setting conditions


K

Invalid tools
ZA

F164
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Enabled
ig

1: Disabled
yr
op
C

Automatic tool data setting conditions


Broken tools
F164
(bit 5)

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-215
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Enabled
1: Disabled

Automatic tool data setting conditions


Expired tools
F164
(bit 6)

.
M

d
Program type

ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Enabled

gh
1: Disabled

ri
ll
.A
Automatic tool data setting conditions
Life warning tools

N
F164

O
TI
(bit 7)
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M
R

Conditions After stop of movement


o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-216
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210
High-speed synchronous tapping function
0: Valid
1: Invalid
X-axis movement to minus side during polar
coordinate interpolation
0: Enabled
1: Disabled
Polar coordinate interpolation of the C-axis

d .
0: Specification in terms of radius value

ve
1: Specification in terms of diameter value

er
C-axis indexing when EIA subprogram is called

s
from MAZATROL program

re
0: Not executed

ts
1: Executed

gh
Modal or non-modal state of Q command in

ri
deep-hole drilling cycle

ll
0: Modal

.A
1: Non-modal

N
Conversion of tool set data for milling tool based on

O
— head swivel angle when G53.5 is commanded

TI
16

A 0: Disabled
F165 1: Enabled
R
04

PO
30

Behavior of automatic operation of an EIA program


when Z-offset is not set
R
o.

0: Z-offset = 0
N

1: Alarm stop
al

Setting at CONTI. of the END unit during tool path


ri

ZA

check
Se

0: Invalid
IM

1: Valid
Supplemental explanation of F165 Bit 4
K
ZA

This bit is used to select whether the depth of infeed per pass (address Q
command) in deep-hole drilling cycles (G83, G283, and G287 for G-code
A

series M; G83 and G87 for G-code series A) is modal or non-modal.


M

0: Modal
YA

The modal value is used if the Q command is not specified. If the


modal value of the Q command is 0 (typically, in cases where the Q
3
01

setting is omitted in the initial deep-hole drilling cycle command), or if


the Q value is set to 0, an alarm 809 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT
)2

occurs.
(c

1: Non-modal
ht

Program type M If the Q setting is omitted, or if the Q value is set to 0, the workpiece is
ig

Conditions After stop of movement cut to the preset infeed depth in a single pass.
yr

Unit —
op

Setting range Binary, eight digits


C

2-217
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Possible
1: Impossible

Alteration of tool set value (tool length) on


the TOOL DATA display in the automatic
operation mode,
F166 enabled/disabled
(bit 0)

.
M, E

d
Program type

ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Cutting edge offset

gh
1: Wear offset

ri
ll
.A
Type of wear offset indicated in the milling
tool list on the TOOL DATA display

N
F166

O
TI
(bit 1)
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
R

Conditions After stop of movement


o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
ri

ZA

0: IDNo.
Se

1: Name
IM
K

ID No./Tool name selection on the TOOL


ZA

DATA display
F166
A
M

(bit 2)
YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig

0: Same plane
yr

1: Retain independent plane


op
C

Selection whether the selected plane on the


TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK display is
to be held
F166
(bit 3)

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-218
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Retain search complete status


1: Cancel search results

Operation conducted when the [RESTART]


menu item is tapped following the
completion of the search in EIA modal
F166 restarting mode
(bit 4)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Automatic adjustment to nominal diameter

gh
1: No automatic adjustment

ri
ll
Tool diameter auto-setting for the end mill,

.A
face mill, and ball end mill on the TOOL
DATA display

N
F166

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Invalid
Se

1: Valid
A
IM
K

Automatic backup function


ZA

F166
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-219
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Threading (by turning) shift angle (Q-command) unit
0: 1/1000° 1: 1°
Handling the diameter/radius of point R during the
hole-machining fixed cycle
0: Based on the settings for the X-axis
1: Fixed at the radius value
Handling the tool measured using the G137H
command
0: Regarding the tool as broken

d .
1: Not regarding the tool as broken

ve
Handling the single-process mode when operation

er
— is completed/reset

s
0: Not holding the mode

re
F167 1: Holding the mode

ts
If the arc internal correction value is greater than

gh
the arc radius

ri
0: Connecting the path linearly

ll
1: Regarding the status as an alarm

.A
Handling the X-axis command in G68.5

N
0: Radius value

O
1: Diameter value

TI
Wear correction direction in the lathe-based
16

A machine model
R
04

0: Actual axis direction


PO

1: Virtual axis direction


30

Program type M
R

Updating the current position by a press of the


o.

Conditions After stop of movement RESET key in manual operation mode


N

Unit — 0: Valid 1: Invalid


al

Setting range Binary, eight digits


ri

ZA
Se

Axis movement at the time when dynamic offset II is canceled (G54.2P0)


A
IM

0: Perform
1: Do not perform
K

Selection of operation to perform when


ZA

dynamic offset II is canceled


A

F168
M

(bit 0)
YA
3

Program type E
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig

Select whether the rotational center offset is to be added to the tool length
yr

when the tool axial tool length offset command (G43.1) is issued
op

F168 (bit 2) = 0:
C

Rotational center offset is added/not added


Offset is added.
to the tool length when the tool axial tool
length offset command (G43.1) is issued F168 (bit 2) = 1:
F168
(bit 2) Offset is not added.

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-220
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Select axis for the milling tool wear correction and TOOL EYE
compensation amount for the B-axis rotational turret.

F168 (bit 3) = 0:
Axis for the milling tool wear correction and
Virtual axis
TOOL EYE compensation amount for the
B-axis rotational turret F168 (bit 3) = 1:
F168
(bit 3) Actual axis

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Convert the 3D coordinate conversion (G68/G68.5) into inclined-surface

gh
machining (G68.2 or G68.4).

ri
0: Invalid

ll
Conversion of 3D coordinate conversion 1: Valid

.A
into inclined-surface machining
F168

N
* When G68 is replaced with G68.2 (or G68.4) by setting bit 4 of

O
(bit 4) parameter F168 to 1, 5-axis machining function (inclined-surface

TI
machining, workpiece placement error correction) can be used at the
16

A
same time.
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Select whether to hold the amount of shift in spite of pressing the RESET
ri

ZA

key when manual handle pulse interruption is valid.


Se

F168 (bit 5) = 0:
IM

Holding the amount of manual handle pulse Hold


K

interruption
ZA

F168 F168 (bit 5) = 1:


No hold (M640T compatible mode)
A

(bit 5)
M

The same operation as that of the M640T can be selected. This parameter
YA

is valid when F95 bit 6 = 0 (holds the amount of manual handle pulse
Program type M, E interruption, in spite of the RESET key operation/M30/M02).
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Select whether [RESTART2 NONMODAL] during stop of an EIA program


execution is to be made valid or invalid.
ig
yr

F168 (bit 6) = 0:
op

[RESTART2 NONMODAL] during stop of Invalid


C

an EIA program execution invalid/valid


F168 F168 (bit 6) = 1:
(bit 6) Valid

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-221
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Whether to allow for groove/protrusion width measurement the selection


of a correction pattern which assumes that both ends of the groove or
protrusion are machined with the same tool

Correction pattern for groove/ protrusion F168 (bit 7) = 0:


width measurement Impossible to select the correction pattern
F168
F168 (bit 7) = 1:
(bit 7)
Possible to select the correction pattern

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Rapid feed overlapping function

gh
0 : Invalid

ri
1 : Valid

ll
.A
Rapid feed overlapping function
F169

N
O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

The function to restart machine operation after the detection of collision by


ri

ZA

the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function


Se

0 : Invalid
IM

The function to restart machine operation 1 : Valid


after the detection of collision by the
K

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function


ZA

F169
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Fixed value (0)


ig
yr
op


C

F169
(bit 3)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-222
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Handling of smooth corner control setting width when G61.1 is specified in


MAZATROL programs
0: Handle as 0 without referring to parameter F270
Handling of smooth corner control setting 1: Refer to parameter F270
width when G61.1 is specified in
MAZATROL programs
F169 [Related parameters]
(bit 4) F270: Smooth corner control function setting width

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Calling of the program specified in the end unit upon reaching the target

ts
part count

gh
0: Not called

ri
Calling of the program specified in the end 1: Called (compatible with T PLUS/M640T/M640MT/M640MTPro)

ll
.A
unit upon reaching the target part count,
enabled/disabled
F169

N
O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Fixed value (0)


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K

F169
ZA

(bit 7)
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c

Consideration of offset amount of dynamic offsetting II at the current


ht

position
ig

0: Considered
yr
op

Consideration of the offset amount of 1: Not considered


C

dynamic offsetting II at the current position


F170
(bit 0)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-223
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Reflecting the tool offset changed in an EIA program in a tool path check
0: Does not reflect
1: Reflects
Tool offset changed in an EIA program in a
tool path check
F170
(bit 2)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Continuous diameter display of the X-axis coordinate on the POSITION,

ts
TRACE, TOOL PATH CHECK, 3D MONITOR and VIRTUAL

gh
MACHINING displays, and diameter value input in the X-axis direction for

ri
tip position memory on the TOOL DATA display

ll
0: Invalid

.A
1: Valid

N
Continuous diameter display of the X-axis

O
coordinates on the displays/Diameter value Note :

TI
input in the X-axis direction for tip position 1. F170 bit 3 is enabled only when F82 bit 4 is set to 1. When the
16

F170 memory on the TOOL DATA display A


diameter display is enabled, the coordinates are displayed in
R
04

(bit 3) diameters even in the milling mode.


PO
30

F82 bit 4 0 1
R
o.

F170 bit 3 0 1 0 1
O
N

Turning mode Radius Radius Diameter Diameter


al

K
ri

Milling mode Radius Radius Radius Diameter


ZA

Program type M, E
Se

Conditions Immediate
A

2. Diameter value input in the X-axis direction for tip position memory
IM

Unit — on the TOOL DATA display is enabled only when F170 bit 3 and
Setting range 0, 1 F82 bit 4 are set to 1.
K
ZA

Inclusion of the MAZATROL tool length in the tool length offset displayed
on the POSITION screen
A
M

0: Not included
YA

Inclusion of the MAZATROL tool length in 1: Included


the tool length offset displayed on the
3

POSITION screen
F170
01

Note :
)2

(bit 4) Bit 4 of F170 is used only for machining centers.


(c
ht

Program type E
ig

Conditions Immediate
yr

Unit —
op

Setting range 0, 1
C

2-224
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Select the parameter setting range when the inertia estimation/parameter


setting G codes (G297/G298) are specified with address P omitted.
0: All axes in all systems (same operation as when P0 specified)

Operation when address P is omitted in 1: All axes in the specified systems (same operation as when P1
G297/G298 command specified)
2: Specified axes in specified systems (same operation as when P2
F241 specified)
Other than above: Displaying alarm 807 ILLEGAL FORMAT

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 32768 to 32767

re
Fixed value

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A

N
F269

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

Set the setting width used when the Smooth corner control function is
ri

ZA

valid.
Se

The value set at this parameter is used when the R command is not
IM

specified with the G61.1 or G61.2 command.


Smooth corner control function:
K

Setting width
ZA

* When the set value is modified, the new value is made valid when
F270 G61.1 or G61.2 is executed after the modification.
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 999999


(c

Set the arc cutting clamp speed coefficient used when the Smooth corner
ht

control function is valid.


ig
yr
op

Smooth corner control function:


C

Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient

F271

Program type M, E [Related parameters]


Conditions Immediate F2

Unit %
Setting range 0 to 500

2-225
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Sets the arc cutting clamp speed coefficient used when both the smooth
corner control function and the high-speed smooth control function are
enabled.
Smooth corner control function:
Arc cutting clamp speed coefficient for
high-speed smooth control
F272

Program type M, E [Related parameters]

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate F9

er
Unit %

s
Setting range 0 to 500

re
Set the Smooth corner control function cancellation angle.

ts
gh
Corner deceleration is not performed at a point where two blocks are
joined at an angle smaller than the angle obtained by the following math

ri
calculation.

ll
Smooth corner control function:

.A
Cancellation angle
Cancellation angle = F273  Number of feed axes/2

N
F273

O
TI
* If “0” is set, default operation applies.
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit °
O
N

Setting range 0 to 90
al

Sets the ratio of the cutting feedrate in the tool axial direction with respect
ri

ZA

to the feedrate F specified in the program, used during execution of the


Se

EIA/ISO engraving function.


A
IM

Cutting feedrate override rate in the tool Cutting feedrate in the tool axial direction F’ = F  F274/100
axial direction for the EIA/ISO engraving When 0 is set, 100 is assumed.
K

function
ZA

If 999 or greater is set, 999 is assumed.


F274
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit %
)2

Setting range 0 to 999


(c

Sets the character depth used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving
ht

function if specification of the depth (address D) is omitted in the program.


ig

When a value smaller than 0 is set, 0 is assumed.


yr
op

Character depth for the EIA/ISO engraving


C

function

F275

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-226
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Sets the character height used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving
function if specification of the height (address H) is omitted in the program.

Character height for the EIA/ISO engraving When a value smaller than 0 is set, 0 is assumed.
function When 0 is set, the alarm 1914 TEXT HEIGHT INVALID OF ENGRAV.
occurs.
F276

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
Setting range 0 to 99999999

re
Sets the retract height used during execution of the EIA/ISO engraving

ts
function if specification of the retraction height (address R) is omitted in

gh
the program.

ri
When a value smaller than 0 is set, 0 is assumed.

ll
Retraction height for the EIA/ISO engraving

.A
function

N
F277

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Set the cutting accuracy to be taken into consideration for the


ri

ZA

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function during automatic operation.


Se

A
IM

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD:


K

Cutting accuracy
ZA

F300
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit 0.0001 mm
)2

Setting range 1000 to 20000


(c

Set the tool path accuracy to be taken into consideration for the collision
ht

check processing by the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function.


ig
yr

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD:


op

Tool path accuracy for collision check


C

processing
F301

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range 1000 to 20000

2-227
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Set the allowance when stopping axis feed above the previously reached
depth for the execution of a deep-hole boring cycle or a cycle shown
below.
G85/G285, G89/G289, G75, G76, G78, G79, G86, G88, G89

Allowance in rapid feed stop in deep-hole


boring cycle G00
F302
G00 feed rate  D131/100
F302

.
G01

d
ve
Program type M, E F302

s er
Conditions Immediate

re
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

ts
Setting range 0 to 99999

gh
Sets the feed rate per minute for G01 re-entry for a deep-hole boring cycle

ri
or for G85/G285, G89/G289, G75, G76, G78, G79, G86, G88 and G89.

ll
.A
N
G01 feed-in speed for deep-hole boring Note :

O
cycle If “0” or a value outside the setting range is set, re-entry is executed at

TI
the machining feed rate.
16

F303 A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
o.

O
N

Conditions Immediate
C
al

Unit 1 mm/min / 1 in/min


K
ri

ZA

Setting range 0 to 99999


Se

Sets the wait time when an alarm is detected during restarting search
IM

initiated by pressing [CUT] during VIRTUAL MACHINING.


When an alarm has been detected, the restarting search is resumed if the
K

alarm is canceled within the set wait time or stopped with alarm 2120
ZA

Alarm wait time during [CUT] restarting RESTART PT SEARCH INTERRUPTED generated if it is not canceled
search during VIRTUAL MACHINING
A

even after the wait time has elapsed.


M

F304
YA

When this parameter is set to “0”, the wait time is 10 seconds.


3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit ms
ht

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ig
yr
op
C

2-228
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

When an incremental feed command of 720 (two turns) or greater is


specified for a rotary type rotary axis, the feed amount of the rotary axis is
rounded to one turn + a fraction (remainder obtained by dividing the
specified feed amount by 360).
Rounding the feed amount increases the speed of the interference check
during automatic operation intelligent safety shield (ISS)/virtual
machining.
The rounding process can be enabled/disabled as follows.
0: Rounding process for rotary axes disabled
1: Rounding process for rotary axes enabled in interference check during

d .
automatic ISS

ve
2: Rounding process for rotary axes enabled in interference check during

er
automatic ISS and in virtual machining

s
re
Automatic operation intelligent safety shield

ts
(ISS)/virtual machining interference check Example :

gh
selection Change in machining shape due to rounding process with respect to the

ri
F326 ZC plane

ll
.A
Before applying the After applying the
rounding process rounding process

N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

Cutting path in C-axis line machining


O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA

Note :
Se

Program type M, E Applying the rounding process to two or more axes including a rotary
IM

axis may change the cutting shape and cause interference. Therefore,
Conditions Immediate restrict the use of this parameter to machining in which no interference
K

Unit — will be caused due to influence of the rounding process.


ZA

Setting range 0 to 2
A

Number of buffers for calculating the average of optimum time constants


M
YA

Note :
Real time tuning II Number of buffers for
3

When a value outside the setting range is set, 3 is assumed.


01

calculating the average of optimum time


constants
)2

F328
(c
ht
ig

M, E
yr

Program type
op

Conditions Immediate
C

Unit —
Setting range 1-5

2-229
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Used to select the operation when an undefined SMC data number or an


SMC data number outside the permissible range has been specified with
an SMC data specification command (G61.1P) in EIA/ISO programs.
0: Continue operation without changing the SMC data number with the
Operation at specification of undefined alarm 965 DESIGNATED PNo NOT FOUND displayed.
SMC data number Note, however, if this alarm is generated during a tool path check, the
F329 tool path check operation stops.
(bit 0) 1: Stop operation with the alarm 964 DESIGNATED PNo NOT FOUND
displayed.

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether the M codes related to spindle rotation are to be

gh
automatically output when executing the smooth restart function.
0: Output automatically

ri
ll
1: Do not output automatically

.A
Automatic M code output for smooth restart
F329

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Select the operation of the axes for which no movement is specified in the
ri

ZA

program when returning the axes to the restarting position for the smooth
Se

restart function.
A
IM

0: Move the axes for which no movement is specified in the program to


Operation to return to the restarting position the machine zero point.
K

for smooth restart


F329 1: Do not move the axes for which no movement is specified in the
ZA

program to the machine zero point.


(bit 4)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Switches the hobbing mode between standard hobbing and hobbing II.
ht
ig

0: Hobbing
yr

1: Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)


op

Hobbing selection
C

F330
(bit 0)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-230
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Selects the clamping speed of the hobbing axis (V-axis) in hobbing II.
0: Clamping at the rapid feed rate (parameter M1)
1: Clamp at the cutting feed rate (parameter M3).
Hobbing axis (V-axis) clamping speed
selection in hobbing II (position controlled
hobbing)
F330
(bit 1)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Selects whether to display the machine coordinates of the hobbing axis

ts
(V-axis) and workpiece spindle (C-axis) in hobbing II.

gh
0: Not displayed

ri
Machine coordinate display of hobbing axis 1: Displayed

ll
.A
(V-axis) and workpiece spindle (C-axis) in
hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)
F330

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Counting of use count and time of use for multiple tools with the same tool
ri

ZA

number and different tool names


Se

0: Invalid
IM

Life count for multiple tools with the same 1: Valid


K

tool number and different tool names


F330
ZA

* This parameter is enabled when parameter F113 bit 0 = 1 (counting all


(bit 7) types of use under the same tool number for the tool life management
A

on the TOOL DATA display).


M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Synchronized tapping feed command mode


ht

0: Feed per minute


ig
yr

1: According to the modal mode at the time of execution


op

Synchronized tapping feed command mode


C

F331
(bit 1)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-231
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

Method of calculation of safe spindle speed


0: Use tool diameter
1: Use nominal diameter

Safe spindle speed calculation


* This parameter is valid only with the tool name method.
F331
* For the tools that do not have a tool diameter specified, the nominal
(bit 3) diameter is used for calculation.

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Shape sequence specification at restart in a MAZATROL program

ts
gh
0: Invalid

ri
1: Valid

ll
Shape sequence specification at restart in

.A
a MAZATROL program The shape sequence can be specified only for point machining units or
F331

N
the C-axis point machining unit.

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Selects whether or not to output alarm 822 ILLEGAL MODAL upon


ri

ZA

specification of shaping (G41.1/G42.1) in the geometry compensation


Se

mode (G61.1).
A
IM

Outputting alarm upon specification of 0: Invalid


shaping (G41.1/G42.1) in the geometry 1: Valid
K

compensation mode (G61.1)


F331
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Action to take when the part count is set using the program (#3901,
ht

#3902) during automatic operation with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY


ig

SHIELD (ISS) enabled for automatic operation


yr

Action to take when the part count is set


0: Follow the setting of parameter F143 bit 0 (operation upon overwriting
op

using the program with the INTELLIGENT


the part count during automatic operation with IIS enabled).
SAFETY SHIELD enabled for automatic
C

F335 operation 1: Set the part count and continue automatic operation with ISS enabled.
(bit 7)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
[Related parameters]
Unit —
F143bit0
Setting range 0, 1

2-232
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title EIA/ISO

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Variable acceleration control G0


F336
(bit 2)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Variable acceleration control

ts
gh
0 : Invalid

ri
1 : Valid

ll
.A
Variable acceleration control
F336

N
O
(bit 6)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Super-high-speed machining
ri

ZA
Se

0 : Invalid
A

1 : Valid
IM

Super-high-speed machining
K

* This parameter is valid only when the high-speed smooth control


F336
ZA

function is valid.
(bit 7)
A

* When the set value is modified, the new value is made valid when
M

G61.1 or G61.2 is executed after the modification.


YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-233
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-5 User parameter SOFT LIMIT (I)

Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description


The amount and direction of shift from the final setting position during
unidirectional positioning of the point-machining or during execution of
G60.
I1 < 0: Positioning in minus direction
I1 > 0: Positioning in plus direction
Example : +y
Shift amount of unidirectional positioning
(G60) Machine coordinate system
Shift amount
I1 +x

.
I1

d
ve
ser
re
Final setting position MPL091
Program type M, E

ts
Note :

gh
Conditions After stop of movement
For the axes which operate in submicrons in the case of submicron

ri
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit machine specifications, the setting unit of this parameter is reduced to
(0.0001°)

ll
1/10 times.

.A
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

N
The parameter used to define the machine working zone in order to

O
prevent machine interference with the workpiece or jigs. Set the

TI
coordinate values of the machine coordinate system.
16

Example :
A
R
04

PO

Upper (plus direction) user soft-limit


30

+Y Machine
R

coordinate system
o.

I2 M8
N

(Y-axis) +X
al

I3 (X-axis)
K
ri

ZA
Se

Program type M, E
A

M9
Conditions After stop of movement
IM

(Y-axis)
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in I2 (X-axis)
Unit
K

(0.0001°)
ZA

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


A
M

M9 (X-axis) M8 (X-axis)
YA

Manufacturer soft-limit MPL092


3
01

Lower (minus direction) user soft-limit


)2

If the machine is likely to overstep its working zone, an alarm will occur
(c

I3 and the machine will stop.


ht

Note :
ig

1. These parameters are valid only when bit 2 of I14 is 0.


yr

Program type M, E
2. These parameters are invalid if I2 = I3.
op

Conditions After stop of movement


3. For the axes which operate in submicrons in the case of submicron
C

0.0001 mm/0.00001 in machine specifications, the setting unit of this parameter is reduced
Unit
(0.0001°) to 1/10 times.
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-234
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description

Override
(%)

Function for making the G0 speed variable


Variable override: Minimum value 100
I5
50
I5
Program type M, E
0

d .
Conditions Immediate Axis position

ve
I9 I7 I8
Unit %

er
I10

s
Setting range 0 to 100

re
Note :

ts
1. When I7 = 0, the G0 speed variable control function is invalid.

gh
2. When I8 = 0, the variable control area width (upper limit side and

ri
lower limit side) is determined by parameter I7.

ll
.A
Function for making the G0 speed variable Override

N
Variable control area (lower limit side) (%)

O
TI
I7
16

100
A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E 50
o.

I5
N

Conditions Immediate
C

0
al

0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
K

Unit I9 I7 I8 Axis position


ri

(0.0001°)
ZA
Se

Setting range 0 to 99999999 I10


A
IM

Note :
1. When I7 = 0, the G0 speed variable control function is invalid.
K
ZA

2. When I8 = 0, the variable control area width (upper limit side and
lower limit side) is determined by parameter I7.
A
M

Function for making the G0 speed variable, Override


YA

Variable control area (upper limit side) (%)


3

I8
01
)2

100
(c
ht

Program type M, E 50
ig

Conditions Immediate I5
yr

0
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
op

Unit I9 I7 Axis position


(0.0001°) I8
C

Override

Setting range 0 to 99999999 I10 A xis position

2-235
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description

Override
(%)

Function for making the G0 speed variable


Variable control area lower limit
100
I9
50
Program type M, E I5
0

d .
Conditions Immediate
Axis position

ve
I9 I7 I8
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

er
I10
Setting range 0 to 99999999

s
re
Override

ts
gh
(%)

ri
Function for making the G0 speed variable

ll
Variable control area upper limit

.A
100
I10

N
O
50

TI
16

Program type M, E I5A


0
R
04

Conditions Immediate
PO

I9 I7 I8 Axis position
30

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


R

I10
o.

Setting range 0 to 99999999


O
N

Set the rotary center of a workpiece at a table angle of 0° for each axis in
al

the machine coordinate system. (Valid only with dynamic offset function
ri

ZA

and in manual operation)


Se

Rotary center of a workpiece


IM

I11
K
ZA

Note :
A

Program type E
M

For the axes which operate in submicrons in the case of submicron


Conditions After stop of movement
YA

machine specifications, the setting unit of this parameter is reduced to


Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in 1/10 times.
3
01

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


)2

Set the clamping value for the amount of handle interruption.


(c
ht
ig

Clamping value for the amount of handle


yr

interruption
op

I12
C

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-236
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description

Execution of G28 (reference-point return)


0: Memory-type zero-point return
1: Watchdog-type zero-point return
Zero-point return mode when G28
(reference-point return) is specified
I13
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Manual zero-point return operation

gh
0: Memory-type zero-point return (After power-on, however,

ri
watchdog-type zero-point return)

ll
1: Watchdog-type zero-point return

.A
Manual zero-point return operation

N
I13

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.


O

Unit
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Display of a removed axis


ZA
Se

0: Not displayed
A
IM

1: Displayed

Axis display when a control axis is removed


K
ZA

I13
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Removal of control axes


ig

0: Not removed
yr

1: Removed
op
C

Removal of control axes, valid/invalid


I13
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-237
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Mirror image with respect to the machine
zero-point
0: Invalid
1: Valid
User software limits (I2, I3)
— 0: Valid
1: Invalid
I14
Tool-tip relief after spindle orientation during

d .
execution of G75, G76, G86 or point-machining

ve
(boring or back-boring)

er
0: Required

s
1: Not required

re
Program type M, E Direction of the relief mentioned above

ts
0: Plus

gh
Conditions After stop of movement 1: Minus

ri
Unit —

ll
Setting range Binary, eight digits

.A
Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the

N
FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the

O
workpiece transfer unit (with work hand angle of 0°).

TI
16

X A X
Automatically calculated workpiece position
R
04

Amount of work hand rotational error Z Y


PO

correction (Work hand angle: 0°) Actual workpiece position


30

I17
R
o.

O
N

C
al

I17 (X)
ri

ZA

Program type M, E
Se

Conditions After stop of movement I17 (Z) I17 (Y)


IM

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
K

Setting range –32768 to 32767


ZA

Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the
A

FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the
M

workpiece transfer unit (with work hand angle of 45°).


YA

X Automatically calculated workpiece position X


Amount of work hand rotational error Z
Actual workpiece position Y
3

correction (Work hand angle: 45°)


01

I18
)2
(c

I18 (X)
ht

Program type M, E
ig

After stop of movement


yr

Conditions I18 (Z) I17 (Y)


op

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


C

Setting range –32768 to 32767 (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)

2-238
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOFT LIMIT

Address Meaning Description

Enter the error between the zero point of the actual workpiece and the
FRM zero point that has been automatically calculated as a result of the
workpiece transfer unit (with work hand angle of 90°).
X Automatically calculated workpiece position X
Amount of work hand rotational error Z Actual workpiece position Y
correction (Work hand angle: 90°)

I19 I19 (X)

d .
Program type M, E I19 (Z)

ve
I19 (Y)
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
(Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
Setting range –32768 to 32767

ts
Specify the position of the fixed point which is used when 9 is specified in

gh
parameter SU10 or that [USER 1 (I21)] is specified in “Change position” of

ri
the manual program unit.

ll
.A
Fixed point 1 specified by the user

N
O
I21

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M
30

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


C
al

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


K
ri

ZA

Specify the position of the fixed point which is used when 9 is specified in
Se

parameter SU10 or that [USER 2 (I22)] is specified in “Change position” of


A
IM

the manual program unit.


K

Fixed point 2 specified by the user


ZA
A

I22
M
YA
3

Program type M
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(c

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-239
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-6 User parameter SYSTEM (SU)

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Axis setting for selecting the plane used in circular interpolation, cutter
radius compensation, tool nose radius compensation, cylindrical
interpolation and polar coordinate interpolation.
Base axis Parallel axis 1 Parallel axis 2
Axis setting I for plane selection
I SU1 SU2 SU3
SU1 J SU4 SU5 SU6
K SU7 SU8 SU9

d .
Enter the ASCII code for the axis name as a decimal number for the

ve
Program type M, E parameters.

er
Conditions After stop of movement (Example: 88 for the X-axis)

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 0 to 255 When a plane selection command (G17, G18, G19) is specified, the

gh
horizontal and vertical axes are determined according to the axis address
specified in the same block as the plane selection command.

ri
When there are multiple axis addresses that can be candidates for the

ll
.A
horizontal and vertical axes of the plane, the axes are selected in this
order of priority: “base axis > parallel axis 1 > parallel axis 2”. If there are

N
Axis setting I for plane selection
no axis addresses that can be candidates for the horizontal and vertical

O
axes specified in the same block as the plane selection command, the

TI
SU2
base axes are selected.
16

A
R
04

PO

The G17 plane takes I in the above table as the horizontal axis and J as
30

Program type M, E
the vertical axis.
R

Conditions After stop of movement


o.

The G18 plane takes K in the above table as the horizontal axis and I as
N

Unit —
C

the vertical axis.


al

Setting range 0 to 255 The G19 plane takes J in the above table as the horizontal axis and K as
ri

ZA

the vertical axis.


Se

A
IM
K

Axis setting I for plane selection


ZA

SU3
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.


ig
yr
op

Axis setting J for plane selection


C

SU4

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 255

2-240
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.

Axis setting J for plane selection

SU5

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.

gh
ri
ll
.A
Axis setting J for plane selection

N
SU6

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0 to 255


al

For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Axis setting K for plane selection


K
ZA

SU7
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 255


(c
ht

For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.


ig
yr
op

Axis setting K for plane selection


C

SU8

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 255

2-241
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

For details, refer to the explanation of parameters SU1 to SU3.

Axis setting K for plane selection

SU9

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-242
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Selection of tool change command output Specify tool change command output position from [0] through [10] below.
position
M5 Z-axis

[6] [1] [3] I21/I22 Z-axis Zc : Stock material edge projection length
Dmax : Stock material maximum outside
diameter
x : Tool turning clearance (X-axis) SU50
M5 X-axis
Machine zero point + B-axis spindle edge offset value
[4] BA62
+ Spindle tool length
z : Tool turning clearance (Z-axis) SU51

d .
Fixed point

ve
[5] [0] [2]

er
I21/I22 X-axis

s
[9/10]

re
x

ts
[7] [8]

gh
User-specified

ri
Dmax fixed point 1/2

ll
.A
Setting X-axis Z-axis

N
Zc z 0 Clearance position Clearance position

O
1 Machine zero point Clearance position

TI
16

2 Clearance position Machine zero point


3
A Machine zero point Machine zero point
R
04

PO

4 Fixed point Fixed point


SU10
30

5 Clearance position End point of previous machining


R
o.

6 Machine zero point End point of previous machining


O
N

7 End point of previous machining Clearance position


C
al

8 End point of previous machining Machine zero point


K
ri

9 User-specified fixed point 1 User-specified fixed point 1


ZA
Se

10 User-specified fixed point 2 User-specified fixed point 2


A
IM

Note :
K

1. SU10 = 5 or 6, Z-axis tool change command output position is


ZA

identical with the end point of previous machining. In the case


below, however, this may not be applied.
A

As shown here, if the longest tool comes into the hatched portion,
M

the position will escape in Z-axis direction by the distance


YA

determined by SU51.
3
01
)2

SU51
(c
ht
ig

Stock material
Stock material edge protrusion
yr

length length
op

Program type M
C

Conditions Immediate 2. The turret type of turret conducts tool turning at the tool change
Unit — command output position. The ATC type of turret moves from the
tool change command output position to the ATC position.
Setting range 0 to 10

2-243
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Selection of tool change command output Specify tool change command output position from [0] through [11] below.
position

INTEGREX e-H I21/I22 Z-axis Zc : Stock material edge projection length


[11] 3rd zero point Dmax : Stock material maximum outside
diameter
M5 Z-axis x : Tool turning clearance (X-axis) SU50
M6 [6] [1] [3] + B-axis spindle edge offset value BA62
X-axis + Spindle tool length
M5 z : Tool turning clearance (Z-axis) SU51
X-axis [4]
Machine zero point
I21/I22

.
[2]

d
[5] [0] X-axis

ve
User-specified
[9/10]

er
fixed point 1/2
2nd zero point

s
x

re
[7] [8]

ts
Setting X-axis Z-axis

gh
0 Clearance position Clearance position
Dmax
1 Machine zero point Clearance position

ri
2 Clearance position Machine zero point

ll
3 Machine zero point Machine zero point

.A
Zc z
4 2nd zero point 2nd zero point
3rd zero point

N
End point of previous
5 Clearance position

O
machining

TI
INTEGREX e-V M6 End point of previous
6 Machine zero point
16

X-axis A machining
I21/I22
R
End point of previous
04

X-axis Machine 7 Clearance position


machining
PO

M5 zero point
30

X-axis End point of previous


8 Machine zero point
[8] [2] [3] machining
R
o.

User-specified fixed User-specified fixed


N

I21/I22 9
M5 point 1 point 1
C

Z-axis [4]
Z-axis
al

SU10 User-specified fixed User-specified fixed


K

10
[9/10] point 2 point 2
ri

ZA

End point of previous


Se

User-specified 11 3rd zero point


machining
A

fixed point 1/2 2nd zero point


IM

[7] [0] [1]


K

z
ZA

[11] Note :
A

[5] [6] 1. Do not set SU10 = 4 with machines equipped with an


M

ATC mechanism. Since some models have an ATC


Zc position that is specified as the second zero point
YA

inside the ATC cover or the software limit range, this


Dmax x setting can cause a collision with the ATC cover or
3

hitting the software limit.


01

2. Since x in the case of SU10 = 0, 2, or 5 includes


spindle tool length, if the tool is too long (as in the
)2

case of a long boring bar), the tool change operation


(c

may be software-limited in the +X direction.


3. SU10 = 5 or 6, Z-axis tool change command output
ht

position is identical with the end point of previous


ig

machining. In the case below, however, this may not


be applied.
yr

As shown here, if the longest tool comes into the


op

hatched portion, the position will escape in Z-axis


direction by the distance determined by SU51.
C

SU51

Program type M
Stock material
Conditions Immediate Stock material edge protrusion
length length
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 11

2-244
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Specify the types of axes to be simultaneously moved when approaching


the tool to the next machining area.
0: Three axes (X, Y, Z) move at the same time.
1: After Z-axis movement, the X-axis and the Y-axis move at the same
time.
Movement of axes during approach Note :
When PINCHCUT HOLDER or Y TURN. HOLDER is used either of the
SU11 following movements can be specified.
0: After Y-axis movement, the X-axis and the Z-axis move at the same
time.

d .
ve
1: The Y-axis, Z-axis and X-axis move in order.
Program type M

er
<Supplementary description>

s
Conditions Immediate This parameter is valid only when “workpiece scheme” is selected in the

re
Unit — common unit. If “initial-point scheme” is selected, three axes move

ts
simultaneously, irrespective of setting of this parameter.
Setting range 0, 1

gh
ri
Select the rotating position specified in the index unit after tool change.

ll
0: After the tool change, rotation occurs at the position specified in the

.A
index unit. For the movement from the completing position of the
tool change to the rotating position of the index unit, three axes (X,

N
Rotating position specified in the index unit Y, Z) move at the same time.

O
after tool change

TI
1: After the tool change, rotation occurs at the position specified in the
16

SU12 index unit. For the movement from the completing position of the
A
R
04

tool change to the rotating position of the index unit, the X-axis and
PO

the Y-axis move at the same time following completion of Z-axis


30

movement.
R

Program type M
o.

2: After the tool change, rotation occurs at the completing position of


N

Conditions Immediate
C

the tool change.


al

Unit —
ri

ZA

Setting range 0, 1, 2
Se

Set the axis name of the transfer axis.


IM
K
ZA

Axis name of the transfer axis


A
M

SU13
YA
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions After stop of movement


(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range &0 to &7F


ig
yr

Set the display color for the tool nose marks in each system indicated on
op

the TOOL PATH CHECK and TRACE displays.


C

0: Red (default)
1: Green
Tool nose mark display color on the TOOL 2: Blue
PATH CHECK display/TRACE display 3: Yellow
SU14 4: Pink
5: Cyan
6: White

Program type M, E
* Invalid when the 3D mode is valid.
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 6

2-245
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Specify the name of the axis used as the thrust axis for the servo axis.

Name of thrust axis for servo axis

SU15

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
0: The tool moves to the approach position set in the machining program,

gh
without moving to the indexed swivel position.

ri
1: The tool moves to the index swivel position and after C-axis indexing, it
moves to the approach position.

ll
Movement to C-axis index swivel position

.A
when Z-offset scheme is used

N
SU16

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Set the background color for the MDI window.


ZA
Se

0: Green (default)
A

1: Red
IM

2: Green
3: Blue
K

Background color for the MDI window


4: Yellow
ZA

SU17 5: Pink
A

6: Cyan
M

7: White
YA

8: Black
Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 8
ht

Set the character color for the MDI window.


ig

0: Black (default)
yr

1: Red
op

2: Green
C

Character color for the MDI window 3: Blue


4: Yellow
SU18 5: Pink
6: Cyan
7: White
8: Black
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8

2-246
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

SU19 = 0:
Three axes (X, Y, Z) are simultaneously moved to the tool change
command output position specified in SU10 and TC62 or to the position
designated at RETURN of the end unit.
* When the tool nose is present at a position internal to the position of
(workpiece diameter + safety profile clearance), the axes pass through
the clearance point.
SU19 = 1:
Following the X-axis, the Y- and Z-axes are simultaneously moved to the
tool change command output position specified in SU10 and TC62 or to

.
the position designated at RETURN of the end unit.

d
Selecting the method of axis movement to

ve
the tool change command output position or * When the tool nose is present at a position internal to the position of

er
to the position designated at RETURN of (workpiece diameter + safety profile clearance), only the X-axis passes

s
the end unit through the clearance point. The Z-axis does not pass.
SU19

re
Note :

ts
This parameter is valid only when the program is of the workpiece

gh
scheme (WPC setting) or the Z-offset scheme.

ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

During polygonal machining, acceleration of the turning and milling spindle


ri

ZA

can be decreased by this parameter.


Se

Spindle acceleration for polygonal machining =


IM

SU20
Coefficient for polygonal machining spindle Spindle acceleration × 100
K

acceleration
Note :
ZA

SU20 This value will be handled as100 if a negative value, 0 or a value more
A

than 100 is set here.


M
YA

<Supplementary description>
Program type E If during polygonal machining alarm 43 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 2
3

(52, , ) occurs for the milling spindle, set a value less than 100 in this
Conditions Immediate
01

parameter to elongate the turning spindle speed attainment time


Unit %
)2

(acceleration is decreased).
Setting range 0 to 100
(c
ht

Specify the axis to be returned home after the execution of the workpiece
transfer unit corresponding to the work hand angle to be changed, and the
ig

returning sequence.
yr

Selection of returning operation after the


op

0: X-axis homing  B-axis homing


execution of the workpiece transfer unit
C

corresponding to the work hand angle to be 1: XYZ axes simultaneous homing  B-axis homing
changed 2: X-axis homing  YZ axes simultaneous homing  B-axis homing
SU21

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2

2-247
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the feed rate reduction rate for in-feed paths for the execution of a
composite-type fixed cycle.
The setting “0” is regarded as a setting of 100%.

Cutting feed rate reduction rate in


composite-type fixed cycle

SU23

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99

ts
Set the spindle speed multiplication factor for the execution of a

gh
composite-type fixed cycle.

ri
ll
Spindle speed multiplication factor in the The setting “0” is regarded as a setting of 100%.

.A
execution of a composite-type fixed cycle

N
SU24

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

Set the name of an axis (linear axis) on a plane used during polar
ZA
Se

coordinate interpolation by ASCII code (hexadecimal).


A
IM

Specification of an axis (linear axis) on a


K

plane during polar coordinate interpolation


ZA

SU29
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range &0 to &7F


ht

Set the name of an axis (rotary axis) on a plane used during polar
ig

coordinate interpolation by ASCII code (hexadecimal).


yr
op

Specification of an axis (rotary axis) on a


C

plane during polar coordinate interpolation

SU30

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range &0 to &7F

2-248
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set dwell time for the parts catcher.

Delay timer for the parts catcher

SU49

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 s

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999

ts
Tool turning clearance is required to prevent interference between the tool

gh
and stock material during tool change in automatic operation.

ri
SU51

ll
Tool turning clearance (radial value) in

.A
Chuck
X-axis SU50

N
SU50

O
Stock material shape

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M 0
PO

Dmax
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 65535 NM211-00220


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Dmax: Stock material maximum outside diameter


A
IM

0: Stock material edge projection length

Tool turning clearance in Z-axis


K
ZA

SU51
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 65535


(c
ht

Set the tool to be retracted to the fixed position for the automatic
lower-turret retraction function. Specify the tool number of the lower turret.
ig
yr

SU52: Tool number of Retraction tool 1


op

Lower-turret retraction function SU53: Tool number of Retraction tool 2


C

Tool number of the retraction tool


SU52
SU53

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 960

2-249
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Sets the wait time for the response to a request to access the programs in
the hard disk operation area and Ethernet operation area in automatic
operation
0: Continues to wait for the response to an access request
1 to 65535: Displays the alarm 1835 FILE ACCESS ERROR ( , , ) if no
Wait time for accessing the programs in the response is received within the set wait time after requesting
hard disk operation area/Ethernet operation an access
area
SU55 Note :
1. Set the parameter for system 1.

d .
ve
2. Normally, an access to a program is completed within one second.

er
Since the purpose of this parameter is to detect a wait for a
response, set a value of 10 or larger when changing the setting of

s
re
Program type E this parameter. If a value less than 10 is set, the alarm 1835 FILE
ACCESS ERROR ( , , ) may occur before completion of normal

ts
Conditions Immediate
processing.

gh
Unit 0.1 s

ri
Setting range 0 to 65535

ll
.A
For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value

N
O
TI
16

— A
R
04

PO

SU56
30

R
o.

O
N

Program type —
al

K
ri

Conditions —
ZA
Se

Unit —
A
IM

Setting range —
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-250
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the position where the turret is to be retracted for the turret retraction
function. Specify coordinates in the machine coordinate system based on
the machine zero point.

Fixed point 2
Fixed point 1

SU100

d .
SU98 SU99
SU97

ve
Lower-turret retraction function

er
SU97 Fixed point of the retraction position
Machine zero point

s
to

re
SU100

ts
SU97: X-axis retraction point – Fixed point 1

gh
SU98: Z-axis retraction point – Fixed point 1
SU99: X-axis retraction point – Fixed point 2

ri
SU100: Z-axis retraction point – Fixed point 2

ll
.A
Specify a minus value if the fixed point of the retraction position is located
in a minus direction when viewed from the zero point of the machine

N
coordinates.

O
TI
16

Note : A
R
04

Program type M Set this parameter for the system of the lower turret.
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Example :
ri

ZA
Se

1. Standard type cutting


A

Prior to cutting up along the wall in the end of final cycle, escape will
IM

be made by specified distance.


K
ZA
A
M

SU102
YA
3

Return distance at walls during rough


01

cutting in bar machining or in corner


)2

machining of an EIA/ISO program SU102


SU102
(c

2. High speed rough cutting


ht

Escape will be made by SU102 specified distance during return after


ig

reaching the wall.


yr
op
C

SU102

Program type E
Conditions Immediate SU102
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
* For MAZATROL programs refer to TC67 and TC68.
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-251
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

If a cutting depth has not been specified in the program, operation will
occur in accordance with the setting of this parameter.

Cutting depth in the composite-type fixed


cycle (G271/G272, G71/G72)
SU103
SU103

Program type E

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
gh
ri
Tool
Pecking return distance in grooving

ll
.A
(G274/G275, G74/G75) of EIA/ISO
program

N
SU104

O
TI
SU104
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate NM211-00248


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in * For MAZATROL programs refer to TC74.


O
N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Cut depth (diametral value) for final cut in


composite-type thread cutting cycle G276,
K

1st cut
G76 of EIA/ISO program
ZA

SU105
A

(n/2-1)th cut
M

(n/2)th cut
YA

SU105/2 nth cut


Program type E
3

NM211-00247
Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


)2

* For MAZATROL programs refer to TC78.


Setting range 0 to 65535
(c
ht

Clamping will follow the setting of SU106 if the calculated value of the cut
depth with the composite type thread cutting cycle G276 is smaller than
ig

the setting of SU106. This parameter is valid only for the infeed operation
yr

of the fixed volume chip production scheme.


op

Minimum cut depth clamping value (radial


value) in composite-type thread cutting
C

cycle G276 of EIA/ISO program * For MAZATROL programs refer to TC79.


SU106

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-252
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the spindle safety clamp speed of a tool whose diameter (nominal
diameter) is not specified in the tool data. This clamp speed is invalid for
the tools with tool diameter (or nominal diameter, if diameter cannot be
specified) setting in the tool data.
Safety clamp speed

SU107

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
–1
Unit min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999

ts
Set the machine safeguarding strength to be used during the calculation of

gh
the safety speed for the spindle.

ri
Remark : Spindle safety speed calculation expression

ll
3
60 × 10 2E –1
N= m (min )

.A
Safeguarding strength D

N
Tool diameter D (mm):
SU108

O
ACT- in MAZATROL tool data

TI
(For a tool whose tool diameter cannot be registered in tool data:
16

A
Nominal diameter)
R
04

Program type M Safeguarding strength E (J): Parameter SU108


PO
30

Conditions Immediate Tip mass m (kg): Parameter SU109/1000


R
o.

Unit J
O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Set the tip mass used to calculate the spindle safety clamp speed.
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Tip mass
K
ZA

SU109
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit g
)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-253
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the desired data range.


Note :
Although entered data is checked for the range that has been set in
SU110 - SU113, the check is conducted only when the “Tool length
setting range check function” is valid (SU154 bit 1 = 1).
Example of setting (SU111 = 0):

Tool length setting range check function

.
Settable data range

d
ve
SU110 Max. tool length (+X-axis)

er
SU110 SU111 Min. tool length (–X-axis)

s
SU112 Max. tool length (+Z-axis)
to

re
SU113 Min. tool length (–Z-axis)
SU113

ts
SU112 SU113

gh
SU110

ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


O
N

Setting range ±19999999


al

0: Invalid
ri

ZA
Se

1 to 99999999: Reduction distance


A
IM

Feed-in speed reduction distance for


K

composite-type fixed cycle


ZA

SU114
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c
ht

Set the limit for the amount of motion on the primary rotational axis for
workpiece placement error correction.
ig
yr
op

Admissible motion range on the primary Note :


rotational axis for workpiece placement
C

Set zero (0) in SU123 if no restriction is to be imposed on the range of


error correction
correcting motion on the primary rotational axis for workpiece placement
SU123 error correction.

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001°
Setting range 0 to 1799999

2-254
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the limit for the amount of motion on the secondary rotational axis for
workpiece placement error correction.

Admissible motion range on the secondary Note :


rotational axis for workpiece placement
Set zero (0) in SU124 if no restriction is to be imposed on the range of
error correction
correcting motion on the secondary rotational axis for workpiece
SU124 placement error correction.

Program type M

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
er
Unit 0.0001°

s
Setting range 0 to 1799999

re
Fixed value

ts
gh
ri
ll

.A
N
SU125

O
TI
16

Program type —
A
R
04

PO

Conditions —
30

Unit —
R
o.

Setting range —
N

C
al

Set the X- and Z-axis retraction positions of the upper and lower turret in
K
ri

the machine coordinate system. When parameter TC108 = 3, the upper


ZA
Se

and lower turrets are placed in a queue in this position after the
A

two-workpiece machining sequence.


IM
K

SU129 (#1)
ZA

Retraction positions of the upper and lower


A

turrets at the end of the two-workpiece SU128 (#1)


M

SU128 machining sequence


YA

SU129
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig

Program type M SU128 (#2)


yr

Conditions Immediate
op
C

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in SU129 (#2)


Setting range ±99999999

2-255
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

M-code selection for tapping cycle.


If the command block of G284/G288 (machining G-codes, F30 = 0) or of
G84/G88 (turning G-codes, F30 = 1) does not contain spindle forward/
reverse rotation M-codes, one of the following M-codes will be output,
depending on the status of bit 0 in parameter SU153:
M-code selection for tapping cycle
BA59 = 3 BA59 = 203
SU153 BA60 = 4 BA60 = 204
(bit 0) 0 Tapping cycle of turning Tapping cycle of milling
SU153
bit 0 Inverse tapping cycle of Inverse tapping cycle of
1

.
turning milling

d
ve
Program type E  If 0 is set in BA59, 3 will be regarded as having been set, and M03 will

er
Conditions After stop of movement be output.

s
 If 0 is set in BA60, 4 will be regarded as having been set, and M04 will

re
Unit —
be output.

ts
Setting range 0, 1

gh
Display of BUFFER/REMAIN/POSITION on the POSITION display

ri
0: Display in the machine axial direction

ll
1: Display in the axial direction in the coordinates system that has been

.A
converted by the inclination of the B-axis

N
O
TI
Actual axis X
16

A Virtual axis Z
R
04

Virtual axis X
PO

Bit 1: Display of BUFFER on the POSITION


30

display
R
o.

Bit 2: Display of REMAIN on the POSITION


N

SU153 display
al

(bit 1) Bit 3: Display of POSITION on the


ri

ZA

(bit 2) POSITION display Actual axis Z


Se

(bit 3)
A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr
op
C

2-256
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

The retraction of the lower turret in the execution of a MAZATROL


program is determined according to the program contents and this
parameter’s setting as detailed below.

Program contents Retraction of the lower turret


Retraction to the position as specified with
With a retraction [TURRET 2 POS. 1] or [TURRET 2 POS. 2]
command POS. 1: X = SU97, Z = SU98
POS. 2: X = SU99, Z = SU100
 SU153 bit 4 = 0: No retraction

d.
Automatic retraction of the lower turret for  SU153 bit 4 = 1: Retraction

ve
MAZATROL programs Movement to the position of automatic

er
SU153 Without retraction retraction as below.

s
commands

re
(bit 4) MULTIPLEX: X/Z = 2nd zero point
(M5)

ts
Others: X/Y/Z = Machine zero point

gh
(M4)

ri
ll
Note :

.A
Set this parameter for the system of the lower turret.

N
O
TI
16

Program type M A
R
04

Conditions Immediate
PO
30

Unit —
R
o.

Setting range 0, 1
N

Set the “C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs


al

(line/linear machining for the C-axis CYLIND mode).


ri

ZA
Se

“C-axis Clamp” machining method for 0: Machining with C-axis braked


A
IM

MAZATROL programs 1: Machining with C-axis clamped


(Line/Linear machining for the C-axis (only for machining without C-axis movement)
SU153
K

CYLIND mode)
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

MAZATROL point machining with C-axis clamped (M210)


ht

0: Output of M210
ig

1: No output of M210
yr

MAZATROL point machining with C-axis


op

clamped (M210)
C

SU153
(bit 6)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-257
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Set the “C-axis Clamp” machining method for MAZATROL programs


(line/linear machining for the C-axis FACE mode).

“C-axis Clamp” machining method for 0: Machining with C-axis braked


MAZATROL programs 1: Machining with C-axis clamped
(Line/Linear machining for the C-axis FACE (only for machining without C-axis movement)
SU153 mode)
(bit 7)

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Do not display

gh
1: Display

ri
ll
.A
Displaying tool-setting values for ATC-type
turret

N
SU154

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0 : Invalid
Se

1 : Valid
A
IM
K

Tool length setting range check function


ZA

SU154
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Actual axis
ig

1: Virtual axis
yr
op
C

Displaying the “next distance” during


execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4
SU154
(bit 2)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-258
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

0: Actual axis
1: Virtual axis

Displaying the “remaining distance” during


execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4
SU154
(bit 3)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Actual axis

gh
1: Virtual axis

ri
ll
.A
Displaying the “current position” during
execution of G18.2/G18.3/G18.4

N
SU154

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Actual axis
Se

1: Virtual axis
A
IM

Displaying the “next distance” during


K

execution of G17.1 to G17.5


ZA

SU154
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Actual axis
ig

1: Virtual axis
yr
op
C

Displaying the “remaining distance” during


execution of G17.1 to G17.5
SU154
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-259
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

0: Actual axis
1: Virtual axis

Displaying the “current position” during


execution of G17.1 to G17.5
SU154
(bit 7)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value (1)

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
SU155

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Select the timing in which the tool length of the touch sensor is to be made
ZA
Se

valid during EIA/ISO programmed or MDI operation when the following


A

conditions are satisfied:


IM

Correction timing of the touch sensor tool  F93 bit 3 = 1 (using MAZATROL tool length)
length during EIA/ISO programmed or MDI
K

 F94 bit 7 = 0 (using tool offsets)


operation
ZA

SU155 (for machining center specifications only) 0: When a move command is executed for any controlled axis (X, Y, Z, or
rotational axis)
A

(bit 1)
M

1: When a move command is executed for the Z-axis


YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether the zero point return is to be executed at an EIA


ig

subprogram call from a MAZATROL program.


yr

0: Executed
op

Operation at an EIA subprogram call from a 1: Not executed


C

MAZATROL program
SU155
(bit 2)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-260
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Select whether the index angle of the spindle is to be checked during


MAZATROL programmed operation when a judgment on whether a tool
change is necessary.
Judgment method for tool change 0: No check (No tool change command is output when the tool is the
command output during MAZATROL same in tool name, nominal size, and suffix.)
programmed operation
SU155 1: Check (No tool change command is output when the tool is the same in
(bit 3) tool name, nominal size, suffix, and spindle index angle.)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether the tool change command is to be output during

gh
MAZATROL programmed operation when the machining unit is executed
for the first time.

ri
0: Output of the tool change command except for the same tool

ll
Tool change command output at the start of

.A
1: Unconditional output of the tool change command
MAZATROL programmed operation
SU155

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Select a method of judging tool breakage during laser tool measurement.


ri

ZA
Se

0: Judging from the setting of parameter L6


A
IM

For details, refer to the explanation of parameter L6.


Reference value for judging tool breakage
K

during laser tool measurement


1: Judging from the tolerance specified in the program
ZA

SU155
If (“registered tool length data” – “tool length data that has been measured
A

(bit 7)
during the detecting operation”) > “tolerance set in the program”, then the
M

tool is judged to be broken.


YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

Type of deep-hole drilling cycle G83/G87


ig

0: Normal type
yr

1: High-speed type
op

Type of deep-hole drilling cycle G83/G87


C

SU156
(bit 4)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-261
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)


SU156
(bit 5)

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Execution of the restarting search for a block in the mode of G68 when

gh
tool length compensation (G43/G44) remains valid with a turning tool
mounted.

ri
Execution of a restarting search for a block

ll
in the mode of G68 when tool length 0: Alarm

.A
compensation (G43/G44) remains valid 1: Possible (however, the return to the restarting position is not

N
SU156 with a turning tool mounted conducted)

O
(bit 6)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Execution of the restarting search for a block after the cancellation of the
ZA
Se

cross command
A
IM

0: Alarm
Execution of a restarting search for a block 1: Possible (however, the return to the restarting position is not
K

after cancellation of the cross command conducted)


ZA

SU156
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Compliant with SU11 and SU19.


ig

1: Approach with priority assigned to the Z-axis (SU11 = 1)


yr

Movement to the tool rotating position with priority assigned to the


The scheme of axis movement during an
op

X-axis (SU19 = 1)
approach and during movement to the tool (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)
C

change command output position for


SU157 machining at the work hand side
(bit 1)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-262
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Operation pattern with [NO RETURN] selected for CHANGE-PT in the


manual program unit (MANL PRG)

0: NO RETURN to the tool change command output position is effective


Conditions for moving to the tool change only when the tool need not be changed for another one, nor in the
command output position in manual index angle.
program unit
SU157 1: NO RETURN to the tool change command output position is effective
when there is no need of changing the tool, irrespectively of whether its
(bit 2)
index angle is to be altered or not.

Program type M

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Response to a tool change command for the same tool number (TNo.)

gh
0: No movement to the tool rotating position

ri
1: Movement to the tool rotating position when either of the following

ll
Conditions for moving to the tool change three conditions is satisfied:

.A
command output position for the same TNo. a. The value of tool length/tool setting data differs.

N
SU157

O
b. The value of nose R/tool diameter differs.
(bit 3)

TI
c. The section to be machined differs.
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

C
al

Setting range 0, 1
K
ri

ZA

Select the kind of operation to be performed if either TURN POS X, Y, or Z


Se

of the indexing unit is left blank (only when a tool change is not conducted
A

in immediate front of the indexing unit).


IM

Operation to perform if either TURN POS X, 0: The unspecified axis moves to the position of the third home position
K

Y, or Z is left blank in index unit (M6) before the B/C-axes are swiveled. (Conventional operation)
ZA

SU157 1: The B/C-axes are swiveled without any motion having been conducted
A

on the unspecified axis. (New operation)


(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Preparatory C-axis positioning to 0° for a manual program unit (MANL


ig

PRG) with a milling tool after a turning unit


yr
op

0: Positioning to 0° on the C-axis


Preparatory C-axis positioning to 0° for
C

1: No movement on the C-axis.


manual program unit with a milling tool in
turning mode
SU157
(bit 5)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-263
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Select whether or not the B-axis rotation radius is to be included into the
“clearance position,” a component of the tool change position (when TC62
= 0, 1, 2, 5 or 7) for changing the indexed cutting edge on one and the
Selection of whether or not the B-axis
same FLASH tool.
rotation radius is to be included into the
“clearance position” for changing the 0: Included
indexed cutting edge on one and the same
SU157 1: Not included
FLASH tool
(bit 7)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
0: Invalid

ts
gh
1: Valid

ri
Note :
Checking the rotary axis correction values

ll
Admissible motion ranges are to be specified in SU123 and SU124

.A
in workpiece placement error correction for
respectively for the primary and secondary rotational axis.
MAZATROL programs
SU158

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Tool length compensation for turning tools


ri

ZA
Se

1: Tool length compensation for milling tools


A
IM

Handling of G43P0 tool length * However, this is always used for tool length compensation for milling
K

compensation with a touch sensor tools when bit 7 of parameter F94 is set to 0 and bit 1 of parameter
ZA

SU158 SU155 is set to 0.


A

(bit 3)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Fixed value (0)


ig
yr
op
C


SU158
(bit 4)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-264
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Manual tool measurement tool wear offset


clear function
SU158
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Displayed

gh
1: Not displayed

ri
ll
“TOOL NAME ORDER” display/hidden with

.A
random ATC machines

N
SU159

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Whether or not to consider tool length depends on bit 3 of parameter


Se

F93.
A

Do not consider tool length when bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to 0.


IM

Consider tool length when bit 3 of parameter F93 is set to 1.


Selection of whether or not to consider the
K

tool length for tip position memory on the 1: Do not consider tool length.
ZA

WORK OFFSET display * F93 (bit 3) Tool length in MAZATROL tool data in the EIA/ISO program
SU159
(0: invalid, 1: valid)
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Buffer block limit for tool diameter compensation/tool nose radius offset in
ig

manual program units


yr

0: Valid
op

Buffer block limit for tool diameter 1: Invalid


C

compensation/tool nose radius offset in


manual program units
SU161
(bit 0)

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-265
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SYSTEM

Address Meaning Description

Selects whether to reflect the B-axis angle when displaying the current
position of the milling tool in the manual operation mode.
0: Not displayed
Current position display for milling tool with 1: Displayed
B-axis angle reflected in manual operation
mode
SU165
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-266
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-7 User parameter TURNING (TC)

Classification USER Display title TURNING

Address Meaning Description

F1 : Feed rate for rough cutting


F2 : Increased feed rate
F2 F1
Acceleration rate in up-going wall slope
(90°) for rough cutting in bar machining unit

TC3 NM211-00263
TC3

d .
F2 = F1 × 100

ve
Program type M

er
Conditions Immediate Note :

s
re
Up to 500 % can be set.
Unit %

ts
This is effective only when TC141 (bit 0) = 1.
Setting range 0 to 500

gh
TC4 = 0: 45°

ri
TC4 = 1: Chamfering along the shape to be finished

ll
TC4 = 2: Feed rate (F) for chamfering is expressed as follows:

.A
Selection of chamfering pattern in rough TC3
F = F0 × 100

N
external turning cycle G71 (G271) or rough

O
edge-machining cycle G72 (G272) (where F0 = Feed rate specified in program)

TI
TC4 When TC4 = 2, feed rate can be changed only when chamfering at 90°.
16

A
R
04

PO

(TC3)
30

Program type E
R
o.

Conditions Immediate
N

Unit —
al

K
ri

Setting range 0 to 2
ZA
Se

If the number of times of roughing has not been specified in the program,
A

operation will occur in accordance with the setting of this parameter.


IM
K
ZA

Number of times of roughing in the


composite-type fixed cycle (G273, G73)
A

Number of times of
M

TC72 roughing
YA
3
01

Program type E
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit Times
ht

Setting range 0 to 65535


ig
yr
op
C

2-267
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title TURNING

Address Meaning Description

The settings of these parameters will be used if the amount of release is


not specified in the program.

Composite-type fixed cycle


— amount of X-axial release (G273)
TC117
TC117

Program type E TC118

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
gh
ri
ll
Composite-type fixed cycle

.A
— amount of Z-axial release (G273)

N
TC118

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

TC141 (bit 0) = 0: Disuse


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

F1
F1 No acceleration
K
ZA

Use/disuse of acceleration in up-going


slope during rough cutting cycle in bar
A

machining unit
M

TC141
TC141 (bit 0) = 1: Use
YA

(bit 0)
3

F2 > F1
01

F2
F1 F1 : Feed rate for rough
)2

cutting cycle
F2 : Feed rate after
(c

Program type M acceleration


ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

NM211-00208
Unit —
yr

(TC2, TC3)
op

Setting range 0, 1
C

2-268
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-8 User parameter SOLID (SD)

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Set the type of coordinate system used for position display.


0: MAZATROL coordinate system
1: Machine coordinate system
Machine coordinate system setting

SD49

d .
ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions Immediate

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 0, 1

gh
Select a table type for 3D setup display.

ri
0: Square table

ll
.A
1: Round table
2: Chuck

N
Table type

O
TI
SD50 * When this parameter is set to “2” on machines with the vertical Z-axis
16

A
(L110 bit 7 = 1) and the rotary head axis (BA48 ≠ 0), the table will be
R
04

displayed by referring to the settings of parameters BA1 to BA3. With


PO
30

Program type M, E other machines, the chuck shape will not be displayed even if this
parameter is set to “2”.
R

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0 to 2
ri

ZA
Se

Select the axis direction of a round table to be displayed in the 3D SETUP


A

display.
IM

0: X-axis
1: Y-axis
K

Round table axis direction


ZA

2: Z-axis
A

SD51
M

* This parameter is valid when parameter SD50 is set to 1.


YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Sets the drawing mode for arcs in the tool path check and shape check.
ig
yr

0: Simplified drawing (drawing speed prioritized)


op

1: Detailed drawing (drawing accuracy prioritized)


C

Smoothness selection for arcs in the tool


path check/shape check

SD53

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-269
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Determine the type of second table displayed on the 3D SETUP display.


0: Rectangular
1: Round
2: Chuck
Table type of the second additional table

SD56

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 2

ts
Select the axis direction of the second round table to be displayed on the

gh
3D SETUP display.
0: X-axis

ri
ll
Round table axis direction for the second 1: Y-axis

.A
additional table 2: Z-axis

N
SD57

O
* This parameter is valid when parameter SD56 is set to 1.

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0 to 2
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-270
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Sets the accuracy of the product shape to be displayed with QUICK


MAZATROL.
The permissible error when approximating a circular arc with polygons is
selected based on this parameter setting.
The product shape will be represented most coarsely when this parameter
is set to “1” and most precisely when set to “9”.

The relationship between setting of this parameter and the permissible


error is as follows.

d.
ve
0 : Invalid *
Permissible error

er
1 : 1.2 mm

s
2 : 0.8 mm

re
3 : 0.5 mm

ts
4 : 0.4 mm

gh
QUICK MAZATROL product shape display
accuracy 5 : 0.35 mm

ri
SD58 6 : 0.3 mm

ll
.A
7 : 0.25 mm

N
8 : 0.2 mm

O
9 : 0.15 mm

TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

* When this parameter is disabled, the following shapes will be


C

approximated with a 32-sided polygon.


al

K
ri

- Material of common unit: cylindrical surface


ZA
Se

- Material unit: cylindrical surface


A
IM

- Point machining unit: hole shape

Program type M - Turning unit: turning cylindrical surface


K

- C-axis cylindrical surface, line-/face-machining shape (360-degree


ZA

Conditions Immediate
machining)
Unit —
A

For shapes other than above, a setting of “7” is assumed.


M

Setting range 0 to 9
YA

Fixed value
3
01
)2


(c
ht

SD74
ig
yr
op

Program type —
C

Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-271
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Set the default value for the model’s movement distance per time that is to
be displayed in the movement distance assignment dialog box.

Distance of the model movement per time

SD97

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the default value for the amount of model rotation per time that is to be

gh
displayed in the amount-of-rotation assignment dialog box.

ri
ll
.A
Amount of model rotation per time

N
SD98

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001°
O
N

Setting range 0 to 3600000


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-272
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Set the table size for 3D setup display.

< Rectangular table (not chamfered) >

 Vertical type

SD125 +Z
+Y
SD128
+X
SD126

. d
SD127

ve
SD130

er
SD129

s
re
 Horizontal type

ts
gh
ri
SD129 +Y

ll
+X

.A
SD126
+Z

N
SD130
SD125

O
Table size

TI
SD125: Minimum table dimension X SD128
16

SD126: Maximum table dimension X


A SD127
R
04

SD127: Minimum table dimension Y


PO

SD125
30

SD128: Maximum table dimension Y


to < Rectangular table (chamfered) >
R

SD129: Minimum table dimension Z


o.

SD130 SD130: Maximum table dimension Z  Vertical type


N

C
al

SD125 SD126
K
ri

ZA

SD131
Se

SD131
IM

+Y SD128
K

+X
ZA
A
M

SD127
YA
3
01

 Horizontal type
)2

SD129 SD130
(c

SD131
ht

SD131
ig

SD126
yr

+X
op

+Z
C

Program type M, E
SD125
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-273
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

< Round table >

Table upper face direction is determined according to the setting of


parameter SD51.

1. SD51 = 0:
In the length in the Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128) and that in the
Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130), the value having a smaller absolute
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) is taken as the height of the round
table. The center of the rectangle (SD127, SD128, SD129, SD130) is
taken as the center of the round table.

d .
ve
2. SD51 = 1:
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) and that in the

er
Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130), the value having a smaller absolute

s
re
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128) is taken as the height of the round

ts
table. The center of the rectangle (SD125, SD126, SD129, SD130) is

gh
taken as the center of the round table.

ri
3. SD51 = 2:

ll
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD125 + SD126) and that in the

.A
Table size Y-axis direction (SD127 + SD128), the value having a smaller

N
SD125: Minimum table dimension X absolute value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the

O
SD126: Maximum table dimension X length in the Z-axis direction (SD129 + SD130) is taken as the height

TI
SD127: Minimum table dimension Y of the round table. The center of the rectangle (SD125, SD126,
SD125
16

SD128: Maximum table dimension Y SD127, SD128) is taken as the center of the round table.
A
to
R
04

SD129: Minimum table dimension Z  Vertical type (SD51 = 2)


PO

SD130 SD130: Maximum table dimension Z


30

Length in the X-axis direction


R
o.

SD125 SD126
O
N

+Y
al

SD128
ri

ZA
Se

+X
Length in the
A

Y-axis direction
IM
K

SD127
ZA
A

 Horizontal type (SD51 = 1)


M

Length in the Z-axis direction


YA

SD129 SD130
3
01

+X
SD126
)2

+Z
(c

Length in the
X-axis direction
ht
ig

Program type M, E
yr

Conditions Immediate SD125


op

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


C

Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-274
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Set the amount of table chamfer for 3D setup display.

 Top view of the table


Length of the shorter side in vertical and horizontal directions

Amount of chamfer
Amount of table chamfer

SD131

d .
ve
er
Program type M, E

s
Conditions Immediate

re
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

ts
gh
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-275
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

Set the table dimension of the second table to be displayed on the 3D


SETUP display.

< Rectangular table (not chamfered) >

 Vertical type

SD136 +Z
+Y
SD139

.
+X

d
SD137

ve
SD138

er
SD141

s
SD140

re
ts
 Horizontal type

gh
ri
ll
SD140

.A
+Y
+X
SD137

N
+Z

O
SD141
Table dimension of the second table SD136

TI
16

SD136: Minimum table dimension X A SD139


R
SD137: Maximum table dimension X
04

SD138
PO

SD138: Minimum table dimension Y


30

SD136 SD139: Maximum table dimension Y


R

to SD140: Minimum table dimension Z


o.

< Rectangular table (chamfered) >


O
N

SD141 SD141: Maximum table dimension Z


C

 Vertical type
al

K
ri

ZA

SD136 SD137
Se

SD142
IM

SD142
K

+Y SD139
ZA

+X
A
M
YA

SD138
3
01
)2

 Horizontal type
(c

SD140 SD141
ht

SD142
ig
yr

SD142
op

+X SD137
C

+Z

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate SD136
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-276
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

< Round table >

Table upper face direction is determined according to the setting of


parameter SD57.

1. SD57 = 0:
In the length in the Y-axis direction (SD138 + SD139) and that in the
Z-axis direction (SD140 + SD141), the value having a smaller absolute
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
X-axis direction (SD136 + SD137) is taken as the height of the round
table. The center of the rectangle (SD138, SD139, SD140, SD141) is
taken as the center of the round table.

d .
ve
2. SD57 = 1:
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD136 + SD137) and that in the

er
Z-axis direction (SD140 + SD141), the value having a smaller absolute

s
re
value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the length in the
Y-axis direction (SD138 + SD139) is taken as the height of the round

ts
table. The center of the rectangle (SD136, SD137, SD140, SD141) is

gh
taken as the center of the round table.

ri
3. SD57 = 2:

ll
In the length in the X-axis direction (SD136 + SD137) and that in the

.A
Table dimension of the second table Y-axis direction (SD138 + SD139), the value having a smaller

N
SD136: Minimum table dimension X absolute value is taken as the diameter of the round table, and the

O
SD137: Maximum table dimension X length in the Z-axis direction (SD140 + SD141) is taken as the height

TI
SD138: Minimum table dimension Y of the round table. The center of the rectangle (SD136, SD137,
SD136
16

SD139: Maximum table dimension Y SD138, SD139) is taken as the center of the round table.
A
to
R
04

SD140: Minimum table dimension Z  Vertical type (SD57 = 2)


PO

SD141 SD141: Maximum table dimension Z


30

Length in the X-axis direction


R
o.

SD136 SD137
O
N

+Y
al

SD139
ri

ZA
Se

+X
Length in the
A

Y-axis direction
IM
K

SD138
ZA
A

 Horizontal type (SD57 = 1)


M

Length in the Z-axis direction


YA

SD140 SD141
3
01

+X
SD137
)2

+Z
(c

Length in the
ht

X-axis direction
ig

Program type M, E
yr

Conditions Immediate SD136


op

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


C

Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-277
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title SOLID

Address Meaning Description

When a rectangular table is set as the second table, this parameter sets
the amount of chamfer of the table displayed on the 3D SETUP display.
 Top view of the table
Length of the shorter side in vertical and horizontal directions

Amount of table chamfer for the second Amount of chamfer


table

SD142

d .
ve
er
Program type M, E

s
re
Conditions Immediate

ts
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

gh
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

ri
0: Reflecting information on tools used to the shape

ll
1: Reflecting information (nominal diameter, etc.) specified in the program

.A
to the shape

N
O
Tool data setting using QUICK MAZATROL

TI
SD165
16

A
R
04

(bit 1)
PO
30

R
o.

Program type M
O
N

Conditions Immediate
al

Unit —
ri

ZA
Se

Setting range 0, 1
A

Registration of rotary tool holder model data for turning tools


IM
K

0: Disabled
ZA

Registration of rotary tool holder model data 1: Enabled


A

for turning tools Note :


M

SD166
Usable only with ATC-type turrets and long boring bars
YA

(bit 0)
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr

0: Invalid
op

1: Valid
C

Sampling data automatic save function on


occurrence of an INTELLIGENT SAFETY
SHIELD (ISS) alarm
SD167
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-278
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-9 User parameter DISPLAY STRUCTURE (US)

Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE

Address Meaning Description

Selects the highlighting method for the menu items selected.


0: Display the frame and text in green
1: Display the background in white and text in black

Menu highlighting method


US1
(bit 0)

d .
ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions Immediate

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 0, 1

gh
Select the operation to be performed when tool data (ACT-, NOSE-R,

ri
EDG-ANG, TIP-WID, WIDTH) is not input upon automatically determining

ll
cutting conditions.

.A
Selection of operation for automatic

N
determination of cutting conditions when

O
0: Displaying the alarm 414 AUTO CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE
tool data is not input

TI
US1 1: Automatically determining cutting conditions by referring to NOM- in
16

(bit 1) A
the program and parameters US43, US44, US45 and US46
R
04

PO
30

Program type M
R
o.

Conditions Immediate
N

Unit —
al

K
ri

ZA

Setting range 0, 1
Se

0: Fixed for each machine model


IM

1: According to the setting file


K
ZA

MAZA-CHECK input support function log


output, parameter reference
A

US1
M

(bit 2)
YA
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig

0: Invalid
yr

1: Valid
op
C

Directory selection function in the WORK


No. SELECT window
US1
(bit 4)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-279
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Project function in the WORK No. SELECT


window/PROGRAM FILE display
US1
(bit 5)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Display of the alarm window while the Smooth application manager is

gh
displayed

ri
0 : Not displayed

ll
Alarm window display selection while 1 : Displayed

.A
displaying Smooth application manager

N
US1

O
(bit 6)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.


O

Unit
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: Display the block being executed in the lower part of the screen.
ZA
Se

1: Display the block being executed in the upper part of the screen.
A
IM

Selection of display position for the block


K

being executed on the EIA MONITOR


ZA

display
US1
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Set the number of users which the data guard function identifies.
ig

* The function is invalid when “0” or “1” is set.


yr
op

Data guard function:


C

Maximum number of users

US37

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8

2-280
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE

Address Meaning Description

When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting


condition determination function, adjust the calculated feed rate according
to the cutting power.
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when “DRILL” is set for the tool name in the tool sequence for
conditions
point machining.
Element that automatically determines “FR”

US39 (DRILL)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting

gh
condition determination function, adjust the calculated feed rate according
to the cutting power.

ri
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when “BOR BAR”, “B-B BAR” or “BCK FACE” is set for the tool

ll
conditions

.A
name in the tool sequence for point machining.
Element that automatically determines “FR”

N
US40 (BOR BAR, B-B BAR, BCK FACE)

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting


ZA
Se

condition determination function, adjust the calculated feed rate according


A

to the cutting power.


IM

Automatic determination of cutting


Enabled when “FCE MILL” or “END MILL” is set for the tool name in the
conditions
tool sequence for point machining, line machining or face machining.
K

Element that automatically determines “FR”


ZA

US41 (FCE MILL, END MILL)


A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

When determining “DEP-1” automatically using the automatic cutting


ig

condition determination function, adjust the depth of cut during I.D.


yr

machining.
Automatic determination of cutting
op

Enabled when “IN” or “IN INNER (BAK)” is set for the machining section in
conditions
C

the tool sequence for a “BAR”, “CPY” or “CORNER” unit.


Reference shank diameter

US42 (BAR, CPY, CORNER)


DEP-1 = R-MAX-DEPTH (CUTTING CONDITION display) 
WORKPIECE MATERIAL PERCENTAGE_R-DEPTH% (CUTTING
CONDITION display)  TOOL MATERIAL PERCENTAGE_R-DEPTH%
(CUTTING CONDITION display)  (WIDTH (TOOL DATA) / US42
Program type M
(reference shank diameter))
Conditions Immediate
Unit mm/0.1 in
Setting range 0 to 100

2-281
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification USER Display title DISPLAY STRUCTURE

Address Meaning Description

When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting


condition determination function, determine the condition by using US43
as the tool nose radius if “NOSE-R” is not input for the specified tool.
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when a “BAR”, “CPY”, “CORNER” or “FACING” unit is selected.
conditions
Tool nose radius when tool data is not input
(BAR, CPY, CORNER, FACING) Note :
US43
US43 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
When determining “DEP-1” automatically using the automatic cutting

gh
condition determination function, determine the condition by using US44
as the tool width if “WIDTH” is not input for the specified tool.

ri
Automatic determination of cutting
Enabled when “IN” or “IN INNER (BAK)” is set for the machining section in

ll
conditions

.A
the tool sequence for a “BAR”, “CPY” or “CORNER” unit.
Tool width when tool data is not input

N
US44 (BAR, CPY, CORNER)

O
Note :

TI
US44 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit mm/0.1 in
N

Setting range 0 to 100


al

K
ri

When determining “DEP-1” automatically using the automatic cutting


ZA
Se

condition determination function, determine the condition by using US45


A

as the tool nose angle if “EDG-ANG” is not input for the specified tool.
IM

Automatic determination of cutting


Enabled when a “BAR”, “CPY”, “CORNER” or “FACING” unit is selected.
conditions
K

Tool nose angle when tool data is not input


ZA

(BAR, CPY, CORNER, FACING) Note :


US45
A

US45 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.


M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1°
(c

Setting range 0 to 1000


ht

When determining “FR” automatically using the automatic cutting


ig

condition determination function, determine the condition by using US46


yr

as the tool nose width if “TIP-WID” is not input for the specified tool.
Automatic determination of cutting
op

Enabled when a “T.GROOVE” unit is selected.


conditions
C

Tool nose width when tool data is not input


(T.GROOVE) Note :
US46
US46 is enabled only when US1 bit 1 = 1.

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-282
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-10 Machine parameter CALL MACRO (J)

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

G-code macroprogram call


Setting Program
No.1 No.2 No.3 No.4 No.5 No.6 No.7 No.8 No.9 No.10 Unit Conditions Description
range type
J29 J33 J37
Work number of
100009590 100009599 100009401 0 to
J1 J5 J9 J13 J17 J21 J25 — M, E Immediate the program to be
(Fixed (Fixed (Fixed 999999999
called
value) value) value)
The G-code
number to be used
for program call

.
J30 J34 J38

d
136 137 130 Note :

ve
J2 J6 J10 J14 J18 J22 J26 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
(Fixed (Fixed (Fixed Not possible to

er
value) value) value) set G-codes

s
re
whose uses are
predefined.

ts
J31 J35 J39

gh
Calling type
1 1 2
J3 J7 J11 J15 J19 J23 J27 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66

ri
(Fixed (Fixed (Fixed
1: G65 3: G66.1
value) value) value)

ll
.A
J4 J8 J12 J16 J20 J24 J28 J32 J36 J40 — — — — Invalid

N
O
TI
Setting Program
No.11 No.12 No.13 No.14 No.15 No.16 No.17 No.18 No.19 No.20 Unit Conditions Description
16

A range type
R
04

0 to Work number of
PO

J265 J269 J273 J277 J281 J285 J289 J293 J297 J301 — M, E Immediate the program to be
30

999999999 called
R
o.

The G-code
O
N

number to be used
C

for program call


al

Note :
ri

ZA

J266 J270 J274 J278 J282 J286 J290 J294 J298 J302 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Se

Not possible to
A

set G-codes
IM

whose uses are


predefined.
K

Calling type
ZA

J267 J271 J275 J279 J283 J287 J291 J295 J299 J303 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
A

1: G65 3: G66.1
M

J268 J272 J276 J280 J284 J288 J292 J296 J300 J304 — — — — Invalid
YA
3
01

Setting Program
No.21 No.22 No.23 No.24 No.25 No.26 No.27 No.28 No.29 No.30 Unit Conditions Description
range type
)2

0 to Work number of
(c

J305 J309 J313 J317 J321 J325 J329 J333 J337 J341 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
ht

The G-code
ig

number to be used
yr

for program call


op

Note :
C

J306 J310 J314 J318 J322 J326 J330 J334 J338 J342 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
set G-codes
whose uses are
predefined.
Calling type
J307 J311 J315 J319 J323 J327 J331 J335 J339 J343 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J308 J312 J316 J320 J324 J328 J332 J336 J340 J344 — — — — Invalid

2-283
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Setting Program
No.31 No.32 No.33 No.34 No.35 No.36 No.37 No.38 No.39 No.40 Unit Conditions Description
range type

0 to Work number of
J345 J349 J353 J357 J361 J365 J369 J373 J377 J381 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
The G-code
number to be used
for program call
Note :
J346 J350 J354 J358 J362 J366 J370 J374 J378 J382 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
set G-codes
whose uses are

d .
predefined.

ve
Calling type

er
J347 J351 J355 J359 J363 J367 J371 J375 J379 J383 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66

s
1: G65 3: G66.1

re
J348 J352 J356 J360 J364 J368 J372 J376 J380 J384 — — — — Invalid

ts
gh
ri
Setting Program
No.41 No.42 No.43 No.44 No.45 No.46 No.47 No.48 No.49 No.50 Unit Conditions Description
range type

ll
.A
0 to Work number of
J385 J389 J393 J397 J401 J405 J409 J413 J417 J421 — M, E Immediate the program to be

N
999999999 called

O
The G-code

TI
number to be used
16

A for program call


R
04

Note :
PO
30

J386 J390 J394 J398 J402 J406 J410 J414 J418 J422 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
R
o.

set G-codes
O
N

whose uses are


C

predefined.
al

K
ri

Calling type
ZA

M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66


Se

J387 J391 J395 J399 J403 J407 J411 J415 J419 J423 — 0 to 3
1: G65 3: G66.1
A
IM

J388 J392 J396 J400 J404 J408 J412 J416 J420 J424 — — — — Invalid
K
ZA

Setting Program
No.51 No.52 No.53 No.54 No.55 No.56 No.57 No.58 No.59 No.60 Unit Conditions Description
A

range type
M

0 to Work number of
YA

J433 J437 J441 J445 J449 J453 J457 J461 J465 J469 — M, E Immediate the program to be
999999999 called
3

The G-code
01

number to be used
)2

for program call


Note :
(c

J434 J438 J442 J446 J450 J454 J458 J462 J466 J470 — 0 to 999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to
ht

set G-codes
ig

whose uses are


yr

predefined.
op

Calling type
C

J435 J439 J443 J447 J451 J455 J459 J463 J467 J471 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J436 J440 J444 J448 J452 J456 J460 J464 J468 J472 — — — — Invalid

2-284
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

M-code macroprogram call


Setting Program
No. 1 No .2 No. 3 No. 4 No. 5 Unit Conditions Description
range type
J41 J45 J49 J53 J57
0 to Work number of the
100000090 100000091 100000092 100000093 100000001 — M, E Immediate
999999999 program to be called
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value)
The M-code number to
be used for program call
J42 J46 J50 J54 J58 Note :
90 91 92 93 153 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) Not possible to set
M-codes whose uses

.
are predefined.

d
ve
J43 J47 J51 J55 J59 Calling type

er
0 0 0 0 0 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1

s
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value)

re
J44 J48 J52 J56 J60 Parameter for system

ts
0 0 0 0 0 — — — — internal setting
Setting prohibited

gh
(Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value) (Fixed value)

ri
ll
Setting Program

.A
No. 6 No. 7 No. 8 No. 9 No. 10 Unit Conditions Description
range type

N
J61

O
0 to Work number of the
100000002 J65 J69 J73 J77 — M, E Immediate

TI
999999999 program to be called
(Fixed value)
16

A The M-code number to


R
04

be used for program call


PO
30

J62 Note :
154 J66 J70 J74 J78 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
R
o.

Not possible to set


O

(Fixed value)
N

M-codes whose uses


C

are predefined.
al

K
ri

ZA

J63 Calling type


Se

0 J67 J71 J75 J79 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66


A

(Fixed value) 1: G65 3: G66.1


IM

J64
0 J68 J72 J76 J80 — — — — Invalid
K

(Fixed value)
ZA
A
M

Setting Program
No.11 No.12 No.13 No.14 No.15 No.16 No.17 No.18 No.19 No.20 Unit Conditions Description
YA

range type
0 to Work number of the
3

J145 J149 J153 J157 J161 J165 J169 J173 J177 J181 — M, E Immediate
program to be called
01

999999999
The M-code number to
)2

be used for program call


(c

Note :
ht

J146 J150 J154 J158 J162 J166 J170 J174 J178 J182 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to set
ig

M-codes whose uses


yr

are predefined.
op

Calling type
C

J147 J151 J155 J159 J163 J167 J171 J175 J179 J183 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66
1: G65 3: G66.1
J148 J152 J156 J160 J164 J168 J172 J176 J180 J184 — — — — Invalid

2-285
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Setting Program
No.21 No.22 No.23 No.24 No.25 No.26 No.27 No.28 No.29 No.30 Unit range type
Conditions Description

0 to Work number of the


J473 J477 J481 J485 J489 J493 J497 J501 J505 J509 — M, E Immediate
999999999 program to be called
The M-code number to
be used for program call
Note :
J474 J478 J482 J486 J490 J494 J498 J502 J506 J510 — 0 to 9999 M, E Immediate
Not possible to set
M-codes whose uses
are predefined.

.
Calling type

d
J475 J479 J483 J487 J491 J495 J499 J503 J507 J511 — 0 to 3 M, E Immediate 0: M98 2: G66

ve
1: G65 3: G66.1

er
J476 J480 J484 J488 J492 J496 J500 J504 J508 J512 — — — — Invalid

s
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-286
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Parameter for system internal setting


Setting prohibited


J89
to
J107

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
When updating the model with the SAFETY SHIELD function at power-on,

gh
if “model update completion check interval (300 ms) * the number of
retrials” counting from the start of update is exceeded, it will be regarded

ri
as a failure in model update and alarm 1106 SAFETY SHIELD FAILURE

ll
Maximum number of retrials to update the (3, , ) will be output.

.A
model with the SAFETY SHIELD function 0 or less : 50 times

N
J108 1 or above : The setting value (J108) is regarded as the number of

O
TI
retrials.
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit Times
N

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-287
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Set the chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side or the NC
tailstock position with respect to the machine zero point of the upper turret.
Use BA79 to BA86 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 2.
 Setting the chuck reference position 1 on the No. 2 spindle side
Machine zero point
of the upper turret

J111 J109

d.
ve
er
Barrier setup chuck reference position 1 on

s
J110

re
the No. 2 spindle side
J109 Barrier setup NC tailstock position

ts
to

gh
J112 J112

ri
ll
.A
 Setting the NC tailstock position

N
Machine zero point

O
of the upper turret

TI
16

A J111
R
04

PO
30

J110
R

J109
o.

O
N

Program type M, E
al

Conditions Immediate
ri

ZA
Se

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


A

J112
Setting range –99999999 to 99999999
IM

Set the chuck reference position 2 on the No. 2 spindle side with respect
K

to the machine zero point of the upper turret.


ZA

Use BA79 to BA86 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 2.
A

Machine zero point


M

of the upper turret


Barrier setup chuck reference position 2 on
YA

J113 the No. 2 spindle side


3

to J115 J113
01

J116
)2

J114
(c
ht

Program type M, E
ig

Conditions Immediate
yr

J116
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
op

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


C

2-288
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Specify the ID number of the barrier-setting and barrier-cancelling


M-codes to be used for barrier teaching function.

J119: Barrier-setting M-code to be used for barrier teaching


(If a value other than 1 - 999 is set, the value will be regarded as
Barrier-setting/cancelling M-code to be 846.)
used for barrier teaching
J120: Barrier-cancelling M-code to be used for barrier teaching
J119
(If a value other than 1 - 999 is set, the value will be regarded as
J120 847.)

d .
ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions Immediate

s
Unit —

re
Setting range 1 to 999

ts
gh
Amount of offset for height axis rotational center offset (K124, K128) of the
rotary axis for the tool

ri
<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>

ll
.A
Set the amount of offset for the distance (K124) from the rotational center
of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side) in the direction of the height

N
Amount of offset for height axis rotational

O
axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite

TI
center offset (K124, K128) of the rotary axis side).
16

for the tool (tool tip point control) A


* Height axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis at the tool side =
J121
R
04

K124 + J121
PO
30

<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>


o.

O
N

Set the amount of offset for the distance (K128) from the spindle holder
C
al

end in the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of the tool
K

Program type E control rotary axis (at the tool side).


ri

ZA
Se

Conditions After stop of movement * Height axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis at the tool side =
A

Unit 0.0001 mm K128 + J121


IM

* This parameter can be altered by using system variable #6022.


Setting range —
K
ZA

Specify the ID number of the M-code for making the interference check
function valid/invalid.
A
M

J131: INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function invalid


Setting the M-code for making the
YA

J132: Material model cutting invalid


INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function J133: Machine interference check invalid
J131 valid/invalid during automatic operation
3

J134: Machine interference check valid


01

to J135: Material model interference check invalid


)2

J140 J136: Material model interference check valid


J137: Fixture model interference check invalid
(c

J138: Fixture model interference check valid


ht

Program type M, E J139: Tool model interference check invalid


ig

Conditions Immediate J140: Tool model interference check valid


yr

Unit —
op

Setting range —
C

2-289
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Select whether the M-code registered in parameter J131–J138 to make


the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid during
automatic operation is to be output from the NC to the PLC ladder.
0: Invalid (No output to the PLC ladder)
1: Valid (Output to the PLC ladder)
Selecting whether to output the M-code for
making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY 76543210
SHIELD function valid/invalid during M-code registered in J131
automatic operation
J141 M-code registered in J132

d .
M-code registered in J133

ve
M-code registered in J134

er
M-code registered in J135

s
re
M-code registered in J136
Program type M, E

ts
M-code registered in J137

gh
Conditions Immediate
M-code registered in J138

ri
Unit —

ll
Setting range Binary, eight digits

.A
Select whether the M-code registered in parameter J139 and J140 to

N
make the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function valid/invalid during

O
automatic operation is to be output from the NC to the PLC ladder.

TI
Selecting whether to output the M-code for
16

0: Invalid (No output to the PLC ladder)


A
making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY
R
04

SHIELD function valid/invalid during 1: Valid (Output to the PLC ladder)


J142
PO
30

automatic operation 76543210


(bit 0)
R
o.

(bit 1) M-code registered in J139


O
N

M-code registered in J140


al

Program type M, E
ri

ZA
Se

Conditions Immediate
A

Unit —
IM

Setting range 0, 1
K

Selects whether to output the M codes for temporarily disabling/canceling


ZA

the disabled status of INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD in the automatic


A

operation, which are registered in parameters J550/J551, from the NC to


M

Output selection of M codes for temporarily the PLC ladder.


YA

disabling/canceling disabled status of 0: Disabled (Not output to PLC ladder)


J142 INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in
1: Enabled (Output M code registered in relevant parameter to PLC
3

automatic operation
ladder)
01

(bit 2)
(bit 3)
)2

76543210
(c

M code registered in J550


Program type M, E
ht

M code registered in J551


Conditions
ig

Immediate
yr

Unit —
op

Setting range 0, 1
C

2-290
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

0: Used in the manual programming unit and subprogram unit (EIA/ISO)


1: Cancel
Method to handle the tool offset data when
the program is returned to a MAZATROL
program with the tool offset function set
J143 valid in an EIA/ISO subprogram
(bit 0)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
In reference point return operation, execution of tool change command

gh
waits or does not wait the completion of middle-point return

ri
0 : Do not wait
In reference point return operation (G28,

ll
G30, G30.1), tool change command is 1 : Wait

.A
executed with or without waiting the

N
J143 completion of middle-point return

O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Modal at power-on or at reset.


ri

ZA
Se

0: G23 (Stroke check before movement OFF)


A

1: G22 (Stroke check before movement ON)


IM

Modal selection at power on or at reset


K

(G23/G22)
ZA

J143
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value


ig
yr
op
C


J143
(bit 7)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-291
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Tool interference check type on the TOOL DATA display


0: Magazine-type tool interference check
1: Tool interference check using Racklayout.txt

Tool interference check type


J144
(bit 0)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Overwriting of tool life data (maximum allowable wear, life time, use time,

gh
life count, use count) when parameter L57 is set to 1 (tool data overwriting

ri
during automatic operation valid)

ll
0: Possible

.A
Tool life data overwrite during automatic
1: Impossible
operation

N
J144

O
TI
(bit 2)
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 0, 1
K
ri

ZA

For details, refer to the explanation for M-code macroprogram call.


Se

A
IM
K

M-code macroprogram call


ZA

J145
to
A
M

J184
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for OD (both sides), X-axis


ig

offset for protrusion width)


yr
op

Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis


C

offset for OD (both sides), X-axis offset for


protrusion width)
J235

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 99999999

2-292
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for OD (both sides), Y-axis


offset for protrusion width)

Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis


offset for OD (both sides), Y-axis offset for
protrusion width)
J236

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range 99999999

ts
Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis offset for ID (both sides), X-axis

gh
offset for groove width)

ri
ll
Workpiece measurement offset (X-axis

.A
offset for ID (both sides), X-axis offset for
groove width)

N
J237

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

Setting range 99999999


al

Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis offset for ID (both sides), Y-axis


ri

ZA
Se

offset for groove width)


A
IM

Workpiece measurement offset (Y-axis


offset for ID (both sides), Y-axis offset for
K

groove width)
ZA

J238
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


99999999
(c

Setting range
ht

Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for protrusion width, offset


ig

for ID protrusion width)


yr
op

Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis


C

offset for protrusion width, offset for ID


protrusion width)
J239

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 99999999

2-293
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis offset for groove width, offset for
ID groove)

Workpiece measurement offset (Z-axis


offset for groove width, offset for ID groove)

J240

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range 99999999

ts
For any two axes that run on the same slideway, the maximum distance

gh
that those axes can be separated from each other is set to prevent
damage to the way covers. If the two axes are going to be separated

ri
beyond the value set for this parameter, a software limit alarm is output to

ll
stop the axis movement. Using parameters J251 to J254, the maximum

.A
separating distances can be set for up to four axes.

N
O
TI
Set the machine coordinate of the check target axis, set at parameters
16

L117 to L120, existing at the permissible most separated position from the
A
check reference axis, set at parameters L113 to L116, which is located at
R
04

Software limit relative position check –


PO

the home position.


30

Limit distance in the separating direction


Example :
R

J251: 1st set of axes


o.

In the example shown below, if the W-axis and the Z2-axis are defined
N

J251 J252: 2nd set of axes


C

as the check reference axis and the check target axis, respectively, set
al

l J253: 3rd set of axes


K

the machine coordinate of the Z2-axis existing at the permissible most


ri

ZA

J254: 4th set of axes separated position from the W-axis, which is located at the home
J254
Se

position. If zero is entered, the checking function in the separating


A

direction will be invalid. Note that the check is possible only for the
IM

combination of NC axes.
K
ZA

Machine coordinate
W=0
A
M

Z2-axis
YA
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate J251 Lower turret W-axis


(c

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in machine zero point machine zero point


ht

Setting range ±99999999


ig
yr
op
C

2-294
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

Used to select the mode of operation when an arithmetic operation is


specified without [ ] after a G code.
0: No alarm
1: Alarm

Example : (G code command pattern)


[ When bit 0 of parameter J261 is set to 0 ]
G70 – 1 ······· Handled as G69
G68 + 1······· Handled as G69

d .
ve
Arithmetic operation after G code G1 – 70 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (808 MIS-SET G CODE)

er
G [70 – 1] ···· Handled as G69
J261

s
re
(bit 0)
[ When bit 0 of parameter J261 is set to 1 ]

ts
G70 – 1 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)

gh
G68 + 1······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)

ri
G1 – 70 ······· Stop with alarm displayed (807 ILLEGAL FORMAT)

ll
.A
G [70 – 1] ···· Handled as G69

N
O
TI
16

Program type E Note : A


R
04

Regardless of this parameter setting, the alarm 808 MIS-SET G CODE


Conditions Immediate
PO

occurs when the calculation inside [ ] results in a negative value.


30

Unit —
R
o.

Setting range 0, 1
N

For details, refer to the explanation for G-code macroprogram call.


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

G-code macroprogram call


J265
K

to
ZA

J424
A
M
YA

Program type —
Conditions —
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c

For details, refer to the explanation for G-code macroprogram call.


ht
ig
yr
op

G-code macroprogram call


J433
C

to
J472

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-295
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title CALL MACRO

Address Meaning Description

For details, refer to the explanation for M-code macroprogram call.

M-code macroprogram call


J473
to
J512

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Parameter for system internal setting

gh
Setting prohibited

ri
ll
.A

J513

N
to

O
TI
J530
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

For setting SPRINT interface (option), fixed value


ZA
Se

A
IM
K


J533
ZA

to
A
M

J540
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Specifies the M code numbers for temporarily disabling/canceling the


ig

disabled status of interference check by INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD


yr

in the automatic operation.


op

M code setting for temporarily J550: Temporarily disable the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function
disabling/canceling disabled status of
C

in automatic operation
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in
J551: Cancel disabled status of the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD
J550 automatic operation
function in automatic operation
J551

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 31 to 9999

2-296
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-11 Machine parameter MEASURE (K)

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Distance from the center of the C-axis (spindle) to the nose of the tool

Z
Tool

Rotational radius of the C-axis

K1

d.
K1

ve
X

er
Spindle

s
center

re
K1
Program type E

ts
gh
Conditions Immediate

ri
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Y

ll
Setting range 0 to 99999999

.A
The minimum rotational angle of the C-axis at shaping block connections

N
Rotational angle of the C-axis at block connections: 

O
The C-axis does not rotate if l  l < K2.

TI
16

A
R
04

90°
Minimum rotational angle
PO
30


K2
R
o.

K2
O

180°
N

0° If –K2    K2,
C

C-axis does not rotate.


al

–K2
ri

ZA

Program type E
Se

Conditions Immediate
IM

270°
Unit 0.001° –
K

Setting range 0 to 90000


ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-297
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set identification number of the shaping control axis.


Specify the identification number of the shaping control axis as follows
according to the value set at parameter K105 bit 6 (handling of the
shaping control axis)
Example :
Data unset axis Shaping axis

X Y Z B C V
M1
M2

d .

ve
Identification number of the shaping control ・

er
axis

s
When there is an axis for which data is not set on the MACHINE

re
PARAMETER display (“FEED VEL.” (M), “TIME CONST.” (N), etc.),
K3

ts
where the axis data is set, as shown below, set the identification number

gh
of the shaping axis as follows:

ri
If the value set at parameter K105 bit 6 is:

ll
“0”, set “6”.

.A
Counting of the axis number starts with “1” and the axis for which the
data is not set is not included when counting the axis number.

N
O
“1”, set “7”.

TI
Counting of the axis number starts with “1” and the axis for which the
16

data is not set is included when counting the axis number.


A
R
04

PO

Program type E Note :


30

Set the type of the axis which has been set on this parameter to the
R

Conditions Immediate
o.

rotational axis (M17 bit 4 = 1).


O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 3 to 13
K
ri

ZA

Specify the axis that moves vertically


Se

1 : The X-axis acts as the unbalanced axis.


IM

2 : The Y-axis acts as the unbalanced axis.


4 : The Z-axis acts as the unbalanced axis.
K

Unbalanced axis
ZA

K7
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 1, 2, 4
ht

Fixed value
ig
yr
op
C

K10

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-298
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set this parameter to change the display language.

Setting Language Setting Language


0 English 12 Portuguese
1 Japanese 13 Danish
2 German 14 Czech
3 French 15 Turkish
4 Italian 16 Polish

Selection of language to be displayed 5 Spanish 17 Romanian

d .
6 Norwegian 18 Hungarian

ve
K11 7 Swedish 19 Russian

er
8 Finnish 20 Slovak

s
re
Chinese Chinese
9 21
(traditional character) (simplified character)

ts
10 Dutch 22 Slovenian

gh
11 Korean 25 Bulgarian

ri
ll
.A
Program type — Note :

N
Conditions Immediate To display Japanese characters, traditional and/or simplified Chinese

O
characters, Korean characters, Russian characters, Slovenian

TI
Unit — characters, or Bulgarian characters the appropriate OS (display
16

Setting range 0 to 22, 25


A
language) must be installed in your personal computer.
R
04

PO

Fixed value (0)


30

R
o.

O
N

C
al


ri

ZA
Se

K12
A
IM
K

Program type —
ZA

Conditions —
A
M

Unit —
YA

Setting range —
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-299
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

1. Workpiece measurement
Sensor path
fa
K13
Measurement skip feed rate (X-axis, Z-axis)
Workpiece

K13
Measurement stroke (K19)
fa: Measurement approach
Program type M

.
speed (K14)

d
ve
Conditions Immediate NM211-00233

er
Unit mm/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 20000 2. Tool tip measurement
Tool path

ts
gh
ri
K13

ll
Measurement approach speed (X-axis,

.A
Z-axis) Sensor

N
K14

O
Measurement stroke (K20)

TI
16

A NM211-00234
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate (K19, K20)


R
o.

Unit mm/min
O
N

Setting range 0 to 20000


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Sensor path
A
IM

[1]
Measurement skip speed (C-axis)
K
ZA

[3]
K15 [1], [3] : Rapid feed
A

[2] [2] : Measurement approach


[4] Workpiece
M

speed (K16)
YA

[4] : K15
Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
NM211-00235
)2

Unit °/min
(c

Setting range 0 to 65535


ht
ig
yr
op
C

Measurement approach speed (C-axis)

K16

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit °/min
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-300
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

 With workpiece measurement


1. Tool compensation will be applied in the cases below.
 1 – 2 1 – 2
100  K18  Compensation data  100  K17
 1 – 2 1 – 2
 100  K17  Compensation data   100  K18
2. Tool compensation will not be applied in the cases below.
Specification of measuring tolerance
(lower limit)  1 – 2 1 – 2
100  K17 > Compensation data >  100  K17
K17

.
3. Alarm will be caused in cases below.

d
ve
 1 – 2
Compensation data > 100  K18

s er
 1 – 2

re
 100  K18 > Compensation data

ts
where 1 = Tolerance upper limit

gh
Program type M, E 2 = Tolerance lower limit (Specified in program)

ri
Conditions Immediate

ll

.A
Unit % With tool measurement
1. Tool compensation will be applied in the cases below.

N
Setting range 0 to 100

O
 
100  K18  Compensation data  100  K17

TI
16

 A 
 100  K17  Compensation data   100  K18
R
04

PO
30

2. Tool compensation will not be applied in the cases below.


R

 
o.

100  K17  Compensation data >  100  K17


N

C
al

Specification of measuring tolerance 3. Alarm will be caused in cases below.


K
ri

(upper limit)
ZA


Compensation data > 100  K18
Se

K18
A


IM

 100  K18  Compensation data


K

: Tolerance (tool length/X-axis direction or tool


ZA

radius/Z-axis direction)
A

(Specified in program)
M
YA

Program type M, E
Note :
Conditions Immediate
3

Judgment against the tolerance takes place in tool measurement only


01

Unit % when L106 bit 6 = 1.


)2

Setting range 0 to 100


(c
ht

a
ig

a : Approach point
yr

b : Measurement start point


Measurement stroke for workpiece c : Measurement point
op

measurement b (target data)


C

d : Measurement end point


K19 K19

Measurement region
c
Program type M
K19
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in d NM211-00259
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-301
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

TOOL EYE TOOL EYE


reference reference
point #2 point #1
K20
Measurement stroke for tool nose
measurement K20 K20
K20

K20
Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate TOOL EYE TOOL EYE
reference reference

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in point #4 point #3

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
During approach operation to measurement start point, if touch sensor is

gh
actuated, the C-axis will rotate by angle determined by the measurement
object shape angle and setting value K21.

ri
Example : CW programmed as measurement direction

ll
Coefficient to determine rotation angle

.A
when retrying measurement C reference
face

N
ON : Measurement object shape
K21

O
angle

TI
 :  × K21/100
16

A
R
04

Program type M C-axis rotation by angle


PO

  in this direction
30

Conditions Immediate

R
o.

Unit % NM211-00261
N

Setting range 1 to 1000


al

K
ri

When touch sensor is actuated before reaching target point in C offset


ZA
Se

measurement, set retry frequency.


A

When K22 is set to N (N = 0 to 255), measurement alarm will be indicated


IM

when touch sensor is actuated before reaching measurement target point


Measurement retry frequency when retrying in (N+1)th retry operation.
K

reference face C measurement


ZA

K22
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit Times
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

Specify the number of times the workpiece measurement is to be retried if


ig

a measurement error occurs.


yr
op

Retry frequency for workpiece


C

measurement

K23

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit Times
Setting range 0 to 99999

2-302
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Parameter for system internal setting


Setting prohibited


K24
to
K28

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Delays master/slave axis position matching during automatic error

gh
correction (parameter K103 bit 1 = 0).

ri
ll
Simultaneous control:

.A
Delay counter for automatic correction of
synchronizing errors

N
K29

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Note : The delay time will be 3 seconds if 0 is set.


R
o.

Unit 1.7 ms
N

Setting range 0 to 99999


al

K
ri

Specify the approach speed and pre-measuring speed for laser tool length
ZA
Se

K30 Approach speed for laser tool length (diameter) measurement.


A

measurement
IM

K31 Approach speed for laser tool


diameter measurement
K

K30 K32 Pre-measuring speed for laser tool


ZA

length measurement
to K33 Pre-measuring speed for laser tool
A
M

K33 diameter measurement


YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit mm/min / 0.1 in/min


(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

Specify the pre-measuring spindle speed for laser tool length (diameter)
ig

measurement.
yr
op

K34 Pre-measuring spindle speed for laser


tool length measurement
C

K35 Pre-measuring spindle speed for laser


K34 tool diameter measurement
K35

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-303
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Parameter for system internal setting


Setting prohibited

K36

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
The upper-limit value of the feed rates available while the external

gh
deceleration signal is ON

ri
Feedrate

ll
.A
External deceleration speed

N
K37

O
TI
16

K37 A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

External
Conditions After stop of movement ON deceleration
R
o.

Unit mm/min signal


N

Setting range 0 to 120000 MPL508


al

K
ri

The work number of the macroprogram to be called during S-code


ZA
Se

macroprogram appointment
A

(Programming of “S0000;” causes execution of the macroprogram whose


IM

work number is set using this parameter.)


Work number called during S-code
K

macroprogram appointment
ZA

K38
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate Note : This parameter is valid only when bit 2 of parameter K105 is 1.
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999999


ht

The work number of the macroprogram to be called during T-code


ig

macroprogram appointment
yr

(Programming of “T0000;” causes execution of the macroprogram whose


op

work number is set using this parameter.)


Work number called during T-code
C

macroprogram appointment

K39

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note : This parameter is valid only when bit 3 of parameter K105 is 1.
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999999999

2-304
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

The work number of the macroprogram to be called during macroprogram


appointment using the second auxiliary function

Work number called during second auxiliary


function macroprogram appointment

K40

Program type M, E Note :

d .
1. This parameter is valid only when bit 4 of parameter K105 is 1.

ve
Conditions Immediate
2. See the description of parameter K56 for details of the addresses

er
Unit —
available with the second auxiliary function.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999999

ts
The feed rate during axis movement by G31 (skip function)

gh
If the same block as that of G31 contains an F command, then that feed
rate becomes valid.

ri
ll
.A
G31 skipping speed

N
K41

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit mm/min
N

Setting range 0 to 120000


al

K
ri

The feed rate during axis movement by G31.1 (multi-step skip function)
ZA
Se

If the same block as that of G31.1 contains an F command, then that feed
A

rate becomes valid.


IM

G31.1 skipping speed


K
ZA

K42
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit mm/min
(c

Setting range 0 to 120000


ht

The feed rate during axis movement by G31.2 (multi-step skip function)
ig

If the same block as that of G31.2 contains an F command, then that feed
yr

rate becomes valid.


op
C

G31.2 skipping speed

K43

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 120000

2-305
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

The feed rate during axis movement by G31.3 (multi-step skip function)
If the same block as that of G31.3 contains an F command, then that feed
rate becomes valid.

G31.3 skipping speed

K44

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit mm/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 120000

ts
The feed rate during axis movement by G31.4 (skip function)

gh
If the same block as that of G31.4 contains an F command, then that feed

ri
rate becomes valid.

ll
.A
G31.4 skipping speed

N
K45

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit mm/min
N

Setting range 0 to 120000


al

K
ri

Set the excessive pressing error spread (the amount of drooping).


ZA
Se

A
IM

Excessive pressing error spread


K

(Amount of drooping)
ZA

K46
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm
(c

Setting range 0 to 32767


ht

0: Monitoring based on acceleration


ig

1: Monitoring based on speed


yr

2: Ignoring alarms
op
C

Spindle FB alarm detection method

K48

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2

2-306
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the first number of the M-codes to be used for the M-code standby
function.

Example :
To use M950 to M995 as the standby M-codes set “950” in K49 and “46”
First number of the standby M-codes
in K50.
K49

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 31 to 1000

ts
Set the total number of M-codes to be used for the M-code standby

gh
function.

ri
Example :

ll
To use M950 to M995 as the standby M-codes set “950” in K49 and “46”

.A
Total number of the standby M-codes
in K50.

N
K50

O
TI
Note : If “0” is set, the M-code standby function will be invalid.
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 1000


al

K
ri

Set the M-code to be output if workpiece measurement results in an error


ZA
Se

and is to be retried.
A

Note : If “0” is set, this function will be invalid.


IM

M-code during workpiece measurement M-code output


K

retry operation
ZA

K51
A
M

If workpiece measurement results


in an error and is to be retried
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement M-code output


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 1000


ht

Parameter for system internal setting


ig
yr

Setting prohibited
op
C

K52

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-307
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the type of vocal output language.

Setting Language Setting Language


0 English 11 Korean
1 Japanese 12 Portuguese
2 German 13 Danish
3 French 14 Czech
4 Italian 15 Turkish
Language selection (vocal output)
5 Spanish 16 Polish
6 Norwegian 17 Rumanian

.
K53

d
7 Swedish 18 Hungarian

ve
8 Finnish 19 Russian

er
Chinese (traditional

s
9 20 Slovakian

re
character)

ts
10 Dutch 21 Chinese (simplified character)

gh
Note :

ri
Program type M, E Output will be in English (0) if the selected value is for a language not

ll
Conditions Immediate supported.

.A
Unit —

N
O
Setting range 0 to 21

TI
Set the vocal output sound level.
16

A
R
04

Note : Entry of “0” means no sound level.


PO
30

Sound level (vocal output)


o.

O
N

K54
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Program type M, E
IM

Conditions Immediate
K

Unit —
ZA

Setting range 0 to 100


A
M

A vocal warning will be output if the value of the spindle load meter
YA

exceeds the percentage value set in K55.


3
01

Warning reference value (vocal output)


)2
(c

K55
ht
ig
yr

Program type M, E
op

Conditions Immediate
C

Unit %
Setting range 0 to 200

2-308
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Select the address name of the second auxiliary function from among the
following three types:

Address name Setting (HEX)


Name of second auxiliary function Invalid 0
A 41
K56
B 42
C 43
Program type E
Note :
Conditions At power on

d.
Do not use the same address for the axis name and the second auxiliary

ve
Unit —
function.

er
Hexadecimal two-digit
Setting range

s
0, 41, 42, 43

re
This parameter is used during S-code macroprogram appointment to

ts
select the method of calling the macroprogram whose work number has

gh
been set using the K38 parameter.

ri
ll
Type of S-code macroprogram appointment Setting Calling method

.A
call 0 M98 P

N
K57 1 G65 P

O
2 G66 P

TI
16

A 3 G66.1 P
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

Note : Valid only when bit 2 of K105 is 1.


30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0 to 3
al

This parameter is used during T-code macroprogram appointment to


ri

ZA

select the method of calling the macroporgram whose work number has
Se

been set using the K39 parameter.


A
IM

Type of T-code macroprogram appointment Setting Calling method


K

call 0 M98 P


ZA

K58 1 G65 P


A

2 G66 P
M

3 G66.1 P
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate Note : Valid only when bit 3 of K105 is 1.


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 3
(c
ht

This parameter is used during the second auxiliary function macroprogram


appointment to select the method of calling the macroporgram whose work
ig

number has been set using the K40 parameter.


yr
op

Type of second auxiliary function Setting Calling method


C

macroprogram appointment call 0 M98 P


K59 1 G65 P
2 G66 P
3 G66.1 P
Program type M, E
Note : Valid only when bit 4 of K105 is 1.
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 3

2-309
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (4)

K60

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Fixed value (1)

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
K61

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Fixed value (1)


ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

K62
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Fixed value (1)


ig
yr
op
C

K63

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-310
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (2)

K64

Program type —

.
d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Fixed value (1)

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
K65

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Fixed value (1)


ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

K66
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Fixed value (1)


ig
yr
op
C

K67

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-311
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Coordinate system with reference to which the offset amounts are to be


used in tool length offset for the selected machining surface.
(For machines of five-surface machining by angular tools)
Coordinate system in which the amount of 0: Machine coordinate system
tool offset becomes valid (for five-face 1: Workpiece coordinate system
machining by angular tools)
K68
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value (0)

gh
ri
ll
.A

K68

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

Fixed value (0)


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

K68
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c

0 : Invalid
ht
ig

1 : Valid
yr
op

Override/dryrun speed valid/invalid when


C

the G31 command is issued


K68
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-312
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Whether or not all the barrier cancel data in


the program is to be cleared by executing
the MMS unit in the MAZATROL program
K68
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-2 is used as

gh
the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
ll
1: Used as the skip signal

.A
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-2
K69

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-10 is used


ri

ZA

as the skip signal:


Se

0: Not used as the skip signal


IM

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.1 skip condition SKIP-10
K

K69
ZA

(bit 1)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as


ht

the skip signal:


ig

0: Not used as the skip signal


yr

1: Used as the skip signal


op

G31.1 skip condition SKIP-3


C

K69
(bit 2)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-313
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-11 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-11
K69
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
Unit —

ser
Setting range 0, 1

re
In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-5 is used as

ts
the skip signal:

gh
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
1: Used as the skip signal

ll
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-5

.A
K69

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

Program type E
A
R
04

PO

Conditions After stop of movement


30

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-13 is used


ri

ZA

as the skip signal:


Se

0: Not used as the skip signal


A
IM

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.1 skip condition SKIP-13
K

K69
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as


ht

the skip signal:


ig

0: Not used as the skip signal


yr

1: Used as the skip signal


op

G31.1 skip condition SKIP-6


C

K69
(bit 6)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-314
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.1 command, whether or not SKIP-14 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.1 skip condition SKIP-14
K69
(bit 7)

Program type E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-2 is used as

ts
the skip signal:

gh
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
1: Used as the skip signal

ll
.A
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-2

N
K70

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-10 is used


Se

as the skip signal:


A

0: Not used as the skip signal


IM

1: Used as the skip signal


K

G31.2 skip condition SKIP-10


ZA

K70
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as


ig

the skip signal:


yr

0: Not used as the skip signal


op

1: Used as the skip signal


C

G31.2 skip condition SKIP-3


K70
(bit 2)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-315
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-11 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-11
K70
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-5 is used as

ts
the skip signal:

gh
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
1: Used as the skip signal

ll
.A
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-5

N
K70

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-13 is used


Se

as the skip signal:


A

0: Not used as the skip signal


IM

1: Used as the skip signal


K

G31.2 skip condition SKIP-13


ZA

K70
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as


ig

the skip signal:


yr

0: Not used as the skip signal


op

1: Used as the skip signal


C

G31.2 skip condition SKIP-6


K70
(bit 6)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-316
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.2 command, whether or not SKIP-14 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.2 skip condition SKIP-14
K70
(bit 7)

Program type E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
Unit —

ser
Setting range 0, 1

re
In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-2 is used as

ts
the skip signal:

gh
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
1: Used as the skip signal

ll
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-2

.A
K71

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

Program type E
A
R
04

PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-10 is used


ri

ZA

as the skip signal:


Se

0: Not used as the skip signal


A
IM

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.3 skip condition SKIP-10
K

K71
ZA

(bit 1)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-3 is used as


ht

the skip signal:


ig

0: Not used as the skip signal


yr
op

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.3 skip condition SKIP-3
C

K71
(bit 2)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-317
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-11 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-11
K71
(bit 3)

Program type E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
Unit —

ser
Setting range 0, 1

re
In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-5 is used as

ts
the skip signal:

gh
0: Not used as the skip signal

ri
1: Used as the skip signal

ll
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-5

.A
K71

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
Program type E
04

PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-13 is used


ri

ZA

as the skip signal:


Se

0: Not used as the skip signal


A
IM

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.3 skip condition SKIP-13
K

K71
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-6 is used as


ht

the skip signal:


ig
yr

0: Not used as the skip signal


op

1: Used as the skip signal


G31.3 skip condition SKIP-6
C

K71
(bit 6)

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-318
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

In the execution of the G31.3 command, whether or not SKIP-14 is used


as the skip signal:
0: Not used as the skip signal
1: Used as the skip signal
G31.3 skip condition SKIP-14
K71
(bit 7)

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
76543210 (0: Invalid 1: Valid)

gh
ri
SKIP-2

ll
SKIP-10

.A
G31.4 skip conditions
SKIP-3

N
K72 SKIP-11

O
HR353

TI
SKIP-5
16

A SKIP-13
R
04

Program type E SKIP-6


PO
30

SKIP-14
Conditions After stop of movement
R
o.

Unit —
N

Select the skip signal for the G31.4 command.


C

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

K
ri

ZA

76543210 (0: Invalid 1: Valid)


Se

A
IM

SKIP-2
G4 skip conditions
K

SKIP-10 QX721
ZA

K73 SKIP-3
A
M

Select the skip signal for G4 command.


YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range Binary, eight digits


ht

Set the desired time from an emergency stop to the start of cutting off the
ig

contactor of the main power to the driving section during the execution of a
yr

safety supervisory function when all-axis zero-speed confirmation is


op

impossible.
Emergency stop contactor cutoff time
C

A contactor cutoff signal will be immediately output if all-axis zero-speed


(Safety supervisory function) confirmation is executable earlier than the set time.
K74

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit s
Setting range 0 to 60

2-319
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Specify a remote I/O device that is to output a contactor


activating/deactivating signal when the safety supervisory function is
executed.

Contactor control output device 1


Note : The signal will not be output if “&0” is specified.
(Safety supervisory function)

K75

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F

ts
Specify another remote I/O device that is to output the contactor

gh
activating/deactivating signal when the safety supervisory function is
executed.

ri
ll
Contactor control output device 2

.A
Note : The signal will not be output if “&0” is specified.
(Safety supervisory function)

N
K76

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range &0 to &7F


al

K
ri

Enter the device number of the remote I/O device to be activated to input a
ZA
Se

door open/closed status signal. The device of the entered serial device
A

number will be reserved according to the particular setting of K78 (the


IM

parameter for setting the number of door switches).


Door switch input device
K

(Safety supervisory function)


ZA

Note : Door switch input will be invalid if “&0” is entered.


K77
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range &0 to &7F


ht

Set the number of doors for which the door open/closed status signal is to
ig

be output.
yr
op

Number of door switches


C

(Safety supervisory function)

K78

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16

2-320
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the filtering time for the speed that is to be monitored in a servo-off
status during safety speed monitoring.

Supervisory speed filtering time during Note : Input of “0” means 200 ms.
servo-off
(Safety supervisory function)
K79

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit 1.777 ms

s
re
Setting range 0 to 1000

ts
A vocal warning will be output when the value of the load meter for servo

gh
axis control reaches or exceeds the percentage value set in K80.

ri
ll
Warning reference value

.A
(Vocal output)

N
K80

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 200


al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM

Timer for machining management


K
ZA

K81
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit ms
(c

Setting range 0 to 32767


ht

Fixed value
ig
yr
op
C

K82

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-321
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the maximum amount of compensation for workpiece thermal


expansion. In order to prevent eventual collision, the maximum amount
should not exceed the distance between software limit and mechanical
end on any axis concerned.
Maximum amount of compensation for
workpiece thermal expansion Note :
1. If 0 is set here, compensation will not be made for workpiece thermal
K83 expansion.
2. This parameter is valid for machining centers with the capability of
compensating for workpiece thermal expansion.
Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.00005 mm

s
re
Setting range 0 to 32767

ts
Specify the maximum amount of compensation for workpiece thermal

gh
expansion in each interpolating cycle.

ri
If the compensation amount computed exceeds the maximum value (as
Maximum allowable amount of set with K84), compensation will be executed by dividing the interpolation

ll
.A
compensation for workpiece thermal motion into multiple sections.
expansion in each interpolating cycle

N
Note :
K84

O
1. If 0 is set here, the amount is set to 0.001 mm.

TI
16

2. This parameter is valid for machining centers with the capability of


A
compensating for workpiece thermal expansion.
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.00005 mm
O
N

Setting range 0 to 32767


al

If the setting of K85 is from 1 to 300 ms, this setting will be used as the
ri

ZA

linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the G32 threading block.


Se

If the setting is outside the valid range, however, the normal linear
IM

acceleration/deceleration time constant for G01 will be used.


Special linear acceleration/deceleration
K

time constant for threading


ZA

K85
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit ms
)2

Setting range 0 to 32767


(c
ht

Parameter for system internal setting Setting prohibited


ig
yr
op
C


K87
to
K89

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-322
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

The overriding value for return from the hole bottom during a synchronous
tapping cycle

Return override during synchronous tapping

K90

Programmed × K90
feed rate 100
Program type E

d.
ve
Conditions After stop of movement MPL509

er
Unit % Note : This parameter is valid only when bit 6 of F94 is 1.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999

ts
Specify an alternative M-code for M96 when user macro interruption is

gh
valid.

ri
ll
.A
Alternative M-code for M96

N
K91

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 127


al

K
ri

Specify an alternative M-code for M97 when user macro interruption is


ZA
Se

valid.
A
IM

Alternative M-code for M97


K
ZA

K92
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 127


ht

Fixed value (2)


ig
yr
op
C

K93

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-323
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

If [ATC STOP] does not need to be deselected to restart the automatic


operation that has been stopped by tapping [ATC STOP], set this
parameter to “1” (only for applicable machines).
Selection of whether or not the menu 0: [ATC STOP] is to be made invalid
function is to be made invalid after
operation has been stopped by [ATC 1: [ATC STOP] is not to be made invalid
K94 STOP]
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select indexing operation in measurement unit when the rotation position

gh
in index unit is blank.
0: Move to the zero point.

ri
ll
1: Do not move.

.A
Indexing in measurement unit
K94

N
O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Command code to be displayed in the MDI window when [W SUB] is


ri

ZA

selected in the MDI mode


Se

0: G110B2
IM

W-axis command code selection for MDI 1: G110Z[B]2


K

mode
K94
ZA

(bit 3)
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: Displayed
ht
ig

1: Not displayed
yr

(A tool life alarm will be displayed.)


Display/No display of a block start interlock
op

* Only the alarm display is invalid while interlock remains valid.


alarm if tool life of a tool specified in the
C

block has expired Alarm 135 BLOCK START INTERLOCK is not displayed on the ALARM
K94 or ALARM HISTORY display.
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-324
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

76543210

Select whether the difference in angle between the


upper and lower turrets is to be incorporated into
the current C-axis position display of HD2.
0: Yes (Incorporated)
1: No (Not incorporated)

Fixed value (0)


Tool position compensation during T-command

.
execution

d
ve
0: Not performed

1: Performed

s er
K95 Coordinate system update during handle pulse

re
interrupt

ts
0: Not performed

gh
1: Performed

ri
Fixed value (0)

ll
Acceleration/deceleration time constant for handle

.A
pulse feed

N
0: Time constant for cutting feed

O
1: No time constant

TI
Software limits for G30 execution
16

Program type M, E
A 0: Invalid
R
04

1: Valid
PO

Conditions At power on
30

In-position check
R

Unit — 0: Invalid
o.

1: Valid
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


C
al

76543210
ri

ZA

G0 command in-position check


Se

0: Check
IM

1: Non-check
K

Timing of manual free feed finish signal


ZA

0: Smoothing
1: Distribution finish (equivalent to DEN)
A
M

— Fixed value (0)


YA

K96 Axis/Cutting interlock alarm display


0: Valid
3
01

1: Invalid
)2

Suppression of lost motion in modes other than the


(c

G1 command mode
ht

0: Valid
ig

1: Invalid
yr

Program type M, E Fixed value (0)


op

Conditions After stop of movement


Fixed value (0)
C

Unit —
Fixed G0 inclination
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-325
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the name of the axis to be made parallel with respect to the
direction of the spindle when the angle of the B-axis is 0 degrees.

B-axis misalignment correction


Name of parallel axis
K97

Program type M, E

d .
Note : If 0 is entered, the axis will be regarded as the Z-axis (&5A).

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits

s
re
Setting range &41 to &5A

ts
Specify the name of the axis to be made orthogonal with respect to the

gh
direction of the spindle when the angle of the B-axis is 0 degrees.

ri
ll
B-axis misalignment correction

.A
Name of orthogonal axis

N
K98

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Note : If 0 is entered, the axis will be regarded as the X-axis (&58).
R
o.

Unit Hexadecimal, two digits


N

Setting range &41 to &5A


al

K
ri

Specify the name of the rotational axis to undergo dynamic offset.


ZA
Se

A
IM

Dynamic offset
K

Name of rotational axis


ZA

K99
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit Hexadecimal, two digits


(c

Setting range &41 to &5A


ht

Specify the name of the axis to be made parallel with respect to the
ig

rotational plane of the rotational axis to undergo dynamic offset.


yr
op

Dynamic offset
C

Name of parallel axis


K100

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits
Setting range &41 to &5A

2-326
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the name of the axis to be made orthogonal with respect to the
rotational plane of the rotational axis to undergo dynamic offset.

Dynamic offset
Name of orthogonal axis
K101

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits

s
re
Setting range &41 to &5A

ts
Fixed value (0)

gh
ri
ll
.A

K102

N
(bit 0)

O
to

TI
(bit 2)
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

How to use the data of compensation for the sensing tool’s eccentricity
ri

ZA
Se

and stylus radius in workpiece measurement and coordinate measure-


A

ment.
IM

0: M Pro scheme
For workpiece measurement: No use of eccentricity settings; Use of
K

stylus radius settings for both longitudinal (workpiece-axial) and


ZA

transverse (workpiece-radial) directions.


A

Compensation method for the sensing For coordinate measurement: Use of eccentricity setting for the direc-
M

tool’s eccentricity and stylus radius in tion of measuring feed; Use of stylus radius setting for transverse
YA

workpiece measurement and coordinate (workpiece-radial) direction.


K102 measurement 1: New scheme
3

Full use of the eccentricity and stylus radius settings for both work-
01

(bit 3)
piece measurement and coordinate measurement.
)2

* Setting of this parameter and compensation method


(c
ht

Eccentricity Stylus radius


K102
ig

bit 3 Measurement Other


Axial Radial
direction directions
yr

0 Invalid Invalid Valid Valid


op

Program type M Workpiece


measurement 1 Valid Valid Valid Valid
C

Conditions Immediate
Coordinate 0 Valid Invalid Invalid Valid
Unit — measurement 1 Valid Valid Valid Valid
Setting range 0, 1

2-327
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay points for a measurement unit.
0: Direction opposite to the program coordinate system
X
Z-axis direction for setting the TPC relay
points for a measurement unit
K102 Z
(bit 4)
1: Direction of the program coordinate system

X
Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit — Z

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Barrier information for EIA/ISO programs is to be set

gh
0: in the relevant parameters,

ri
1: on the SET UP MANAGE. display.

ll
Barrier information setting for EIA/ISO

.A
programs

N
K102

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Whether or not, on the TOOL DATA display, the direction of rotation can
ZA
Se

be specified for milling tools mounted on the turret.


A
IM

0: No
Setting the direction of rotation for milling 1: Yes (Forward/Reverse)
K

tools
K102
ZA

(bit 6)
A
M
YA

Program type M
Conditions At power on
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Fixed value (0)


ht
ig
yr
op


C

K102
(bit 7)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-328
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Handling of the sign assigned to hobbing address D
(Note 1)
0: If plus (+), the workpiece spindle and the milling
spindle rotate in opposite directions.
If minus (–), both spindles rotate in the same
direction.
1: If plus (+), the workpiece spindle and the milling
spindle rotate in the same direction.
If minus (–), both spindles rotate in opposite

.
directions (MT Pro compatible).

d
ve
Synchronous control error auto-correction (Note 2)

er
0: Valid 1: Invalid

s
re
Fixed value
K103

ts
DDB micron unit

gh
0: Interpolation 1: Microns

ri
Fixed value

ll
Output of S-code and T-code at restart

.A
0: Invalid 1: Valid

N
* Set 0 for machining center specifications.

O
Whether FIXED PT can be selected at RETURN of

TI
16

A the end unit of the MAZATROL program


0: Possible to select
R
04

1: Impossible to select
PO
30

R
o.

Program type M, E Note :


O
N

Conditions Immediate 1. K103 bit 0 is valid, only when M17 bit 5 = 1.


al

Unit — 2. Even with K103 bit 1 = 0, unless M17 bit 4 is set to 0 (linear axis) for
ri

ZA

the axis concerned, auto-correction is not made valid.


Se

Setting range Binary, eight digits


A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-329
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Output of a laser measurement B-axis 0-degree
command after ATC
0: Output invalid
1: Output valid
Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring
instrument
0: Depends on the setting of parameter L16.
L16 = 1: Parallel to the Y-axis,
L16 = 2: Parallel to the X-axis

d .
1: Depends on the setting of bit 2 in parameter

ve
K104.

er
Direction of the laser axis of the laser measuring

s
re
instrument
0: Parallel to the Y-axis

ts
1: Parallel to the X-axis

gh
Note :

ri
— This parameter is valid when K104 bit 1 = 1.

ll
.A
Voice Adviser (Vocal output function)
K104

N
0: Invalid

O
1: Valid

TI
16

A Type of voice
0: Male’s voice
R
04

PO

1: Female’s voice
30

Vocal guidance for warm-up operation


R
o.

0: Invalid
N

1: Valid
al

Machine status when rapid feed command is given


ri

ZA

with cutting feed override set to 0%


Se

0: Alarm stop
IM

1: Operation is executed.
Feed rate for an approach to the starting point in
K
ZA

EIA modal restarting mode


0: Approach at the feed rate during manual
A

Program type M, E operations


M

1: If the modal command during the search is G0,


YA

Conditions Immediate
approach at G0, or if the modal command is
Unit — other than G0, approach at G1
3
01

Setting range Binary, eight digits


)2

Fixed value (1)


(c
ht
ig


yr
op

K105
C

(bit 1)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-330
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

S-code macro call invalid/valid


K105
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
.A
T-code macro call invalid/valid

N
K105

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: Invalid
ZA
Se

1: Valid
A
IM

Second auxiliary function macro call


K

invalid/valid
ZA

K105
A

(bit 4)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Fixed value (0)


ig
yr
op
C


K105
(bit 5)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-331
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Select the value to be set (shaping control axis) at parameter K3.


On the MACHINE PARAMETER display (“FEED VEL.” (M), “TIME
CONST.” (N), etc.) where the axis data is set,
0: The identification number of the shaping control axis is handled as a
number that does not include the axes for which data is not set.
Handling of the shaping control axis 1: The identification number of the shaping control axis is handled as a
K105 number that includes the axes for which data is not set.
(bit 6) Refer to the explanation for parameter K3 for the example of setting.

Data unset axis Shaping axis

d .
ve
X Y Z B C V
Program type E

er
M1

s
Conditions Immediate M2

re
— ・
Unit

ts

Setting range 0, 1

gh
ri
Fixed value (0)

ll
.A
N
O

TI
K105
16

(bit 7)
A
R
04

PO
30

Program type —
o.

O
N

Conditions —
C
al

Unit —
ri

ZA

Setting range —
Se

76543210
IM

Execution conditions for user macroprogram


K

interrupt
ZA

0: Edge triggering (Performed just once when the


A

interrupt signal is turned ON)


M

1: Status triggering (Repeatedly performed while


YA

the interrupt signal is ON)


3

— Start timing for user macroprogram interrupt


01

0: The block under execution is aborted and then


)2

K106 the interrupt occurs immediately.


1: Interrupt occurs after completion of the block
(c

being executed.
ht
ig

Fixed value (0)


yr

Fixed value
op
C

Fixed value (0)

Program type M, E Fixed value (0)


Conditions At power on Fixed value (0)
Unit — Fixed value (0)
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-332
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)


K107
(bit 0)

Program type —

.
d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
0: Switching to 1-mm increments

gh
1: Switching to 1/2.54-mm increments

ri
Switching of measurement unit used to read

ll
parameters for error compensation of * When this parameter is set to 1, the measurement unit is switched to the

.A
rotation center of the tilt table with inch system for parameter L134 (Y-axis runout of the A-axis) and
K107

N
inch-specification machines parameter L135 (Z-axis runout of the A-axis).

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: In radius values
ri

ZA
Se

1: In diameter values
A

* Invalid for the axis for which bit 5 of M18 is set to 1.


IM

Motion distance in the manual pulse feed


mode for the axis whose position is
K

displayed in diameter value.


ZA

K107
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Deceleration for arc valid/invalid


ig
yr
op
C

Deceleration for arc valid/invalid


K107
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-333
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)


K107
(bit 7)

Program type —

d .
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Specify the maximum permissible error range for the master and slave

gh
axes for synchronous control (Tandem driving system).

ri
If the specified range is overstepped, alarm 141 EXCESS
SIMULTANEOUS ERROR will be displayed.

ll
Permissible error range for synchronous

.A
Note : Error checking will not occur if 0 is set.
control

N
K108

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

0.0001 mm
O

Unit
N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

Set the judgment angle near a singular point. The setting, if 0, will be
ZA
Se

handled as 1°.
A
IM

Judgment angle near a singular point


K
ZA

K110
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of axis movement


)2

Unit °
(c

Setting range 0 to 360


ht

Set the clamping speed (speed command) in safety supervisory mode 3.


ig
yr
op

Clamping speed in safety supervisory mode


C

K111

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 1000

2-334
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the type of machine.


1: Tool tilt type
2: Mixed type
3: Table tilt type
Example :
1 = Tool tilt type 2 = Mixed type
1st rotary axis
for the tool

.
Rotary axis for

d
the tool

ve
Machine type 2nd rotary axis
for the tool

er
Tool
Workpiece

s
K113 Tool

re
Workpiece Table

ts
gh
Table Rotary axis

ri
for the table

ll
3 = Table tilt type

.A
N
Table

O
Tool

TI
1st rotary axis
16

Workpiece for the table


Program type E A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit —
R
o.

Setting range 1 to 3 2nd rotary axis for the table


N

Set the axis number of the horizontal axis in the rectangular coordinate
al

system.
ri

ZA

A setting of 0 is invalid.
Se

A
IM

Axis number of the horizontal axis in the


rectangular coordinate system
K

K114
ZA
A
M
YA

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 16
(c

Set the axis number of the vertical axis in the rectangular coordinate
ht

system.
A setting of 0 is invalid.
ig
yr

Axis number of the vertical axis in the


op

rectangular coordinate system


C

K115

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16

2-335
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the axis number of the height axis in the rectangular coordinate
system.
A setting of 0 is invalid.

Axis number of the height axis in the


rectangular coordinate system

K116

Program type E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 16

ts
1 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the horizontal axis.

gh
2 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the vertical axis.

ri
3 : Machines with 4 axes, the rotary axis rotates about the height axis.

ll
12: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about horizontal axis,

.A
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about vertical axis.

N
13: 2nd rotary axis .... Rotates about horizontal axis,
Rotational direction of the rotary axis

O
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about height axis.

TI
21: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about vertical axis,
16

K117 A
1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about horizontal axis.
R
04

PO

23: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about vertical axis,


30

1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about height axis.


R
o.

31: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about height axis,


O
N

1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about horizontal axis.


C

Program type E
al

32: 2nd rotary axis ...... Rotates about height axis,


ri

Conditions Immediate
ZA

1st rotary axis ....... Rotates about vertical axis.


Se

Unit —
A
IM

Setting range —
Set the axis number of the first rotary axis.
K

A setting of 0 is invalid.
ZA
A
M

Axis number of the first rotary axis


YA

K121
3
01
)2
(c

Program type E
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

Unit —
yr

Setting range 0 to 16
op
C

2-336
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>


Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
the tool side) in the direction of the horizontal axis to the rotational center
of the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite side).
Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the
first rotary axis <If the first rotary axis rotates for table control>
K122 Set the distance from the spindle tip point in the direction of the horizontal
axis to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at the opposite
side) when all axes are in the machine home position.

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>

gh
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at

ri
the tool side) in the direction of the vertical axis to the rotational center of
the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite side).

ll
Vertical axis rotational center offset of the

.A
first rotary axis <If the first rotary axis rotates for table control>

N
K123 Set the distance from the spindle tip point in the direction of the horizontal

O
axis to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at the opposite

TI
side) when all axes are in the machine home position.
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

<If the first rotary axis rotates for tool control>


ri

ZA
Se

Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
A

the tool side) in the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of
IM

the tool control rotary axis (at the opposite side).


K

Note :
ZA

In the case of machines with the capability of Maza-Check, the height


A

Height axis rotational center offset of the axis rotational center offset is equal to K124 + J121 (amount of height
M

first rotary axis axis rotational center offset of the rotary axis on the tool side).
YA

K124
<If the first rotary axis rotates for table control>
3
01

Set the distance from the spindle tip point in the direction of the height axis
)2

to the rotational center of the table control rotary axis (at the opposite side)
when all axes are in the machine home position.
(c
ht

Note :
ig

Program type E When K113 = 2 (machine type: mix type), K124 has the same meaning
yr

as BA62 (amount of offset for the B-axis - spindle). In the case of inch
Conditions Immediate
op

specifications, multiply the BA62 value by 2.54, round off to the nearest
whole number, and enter this value to K124.
C

Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999

2-337
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the axis number of the second rotary axis.


A setting of 0 is invalid.

Axis number of the second rotary axis

K125

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 16

ts
<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>

gh
Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the

ri
horizontal axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
tool side).

ll
Horizontal axis rotational center offset of the

.A
second rotary axis <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>

N
K126 Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in

O
the direction of the horizontal axis to the rotational center of the table

TI
control rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine
16

A
home position.
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>


ri

ZA
Se

Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the vertical
A

axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side).
IM

Vertical axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>
K

second rotary axis Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in
ZA

K127 the direction of the vertical axis to the rotational center of the table control
A

rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine home
M

position.
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm
)2

Setting range ±99999999


(c
ht

<If the second rotary axis rotates for tool control>


ig

Set the distance from the spindle holder end in the direction of the height
yr

axis to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the tool side).
op

Height axis rotational center offset of the <If the second rotary axis rotates for table control>
C

second rotary axis Set the distance from the rotational center of the table control rotary axis in
K128 the direction of the height axis to the rotational center of the table control
rotary axis (at the workpiece side) when all axes are in the machine home
position.

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999

2-338
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
deviation in the vertical axis direction
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
deviation in the horizontal axis direction
Position deviation 1 of the first rotary axis When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
deviation in the horizontal axis direction
K129

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm

s
re
Setting range ±30000

ts
When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position

gh
deviation in the height axis direction

ri
When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
deviation in the height axis direction

ll
.A
Position deviation 2 of the first rotary axis When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
deviation in the vertical axis direction

N
K130

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit
O

0.0001 mm
N

Setting range ±30000


al

K
ri

When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
ZA
Se

deviation in the vertical axis direction


A

When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
IM

deviation in the horizontal axis direction


Position deviation 1 of the second rotary
K

axis When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
ZA

deviation in the horizontal axis direction


K131
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm
(c

Setting range ±30000


ht

When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: center position
ig

deviation in the height axis direction


yr

When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: center position
op

deviation in the height axis direction


Position deviation 2 of the second rotary
C

When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: center position
axis
deviation in the vertical axis direction
K132

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±30000

2-339
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the X-axis deviation of the spindle center position. Normally set 0
because the zero point is determined with respect to the spindle center
position. This parameter is invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type
machine, and 4-axis machine of table-side rotation type.
X-axis position deviation at the spindle
center position

K133

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm

s
re
Setting range ±30000

ts
Set the Y-axis deviation of the spindle center position. Normally set 0

gh
because the coordinate origin is determined with respect to the spindle
center position. This parameter is invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt

ri
type machine, and 4-axis machine of table-side rotation type.

ll
Y-axis position deviation at the spindle

.A
center position

N
K134

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit
O

0.0001 mm
N

Setting range ±30000


al

K
ri

When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
ZA
Se

about vertical axis


A

When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation about
IM

horizontal axis
Angle deviation 1 of the first rotary axis
K

centerline When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation about
ZA

vertical axis
K135
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001
(c

Setting range ±10000


ht

When the first rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
ig

about height axis


yr

When the first rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation about
op

height axis
Angle deviation 2 of the first rotary axis
C

When the first rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation about
centerline
horizontal axis
K136

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001
Setting range ±10000

2-340
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation
about vertical axis
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation
about horizontal axis
Angle deviation 1 of the second rotary axis
When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation
centerline
about vertical axis
K137

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001

s
re
Setting range ±10000

ts
When the second rotary axis rotates about horizontal axis: angle deviation

gh
about height axis

ri
When the second rotary axis rotates about vertical axis: angle deviation
about height axis

ll
Angle deviation 2 of the second rotary axis

.A
centerline When the second rotary axis rotates about height axis: angle deviation
about horizontal axis

N
K138

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit
O

0.0001
N

Setting range ±10000


al

K
ri

Set the X-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline. This parameter is
ZA
Se

invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type machine, and 4-axis machine
A

of table-side rotation type.


IM

X-axis angle deviation of the spindle


K

centerline
ZA

K139
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001
(c

Setting range ±10000


ht

Set the Y-axis angle deviation of the spindle centerline. This parameter is
ig

invalid with the 3-axis machine, table tilt type machine, and 4-axis machine
yr

of table-side rotation type.


op

Y-axis angle deviation of the spindle


C

centerline

K140

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001
Setting range ±10000

2-341
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the axis name of the spindle to be rotated in orbit machining.

Axis name of the spindle to be rotated in


orbit machining

K242

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions After resetting

er
Unit Hexadecimal, two digits

s
re
Setting range &00 to &7F

ts
Set the M code number of the forward rotation command for orbit

gh
machining.

ri
ll
.A
M code number of the forward rotation
command for orbit machining

N
O
K243

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
N

C
al

Setting range 0 to 999


K
ri

ZA

Set the M code number of the reverse rotation command for orbit
Se

machining.
A
IM

M code number of the reverse rotation


K

command for orbit machining


ZA

K244
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 999


ht

Set the M code number of the rotation stop command for orbit machining.
ig
yr
op
C

M code number of the rotation stop


command for orbit machining

K245

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 999

2-342
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Permissible error at involute interpolation end point


Sets the permissible error between the involute curve that passes the start
point and that which passes the end point in involute interpolation.
L in the figure corresponds to the involute interpolation error at the end
point.

Involute curve that


passes the end point
End point
Involute curve
Y that passes L

d .
the start point

ve
Start

er
point

s
Permissible error at involute interpolation

re
end point

ts
K246

gh
ri
ll
Base circle

.A
X
0

N
O
TI
If the error L becomes larger than the value set for this parameter, the
16

A
alarm 817 INCORRECT ARC DATA occurs at the start point of the
R
04

involute interpolation.
PO
30

R
o.

Note :
O
N

When 0 is set, the permissible error at the end point becomes 0,


Program type E
al

meaning that the alarm 817 INCORRECT ARC DATA occurs unless the
K
ri

Conditions Immediate
ZA

curve that passes the start point completely coincides with the curve that
Se

passes the end point.


Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
A

When a value outside the setting range is set, 0 is assumed.


IM

Setting range 0 to 99999999


Sets the maximum acceleration permitted in involute interpolation to clamp
K
ZA

the acceleration. The feedrate in the tangential direction can be clamped


to maintain the acceleration within the value set for this parameter.
A

Note :
M

Involute interpolation permissible


YA

When this parameter is set to 0 or a value outside the setting range, the
acceleration
involute acceleration/deceleration clamp function is disabled and the
K247
3

feedrate in the tangential direction becomes constant regardless of the


01

curvature radius.
)2
(c

Program type E
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

2
Unit 0.1 mm/sec
yr
op

Setting range 0 to 99999999


C

2-343
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Sets the minimum feedrate permitted in involute interpolation to clamp the


acceleration. When the lower limit for the clamping feedrate is set for this
parameter, the feedrate in the tangential direction is adjusted so that it
does not go below the lower limit.
Involute interpolation minimum feedrate Note :
1. When a value outside the setting range is set, 0 is assumed.
K248 2. This parameter is valid when K247 > 0.

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit mm/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Sets the lower limit for the involute interpolation override. When this

gh
parameter is set, the override is adjusted according to the curvature radius

ri
so that the feedrate at the cutting position becomes the specified feedrate,
with respect to the feedrate at the tool center path.

ll
.A
Involute interpolation override lower limit Note :

N
When this parameter is set to 0 or a value outside the setting range, the

O
K249 involute interpolation override function is disabled and the override is

TI
always set to 100% during tool radius offset.
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

C
al

Setting range 0 to 100


K
ri

ZA

Sets the time to wait before the zero-speed signal of the hobbing axis
Se

(V-axis) turns ON upon specifying G113 (hobbing end) or interruption of


A

hobbing during hobbing II operation.


IM

Wait time before turning ON of zero-speed


K

signal upon ending hobbing II (position


ZA

controlled hobbing)
K250
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit ms
(c

Setting range 0 to 65000


ht

Fixed value
ig
yr
op
C

K252

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-344
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Set the angle of the mill spindle when the tip of the tool in the mill spindle is
oriented in the +X-axis direction in orbit machining.

Angle that sets the mill spindle tool tip in the


+X-axis direction in orbit machining

K253

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001°

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Fixed value (1)

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
K257

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type —
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA

Fixed value
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

K257
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

0: Rotated in the forward direction


ig

1: Rotated in the reverse direction


yr
op

Direction of mill spindle rotation in orbit


C

machining
K257
(bit 3)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-345
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Display of the alarm 1154 FEED LIMITED IN ORBIT MACHINING upon


clamping the speed in orbit machining
0: Not displayed
1: Displayed
Speed clamp alarm display in orbit
machining
K257
(bit 4)

Program type E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
K257

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type —
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA

Fixed value (0)


Se

A
IM
K


ZA

K257
A

(bit 6)
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Fixed value (1)


ig
yr
op
C


K257
(bit 7)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-346
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Spindle speed override unit switching function


0: Invalid
1: Valid
Spindle speed override unit switching
function
K258
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
.A
MDI input support function
K258

N
O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: Invalid
ri

ZA
Se

1: Valid
A
IM

HANDLE INTERUPT window preset


K

function
ZA

K258
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht

0: Invalid (using the Z-axis as the feed axis in the workpiece axis direction)
ig

1: Valid (discriminating the feed axis in the workpiece axis direction


yr

according to parameters K113 to K127)


op

Hobbing: Axis configuration discrimination


C

function
K259
(bit 0)

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-347
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing),


Quasi constant inclination control
K259
(bit 1)

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
K280

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

K280
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Fixed value
ig
yr
op
C


K280
(bit 2)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-348
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title MEASURE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value


K280
(bit 6)

Program type —

.
d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

K280

N
O
(bit 7)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-349
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-12 Machine parameter TABLE (L)

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

The eccentricity of the stylus of the touch sensor with respect to the center
of the spindle
Touch sensor

Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor


(X-component)

L1
+Z

.
Stylus

d
ve
+X Spindle centerline

er
Program type M

s
Conditions At power on

re
Stylus L1
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in centerline

ts
gh
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

ri
ll
.A
N
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor L2

O
(Y-component) +Y

TI
16

L2 A
R
04

+X
PO
30

MPL093
R

Note :
o.

Program type M
O
N

1. These data are automatically set when calibration measurement is


C

Conditions At power on
al

performed using the MMS unit.


K

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


ri

ZA

2. With 5-axis machines, L84 and L85 are used for these settings.
Se

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


A

The true radius value of the stylus ball of the touch sensor
IM

Touch sensor
K
ZA

Radius of stylus ball of touch sensor


(X-component)
A
M

L3
YA

+Z
Stylus ball
3
01

Program type M +X
)2

Conditions At power on
(c

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


ht

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


ig
yr
op

L4 × 2
C

Radius of stylus ball of touch sensor


(Y-component) +Y

L4
+X
L3 × 2 MPL094
Program type M
Conditions At power on Note :
These data are automatically set when calibration measurement is
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
performed using the MMS unit.
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-350
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

The distance from the spindle taper gage line to the table surface, No. 1
turning spindle chuck edge, or the reference block on the pallet existing
when the Z-axis is in the machine zero-point position

Spindle L5
Machine
zero point

Machine Spindle
zero point
L5

d .
Pallet

ve
Z-axis stroke for tip position memory Reference block

er
(TEACH function)
Table

s
MPL095

re
L5

ts
Machine

gh
zero point

ri
L5

ll
.A
N
O
Spindle Machine
Spindle

TI
edge zero point
edge
16

A L5
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

Chuck edge
30

Conditions Immediate Table


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

(Horizontal composite machine) (Vertical composite machine)


C

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

The displacement of tool length to be judged as a breakage when the tool


ZA
Se

breakage detection function is executed in laser measurement.


A

If | “registered tool length data” – “tool length that has been measured
IM

during the detecting operation” | > L6, the tool is judged to be broken.
Tool breakage judgment distance
K

(for laser measurement)


ZA

L6
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(c

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-351
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Selects the restoration operation to be executed when the tool is judged


broken upon executing the external tool breakage detection function
(M35) or tool measurement unit.
0: Continue machining
1: Single-block stop occurs
Tool-breakage restoration mode (for M35 2: Continue machining from the next process, or executing the end
external tool breakage detection or tool unit when there is only one process or when the machining for the
measurement unit) last process is being executed.
L7 3: After stopping in single block mode, continue machining from the
next process, or execute the end unit when there is only one

d .
process or when the machining for the last process is being

ve
executed.

er
Note :

s
re
Program type M
1. When “2” is set for this parameter, the operation is equivalent to that

ts
Conditions Immediate for the setting of “0” upon executing a tool measurement unit.

gh
Unit — 2. When “3” is set for this parameter, the operation is equivalent to that

ri
Setting range 0 to 3 for the setting of “1” upon executing a tool measurement unit.

ll
.A
The maximum skipping movement distance for the measurement with the
MMS unit

N
An alarm message will appear if the touch sensor has not come into

O
contact with the workpiece within this distance.

TI
Tool-breakage restoration mode (for M35
16

external tool breakage detection or tool A


R
04

measurement unit)
PO

L8
30

R
o.

O
N

Program type M, E
al

K
ri

Conditions Immediate
ZA
Se

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


A
IM

Setting range 0 to 99999999


Set to 1 when the machine of the random ATC specifications is used.
K
ZA

0: Standard machine
1: Machine of random ATC specifications
A
M

Selection of random ATC specifications


YA

L9
3
01
)2
(c

Program type M, E
ht

Conditions At power on
ig

Unit —
yr

Setting range 0, 1
op
C

2-352
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the interval between magazine pockets.

Interval between magazine pockets

L10
L10
MPL511
Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 1 mm/0.1 in

s
Setting range 0 to 999

re
Set the touch sensor's interference direction.

ts
gh
0: Non-interference (normal diameter)

ri
1: To jut out in the direction of a pocket of higher number (Positive
direction of magazine)

ll
Touch sensor’s interference direction

.A
2: To jut out in the direction of a pocket of lower number (Negative
direction of magazine)

N
L11

O
TI
16

Program type M, E
A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 2
C
al

Tolerance for Z coordinate value in circle measurement


K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K

Tolerance for manual measurement


ZA

L12
A

L12 Tolerance for measured coordinate value in face measurement


M
YA

Y
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate L12


(c

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in X


ht

Setting range 0 to ±99999999 MPL512


ig
yr

Set the allowable angle for calculation of parallelism and right angle to be
op

measured manually.
C

Allowable angle for parallelism and right


angle in manual measurement

L13

Program type M
Conditions Immediate Note :
Unit 0.0001° When error angle is smaller than the setting angle, the parallelism and
right angle are calculated.
Setting range 0 to ±900000

2-353
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Set an escape amount from a measurement point to the next point in


straightness measurement.

Escapement for straightness measurement


L14
L14
MPL513

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

ts
Set macro program number for straightness measurement.

gh
Before shipment, the macro program is numbered “9999” at the factory.

ri
ll
Macro program number for straightness

.A
measurement

N
L15

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

ZA

Parameter for system internal setting


Se

Setting prohibited
A
IM
K


ZA

L16
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Set a command unit of head indexing angle.


ig
yr
op
C

Minimum angle of head indexing command

L17

Program type M, E
Conditions Next block
Unit 0.1° (Only for INTEGREX j)
Setting range 0 to 3600

2-354
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

0: Tailstock absent.
1: Tailstock present.

Presence/absence of tailstock

L18

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set the number of electric steady rests.

gh
0: No electric steady rest

ri
1: One electric steady rest

ll
2: Two electric steady rests

.A
Number of electric steady rests

N
L19

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 2
al

K
ri

ZA

Select the output type for the angle command of the indexing unit and the
Se

end unit of the MAZATROL program.


A

0: To select servo axis (4th axis)


IM

1: To select the code (the second auxiliary function) set by K56


K

Output type of index (rotary) table


2: To select servo axis (4th/5th axis)
ZA

L21
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-355
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Use L22 and L23 to set the dimensions of the sensor for tool nose
measurement.
L24 and L25 are provided to set in machine coordinates the reference
point of the sensor (see the diagram below).
Example :
[INTE IV, INTE e-HII, lathes]
1. For No. 1 turning spindle
Machine zero point

d.
ve
er
L24

s
Sensor’s

re
reference point

ts
L25

gh
Data of the tool nose measurement sensor

ri
L22
L22 : Sensor width along the X-axis

ll
Sensor for tool nose

.A
L23 : Sensor width along the Z-axis
L24 : X-coordinate of the sensor’s measurement
L22

N
reference point L23

O
to L25 : Z-coordinate of the sensor’s Set the imaginary upper left corner of the sensor as its reference point

TI
L25 reference point for No. 2 spindle.
16

[INTE e-VII]
A
R
04

PO

2.
30

Machine zero point


o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

L25
IM

Sensor’s
reference point
K

L24
ZA
A

L23
M
YA

Sensor for tool nose


measurement
3

Program type M L22


01

Conditions Immediate Note :


)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in As shown above, the X- and Z-axes must be replaced with each other
(c

Setting range ±99999999 between INTEGREX e-HII and e-VII.


ht
ig

Setting of sensor reference point Y coordinate


yr
op

L26 Machine zero point


C

Tool nose measurement sensor reference


position, Y-axis

L26

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range ±99999999

2-356
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

During manual TOOL EYE measurement, even if the sensor turns on for a
time shorter than that which has been specified in this parameter, that will
not be regarded as sensor-on.

Timer setting for manual TOOL EYE


measurement

L27

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 7.1 ms

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
In the machine configuration that will cause the arm of the TOOL EYE to

gh
interfere with the tool when the arm is extended or retracted with the tool
present at the measuring approach point during automatic tool

ri
measurement with the TOOL EYE, set the distance through which the tool

ll
is to be returned in the Z-axis direction before extending or retracting the

.A
arm for the measurement.

N
In the MAZATROL program, before the arm is extended or retracted, the

O
tool is returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the measuring

TI
16

approach point.
A
R
In the EIA/ISO program, when G136 command execution is completed,
04

PO

the tool will be returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the
30

approach point. (In the EIA/ISO program, the tool will be retreated to a
R
o.

relay point, only in retraction mode, and the arm will be extended by
O
N

execution of M284 in the next block onward.)


C

Amount of Z-axial retreat from the approach


al

point for TOOL EYE measurement (For QTN machine specifications, parameter L28 becomes valid for the #2
K
ri

and #4 approach points in the –Z direction.)


ZA

L28
Se

X
IM
K

Z
ZA

In case of #2, #4
approaching (QTN) TOOL EYE #1, #2 APK1
A

approach point AP1


M

L78 TOOL EYE #1, #2


AP1
YA

approach point
L28 APK1
K20
3
01

K20 TOOL K20


EYE L28
)2

APK3
K20 TOOL EYE #3, #4
(c

Program type M, E
approach point
ht

Conditions Immediate AP3 APK3


ig

TOOL EYE #3, #4


Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
yr

approach point AP3


Setting range ±99999999
op
C

2-357
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Set machine efficiency. This value is used as average output calculation


data for machining navigation. If the setting is 0, machine efficiency will
become 90%.

Machine efficiency

L29

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 100

ts
Select for each machine model the appropriate case introduction

gh
messages on MACHINING NAVIGATION-PREDICTION display.

ri
Specific data is preset for each machine model. Do not disturb the

ll
presettings.
Selection of machining navigation case

.A
introduction messages

N
L30

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 999


al

K
ri

ZA

The settings of these parameters can be read using system variables.


Se

Parameter System variable


IM

L31 #3103
K

Use in machine manufacturer macro L32 #3104


L31
ZA

L33 #3105
to
A

L34 #3106
M

L34
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

For the command to rotate the index table, specify the minimum index
ig

angle for angle command by the M-code or B-code.


yr
op
C

Minimum index angle of index table

L37

Program type M
Conditions At power on Note :
This parameter is ineffective for the system with an NC rotary table.
Unit °
Setting range 0 to 180

2-358
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

For the command to rotate the index table, select the turning direction and
the M-code number to be output.
0 or 1: B-code (0: Turning in the direction of CW,
1: Turning in the direction of CW/CCW/shortcut)
M/B-code for index of index table 2 to 9999: M-code (Numeric value is the M-code number to be
output)
L38

Note :
1. This parameter is ineffective for the system with an NC rotary table.

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions At power on 2. Turning direction of the index table can be selected in the indexing
unit only when this parameter is set to 1.

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 9999

ts
Specify the execution condition of the indexing unit.

gh
Execution of the indexing unit just before starting of machining of each
tool sequence or at the end of each process:

ri
ll
0: Won’t be made when the index angle is the same as the preceding
Selection of execution/non execution of

.A
indexing unit execution.
indexing unit

N
1: Will be made unconditionally.
L39

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Select availability to specify the index table angle in the end unit.
Se

0: Enables to specify the angle.


A
IM

1: Prohibits to specify the angle.


Availability of specification of index table
K

angle in end unit


ZA

L40
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate Note : Set to 0 only for index table specification.


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

For execution of the indexing unit, specify the commanding order for
ig

movement to turning position, turning of the table and ATC.


yr

0: Movement to turning position  Table turning  ATC


op

1: Movement to turning position  Table turning and ATC


Simultaneous operation of indexing unit
C

with ATC 2: Movement to turning position, table turning and ATC


simultaneously take place.
L41

Program type M
Note :
Conditions At power on
In case of setting to 2, only the X-axis coordinates can be set at turning
Unit — position of the indexing unit.
Setting range 0 to 2

2-359
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Select setting of the initial value (modal) of the index table angle for cyclic
operation.
0: Actual table angle of the machine
1: Table angle indexed at present taken as 0°
Initial value of index table angle

L42

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select showing or not showing of the index table angle on the POSITION

gh
display.

ri
0: Not to show

ll
1: To show

.A
Indication of index table angle

N
L43

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate Note :


R
o.

Set to 1 for the machine with the index table, or set to 0 for that of the
O

Unit —
N

NC rotary table.
C

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Select whether automatic setting of the amount of tool nose position


Se

correction is to be made valid or invalid when entering the nose angle of a


A

drilling tool in the tool data or when measuring the tool.


IM

0: Automatic setting valid


Selection of automatic setting on/off for
K

When the tool nose angle is specified: The amount of correction that is
nose position correction of a drilling tool
ZA

appropriate for the specified angle is auto-set.


L44 When the tool nose angle is not specified: The amount of correction is
A

not auto-set.
M

1: Automatic setting invalid


YA

2: Automatic setting valid


Program type M, E
3

When the tool nose angle is specified: The amount of correction that is
01

Conditions Immediate appropriate for the specified angle is auto-set.


)2

Unit — When the tool nose angle is not specified: The amount of correction
that assumes a nose angle of 118° is auto-set.
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Set the minimum unit of index table angle command for the indexing units,
ig

ANGLE in the end units and B-codes in the manual program unit.
yr

0: 1°
op

1 to 8: 1/1000° (auxiliary equipment axis specifications)


C

Index table angle command

L45
Note :
Index table angle display on the POSITION display is valid only when
L43 = 1 (index table angle display on).
Program type — 0: 1° index table
Conditions — 1 to 7: Nth axis under auxiliary equipment axis specs. (N = 1 to 7)
8: Positioning table
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8

2-360
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Select change or no change of the pallet and specify the maximum


number of pallets.
0 or 1: Not to change pallet
2 to 255: To change pallet (Numeric value indicates the maximum
Maximum number of pallets in pallet
number of pallets.)
changing unit

L46

.
Program type M

d
Note :

ve
Conditions At power on
When this parameter is set to 0 or 1, use of the pallet changing unit is

er
Unit — prohibited.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
Select preparation of next pallet or not to do so according to the pallet

gh
change mechanism.

ri
0: Not to prepare next pallet

ll
1: To prepare next pallet
To prepare or not to prepare next pallet

.A
change

N
L47

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M Note :


PO
30

Conditions At power on When this parameter is set to 1, it is possible to set the number of the
R
o.

next pallet in the pallet changing unit.


O

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Specify the number of long boring bars mounted.


Se

A
IM
K

Number of long boring bars


ZA

L48
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 9
ht

This parameter is used to select simultaneous operation of pallet change


ig

with the next ATC operation in execution of the pallet changing unit and
yr

the face definition unit, or not.


op

0: To operate ATC after pallet change


Simultaneous operation of pallet change
C

1: To operate pallet change and ATC simultaneously


with ATC

L49

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-361
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Rewriting of head number in MDI mode:


0: Impossible
1: Possible

Rewriting of head number

L50

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
(For five surface machining)
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Tool command system in MDI operation (Tool on the spindle and next

gh
time tool)

ri
0: Command of pocket number

ll
1: Command of group number

.A
Tool command system in MDI operation

N
L51

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Rewriting of machining management data with macro variable (system


Se

variable)
A

0: Impossible
IM

1: Possible
Writing of machining management data with
K

macro variable
ZA

L52
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select showing or not showing of the work number in the PALLET


ig

MANAGEMENT display.
yr

0: Not to show WNo.


op

1: To show WNo.
Showing of program number in PALLET
C

MANAGEMENT display

L53

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-362
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: FMS pallet ID operation mode
2: Pallet management operation mode

Selection of automatic operation mode

L54

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 2

ts
0: FR-SF

gh
1: FR-SE

ri
ll
.A
Spindle load meter display type

N
L55

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Method by M2 tool edge memorizing function


Se

1: Method by M32 tool edge memorizing function (for Z-axis only)


A

2: Method by M32 tool edge memorizing function (for X-, Y-, Z-axes)
IM

Method of measurement of coordinates by Example :


K

tool edge memorizing function (TEACH) +Z


ZA

L56
A

 Mothod by M2
M

(distance from the tool tip


YA

50 to the zero point with a sign) .... –50


Program type M  Method by M32
3
01

Conditions Immediate +Y (distance from the zero point


)2

Unit — to the tool tip with a sign) ........... 50


MPL514
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Make it possible/impossible to rewrite tool data except on tools on the


ig

spindle in automatic operation on a program.


yr

0: Impossible
op

1: Possible
Rewriting of tool data during automatic
C

operation

L57

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-363
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Select a head angle indication system for the five surface machining
system.
0: Indication corresponding to 90° index (0°, 90°, 180°, 270°)
1: Indication corresponding to 1° (5°) index
Head index angle indication system

L58

.
Program type E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit — (For five surface machining)

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
This parameter limits input items on the HEAD OFFSET display.

gh
0: Data just on item SPDL. CMD can be input.

ri
1: All data can be input.

ll
.A
Input selection for HEAD OFFSET display

N
L59

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit — (For five surface machining)


N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

The total number of heads to be mounted in the spindle


Se

A
IM
K

Head quantity
ZA

L60
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit — (For five surface machining)


(c

Setting range 0 to 10
ht

Operation timing of automatic head change (AHC) and automatic pallet


ig

change (APC)
yr

0: AHC first and then APC


op

1: APC first and then AHC


C

Output timing of AHC and APC


2: Simultaneous

L61

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
(For five surface machining)
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 2

2-364
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

When FIXED is selected at the item RELAY in the 5-face machining unit
or face definition unit, the head arrives at the face for next machining via
the point(s) specified by the parameters.
(To be set in the machine coordinate system)
Head relay point X1 For AGX or machining models that use 5-face machining units, the relay
points (X1, Y1) and (X2, Y2) can be specified in the program (in the 5-face
L62 machining unit or face definition sequence).
For the five surface machining, the head goes through the four corners of
a face where the two specified points are positioned in its diagonal line.

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate Z

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
(X1, Y1)

re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 Y
X

ts
gh
ri
ll
(X2, Y2)

.A
Head relay point Y1
MPL515

N
L63

O
(For five-surface machining)

TI
(For AGX series)
16

Note :
A
R
04

Program type M
PO

Set the relay points so that parameter settings become L62 < L64 and
30

Conditions Immediate L63 < L65.


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Head relay point X2


K
ZA

L64
A
M
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(c

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

Head relay point Y2

L65

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-365
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

After EIA/ISO subprogram execution;


0: Return to head indexing point Z (Even if the T-code command is for
the same tool.)
1: No return to head indexing point Z
Return/No return to head indexing point Z

L66

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate (For five-surface machining)

er
Unit — (For AGX series)

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set the length from the end surface of the spindle to the center of head

gh
rotation for respective machines. (100 mm in usual)

ri
Y

ll
 = 180°
Length between the end surface of the

.A
spindle and the center of head rotation

N
L67  = 0°

O
TI
16

A L67
Z
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

MPL516
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA

Set for respective machines.


Se

 = 180°
IM

Y
 = 0°
K

Head correction value X


ZA

L68
A
M

L68
YA

X
Program type M, E
3

MPL517
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For AGX series)


(c

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


ht

Set for respective machines.


ig
yr
op
C

Head correction value Y

L69

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For AGX series)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-366
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the axes that simultaneously move from a machining face to the
next machining face or in case of tool replacement.
0: Two (three) axes simultaneously move to the safety position.
1: Y-axis (or X- and Y-axes) moves to the safety position after Z-axis
Axis movement from machining face on
moved.
escapement
The X-axis moves when a relay point (RELAY) or a fixed point (FIXED) is
L70 selected for the item RELAY in the face definition unit.

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit — (For AGX series)

s
re
Setting range 1, 0

ts
For execution of the program for oblique face machining, specify to

gh
execute or not machining on the coordinate that is turned from the basic
coordinate (set in WPC unit or in OFFSET unit) at an angle of the

ri
correction value for the B-axis.

ll
Shift of basic coordinate for oblique face

.A
0: Machining on the coordinate that is turned from the basic
machining coordinate at an angle of the correction value for the B-axis

N
L71

O
1: Machining on the basic coordinate specified in the program

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

(For AGX series)


C

Setting range 1, 0
al

K
ri

ZA

Set the time constant to be used in the 5-axis spline interpolation mode.
Se

A setting value of 0 is invalid.


A
IM

5-axis spline interpolation geometry


K

compensation software acceleration/


ZA

deceleration filter 2 time constant


L72
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions After stop of axis movement


)2

Unit ms
(c

Setting range 0 to 57
ht

Set the time constant to be used when shape correction is on.


ig

A setting of 0 is invalid.
yr
op

Time constant for shape correction


C

acceleration/deceleration filter 2

L73

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 56

2-367
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational acceleration/deceleration


control.

Cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational


acceleration/deceleration control

L74

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement

er
Unit mm/min

s
re
Setting range 1 to 999999

ts
Set the time constant to obtain acceleration/deceleration of the cutting

gh
feed rate for pre-interpolational linear control.

ri
ll
Time constant for pre-interpolational linear

.A
control during cutting feed rate
acceleration/deceleration

N
L75

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of axis movement


R
o.

Unit ms
N

Setting range 1 to 5000


al

K
ri

ZA

Set the maximum cutting speed in the G61.1 mode at percentage to the
Se

maximum cutting speed in the G64 mode.


A

Input of 0 is regarded as 100%.


IM

1000 or higher percent is disposed as 1000%.


K

Acceleration rate for high-speed cutting


ZA

L76
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of axis movement


)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 5000


ht

Set an angle for decelerating cutting feed rate at a corner.


ig

Input of 0 is regarded as 5°.


yr

Setting at an angle higher than 30° is disposed as 30°.


op

Angle for deceleration at corner before


C

interpolation 
L77
MPL518

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit °
Setting range 0 to 30

2-368
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

In the machine configuration that will cause the arm of the TOOL EYE to
interfere with the tool when the arm is extended or retracted with the tool
present at the measuring approach point during automatic tool
measurement with the TOOL EYE, set the distance through which the tool
is to be returned in the X-axis direction before extending or retracting the
arm for the measurement.
In the MAZATROL program, before the arm is extended or retracted, the
tool is returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the measuring
approach point.
In the EIA/ISO program, when G136 command execution is completed,

.
the tool will be returned through the L28/L78-set distance from the

d
ve
approach point. (In the EIA/ISO program, the tool will be retreated to a
Amount of X-axial retreat from the approach

er
relay point, only in retraction mode, and the arm will be extended by
point for TOOL EYE measurement execution of M284 in the next block onward.)

s
re
X
L78

ts
gh
Z

ri
In case of #2, #4

ll
approaching (QTN) TOOL EYE #1, #2 APK1

.A
approach point AP1
TOOL EYE #1, #2

N
AP1 L78
approach point

O
L28 APK1

TI
K20
16

A K20 TOOL K20


R
04

EYE L28 APK3


PO
30

Program type M, E K20 TOOL EYE #3, #4


R

approach point
o.

Conditions Immediate
O

AP3 APK3
N

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in TOOL EYE #3, #4


al

approach point AP3


K

Setting range ±99999999


ri

ZA
Se

Set the In-position width for changeover of the synchronized-tapping gain.


A

If 0 is set, 10 microns will be regarded as having been set.


IM
K

In-position width for changeover of the


ZA

synchronized-tapping gain
A

L79
M
YA
3

Program type M, E
01
)2

Conditions At power on
(c

Unit 0.001 mm
ht

Setting range 0 to 255


ig

Set the deceleration rate at the linear to arc or arc to linear blocks of
yr

shape correction.
op
C

Linear to arc deceleration rate

L80

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min / in/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-369
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Parameter for system internal setting


Setting prohibited

L81

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Set the thickness of the tilting table.

gh
This parameter is used for the software travel limit function provided to

ri
avoid collision between the spindle head and the tilting table (in its angular

ll
position from –90° to –120°).

.A
Table thickness

N
L82

O
TI
16

A Tilting table L82


R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm
N

(For machines equipped with a tilting table)


C

Setting range ±99999999


al

K
ri

Set the radius of the spindle head.


ZA
Se

This parameter is used for the software travel limit function provided to
A

avoid collision between the spindle head and the tilting table.
IM
K

Spindle head radius


ZA

L83
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm
L83 (For machines equipped with a tilting table)
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-370
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

2Mx

Correction value of alignment deviation X


(Upper face)
2My
L84 ey

ex

.
Program type M Stylus

d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
MPL519

s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis

ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis

gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)

ri
ll
Correction value of alignment deviation Y

.A
Note :
(Upper face)

N
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L85

O
(on the upper face) with the MMS unit.

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)


N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA

2Mx
Se

A
IM

Correction value of alignment deviation X


K

(0-degree face)
ZA

2My
L86 ey
A
M
YA

ex
Program type M Stylus
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center


)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


MPL519
(c

Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis


ht

ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis


ig

Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)


yr

My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)


op

Correction value of alignment deviation Y


C

Note :
(0-degree face)
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L87 (0-degree face) with the MMS unit.

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-371
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

2Mx

Correction value of alignment deviation X


(90-degree face)
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor
(X-component for B-axis at 90-degree
2My
L88 position) ey

ex

.
Program type M Stylus

d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
MPL519

s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis

ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis

gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)

ri
Correction value of alignment deviation Y
(90-degree face)

ll
.A
Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor Note :

N
(Y-component for B-axis at 90-degree The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L89

O
position) (90-degree face) with the MMS unit.

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement (For INTEGREX series)


R
o.

(For five-surface machining)


O

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA

2Mx
Se

Correction value of alignment deviation X


IM

(180-degree face)
K

Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor


ZA

(X-component for B-axis at 180-degree


2My
L90 position) ey
A
M
YA

ex
Program type M Stylus
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center


)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


MPL519
(c

Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis


ht

ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis


ig

Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)


yr

My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)


Correction value of alignment deviation Y
op

(180-degree face)
C

Stylus eccentricity of touch sensor Note :


(Y-component for B-axis at 180-degree The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L91 position) (180-degree face) with the MMS unit.

Program type M
Conditions After stop of movement (For INTEGREX series)
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)

Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-372
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

2Mx

Correction value of alignment deviation X


(270-degree face)
2My
L92 ey

ex

.
Program type M Stylus

d
ve
Conditions After stop of movement Spindle center

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
MPL519

s
re
Setting range 0 to ±99999999 ex: Alignment deviation correction value on X-axis

ts
ey: Alignment deviation correction value on Y-axis

gh
Mx: Stylus radius in the X-axis direction (The setting of L3)
My: Stylus radius in the Y-axis direction (The setting of L4)

ri
ll
Correction value of alignment deviation Y

.A
Note :
(270-degree face)

N
The data is set automatically by execution of calibration measurement
L93

O
(270-degree face) with the MMS unit.

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in (For five-surface machining)


N

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


al

K
ri

The X/Y travel distance can be set during the selection of


ZA
Se

EIA-programmed fully automatic tool length measurement with the


A

measuring table.
IM

0: Invalid
X/Y travel distance during EIA-programmed
K

1: Valid
tool measurement
ZA

L94
A

Note :
M

It is invalid to set this parameter under laser tool measuring equipment


YA

specifications.
Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

The offset number is auto-set during EIA-programmed tool measurement


ig

data setting.
yr

0: Invalid
op

Offset number auto-setting for 1: Valid


C

EIA-programmed tool measurement


Note :
L95
When making the auto-setting function valid, see the description of L96.

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-373
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

The amount of shifting for TNo. during offset number auto-setting for
EIA-programmed tool measurement data setting.
[Offset No.] = [TNo. setting] + [L96 setting]
Amount of shifting during offset number
auto-setting for EIA-programmed tool
Note : Valid only when L95 = 1.
measurement
L96

.
Program type E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 4000

ts
1 - 999: M-code of the specified number

gh
1000: None

ri
Other than above: M149

ll
M-code to be output when selecting menu

.A
function for the MDI tool designation

N
L97

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

Specify the muximum tool length for the MDI laser tool length
ZA
Se

measurement.
A
IM

Max. tool length for laser tool length


K

measurement
ZA

L98
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(c

Setting range 99999999


ht

Specify the cycle time at which the operational status management data
ig

for the day is to be saved as a file on the hard disk.


yr

Note :
op

Cycle time for saving the operational status 1. If the setting is 0, the data will be saved each minute.
C

management data 2. If the setting is –1, the data will be saved only when the date
changes or when NC power is turned off.
L99

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit min
Setting range –1 to 1439

2-374
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

[INTE e-HII]
Approach point for tool
diameter measurement

L103: X
L100: X

Machine

d .
zero point

ve
L102: Z

s er
re
L100 Laser sensor position X

ts
gh
L101 Laser sensor position Y L101: Y
L102 Laser sensor position Z

ri
ll
L103 Approach point X for laser tool

.A
diameter measurement
L100

N
L104 Approach point Y for laser tool
to

O
diameter measurement L98
L105: Z

TI
L105 L105 Approach point Z for laser tool length
16

measurement A
Approach point for tool
R
04

length measurement
PO
30

[INTE e-VII]
R
o.

Machine
N

zero point Machine


al

L100: X zero point


K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K

L104: Y
L105: Z L102: Z
ZA

L98
A
M

L101: Y
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on Approach point for tool


Approach point for tool
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in diameter measurement length measurement


)2

Setting range ±99999999


(c

Select the measuring equipment to be used to perform MDI tool


ht

measurements and EIA tool measurements.


ig
yr

0: Measuring table
1: Laser tool measuring equipment
op

Measuring equipment selection


C

L106
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-375
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Select a rotational reference coordinate system for WPC-th.


0: Workpiece coordinates (Index angle B)
1: Machine coordinates
Selection of a rotational reference
coordinate system for WPC-th
L106
(bit 1)

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Measuring table (see L22 to L26)

gh
1: TOOL EYE (see BA95 to BA102)

ri
ll
.A
Selection of measuring equipment

N
L106

O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Select whether workpiece measurement results and tool measurement


ZA
Se

results are to be stored into tool data of the lower turret.


A

0: Measurement results are stored into lower-turret tool data


IM

1: Measurement results are not stored into lower-turret tool data



K
ZA

L106
A

(bit 3)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Specify whether to enable or disable the fixed amount compensation


ig

function.
yr

0: Disabled
op

1: Enabled
C


L106
(bit 4)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-376
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Select whether the user-defined angle setting for the B-axis in the
coordinate measurement unit and workpiece measurement unit is to be
made valid or invalid.
B-axis user-defined angle setting in the 0: Invalid
coordinate measurement unit and 1: Valid
workpiece measurement unit
L106
(bit 5)

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set the non-compensation area for the tool measurement and execution

gh
timing of tool and workpiece measurement operation.

ri
0: MT Pro scheme

ll
Non-compensation area setting

.A
Non-compensation area for the tool measurement based on the

N
measuring tolerance (K17 and K18) invalid (handled as if K17 = 0

O
and K18 = 100)

TI
Execution timing of tool and workpiece measurement operation
16

A
The measurement unit is executed whenever the parts count
R
04

reaches same or a multiple of the specified measurement interval in


PO

addition to the first time.


30

Non-compensation area for the tool


R

measurement and execution timing of tool 1: M Pro scheme


o.

and workpiece measurement operation Non-compensation area setting


N

L106
C

Non-compensation area for the tool measurement based on the


al

(bit 6) measuring tolerance (K17 and K18) valid


ri

ZA
Se

Execution timing of tool and workpiece measurement operation


A

The measurement unit is executed whenever the program


IM

execution count reaches same or a multiple of the specified


measurement interval, omitting the first time.
K
ZA
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether the laser measuring menu is to be displayed when laser


ig

tool measuring equipment is selected (L106 bit 0 = 1) as tool measuring


yr

equipment.
op

0: Display of the laser measuring menu


C

Selection of laser measuring menu display 1: No display of the laser measuring menu

L106
(bit 7)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-377
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

In AGX machines, the tool locus (on the TRACE or TOOL PATH CHECK
display) on the following coordinate is drawn by the EIA/ISO program.
0: Loft on the standard coordinates system
1: Loft on the machine coordinates system
Tool path drawing
L107 Note :
(bit 0) When 1 (drawing on the machine coordinate) is selected, the loft does
not correspond to the form made on the MAZATROL coordinates
system. However, 1 makes a loft corresponding to the tool movement of
the machine.

.
Program type E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate (For AGX series)

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set whether the tailstock function is to be made valid or invalid.

gh
0: Tailstock function invalid

ri
1: Tailstock function valid

ll
.A
Tailstock function valid/invalid

N
L107

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Select whether the tailstock included in the tailstock-equipped machine


ZA
Se

specifications is of the conventional type or the motor-driven type.


A

0: Conventional type
IM

1: Motor-driven type
Tailstock type
K
ZA

L107
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether the tail thrust is also to be displayed in pounds (lbs).


ig

0: Display off
yr

1: Display on
op

Whether tail thrust is also to be displayed in


C

pounds (lbs)
L107
(bit 3)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-378
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

LBB No. setting for the grooving I.D. tool, threading I.D. tool, or touch
sensor
0: Invalid
1: Valid

L107
(bit 4)

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Moves the X-axis to the third zero point and the Y/Z-axes to the

gh
respective zero points.

ri
1: Moves the X-axis to the third zero point and the Y/Z-axes to the
respective second zero points.

ll
XYZ-axis operation for the first T-command

.A
after cycle start

N
L107

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit — (For AGX series)


N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: Does not operate the A-axis.


ZA
Se

1: Returns the A-axis to its zero point.


A
IM

A-axis operation for the first T-command


K

after cycle start


ZA

L107
A

(bit 6)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
(For AGX series)
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Heavy tool designation valid


ig

1: Heavy tool designation invalid


yr
op
C

Heavy tool designation valid/invalid


L107
(bit 7)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-379
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (0)


L108
(bit 0)
to
(bit 4)

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Set whether the C-axis coordinate obtained by C-axis coordinate rotation

gh
in the indexing unit is to be incorporated into the path and shape drawings
on the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and SHAPE CHECK displays of

ri
Incorporating the C-axis coordinate into the VRX machine.

ll
the TOOL PATH CHECK, TRACE, and

.A
0: Incorporation valid.
SHAPE CHECK displays of the VRX 1: Incorporation invalid (M640M-5X compatible).

N
L108 machine

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Fixed value (0)


ZA
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

L108
A

(bit 6)
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Set whether, during tool path check of the MAZATROL program on the
ig

TOOL PATH CHECK display of a machine having a turning function, the


yr

tool nose of the milling tool is to be displayed with the tool diameter
similarly to the M640M Pro or with a tool nose mark similarly to the
op

Displaying the milling tool nose in the M640MT Pro.


C

MAZATROL program of the TOOL PATH


0: Display with tool diameter (M640M Pro compatible)
CHECK display
L108 1: Display with tool nose mark (M640MT Pro compatible)
(bit 7) Note :
1. A tool nose mark is always displayed when the tool path of the
EIA/ISO program is checked.
Program type M 2. For a machine without a turning function, this parameter is invalid
Conditions Immediate and the display is always made with the tool diameter.

Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-380
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the relationship between axial directions of the two axes, on the
machine coordinate system, for which software limit relative position is
checked.
0: Same direction
1: Reverse directions
Example :
When checking the software limit relative position between the Z2- and
W-axis, the positive (+) direction of the W-axis on the machine
coordinate system may be the same or reverse direction of the positive
(+) direction of the Z2-axis depending on the machine model.

.d
Axial direction for checking the software

ve
limit relative position Set “0” if the positive (+) direction of the Z2- and W-axis is the same on

er
the machine coordinate system as shown in Fig. 1. Conversely, if the
Bit 0: Axial direction (1st set of axes)
direction is reverse as shown in Fig. 2, then set “1”.

s
L109 Bit 1: Axial direction (2nd set of axes)

re
(bit 0) Bit 2: Axial direction (3rd set of axes) Fig. 1

ts
to Bit 3: Axial direction (4th set of axes)

gh
W-axis
(bit 3)

ri
+

ll
.A
Z2-axis +

N
O
TI
Fig. 2
16

A
R
04

W-axis
PO
30

+
R

Program type M, E
o.

O
N

Conditions After stop of movement


+
C

Z2-axis
al

Unit —
K
ri

ZA

Setting range 0, 1
Se

Selection of formula to be used for calculating the horsepower and thrust


IM

on the TOOL DATA display with [AUTO SET]


0: M640M compatible scheme
K
ZA

Formula selection for calculating 1: New scheme


horsepower and thrust on the TOOL DATA
A

display with [AUTO SET]


L109
M
YA

(bit 4)
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate
(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range 0, 1
ig
yr

Fixed value
op
C


L109
(bit 6)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-381
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value

Fixed value
L109
(bit 7)

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
76543210

gh
ri
Opposed-spindle lathe specifications

ll
Vertically inverted spindle specifications

.A
Axis name of the secondary spindle

N
0: Z/C-axis

O
TI
1: W/U-axis
16

A Display of “section to be machined” in the milling


R
04

tool sequence
PO


30

0: Disabled
R

1: Enabled
L110
o.

O
N

RAM spindle specification (e-V RAM)


C
al

Correction axis for LENGTH B


ri

ZA

0: X-axis
Se

1: Y-axis (VARIAXIS Turning Specifications)


A
IM

Lower turret specification


0: Horizontal
K

1: Vertical
ZA

Program type M, E Z-axis direction


A
M

Conditions At power on 0: Horizontal


1: Vertical
YA

Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits
3
01

0: Output
)2

1: Do not output
(c
ht

T-code in the index unit to be executed


ig

before the pallet change unit


yr

L111
op

(bit 5)
C

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-382
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value (1)


L111
(bit 6)

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
76543210

gh
ri
Whether traction tailstock is present or absent

ll
0: Without traction tailstock

.A
1: With traction tailstock

N
Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 1 is

O
TI
present or absent
16

A 0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 1


— 1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 1
R
04

PO
30

Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 2 is


L112
present or absent
R
o.

0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 2


N

1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 2


al

Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 3 is


ri

ZA
Se

present or absent
A

0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 3


IM

1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 3


Program type M, E Whether carriage-connection steadyrest 4 is
K
ZA

Conditions At power on present or absent


0 : Without carriage-connection steadyrest 4
A

Unit —
1 : With carriage-connection steadyrest 4
M

Setting range Binary, eight digits


YA

Set the axis to be taken as the check reference in software limit check in
3

the approaching or separating direction. Specify the axis number by that


01

Software limit relative position check – of NC.


Check reference axis
)2

The checking function will be invalid if the number is missing or if an


L113 1st set of axes invalid number is set.
(c

L113 L114 2nd set of axes


ht

L115 3rd set of axes


to
ig

L116 4th set of axes


yr

L116
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16

2-383
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the check target axis corresponding to the axis set as the check
reference (parameter L113 to L116) for checking the software limit
Software limit relative position check – relative position. Specify the axis number by that of NC.
Check target axis
The checking function will be invalid if the number is missing or if an
L117 1st set of axes invalid number is set.
L117 L118 2nd set of axes
L119 3rd set of axes
to
L120 4th set of axes
L120

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 16

ts
For arbitrary two axes that move on the same slideway, the limit of

gh
distance those axes can approach with each other is set to prevent
interference. If they are going to move closer beyond the distance set at

ri
this parameter, software limit alarm is output and they stop moving. Using

ll
parameters L121 to L124, the limit distance in the approaching direction

.A
can be set for up to four axes.

N
O
Set the machine coordinate of the check target axis, set at parameters

TI
L117 to L120, existing at the permissible closest position from the check
16

A
reference axis, set at parameters L113 to L116, which is located at the
R
04

home position.
PO
30

Example:
R

In the example shown below, if the W-axis and the Z2-axis are defined
o.

as the check reference axis and the check target axis, respectively,
N

move the Z2-axis close to the W-axis, which is located at the home
al

position, up to the position just before they interfere with each other, and
ri

ZA

set the machine coordinate of the Z2-axis located at that position. If zero
Se

Software limit relative position check –


is entered, the checking function in the approaching direction will be
A

Limit distance in the approaching direction


IM

invalid. Note that the check is possible only for the combination of NC
L121 1st set of axes axes.
L121 L122 2nd set of axes
K

L123 3rd set of axes


ZA

to Machine coordinate W = –100.


L124 4th set of axes
L124
A
M

W
YA

Z2
3
01

X2
)2
(c

Lower turret Machine coordinate Z2 = 496. W-axis machine


ht

machine zero point zero point


ig
yr

Machine coordinate W = 0
op
C

Z2-axis

Program type M, E
L121 W-axis machine
Conditions Immediate zero point
Lower turret
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in machine zero point
Setting range ±99999999

2-384
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the time constant for smoothing the tool attitude during tool tip
point control.
This time constant is valid only when all the following conditions are
satisfied:
Rotational axis prefiltering time constant  High-speed smooth interpolation is valid (G05P02, G61.1, F3 bit 0 =
1)
L125  Rotational axis prefiltering is valid (F36 bit 7 = 1)
 Tool tip point control (G43.4, G43.5) is on
 Cutting feed is on
Program type E

.
Even when the above conditions are met, if the setting of L125 is 0,

d
ve
Conditions Immediate rotational axis prefiltering will be invalid.

er
Unit ms

s
re
Setting range 0 to 200
Positioning direction of the -axis for oblique plane indexing specified in

ts
gh
ANGLE (plane angle) of the surface definition sequence.
0: Makes the sign of the plane angle value invalid and positions the

ri
-axis in its minus direction.

ll
.A
1: Makes the sign of the plane angle value valid and if the plane angle
is plus, positions the -axis in its plus direction or if the plane angle

N
is minus, positions the -axis in its minus direction.

O
TI
2: Makes the sign of the plane angle value invalid and positions the
16

-axis in its plus direction.


A
R
04

If the setting of this parameter is other than the above, the value of L126
PO

Positioning direction of the head rotation will be handled as 1.


30

-axis for oblique plane indexing


R
o.

<Example of operation with 0 assigned to L126 and 45° as a plane angle>


O

L126
N

Head rotation -axis = –114.4698°


C
al

Table rotation B-axis = 65.5302°


K
ri

ZA
Se

– –
A
IM
K
ZA

+B
+B
A
M

Program type M, E
YA

Conditions Immediate +B –
3

Unit —
01

(For AGX series)


Setting range 0 to 2
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-385
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

This parameter functions as a filter to smoothen the waveform command


specified for pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration.
<Type of feed and acceleration/deceleration>
Acceleration/deceleration filter (1st stage) L = Post-interpolation Linear acceleration/deceleration
L129 G1 time constant S = Pre-interpolation S-shaped acceleration/deceleration
L129 L130 G0 time constant
G64 mode G61.1 mode
L130 G0 L S
Auto- G1 L S
matic Positioning to fixed points
L L

.
Program type M, E

d
(for ATC, APC, etc.)

ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement Manual Axis feed L

er
Unit ms
Linear acc. & dec. S-shaped acc. & dec.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 200
Speed Speed

ts
gh
Time Time

ri
Acceleration/deceleration filter (2nd stage)

ll
.A
L131 G1 time constant
L131 L132 G0 time constant

N
O
L132

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of axis movement


R
o.

Unit ms
O
N

Setting range 0 to 200


al

<For tool tilt type (Example: VERSATECH)>


ri

ZA
Se

Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
A

the tool side) in the direction of the horizontal axis to the rotational center
IM

<For tool tilt type> of the tool control rotary axis (at the root side).
Tool control rotary axis offset Setting range: –30000 to 30000
K

First rotary axis horizontal offset


ZA

Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
<For table tilt type (B-axis tilting table setting the upper (lower) limit.
A

specifications)>
M

L133 B-axis rotation center displacement (X-axis <For table tilt type (B-axis tilting table specifications) (Example:
YA

direction) VARIAXIS)>
Sets the displacement of the actual center of B-axis rotation from the
3

reference position in the X-axis direction. Specify a minus value when


01

the actual center of B-axis rotation is located at the plus side in the X-axis
)2

direction with respect to the reference position.


Program type — Setting range: –10000 to 10000
(c

Conditions After stop of axis movement


ht

Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
setting the upper (lower) limit.
ig

Unit 0.0001 mm
yr

Setting range See explanation to the right.


op
C

2-386
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

<For tool tilt type (Example: VERSATECH)>


Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the
<For tool tilt type> root side) in the vertical axis direction.
Tool control rotary axis offset
Setting range: –30000 to 30000
First rotary axis vertical offset
Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
<For table tilt type (A-axis tilting table
setting the upper (lower) limit.
specifications)>
L134 A-axis rotation center displacement (Y-axis <For table tilt type (A-axis tilting table specifications) (Example:
direction) VARIAXIS)>

.
Sets the displacement of the actual center of A-axis rotation from the

d
ve
reference position in the Y-axis direction. Specify a minus value when
the actual center of A-axis rotation is located at the plus side in the Y-axis

er
Program type — direction with respect to the reference position.

s
re
Conditions After stop of axis movement Setting range: –10000 to 10000

ts
Unit 0.0001 mm Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as

gh
setting the upper (lower) limit.
Setting range See explanation to the right.

ri
<For tool tilt type (Example: VERSATECH)>

ll
.A
Set the distance from the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at
the tool side) to the rotational center of the tool control rotary axis (at the

N
<For tool tilt type> root side) in the height axis direction.

O
TI
Tool control rotary axis offset Setting range: –30000 to 30000
16

First rotary axis height offset A


Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
R
04

<For table tilt type> setting the upper (lower) limit.


PO

(A-(B-)axis rotation center displacement


30

L135 <For table tilt type (Example: VARIAXIS)>


(Z-axis direction))
R
o.

Sets the displacement of the actual center of A-(B-)axis rotation from the
O
N

reference position in the Z-axis direction. Specify a minus value when


C

the actual center of A-(B-)axis rotation is located at the plus side in the
al

Z-axis direction with respect to the reference position.


ri

ZA

Program type E
Se

Setting range: –10000 to 10000


A

Conditions Immediate
Setting a value exceeding the upper (lower) limit has the same effect as
IM

Unit — setting the upper (lower) limit.


K

Setting range 0 to 31
ZA

<For tool tilt type only (Example : VERSATECH)>


Set the distance along the horizontal axis from the spindle edge to the
A
M

rotational center of the tool-side rotational axis (tool side).


YA

<For tool tilt type>


Tool rotational axis offset
3

horizontal axis offset amount for the 2nd


01

rotational axis
L136
)2
(c
ht
ig

Program type —
yr

Conditions After stop of axis movement


op

Unit 0.0001 mm
C

Setting range –30000 to 30000

2-387
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

<For tool tilt type only (Example : VERSATECH)>


Set the distance along the vertical axis from the spindle edge to the
rotational center of the tool-side rotational axis (tool side).
<For tool tilt type>
Tool rotational axis offset
vertical axis offset amount for the 2nd
rotational axis
L137

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement

er
Unit 0.0001 mm

s
re
Setting range –30000 to 30000

ts
<For tool tilt type only (Example : VERSATECH)>

gh
Set the distance along the height axis from the spindle edge to the
rotational center of the tool-side rotational axis (tool side).

ri
<For tool tilt type>

ll
Tool rotational axis offset

.A
height axis offset amount for the 2nd

N
rotational axis
L138

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions After stop of axis movement


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm
N

Setting range –30000 to 30000


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Minimum tool diameter of the measurable


chamfering tool
K

(For fully automatic tool measurement with


ZA

measuring table)
L139
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.1 mm/0.01 in


)2

Setting range 0 to 999


(c
ht

0: 50 ms
ig

1: 50 ms
yr

2: 100 ms
op

Waiting time for the completion signal of 3: 150 ms


C

M35 (tool breakage detection) from PLC 


L140 

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 50 ms
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-388
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Software limit relative position check (for


auxiliary equipment axis) – Task delay
period
L141

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement

er
Unit 0.1 ms

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational acceleration/deceleration

gh
control when the Smooth corner control function is valid.

ri
Smooth corner control function:

ll
.A
Cutting feed rate for pre-interpolational
acceleration/deceleration control

N
L145

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R

[Related parameters]
o.

Unit mm/min
O

L74
N

Setting range 1 to 999999


al

Set the time constant for pre-interpolational linear control during cutting
ri

ZA

feed rate acceleration/deceleration when the Smooth corner control


Se

function is valid.
A

Smooth corner control function:


IM

Time constant for pre-interpolational linear


control during cutting feed rate
K
ZA

acceleration/deceleration
L146
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit ms [Related parameters]


)2

1 to 5000 L75
Setting range
(c

Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (1st stage) used


ht

when the Smooth corner control function is valid.


ig
yr

Smooth corner control function:


op

Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1


C

time constant (1st stage)


L147

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms [Related parameters]
L129
Setting range 1 to 200

2-389
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1 time constant (2nd stage)


used when the Smooth corner control function is valid.

Smooth corner control function:


Software acceleration/deceleration filter G1
time constant (2nd stage)
L148

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit ms [Related parameters]
L130

s
re
Setting range 1 to 200

ts
Sets the thickness of the small-diameter table.

gh
The thickness of the small-diameter table is taken into consideration in the
software limit check with respect to the spindle when the tilt table is

ri
indexed in the range from 90 to 180.

ll
.A
N
When 0 is set, the small-diameter table is not taken into consideration.

O
Small-diameter table thickness

TI
16

L151 A
R
04

PO
30

L151
L82
R
o.

O
N

Program type M, E
al

K
ri

ZA

Conditions Immediate [Related parameters]


Se

Unit 0.0001 mm L82


A
IM

Setting range 0 to 99999999 (Function dedicated to machines equipped with the tilt table)

0: No retry operation
K
ZA

1 to 100: Work number search is performed up to the specified number


of retries.
A
M

Number of retries in machining If the work number search does not succeed within the specified number
YA

management work number search of retries, 444 is output to register R2087.


When a value other than those given above is specified, 0 is assumed.
L152
3
01
)2
(c

Program type M, E
ht

Conditions After resetting


ig

Unit Times
yr

Setting range ±99999999


op
C

2-390
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TABLE

Address Meaning Description

Display of the [PALLET No.SET] menu item


0: Displayed
1: Not displayed
Selection of [PALLET No.SET] menu item
display Note :
L171
This parameter is valid when L46 > 1.
(bit 1)

M, E

.
Program type

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set the clamp value for the acceleration in orbit machining.

gh
When either L270 or L271 is a negative value or 0: L74 and L75 are used.

ri
Other: L270 and L271 are used.

ll
Feedrate for clamping the acceleration in

.A
orbit machining

N
L270

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit mm/min
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Time constant for clamping the acceleration


K

in orbit machining
ZA

L271
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit ms
)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-391
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-13 Machine parameter FEED VEL. (M)

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

The feed rate for moving each axis under the G00 command during
automatic operation
The feed rate for moving each axis in either the manual rapid feed mode
or the zero-point return mode
Rapid feed rate

M1

d .
ve
er
Program type M, E
Note :

s
Conditions After stop of movement

re
Initial zero-point return is performed at the feed rate set in parameter
Unit mm/min (°/min)

ts
M2.

gh
Setting range 0 to 600000

ri
The feed rate for moving each axis during initial zero-point return

ll
(reference-point return) at power on

.A
Feed rate

N
O
Feed rate for initial zero-point return

TI
M2
16

A
M2
R
04

PO

N8
30

R
o.

Program type M, E
O
N

Watchdog
C

Conditions After stop of movement


Zero point
al

Unit mm/min (°/min) (reference point)


ri

ZA

MPL520
Se

Setting range 0 to 600000


A

The limit of cutting feed rate during automatic operation


IM

Even if a feed rate higher than this parameter setting is specified, the
K

latter governs.
ZA

Cutting feed rate limit


A
M
YA

M3
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions After stop of movement


(c

Unit mm/min (°/min)


ht
ig

Setting range 0 to 600000


yr
op
C

2-392
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

The machine coordinating values of the point to which each axis is to


move back under G28 command (first zero-point return).

M4 First zero point


Offset of machine coordinates system

M4
Machine M4
zero point
Program type M, E

d .
MPL521

ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit 0.0001 mm

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
The machine coordinating values of the point to which each axis is to

gh
move back under the G30 command (second zero-point return).

ri
ll
.A
Second zero-point coordinating value Second zero point
M5

N
M5

O
TI
16

A
Machine M5
R
04

Program type M, E zero point


PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement MPL521


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

The machine coordinating values of the point to which each axis is to


ri

ZA
Se

move back under the G30P3 command (third zero-point return).


A
IM

Third zero-point coordinating value


K

M6 Third zero point


ZA

M6
A
M
YA

Machine M6
Program type M, E zero point
3

MPL521
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit 0.0001 mm
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

The machine coordinating values of the point to which each axis is to


ig

move back under the G30P4 command (fourth zero-point return).


yr
op
C

Fourth zero-point coordinating value Fourth zero point


M7
M7

Machine M7
Program type M, E zero point

Conditions After stop of movement MPL521

Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range ±99999999

2-393
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

The maximum moving zone permissible under the machine specifications


Set the machine coordinate values.
Example :
+Y
Maximum software limit specified by
manufacturer (+ direction)

M8
M8 (Y-axis)
+X

Moving zone
Program type M, E M9 (Y-axis)

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°

s
re
Setting range ±99999999
M9 (X-axis) M8 (X-axis)

ts
MPL522

gh
ri
Note : This parameter is invalid when M8 = M9.

ll
Maximum software limit specified by

.A
manufacturer (– direction)

N
M9

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°


O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

Select a unit of command from the following table and set it.
ri

ZA
Se

* micron system
A
IM

1000* 100* 10* 1* 0.1*


Command unit
K

– 10000 1000 100 10 1


ZA

2° index 20000 2000 200 20 2


M10
A

5° index 50000 5000 500 50 5


M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions At power on
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 1 to 50000


ht

Register the address of each axis in hexadecimal numbers in ASCII code.


ig
yr

X-axis Y-axis Z-axis 4th-axis 5th-axis 6th-axis


op

Address name X Y Z A B C
C

Coding of address of axis


Set value &58 &59 &5A &41 &42 &43
M11
Fixed value

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range &0 to &7F

2-394
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Register the incremental axes respectively in hexadecimal numbers of the


ASCII code.

Coding of incremental axis

M12

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F

ts
Specify the address name of the axes to be used for display, by the

gh
appropriate hexadecimal number of the ASCII code.

ri
For reverse display, set up the most significant bit.

ll
Example :

.A
Axis name (for display)
1. Reverse display of “C”

N
M13 C : &0043  Reverse display of “C”: &00C3

O
TI
2. Reverse display of “X1”
16

X1 : &5831  Reverse display of “X1”: &D831


A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range &0 to &FFFF


al

K
ri

When the watchdog-less home position is set, it will be shifted through the
ZA
Se

distance
A
IM

<If returning to the zero point is not yet executed>


K

M14
ZA

Shifting distance of the watchdog-less home


A

position
M

M14 Zero point Signal ON position


YA
3

<If returning to the zero point is executed>


01

New M14
)2

Ex-M14
(c

Program type M, E
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001° Zero Ex-zero M14 changing position


yr

point point
Setting range ±99999999
op
C

2-395
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Specify the name of the address to be used for axis name changing
(G110), by the appropriate hexadecimal number of the ASCII code.

Axis name (for axis name changing)

M15

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range &0 to &7F

ts
The distance from the grid point to the actual zero point that exists during

gh
zero-point return (reference point return) in the initial operation after
power-on.

ri
ll
M16

.A
Zero-point shift amount/grid shift amount

N
O
M16

TI
16

A Watchdog
R
04

Grid point Zero point


PO

(Reference point)
30

Program type M, E MPL527


o.

Note :
N

Conditions Immediate
C

This parameter specifies a grid shift amount when bit 6 of parameter


al

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°


K

M20 is 1.
ri

ZA

Setting range 0 to 99999999


Se

76543210
IM

Unit of output from MCP to servo amplifier


K

0: Millimeter
ZA

1: Inch
A

Direction of machine zero-point return


M

0: (+) direction
YA

1: (–) direction
Error correction schema with servo on
3

0: To correct with motor


01

Axis control flag 1: To correct with counter display


)2

Type of axis
M17 0: Linear
(c

1: Rotational
ht

Rotational direction of servo motor (Note)


ig

(for movement in (+) direction)


yr

0: CW
op

1: CCW
If axis is removed:
C

0: Alarm
1: No alarm
Program type M, E Note :
Usually, specify the rotational direction for the motor when viewed from
Conditions At power on
the front (the opposite side of the encoder). For “Spindle-Cs control”,
Unit — however, specify the rotational direction for the motor when viewed
Setting range Binary, eight digits from the rear.

2-396
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

0: Motor type with frame


1: Built-in type

Spindle C-axis
M18
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

.d
Conditions At power on

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
0: Fixed point for zero-point return using dog

ts
gh
1: Position existing when power was turned on

ri
ll
.A
Machine zero-point position
M18

N
O
(bit 2)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Set the axis to perform virtual dog-type zero-point return.


ri

ZA
Se

0: Invalid
A

1: Valid
IM
K

Virtual axis with dog


ZA

M18
A

(bit 3)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Invalid
ig

1: Valid
yr
op
C

Dog-less axis
M18
(bit 4)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-397
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

0: Radius
1: Diameter

X-axis current position display in


radius/diameter
M18
(bit 5)

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
ll
.A
Automatic/manual simultaneous
absolute-value updating

N
M18

O
(bit 6)

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

0: Invalid
Se

1: Valid
A
IM

M18 bit 7
0 1
K

Absolute-value detection 0 Dog type Simplified detection position


ZA

SV17 bit 7
M18 1 Dog type Absolute detection position
A

(bit 7)
M
YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Set whether or not the value of parameter M1 (rapid feed rate) is


ig

transmitted to servo parameter at power-on.


yr
op

0 : Transmit (same as before)


C

1 : Do not transmit
Transmission of rapid feed rate value to
SV69/SV70
M19
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-398
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

0 : NC
1 : Servo

Select an in-position checking method


M19
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Parameter for system internal setting

gh
Setting prohibited

ri
ll
.A

N
M19

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

0: No check
ZA
Se

1: Alarm if returned from the dog


A
IM

Zero-point operation starting position check


K
ZA

M19
A

(bit 5)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0 : G01
ig

1 : G00
yr
op

Backlash scheme to be adopted for


C

dog-type returning to zero point


M19
(bit 7)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-399
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

0: Forward
1: Reverse

Rotational direction of the rotary axis (for


dynamic offset II)
M20
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Normal

gh
1: KOMET tool axis

ri
ll
.A
KOMET tool axis selection

N
M20

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

0: With the ISS being selected, the stop is delayed by about 140 ms than
ZA
Se

otherwise.
A

Example :
IM

Type of stopping the motion of feed and The stop position for combining the tailstock or steady rest will be
rapid traverse for the INTELLIGENT shifted accordingly.
K
ZA

SAFETY SHIELD (ISS) 1: Independently of whether the ISS is selected or canceled, the axis
M20
movement will come to a stop in one and the same position.
A

(bit 2)
M

Example :
YA

Independently of the ISS, the stop for combining the tailstock or


Program type M, E steady rest will occur in one and the same position. Changing the
3

parameter setting from 0 to 1, therefore, must be followed by a


01

Conditions At power on
readjustment of the combining position.)
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Include
ig

1: Do not include
yr
op

Warning check for alarm 67 HI-SPEED


C

SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM


M20
(bit 4)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-400
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

0: Normal
1: Multi-axis integrated type amplifier

Multi-axis integrated type amplifier


specification
M20
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on

d .
ve
Unit —

er
Setting range 0, 1

s
re
This parameter determines the use of parameter M16.

ts
0: Use parameter M16 for zero-point shift amount.

gh
1: Use parameter M16 for grid shift amount.
Switching between zero-point shift amount

ri
and grid shift amount

ll
M20

.A
(bit 6)

N
O
TI
Program type M, E
16

Conditions At power on
A
R
04

PO

Unit —
30

Setting range 0, 1
R
o.

O
N

76543210 0: Invalid 1: Valid


al

K
ri

ZA

Linear acceleration/
Se

deceleration
A

Rapid-feed
IM

First-order lag
acceleration/
Second-order lag deceleration type
K


Exponential acceleration/
ZA

linear deceleration
M21
A

Linear acceleration/
M

deceleration
YA

First-order lag Cutting-feed


acceleration/
3

Second-order lag
01

deceleration type
)2

Program type M, E Exponential acceleration/


linear deceleration
(c

Conditions At power on
ht

Unit — Time constants for each type of acceleration/deceleration control must be


ig

set using parameters N1 through N6.


Setting range Binary, eight digits
yr
op
C

2-401
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

76543210
Deceleration time constant for rapid-feed
exponential acceleration/linear deceleration
0: Parameter N3
— 1: Parameter N3 × 2

Type of stroke-end stop


M22
00: Linear deceleration
10: Position-loop stepped stop
01: Speed-loop stepped stop
Program type M, E 11: Position-loop stepped stop

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits

ts
0: NC control axes

gh
1: PLC control axes

ri
ll
Selection of NC control axes/PLC control

.A
axes
M23

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

Set the axis for which the MP scale offset method is adopted.
ri

ZA
Se

0: Normal
A

1: MP scale offset method


IM

MP scale offset method


K
ZA

M23
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-402
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set an access inhibition area in the inclined-axis control software limit


area consisting of the X-axis and the Yt-axis.
 Parameters M25 and M26 are valid only for the X-axis and the
Yt-axis.
 If the X-axial and Yt-axial upper limits (M25) and lower limits (M26)
are all zeros, the illegal axis area check function is invalid.
 Use the parameter BA126 to select Type A or B (BA126 bit 1).
Illegal axis area upper limits (Type A)  When the selection of whether to make this interference checking
function valid or invalid is to be made according to the B-axis angle,
M25 specify the interference checking B-axis angle range.

d .
(Type A) The interference checking function will be valid when the following

ve
conditions are satisfied:

er
1. M26 (B-axis)  B-axis angle  M25 (B-axis)

s
re
2. M25 (B-axis) = M26 (B-axis) = 0

ts
gh
<Type A (BA126 bit 1 = 0)>

ri
Program type M, E
X-axial upper limit M25 (X) Upper

ll
Conditions After stop of movement interference

.A
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001° Yt-axial upper soft-limit area

N
M8 (Yt)
Setting range ±99999999

O
Yt-axial (A)

TI
lower limit
16

M26 (Yt) (X,Yt) = (0,0)


A
R
04

Lower
PO
30

interference area
Yt-axial
R

(B)
o.

upper limit
O

M25 (Yt)
N

Yt-axial
al

lower
K

soft-limit
ri

ZA

Illegal axis area lower limits (Type A) M9 (Yt)


Se

M26 X-axial lower X-axial X-axial upper


IM

soft-limit lower limit soft-limit


(Type A) M26 (X)
M9 (X) M8 (X)
K
ZA

Shaded area (A) in the above diagram, determined by


A

parameters M8 (X), M8 (Yt), M25 (X), and M25 (Yt), is referred


M

Upper: to as the illegal axis area.


YA

An alarm will result if an attempt is made to move the machine


into the area.
Program type M, E Shaded area (B) in the above diagram, determined by
3

parameters M9 (X), M9 (Yt), M26 (X), and M26 (Yt), is referred


01

Conditions After stop of movement


Lower: to as the illegal axis area.
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001° An alarm will result if an attempt is made to move the machine
into the area.
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-403
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set an access inhibition area in the inclined-axis control software limit


area consisting of the X-axis and the Yt-axis.
 Parameters M25 and M26 are valid only for the X-axis and the
Yt-axis.
 If the X-axial and Yt-axial upper limits (M25) and lower limits (M26)
are all zeros, the illegal axis area check function is invalid.
 Use the parameter BA126 to select Type A or B (BA126 bit 1).
 When the selection of whether to make this interference checking
Illegal axis area upper limits (Type B)
function valid or invalid is to be made according to the B-axis angle,
M25 specify the interference checking B-axis angle range.

d .
The interference checking function will be valid when the following

ve
(Type B)
conditions are satisfied:

er
1. M26 (B-axis)  B-axis angle  M25 (B-axis)

s
re
2. M25 (B-axis) = M26 (B-axis) = 0

ts
gh
<Type B (BA126 bit 1 = 1)>

ri
Program type M, E X-axial upper

ll
Yt-axial upper Upper
soft-limit

.A
Conditions After stop of movement limit M25 (Yt) interference area
M8 (X)
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°

N
O
Setting range ±99999999 (A)

TI
X-axial (X,Yt) = (0,0)
16

A
lower limit
R
04

M26 (X) X-axial


PO

Lower upper limit


30

interference area M25 (X)


R

(B)
o.

O
N

X-axial
C

Yt-axial lower
lower
al

soft-limit M9 (Yt)
soft-limit
ri

ZA

M9 (X)
Se

Illegal axis area lower limits (Type B)


A

Yt-axial upper
IM

M26 soft-limit M8 (Yt) Yt-axial lower


limit M26 (Yt)
(Type B)
K
ZA
A

Shaded area (A) in the above diagram, determined by


M

parameters M8 (X), M9 (Yt), M25 (X), and M25 (Yt), is referred


Upper: to as the illegal axis area.
YA

An alarm will result if an attempt is made to move the machine


into the area.
3

Program type M, E Shaded area (B) in the above diagram, determined by


01

parameters M9 (X), M8 (Yt), M26 (X), and M26 (Yt), is referred


Conditions After stop of movement Lower: to as the illegal axis area.
)2

An alarm will result if an attempt is made to move the machine


Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°
(c

into the area.


Setting range ±99999999
ht
ig

Set the value that determines the maximum allowable value (Amax) of the
yr

acceleration that occurs between blocks.


op

M27 100 – N26 2


Amax = × 60 × 1000 × (mm/ms )
C

Optimum acceleration control N25 100


(Target speed)
Note :
M27 If M27 = 0, M27 is regarded as equal to M1 (rapid feed rate).
If N25 = 0, N25 is regarded as equal to N1 (rapid feed time constant)

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 5000

2-404
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set the rapid feed clamping speed 1 for superposition control.


(Set value for the reference axis and superposition axis to be used during
superposition control.)
 When both the reference axis and superposition axis move at a rapid
Rapid feed clamping speed 1 for feed rate and in the same direction (see Note below), the rapid feed
superposition control rate for superposition will be clamped in accordance with the setting
of M30.
M29  Set M29 to M31 so that the following conditions are satisfied:
M29 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA)
M31 (RA) + M29 (SA)  M1 (SA)

.
M30 (RA) + M30 (SA)  M1 (SA)

d
RA: reference axis

ve
Program type M, E M31 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA) SA: superposition axis

er
Conditions After stop of axis movement Note :

s
re
Unit mm/min Whether the axes move in the same direction or in different directions is
Setting range 0 to 600000 judged from the command and polarity (parameter N21, bit 6).

ts
gh
Set the rapid feed clamping speed for superposition control when both the

ri
reference axis and superposition axis move at a rapid feed rate and in the
same direction (see the Note).

ll
.A
(Set value for the reference axis and superposition axis to be used during
Rapid feed clamping speed 2 for superposition control.)

N
superposition control  Set M29 to M31 so that the following conditions are satisfied:

O
TI
M30 M29 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA)
16

M31 (RA) + M29 (SA)  M1 (SA)


A
R
M30 (RA) + M30 (SA)  M1 (SA)
04

RA: reference axis


PO

M31 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA) SA: superposition axis


30

Program type M, E Note :


R
o.

Conditions After stop of axis movement Whether the axes move in the same direction or in different directions is
N

Unit mm/min judged from the command and polarity (parameter N21, bit 6).
al

Setting range 0 to 600000


ri

ZA
Se

Set the cutting feed clamping speed for superposition control.


A

(Set value for the reference axis and superposition axis to be used during
IM

superposition control.)
K

 Set M29 to M31 so that the following conditions are satisfied:


Cutting feed clamping speed for
ZA

superposition control M29 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA)


M31 (RA) + M29 (SA)  M1 (SA)
A

M31 M30 (RA) + M30 (SA)  M1 (SA)


M

RA: reference axis


M31 (RA) + M31 (SA)  M1 (SA) SA: superposition axis
YA
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions After stop of axis movement


(c

Unit mm/min
ht

Setting range 0 to 600000


ig

Set the safety speed to be used in safety supervisory mode 2.


yr

If the operating speed of the axis exceeds the set value in safety
op

supervisory mode 2, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and result
C

in an emergency stop.
Safety speed
(Safety supervisory mode 2)

M32

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit mm/min / °/min
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-405
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set the safety speed to be used in safety supervisory mode 3.


If the operating speed of the axis exceeds the set value in safety
supervisory mode 3, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and result
in an emergency stop. (Assign a value greater than that of parameter M32
Safety speed to parameter M33.)
(Safety supervisory mode 3)

M33

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement

er
Unit mm/min / °/min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the safety clamping speed to be used in safety supervisory mode 2.

gh
In safety supervisory mode 2 and while a safety clamping request is in
effect, operation decelerates to the set speed. (Assign a value smaller

ri
than that of parameter M32 to parameter M34.)

ll
Safety clamping speed

.A
(Safety supervisory mode 2)

N
M34

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of axis movement


R
o.

Unit mm/min / °/min


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Set the safety clamping speed to be used in safety supervisory mode 3.


ri

ZA
Se

In safety supervisory mode 3 and while a safety clamping request is in


A

effect, operation decelerates to the set speed. (Assign a value smaller


IM

than that of parameter M33 to parameter M35.)


Safety clamping speed
K

(Safety supervisory mode 3)


ZA

M35
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of axis movement


01

Unit mm/min / °/min


)2

Setting range 0 to 99999999


(c
ht

Set to which door group the axis belongs in safety supervisory mode.
ig
yr
op

Speed supervisory door selection


C

(Safety supervisory mode)

M36

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-406
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

A speed clamping signal is output after the axis has decelerated to the
clamping speed. This parameter specifies to what additional percentage
of the safety clamping speed the axis is to be decelerated as the output
timing of the speed clamping signal.
Safety clamping speed reduction judgment
coefficient If 0 is set, the speed clamping signal will be output when the axis
(Safety supervisory mode) decelerates to a 10% additional speed (i.e., 110% of the safety clamping
speed).
M37

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions After stop of axis movement

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set the machine interference detection distances for the INTELLIGENT

gh
SAFETY SHIELD.

ri
Set data so that the primary check distance is longer than the secondary
check distance.

ll
.A
N
Interference check distances for

O
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD during

TI
16

manual operation A Primary


R
04

M38 M38: Primary check distance


interference check
PO

M39: Secondary check distance


30

M39 distance (M38)


R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA

Secondary interference check


Se

distance (M39)
A

Program type M, E
IM

Conditions At power on Note :


K

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001° The same value as that of the primary parallel driving control axis
ZA

Setting range 0 to 99999999 should be assigned to the secondary axis.


A
M

For the machine specifications with a ram spindle, specify the maximum
YA

operating range for the ram spindle selection. When ram spindle is
selected, the range specified in these parameters becomes the maximum
3

operating range, instead of the manufacturer software limits specified in


01

Ram spindle stored stroke end M08/M09.


M40: Upper limit
)2

M40 M41: Lower limit


(c

M41
ht
ig
yr

Program type M, E
op

Conditions After stop of axis movement


C

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°


Setting range ±99999999

2-407
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set the machine interference check distance for INTELLIGENT SAFETY


SHIELD during automatic operation
Note :
Interference check distance for The same value as that of the primary parallel driving control axis
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD during should be assigned to the secondary axis.
automatic operation
M42

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Set which door signal is input for the axis with door signal input on the

gh
drive side (servo) in safety supervisory mode.

ri
1: Door 1 signal

ll
Selection of a door for signal input on the 2: Door 2 signal

.A
drive side (servo) in safety supervisory
4: Door 3 signal
mode

N
8: Door 4 signal
M45

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

M61
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Set the cutting feed rate for variable acceleration control.


ig

When “0” is set, the value set at parameter L74 is assumed.


yr
op
C

Variable acceleration control:


Cutting feed rate
M66

Program type M, E [Related parameters]


Conditions Immediate L74

Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 255

2-408
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title FEED VEL.

Address Meaning Description

Set the limit for the rapid traverse rate in orbit machining.
When “0” is set for M67 or the value set for M67 is larger than M1, the
rapid traverse rate is clamped at the value set for M1.

Rapid traverse rate limit in orbit machining

M67

Program type E

.d
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit mm/min (°/min)

s
Setting range 0 to 99999999

re
Set the limit for the cutting feedrate in orbit machining.

ts
gh
When “0” is set for M68, the cutting feedrate is clamped at the value set
for M3.

ri
When the value set for M68 is larger than M1, the cutting feedrate is

ll
Cutting feedrate limit in orbit machining

.A
clamped at the value set for M1.

N
M68

O
TI
16

Program type E
A
R
04

PO

Conditions After stop of movement


30

Unit mm/min (°/min)


o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


C
al

Fixed value
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

M70
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c

0: Invalid
ht

1: Valid
ig
yr
op

Real time tuning II Rapid feed time


C

constant selection
M72
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-409
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-14 Machine parameter TIME CONST. (N)

Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Set the time constant to obtain linear acceleration/deceleration of the rapid


feed rate.
Speed

Rapid-feed time constant


M1
(linear acceleration/deceleration)

N1

d .
ve
Time

er
Program type M, E
N1 N1

s
Conditions Immediate

re
MPL523
Unit ms Note :

ts
gh
Setting range 4 to 1800 This parameter is valid only when bit 0 of M21 is 1.

ri
Set the time constant to obtain linear acceleration/deceleration of the

ll
cutting feed rate.

.A
Speed

N
Cutting-feed time constant

O
M3
(linear acceleration/deceleration)

TI
16

N2 A
R
04

PO
30

Time
R
o.

Program type M, E
O

N2 N2
N

Conditions Immediate MPL523


al

Unit ms Note :
ri

ZA
Se

Setting range 4 to 1800 This parameter is valid only when bit 4 of M21 is 1.
A

First-order lag time constant for rapid-feed acceleration/deceleration


IM

(First-order lag) (Exponential acceleration/


Speed Speed
K

linear deceleration)
ZA

Rapid-feed time constant M1 M1


A

(First-order lag)
M

N3 Time
YA

Time
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

N3 N3 N3 N3 × 2
Conditions Immediate MPL524
(c

Unit ms Note :
ht

This parameter is valid only when either bit 1, 2 or 3 of M21 is 1.


ig

Setting range 4 to 5000


yr
op
C

2-410
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Set the time constant for the filter that further smoothens the speed signal
waveform during rapid feed (G0) operation with shape correction off and
during rapid feed operation in manual operation mode.
The filter will be invalid if 0 is set.
Time constant for post-interpolation rapid
feed acceleration/deceleration filter

N4

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit ms

s
Setting range 0 to 455

re
First-order lag time constant for cutting-feed acceleration/ deceleration

ts
gh
(First-order lag) (Exponential acceleration/
Speed Speed linear deceleration)

ri
ll
Cutting-feed time constant M3 M3

.A
(First-order lag)

N
N5 Time Time

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E N5 N5 N5 N5 × 2
PO
30

Conditions Immediate MPL524


R

Note :
o.

Unit ms
O
N

This parameter is valid only when either bit 5, 6 or 7 of M21 is 1.


C

Setting range 0 to 5000


al

During external deceleration, the position loop is disconnected for the time
ri

ZA

interval set using this parameter and, as a result, the speed becomes
Se

zero.
A
IM

OT time
K
ZA

N7
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit ms
)2

Setting range 1 to 32767


(c
ht

The feed rate at which each axis is moved back to the zero-point
(reference point) after the zero-point watchdog LS (limit switch) has turned
ig

on in the initial operation after power-on.


yr

Feedrate
op

Creeping speed during initial zero-point


C

return
M2
N8
N8

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement Watchdog Zero point
Unit mm/min (°/min) (Reference point)
MPL525
Setting range 1 to 60000

2-411
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

The spacing at which the grid point is ignored during zero-point return
(reference point return in the initial operation after power-on) after the
zero-point watchdog LS (limit switch) is turned off. With this parameter,
dispersion in position deviations of the zero point can be avoided.
Amount of grid ignorance during initial
zero-point return

N9

Watchdog
Program type M, E Zero point

d.
(Reference point)

ve
Conditions Immediate N9 MPL526

er
Unit 0.001 mm (0.001°)
The amount of grid ignorance must not exceed 1 grid spacing.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
Set the grid interval of the detector.

gh
Usually, set the same value as the ball screw pitch. However, set the grid

ri
interval of the detector if the grid interval differs from the pitch.

ll
.A
Grid interval

N
N10

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit mm (0.001°)
N

Setting range 0 to 32767


al

K
ri

Machine dependent specific value


ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

N12
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Machine dependent specific value


ig
yr
op
C

N13

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-412
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Machine dependent specific value

N15

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Machine dependent specific value

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
N16

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Specify the channel number of the servo amplifier.


ZA
Se

1: 1 ch
A

2: 2 ch
IM

Servo amplifier channel number


K
ZA

N17
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Specify the rotary switch number of the servo amplifier.


ig

0: SW0
yr

1: SW1
op

2: SW2
C

Servo amplifier rotary switch number 3: SW3


4: SW4
N18 5: SW5
6: SW6

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 6

2-413
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Set the system number of the axes.


0: System 1
1: System 2
2: System 3
Axis system number 3: System 4

N19

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 3

ts
76543210

gh
ri
Linear-type rotational axis (Note)

ll
0: Rotary type

.A
1: Linear type

N
Rotational axis shortcut

O
0: Invalid

TI
1: Valid
16

A
R
04

— Fixed value (0)


PO
30

N21 Fixed value


R
o.

Reference axis for superposition control


N

Superposition axis for superposition control


al

K
ri

Relative polarity of control axis


ZA
Se

Current position immediately after cross machining


A

0: No re-acquisition
IM

1: Re-acquisition
K

Program type M, E Note :


ZA

Conditions At power on When M18 bit 0 = 1 (type of C-axis: built-in type), if N21 bit 0 is set to 1
A

(linear type rotational axis), SA46 bit 2 must be set to 0 (C-axis position
Unit —
M

control changeover type: after return to zero point).


YA

Setting range Binary, eight digits


0: Positioning
3
01

1: No positioning
)2

Axis selection for positioning during


(c

automatic operation or virtual machining


ht

with 3D interference check


N22
ig
yr

(bit 0)
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-414
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value


N22
(bit 3)

.
Program type —

d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
N22

O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA

Set the maximum allowable value, Amax, for the acceleration occurring
Se

between blocks.
A
IM

M27 100 – N26 2


Amax = × 60 × 1000 × 100 (mm/ms )
N25
Time constant for deceleration rate
K

calculation Note :
ZA

If M27 = 0, M27 is regarded as equal to M1 (rapid feed rate).


N25
A

If N25 = 0, N25 is regarded as equal to N1 (rapid feed time constant)


M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of axis movement


)2

Unit ms
(c

Setting range 0 to 5000


ht
ig
yr
op

Accuracy coefficient for deceleration rate


C

calculation

N26

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of axis movement
Unit —
Setting range ±32768

2-415
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Set the rapid feed (linear acceleration/deceleration) time constant for


superposition control.

Note : Set the same value for all axes.


Rapid feed time constant for superposition

N27

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit ms

s
re
Setting range 4 to 1800

ts
Set the cutting feed (linear acceleration/deceleration) time constant for

gh
superposition control.

ri
ll
Note : Set the same value for all axes.

.A
Cutting feed time constant for superposition

N
N28

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit ms
N

Setting range 4 to 1800


al

K
ri

Use of this parameter allows further smoothening of the speed signal


ZA
Se

waveform during rapid feed with shape correction on.


A

The filter will be invalid if 0 is set.


IM

Time constant for shape correction rapid


K

feed acceleration/deceleration filter


ZA

N29
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit ms
(c

Setting range 0 to 455


ht

Set the cutting feed time constant for a time constant changeover M-code
ig

Cutting feed time constant for time constant command.


yr

changeover M-code command


op

N30: for M881 command Feed rate


C

N31: for M882 command


N30 N32: for M883 command
N33: for M884 command
to
N34: for M885 command
N35 N35: for M886 command

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement M3 Time

Unit ms N30 to N35 N30 to N35


Setting range 0 to 1800

2-416
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

If the actual ball screw pitch is a decimal fraction (special gear ratio) with
the machine of absolute position specification, input the number of
rotations of the ball screw per rotation of the rotary axis (360 degrees/
actual ball screw pitch).
Multi-turn counter increment with absolute
position rotary-type rotational axis in special
gear ratio
N36

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range –32768 to 32767

ts
Set the rotational speed of the rotary axis so that the number of rotations

gh
of the ball screw per rotation of the rotary axis (360 degrees/actual ball
screw pitch) will not be a decimal fraction.

ri
ll
Rotational speed after multi-turn counter

.A
increment with absolute position rotary-type
rotational axis in special gear ratio

N
N37

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range –32768 to 32767


al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

N38
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, maximum value


ig

The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
yr

setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
op

and inertia ratio.


C

Real time tuning II Rapid feed time


constant, maximum value Rapid feed time constant

N57
N57

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate N60
Unit ms Inertia ratio
Setting range 0 to 10000 N58 N61

2-417
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Real time tuning II Minimum inertia ratio

The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
and inertia ratio.
Real time tuning II Minimum inertia ratio
Rapid feed time constant

N58
N57

. d
Program type M, E

ve
Conditions Immediate N60

er
Unit %

s
Inertia ratio

re
Setting range 0 to 65535 N58 N61

ts
Real time tuning II Rapid feed time constant, minimum value

gh
ri
The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant

ll
.A
and inertia ratio.
Real time tuning II Rapid feed time

N
constant, minimum value Rapid feed time constant

O
N60

TI
16

N57 A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
R
o.

Conditions Immediate N60


O
N

Unit ms Inertia ratio


al

Setting range 0 to 10000 N58 N61


ri

ZA
Se

Real time tuning II Maximum inertia ratio


A
IM

The optimum time constant is calculated from the estimated inertia ratio by
setting the maximum and minimum values for the rapid feed time constant
K

and inertia ratio.


ZA

Real time tuning II Maximum inertia ratio


Rapid feed time constant
A

N61
M
YA

N57
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate N60


(c

Unit % Inertia ratio


ht

Setting range 0 to 65535 N58 N61


ig

The current time constant is used if the difference between the optimum
yr

time constant and current time constant is equivalent to or smaller than the
op

value set for N63, and the optimum time constant is used if the difference
C

is greater than the value set for N63.


Real time tuning II Rapid feed time
constant, range of change

N63

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 10000

2-418
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title TIME CONST.

Address Meaning Description

Set the cutting feed time constant for variable acceleration control.
When “0” is set, the value set at parameter L75 is assumed.

Variable acceleration control:


Cutting feed time constant

N66

[Related parameters]
Program type M, E L75

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit ms

s
re
Setting range 1 to 5000

ts
Axis name specified with 2 characters is

gh
0 : Invalid

ri
1 : Valid

ll
.A
Axis with a 2-character axis name

N
N67

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Fixed value
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

N67
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-419
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-15 Machine parameter ANOTHER (S)

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Set for each axis the feed forward gain for acceleration/deceleration
before interpolation for the MAZAK Precision Rapid Boring Tornado
Option.

Feed forward gain for the MAZAK Precision


Rapid Boring Tornado Option

S3

d .
ve
er
Program type M, E

s
Conditions Immediate

re
Unit 0.1%

ts
gh
Setting range 0 to 1000

ri
Set for each axis the feed forward gain for acceleration/deceleration

ll
before interpolation.

.A
N
O
Feed forward gain

TI
16

S4 A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

Program type M, E
O
N

Conditions Immediate
al

Unit %
ri

ZA
Se

Setting range 0 to 100


A

Set the position of the rotational center of the table in the machine
IM

coordinates system.
K

–X
ZA
A

S5
M
YA

S5
Rotational center of the table
3

–Y
01

S5 Note :
)2

1. Z-axis data are not required for a machine with a tilting table.
(c

2. This parameter is used to execute the automatic program origin


ht

calculation function (option) for a machine with a tilting table.


ig
yr
op

Program type M, E
(For INTEGREX series)
C

Conditions At power on (For dynamic offset)


Unit (For HV machining)
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
(For machines equipped with a tilting table)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-420
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

When movement is beyond the length set by this parameter during the
power off, it activates the alarm mode.
If 0 is set, no alarm occurs.

Absolute position detection parameter

S6

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on

er
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in/
Unit

s
0.0001°

re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
This parameter specifies the range of rotating machining for the table

gh
rotating machining  (X-B machining).

ri
Set the upper limit (on Z-axis) of the machining range in the machine

ll
coordinates system.

.A
Upper limit (on Z-axis) of machining range The machine recognizes that it is prohibited to move beyond this limit in
for table rotating machining  the negative direction.

N
O
S7

TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions At power on
o.

(For HV machining)
N

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


C
al

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


K
ri

ZA

Specify the pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration feed-forward gain


Se

levels for each axis.


A
IM
K

Feed-forward gain G00


ZA
A

S8
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 100


ht

Specify the axis of rotation of the tilting table in machine coordinates (Y


ig

and Z).
yr

This parameter is used for the software travel limit function.


op

Note : X-axial data are not required.


C

Axis of rotation of the tilting table

S10 –Y

S10 (Z)
Program type M, E
S10 (Y)
Conditions Immediate –Z

Unit 0.0001 mm
(For machines equipped with a tilting table)
Setting range 0 to ±99999999

2-421
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Specify the corner position of the tilting table in (Y- and Z-axial) distances
from its axis of rotation.
This parameter is used for the software travel limit function.

Corner position of the tilting table Note : X-axial data are not required.

S11
S11 (Z)

Program type M, E

d .
S11 (Y)

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm
(For machines equipped with a tilting table)

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Specify the axis of rotation of the tilting table in machine coordinates (Y

gh
and Z). Use this parameter to execute the automatic program origin
calculation function (option).

ri
Measure and enter data for respective machines.

ll
Axis of rotation of the tilting table

.A
Note : X-axial data are not required.
(Used for the automatic program origin

N
calculation function)

O
S12 –Y

TI
16

A S12 (Z)
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

S12 (Y)
–Z
R

Conditions Immediate
o.

O
N

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


C

(For machines equipped with a tilting table)


al

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


K
ri

ZA

Set the in-position width for G00. The in-position check for G00 is
Se

effective when the parameter K95 bit 7 is 1 and K96 bit 0 is 0.


A

For utilizing the in-position width of G00, set the in-position width of the
IM

servo parameter to 0 to avoid trouble.


K

G00 in-position width


ZA

Note :
S13
A

1. This parameter is valid only when bit 3 of M19 is 0.


M

2. Setting a value outside 0 to 32767 assumes S13 = 200.


YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit 0.001 mm
(c

Setting range 0 to 32767


ht

Set the inposition width for G01. The in-position check for G01 is effective
ig

when one of G09 (exact stop check), G61 (exact stop check mode) and
yr

the error detection is selected with the parameter K95 bit 7 set to 1.
op

For utilizing the in-position width for G01, set the in-position width of the
C

G01 in-position width servo parameter to 0 to avoid trouble.

S14 Note :
1. This parameter is valid only when bit 3 of M19 is 0.
2. Setting a value outside 0 to 32767 assumes S14 = 50.
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit 0.001 mm
Setting range 0 to 32767

2-422
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value

S15

Program type —

. d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
Set automatically after estimation of the characteristics.

gh
ri
ll
.A
Unbalanced axis torque offset

N
S16

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Specify torque limit buffer reduction ratio 1.


ZA
Se

A
IM

Torque limit buffer reduction ratio 1


K
ZA

S17
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 200


ht

Specify torque limit buffer reduction ratio 2.


ig
yr
op
C

Torque limit buffer reduction ratio 2

S18

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 200

2-423
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Specify the tool change completion position of the long boring bar end tool
by the corresponding machine coordinates.

Tool change completion position of the long S19 Tool change


boring bar end tool completion position

S19
Machine S19
zero point
Program type M, E

.
Conditions Immediate MPL521

d
ve
0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Unit

er
0.0001°

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Set the completion position of automatic pallet change operation.

gh
ri
ll
.A
APC completion position

N
S20

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°


O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

Set the completion position of gantry robot operation.


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Completion position of gantry robot


K

operation
ZA

S21
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°


)2

Setting range ±99999999


(c
ht

Specify the critical cutting feed rate to be used during tool tip point control.
ig

During tool tip point control, speed is clamped in accordance with


yr

parameter S22 or M3 (critical cutting feed rate), whichever is the smaller.


op

Cutting feed clamping speed during tool tip


C

point control

S22

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min (°/min)
Setting range 1 to 200000

2-424
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Set the position of a reference workpiece zero point for each axis in the
machine coordinate system.
Set the position of a reference workpiece zero point relating to the turret
also in the machine coordinate system.
For machining centers, this parameter is invalid.
* Tool set value is determined based on this parameter.
Reference workpiece zero point X

S23 M
Z

d.
S23 (Z)

ve
er
S23 (X)

s
re
Program type M, E

ts
gh
Conditions After stop of movement

ri
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in Reference workpiece zero point

ll
Setting range ±99999999

.A
Set the central position of the tilt table upper surface on the VIRTUAL

N
MACHINING display in terms of machine coordinates for each axis.

O
(For machines with a tilt table)

TI
Central position on the upper surface of the
16

tilt table Set the central position of the table upper surface on the VIRTUAL
A
MACHINING display in terms of machine coordinates for each axis.
R
04

(for machines with a tilt table)


(For other machining centers)
PO
30

Central position on the table upper surface


S25 (for other machining centers) +Z +Z
R
o.

O
N

+X +Y
al

S25 (Z) S25 (Z)


ri

ZA

Program type M, E
Se

Conditions Immediate
A

S25 (X) S25 (Y)


IM

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


Setting range ±99999999
K
ZA

Set the position of the tilt table rotational center on the VIRTUAL
MACHINING display in terms of machine coordinates for each axis.
A
M

+Z +Z
YA

Central position of tilt table rotation +X +Y


3
01

S26 S26 (Z) S26 (Z)


)2
(c

S26 (X) S26 (Y)


ht

Program type M, E
ig

Conditions Immediate
yr
op

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(Special function for machines with a tilt table)
C

Setting range ±99999999

2-425
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

For the machine specifications with a ram spindle, specify the offsets
between the main spindle and the ram spindle for each axis.

+Z +Z

+Y +X

Ram spindle offset amount S27Y S27X

S27

d .
ve
er
s
re
S27Z S27Z

ts
gh
Program type E Main spindle Ram spindle
Ram spindle

ri
Main spindle
(Milling spindle)
Conditions Immediate

ll
.A
Unit 0.0001 mm

N
Setting range ±99999999 (Special function for machines with a ram spindle)

O
For graphics on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display, set with machine co-

TI
16

ordinates of the rectangular axes, the center of the workpiece to be


A
directly mounted on the table of the machines equipped with an additional
R
04

PO

table.
30

+Z
R

Center of the workpiece to be directly


o.

mounted on the table of the machines


N

equipped with an additional table +X


al

S28
ri

S28 (Z) S25 (Z)


ZA
Se

Table S25 (X) Additional table


A

S28 (X)
IM

Program type M
K

Note :
ZA

Conditions At power on
This parameter is only used when multiple material pieces can be
A

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in arranged on the display in question (F35 bit 0 = 1). Use parameter S25
M

Setting range ±99999999 to set the center of the additional table’s upper surface.
YA

Machine
3

zero point
01
)2

Position of the axis of rotation of the work


(c

hand in relation to the machine zero point S29 (X) Work hand
ht

S29
ig
yr
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
S29 (Z) Axis of rotation
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range ±99999999 (Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)

2-426
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Set the distance from the axis of rotation of the work hand to the reference
position of the vice for the work hand during workpiece transfer.
S30 (Z)
Distance from the axis of rotation of the Reference position
work hand to the reference position of the of the vice
vice
S30
Work hand S30 (X)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate
Axis of rotation

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
(Only for machines with a workpiece handling device)

re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Specify the machine coordinates of the floating reference point.

gh
Example :

ri
G30.1X10.Z10.;

ll
Specification of the machine coordinates of Entry of the above command returns the tool in rapid feed mode

.A
the floating reference point through the intermediate point (X10, Z10) to the floating reference point

N
specified in this parameter.
S31

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

The general setting for rapid traverse speed in parameter M1 will be used
ri

ZA

also for the mode of tool tip point control if it is lower than the setting in
Se

parameter S32.
IM

Rapid traverse speed for the mode of tool


Note :
K

tip point control


ZA

Set zero (0) in S32 if it is desirable to use the general setting in


S32 parameter M1 for the rapid traverse in question.
A
M
YA

Program type E
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit mm/min (°/min)


)2

Setting range 0 to 200000


(c
ht

Set the machine coordinate of the table edge on the negative side of the
X-axis.
ig
yr

Reference position X for the TEACH Machine zero point


Reference position S33 (X)
op

function, to be used for setting the LENGTH


B item of an angular tool
C

(For machines of five-surface machining by


S33 angular tools)

Program type M, E
Table
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm
Setting range —

2-427
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Set the amount of offset to add to the data for rotary head misalignment
offset for each axis.

Amount of offset for rotary head * This parameter is valid on the machines with the capability of
misalignment Maza-Check.

S34

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.0001°

s
re
Setting range –10000 to 10000

ts
Set the position of the rotational center of the second table in the machine

gh
coordinate system when table selection is valid. (That of the first table to
be specified in parameter S5)

ri
Table having a horizontally rotational axis

ll
.A
Machine zero point

N
S35(Y) S5(Y)

O
TI
S5(X)
16

A S35(X)
R
04

PO
30

Z
Y
R
o.

Rotational center of the second table X


N

C
al

Table having a vertically rotational axis


K

S35
ri

ZA
Se

Machine zero point


A
IM

S35(Y) S35(Z) S5(Y)


S5(Z)
K
ZA
A
M

Z
Y
YA

X
3
01

Program type M, E Note :


)2

Conditions At power on Among the rotary axes (parameter M17 bit 4 = 1) excluding the rotary
(c

head, the first axis is regarded as the first rotary table and the second
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
axis the second rotary table.
ht

Setting range 0 to ±99999999


ig
yr
op
C

2-428
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Set the central position of the second additional table in the machine
coordinate system on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display when the table
selection function is valid. (Set the first additional table at parameter S25.)
For the table having the horizontal axis of rotation

Machine zero point

S36(Y) S25(Y)
S25(X)

.
S36(X)

d
ve
er
Z
Position of the center of the second Y

s
re
additional table on the VIRTUAL
MACHINING display X

ts
S36

gh
For the table having the vertical axis of rotation

ri
Machine zero point

ll
.A
S36(Y) S36(Z) S25(Y)

N
S25(Z)

O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO

Z
30

Y
R
o.

X
O
N

Program type M, E Note :


al

Conditions Immediate
ri

Among the rotary axes (parameter M17 bit 4 = 1) excluding the rotary
ZA
Se

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in head, the first axis is regarded as the first rotary table and the second
A

axis the second rotary table.


Setting range 0 to ±99999999
IM

Sets the distance from the spindle side face to the center of head.
K
ZA
A

Distance from the spindle side face to the


M

center of head
YA

S37
3
01
)2

Program type M, E
(c

Conditions Immediate
ht

Unit 0.0001 mm
ig
yr

Setting range 0 to 99999999


op
C

2-429
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

This parameter allows you to make the preset time for canceling the
emergency stop status at powering on (hotline disconnection time)
variable.
0: 1000 ms
1 to 7: 8 ms

Time-out period for releasing the 8 to 3000: The time-out period is set according to the setting.
emergency stop status during powering on Beyond 3000: 3000 ms

S38 Note :
1. Set the value for the first axis (X-axis).

d .
ve
2. Setting a negative value invalidates this parameter and the hotline
is disconnected for 7.1 ms.

er
3. When this parameter is valid, the time taken to cancel the

s
re
Program type M, E emergency stop status is output to register R71. When the ready
lamp turning on process has failed due to a communication error,

ts
Conditions At power on
“0” is output to the register R71.

gh
Unit ms

ri
Setting range 0 to 3000

ll
.A
Non-target axis setting for indexing unit (rotational axis)
Set the axis of which setting check or rotation command is not output in

N
the indexing unit.

O
TI
* Rotational axis: the axis specified in parameter M17 bit 4 = 1
Non-target axis setting for indexing unit
16

(rotational axis)
A
0: Target axis
R
04

S45 1: Non-target axis


PO
30

(bit 0)
R
o.

Note :
O
N

Program type M This is invalid for rotational axes of the sixth or higher.
al

When parameter BA48 = 0 and L21 = 0, this is invalid for rotational


ri

Conditions Immediate
ZA

axes of the fifth or higher.


Se

Unit —
A
IM

Setting range 0, 1
Set an axis that is not displayed on the counter.
K
ZA

0: Displayed
1: Hidden
A
M

Setting of an axis not displayed on the


YA

counter
S45
3

(bit 1)
01
)2
(c

Program type M, E
ht

Conditions Immediate
ig

Unit —
yr

Setting range 0, 1
op
C

2-430
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Sets the disable axis for the rapid feed overlapping function.
0: Rapid feed overlapping function enabled axis
1: Rapid feed overlapping function disabled axis
Rapid feed overlapping function disabled
axis * When bit 2 of S45 is set to “1”, the settings of S49 and S50 will be
S45 ignored.
(bit 2)
S49: Rapid feed overlapping function: G0 in-position width
Program type M, E S50: Rapid feed overlapping function: G1 in-position width

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Set the G0 in-position width to be used when the rapid feed overlapping

gh
function is valid.

ri
If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).

ll
Rapid feed overlapping function:

.A
G0 in-position width

N
O
S49

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
O

Unit
N

0.0001°
al

Setting range 0 to 10000000


ri

ZA
Se

Set the G1 in-position width to be used when the rapid feed overlapping
A

function is valid.
IM

If a value outside the setting range is set, operation is carried out with the
upper limit value (10000000) or lower limit value (0).
K

Rapid feed overlapping function:


ZA

G1 in-position width
A
M

S50
YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
(c

Unit
0.0001°
ht

Setting range 0 to 10000000


ig
yr
op
C

2-431
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Sets the distance from the center of rotation to the edge of the
small-diameter table for VARIAXIS.
Even if a value is set for the axis parallel to the rotary axis of the tilt table,
the value is not used for the software limit check.

When 0 is set, the small-diameter table is not taken into consideration.

Distance to the edge of the small-diameter


table

S51

d .
ve
s er
S51 (Y)

re
ts
S11 (Y)

gh
Program type M, E

ri
Conditions Immediate [Related parameters]

ll
.A
Unit 0.0001 mm S11
(Function dedicated to machines equipped with the tilt table)

N
Setting range 0 to 99999999

O
Sets the position of the center of table rotation for the additional A-axis in

TI
the machine coordinate system. (Machining centers)
16

A
R
04

PO

* This setting is used for drawing in QUICK MAZATROL and on the


30

Center of table rotation (additional A-axis) TRACE display.


R
o.

O
N

S66
C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Program type M
A
IM

Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm / 0.00001 in
K
ZA

Setting range ±99999999


A

Fixed value
M
YA
3
01


)2

S70
(c
ht
ig

Program type —
yr
op

Conditions —
C

Unit —
Setting range —

2-432
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title ANOTHER

Address Meaning Description

Used to select whether the alarms 1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM
ALARM3 and 72 SERVO WARNING are to be displayed or not.
0 : Displayed

Smart safety monitoring alarm 1 : Not displayed


(for servo axis)
S71
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

S72

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
(bit 1)
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-433
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-16 Machine parameter SPINDLE (SA)

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Number of revolutions per minute of the spindle in each speed range

Maximum number of speed ranges


Address
1 2 3 4
SA1  L L L
SA2 Invalid H M ML
SA3 Invalid Invalid H MH

.
SA4 Invalid Invalid Invalid H

d
ve
Maximum spindle speed in each speed
range (range 1 to 8) Example :
SA1

er
Output voltage

s
to

re
SA8

ts
gh
MAX

ri
H

ll
L

.A
N
O
Program type M, E min
–1

TI
16

Conditions At power on A SA9 (Spindle speed)


R
04

–1
Unit min SA1 SA10
PO
30

Setting range 0 to 999999 SA2


R
o.

Constants for calculating each gear speed of the spindle


O
N

Maximum number of speed ranges


al

Address
ri

1 2 3 4
ZA
Se

Constants for calculating each gear speed SA9  L L L


A

SA9 of the spindle (range 1 to 8)


IM

SA10 Invalid H M ML
to SA11 Invalid Invalid H MH
K

SA16 SA12 Invalid Invalid Invalid H


ZA
A
M

Program type M, E
YA

Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
3
01

Setting range 0 to 999999 ( SA1, SA2, SA3, SA4)


)2

The maximum number of revolutions per minute of the spindle in each


(c

speed range during a tapping cycle


ht

Maximum number of speed ranges


ig

Address
Maximum spindle speed during tapping 1 2 3 4
yr

SA17 cycle (range 1 to 8)


op

SA17  L L L
to
C

SA18 Invalid H M ML
SA24 SA19 Invalid Invalid H MH
SA20 Invalid Invalid Invalid H
Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999

2-434
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

The number of revolutions per minute of the spindle during shifting of


gears thru the various ranges

Maximum number of speed range


Address
Spindle speed during gear shifting (range 1 1 2 3 4
SA25 to 4)
SA25  L L L
to SA26 Invalid H M ML
SA28 SA27 Invalid Invalid H MH
SA28 Invalid Invalid Invalid H
Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
–1
Unit min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999

ts
Scaling factor (for high-speed coil) with respect to the reference output of

gh
the load meter

ri
Output
(kW) Output diagram at

ll
Load meter reference output scaling factor short-time rating

.A
(high-speed coil) P0

N
Output diagram at
SA29

O
continuous rating
P1

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

N0 N1 Speed
30

Conditions Immediate SA29 = P1/P0 × 100 –1


(min )
R
o.

SA30 = N1
O

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 100


al

K
ri

Base rotational speed (for high-speed coil) for the output changed by the
ZA
Se

parameter SA29 with respect to the reference output of the load meter
A

Output
IM

(kW) Output diagram at


Load meter reference output base short-time rating
K

rotational speed (high-speed coil) P0


ZA

Output diagram at
SA30 continuous rating
A

P1
M
YA

Program type M, E
N0 N1
3

Speed
01

Conditions Immediate SA29 = P1/P0 × 100 –1


(min )
SA30 = N1
)2

–1
Unit min
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999


ht

Scaling factor (for low-speed coil) with respect to the reference output of
ig

the load meter


yr

Output
op

(kW) Output diagram at


Load meter reference output scaling factor short-time rating
C

(low-speed coil) P0
Output diagram at
SA31 continuous rating
P1

Program type M, E
N0 N1 Speed
Conditions Immediate SA31 = P1/P0 × 100 –1
(min )
Unit % SA32 = N1

Setting range 0 to 100

2-435
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Base rotational speed (for low-speed coil) for the output changed by the
parameter SA31 with respect to the reference output of the load meter
Output
Output diagram at
(kW)
Load meter reference output base short-time rating
rotational speed (low-speed coil) P0
Output diagram at
SA32 continuous rating
P1

Program type M, E

. d
N0 N1 Speed

ve
Conditions Immediate SA31 = P1/P0 × 100 –1
(min )
SA32 = N1

er
–1
Unit min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999

ts
Linear acceleration/deceleration time constant for the synchronous

gh
tapping cycle
SA33: Range 1

ri
ll
SA34: Range 2
Acceleration/deceleration time constant for

.A
the synchronous tapping (range 1 to 8) SA35: Range 3
SA33

N
SA36: Range 4
to

O
TI
SA40
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit ms
N

Setting range 0 to 1800


al

Specify the spindle orientating speed.


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Spindle orientating speed


K
ZA

SA41
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

–1
Unit min
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999


ht

Specify the minimum spindle speed.


ig
yr
op
C

Minimum spindle speed

SA42

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999

2-436
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description


Specify the channel number for the spindle amplifier.
1: 1 ch (the setting used when connection to SV1 of the HR353 is
established)
2: 2 ch (the setting used when connection to SV3 of the HR353 is
Channel number for the spindle amplifier established)

SA43

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions At power on

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0 to 2

re
Specify the rotary switch number of the spindle amplifier.

ts
gh
0: SW0

ri
1: SW1

ll
2: SW2
Spindle amplifier rotary switch number

.A
3: SW3

N
SA44 4: SW4

O
5: SW5

TI
16

6: SW6 A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0 to 6
C
al

0: As specified by bit 1
ri

ZA

1: L/H coil sw. + Mecha. gear shift


Se

Spindle speed range changing method, in * For the setting of SA45 bit 0 = 1, set the rated torque, viscous &
IM

relation to switching the torque factors for coulomic friction coefficients of the spindle motor in the relevant
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection parameters as tabulated below:
K

SA45 type
ZA

Speed Rated Visc. fric. Coul. fric.


(bit 0) Coil
range No. torque coef. coef.
A
M

1 L SA53 SA57 SA61


YA

Program type M, E 1 H SA54 SA57 SA61


Conditions After stop of movement 2 L SA53 SA58 SA62
3
01

Unit — 2 H SA54 SA58 SA62


)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: L/H coil switching scheme


ht

1: Mecha-gear scheme (Only when 0 is set up at bit 0)


ig

* Bit 1 is valid only when bit 0 = 0.


yr

Spindle speed range changing method, in


relation to switching the torque factors for
op

auto-pecking of the cutting load detection


C

SA45 type 2
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-437
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

00: Shorter route


01: Forward rotation
10: Reverse rotation

Homing direction for synchronous tapping


SA45
(bit 2)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
ts
gh
ri
ll
Homing direction for synchronous tapping

.A
SA45

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

Program type M, E
A
R
04

PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

Defines the specified direction as the Z-phase detection direction.


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Defines the specified direction as the


Z-phase detection direction.
K

SA45
ZA

(bit 4)
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: Invalid
ht

1: Valid
ig
yr
op

Spindle index gear correction


C

SA45
(bit 5)

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-438
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Valid

Selection of spindle removal


SA45
(bit 6)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions After stop of movement

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
ts
76543210

gh
Direction of orientation

ri
00: Shorter route

ll
01: Forward rotation

.A
10: Reverse rotation

N
C-axis position control changeover type

O
00: After return to zero point

TI
01: After deceleration stop
16

A Synchronous tapping position control changeover


R
04

type
PO
30

0: After return to zero point



R

1: After deceleration stop


o.

O
N

SA46 Z-phase detection direction


al

0: Forward rotation
K
ri

ZA

1: Reverse rotation
Se

C-axis homing direction


IM

00: Shorter route


01: Forward rotation
K

10: Reverse rotation


ZA

Synchronous tapping command polarity


A

0: Reverse rotation
M

1: Forward rotation
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions After stop of movement


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range Binary, eight digits


(c
ht

76543210
ig
yr
op

0: Ignoring the spindle/motor gear ratio


— 1: Considering the spindle/motor gear ratio
C

SA47

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-439
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Specify the encoder signal input destination.


0: Via the HDLC-connected axis (Spindle AMP feedback data)
1: Direct connection to encoder 1 (ENC1)
2: Direct connection to encoder 2 (ENC2)
Encoder signal input destination

SA48

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 2

ts
Set the speed attainment detection width. If a value other than 1-99 (%) is

gh
set, the value will be regarded as 15 (%).

ri
ll
.A
Speed attainment detection width

N
SA49

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit %
N

Setting range 0 to 99
al

K
ri

Specify the type of spindle corresponding to the displayed SA parameters,


ZA
Se

by the appropriate numeric value.


A

0: Axis not specified


IM

1: No. 1 milling spindle


Spindle type 2: No. 1 turning spindle
K

3: No. 2 milling spindle


ZA

SA50 4: No. 2 turning spindle


A

5: No. 3 milling spindle


M

6: No. 3 turning spindle


YA

7: No. 4 milling spindle


Program type M, E 8: No. 4 turning spindle
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 8
ht

Set the number of gears on the spindle.


ig

1. For displaying [GEAR SELECT] in the manual operation mode


yr

0, 5 to 8: Without gear
op

1: 2 gear positions (without neutral)


C

Number of gears on spindle


2: 2 gear positions (with neutral)
SA51 3: 3 gear positions (with neutral)
4: 4 gear positions (with neutral)
2. For automatic gear selection with the MAZATROL program (only for
Program type M, E milling spindle)

Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 8

2-440
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

0: Type not set.


1: C-axis type
2: Orientation type

Turning spindle type

SA52

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 2

ts
Set the 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for the L coils of the spindle motor.

gh
Note :

ri
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known

ll
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.

.A
type If coil selection is not possible for the spindle, enter the same value
in both SA53 and SA54. An alarm will result if 0 is entered even in

N
— L coils
SA53 either one of the two parameters.

O
TI
2. If bit 1 in SA45 is set to 1, set the 1/4h rated torque applied when
16

A
the spindle motor gear position is 1.
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.1 N·m


N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

Set the 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for the H coils of the spindle motor.
ZA
Se

Note :
A
IM

Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
K

type If coil selection is not possible for the spindle, enter the same value
ZA

— H coils in both SA53 and SA54. An alarm will result if 0 is entered even in
SA54 either one of the two parameters.
A
M

2. If bit 1 in SA45 is set to 1, set the 1/4h rated torque applied when
the spindle motor gear position is 2.
YA

Program type M
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1 N·m


(c

Setting range 0 to 65535


ht

Set the 1/4h rated torque applied when the spindle motor gear position is
ig

3.
yr

Note :
op

Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for


auto-pecking of the cutting load detection 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
C

type for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
— Spindle gear position 3 2. This parameter is valid only when the setting of bit 1 in SA45 is 1.
SA55

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.1 N·m
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-441
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the 1/4h rated torque applied when the spindle motor gear position is
4.
Note :
Spindle 1/4h (1/2h) rated torque for
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection 1. Only the 1/2h rated torque, not the 1/4h rated torque, may be known
type for the particular motor. If that is the case, set the 1/2h rated torque.
— Spindle gear position 4 2. This parameter is valid only when the setting of bit 1 in SA45 is 1.
SA56

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.1 N·m

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-442
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

If the “fms” value depends on spindle speeds, specify the gradient.

Example :

Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for If “fms” is 90000 for an “S” value of 5000 and 140000 for S10000:
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection
type — Range 1 fms
SA57 140000 Gradient = b/a
b
90000
a
Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit — 5000 10000 S

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Since “cms” = (140000 – 90000) / (10000 – 5000) = 10, set “10” in the

gh
above example.

ri
Note :
Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for

ll
Set the spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” when SA45 bit 0 = 1.

.A
auto-pecking of the cutting load detection (Enter, moreover, 1000 times the respective calculation results in this
type — Range 2

N
case.)
SA58

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for


auto-pecking of the cutting load detection
K

type — Range 3
ZA

SA59
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op

Spindle viscous friction coefficient “cms” for


C

auto-pecking of the cutting load detection


type — Range 4
SA60

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range ±99999999

2-443
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the value where the width of the flat section in the current feedback
data matches estimated data.

Example :
Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms”
for auto-pecking of the cutting load If “fms” is 90000 for an “S” value of 5000 and 140000 for S10000, set “c”
detection type — Range 1 in L105.
SA61 fms

140000 Gradient = 10
b
Program type M

.
90000

d
a

ve
Conditions Immediate c

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range ±99999999 5000 10000 S

ts
gh
Calculate “c” form the linear equation “y = (b/a) x + c”. Since “c” = 90000

ri
Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” – (10 × 5000) = 40000, set “40000” in the above example.

ll
.A
for auto-pecking of the cutting load Note :
detection type — Range 2

N
Set the spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms” when SA45 bit 0 = 1.
SA62

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms”


for auto-pecking of the cutting load
K

detection type — Range 3


ZA

SA63
A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht
ig
yr
op

Spindle coulombic friction coefficient “fms”


C

for auto-pecking of the cutting load


detection type — Range 4
SA64

Program type M
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range ±99999999

2-444
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the filter for the data which has been sampled at 3.5-ms intervals.
If the entered value is “0”, the data actually used will be 4 × 3.5 (ms).

Cutting force calculation filter for


auto-pecking of the cutting load detection
type
SA65

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 3.5 ms

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
If the rotational speed of the milling spindle during polygonal machining

gh
exceeds the setting of this parameter, that rotational speed will be
clamped at this setting.

ri
Also, if the rotational speed of the milling spindle during hobbing exceeds

ll
Maximum permissible speed of milling

.A
the setting of this parameter, that rotational speed will be clamped at this
spindle for polygonal/hobbing machining setting.

N
SA66 Note : This parameter is valid only for the milling spindle.

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

–1
O

Unit min
N

Setting range 0 to 999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Rotational speed in the following spindle Output


A

output diagrams: (kW)


IM

P3 P4 P5
 MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT
P1 P2
 MACHINING
K

SA67
ZA

NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P6
to  Monitoring Functions
A
M

SA73  POSITION P0
YA

Speed
Program type M, E (min–1)
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

–1
Unit min Cross axis: speed Vertical axis: output
Point –1
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999 (Unit: min ) (Unit: 1/100 kW)


ht

P0 SA67 SA74
P1 SA68 SA75
ig

Output in the following spindle output


yr

diagrams: P2 SA69 SA76


op

 MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT P3 SA70 SA77


C

 MACHINING P4 SA71 SA78


SA74 NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P5 SA72 SA79
to  Monitoring Functions P6 SA73 SA80
SA80  POSITION
Note :
Program type M, E Whether to specify these values for an output diagram at short-time
rating or at continuous rating depends on the specifications of the
Conditions Immediate model.
Unit 0.01 kW
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-445
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the spindle limit speed at which the time constant for the spindle
position control is to be changed
Spindle limit speed selection for spindle
position control time constants [Spindle speed]
SA81: Limit speed 1
SA81 SA82: Limit speed 2
to SA83: Limit speed 3 Max. spindle
speed
SA83

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on SA83

er
–1
Unit min

s
SA82

re
Setting range 0 to 999999
SA81

ts
gh
[Time]

ri
Spindle position control time constants 0

ll
SA84
SA84: Time constant 1

.A
SA84 SA85: Time constant 2
SA85

N
SA86: Time constant 3
to

O
TI
SA86 SA86
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit ms
O
N

Setting range 0 to 9999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Revolutions
A
IM

Spindle speed operating time constant


SA9
changeover revolutions
SA88
K

SA87: Revolutions 1
ZA

SA87 SA88: Revolutions 2 SA87


A

SA88
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate SA89 Time


–1
)2

Unit min SA90


SA91
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999


Note :
ht
ig

For gears 2 to 8, SA87 or SA88 is internally converted to calculate the


yr

changeover revolutions.
Spindle speed operating time constant
op

SA89: Time constant 1


C

SA10 to 16
SA89 SA90: Time constant 2
SA88 × (SA10 to 16/SA9)
SA91: Time constant 3
to SA87 × (SA10 to 16/SA9)
SA91

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit ms
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-446
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the maximum revolutions for conducting Z-phase detection.

Z-phase detection speed

SA92

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
–1
Unit min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999

ts
Set the amount of shifting from the Z-phase when the axis is to be

gh
returned to its zero point for synchronous tapping.

ri
Shifting is conducted in the Z-phase detection direction (specified in bit 4
of SA46).

ll
Amount of synchronous tapping zero point

.A
shifting

N
SA93

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit °
N

Setting range 0 to 359


al

K
ri

Set the homing speed effective when “After return to zero point” (SA46 bit
ZA
Se

2 = 0) is selected as the position-changing type for synchronous tapping.


A
IM

Homing speed for synchronous tapping


K
ZA

SA94
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

–1
Unit min
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999


ht

Set the manual operation mode maximum revolutions.


ig
yr
op

Maximum revolutions in manual operation


C

mode

SA95

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999

2-447
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the amount of shifting from the zero point of orientation control.

Amount of orientation position shifting

SA96

Program type M, E

.
Conditions Immediate

d
ve
Unit 0.00005°

er
Setting range ±7200000

s
re
The synchronous tapping time constant for high-speed synchronous

ts
tapping is reduced with respect to the synchronous tapping time constant

gh
set in parameter SA33 to SA40. The value set in SA97 becomes the
reduction ratio.

ri
Reduction ratio of the synchronous tapping
time constant for high-speed synchronous Without the high-speed synchronous tapping option or for the axis

ll
.A
tapping combination that does not allow high-speed synchronous tapping, normal
SA97 synchronous tapping is applied, in which case the data setting of SA33 to

N
SA40 is used as it is.

O
TI
High-speed synchronous tapping time constant
16

Program type M, E
A = SA33 × (100 – SA97)/100
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit %
R
o.

Setting range 0 to 100


N

Set the time constant for orientation control.


al

K
ri

ZA

If 0 is set, 300 will be regarded as having been specified.


Se

A
IM

Orientation time constant


K

SA99
ZA
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
3
01

Unit ms
)2

Setting range 0 to 30000


(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-448
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Rotational speed in the following spindle Output


output diagrams at continuous rating: (kW)
P3 P4 P5
 MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT
P1 P2
 MACHINING
SA100 NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P6
to  Monitoring Functions
SA106  POSITION P0
Speed
Program type M, E (min–1)

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
–1
Unit min Cross axis: speed Vertical axis: output

s
Point –1

re
Setting range 0 to 999999 (Unit: min ) (Unit: 1/100 kW)
P0 SA100 SA107

ts
Output in the following spindle output P1 SA101 SA108

gh
diagrams at continuous rating: P2 SA102 SA109

ri
 MACHINING NAVIGATION-RESULT P3 SA103 SA110

ll
.A
 MACHINING P4 SA104 SA111
SA107 NAVIGATION-PPEDICTION P5 SA105 SA112

N
to  P6 SA106 SA113

O
Monitoring Functions

TI
SA113  POSITION
16

Note : A
R
04

Program type M, E 1. Set values for spindle output diagrams at continuous rating.
PO
30

Conditions Immediate 2. This parameter is valid for models that allow you to switch between
R

load meter ratings on the POSITION display.


o.

Unit 0.01 kW
O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

Set the spindle speed to be monitored in safety supervisory mode 2.


ri

ZA
Se

If the operating speed of the spindle exceeds the set value in safety
A

supervisory mode 2, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and bring
IM

the machine to an emergency stop.


Spindle speed supervisory mode 2 for
K

safety supervision
ZA

SA114
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


–1
)2

Unit min
(c

Setting range 0 to 999999


ht

Set the spindle speed to be monitored in safety supervisory mode 3.


ig

If the operating speed of the spindle exceeds the set value in safety
yr

supervisory mode 3, this will cause a safety supervisory alarm and bring
op

the machine to an emergency stop.


Spindle speed supervisory mode 3 for
C

Assign a value greater than the speed value to be monitored in mode 2


safety supervision
(i.e., specified in SA114).
SA115

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
–1
Unit min
Setting range 0 to 999999

2-449
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the spindle safety clamping speed to be monitored in safety


supervisory mode 2.
In safety supervisory mode 2 and while a safety clamping request is in
effect, the spindle is decelerated to the set speed.
Spindle safety clamping mode 2 for safety
Assign a value smaller than the speed value to be monitored in mode 2
supervision
(i.e., specified in SA114).
SA116

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
–1
Unit min

s
re
Setting range 0 to 999999

ts
Set the spindle safety clamping speed to be monitored in safety

gh
supervisory mode 3.

ri
In safety supervisory mode 3 and while a safety clamping request is in
effect, the spindle is decelerated to the set speed.

ll
Spindle safety clamping mode 3 for safety

.A
Assign a value smaller than the speed value to be monitored in mode 3
supervision
(i.e., specified in SA115).

N
SA117

O
Assign a value greater than the speed value to be monitored in mode 2

TI
(i.e., specified in SA116).
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

–1
O

Unit min
N

Setting range 0 to 999999


al

K
ri

Select the door group to which the spindle belongs in safety supervisory
ZA
Se

mode.
A

If SP129: SFNC9/bit F is OFF, speed monitoring will not be conducted,


IM

irrespective of the setting of this parameter.


Selecting the spindle door of the spindle
K

[Examples of setting]
whose speed is to be monitored
ZA

0000: The spindle does not belong to any door.


SA118 0001: The spindle belongs to the door-1 group.
A

0002: The spindle belongs to the door-2 group.


M

0003: The spindle belongs to the door-1/2 group.


YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

For safety speed clamping in safety supervisory mode, when a claming


ig

request is input, a clamping signal will be output after the spindle has
yr

decelerated to a safety clamping speed. This parameter specifies to what


op

additional percentage of the safety clamping speed the spindle is to be


Deceleration judgment coefficient on safety
decelerated as the output timing of the speed clamping signal.
C

speed clamping of the spindle to be


supervised for safety If 0 is set, the speed clamping signal will be output when the spindle
SA119 decelerates to a 10% additional speed (i.e., 110% of the safety clamping
speed).

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit %
Setting range 0 to 100

2-450
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the number of PLG teeth per revolution.


If a value less than zero is set, 1024 will be regarded as having been set.

PLG pulse rate for spindle index gear tooth


correction

SA120

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit Teeth

s
re
Setting range –99999999 to 99999999

ts
Amount of branching point correction for Set the amount of correction at the branching point where one PLG gear

gh
spindle index gear tooth tooth is split into eight equal segments.

ri
SA121: Branching point [1]
SA122: Branching point [2]

ll
.A
SA123: Branching point [3]
SA121 SA124: Branching point [4]

N
SA125: Branching point [5]
to

O
SA126: Branching point [6]

TI
SA128 SA127: Branching point [7]
16

SA128: Branching point [8]


A
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.0001°
N

Setting range –99999999 to 99999999


al

K
ri

ZA

Set the notch filter frequency for the cutting-load detection pecking cycle.
Se

A
IM

Notch filter frequency for cutting-load


detection pecking cycle
K
ZA

SA129: #1 notch filter frequency


SA129 SA131: #2 notch filter frequency
A

SA131
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.1 Hz
(c

Setting range 0 to 65535


ht

Set the notch filter depth to be used in the cutting-load detection pecking
ig

cycle.
yr
op

Notch filter depth for cutting-load detection


pecking cycle
C

SA130: #1 notch filter depth


SA130 SA132: #2 notch filter depth
SA132

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 7

2-451
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Set the detection torque to be used when the breakage detection distance
(l) is specified for the cutting-load detection pecking cycle.

Breakage detection torque for cutting-load


detection pecking cycle

SA133

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.01 Nm

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
Set the maximum spindle orientation speed.

gh
Note :

ri
1. Some other functions (such as safety speed clamping control based

ll
on a PLC ladder) may cause the spindle orientation speed to be

.A
Maximum spindle orientation speed clamped at a speed lower than the setting of this parameter.

N
2. Immediately after power-on, the Z-phase is detected, so the spindle
SA134

O
is oriented at the maximum speed specified in parameter SA92, not

TI
SA134.
16

A
3. Clamping based on this parameter will be invalid if the setting is 0.
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

–1
O

Unit min
N

Setting range 0 to 999999


al

K
ri

Set which door signal is input for the axis with door signal input on the
ZA
Se

drive side (spindle) in safety supervisory mode.


A

1: Door 1 signal
IM

Selection of a door for signal input on the 2: Door 2 signal


drive side (spindle) in safety supervisory
K

4: Door 3 signal
mode
ZA

SA136 8: Door 4 signal


A
M
YA

Program type M
3

Conditions Immediate
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0 to 255


(c
ht

Set the number of gears.


ig

0 : No gears
yr

1 or more : Actual number of gears


op

Number of gears
C

SA138: Number of spindle gears


SA138 SA139: Number of motor gears

SA139

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-452
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Sets the turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side.

Turret indexing gear ratio at the motor side

SA140

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit —

s
(Only for MULTIPLEX)

re
Setting range 1 to 199

ts
When the C-axis position control changeover type is set “after

gh
deceleration stop” (parameter SA46 bit 2 = 1)

ri
0: No initial zero-point return

ll
1: Initial zero-point return
Initial C-axis position control changeover

.A
with deceleration to stop setting

N
SA142

O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Spindle speed with stepless spindle gear (parameter SA51 = 0)


ZA
Se

0: Clamp at the speed specified for SA17


A
IM

1: Clamp at the maximum speed specified for SA17 to SA20


Spindle speed clamp selection with
K

stepless spindle gear


ZA

SA142
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Set whether or not to wait spindle orientation completion at the start of


ig

high-speed synchronous tapping.


yr

0: Do not wait
op

Waiting for phase compensation completion 1: Wait


C

at the start of high-speed synchronous


tapping
SA143
(bit 1)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-453
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

When the orient command is given during spindle rotation


0: Hold the spindle speed at the time of the orient command.
1: Accelerate the spindle speed up to the maximum speed for orientation.
Spindle speed for the orient command
given during spindle rotation
SA143
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Fixed value

ts
gh
ri
ll

.A
SA143

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range —
C
al

Fixed value
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


K

SA143
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c
ht

Fixed value
ig
yr
op


C

SA143
(bit 6)

Program type —
Conditions —
Unit —
Setting range —

2-454
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

0: Include
1: Do not include

Warning check for alarm 67 HI-SPEED


SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM (for spindle
C-axis)
SA144
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

.d
Conditions Immediate

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
0: Spindle cycle counter increase

ts
gh
1: Spindle cycle counter decrease

ri
ll
Encoder polarity for the spindle rotation for

.A
normal thread cutting
SA144

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

Gear conversion during spindle rotation valid


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Gear conversion during spindle rotation


valid
K

SA144
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Spindle gear changeover valid


ht
ig
yr
op

Spindle gear changeover valid


C

SA144
(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-455
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Turret indexing valid

Turret indexing valid


SA144
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range 0, 1

re
Sets the spindle speed limit for selecting a time constant dedicated to

ts
quasi constant inclination control in hobbing II (position controlled

gh
hobbing), and the value for the time constant.

ri
ll
[Spindle speed]

.A
Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing),
Spindle speed limit for time constant

N
SA224 selection 1 to 3 for quasi constant

O
inclination control Maximum

TI
SA225 spindle speed
16

SA226 A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

Program type E SA226


O
N

Conditions Immediate
al

–1
Unit min
ri

SA225
ZA
Se

Setting range 0 to 999999 SA224


A
IM

0
K

[Time]
SA227
ZA
A

Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing),


M

Time constant 1 to 3 for quasi constant SA228


YA

SA227 inclination control


SA228
3
01

SA229
)2

SA229
(c

*1 This parameter is valid only when K259 bit 1 = 1.


ht

Program type E
ig

*2 When all of parameters SA224 to SA229 are 0, parameters SA81 to


Conditions Immediate
yr

SA86 are used.


op

Unit ms
C

Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-456
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title SPINDLE

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value

SA242

Program type —

d.
Conditions —

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range —

re
Used to select whether the alarms 1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM

ts
ALARM3 and 82 SPINDLE WARNING are to be displayed or not.

gh
0: Displayed

ri
1: Not displayed

ll
Smart safety monitoring alarm (for spindle)

.A
SA243

N
O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

Fixed value
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM


SA244
K
ZA

(bit 0)
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type —
Conditions —
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-457
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-17 Machine parameter BARRIER (BA)

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of chuck outside diameter of the No. 1 turning spindle

Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier)


— No. 1 turning spindle

BA1 BA1

d .
ve
Program type M, E

er
NM211-00312
Conditions Immediate

s
re
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

ts
Setting range 0 to 99999999

gh
Setting of chuck width of the No. 1 turning spindle

ri
ll
.A
BA2

N
Chuck width (for chuck barrier)

O
— No. 1 turning spindle

TI
BA2
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
R
o.

Conditions Immediate
N

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


al

NM211-00313
ri

ZA

Setting range 0 to 99999999


Se

Setting of chuck inside diameter of the No. 1 turning spindle


A
IM
K
ZA

Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier)


— No. 1 turning spindle
A
M

BA3 BA3
YA
3
01

Program type M, E
)2

Conditions Immediate
NM211-00314
(c

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


ht

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ig

Specify the workpiece outside diameter to be used for the EIA program.
yr
op
C

EIA program workpiece outside diameter

BA4 BA4

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in BA17

Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-458
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of chuck outside diameter of the No. 2 turning spindle

Chuck outside diameter (for chuck barrier)


— No. 2 turning spindle

BA5 BA5

Program type M, E NM211-00312

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate Note :

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in For single turning-spindle specifications, this parameter is invalid.

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Setting of chuck width of the No. 2 turning spindle

gh
ri
ll
Chuck width (for chuck barrier)

.A
— No. 2 turning spindle

N
BA6

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

BA6 NM211-00313
30

Conditions Immediate
R

Note :
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


N

For single turning-spindle specifications, this parameter is invalid.


C

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

Setting of chuck inside diameter of the No. 2 turning spindle


ZA
Se

A
IM

Chuck inside diameter (for chuck barrier)


K

— No. 2 turning spindle


ZA

BA7 BA7
A
M
YA

Program type M, E NM211-00314


3
01

Conditions Immediate
Note :
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in For single turning-spindle specifications, this parameter is invalid.
(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht

Setting of tail body outside diameter


ig
yr
op
C

Tail body outside diameter (for tail barrier) BA8

BA8

NM211-00315
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-459
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of tail body length

BA9

Tail body length (for tail barrier)

BA9

Program type M, E

d .
NM211-00316

ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Setting of tail spindle outside diameter

gh
ri
ll
Tail spindle outside diameter

.A
(for tail barrier) BA10

N
BA10

O
TI
16

A NM211-00317
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

Setting of length with tail spindle at back end


ZA
Se

BA11
IM

Length with tail spindle at back end


K

(for tail barrier)


ZA

BA11
A
M
YA

NM211-00318
Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht

Setting of tail head outside diameter


ig
yr
op

Tail head outside diameter


C

(for tail barrier) BA12

BA12

NM211-00319
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-460
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of tail head length

BA13

Tail head length


(for tail barrier)

BA13

Program type M, E NM211-00320

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Setting of tail head taper angle

gh
ri
ll
Tail head taper angle

.A
BA14
(for tail barrier)

N
BA14

O
TI
16

A NM211-00321
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001°
N

Setting range 0 to 180000


al

K
ri

Setting of biting diameter when tail head is used


ZA
Se

A
IM

Tail head biting diameter


K

BA15
(for tail barrier)
ZA

BA15
A

Workpiece zero point


M
YA

NM211-00322
Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-461
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the dimensional data for forming tail barriers using an EIA/ISO
program.
<During tail operation>

BA17 BA16

.d
EIA tail barrier <During tail reversing>

ve
BA16 Tail dimensions

s er
to

re
BA18 Machine

ts
zero point BA18

gh
ri
ll
.A
BA16: Tail extruding length

N
BA17: Workpiece length (Note 2)

O
BA18: Distance from the machine zero point to the leading edge

TI
position during tail reversing
16

Program type E Note :


A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate 1. ±999999999 for BA18.


30

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in 2. BA17 is valid for MAZATROL programs as well, when ONLY MILL
R
o.

Setting range 0 to 99999999 (Note 1) is specified for the common unit of the MAZATROL program.
N

C
al

Specify the distance from the machine zero point of the Z-axis to the edge
K
ri

of the No. 1 turning spindle.


ZA
Se

BA19
Distance from the Z-axis machine zero
IM

point to the spindle edge


— No. 1 turning spindle Machine zero point
K
ZA

BA19
A

Spindle
M

edge
YA

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note :
3
01

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Enter the distance with minus sign for the machine zero point in the
minus direction with respect to the spindle edge.
)2

Setting range ±99999999


(c

Specify the distance from the machine zero point of the Z-axis to the edge
ht

of the No. 2 turning spindle.


ig
yr

BA20
Distance from the Z-axis machine zero
op

point to the spindle edge


C

— No. 2 turning spindle Machine zero point


BA20
Spindle
edge
Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate Note :
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Enter the distance with minus sign for the machine zero point in the
minus direction with respect to the spindle edge.
Setting range ±99999999

2-462
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Specify the jaw number that has been registered on the CHUCK JAW
DATA display to be referred to in the EIA program when forming a jaw
barrier for the No. 1 turning spindle.

Jaw number for EIA program barrier


— No. 1 turning spindle

BA21

Program type E

d.
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 1 to 44

ts
Specify the jaw number that has been registered on the CHUCK JAW

gh
DATA display to be referred to in the EIA program when forming a jaw
barrier for the No. 2 turning spindle.

ri
ll
Jaw number for EIA program barrier

.A
— No. 2 turning spindle

N
BA22

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 1 to 44
al

K
ri

Set the turret dimensions for the turret-type tool post.


ZA
Se

BA24
A
IM

Turret dimensions
K
ZA

BA23
A

BA24 BA23
M
YA

BA23: Outside diameter of the turret


Program type E BA24: Width of the turret
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht

Specify the turret reference position from the machine zero point for the
ig

turret-type tool post.


yr

Turret
op

reference BA26
position
C

Turret reference position


BA25
BA26 BA25

Program type E BA25: Turret reference position X


Machine
Conditions Immediate zero point BA26: Turret reference position Z
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-463
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of tool holder mounting position. When plus data is used, the tool
holder is mounted horizontally, and minus data downward.
Tool holder mounting position Example : Type 1
BA27 - Type 1 Turret reference positon
BA27 BA30 - Type 2
BA33 - Type 3 BA27 (> 0)
BA30
BA36 - Type 4
BA33
BA36
Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate BA27 (< 0) NM211-00327’

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
Same for types 2, 3, 4

re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Setting tool holder width in X-axis direction

gh
Example : Type 1

ri
Tool holder width in X-axis direction Turret reference position

ll
BA28 - Type 1

.A
BA28 BA31 - Type 2
BA34 - Type 3

N
BA31
BA37 - Type 4

O
BA34

TI
BA28
16

BA37 A (where BA27 < 0)


R
04

Program type M BA28


PO
30

(where BA27 > 0)


Conditions Immediate
R

NM211-00328’
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


N

Same for types 2, 3, 4


Setting range 0 to 99999999
al

K
ri

Setting of tool holder width in Z-axis direction


ZA
Se

Example : Type 1
A

Tool holder width in Z-axis direction Turret reference position


IM

BA29 - Type 1
BA29
K

BA32 - Type 2
ZA

BA32 BA35 - Type 3


BA38 - Type 4
A

BA35
M

BA38
YA

Program type M
3

BA29 BA29
01

Conditions Immediate (where BA27 < 0)


(where BA27 > 0)
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in NM211-00329’


Same for types 2, 3, 4
(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-464
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the holder shape data for forming tool barriers using an EIA/ISO
program.

<Holder-under type>
Input BA39 with a minus sign.

BA40

d.
BA39

ve
er
BA41
EIA tool barrier

s
re
BA39 Holder dimensions

ts
to <Holder-side type (0° type)> <Holder-side type (180° type)>

gh
BA41 Input BA39 with a plus sign. Input BA39 with a plus sign.

ri
Input BA41 with a plus sign. Input BA41 with a minus sign.

ll
.A
BA39 BA39

N
O
BA40 BA40

TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

BA41 BA41
R
o.

O
N

Program type E BA39: EIA tool barrier, Holder mounting position


C
al

Conditions Immediate BA40: EIA tool barrier, X-axial width of the holder
K
ri

BA41: EIA tool barrier, Z-axial width of the holder


ZA

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


Se

Setting range ±99999999 (Note) Note : 0 to 99999999 for BA40.


IM

Select the type of barrier to be made valid.


K

0: Type with head B-axis (tool rotational B-axis) [INTEGREX type]


ZA

1: Type without head B-axis (tool rotational B-axis)


A
M

Barrier type
YA

BA42
3
01
)2

Program type M, E
(c

Conditions Immediate
ht

Unit —
ig
yr

Setting range 0 to 99999999


op
C

2-465
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the first tool number assigned to the first set of tools.

First tool number (in the 1st set of tools)

BA43

Program type M, E

. d
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 1 to 4000

ts
Set the number of tools assigned as the first set of tools.

gh
ri
ll
.A
Number of tools (in the 1st set of tools)

N
BA44

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 1 to 960


al

K
ri

Set the first tool number assigned to the second set of tools.
ZA
Se

A
IM

First tool number (in the 2nd set of tools)


K
ZA

BA45
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 1 to 4000


ht

Set the number of tools assigned as the second set of tools.


ig
yr
op
C

Number of tools (in the 2nd set of tools)

BA46

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 1 to 960

2-466
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the turret type.


0: ATC
1: Turret
2: Lower turret
Turret type
3: Opposed turret
BA47 4: Steady rest
5: Laser head type

Program type M, E Setting a value outside the setting range causes the alarm 1417

d .
PARAMETER ERROR.

ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 5

ts
Set the axis name of the head axis to be rotated.

gh
Set “&42” if the head axis to be rotated is the B-axis.

ri
ll
.A
Axis name of the head to be rotated

N
BA48

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range &41 to &5A


al

Set the axis number of the Y-axis to be controlled using inclined-axis


ri

ZA
Se

control functions.
A

The inclined-axis control is invalid when this parameter is set to 0.


IM

Axis number of the inclined axis


K

(Inclined-axis control)
ZA

BA49
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At power on
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 16
ht

Set the axis number of the X-axis to be controlled using inclined-axis


ig

control functions.
yr

The inclined-axis control is invalid when this parameter is set to 0.


op

Fundamental axis number


C

(Inclined-axis control)

BA50

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16

2-467
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Specify one of the vectors created by the triangles formed by inclination


angles.
BA51: Vector of the inclined axis (virtual Y) in the rectangular
coordinate system
Vector of virtual Y
BA52: Vector of the fundamental axis (X-axis) corresponding to the
(Inclined-axis control)
inclined axis
BA51 BA53: Vector of the real axis corresponding to the inclined axis
X
Y

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At power on BA51
BA52

er
Unit —

s
Yt

re
Setting range ±99999999 BA53

ts
gh
Set the value of BA51/BA52 assuming that 10000000 is assigned to

ri
BA53.

ll
Vector of real X

.A
(Inclined-axis control)

N
BA52

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At power on
R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Vector of real Y
K

(Inclined-axis control)
ZA

BA53
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At power on
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

Set the axis number of the work spindle to be used for hobbing.
ig

The hobbing is invalid when this parameter is set to 0.


yr
op
C

Selection of work spindle for hobbing

BA54

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 16

2-468
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the turning spindle to be used in the D1 command mode of polygonal


machining.
0: Turning spindle No. 1
1: Turning spindle No. 2
Turning spindle number for polygonal 2: Turning spindle No. 3
machining (D1) 3: Turning spindle No. 4
BA55 –1: Invalid

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range –1 to 3

ts
Set the turning spindle to be used in the D2 command mode of polygonal

gh
machining.

ri
0: Turning spindle No. 1
1: Turning spindle No. 2

ll
Turning spindle number for polygonal

.A
2: Turning spindle No. 3
machining (D2) 3: Turning spindle No. 4

N
BA56 –1: Invalid

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range –1 to 3
al

K
ri

Set the turning spindle to be used in the D3 command mode of polygonal


ZA
Se

machining.
A

0: Turning spindle No. 1


IM

1: Turning spindle No. 2


Turning spindle number for polygonal 2: Turning spindle No. 3
K

machining (D3) 3: Turning spindle No. 4


ZA

BA57 –1: Invalid


A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range –1 to 3
ht

Set the turning spindle to be used in the D4 command mode of polygonal


ig

machining.
yr

0: Turning spindle No. 1


op

1: Turning spindle No. 2


Turning spindle number for polygonal
C

2: Turning spindle No. 3


machining (D4) 3: Turning spindle No. 4
BA58 –1: Invalid

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range –1 to 3

2-469
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

 If the command block of G284/G288 (machining G-codes, F30 = 0) or


of G84/G88 (turning G-codes, F30 = 1) does not contain spindle
forward/reverse rotation M-codes, one of the following M-codes will be
output, depending on the status of bit 0 in parameter SU153:
Spindle forward rotation M-code for tapping
BA59 = 3 BA59 = 203
cycle
BA60 = 4 BA60 = 204
BA59 0 Tapping cycle of turning Tapping cycle of milling
SU153
Bit 0 Inverse tapping cycle of Inverse tapping cycle of
1
turning milling
Program type M, E

.
 If 0 is set in BA59, 3 will be regarded as having been set, and M03 will

d
ve
Conditions Immediate be output.

er
Unit —  If 0 is set in BA60, 4 will be regarded as having been set, and M04 will

s
be output.

re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
gh
ri
ll
Spindle reverse rotation M-code for tapping

.A
cycle

N
BA60

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Enter the distance from the rotational center of the B-axis to the tool
ZA
Se

center.
A

B-axis rotational center


IM

Amount of runout of the B-axis center


K
ZA

BA61
BA61
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
Note :
3
01

Conditions Immediate Enter the distance with a minus sign for B-axis rotational center above
)2

Unit 0.001 mm the tool center position.


(c

Setting range –1000 to 1000


ht

Enter the distance from the rotational center of the B-axis to the spindle
ig

edge.
yr

B-axis rotational center


op

Amount of offset for the B-axis — spindle


C

distance

BA62

Program type M, E
BA62
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
Setting range ±99999999

2-470
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the holder angle of the angle tool holder.


According to the value set in this parameter, the holder angle is set in
HLD.TYPE on the TOOL DATA display.
BA63 = 45
Holder angle of angle tool holder

BA63

.
Program type M

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
HLD.TYP: 45 HLD.TYP: 45
Unit °

s
(BA63 = 45) (180 – BA63 = 135)

re
Setting range 0 to 90

ts
gh
Upper turret

ri
BA65
machine zero point

ll
.A
B-axis tool reference position X

N
BA64

O
BA64

TI
16

A Upper turret
R
04

PO

Program type M, E
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


N

Setting range ±99999999 B-axis tool reference position


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K

B-axis tool reference position Z


ZA

BA65
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

Set the deceleration area and measuring area in the G37 command.
ig

BA66: Set the distance between the starting point of movement at the
yr

measuring rate, and the measuring point. This value will be used
op

when argument R is omitted from the G37 command.


G37 deceleration area
C

G37 measuring area BA67: Set the moving distance in measuring feed mode. This value will
be used when argument D is omitted from the G37 command.
BA66
BA67

Program type E
Conditions After stop of movement
0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Unit
±99999999
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-471
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the deceleration area and measuring area in the G36 command.
BA68: Set the distance between the starting point of movement at the
measuring rate, and the measuring point. This value will be used
when argument R is omitted from the G36 command.
G36 deceleration area
BA69: Set the moving distance in measuring feed mode. This value will
G36 measuring area
be used when argument D is omitted from the G36 command.
BA68
BA69

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Unit

s
re
±99999999

ts
Setting range 0 to 99999999

gh
 Workpiece zero point:

ri
Workpiece edge center

ll
 Tool position reference point:

.A
Reference point on the turret

N
 Turret clearance:

O
Distance between the reference points on both turrets (radius value)

TI
 Workpiece offset:
16

A
Workpiece zero point – Reference point of reference turret tool
R
04

Distance between the reference points on position


PO
30

both turrets (radius value)  Tool position:


R

Tool position reference point – Tool nose position


o.

BA70
O
N

<Schematic diagram>
C
al

Tool position
K
ri

ZA
Se

Work offset
IM

Turret clearance
K

(BA70)
ZA

Program type M, E
Workpiece zero point
A

Conditions Immediate
M

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in Tool position


YA

Setting range 0 to 99999999


3
01

0: System 1
1: System 2
)2

2: System 3
(c

3: System 4
ht

System number to be used when argument


L is omitted from G112
ig
yr

BA71
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0 to 3

2-472
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the overriding value for retracting the tap.


Tap retracting feed = [Programmed feed for the interrupted synchronous
tapping] × BA72/100
BA72 is processed as 100 (%) when the setting is equal to zero (0) or
Feed override for retracting the tap greater than 100.

BA72

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit %

s
re
Setting range 0 to 100

ts
0: Chuck, sub-chuck and tailstock invalid

gh
1: Chuck valid

ri
2: Sub-chuck valid

ll
Barrier valid/invalid 1 3: Tailstock valid

.A
(chuck, sub-chuck, tailstock)

N
BA73

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 3
al

K
ri

0: Lower turret and steady rest invalid


ZA
Se

1: Lower turret valid


A
IM

2: Steady rest valid


Barrier valid/invalid 2
K

(Lower turret, steady rest)


ZA

BA74
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-473
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the reference position when it is viewed from the machine zero point.

BA19 (#1) Upper turret machine


BA65 (#1)
zero point

BA77
BA75 (#1) BA64
(#1) (#1)
Upper turret BA78
BA92 (#1)
(#1)
Barrier setup turret reference position X1
BA75

d .
ve
to BA76 (#1)
Z1

er
B-axis tool reference position
BA78

s
Lower turret/Steady rest

re
BA78

ts
BA92 Z2 (#2)
(#2)

gh
BA76

ri
X2 BA75 BA77 (#2)
(#2) (#2)

ll
.A
Program type M, E
BA19 (#2)

N
Lower turret/Steady rest
Conditions Immediate machine zero point

O
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

TI
16

Setting range ±99999999 A


R
04

Set the reference position 1 of the chucks with respect to the machine
PO
30

zero point of the upper turret.


R

Use J109 to J112 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 1.
o.

O
N

Upper turret machine zero point


C

Barrier setup chuck reference position 1


al

BA79
ri

ZA

to
Se

BA79 BA81 BA79 BA81


A

(#1) (#1) (#2) (#2)


BA82
IM

BA82
(#2)
K

Program type M, E
BA82 (#1)
ZA

Conditions Immediate
A

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in BA80 (#1) BA80


M

(#2)
Setting range ±99999999
YA

Set the chuck reference position 2 to be used to set barrier around jaws
3

for a program without jaw No. setting.


01

Use J113 to J116 for machines with the No. 2 spindle set as System 1.
)2

Upper turret machine zero point


(c

Barrier setup chuck reference position 2


BA83
ht

BA83 BA85
BA83 BA85 (#2) (#2)
ig

to (#1) (#1)
yr

BA86
BA86 BA86 (#1) (#2)
op
C

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
BA84 (#1) BA84
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in (#2)
Setting range ±99999999

2-474
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the reference position for barrier area of a powered tailstock.


Use coordinates with respect to the machine zero point of the upper turret
to set the position of the tailstock being not used for machining.
When the tailstock is used, the barrier will be provided at the position
shifted through the distance of R10366 (lower-order)/R10367
(higher-order) in the Z-axis direction, from the position specified above.
For machines with multiple systems use only parameters for System 1.

Upper turret machine


Barrier reference position for a powered zero point
BA87 tailstock

d .
ve
to

er
BA90 BA87 BA89

s
(#1) (#1)

re
ts
BA88

gh
(#1)

ri
ll
BA90

.A
Program type M, E (#1)

N
Conditions Immediate

O
R10366 (lower-order)
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

TI
R10367 (higher-order)
16

Setting range ±99999999 A


R
04

Set the reference position of the partition plate.


PO
30

Machine zero point


R
o.

BA91
N

Distance from spindle edge to partition (System 1)


al

plate
ri

ZA

BA91
Se

Machine zero Partition


IM

point plate
K

Program type M, E
ZA

Conditions Immediate
BA91
A

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in (System 3)


M

Setting range ±99999999


YA

Set the central position X when viewed from the machine zero point.
3
01

Upper turret (HD1)


machine zero point
)2

Central position X when viewed from


(c

machine zero point


X1
ht

(Barrier function) BA92


BA92 (HD1)
ig

Z1
yr
op
C

Program type M, E
BA92 Z2
Conditions Immediate
(HD2)
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in X2 Lower turret (HD2)
machine zero point
Setting range —

2-475
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

When using the C-axes of the HD1/HD2 in the lower turret system, set the
offset angle with respect to the upper turret, for the lower turret system.
<HD1> <HD2>
BA93: Upper/lower turret tool angle
difference (HD1)
BA94: Upper/lower turret tool angle
BA93 difference (HD2)
BA93
BA93 BA94
BA94
BA94 XX XX
YY CC CC YY

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001°

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Use BA95 and BA96 to set the dimensions of the sensor for tool nose

gh
measurement.
BA97 and BA99 are provided to set in machine coordinates the reference

ri
point of the sensor (see the diagram below).

ll
.A
Example :
1. For horizontal type

N
O
Machine zero point

TI
16

A
R
04

BA95: Sensor width along the X-axis


PO
30

BA96: Sensor width along the Z-axis


BA97: X-coordinate of the sensor’s
R
o.

BA97
O

reference point
N

Sensor’s
C

BA99: Z-coordinate of the sensor’s


reference point
al

BA95
K

reference point
BA99
ri

ZA

BA96
Se

BA103: Sensor width along the X-axis


A

BA97 (for lower turret/HD2) BA95


IM

BA104: Sensor width along the Z-axis


BA99 Sensor for tool nose
(for lower turret/HD2)
K

BA100 BA100: X-coordinate of the sensor’s measurement


ZA

BA102 reference point BA96


A

(for lower turret/HD2)


BA103
M

BA102: Z-coordinate of the sensor’s 2. For vertical type


YA

BA104 reference point


Machine
(for lower turret/HD2) zero point
3
01
)2
(c

BA99
ht
ig

Sensor’s
reference point
yr

BA97
op
C

BA99
Program type M
Sensor for tool nose
Conditions Immediate
measurement
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in
BA95
Setting range ±99999999

2-476
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Setting of sensor reference point Y coordinate

BA98: Y-coordinate of the sensor’s


B98 Machine zero point
reference point
BA101: Y-coordinate of the sensor’s
reference point
BA98
(for lower turret/HD2)
BA101

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in

s
re
Setting range ±99999999

ts
Set adjustment “FdT” for holding the thrust of the servo axis.

gh
Set a value less than BA108 × BA106/100.

ri
If any other value is set, the thrust may be unstable.

ll
.A
Adjustment “FdT” for servo axis thrust hold

N
BA105

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions After stop of movement


R
o.

Unit 0.0005 mm/0.000005 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

Set the dead zone for the drooping level of the servo axis thrust.
ZA
Se

A drooping level change less than BA108 × BA106/100 is ignored.


A
IM

Dead zone
K
ZA

BA106
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions After stop of movement


)2

Unit %
(c

Setting range 0 to 99999999


ht

Set the monitoring time for changes in the drooping level of the servo axis
ig

thrust.
yr
op
C

Filter

BA107

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit 1/3.5 ms
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-477
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the drooping level for holding the servo axis thrust.
This drooping level is held during the application of the servo axis thrust.

Servo axis thrust hold droop

BA108

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions After stop of movement

er
Unit 0.00005 mm

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Specify the axis offset amount applied during automatic calculation of the

gh
tool setting value for the backface tool, which is difficult to measure using
the TOOL EYE. This automatic calculation is done based on the tool

ri
setting value for the target tool measured in the opposite position.

ll
Offset amount (X) during automatic tool

.A
setting value calculation

N
BA109

O
Reference workpiece

TI
zero point
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

Turret center - TOOL


30

Conditions Immediate SET Z of the target tool


R
o.

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


O
N

Setting range ±99999999


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Distance to the turret center (parameter)


A
IM

Offset amount (Z) during automatic tool TOOL SET X = Tool setting value X for target tool + Parameter for offset
K

setting value calculation amount X


ZA

BA110 TOOL SET Z = (Parameter for distance to center of turret × (–1) × 2)


A

– Tool setting value Z for target tool + Parameter for offset


M

amount Z
YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions Immediate
01
)2

Unit 0.0001 mm/0.00001 in


(c

Setting range ±99999999


ht

Pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration Set the pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant for a time
ig

time constant for time constant changeover constant changeover M-code command.
yr

M-code command If zero is assigned to this parameter, the pre-interpolation


op

BA111: For M881 command acceleration/deceleration time constant will not be changed, even when a
time constant changeover M-code command is assigned. The
C

BA112: For M882 command


BA111 BA113: For M883 command pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration time constant existing before
to BA114: For M884 command the time constant changeover M-code command is assigned will be held.

BA116 BA115: For M885 command


BA116: For M886 command

Program type M, E
Conditions After stop of movement
Unit mm/min
Setting range 0 to 999999

2-478
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the outside diameter and width for the turret which is to be indicated
on the VIRTUAL MACHINING display.

BA118
Outside diameter of the turret for Virtual
Machining

BA117 BA117

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
Width of the turret for Virtual Machining

N
BA118

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


O
N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

0: Head 1
ZA
Se

1: Head 2
A

2: Head 1/2
IM

Selecting a head having a lower-turret


K

TOOL EYE
ZA

BA119
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Set the X-axis position of mounting the HOLDER part of an assembly tool
ig

model.
yr

Machine
op

zero point
Mounting position X for an assembly tool
C

model
BA120
BA120

Assembly tool model


Program type M, E mounting position
Conditions Immediate
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in
Setting range 0 to 99999999

2-479
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the Z-axis position of mounting the HOLDER part of an assembly tool
model.
BA121
Machine
Mounting position Z for an assembly tool zero point
model

BA121

Assembly tool model


Program type M, E

.
mounting position

d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in

s
re
Setting range 0 to 99999999

ts
Specify the turret reference position from the machine zero point for the

gh
turret-type tool post (for VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D MONITOR display).

ri
Turret BA123
For VIRTUAL MACHINING or 3D

ll
reference

.A
MONITOR display position
Turret reference position

N
BA122

O
BA123 BA122

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO

BA122: Turret reference position X


30

Machine
Conditions Immediate zero point BA123: Turret reference position Z
R
o.

Unit 0.001 mm/0.0001 in


N

Setting range 0 to 99999999


al

K
ri

Fixed value (0)


ZA
Se

A
IM
K


ZA

BA124
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-480
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Set the types of tailstock, tool holder and chuck for which the EIA barriers
are to be activated.

76543210

Tailstock usage valid/invalid (Note 1)


0: Invalid
1: Valid
Tailstock present/absent (Note 2)
0: Absent
1: Present

d .
Tool holder present/absent

ve
0: Absent

er
1: Present

s
re
Barrier tool nose position

ts
0: Tool length correction

gh
1: Current tool nose
EIA barrier activation

ri
Setting of BA11 is handled as tailstock extruding

ll
length
BA125

.A
Execution of spindle revolution M-code specified in

N
same block as synchronous tapping

O
0: Invalid

TI
1: Valid
16

A
R
04

Barrier cancellation check (see Note 3)


PO

0: Valid
30

1: Invalid
R
o.

Missing jaw number check (see Note 3)


N

0: Valid
al

1: Invalid
ri

ZA

Note :
Se

1. “Tailstock usage invalid” does not mean canceling the tail barriers; it
IM

means that the tail will move away prior to machining.


2. Bit 1 in this parameter is valid for the MAZATROL program as well.
K

If bit 1 is set to 0, the tailstock function itself will become invalid. For
ZA

Program type E
a machine having a tailstock, be sure to set up 1 at bit 1.
A

Conditions Immediate
3. Valid only for MAZATROL programs.
M

Unit —
YA

Setting range Binary, eight digits


3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-481
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

76543210
System to be made valid without system selection
for queuing
Y-axis interference type
0: Type A 1: Type B
Y-axis moving range display
0: Invalid 1: Valid
Tool command scheme (Note)
0: M06 required. 1: M06 not required.

.
FLASH tool valid/invalid

d
ve
0: Invalid 1: Valid

er
Milling spindle orientation command (M219)

s
0: Output 1: No output
BA126

re
System without turret

ts
gh
Shape of the tailstock center for Virtual Machining

ri
0: Single stage 1: Twin stage

ll
Note :

.A
T-command operation is defined as follows by the setting of bit 3:

N
 If the setting of bit 3 is 0

O
TTM6: Replaces the current tool with  and indexes  as the

TI
16

next tool.
A
TM6: Replaces the current tool with .
R
04

Program type E T: Indexes  as the next tool.


PO
30

Conditions Immediate  If the setting of bit 3 is 1


R
o.

Unit — T: Replaces the current tool with  and set  as the tool
O
N

offset number.
C

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

76543210
ri

ZA
Se

M249 command for preparing for tool change


A

before moving the tool to the tool change position


IM

using a MAZATROL program


0: No output 1: Output
K
ZA

For programs of Z-offset scheme: Fixed value (1)


For other programs: Invalid
A
M

Simultaneous output of TTM6M200 and


YA

TTM6M202
0: No simultaneous output
3

— 1: Simultaneous output
01

NC tailstock (servo axis thrust control)


)2

BA127 0: Invalid 1: Valid


(c

M90/M91 output for machines with turret


ht

(for QTN II series)


ig

0: Output 1: No output
yr

Type of the clamping and unclamping M-codes that


op

the NC automatically output for machines


equipped with a spindle head of swiveling type.
C

0: M-codes for machine tools of composite


machining
1: M-codes for machining centers
Program type M (Bit 3, 7: M, E)
Whether or not to read the current settings
Immediate
Conditions (tailstock position) on the SET UP MANAG. display
(Bit 3: After stop of movement)
at the beginning of the execution of each program
Unit — 0: No 1: Yes
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-482
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

NC tailstock pushing direction


0: Negative direction
1: Positive direction

NC tailstock pushing direction


BA128
(bit 0)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Method of automatic determination of the virtual nose point for tool

gh
measuring unit (TOOL EYE)

ri
0: Determined according to the machining section, direction of rotation
and orientation (left/right hand) in the tool data

ll
.A
* If measurement is carried out at a B-axis angle other than that used for
actual machining, the measurement result will not be correct because

N
the virtual nose point that is automatically determined for measurement

O
TI
according to the machining section, direction of rotation and orientation
16

(left/right hand) of the tool will not agree with the virtual nose point of the
A
actual tool.
R
04

PO
30

Example: Correct Incorrect


measurement measurement
R
o.

Machining
O

TOOL EYE TOOL EYE


N

section: O.D.
C

measurement measurement
Left hand
pattern #1 pattern #3
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Method of automatic determination of the


virtual nose point for tool measuring unit
K

BA128
ZA

Tool nose point Tool nose points agree


(bit 1)
A
M
YA

1: Determined from the measurement pattern (TOOL EYE #1 to #4)


* The measurement result will not be correct if the virtual nose point that is
3

automatically determined for measurement (with TOOL EYE) from the


01

measurement pattern does not agree with the virtual nose point that is
)2

automatically determined according to the machining section, direction


(c

of rotation and orientation (left/right hand) of the tool.


ht

Example: Correct Correct


measurement measurement
ig

Machining
yr

TOOL EYE TOOL EYE


section: O.D. measurement measurement
op

Left hand pattern #1 pattern #3


C

Tool nose
points agree

Program type M
Conditions Immediate Tool nose point Tool nose points agree

Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-483
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the first set
of tool data (BA43, BA44)
0: Valid
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for 1: Invalid
the AFC function in the first set of tool data
(BA43, BA44)
BA128
(bit 2)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for the AFC function in the

gh
second set of tool data (BA45, BA46)

ri
0: Valid
Display of THRUST F. and HORSE PW for

ll
1: Invalid
the AFC function in the second set of tool

.A
data (BA45, BA46)
BA128

N
O
(bit 3)

TI
16

Program type M
A
R
04

PO

Conditions Immediate
30

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

0: Invalid
K
ri

ZA

1: Valid
Se

A
IM

Turret lathe with an ATC unit


K

BA128
ZA

(bit 6)
A
M
YA

Program type E
Conditions Immediate
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

Display of [TURRET UNCLAMP] for machines with an ATC-type turret


ht

0: Invalid
ig

1: Valid
yr

Display/No display of [TURRET


op

UNCLAMP] for machines with ATC-type Note : Setting of bit 7 is valid only for machines without lower turret.
C

turret
BA128
(bit 7)

Program type E
Conditions At pwer on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-484
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

0: Not output
1: Output

Output of tool change preparation M code


(M109/M249) when executing tool change
BA129
(bit 0)

Program type M

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Fixed value

gh
ri
ll
.A

N
BA129

O
(bit 1)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type —
PO
30

Conditions —
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

Select the inclination to be used for fixed G0 inclination control (option) in


ZA
Se

the G68/G68.5 mode when parameter M1 (rapid feed rate) and parameter
A

N1 (rapid-feed time constant) are used.


IM

0: Uses the minimum inclination among the actual axes after G68/G68.5
Fixed G0 inclination control in the conversion.
K

G68/G68.5 mode
ZA

BA129 1: Uses the minimum inclination among the virtual axes before
G68/G68.5 conversion. (*)
A

(bit 2)
M
YA

* If the move command specifies one axis, the inclination of the specified
Program type M, E axis is used.
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

Select whether or not to measure the milling tool length with the tool
ig

measuring unit.
yr

0: When a milling tool is selected, its length is not be measured and the
op

Selection of whether or not to measure the alarm 714 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA is raised.
C

milling tool length with the tool measuring 1: The tool length is measured.
unit
BA129 When BA129 bit 3 is 0, no measurement is performed on models in which
parameters are set as described below.
(bit 3)
 BA47 = 0 (turret type: ATC)
 BA48 = &42 (axis of the head to be rotated: B)
Program type M
 K52 = 0
Conditions Immediate Note :
Unit — For INTEGREX i with a workpiece hand, even if BA129 bit 3 is 0, the
Setting range 0, 1 length of a milling tool can be measured.

2-485
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Display of [BARRIER CANCEL] with [BARRIER CANCEL TEACH]


selected

0: Not displayed
Display of [BARRIER CANCEL] with 1: Displayed
[BARRIER CANCEL TEACH] selected
BA129
(bit 4)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
0: Drop the fractional portion.

gh
1: Do not drop the fractional portion.

ri
Handling of measurement speed of 1 in/min

ll
or higher during laser tool length/diameter Examples of measurement speed during the execution of this

.A
measurement with inch-specification measurement are given below.

N
BA129 machines BA129 (bit 5)

O
(bit 5)

TI
Set speed 0 1
16

A
Example (1) 0.9 in/min 0.9 in/min 0.9 in/min
R
04

Program type M, E Example (2) 1.1 in/min 1.0 in/min 1.1 in/min
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

Fixed value
ZA
Se

A
IM


K
ZA

BA130
A

(bit 1)
M
YA

Program type —
3

Conditions —
01
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Multi-magazine number indication on the POSITION display


ig

0: Not set
yr

1: Set
op

Multi-magazine number display


C

BA131
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-486
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification MACHINE Display title BARRIER

Address Meaning Description

Sets the axis number of the axis to be used as the hobbing axis in hobbing
II operation for each system.

Hobbing II (position controlled hobbing)


Hobbing axis allocation

BA241

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 31

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-487
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-18 Data I/O parameter CMT parameter (CMT)

Classification DATA I/O Display title CMT

Meaning Description

Baud rate for RS-232C interface

Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200

d .
2400

ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions At I/O startup

s
Unit —

re
Setting range 110 to 19200

ts
gh
Type of processing to be executed if the machining program of an existing
work number is to be loaded

ri
ll
.A
SAME WNo. Set values Description

N
Issues an alarm if the work number

O
ALARM
already exists.

TI
16

A LOAD
Overrides the program if the work
R
04

Program type M, E number already exists.


PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range —
al

CMT port selection


ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Set values Description


PORT
K

COM1 RS232C conversion connector


ZA

COM2 RS232C conversion connector


A

COM3 RS232C conversion connector


M

COM4 RS232C conversion connector


YA

Program type M, E
3

Conditions At I/O startup


01

Unit —
)2

Setting range —
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-488
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title CMT

Address Meaning Description

Invalid


CMT1
to
CMT32

Program type —

.
d
ve
Conditions —

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-489
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

2-3-19 Data I/O parameter TAPE parameter (TAP)

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Meaning Description

Baud rate for RS-232C interface

Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200

d .
2400

ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions At I/O startup

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 110 to 19200

gh
Number of data bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)

ri
ll
Set values

.A
DATA BITS

N
7

O
TI
8
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
R

Conditions At I/O startup


o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 7, 8
K
ri

ZA

Parity check (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


Se

A
IM

Set values
K

PARITY
ZA

NONE
A

ODD
M

EVEN
YA
3

Program type M, E
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Number of stop bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


ig
yr
op

Set values
C

STOP BITS
1
1.5
2

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —

2-490
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Meaning Description

This parameter is used to select the method of handshaking to control the


state of data transfer between the NC system and connected device.

Set values Description


HAND SHAKE
NONE No control
DC CONTROL Complies with control code DC1 through
DC4
RTS/CTS Complies with device connection RTS/CTS.

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range —

ts
The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or

gh
outputting.

ri
An alarm occurs if this time elapses following the final reply.

ll
.A
WAIT TIME

N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit 0.1 s
N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

ZA

Selection of paper tape puncher output code


Se

Set values Description


IM

ISO Paper tape punching in ISO code


K

FORMAT
EIA Paper tape punching in EIA code
ZA

ASCII Paper tape punching in ASCII code


A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Type of processing to be executed if the machining program of an existing


ig

work number is to be loaded


yr
op

Set values Description


C

SAME WNo. Issues an alarm if the received work


ALARM
number already exists.
Overrides the program if the received
LOAD
work number already exists.

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —

2-491
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Meaning Description

Tape port selection

Set
values Data I/O Tape operation

RS232C RS232C
PORT COM1
conversion connector conversion connector
RS232C RS232C
COM2
conversion connector conversion connector
RS232C RS232C
COM3
conversion connector conversion connector

d .
ve
RS232C RS232C
Program type M, E COM4
conversion connector

er
conversion connector
Conditions At I/O startup

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range —

gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-492
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

Set values Terminator


0 Without terminator
Type of terminator 1 EOB or EOR
2 EOB only
TAP1
3 EOR only
4 One character of your choice
Program type M, E 5 Two characters of your choice

d.
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 5

ts
Effective only when TAP1 is set to 4 or 5.

gh
ri
ll
.A
Terminator code 1

N
TAP2

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

ZA

Effective only when TAP1 is set to 5.


Se

A
IM
K

Terminator code 2
ZA

TAP3
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

This parameter is used to specify whether or not CR is to be placed in


ig

front of LF (separation of blocks) during ISO code punching.


yr

0: No placement of CR
op

1: Placement of CR
C

Output of CR during ISO code punching

TAP4

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-493
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

This parameter is used to specify whether or not a parity bit is to be


assigned to the DC code to be output.
Set values Parity Hole-punching pattern of DC3 code

DC code parity
0 No assignment    
1 Assignment     
TAP5
Note :
This parameter is valid only when HAND SHAKE is set to DC
Program type M, E CONTROL.

. d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Select whether or not DC2 and DC4 codes are to be output to the feed

gh
sections which will be generated at the beginning and end of paper tape
punching.

ri
Example : :

ll
.A
Feed EOR (Significant EOR Feed

N
information)

O
Feed section DC code output

TI
DC2 DC4
16

TAP6
A
R
04

Set values Description


PO
30

0 Neither DC2 nor DC4 is output.


R
o.

1 Only DC2 is output.


N

2 Only DC4 is output.


al

Program type M, E
ri

3 Both DC2 and DC4 are output.


ZA
Se

Conditions At I/O startup


A

Note :
IM

Unit — This parameter is valid only when HAND SHAKE is set to DC


Setting range 0 to 3 CONTROL.
K
ZA

Select whether or not DSR flow control is valid for serial communication
during tape operation.
A

0: Valid
M

1: Invalid
YA

DSR output flow control selection


3

Note :
01

TAP7
This parameter setting is enabled when the cycle start button is pressed
)2

to start tape operation.


(c
ht

Program type M, E
ig

Conditions Immediate
yr

Unit —
op
C

Setting range 0, 1

2-494
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


code “[” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.

“[” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
“[” code
TAP9

Program type M, E Set value

d.
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit — (0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(1 × 22)+(0 × 21)+(0 × 20) = 76

s
MPL068

re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character

gh
code “]” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.

ri
ll
“]” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched

.A
EIA

N
“]” code
TAP10

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E Set value


PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

(0 × 27)+(0 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(1 × 22)+(0 × 21)+(1 × 20)=13


O

Unit —
N

MPL069
C

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

ZA

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


Se

code “#” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.


A

Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.


IM

“#” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
K

EIA
ZA

“#” code
TAP11
A
M
YA

Program type M, E Set value


3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


(0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(1 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(1 × 22)+(0 × 21)+(1 × 20)=109
)2

Unit —
MPL070
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


ig

code “” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.


yr

Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.


op

Example : : Hole to be punched


C

“” code for paper tape reader/puncher for


EIA
“” code
TAP12

Program type M, E Set value


Conditions At I/O startup
(0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(1 × 25)+(1 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(0 × 20)=122
Unit —
MPL071
Setting range 0 to 255

2-495
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


code “=” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.

“=” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
“=” code
TAP13

Program type M, E Set value

d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup
(0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(1 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(1 × 20)= 91

er
Unit —
MPL072

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character

gh
code “:” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.
Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.

ri
ll
Example : : Hole to be punched
“:” code for paper tape reader/puncher for

.A
EIA

N
“ : “ code
TAP14

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E Set value


PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R

(0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(0 × 23)+(1 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(0 × 20)=70


o.

Unit —
N

MPL073
C

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

ZA

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


Se

code “(” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.


A

Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.


IM

Example : : Hole to be punched


“(” code for paper tape reader/puncher for
K

EIA
ZA

“(“ code
TAP15
A
M
YA

Program type M, E Set value


3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


(0 × 27)+(0 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(1 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(0 × 20)=26
)2

Unit —
MPL074
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

This parameter is used to set a hole-punching pattern for the character


ig

code “)” onto a paper tape reader/puncher using EIA.


yr

Set an eight-digit binary number in decimal form.


op
C

“)” code for paper tape reader/puncher for Example : : Hole to be punched
EIA
TAP16 “)” code

Program type M, E
Set value
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit — (0 × 27)+(1 × 26)+(0 × 25)+(0 × 24)+(1 × 23)+(0 × 22)+(1 × 21)+(0 × 20)=74
Setting range 0 to 255 MPL075

2-496
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

76543210

Paper tape puncher parity-V check

TAP25 0: No parity-V check during paper tape


reading
1: Parity-V check during paper tape reading

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range Binary, eight digits

ts
0: Tape loading impossible

gh
1: Tape loading possible

ri
ll
Data transfer of a paper tape program

.A
which has been punched by M2
TAP26

N
O
(bit 0)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

0: All programs and various NC data


ri

ZA
Se

1: All programs only


A
IM

Types of data to be punched onto paper


tape during all punching
K

TAP26
ZA

(bit 1)
A
M
YA

Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: Valid
ht

1: Invalid
ig
yr
op

Input/output of the program name during


paper tape reading/punching
C

TAP26
(bit 2)

Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-497
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

0: 8 digits
1: 4 digits

Number of digits of work No. output


TAP26
(bit 3)

Program type E

. d
Conditions At I/O startup

ve
Unit —

s er
Setting range 0, 1

re
0: Output of ASCII data in hexadecimal notation

ts
gh
1: Output in characters

ri
Input/output of material data during

ll
.A
punching/reading
TAP26

N
O
(bit 4)

TI
16

Program type E
A
R
04

PO

Conditions At I/O startup


30

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

0: Do not add
K
ri

ZA

1: Add
Se

A
IM

Setup data to add when outputting an


EIA/ISO program through tape I/O
K

TAP26
ZA

(bit 5)
A
M
YA

Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-498
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

76543210
To specify whether or not M99 is to be set as the
program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end
1: Not set as program end
To specify whether or not M02 is to be set as the
program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end
1: Not set as program end

.
To specify whether or not M30 is to be set as the

d
ve
Bit parameter related to program end code program end code in reading of paper tape
0: Set as program end

er
(M) for paper tape reader
1: Not set as program end

s
re
TAP27 To recognize the code “O” (or “:”) as the program

ts
end in reading of multiple programs (on one paper

gh
tape)
0: Yes

ri
1: No

ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
O
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

The number of characters in NULL (feed) that are to be punched at the


ri

ZA

beginning and end of paper tape


Se

Example :
IM

Number of characters in feed section for TAP29 characters TAP29 characters


K

paper tape puncher


ZA

(Significant
Feed EOR information) EOR Feed
TAP29
A
M
YA

Tape setting position End of punching


Program type E
MPL078
3

Conditions At I/O startup


01
)2

Unit Character
(c

Setting range 0 to 65535


ht

The total number of space-characters that are punched out between


ig

O-number and program section.


yr
op

Number of characters in the space between


C

O-number and program for paper tape Program


O 1 2 3 4 SP SP SP  SP CR
puncher section

TAP30
TAP30 characters
MPL079
Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit Character
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-499
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title TAPE

Address Meaning Description

The total number of space-characters that are punched out between


programs when more than one program are punched onto paper tape.

Number of characters in the space between


programs for paper tape puncher  M 0 2 CR SP SP  SP CR O 1 2 3 4 

TAP31
Program TAP31 characters Program

Program type E MPL080

d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit Character

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-500
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-20 Data I/O parameter DNC parameter (DNC)

Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Meaning Description

Baud rate for RS-232C interface

Set values
BAUDRATE
110 4800
300 9600
1200 19200

d .
2400

ve
Program type M, E

er
Conditions At I/O startup

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 110 to 19200

gh
Number of data bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)

ri
ll
Set values

.A
DATA BITS

N
7

O
TI
8
16

A
R
04

PO
30

Program type E
R

Conditions At I/O startup


o.

O
N

Unit —
C
al

Setting range 7, 8
K
ri

ZA

Parity check (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


Se

A
IM

Set values
K

PARITY
ZA

NONE
A

ODD
M

EVEN
YA
3

Program type E
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Number of stop bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


ig
yr
op

Set values
C

STOP BITS 1
1.5
2

Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range —

2-501
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Meaning Description

The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or
outputting.
An alarm occurs if this time elapses following the final reply.

WAIT TIME

Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit 0.1 s

s
re
Setting range 0 to 65535

ts
Type of processing to be executed if the machining program of an existing

gh
work number is to be loaded

ri
ll
Set values Description

.A
SAME WNo. Issues an alarm if the received work
ALARM

N
number already exists.

O
Overrides the program if the received

TI
LOAD
work number already exists.
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range —
al

K
ri

ZA

DNC port selection


Se

A
IM

Set values Description


K

RS232C
PORT COM1
ZA

conversion connector
RS232C
A

COM2
M

conversion connector
YA

RS232C
COM3
conversion connector
3

RS232C
01

Program type E COM4


conversion connector
)2

Conditions At I/O startup


(c

Unit —
ht

Setting range —
ig
yr
op
C

2-502
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

Set values Terminator


0 Without terminator

Type of terminator 1 EOB or EOR


2 EOB only
DNC1 3 EOR only
4 One character of your choice
5 Two characters of your choice
Program type E

d .
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 5

ts
Effective only when DNC1 is set to 4 or 5.

gh
ri
ll
.A
Terminator code 1

N
DNC2

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 255


al

K
ri

ZA

Effective only when DNC1 is set to 5.


Se

A
IM
K

Terminator code 2
ZA

DNC3
A
M
YA

Program type E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

This parameter is used to specify whether or not a parity bit is to be


ig

assigned to the DC code to be output.


yr
op

Set values Parity Hole-punching pattern of DC3 code


C

DC code parity
0 No assignment    
DNC5 1 Assignment     

Program type E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-503
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

This parameter is used to set the number of times that the  code or TEXT
is to be repeatedly transmitted to a host system in case that the @ code is
not sent from the host system within the waiting time which has been set
at WAIT TIME.
Number of NC transmission retries during
HOST NC
DNC file transfer
Retransmitted if @
 is not received.
DNC9
@
An alarm occurs if the
TEXT transmission operation is
Program type M, E

.
repeated up to the number of

d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup @ times set with this parameter.

er
Unit Number of times EOT MPL081

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
This parameter is used to set the number of times that the @ code is to be

gh
repeatedly transmitted to a host system in the case that the EOT-code or
TEXT from the host system is not received within the waiting time which

ri
has been set at WAIT TIME.

ll
Number of NC reception retries during DNC

.A
HOST NC
file transfer

N
 Initialized if EOT or

O
TEXT is not received.
DNC10

TI
@
16

A An alarm occurs if the


R
04

Program type M, E TEX transmission operation is


PO
30

repeated up to the number of


Conditions At I/O startup times set with this parameter.
R

@
o.

Unit Number of times MPL082


N

EOT
Setting range 0 to 255
al

K
ri

ZA

This parameter is used to set the number of times that


Se

transmission/reception of command messages is to be repeated in the


A

case that it is not correctly performed.


IM

Number of NC transmission/reception This parameter has almost the same meaning as that of parameters
DNC9 and DNC10, except that command messages are interchanged in
K

retries during DNC command message


ZA

transfer the case of DNC11 and files are interchanged in the case of DNC9 and
DNC10.
A

DNC11
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit Number of times


(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

The NC waiting time from transmission of  or TEXT to reception of @


ig

from the host system.


yr

HOST NC
op


@ waiting time during DNC
C

DNC12
transmission
@

DNC12 TEXT
DNC12
@
Program type M, E
EOT
Conditions At I/O startup MPL083

Unit 0.1 s
( DNC9)
Setting range 0 to 255

2-504
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

The NC waiting time from transmission of @ or reception of EOT to


reception of  or TEXT from the host system.
HOST NC

“”, TEXT waiting time during DNC
transmission @
DNC13
TEXT
DNC13 @
EOT
DNC13

.
Program type M, E

d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup @
TEXT MPL084

er
Unit 0.1 s

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255 ( DNC10)

ts
The NC waiting time from transmission of @ to reception of EOT from the

gh
host system.

ri
HOST NC

ll
.A
EOT waiting time during DNC
transmission @

N
O
DNC14 TEXT

TI
16

A @
R
04

DNC14
PO

Program type M, E
30

EOT
Conditions At I/O startup MPL085
R
o.

Unit 0.1 s
N

( DNC10)
Setting range 0 to 255
al

K
ri

ZA

The NC stop time from reception of ! from the host system to transmission
Se

of .
A
IM

HOST NC

K

NC stop time after reception of !


ZA

!
DNC15
A

DNC15 
M

MPL086
YA

Program type M, E Code  is transmitted to the host system if the time that has been set with
3

DNC15 elapses following reception of !.


01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit 0.1 s
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

The time from the moment the NC receives the digital-out command to the
ig

moment the NC internally resets this command.


yr
op
C

NC reset time after digital-out

DNC16

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 255

2-505
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

[For NC transmission] [For NC reception]


The NC stop time from reception of The NC stop time from reception
@ from the host system to of  or TEXT from the host system
transmission of EOT or TEXT to transmission of @
NC stop time from reception HOST NC HOST NC
* *
DNC17 DNC17
@ @
DNC17
TEXT TEXT
Program type M, E DNC17

d .
@ @

ve
Conditions At I/O startup
DNC17

er
Unit 0.01 s EOT EOT

s
MPL087

re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
The NC waiting time from transmission of command message EOT to

gh
reception of command reply message  from the host system.

ri
HOST NC
*

ll
.A
DNC command reply message waiting time @

N
Command messages
TEX

O
DNC18 @

TI
16

A EOT
DNC18
R
04

Program type M, E *
PO

Command
30

Conditions At I/O startup reply @


R
o.

messages
O

Unit 0.1 s
N

TEXT
C

MPL088
Setting range 0 to 255
al

K
ri

ZA

The numbers to be assigned to various machines in order to manage on


Se

the host system the tool data, parameters etc. that are specific to the
A

machines being used


IM
K

DNC machine number


ZA
A

DNC19
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 255


ht

The NC stop time from reception of EOT from the host system to
ig

transmission of  of the next message


yr

HOST NC
op

*
C

NC transmission stop time of DNC (from


reception to transmission) @

TEXT
DNC20
@

Program type M, E EOT


DNC20
Conditions At I/O startup *
Unit 0.01 s
@ MPL089
Setting range 0 to 255

2-506
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

The NC stop time from transmission of EOT to the host system to


transmission of  of the next message
HOST NC
*
NC transmission stop time of DNC (from
transmission to transmission) @

TEXT
DNC21
@
Program type M, E EOT

d .
DNC21

ve
Conditions At I/O startup *

er
Unit 0.01 s
@

s
MPL090

re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
76543210

gh
Select the type of processing to be executed if
the tool quantity data within the NC memory

ri
mismatches that which has been transferred

ll
from the DNC memory.

.A

0 : Issues an alarm if the tool quantity data

N
mismatches.
DNC25

O
1 : Executes loading forcibly, even if the tool

TI
quantity data mismatches.
16

A Handling of tool data and tool files in the M


R
04

Program type M, E PLUS format


PO
30

0 : Valid
Conditions At I/O startup
R

1 : Invalid
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range Binary, eight digits


al

K
ri

ZA
Se

76543210 (1: Valid, 0: Invalid)


A
IM

1: After program reception, a search is made for


the work number of that program.
K

1: Details of an alarm occurring in DNC are


ZA

displayed.
A

1: Loading of programs having the same work


M

number as that of the registered program in


YA

— NC becomes impossible.
1: The program protect function is released.
3

DNC26
01

1: Three digit G-format and G10 format codes


)2

input/output for MAZAK data transfer protocol


1: Binary to ASCII format input/output of MAZAK
(c

data transfer protocol


ht

1: All programs having work numbers smaller


ig

than No. 9000 are erased at the start of


yr

program reception.
op

Program type M, E Note :


C

Conditions At I/O startup When both bit 5 and bit 6 are set to 1 (enable), this functions for three
digit G-format and G10 format codes input/output.
Unit —
Setting range Binary, eight digits

2-507
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title DNC

Address Meaning Description

0: Interpret 0 for automatic operation and 1 for check. (Setting for


machining centers)
1: Interpret 1 for automatic operation and 2 for check. (Settings for turning
machines)
Interpretation of message for DNC macro
variable transmission
DNC27
(bit 0)

Program type M, E

d .
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
gh
ri
ll
Number of retry times with detection of a

.A
physical error

N
DNC29

O
TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit Number of times


N

Setting range 0 to 65535


al

K
ri

ZA

Select a tool data/tool file message format.


Se

0: M32 scheme
A
IM

1: M Plus scheme
2: M640M scheme
K

Tool data/tool file message format


3: M640M Pro scheme
ZA

DNC30
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 3
ht

Set the time interval from the time the response from the COM port driver
ig

has disappeared, to the time the initialization of the COM port driver is
yr

started.
op
C

Waiting time for a response from the COM


port driver

DNC31

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 65535

2-508
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
2-3-21 Data I/O parameter OTHER (IOP/DPR/IDD)

Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

Handling of TPC data (parameters, relay points) when loading


MAZATROL programs created with the MATRIX series

Handling of TPC data when loading Bit 1 Bit 0 Handling of TPC data
IOP2 programs created with the MATRIX series
0 0 Not loaded
(bit 0) 0 1 Parameters loaded
(bit 1) 1 0 Not loaded

d.
1 1 Parameters and relay points loaded

ve
Program type M

er
Conditions At I/O startup

s
re
Unit —

ts
Setting range 0, 1

gh
Mazak data library function

ri
0: Invalid

ll
.A
1: Valid

N
Mazak data library function

O
IOP4

TI
16

(bit 0) A
R
04

PO
30

Program type M, E
R
o.

Conditions At power on
O
N

Unit —
al

Setting range 0, 1
ri

ZA
Se

0: To output
A

1: Not to output
IM
K

Outputting of Version.txt at saving on the


ZA

DATA I/O display


IOP4
A
M

(bit 1)
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions Immediate
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht

0: Valid
ig
yr

1: Invalid
op
C

Parameter load error prevention function When the function is enabled, a warning window is displayed if loading is
started with a parameter selected on the DATA I/O display.
IOP4
(bit 2)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-509
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

0: TOOL, PART, NOM, ID CODE (+ATTRIB)


1: TOOL, PART, NOM, ID CODE (+ATTRIB), GROUP No.

Overwriting registration judgment criteria


when entering tool data text with machines
allowing registration of multiple tools
IOP4
(bit 3)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
Unit —

s er
Setting range 0, 1

re
Tool count in tool data is checked when loading tool data in binary format.

ts
0: Invalid

gh
1: Valid

ri
Tool data count check during tool data * When tool data does not match the tool count checked during loading,

ll
loading

.A
alarm 505 CANNOT LOAD (MISMATCH) occurs.
IOP5

N
(bit 1)

O
TI
16

Program type M, E A
R
04

Conditions Immediate
PO
30

Unit —
R
o.

Setting range 0, 1
N

Selects how the sign for the start point Z of point machining (XC, XY
al

mode) is treated when the program of the Z offset scheme (MATRIX


ri

ZA

series) is converted into the WPC workpiece scheme program.


Se

Selection of the sign for the start point Z of 0: Does not invert the sign from the set value.
IM

point machining (XC, XY mode) when


1: Inverts the sign from the set value.
loading a Z offset scheme program
IOP5
K
ZA

(bit 2)
A
M

Program type M, E
YA

Conditions At I/O startup


3

Unit —
01

Setting range 0, 1
)2

Overwriting associated with loading of the same work number as that of


(c

the program(s) registered in the NC unit by hard disk, USB, or SD card


ht

input/output.
ig

0: Alarm without overwriting


yr

Overwriting associated with loading of the


program of the same work number 1: Overwriting
op

IOP5
C

(bit 6)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-510
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

Overwriting associated with loading of the tool model of the same name
0: Next tool model loaded without overwriting
1: Overwriting
Overwriting associated with loading of the
tool model of the same name
IOP5
(bit 7)

Program type M, E

d .
Conditions Immediate

ve
Unit —

s er
Setting range 0, 1

re
Appending the text string specified in the setting text file to the end of the

ts
program name at program conversion using the B-axis tilt table

gh
compatible program conversion function or EIA conversion (INTEGREX

ri
IV  INTEGREX i)

ll
0: Do not append

.A
1: Append

N
O
Program name change upon program

TI
* If the resulting program name exceeds 32 characters, the program
conversion
16

name before the conversion will be truncated at its end and then the
A
IOP6 specified text string is appended at the end to bring the length of the
R
04

(bit 1)
PO

program name to 32 characters.


30

* The setting text file for the B-axis tilt table compatible program
R
o.

conversion function is stored in the following location.


O
N

C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\EiaCnvVA2B\eia_cnvva2b_program_name
C

.txt
al

K
ri

* The setting text file for the EIA conversion function (INTEGREX IV 
ZA
Se

Program type M, E INTEGREX i) is stored in the following location.


A

C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\EiaCnvF2I\eia_cnvf2i_program_name.txt
IM

Conditions Immediate
* This parameter is enabled only for the B-axis tilt table specification
Unit — machines and the INTEGREX i Series horizontal multi-tasking
K
ZA

Setting range 0, 1 machines.


A

Specify the serial port number of the NC unit that is to be used for
M

communication with the magazine-side display unit.


YA

Serial port used for communication with the


3
01

magazine-side display unit


IOP7
)2

(bit 0)
(c

(bit 1)
ht
ig

Program type M, E
yr

Conditions At power on
op

Unit —
C

Setting range 0, 1

2-511
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

Fixed value


IOP7
(bit 2)
(bit 3)

Program type —

d .
Conditions —

ve
er
Unit —

s
Setting range —

re
ts
Bit 5 Bit 4 ID amplifier type

gh
0 0 EUCHNER

ri
0 1 BALLUFF

ll
(Magazine-side display unit) ID amplifier

.A
type 1 0 Invalid
IOP7

N
1 1 No ID amplifier
(bit 4)

O
(bit 5)

TI
16

A
Program type
R
M, E
04

PO
30

Conditions At power on
R

Unit —
o.

O
N

Setting range 0, 1
C
al

K
ri

ZA

Bit 7 Bit 6 Tool mounting/removing timing


Se

0 0 Not controlled with PLC


A
IM

(Magazine-side display unit) Tool mounting/ 0 1 Controlled with PLC


removing timing 1 0 Invalid
K

IOP7
ZA

1 1 Invalid
(bit 6)
A

(bit 7)
M
YA

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
3
01

Unit —
)2

Setting range 0, 1
(c

0: Do not clear
ht

1: Clear
ig
yr
op

(Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool


count/time data clear setting
C

IOP8
(bit 0)

Program type M, E
Conditions Immediate
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-512
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

0: Do not clear
1: Clear

(Magazine-side display unit IN/OUT) Tool


life count/time data clear setting
IOP8
(bit 1)

Program type M, E

.
d
ve
Conditions Immediate

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1

ts
Display of [TILT.TBL A->B CONVERT] menu item on the DATA I/O

gh
display

ri
0: Hidden

ll
1: Displayed
B-axis tilt table compatible program

.A
conversion menu

N
IOP8 * Enabled only with B-axis tilt table specification machines.

O
(bit 3)

TI
16

A
R
04

Program type M
PO
30

Conditions Immediate
R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0, 1
al

K
ri

ZA

Fixed value (0)


Se

A
IM
K


ZA

IOP9
A
M
YA

Program type —
3
01

Conditions —
)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range —
ht

Set the connection port number for the Mazak data library function.
ig
yr
op
C

Mazak data library function:


Connection port number

IOP13

Program type M, E
Conditions At power on
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-513
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

0: Invalid
1: Enabled (LAN-RS232C converter required)
11: Enabled (LAN-RS232C converter not required)
MAZA-CARE function
(for the Japanese market only) * When the term of MAZA-CARE contract has expired, the function
cannot be used even if the parameter is made valid.
IOP14

Program type M, E

d.
ve
Conditions At power on

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0, 1, 11

ts
Baud rate for RS-232C interface

gh
Baud rate
Set values Baud rate Set values Baud rate

ri
110 4800

ll
0 110 4 4800

.A
300 9600
1 300 5 9600
1200 19200

N
2 1200 6 19200
DPR1

O
2400

TI
3 2400
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 6
al

K
ri

ZA

Number of stop bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


Se

Stop bit Set values Stop bit


IM

1 0 1
K

1.5 1 1.5
ZA

2 2 2
DPR2
A
M
YA

Program type M, E
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0 to 2
ht

Number of data bits (parameter for RS-232C interface initialization)


ig
yr

Set values
op
C

Data bit Set values Data bit


0 8
DPR4 1 7

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-514
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

This parameter specifies whether “CR” is to be inserted at the beginning


of LF (block delimiter) in ISO code output when the output destination is a
serial port (DPR14 = 2 or 3).
0: No “CR” insertion
ISO code CR output and the output file size 1: “CR” insertion
This parameter specifies the maximum permissible file size to be used for
DPR8 hard disk output using an external output command macro when the
output destination is the hard disk (DPR14 = 4).
Maximum permissible file size: Entered value × 100K bytes
Program type M, E However, this file size is 100K bytes if the entered value is 0.

.
d
ve
Conditions At I/O startup

er
Unit —

s
re
Setting range 0 to 255

ts
This parameter is used to select the method of handshaking to control the

gh
state of data transfer between the NC system and connected device.

ri
Set values Method Description

ll
.A
Method of handshaking 0 None No control

N
1 DC control Complies with control code DC1 through DC4
DPR9

O
TI
2 RTS/CTS Complies with device connection RTS/CTS.
16

A
R
04

Program type M, E
PO
30

Conditions At I/O startup


R
o.

Unit —
N

Setting range 0 to 2
al

K
ri

ZA

This parameter is used to specify whether or not a parity bit is to be


Se

assigned to the DC code to be output.


A
IM

Set values Parity Hole-punching pattern of DC3 code

  
K

DC code parity 0 No assignment 


ZA

DPR10
1 Assignment     
A
M

Note :
YA

This parameter is valid only when the handshaking method is set to DC


Program type M, E control (DPR9 is set to 1).
3
01

Conditions At I/O startup


)2

Unit —
(c

Setting range 0, 1
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-515
Serial No. 300416

2 PARAMETER

Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

Select whether or not DC2 and DC4 codes are to be output to the feed
sections.

Example :
(Significant
Feed EOR EOR Feed
information)

Feed section DC code output DC2 DC4

.
DPR11

d
ve
Set values Description

er
0 Neither DC2 nor DC4 is output.

s
re
1 Only DC2 is output.

ts
2 Only DC4 is output.

gh
3 Both DC2 and DC4 are output.

ri
Program type M, E

ll
Conditions At I/O startup Note :

.A
Unit — This parameter is valid only when the handshaking method is set to DC

N
control (DPR9 is set to 1).

O
Setting range 0 to 3

TI
The waiting time for replies from the connected device during inputting or
16

outputting.
A
R
04

An alarm occurs if this time elapses following the final reply.


PO
30

R
o.

Waiting time
O
N

DPR12
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Program type M, E
Conditions At I/O startup
K
ZA

Unit 0.1 s
Setting range 0 to 65535
A
M

Selection of output code


YA
3

Set values Format Description


01

0 ISO Output in ISO code


)2

Output format
1 EIA Output in EIA code
(c

DPR13
ht
ig
yr

Program type M, E
op
C

Conditions At I/O startup


Unit —
Setting range 0, 1

2-516
Serial No. 300416

PARAMETER 2
Classification DATA I/O Display title OTHER

Address Meaning Description

The port is selected according to the combination of parameters DPR14


and DPR16.

DPR16 DPR14 Port Description


0 0 – Not used
1 – Not used
2 – NC unit SIO CH1

Selection of an output destination port 3 – NC unit SIO CH2


1 0 – Not used

.
DPR14

d
1 – Not used

ve
2 COM3 RS232C conversion connector

s er
3 COM4 RS232C conversion connector

re
ts
When DPR14 = 4, data is output to the hard disk regardless of the DPR16

gh
setting.

ri
Program type M, E

ll
Set values Output destination

.A
Conditions At I/O startup
4 Hard disk (C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_sdg\Print\)
Unit —

N
O
Setting range 0 to 4

TI
16

This parameter denotes the number of characters in NULL (feed) when


A
the output destination is a serial port (DPR14 = 2 or 3).
R
04

PO
30

Example :
R

Number of characters or the number of


o.

DPR15 characters DPR15 characters


O

lines in feed section


N

(Significant
al

DPR15
K

Feed EOR EOR Feed


information)
ri

ZA
Se

This parameter denotes the number of lines fed when the output
IM

Program type M, E destination is a hard disk (DPR14 = 4).


Conditions At I/O startup
K
ZA

Unit Character
A

Setting range 0 to 65535


M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

2-517
2

C
op
PARAMETER

yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 30
K

2-518 E
04
C
O 16
Serial No. 300416

R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
3 ALARM
If machine failures occur or if erroneous operations are carried out, appropriate alarm numbers
and messages will be displayed in the alarm display section of the screen. If alarm display
appears, refer to the alarm list to locate and eliminate the cause of the alarm. More than one
alarm may be raised at once, depending on the particular status of alarm occurring. In the event
of alarm display, therefore, it is highly recommended that the operator should call the
DIAGNOSIS (USER) - ALARM display on the screen and make sure of the type of alarm.

3-1 Outline
1. Scope of this chapter

d .
This chapter describes all the alarms displayed on the screen of NC unit. Always refer to

ve
this chapter for eliminating an alarm.

ser
re
2. Precautions on this chapter
This chapter also lists alarms related to machine model-dependent functions and optional

ts
gh
functions. These alarms may therefore include ones not displayed for your machine. Check

ri
the type of machine purchased by you and its specifications before you read this chapter.

ll
.A
Note 1: The contents of this list are subjected to change without notice, for NC unit or machine

N
improvement.

O
Note 2: Any questions about the contents of this list should be communicated to Mazak
TI
16

Technical Center or Technology Center. A


R
04

PO
30

3-1-1 Alarm display


R
o.

O
N

1. Display on the screen of NC unit


al

K
ri

ZA

An alarm will be displayed on the DIAGNOSIS (USER) - ALARM display in the following format:
Se

650 CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE (1234, 56, 78)


IM
K

Tool sequence number or block number


ZA

Unit number or sequence number


A

Work number
M

Alarm message
YA

Alarm number
3
01

 For the DIAGNOSIS (USER) - ALARM display, refer to Part 3 OPERATING


)2

NC UNIT AND PREPARATION FOR AUTOMATIC OPERATION of the


(c

Operating Manual.
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-1
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-1-2 Precautions
1. If program-related alarm display appears, that portion of the program in which the alarm has
occurred will be displayed within the parentheses next to the alarm message. The meaning
of each code in parentheses on the alarm list is listed in the table below.
Code Meaning
WNo. Work number (MAZATROL or EIA/ISO)
UNo. Unit number (MAZATROL)
SNo. Tool sequence number (MAZATROL)
NNo. Sequence number (EIA/ISO)
BNo. Block number (EIA/ISO)
blank No display, or intra-system alarm processing code

.d
ve
2. The stopped status, clearing procedure, and display color for some types of alarm depend

er
on whether the alarm-encountered program is on the foreground (program selected on the

s
re
POSITION display) or on the background (program selected on the PROGRAM display).

ts
The above mentioned three types of information for the latter case are indicated with

gh
parentheses in the alarm list.

ri
ll
3. The table for an alarm which does not exist remains blank.

.A
4. An alarm may not be displayed for certain machine models or versions of NC-software.

N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-2
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
3-2 Detailed Description

3-2-1 Structure of the alarm list


This alarm list is written in the following format:
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
[1] [2] ( , , ) [3] [4] [5]

Cause [6]

Action [7]

.d
ve
er
[1] Alarm number

s
[2] Alarm message

re
[3] Type of error

ts
gh
Code Type Description

ri
A Operation A wrong key has been pressed. Or the machine has been operated incorrectly.

ll
.A
B Registered data The program or tool data includes an error(s).

N
There are data to be checked, such as on inspection items.

O
C Servo Malfunctioning of the servo control mechanism

TI
16

D Spindle Malfunctioning of the spindle control mechanism


A
R
04

E NC equipment System (hardware/software) error


PO
30

F Machine (PLC) Machine failure


R
o.

G External I/O unit Malfunctioning of external I/O unit


O
N

C
al

[4] Stopped status


K
ri

ZA
Se

Code Status
A
IM

H Emergency stop
I Reset stop
K
ZA

J Single-block stop
K Feed stop (hold)
A
M

L Operation continued
YA

[5] Clearing procedure


3
01

Code Procedure
)2

M Power off  Eliminate cause  Power back on


(c

N Eliminate cause  Power off  Power back on


ht

O Eliminate cause  Press the RESET key.


ig
yr

P Press the RESET key.


op

Q Eliminate the cause  Tap the alarm clear button.


C

S Tap the alarm clear button.

[6] Cause of alarm


[7] Action to be taken to eliminate the cause.
Note : The list for alarms related to PLC machine control (No. 200 to 399 and No. 1200 to
1399) may have a different format.

3-3
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-2 No. 1 - No. 99, No. 1000 - No. 1099 (System/Drive error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1 EMERGENCY STOP ( , , ) E H O Red

Cause ——

Action ——

2 EMERGENCY STOP ( , , ) E H M Red


Trouble has occurred in the hardware.
Cause

.
d
Turn power off and then back on. If this does not clear the alarm status, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or

ve
Action Technology Center.

s er
3 EMERGENCY STOP ( , , ) A H M Red

re
The emergency stop button on the operating panel has been pressed.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Release the pressed state of the emergency stop button and reset the NC unit to its initial state.

ll
Action

.A
N
4 CORRECTABLE ECC ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red

O
Data error on the memory.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


PO

Action
30

R
o.

5 SYSTEM SOFTWARE ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red


N

The contents of the system software and/or custom software have been destroyed.
al

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


A

Action
IM
K

6 REMOTE I/O ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red


ZA

Cause ——
A
M

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


YA

Action
3
01

7 SRAM MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H M Red


)2

The S-RAM mounted on the CPU card has become abnormal.


Cause
(c
ht

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


ig

Action
yr
op

8 RAM MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H M Red


C

The RAM mounted on the CPU card has become abnormal.


Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

9 ABSOLUTE POSITION MALFUNCTION (Alarm No., Axis, ) E H M Red


The absolute position detection system has lost absolute position data.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-4
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
10 DETECTOR MALFUNCTION (Alarm No., Axis, ) E H M Red
The absolute position detection system has detected its detector error(s).
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

11 POSITION REFERENCE MALFUNCTION (Alarm No., Axis, ) E H M Red


The absolute position detection system has detected an error(s) by cross-checking the absolute position of its detector and
Cause the internal coordinate data of the NC unit.

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

.d
ve
12 SERVO BATTERY WARNING (Alarm No., Axis, ) E L M Blue

er
The battery for retaining absolute position data is running low with a voltage drop, or has exhausted.

s
Cause

re
* Depending on the machine, the message ABSOLUTE POSITION WARNING may be displayed in red.

ts
The battery must be re-charged or replaced. For the battery information, refer to the Maintenance Manual.

gh
Action

ri
13 PRE-PROCESSOR MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H M Red

ll
.A
The software is not correctly working.
Cause

N
O
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

( , , )
PO
30

Cause
o.

O
N

C
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

21 SYSTEM ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red


A
IM

Software of this system has become abnormal.


Cause
K
ZA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
A
M

22 AMPLIFIER NOT EQUIPPED ( , , ) E H M Red


YA

Amplifier power is not yet turned on. Or no signals are transferred yet.
Cause
3
01

Check for an incorrectly connected cable, an incorrectly attached connector, an inadequate input supply voltage to the
)2

Action amplifier, an incorrect axis-number switch setting, etc.


(c
ht

23 —— ( , , )
ig
yr

Cause ——
op
C

Action ——

24 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

3-5
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
25 SAFE OPERATION SYSTEM ALARM ( , , ) E H N Red
There occurred an alarm in the safe operation system.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

26 SPINDLE SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM ( , , ) E H N Red


Trouble has occurred for the spindle in the mode of safety-speed operation.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

d .
ve
( , , )

s er
Cause

re
ts
gh
Action

ri
30 POWER SUPPLY MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C/D H M Red

ll
.A
A power supply alarm has occurred.
Cause

N
O
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

31 SERVO MALFUNCTION 1 ( , , ) C H M Red


PO
30

The servo (power-off level) is abnormal.


R

Cause
o.

The inertia on the servo axis is excessive.


O
N

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


al

Note :
ri

ZA

Action
Se

If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
A

function.
IM

32 SERVO PARAMETER MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C H M Red


K

The parameters that have been transferred from the NC unit to the servo amplifier during NC power-on are not correct.
ZA

Cause
A
M

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
YA

33 SERVO MALFUNCTION 2 ( , , ) C H O Red


3
01

The servo (NC reset level) is abnormal.


Cause
)2

The inertia on the servo axis is excessive.


(c

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


ht

Note :
Action
ig

If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
yr

function.
op

34 SERVO MALFUNCTION 3 ( , , ) C H M Red


C

The servo (amplifier power-off level) is abnormal.


Cause
The inertia on the servo axis is excessive.
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Note :
Action
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
function.

3-6
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
35 OVERLOAD ( , , ) C H N Red
An extraordinary overload has been detected.
Cause

Check if any collision has occurred on the machine and perform the corresponding recovery, or check and reduce the
Action cutting conditions.
If measures other than the above should be taken, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
( , , )

Cause

Action

d .
ve
41 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 1 ( , , ) C H M Red

er
The spindle (power-off level) is abnormal.

s
re
Cause
The inertia on the spindle is excessive.

ts
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

gh
Note :

ri
Action
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation

ll
.A
function.

N
42 SPINDLE PARAMETER MALFUNCTION ( , , ) C H M Red

O
The parameters that have been transferred from the NC unit to the spindle amplifier during NC power-on are not correct.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


PO

Action
30

R
o.

43 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 2 ( , , ) C H O Red


O
N

The spindle (NC reset level) is abnormal.


al

Cause
K

The inertia on the spindle is excessive.


ri

ZA
Se

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


A

Note :
IM

Action
If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
K

function.
ZA

44 SPINDLE MALFUNCTION 3 ( , , ) C H M Red


A

The spindle (amplifier power-off level) is abnormal.


M

Cause
The inertia on the spindle is excessive.
YA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


3
01

Note :
Action
)2

If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
function.
(c

( , , )
ht
ig

Cause
yr
op
C

Action

51 E2ROM MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E L D Blue


Parameters cannot be correctly written into the E2ROM.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-7
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
52 BATTERY ALARM ( , , ) E L D Blue
The battery provided to retain parameters, machining programs and other types of data within the NC unit has reached the
Cause minimum voltage level permissible or has run down.

It is required that the machining data is rechecked for possible loss or that the battery is recharged or replaced. For battery
Action recharging or replacement, refer to the relevant description given in the Maintenance Manual.

53 NC TEMPERATURE WARNING (Note 1, Note 2, Note 3) E L O Blue


The temperature of the control unit or operation board has increased above the required level.
Note :
Cause 1. Location of the temperature alarm
2. Type of temperature alarm

d .
ve
3. On-alarm temperature value

er
Reduce the temperature by turning off the NC power or by mounting a cooling unit.
Action

s
re
54 DIO5V MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H O Blue

ts
gh
Cause ——

ri
ll
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

.A
Action

N
O
55 REMOTE I/O ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E H O Blue

TI
16

Cause —— A
R
04

PO
30

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


R

Note :
o.

O
N

1. & 00 00 01 00 2. & 00 01
C
al

No.1 system (X0 -, Y0 -)


K

No. 5 system (X380 -, Y400 -)


No.2 system (X80 -, Y80 -)
ri

ZA

No. 6 system (X400 -, Y700 -)


Se

No.3 system (X100 -, Y100 -)


The above example indicates that a
A

No.4 system (X280 -, Y300 -)


IM

Action communications error has occurred in


station 1 of the No. 5 system.
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
K
ZA

Station 1
Station 2
A

M

Station 8
YA

The above example indicates that a communications


error has occurred in station 1 of the No. 2 system.
3
01

56 SYSTEM SOFTWARE CHECKING ( , , ) E H N Red


)2

The ROMs mounted in the system ROM card are currently being checked for abnormalities.
Cause
(c
ht

Wait for a while.


ig

Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center if the alarm is not cleared.
yr
op

57 NO PLC ( , , ) F H N Red
C

The user PLC is not stored in the NC unit.


Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

58 CORRUPT PLC ( , , ) F H N Red


Trouble has occurred with the PLC.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-8
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
59 PLC STOPPED ( , , ) F H P Red
The PLC has ceased running.
Cause

Run the PLC.


Action Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center if the alarm is not cleared.

60 REMOTE I/O VER2.0 ERROR (System, station, ) E H M Red


Disconnection or CRC error occurred during remote I/O 2.0 communication.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

d .
ve
61 REMOTE I/O INITIALIZE ERROR (No., System, ) E H N Red

er
An error occurred during remote I/O initialization processing.

s
re
No. Cause

ts
0 × 01 RIO2.0 control register does not “stop” although RIO2.0 stop was requested.

gh
0 × 02 Cyclic transfer counter is not operating.

ri
0 × 04 In RIO2.0 communication, connection status cannot be obtained.

ll
.A
0 × 08 RIO1.0 communication was conducted using a station number (9 or larger) which is
outside the RIO1.0 communication range.

N
Cause
0 × 10 A unit for RIO1.0 communication is connected to the No. 3 system.

O
TI
0 × 20 Units of more than 17 stations were connected to the No. 3 system.
16

0 × 40
A
A safety RIO unit and a unit for RIO1.0 communication are connected to the same
R
04

system.
PO
30

0 × 80 The received data of a safety RIO is not updated.


R
o.

0 × 100 Time-out in obtaining the RIO1.0 communication enabled station information while
O
N

RIO2.0 communication setting is made.


C
al

K
ri

ZA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Se

Action
A
IM

(No., Register
62 RI/O ARBITRARY ALLOTMENT ERROR E H N Red
number, )
K
ZA

An error occurred during remote I/O initialization processing.


No. Cause
A
M

1 A value outside the allowable range is set for a system number or a station number.
YA

2 Overlapped system number or station number


Cause
3

3 A value outside the allowable range is set for a device setting value.
01

4 An illegal value is set for a device setting value.


)2

5 The same device is set for multiple stations.


(c
ht

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
ig
yr
op
C

3-9
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
(No., Register
63 ARBITRARY ALLOTMENT PARACHK ERR E L S Blue
number, )
The setting of a parameter is invalid.
No. Cause
1 A value outside the allowable range is set for a system number or a station number.
2 Overlapped system number or station number

Cause 3 A value outside the allowable range is set for a device setting value.
4 An illegal value is set for a device setting value.
5 The same device is set for multiple stations.
6 Parameter check is executed for arbitrary allocation parameters although the setting is

.
for fixed allocation.

d
ve
er
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Action

s
re
(Threshold value,

ts
64 HIGH SPEED DIO SETTING OVER E H N Red
Number of excesses, )

gh
The number of set high-speed inputs/outputs exceeds the upper limit.

ri
Cause

ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

N
Action

O
TI
65 OVER VOLTAGE DETECT ( , , ) E L M Blue
16

Hardware overvoltage was detected at the control unit.


A
R
04

Cause
PO
30

 After completing the machining, turn off the NC power and then back on.
R
o.

Action
O


N

If the alarm occurs repeatedly, check the voltage of power supply.


C
al

66 PARAMETER MALFUNCTION ( , , ) E H O Blue


K
ri

ZA
Se

Cause ——
A
IM

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
K
ZA

67 HI-SPEED SYNCTAP AXIS ALARM ( , , ) E H O Blue


A

A servo with a system not applicable to high-speed synchronous tapping is connected in spite of the high-speed
M

Cause synchronous tapping option being valid.


YA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


3

Action
01
)2

68 HI-SPEED SYNCTAP SPDL ALARM ( , , ) E H O Blue


(c

A servo with a system not applicable to high-speed synchronous tapping is connected in spite of the high-speed
Cause
ht

synchronous tapping option being valid.


ig

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


yr

Action
op
C

69 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

3-10
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
70 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

71 ILLEGAL SERVO PARAMETER ( , , ) C H M Blue

Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

d .
ve
72 SERVO WARNING ( , , ) E H O Blue

er
The servomotor is loaded abnormally.

s
Cause

re
The inertia has become excessive.

ts
Turn off the NC and the machine, remove the cause of the abnormal load, and then turn on the machine and the NC.

gh
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center if the alarm is not cleared.

ri
Note :

ll
Action 1. If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia

.A
estimation function.

N
2. If this alarm occurs when resetting the emergency stop state, press and hold the RESET key for 0.5 seconds or

O
longer.

TI
16

( , , A )
R
04

PO

Cause
30

R
o.

Action
N

C
al

81 ILLEGAL SPINDLE PARAMETER ( , , ) E H O Blue


ri

ZA
Se

Cause ——
IM

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


K

Action
ZA

82 SPINDLE WARNING ( , , ) E H O Blue


A
M

The inertia on the spindle has become excessive.


YA

Cause
3

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


01

Note :
Action
)2

If this alarm is displayed after replacing the workpiece, the situation may be improved by executing the inertia estimation
(c

function.
ht

( , , )
ig
yr

Cause
op
C

Action

98 H/W SYSTEM DISAGREEMENT ERROR ( , , ) E H M Red


The combination of the hardware and the installed software is not correct.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-11
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure

1000 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

1001 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR1 (No., Information, ) E H M Red


A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Information Cause

.
1 Safety watchdog error

d
ve
2 Crosscheck error

er
3 Function (*1) Safety system internal processing error

s
re
4 Safety parameter saving memory error 1

ts
5 Safety parameter saving memory error 2

gh
6 Safety initial processing time-out

ri
7 Axis name NC-DRV safety initial communication error

ll
.A
8 Unit information Safety I/O initial processing time-out

N
*1

O
TI
Cause Function Function name
16

0001 Safety limit speed monitoring (SLS) A


R
04

0002 Safety limit position monitoring (SLP)


PO
30

0003 Safety speed monitoring (SSM)


R
o.

0004 Safety cam (SCA)


N

0005 Safety stop monitoring (SOS)


al

K
ri

0006 Safety stop 1 (SS1)


ZA
Se

0007 Safety stop 2 (SS2)


A
IM

0008 Safety torque stop (STO)


0009 Safety brake control (SBC)
K
ZA

000A Diagnosis function


000B Safety related I/O monitoring
A
M
YA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
3
01

1002 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR2 (No., Axis name, ) E H M Red
)2

A safety monitoring function error was detected.


(c
ht

No. Cause
ig

1 Encoder error
yr

Cause 2 Abnormality detected in STO circuit diagnosis


op

3 Abnormality detected in SBC circuit diagnosis


C

4 NC-DRV safety communication error


5 Excess axis movement amount during power off

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-12
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure

1003 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR3 (No., Information, ) E H M Red


A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Information Cause
1 Unit information Slave station communication error 1
2 Unit information Slave station communication error 2
3 Unit information Slave station communication error 3
4 Unit information Slave station data verification error
5 Unit information Output OFF check error
6 Unit information Output signal crosscheck error
7 Unit information Transmission crosscheck error

d.
ve
8 Unit information Reception crosscheck error

er
9 Unit information Host station communication error 1

s
re
10 Unit information Host station communication error 2
11 Unit information Host station communication error 3

ts
gh
12 Unit information Drive safety reception crosscheck error

ri
13 Factor (*1) User safety sequence 1 illegal

ll
14 Factor (*1) User safety sequence 2 illegal

.A
15 Unit information Output signal crosscheck error

N
O
*1

TI
16

Factor A Cause
R
04

0 × 1200 CRC error occurred. The user safety sequence can be faulty.
PO
30

0 × 1300 File system version mismatch occurred.


R
o.

0 × 2100 Label duplication error occurred.


O
N

Cause
C

0 × 2600 Illegal execution of RET instruction


al

1. A RET instruction could not haven been executed at the branch destination of a CALL
ri

ZA

instruction.
Se

2. A RET instruction could haven been executed although a CALL instruction was not executed.
IM

0 × 2700 Ladder code error


K

An abnormality was detected with the data in the sequence program to be executed.
ZA

1. An unusable PLC instruction could be used.


A

2. A sequence program stored in the internal ROM could be corrupted.


M

0 × 2900 Execution area over


YA

The total number of steps of the ladder to be executed could be larger than the size of PLC
3

processor execution area.


01

0 × 8000 Exceptional software interruption (BCD instruction error) occurred.


)2

With a BCD or DBCD instruction, BCD conversion could be attempted for a BIN value outside the
(c

allowable input range.


ht

0 × 8100 Exceptional software interruption (BIN instruction error) occurred.


ig

With a BIN or DBIN instruction, BIN conversion could be attempted for a BCD value outside the
yr

allowable input range.


op

0 × 8200 Exceptional software interruption (bus error) occurred.


C

0 × 8300 Exceptional software interruption (non-installed instruction error) occurred.


0 × 8400 Exceptional software interruption (instruction format error) occurred.
0 × 8500 Exceptional software interruption (instruction bus error) occurred.
0 × 8600 Exceptional software interruption (CALL/RET instruction error) occurred.
0 × 8700 Exceptional software interruption (memory area error) occurred.
0 × 8800 Exceptional software interruption (ASYNC BUS error) occurred.

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-13
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure

1004 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR4 (No., Information, ) E H M Red


A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Information Cause
1 - Simultaneous execution of safety monitoring and smart safety
monitoring impossible
2 Connection channel Safety I/O device connection impossible
3 Connection channel Safety I/O impossible Incorrect safety I/O connection
Cause 4 - Safety I/O impossible No safety I/O
5 - Safety PLC not written
6 Channel number NC-DRV safety communication impossible

. d
7 Emergency stop Illegal emergency stop device specification

ve
device number

er
9 - Illegal setting of safety I/O device allocation parameter

s
re
ts
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Action

gh
ri
ll
1005 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR5 (No., Axis name, ) E H M Red

.A
A safety monitoring function error was detected.

N
No. Cause

O
TI
1 SLS speed error
16

2 SLS deceleration error A


R
04

3 SLP position error


PO
30

Cause 4 SOS speed error


R
o.

5 SOS position deviation error


N

6 SOS movement amount error


al

K
ri

7 SS1 deceleration error


ZA
Se

8 SS2 deceleration error


A
IM

Press the reset key.


K

Action If the alarm is still not cleared, please contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
ZA
A

1006 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR6 (No., , ) E H M Red


M

A safety monitoring function error was detected.


YA

No. Cause
3

1 Stopped due to safety external emergency stop function


01

Cause
The emergency stop signal is off when the safety external emergency stop function is
)2

valid.
(c
ht

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


ig

Action
yr
op

1007 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ERROR7 ( , , ) E H M Red


C

Abnormal operation of the safety circuit inside the drive unit has been detected.
Cause

The drive unit can be faulty.


Action Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

3-14
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure

( , , )

Cause

Action

1020 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM1 (No., Axis name, ) E H O Blue
A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Cause

.
1 SSM hysteresis width setting error

d
ve
SSM hysteresis width is larger than SSM speed.

er
2 Safety absolute position not established

s
Cause

re
1. The safety absolute position has not been established even once after making valid
SLP/SCA.

ts
gh
2. In the encoder diagnosis performed while SLP/SCA power is off, there is a positional
offset between the position saved when the power was turned off and the position

ri
restored when the power was turned on.

ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

N
Action

O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-15
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure

1021 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM2 (No., Information, ) E H O Blue


A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Information Cause
1 Factor (*1) SBT start impossible
When making the SBT start signal valid, the test start conditions are not
met.
2 Axis name SBT warning 1
In external brake test pattern 1, axis movement amount exceeded the
permissible value.
5 Axis name SBT warning 4

.
In motor brake test pattern 1, axis movement amount exceeded the

d
ve
permissible value.

er
6 Axis name SBT warning 5

s
In motor brake test pattern 2, axis movement amount exceeded the

re
permissible value.

ts
7 Axis name SBT warning 6

gh
In motor brake test pattern 3, axis movement amount exceeded the

ri
permissible value.

ll
.A
Cause *1

N
Factor Description

O
TI
0001 System during automatic operation existing
16

0002 No in the in-position state


A
R
04

PO

0003 In the servo off state


30

0004 In the current limited state


R
o.

0005 Slave axis in synchronous control


N

0006 In the superimposition control state


al

K
ri

In the arbitrary axis exchanged control state


ZA

0007
Se

0008 In the mixed control state


A
IM

0009 SBT parameter error


000A Reference point not established
K
ZA

000B Corresponding to the SBT exclusive conditions


Slave axis SBT invalid
A

000C
M

000D Slave axis SBT start impossible


YA

000E In the slave axis independent control method


3
01

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
)2
(c

1022 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM3 (No., Axis name, ) E H O Blue
ht
ig

A safety monitoring function error was detected.


yr

No. Cause
op

Cause 1 In the PLC safe stop state


C

The safe stop 1 request signal or the safe torque stop request signal of the PLC input
signal is off.

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action Note : If this alarm occurs when resetting the emergency stop state, press and hold the RESET key for 0.5 seconds or
longer.

3-16
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure

1023 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM4 (No., , ) E H O Blue


A safety monitoring function error was detected.
No. Cause

Cause 1 24-hour ON state continuation warning


The output signal of the safety I/O device remained ON for more than 24 hours.
The relating unit No., RIO system and signal bit are displayed.

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

.
1024 SMART SAFE OPER. SYSTEM ALARM5 (No., , ) E H O Blue

d
ve
A safety monitoring function error was detected.

er
Cause

s
re
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

ts
Action

gh
ri
( , , )

ll
.A
Cause

N
O
TI
16

Action A
R
04

PO
30

1050 MEASURE. ERROR(NOT EMERG. STOP) ( , , ) E L S Blue


R
o.

An attempt was made to measure insulation resistance of a motor manually while the machine was not in the emergency
O
N

Cause
C

stop state.
al

K
ri

ZA

Sets the machine in the emergency stop state before starting manual measurement.
Se

Action
A
IM

1051 INSULATION RESISTANCE DECREASE ( , , ) E L S Blue


K
ZA

The measured insulation resistance of a motor went below insulation resistance warning threshold 1 (S54 or SA145).
Cause
A
M
YA

Since the insulation resistance of the motor is lowered, consider replacing it.
Action
3
01

1052 INSULATION RESISTANCE WARNING ( , , ) E L S Blue


)2

The measured insulation resistance of a motor went below insulation resistance warning threshold 2 (S55 or SA146).
(c

Cause
ht
ig

The insulation resistance of a motor is lowered. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center and
yr

Action request a replacement.


op
C

( , , )

Cause

Action

3-17
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-3 No. 100 - No. 199, No. 1100 - No. 1199 (CNC machine control error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
100 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

101 SOFT LIMIT (Axis, , ) A K P Blue


Some mistake in operations during the automatic operation has caused the tool tip to overstep the area specified in the
Cause software limit parameters in the direction of the axis corresponding to the displayed axis name.

. d
ve
Modify the program so that the tool tip may move within the area specified in the software limit parameters.
Action

s er
( , , )

re
ts
Cause

gh
ri
Action

ll
.A
113 OVER TRAVEL (Axis, , ) A K P Red

N
O
The tool tip has reached stroke limit in the direction of the axis corresponding to the displayed axis name.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Move the tool tip away from the end in manual operation mode.
Action
PO
30

R
o.

( , , )
O
N

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Action
A
IM

121 SP ROT. FLUCT. ACCEL. CLAMP ( , , ) B L P Blue


K

The spindle speed acceleration was clamped while the spindle speed fluctuation function was enabled.
ZA

Cause
A
M

Review the cycle and amplitude of the fluctuation.


Action
YA
3

122 SPINDLE ROT. FLUCTUATION N/A ( , , ) B K P Red


01

An attempt was made to use the spindle speed fluctuation function although the relevant option was not featured.
)2

Cause
(c

The spindle speed fluctuation function cannot be used since the relevant option is not featured.
ht

Action
ig
yr
op
C

3-18
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
123 SP ROT. FLUCT. SETTING ERROR (Alarm No., , ) B K P Red

Alarm No. Cause


When specifying the M code for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation synchronous mode, a
&0000 0001 spindle that was already in the spindle speed fluctuation synchronous mode in another control
path was specified.
When specifying the M code for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation synchronous mode, the
&0000 0002
specified spindle or NC axis did not exist.
Cause
When specifying the M code for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation, a spindle whose
&0000 0004
spindle speed fluctuation was already enabled in another control path was specified.
When specifying the M code for enabling the spindle speed fluctuation, the specified spindle or
&0000 0008
NC axis did not exist.

d .
The spindle whose spindle speed fluctuation is enabled does not match the spindle encoder

ve
&0000 0010
number or the spindle specified for the constant surface speed control.

s er
re
Review the setting.
Action

ts
gh
124 SP ROT. FLUCT. ILLEGAL COMMAND (Alarm No., , ) B K P Red

ri
ll
Alarm No. Cause

.A
A spindle speed fluctuation mode enabling M code was specified while override variable thread

N
cutting was enabled.
&0000 0001

O
An override variable thread cutting enabling M code was specified while the spindle speed

TI
fluctuation was enabled.
16

A
A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the G61.1 mode.
R
04

&0000 0002
PO

G61.1 was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was enabled.


30

A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the polygon machining mode.
R
o.

&0000 0004 A polygon machining mode command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was
N

enabled.
al

A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified in the hobbing mode.
ri

ZA

&0000 0008
Se

A hobbing mode command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was enabled.
A

A spindle speed fluctuation enabling M code was specified during synchronized tapping.
IM

&0000 0020
A synchronized tapping command was specified while spindle speed fluctuation was enabled.
K

Cause The master spindle in synchronous operation was specified as the spindle for spindle speed
ZA

fluctuation.
&0000 0040
A

A spindle for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the master spindle
M

for synchronous operation.


YA

The slave spindle in synchronous operation was specified as the spindle for spindle speed
fluctuation.
3

&0000 0080
01

A spindle for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the slave spindle
)2

for synchronous operation.


(c

The master axis in the simplified synchronous mode was specified as the servo axis for spindle
speed fluctuation.
ht

&0000 0100
ig

A servo axis for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the master axis
yr

in the simplified synchronous mode.


op

The slave axis in the simplified synchronous mode was specified as the servo axis for spindle
speed fluctuation.
C

&0000 0200
A servo axis for which spindle speed fluctuation was enabled was specified as the slave axis in
the simplified synchronous mode.

Review the program.


Action

3-19
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
125 ILLEGAL AXIS EXISTS ( , , ) E H O Red
During reference-point return, the proximity-point detection limit switch has overrun the position in which the watchdog is
Cause mounted.

Either extend the length of the proximity-point watchdog or reduce the reference-point returning speed. After that, carry out
Action the zero-point returning operation once again.

126 AXIS HAS NOT PASSED Z PHASE ( , , ) E H O Red


During initial reference-point return following the power-on action, an axis has not passed through the Z phase of the
Cause corresponding detector.

First actuate the handle for manual pulse feed to move the axis back in the opposite direction to the zero-point, and then
Action carry out the zero-point returning operation once again.

d .
ve
127 ILLEGAL DIR. FOR ORIGIN RETURN ( , , ) A K P Red

er
The axis-movement direction selected with the axis selector switch is not correct for the reference-point return in manual

s
Cause

re
operation mode.

ts
Select the correct direction (+, –) using the axis selector switch.

gh
Action

ri
128 OUTSIDE INTERLOCK AXIS ( , , ) A K P Red

ll
.A
An axis is interlocked because the interlock function has become active (input signal has turned off).
Cause

N
O
Clear the active state of the interlock function.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

129 INSIDE INTERLOCK AXIS ( , , ) A K P Red


PO
30

The very direction in which the manual skip function has become effective is specified in the axis-movement command. Or
Cause
R

the servo-off function is active.


o.

O
N

Deactivate the servo-off function.


al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

130 NO OPERATION MODE ( , , ) A K P Red


A
IM

Incorrect mode selection or malfunction of the automatic operation key.


Cause
K
ZA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
A
M

131 CUTTING FEED OVERRIDE SET AT 0 ( , , ) A K P Blue


YA

The cutting-feed override value is set to 0 on the machine operating panel.


Cause
3
01

Change the cutting-feed override value to one greater than 0. If this alarm message is displayed when the cutting-feed
)2

Action override value is not 0, check the signal line for a short-circuit.
(c

132 FEEDRATE ZERO ( , , ) A K P Blue


ht
ig

 An attempt has been made to execute an axis movement in the cutting feed mode or dry-run in the automatic
yr

Cause operation mode, with the manual feedrate remaining set to 0 on the machine operating panel.
op

 After a restart search, the cycle start button was pressed with the manual feedrate set to 0.
C

Change the manual feedrate to a value greater than 0. If this alarm message is displayed when the manual feedrate is not
Action 0, check the signal line for a short-circuit.

133 STOP SPINDLE ( , , ) D K N Blue


Spindle rotation did not start when the spindle rotation start command was issued during automatic operation.
Cause

1. Conditions for spindle rotation start are not satisfied. Check the program and tool data.
Action 2. The spindle amplifier and the encoder must be checked for normal operation. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical
Center or Technology Center.

3-20
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
134 SPINDLE ROTATION EXCEEDED ( , , ) D K N Red
The spindle-speed limit has been exceeded.
Cause

Reduce the spindle speed. The spindle amplifier must be checked for normal operation.
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

135 BLOCK START INTERLOCK ( , , ) B K P Blue


The interlock signal to lock the start of the program block has been input.
Cause

The sequence program needs checking for normal functioning.


Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

d .
ve
136 CUTTING BLOCK START INTERLOCK ( , , ) B K P Blue

er
The interlock signal to lock the start of the cutting program block has been input.

s
Cause

re
ts
The sequence program needs checking for normal functioning.

gh
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

ri
137 DYNAMIC COMPENSATION EXCEEDED ( , , ) A K P Red

ll
.A
Dynamic compensation amount exceeded 3 mm (0.12 in).
Cause

N
O
Make sure that the workpiece coordinate zero point is centrally positioned in the workpiece, and set the difference between

TI
Action the center of the workpiece and the rotary center of the table to 3 mm (0.12 in) or less.
16

A
R
04

138 CANNOT ROTATE TABLE ( , , ) A K P Red


PO
30

1. An interruption occurred during rotation of the indexing (rotary) table.


R

Cause
o.

2. A 3D coordinate conversion command (G68/G69) was specified while G0 was temporarily canceled in tool tip point
O
N

control during machining of an inclined plane or workpiece placement error correction.


C
al

1. No interruption is permitted during rotation of the indexing (rotary) table.


ri

Action
ZA

2. Check the details of program.


Se

139 PRE-INTERP ACCEL/DECEL ERROR ( , , ) A K M Red


IM

An abnormality has occurred in the NC unit during the pre-interpolation acceleration/deceleration process.
K

Cause
ZA

Hardware trouble is likely. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
A

Action
M
YA

140 ILLEGAL REFERENCE RETURN No. ( , , ) A K P Blue


Returning to the second reference point has been commanded in spite of the fact that returning to the first reference point
3
01

Cause has not yet occurred.


)2

Return the axis to the first reference point first.


(c

Action
ht

141 EXCESS SIMULTANEOUS ERROR ( , , ) A K P Blue


ig
yr

The synchronization error between the master axis and the slave axis during synchronous control has overstepped a
Cause
op

predetermined allowable value.


C

Move either axis in the direction that the error decreases.


Action
Reduce the allowable value to zero (checking invalid), or increase the allowable value.

142 NONE OR DUPLICATE OPERAT. MODE ( , , ) A K P Blue


An operation mode has not been selected, or more than one operation mode have been selected.
Cause
The automatic operation key is malfunctioning.
Check for incorrect wiring of the input mode key.
Action

3-21
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
143 ILLEGAL HANDLE FEED AXIS ( , , ) A K P Blue
A nonexistent axis has been designated as the handle feed axis.
Cause
Or a handle feed axis has not been designated.
Check the handle feed axis selection signal line for incorrect wiring.
Action
Or check the maximum number of axes that can be used under the current specifications.

144 ILLEGAL CYCLE START (Alarm No., , ) A I O Red


It was attempted to start automatic operation under the following conditions:

Alarm No. Cause


0 × 101 The smoothing level is not zero.

.d
0 × 102 NC ready signal is not ON.

ve
0 × 103 Reset state not yet cleared.

er
0 × 104 Feed hold is in operation.

s
re
0 × 105 Hardware overtravel not yet cleared.

ts
0 × 106 Software overtravel not yet cleared.

gh
0 × 107 No operation mode selected.

ri
0 × 108 Two or more operation modes selected.

ll
.A
0 × 109 During change in operation modes.
Cause

N
0 × 110 During editing on the EIA MONITOR display.

O
0 × 111 During search on the tape data.

TI
16

0 × 113 Abnormality in temperature. A


R
04

0 × 114 Program being edited on the EIA MONITOR display.


PO
30

0 × 115 A door opened.


R
o.

0 × 116 During compensation in tandem control.


O
N

0 × 117 An alarm related to polygonal machining or hob milling not yet cleared.
al

0 × 118 An alarm related to safety barrier not yet cleared.


ri

ZA

0 × 120 After establishing absolute positions through zero return operation, the power has not
Se

been turned off and back on.


IM

0 × 124 The cycle start button was pressed while the work number was being changed.
K
ZA

Remove the cause, if possible, to (re)start the automatic operation.


Action
If not, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
A
M

145 REQUIRE ABSOLUTE RECOVERY (Alarm No., , ) C K P Blue


YA

The absolute position data has become lost.


Cause
3

Trouble has occurred in the absolute position detector.


01

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


)2

Action
(c
ht

146 NOT AUTO MODE ( , , ) A I O Blue


ig

Automatic operation has been started in a mode other than automatic operation.
Cause
yr
op

Change the mode to the automatic.


C

Action

147 SHAPING AXIS TURNING ANGLE OVER (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A K P Blue
1. The rotational angle limit at the shaping block connections has been exceeded.
Cause
2. The radius of the arc is less than the rotational radius of the C-axis.
1. Review the program.
Action
2. Review the setting of parameter K1 (rotational radius of the C-axis).

3-22
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
148 CHUCK BARRIER (Note 1, Note 2, ) A (B) K (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The tool entered in the chuck barrier.
Note :
1. Interfering component 1
Display
1 No. 1 spindle chuck
2 No. 2 spindle chuck
4 Tailstock
8 Turret
2. Interfering component 2
Cause Display Type A Type B Type C

.
d
0 Tool tip Turret Tool, holder, turret

ve
1 Turret Holder —

er
2 — Tool —

s
re
Machine type A, B and C above are available according to the settings of the following parameters:

ts
Type BA73 BA129 bit 1

gh
A Other than 0 0

ri
B — 1

ll
C 0 0

.A
2. Interference is occurring between the tool and chuck in the solid mode.

N
Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.

O
Action

TI
16

149 TAILSTOCK BARRIER ( , Note,


A ) A (B) K (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
04

PO

1. The tool entered in the tail barrier.


30

Note :
R
o.

Cause
O

For details of the cause, refer to Note 2 “Interfering component 2” in the explanation of alarm 148 CHUCK
N

BARRIER.
al

2. Interference is occurring between the tool and tailstock in the solid mode.
ri

ZA

Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.
Se

Action
A
IM

150 WORK PIECE BARRIER ( , , ) A, B H (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


K

1. Interference is occurring between the workpiece of the No. 1 turning spindle side and the workpiece of the No. 2
ZA

Cause turning spindle side.


A

2. Interference is occurring between the tool and workpiece in the solid mode.
M

Review and correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the tool data and the barrier parameters.
YA

Action
3

151 NO TANDEM CONTROLLING OPTION ( , , ) B I N Red


01
)2

Executing the tandem driving function has been attempted despite a tandem driving option not being present.
Cause
(c
ht

The tandem driving function can be used only for a special machine. If this alarm occurs in a special machine that allows
Action
ig

the use of the tandem driving function, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
yr

152 ILLEGAL SYNCHRONIZED AXIS NAME ( , , ) B I N Red


op

1. The settings of the address name parameters (M11) on each axis are illegal.
C

Cause
2. An attempt has been made to simultaneously control axes other than the master axis that has been set in a parameter.
1. Correct the address names of the master axis and slave axis to the uppercase alphabet and the lowercase alphabet,
Action respectively, and set the address name parameters (M11) of each axis properly.
2. Subject the specified master axis to simultaneous control.
153 TRANSFER/PUSH UNFINISHED ( , , ) A K O Red
1. The axis reached its pressing completion position before a skipping signal was generated.
Cause
2. The drooping amount during pressing operation cannot overstep the setting in parameter K46.
1. Check whether the pressing completion position in the program is correct.
Action
2. Modify the K46 setting as appropriate.

3-23
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
154 ZERO RET. NOT ALLOWED (G68 MODE) ( , , ) E L S Blue
Zero-point return mode has been selected during three-dimensional coordinate conversion.
Cause

1. Select an operation mode other than the zero-point return mode.


Action
2. To execute manual zero-point return, cancel three-dimensional coordinate conversion mode.
155 BARRIER TURRET/TOOL HEAD ( , Note, ) A K O Red
The barriers of the upper and lower turrets interferes with each other.
Cause Note :
For details of the cause, refer to Note 2 “Interfering component 2” in the explanation of alarm 148 CHUCK BARRIER.
Correct the machining program. If the program is correct, review the parameters related to the barrier.

.
d
Action

ve
er
156 ILLEGAL MEASURING SENSOR SIGNAL ( , , ) E L P Red

s
re
The measuring sensor has turned on at a position in a non-measuring area.
Cause

ts
gh
If the sensor has come to contact with an object, confirm the program. In other cases, confirm the mounting status of the
Action

ri
sensor.

ll
.A
157 MEASURED RESULT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) A, B I P Red
Measurement results are not normal.

N
Cause

O
TI
16

Check the program. A


R
04

Check if the sensor tool length registered on the TOOL DATA display is correct.
Action
PO
30

Check the mounting status of the sensor.


R

If the error has occurred while measuring a tool, check the tool data.
o.

O
N

158 ILLEGAL COMMAND CROSS MACHINING ( , , ) A K Q Blue


C
al

It was attempted to manually control an axis currently under the control for cross machining.
K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

The axes under the cross machining control cannot be controlled manually.
IM

Action
K

159 CROSS MACHINING IMPOSSIBLE (Alarm No., , ) E I P Red


ZA
A
M

Alarm No. Cause


YA

&0000 0001 The specified axis does not exist in the counterpart system.
&0000 0002 The self-system is specified as the system to be cross-controlled.
3
01

The cross machining control is specified for an axis which is already under the control in
&0000 0004
)2

question.
(c

&0000 0010 A command for cross machining control is given from the counterpart system.
ht

In the mode of inclined-axis control a cross-control command is given for the fundamental axis
ig

Cause (X-axis) without positioning of the inclined axis (Y-axis) in its zero point.
&0000 0040
yr

In the mode of inclined-axis control a cross-control command is given for the inclined axis
op

(Y-axis).
C

A cross control command or cross control cancel command was specified for the NC axis in the
spindle speed fluctuation synchronous mode.
&0000 0080
A cross control command or cross control cancel command was specified for an NC axis for
which spindle speed fluctuation is enabled.
At the execution of a cross-machining command, the axis movement completion wait time
&0000 0400
exceeded the time set at parameter SU54.

Review and correct the program.


Action
Check and correct the value set at parameter SU54 for alarm No. 0 × 0400.

3-24
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
160 ILLEGAL NUMBER OF CROSS AXIS ( , , ) E I P Red
The number of axes in the remote system has become zero as a result of crossing command execution.
Cause

Review and correct the program.


Action

161 SUPERPOSITION CTRL IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P Red


It was attempted to start superposition control with an unavailable axis.
Cause It was attempted to start superposition control under incompatible modal conditions.

Check the parameters related to the type of acceleration & deceleration and to the motion speed during superposition
Action control.

. d
ve
162 ILLEGAL SUPERPOSITION PARAMETER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P Red

er
Incorrect parameter settings do not allow the superposition control to be started.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the parameters related to the type of acceleration & deceleration and to the motion speed during superposition

gh
Action control.

ri
163 BARRIER WORK (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A K O Red

ll
.A
There is a danger that one workpiece will interfere with the other.
Cause There is a danger that the partition plate will interfere with the workpiece or the lower turret.

N
O
Review the barrier parameters, or for automatic operation, correct the program properly.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

164 ILLEGAL CMD SAFE OPER SYS ALARM ( , , ) A J Q Blue


PO
30

With the machine under the control for safety speed, a command for the following was given:
R

Cause Threading, Synchronous tapping, Cross machining, Superposition control.


o.

O
N

Close the door to operate the machine.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

165 CANNOT MAKE SAFE OPER SYS ACTIVE ( , , ) A L Q Blue


A
IM

The command signal for the control for safety speed was turned on in the following modes of machining:
Cause Threading, Synchronous tapping, Cross machining, Superposition control.
K
ZA

Close the door to operate the machine.


Action
A
M

166 LOWER TURRET ALREADY ASSIGNED ( , , ) A K O Red


YA

An M810 command was given from one HD side to operate the lower turret that was currently used on the other HD side.
Cause
3
01

Give the M810 command after the use of the lower turret on the other side.
)2

Action
(c
ht

167 ILLEGAL OPER TOOL TIP PT CTRL ( , , ) A K (O) O (S) Blue


ig

An attempt was made in the mode of tool tip point control to perform such an improper operation as follows:
yr

1. Manual interruption
op

Cause
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle
C

3. MDI interruption
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of tool tip point control.
Action

3-25
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
168 ILLEGAL OPER 5X RADIUS COMP. ( , , ) A K (O) O (S) Blue
An attempt was made in the mode of tool radius compensation for five-axis machining to perform such an improper
operation as follows:
Cause 1. Manual interruption
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle
3. MDI interruption
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of tool radius compensation for five-axis
Action machining.

169 ILLEGAL OPER.HIGH SMOOTHING CTR ( , , ) A K (O) Q (S) Blue


In the mode of high-speed smoothing control an unavailable operation (e. g. manual interruption) was attempted.
Cause

d.
ve
Manual interruption cannot be performed in the mode of high-speed smoothing control.

er
Action

s
re
170 W AXIS THRUST FORCE ALARM ( , , ) E J O Red

ts
W-axis thrust has not been obtained.

gh
Cause

ri
ll
Review and correct the program.

.A
Action

N
171 ILLEGAL W AXIS COMMAND ( , , ) E J O Red

O
TI
W-axis operation was programmed during the application of the W-axis thrust.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO

Review and correct the program.


30

Action
R
o.

172 B AXIS NOT AVAILABLE ( , , ) B I N Red


N

C
al

The head (B) axis is used without the B-axis control option.
K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Purchase the B-axis control option.


A

Action
IM
K

173 2ND SPDL C AXIS NOT AVIALABLE ( , , ) B I N Red


ZA

The No. 2 spindle/C-axis is used without the No. 2 spindle/C-axis option.


Cause
A
M

Purchase the No. 2 spindle/C-axis option.


YA

Action
3
01

174 2ND SPDL 1/10000 N/A ( , , ) B I N Red


)2

The No. 2 spindle/C-axis is used without the No. 2 spindle high-precision indexing option.
Cause
(c
ht

Purchase the No. 2 spindle high-precision indexing option.


Action
ig
yr

175 TABLE UNBALANCE CHECK N/A ( , , ) B I N Red


op

Vibration detection is used without the rotary table vibration detection option.
C

Cause

Purchase the rotary table vibration detection option.


Action

176 CANNOT CHANGE TIME CONSTANT (System No., , ) B I P Red


Changing the cutting feed time constant in the system has been attempted during synchronous tapping, threading, or
Cause control axis superposition.

Review and correct the program.


Action

3-26
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
177 ONE-TOUCH TUNING IMPOSSIBLE (System No., , ) B I P Red
The inertia estimation has been attempted by G297 during movement of the axis whose inertia was to be estimated.
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during movement of the parameter setup reference axis or of some
axis assigned to the parameter data development system.
Cause
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during cutting feed time constant changeover or control axis
superposition.
The G298 parameter setup command has been set during axis rotation.
Review and correct the program.
Action

178 INERTIA TOO LARGE (System No., , ) B I P Red

.
The estimated inertia has exceeded the maximum inertia specified in the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.

d
Cause

ve
er
Correct the settings of the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.

s
Action

re
ts
179 CANNOT AUTO MEASURE INERTIA (System No., , ) B I P Red

gh
Resonance has not been reduced during inertia estimation.

ri
Cause The minimum inertial is not specified in TSVC or TSPC.

ll
.A
The inertia estimation itself has failed.

N
Correct the settings of the TSVC parameter or the TSPC parameter.
Action

O
TI
16

180 SYNCHRO TAP ILLEGAL COMMAND A


(WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I P Red
R
04

An orienting command has been entered during synchronous tapping.


PO

Cause
30

R
o.

Review and correct the program.


N

Action
C
al

K
ri

181 NO MDI DATA (System No., , ) B L S Blue


ZA
Se

Although operation has been started in MDI mode, data has been found to be missing.
A

Cause
IM

Set data in the MDI window.


K

Action
ZA
A

182 CANNOT DETACH AXIS (Axis, UNo., SNo.) B L Q Red


M

The axis removal request signal has been turned on when the axis removal-in-progress signal was on (after turning off the
YA

axis removal request signal, the operator has turned the axis removal request signal back on without waiting for the axis
Cause removal-in-progress signal to turn off).
3
01

After the axis removal request signal was turned on for the absolute position control axis, the axis removal request signal
)2

has been turned off during display of alarm 71 ILLEGAL SERVO PARAMETER.
(c

Turn on the axis removal request signal when the axis removal-in-progress signal is off.
Action
ht

Clear the alarm.


ig

183 CANNOT MDI INTERRUPT ( , , ) A L Q Blue


yr

MDI interruption has been attempted during automatic operation.


op

Cause
C

MDI interruption is not possible. Return to original mode and resume operation.
Action

3-27
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
184 ILLEGAL OPER IN G54.4 MODE ( , , ) A L Q Blue
An attempt was made in the mode of workpiece placement error correction to perform such an improper operation as
follows:
Cause 1. Manual interruption
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle
3. MDI interruption
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of workpiece placement error correction.
Action

185 ILLEGAL OPER IN G68.2 MODE ( , , ) A L Q Blue


An attempt was made in the mode of inclined-surface machining to perform such an improper operation as follows:

d .
1. Manual interruption

ve
Cause
2. Interruption using the manual pulse handle

er
3. MDI interruption

s
re
Do not attempt to perform any of the above operations 1 to 3 in the mode of inclined-surface machining.
Action

ts
gh
186 W-THERMAL COMP. OVER LIMIT ( , , ) B L S Blue

ri
The amount of compensation for workpiece thermal expansion exceeded the effective range of +0.5 to –0.5 mm.

ll
Cause

.A
N
The operation is continued with the amount of error compensation reduced to the limit (+0.5 to –0.5 mm).

O
Change the reference point for workpiece thermal expansion compensation to a point on the workpiece, or execute the

TI
Action
16

workpiece thermal expansion compensation enable/disable command when the tool tip is in close proximity to the
A
workpiece.
R
04

PO

187 SET W-THERMAL COMP. TOOL LENGTH ( , , ) B L S Blue


30

The workpiece thermal expansion compensation command is issued to a tool for which tool data is not entered.
o.

Cause
O
N

C
al

Enter the tool data (tool length). If the tool length is not specified, compensation will be made on the assumption that the
ri

ZA

Action tool tip is at the spindle nose (or at the center of rotation of the B-axis if the machine has a spindle head rotating
Se

mechanism).
A
IM

188 SET W-THERMAL COMP. REF. POINT ( , , ) B J P Red


Although the reference point for workpiece thermal expansion compensation was not set, the workpiece thermal
K

Cause expansion compensation command was issued.


ZA

Set the reference point for workpiece thermal expansion compensation before issuing the workpiece thermal expansion
A

Action
M

compensation command.
YA

189 ILLEGAL SPINDLE DIRECTION (WNo., UNo., ) D K N Red


3

The directions of rotation of the turning tool selected in the manual program unit and the spindle do not match.
01

Cause
)2

Check the direction of rotation set for the tool selected in the manual program unit and select a correct tool.
(c

Action
Alternatively, set TC144 bit3 to “0” to enable automatic output of the spindle rotation command.
ht
ig

190 —— ( , , )
yr
op

Cause ——
C

Action ——

191 FILE SYSTEM I/O ERROR (Alarm No., , ) E I P Red


An internal error(s) has occurred during program data change by the function of VFC, MMS etc.
Cause

After checking the entire data of the program being executed, tool data, tool file, parameters, etc., save the data using the
Action data I/O operation and then Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

3-28
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
192 EXECUTION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P (S) Red (Blue)
1. A measurement operation was attempted although there is no FRM unit.
2. Coordinate measurement was executed from the FRM unit set as the center of table rotation.
3. Measurement of a tool other than a milling tool was attempted with laser measurement.
4. Offsetting of a tool other than a turning tool was attempted using measurement of O.D., I.D, single-side O.D., or
single-side I.D. in a workpiece measurement unit.
5. Offsetting other than tool radius offset was attempted for a milling tool using measurement of groove width, protrusion
Cause width, I.D. protrusion width, or I.D. groove width in a workpiece measurement unit.
6. The barrier teaching function was activated while running a program stored outside the memory operation range or
while there was an active barrier alarm during MDI operation.

.
7. An axis command for the driven axis was specified with the axis set in the synchronized operation mode.

d
ve
8. The override variable thread cutting function was activated while position data is memorized using the rethreading

er
function.

s
re
9. A winding that does not support the override variable thread cutting function is selected.
1. Set the FRM unit.

ts
gh
2. Review the setting of the FRM unit.

ri
3. Measure only milling tools with laser measurement.

ll
4. Select a turning tool.

.A
Action 5. Offset only the tool radius for a milling tool.

N
O
6. Do not use the barrier teaching function for programs other than the ones stored in the memory operation range.

TI
7. Specify the command after canceling the synchronization of the axes.
16

A
8. Clear the memorized position data before using the override variable thread cutting function.
R
04

PO

9. Select a winding that supports the function.


30

193 NO TOOL IN MAGAZINE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I P Red


o.

O
N

Tool data that correspond to the pocket numbers being displayed in the “TNo.” item of the POSITION display are
C

Cause unregistered.
al

K
ri

ZA

Register the tool data.


Se

Action
A
IM

194 NO TOOL DATA IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) E I P Red


K

An internal error(s) has occurred when surface speed or feedrate changing by VFC function was under way.
ZA

Cause
A

After checking the entire data of the program being executed, tool data, tool file, parameters, etc., save the data using the
M

Action data I/O operation (floppy disk) and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
YA

195 WRONG MEASURING DIRECTION ( , , ) A I O Red


3
01

During the second or subsequent rounds of manual measurement, an attempt has been made to perform skipping in a
Cause
)2

direction not available for measurement.


(c

Perform measurements in the correct direction.


ht

Action
ig

196 WRONG MEASURING POINT ( , , ) A I P Red


yr
op

During the second or subsequent rounds of manual measurement, an attempt has been made to measure an illegal point.
Cause
C

Measure correct points.


Action

197 UNREGISTERED HEAD DATA ( , , ) B I P Red


Head data of the head number being used during MMS, MDI MMS or manual measurement does not exist.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-29
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
198 NO HEAD DATA ( , , ) B I P Red
Head data of the head number being used during MMS, MDI MMS or manual measurement is partly missing.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

199 DIVISION BY ZERO ( , , ) B I P Red


An attempt has been made to carry out divisions by zero inside the NC unit during measurement of the
Cause degree-of-straightness on the MEASURE display.

Check the touch sensor for abnormalities.


Action
Carry out measurements once again if the touch sensor is normal.

. d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-30
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1101 INTERFERE ( , , ) A K S Blue
Interference occurs between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering section 2>.
Cause

Tap the alarm clear button. When the alarm clear button is tapped, the interference check for the secondary check
Action distance is carried out.
When the RESET key is pressed, the process returns to the interference check for the primary check distance.
1102 INTERFERE ( , , ) A I P Red
Interference occurs between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering section 2>.
Cause

Press the RESET key to clear the alarm. When the RESET key is pressed, the process returns to the interference check

d .
Action for the primary check distance.

ve
Alternatively, disable the machine interference check to clear the alarm.

s er
1103 INTERFERE CHECK DATA OVERLOAD ( , , ) B L S Blue

re
The 3D interference check process cannot be performed within a proper time.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Set a simple workpiece model or a fixture model or a tool model.
Action

ll
.A
1104 RAPID FEED OVERRIDE SET AT 0 ( , , ) A K P Blue

N
The rapid feed override value set up on the operating panel is “0”.

O
Cause

TI
16

Set the override value other than “0”.


A
R
04

Action
PO
30

1105 SAFETY SHIELD CALCULATING ( , , ) B L S Blue


o.

O
N

Machine operation has been stopped because of a delay in interference check process.
C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

The machine will be restarted when the interference check process catches up with the operation.
Se

Action If this alarm recurs, set up a simplified material model, fixture model or tool model.
A
IM

1106 SAFETY SHIELD FAILURE (Cause, Alarm No., ) B L N Red


K

If the processing load of the PC is too high, it may not be possible to update the model properly.
ZA

A press of the RESET key returns operation to a normal state, thus allowing interference checks to be performed properly.
A

1. Creation of the model has failed.


M

2. The interference check process has not been performed properly.


YA

Cause 3. An NC-PC communications error (time-out error) has occurred.


3

4. An illegal access has been detected in processing at the NC side.


01

5. Preparation of the safety shield has not completed normally because an alarm occurred during preparation of the
)2

safety shield.
(c

* For causes 1 to 4, the alarm No. given as the argument is not effective.
ht

Review and correct the parameter and model data. Then press the RESET key.
ig

If this does not clear the alarm status, turn power off and then back on.
yr

Action If the alarm is not caused by software or hardware fault, pressing the RESET key to update the model may clear the alarm.
op

If the alarm cannot be cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
C

* For cause 5, take the necessary action according to the corrective action for the alarm number.

3-31
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1107 INCOMPLETE TOOL DATA ( , , ) B L N Red
1. Manual tool measurement results cannot be calculated because of tool data items remaining blank.
Cause 2. The “tool length” or “tool diameter (nominal diameter)” of the tool was not set in the tool data when executing an MDI
program. (MAZATROL tool length and tool diameter are enabled and bit 7 of parameter F84 is set to “1”.)
1. Confirm the settings of the machining section, rotational direction, and nose R in the tool data items, and enter the
correct data.
2. Review the tool data and set any missing data.
Action Related parameters (F84 bit 7, F92 bit 7, F93 bit 3)
When MAZATROL tool diameter is enabled (F92 bit 7 = 1), enter the “tool diameter (nominal diameter)”.
When MAZATROL tool length is enabled (F93 bit 3 = 1), enter the “tool length”.
If bit 7 of F84 is set to “0”, missing data will be ignored and the MDI program will be executed.

. d
ve
1108 CANNOT CHANGE OPERATION MODE ( , , ) A L Q Blue

er
The automatic operation key was pressed during tape operation.

s
Cause

re
ts
Changeover to memory operation mode during tape operation is prohibited. Reselect tape operation mode before
Action

gh
restarting operation.

ri
1109 TOOL LENGTH OVER ( , , ) B L N Red

ll
.A
The tool length input range has been overstepped as a result of tool measurement.
Cause

N
O
Use a tool of any tool length value falling within the range defined in parameters SU110–SU113.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

1110 —— ( , , )
PO
30

Cause ——
R
o.

O
N

C
al

Action ——
K
ri

ZA
Se

1111 —— ( , , )
A
IM

Cause ——
K
ZA

Action ——
A
M

1112 CANNOT DETACH SPINDLE (Spindle No., , ) B L O Red


YA

The spindle removal function was activated during spindle operation.


Cause
3
01

Stop the spindle before removing the spindle.


)2

Action
(c
ht

1113 —— ( , , )
ig

Cause ——
yr
op
C

Action ——

1114 SIMULTANEOUS AXIS EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K (L) P (S) Red
Commands that involve movement of axes exceeding the maximum number of simultaneously controllable axes have
Cause been specified.

Review the program.


Action

3-32
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1115 AXIS NUMBER ERROR ( No, , ) A K (L) O Blue
The Tx-/Ty-/Tz-axis was selected in the manual mode while in the conditions described below. Or, the Tx-/Ty-/Tz-axis was
selected during manual handle pulse interruption.
No. Cause
The axis number specified for K114 (or K226) as the horizontal axis of the orthogonal
0 × 00000001
coordinate system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
The axis number specified for K115 (or K227) as the vertical axis of the orthogonal coordinate
0 × 00000002
system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
The axis number specified for K116 (or K228) as the height axis of the orthogonal coordinate
0 × 00000004
system does not exist in the control path. Or, the axis is not a linear axis.
Cause The axis number specified for K121 (or K230) as the first rotary axis does not exist in the
0 × 00000008

.
control path. Or, the axis is not a rotary axis.

d
ve
The axis number specified for K125 (or K234) as the second rotary axis does not exist in the
0 × 00000010

er
control path. Or, the axis is not a rotary axis.

s
re
The first digit (direction of the first rotary axis) of the value specified for K117 (or K229) as the
0 × 00000020
direction of rotation of the rotary axis is incorrect.

ts
gh
The second digit (direction of the second rotary axis) of the value specified for K117 (or K229)
0 × 00000040
as the direction of rotation of the rotary axis is incorrect.

ri
0 × 00000080 The machine type set for K113 (or K225) is incorrect.

ll
.A
Set a correct value for parameters K113 to K117, K121, K125 (or parametersK225 to K230, K234).

N
Action

O
TI
16

( , ,
A )
R
04

PO

Cause
30

R
o.

Action
N

C
al

1122 INTERFERE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L N Red


ri

ZA
Se

Machine interference has been detected with the NC axis active in automatic operation mode.
A

Cause
IM

Press the RESET key. Modify the program to prevent machine interference from recurring.
K

Action
ZA

1123 ILLEGAL OPE (SAFETY SHIELD) (Cause, , ) A I P Red


A
M

The operations that make interference checking impossible were performed during automatic operation when the
YA

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function was valid.


The values of “Cause” denote the causes below.
3
01

1: After an EIA modal search under the invalid status of the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD in automatic operation mode,
Cause the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function was made valid in an attempt to start automatic
)2

operation.
(c

2: Following completion of the EIA modal search, manual operation mode was selected and after the axis was moved to a
ht

position different from that before the search, memory mode was reselected and a restart operation was attempted.
ig

3: An attempt was made to start the MDI operation at the same time for both the upper and the lower turret.
yr

Confirm the cause of the alarm. Also, avoid performing the corresponding operations when the Automatic Operation
op

INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function is valid.


C

Action
Alternatively, restart operation after making the automatic operation interference checking function invalid with the
Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD menu.
1124 ILLEGAL CYCLE START ( , , ) B L N Red
Starting either the hard disk, Ethernet, IC card, or tape operation was attempted when the Automatic Operation
Cause INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function was valid.

Interference checking during automatic operation is prohibited in the hard disk, Ethernet, IC card, or tape operation mode.
Action Restart operation after making the automatic operation interference checking function invalid with the Automatic Operation
INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD menu.

3-33
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1125 SAFETY SHIELD CALCULATING ( , , ) A L Q Blue
1. Calculation for interference checking during automatic operation is in progress.
2. An NC alarm or PLC alarm occurs at the pre-read block. Or an M code is not completed at the pre-read block.
Cause
When the cause is No. 1 above, nothing will be displayed in parentheses.
When the cause is No. 2 above, contributing factors 1, 2 and 3 will be displayed in the parentheses.
1. When the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function is valid, the start of automatic operation
displays this alarm message, but the alarm will be automatically cleared when the calculation is completed.
If this alarm occurs except during the start of automatic operation, change the model to a simple one.
Action
If the single block or feed hold signal is input while an alarm is active, the next operation is not executed even when the
alarm is cleared and the machine remains stopped until the cycle start button is pressed again.
2. Report the arguments (contributing factors 1, 2 and 3) to the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

d .
1126 —— ( , , )

ve
er
Cause ——

s
re
ts
Action ——

gh
ri
1127 INVALID SAFETY SHIELD ( , , ) B L S Blue

ll
The INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD for automatic operation has been canceled.

.A
1. With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, a command which is not compatible with

N
interference check was executed.

O
Cause
2. With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, an attempt was made to start a program

TI
16

stored in the storage areas for Hard Disk operation, Ethernet operation, and IC Card operation, or a program prepared
A
for Tape operation.
R
04

PO

Tap the alarm clear button to clear the alarm. Be all the more cautious of allowing interference because the INTELLIGENT
30

Action SAFETY SHIELD is not working.


R
o.

O
N

1128 SAFETY SHIELD CONDITION CHANGED ( , , ) A L S Blue


C
al

With the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD being valid for automatic operation, the feed-overriding value has been
ri

Cause
ZA

changed.
Se

Tap the alarm clear button to clear the alarm. In addition, take care about interference because the actual operation may
IM

Action differ from the result of the interference check due to the change in the feed rate override.
K

1129 MEMORY PROTECT (SAFETY SHIELD) ( , , ) A L S Blue


ZA

An attempt was made to change the part count value manually during automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD
A

Cause function set valid.


M
YA

Set the part count value before starting the operation, or perform automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD function
Action set invalid.
3
01

1130 EXCESSIVE SPACE ERROR COMP. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue


)2

The amount of space error compensation has exceeded the upper limit.
(c

Cause
ht

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


ig

Action
yr
op

1131 NO SPACE ERROR COMP. DATA ( , , ) A I P Red


C

The space error compensation function is not operating properly.


Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

3-34
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1132 ILLEGAL CHOPPING CONDITION (Cause, , ) A I P Red
1. The chopping axis is in the servo-off or removed status.
2. The chopping axis is the rotating axis, basic axis or tilting axis under tilt control, or tandem axis.
3. The top dead point and the bottom dead point are the same.
4. The chopping axis has not been returned to its zero point.
5. An attempt was made to start chopping when the chopping axis is selected for the axis to control manually.
Cause
6. The chopping feed rate is zero.
7. An attempt was made to change the chopping axis during chopping.
8. An attempt was made in the replay mode of the fixed offset method to use an offset number of which record has not
been written.
9. An M-code command for axis movement is issued during chopping.

d .
ve
Press the RESET key. Take action below against respective causes described above.

er
1. Ensure that the chopping axis is not in the servo-off or removed status.

s
2. Select an axis other than the rotating axis, basic axis or tilting axis under tilt control, or tandem axis for the chopping

re
axis.

ts
3. Review the position of the top dead point or bottom dead point.

gh
Action 4. Return the chopping axis to its zero point.

ri
5. Select another axis for an axis to control manually and start chopping.

ll
.A
6. Review the chopping feed rate setting.

N
7. Do not change the chopping axis during chopping.

O
8. Use an offset number of which recording is finished in the replay mode of the fixed offset method.

TI
9. Do not issue any M-code command for axis movement during chopping.
16

A
R
04

1133 ILLEGAL OPERATION IN CHOPPING (Cause, , ) A L Q Blue


PO
30

Manual interrupt or zero-point return mode for the chopping axis is selected during chopping.
Cause
R
o.

O
N

Do not attempt to select manual interrupt for the chopping axis during chopping. Do not select the zero-point return mode.
Action
al

Remove the cause and tap the alarm clear button.


ri

ZA
Se

1134 CHOPPING OVERRIDE SET AT 0 (Cause, , ) A K Q Blue


A

The chopping override value is zero.


IM

Cause
K

Set a value other than “0” for the chopping override.


ZA

Action
A
M

1135 —— ( , , )
YA

Cause ——
3
01
)2

Action ——
(c

B K P Red
ht

1136 HOB WORK SPINDLE ROT. EXCEEDED ( , , )


ig

The work spindle speed exceeded the clamp speed during hobbing.
Cause
yr
op

Check and correct the spindle speed or the Z-axis feedrate so that the work spindle speed does not exceed the clamp
C

Action speed, and then restart the operation.

1137 SAFETY SHIELD CONDITION CHANGED ( , , ) A L S Blue


The machine has been operated using a spare tool with the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function while automatic
Cause operation was enabled.

Tap the alarm clear button. In addition, take care about interference because the actual operation may differ from the
Action result of the interference check due to the difference between the actual tool and the tool model used for interference
check.

3-35
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1138 INVALID SAFETY SHIELD(MATERIAL) ( , , ) A L S Blue
A material interference check cannot be carried out while the modal restarting process of the EIA/ISO program is in
Cause progress.

Check that there is no interference with the material along the path from the current position to the restarting start position.
Action Retract the tool to a safe position before executing modal restart of the EIA/ISO program.

1139 ILLEGAL COMMAND (SAFETY SHIELD) ( , , ) A K S Red


With parameter settings of F156 bit0 = 0 and F156 bit1 = 1, a cutting command that incorporates a rotary axis travel was
executed while one of the following interpolation modes was active.
 With the C-/U-axis
Cause
Interpolation other than G7.1 (cylindrical interpolation) or G12.1 (polar coordinate interpolation) active

. d
 With the B-axis

ve
Interpolation active

er
Add the material model cutting invalid M-code in the program before starting the operation.

s
re
It is also possible to select whether the operation should be continued or stopped by an alarm by using the following

ts
parameter settings.

gh
0 1

ri
Action F156 bit0 Continue operation with material cutting According to the setting of F156 bit1

ll
enabled only at the end position.

.A
F156 bit1 Continue operation with material cutting Stop with an alarm

N
disabled.

O
TI
16

1140 —— ( , , A )
R
04

PO

Cause ——
30

R
o.

O
N

Action ——
C
al

K
ri

1141 ILLEGAL OPER CUTTING PT CTRL ( , , ) A K (L) O (S) Blue


ZA
Se

1. When the cutting point control mode was valid, automatic operation was restarted after manual interruption from a
A

position that differs from the position where manual interruption was called.
IM

2. When the cutting point command function is valid, automatic operation was restarted after manual interruption from a
K

Cause rotary axis position that differs from the rotary axis position where manual interruption was called.
ZA

3. When the cutting point command function is valid, automatic operation handle interruption or MDI interruption was
performed.
A
M

4. When the cutting point command function is valid, the mode was changed to the zero-point return mode.
YA

1. After manual interruption, in the state the cutting point command function is valid, restart automatic operation only after
returning the axes to the position where they were located before manual interruption.
3
01

2. After manual interruption, in the state the cutting point command function is valid, restart automatic operation only after
returning the rotary axis to the position where it was located before manual interruption.
)2

Action
3. Do not attempt automatic operation handle interruption or MDI interruption when the cutting point command function is
(c

valid.
ht

4. When the cutting point command function is valid, changing the mode to the zero-point return mode is not allowed.
ig

Change the mode to a permissible mode.


yr
op

( , , )
C

Cause

Action

1145 ILLEGAL OPER CUTTING PT CTRL (WNo., NNo. , BNo. ) A K (L) O (S) Red
User macro interruption occurred in the block in which the tool path passes a singular point.
Cause

Eliminate the cause of occurrence of user macro interruption.


Action

3-36
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
( , , )

Cause

Action

1152 CANNOT USE ORBIT MACHINING (Cause, , ) A K (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. G149 was specified without specifying a rotation stop M code during orbit machining.
2. G148 (orbit machining mode ON) was specified while the mill spindle was rotating.
3. G148 was specified for a machine that does not feature a mill spindle.
Cause 4. A cross machining command was specified while in the orbit machining mode.

.d
ve
5. Simplified synchronization control was attempted while in the orbit machining mode.

er
6. Superimposition axis control was attempted while in the orbit machining mode.

s
7. Orbit machining was attempted during inclined-axis control.

re
1. Specify a rotation stop M code before specifying G149.

ts
gh
2. Stop mill spindle rotation before specifying G148.
3. The machine does not support orbit machining. Review the program.

ri
Action

ll
4. No cross machining command can be specified in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.

.A
5. Simplified synchronization control is not possible in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.

N
6. Superimposition axis control is not possible in the orbit machining mode. Review the program.

O
7. Orbit machining is not possible during inclined-axis control. Review the program.

TI
16

1153 ILLEGAL OPER IN ORBIT MACHINING (Cause, A , ) A K Q Blue


R
04

1. The MDI mode was selected during orbit machining.


PO
30

Cause 2. The manual operation mode was selected during orbit machining.
R
o.

O
N

1. Manual interruption using the MDI mode is not possible during orbit machining. Reselect the previous operation
C

Action mode.
al

K
ri

2. The manual operation mode cannot be selected during orbit machining. Reselect the previous operation mode.
ZA
Se

1154 FEED LIMITED IN ORBIT MACHINING ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

The feedrate/speed of any of the X-/Y-/Z-axis and mill spindle was clamped at the value set for parameter M1, M67 or
Cause M68.
K
ZA

Review the spindle speed commands (S command) or feedrate commands (F commands) specified in the program or the
A

Action override setting.


M

If display of this alarm is not necessary, set bit 4 of parameter K257 to “0”.
YA

1155 G124 MOTION RANGE EXCEEDED (Axis name, , ) B K P Red


3

1. The position of the fundamental axis or parallel axis was outside the movement range upon specifying G124.
01

Cause
2. The fundamental axis or parallel axis has moved beyond the specified movement range in the G124 mode.
)2
(c

1. Move the fundamental axis and parallel axis inside their movement ranges before specifying G124.
Action
ht

2. Correct the program so that the axis concerned move within the movement range.
ig

1156 —— ( , , )
yr
op

Cause ——
C

Action ——

3-37
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1157 ILLEGAL OPERATION IN ENGRAVING ( , , ) A K Q Blue
Any of the following operations was attempted while executing the engraving function.
1. Manual interruption
Cause
2. Manual pulse handle interruption
3. MDI interruption
Do not perform operations 1 to 3 above while executing the engraving function.
Action

1158 SENSOR ON WITH MOVING MULTI-AX ( , , ) A K O Red


During manual tool measurement (with TOOL EYE), the sensor was turned ON while multiple measurement axes (*) were
Cause moving.

d .
* The measurement axes vary depending on the machine model.

ve
Move the tool away from the TOOL EYE sensor (Sensor ON  Sensor OFF)

er
Action Pressing the RESET key with the sensor turned OFF clears the alarm.

s
re
After confirming that the alarm has been cleared, restart the measurement.

ts
1159 ILLEGAL WRITING TOOL-OFFSET ( , , ) A K O Red

gh
During manual tool measurement (with TOOL EYE), the sensor was turned ON without specifying the destination for

ri
Cause writing the tool offset for tool offset measurement.

ll
.A
Move the TOOL EYE sensor away from the tool and turn the sensor OFF.

N
Action Pressing the RESET key with the sensor turned OFF clears the alarm.

O
After confirming that the alarm has been cleared, set the destination for writing the tool offset and restart the measurement.

TI
16

1160 SAFETY SHIELD SYNCHRONOUS ( , A , ) B L S Blue


R
04

When an M code for canceling the disabled status of the automatic operation safety shield is specified, operation stops
PO

Cause until synchronization for restarting the interference check is completed. Operation restarts when the synchronization has
30

completed.
R
o.

Wait until the synchronization for the interference check has completed.
N

Action
C
al

K
ri

ZA

( , , )
Se

Cause
IM
K

Action
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-38
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
3-2-4 No. 200 - No. 399, No. 1200 - No. 1399 (PLC machine control error)
To clear PLC machine control errors (No. 200 to No. 399, No. 1200 to No. 1399), first eliminate
the cause of the alarm and tap the alarm clear button or press the RESET key.
Alarm-related detector SQ Nos. that vary depending on the model are given for each model.

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
200 HYDRAULIC UNIT The hydraulic pressure has dropped continuously Feed hold Chiller unit
(F0) PRESSURE DOWN for 2 or more seconds. Spindle stop X1305
201 CHILLER The hydraulic pressure has dropped continuously Stop in the single block Hydraulic
(F1) MALFUNCTION for 2 or more seconds. operation mode temperature
control unit
X130F

d .
ve
202 AIR PRESSURE The air pressure for spindle lubrication has Feed hold SP5
(F2) DOWN dropped. Spindle stop X1242

s er
206 SPINDLE LUB. Alarm related to the spindle lubrication chiller unit Feed hold Chiller unit

re
(F6) CHILLER MALF. Spindle stop X1316

ts
207 IRREGULAR Lubrication pressure does not reduce while the Stop in the single block Pressure switch

gh
(F7) SLIDEWAY OIL grease lubrication pump is at a stop. operation mode SP11

ri
PRESSURE X1245

ll
209 SLIDEWAY OIL Lubrication pressure is not built up although the Stop in the single block Pressure switch

.A
(F9) MALFUNCTION grease lubrication pump is operating. operation mode SP11

N
X1245

O
TI
211 SPINDLE Alarm related to the spindle controller Feed hold Spindle controller
16

(F11) CONTROLLER A Spindle stop X323


MALFUNCTION
R
04

PO

212 MAGAZINE DRUM Alarm related to the magazine driver Magazine rotation stop Magazine driver
30

(F12) MALFUNCTION A30


R
o.

M17228, M17229
O
N

M17231, M17233
al

M17235
ri

ZA
Se

213 INDEX TABLE Alarm related to the index table driver Feed hold Table driver
A

(F13) DRIVER Spindle stop A31


IM

MALFUNCTION M17328, M17329


M17331, M17333
K
ZA

M17335
214 ILLEGAL TOOL A tool was selected for which the tool data has Magazine rotation stop
A

(F14) DESIGNATED been specified as invalid.


M
YA

217 THERMAL TRIP The thermal relay in one of the auxiliary motors or Feed hold KM11, KM12,
(F17) the 100 V circuit protector has been tripped. Spindle stop KM18, KM76,
3

QF7, QF8,
01

X131A
)2

218 CONVEYOR The thermal relay in the motor of the chip Stop in the single block KM15, KM16,
(c

(F18) THERMAL TRIP conveyor or chip screw has been tripped. operation mode KM13
X131B
ht
ig

219 MAIN The temperature of the main power transformer Stop in the single block Main transformer
yr

(F19) TRANSFORMER has exceeded 120°C (248°F). operation mode X1310


OVERHEAT Spindle stop
op
C

222 AFC OVERLOAD Spindle load does not drop even when feed Feed hold
(F22) override is reduced by AFC.
223 TOOL MEAS. UNIT An attempt has been made to perform a semi- No operation start
(F23) NOT IN POS automatic tool length measurement without the
measuring unit being extended.
224 ILLEGAL TOOL FOR 1. An attempt has been made to measure a No operation start
(F24) TOOL LGTH MEAS touch sensor or chip removal tool.
2. An attempt has been made during a fully
automatic tool length measurement to
measure an inverted spot facing, boring,
back boring, chamfering, face milling or
special cutter.

3-39
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
225 TOOL LIFE OVER Accumulated application time of the tool has Stop in the single block
(F25) exceeded its specified life. operation mode if M58 is
given while this alarm
message is displayed.
To continue operation,
tap the alarm clear
button and then press
the cycle start button.
226 TOOL BREAKAGE A broken tool has been detected by the M35 Stop in the single block
(F26) command. Alternatively, a broken tool has been operation mode
mounted on the spindle. Spindle stop
227 SIMULTANEOUS M M-codes have been assigned which cannot be No operation start
(F27) CODE OPERATION processed simultaneously. Machine stop

d.
ve
228 ILLEGAL M CODE An M-code has been assigned which is not No completion signal

er
(F28) included in the specifications. returned, operation stop

s
229 INVALID SCREEN An attempt has been made to start a memory or Feed hold

re
(F29) FOR CYCLE START tape operation with a display other than

ts
POSITION or TRACE on the screen.

gh
230 ILLEGAL MMS UNIT Some form of trouble has occurred in the MMS Feed hold MMS ERROR

ri
(F30) unit and the required signal was not output. Spindle stop X1317

ll
MMS LOW BATT

.A
X1318

N
232 MACHINE DOOR The machine door has been opened. Feed hold SQ9

O
(F32) INTERLOCK Spindle stop X02

TI
Stop in the single block
16

A operation mode, etc.


R
04

233 MAGAZINE DOOR The magazine door was opened in the automatic Magazine rotation is SQ31
PO
30

(F33) INTERLOCK mode of operation. disabled. X04


R
o.

234 PALLET CHANGER The pallet changer safety door has been opened, Pallet changer operation SQ56
O
N

(F34) DOOR INTERLOCK or the door lock has been released. is disabled. X05
C
al

235 MAGAZINE MANUAL Manual interruption was made valid by the switch Only display of message SB1000
ri

ZA

(F35) INTERRUPT concerned on the magazine side. (Automatic magazine X1600


Se

indexing suspended [NC


A

call stop] )
IM

236 HOLD PALLET Pallet change command was given with the Only display of message
K

(F36) CHANGE machine menu displayed on the screen. (Automatic pallet change
ZA

suspended [NC call


stop] )
A
M

237 MAGAZINE DOOR The magazine door is open. Only display of message SQ31
YA

(F37) OPENED X04


238 AUTO TOOL CHANGE The operation has been stopped due to the Operation is stopped
3
01

(F38) STOP selection of [ATC STOP]. immediately before ATC.


Deselect [ATC STOP],
)2

and then press the cycle


(c

start button to resume


ht

the ATC operation.


ig

240 OPERATION An attempt was made to start restart operation Feed hold
yr

(F40) RESTART without having completed the EIA restart setting.


op

UNFINISHED
C

241 SPINDLE ROTATION The zero speed signal remains ON even though Feed hold Y395, X324
(F41) ABNORMAL a spindle rotation command has been given. Spindle stop
242 SPINDLE ORIENT The spindle orient command does not result in Waiting for input of Y3A6, X326
(F42) TIME OVER the orient check signal being turned ON within 10 spindle orient check
seconds. signal 1
244 ZERO SIGNAL OFF IN The spindle zero speed check signal turned OFF Only display of message Y3A6, X324
(F44) SPDL ORIENT while the orient check signal was ON.
246 VERIFY TL DATA The specified spindle speed is over the safety Spindle speed restricted
(F46) SP-SPEED SETTING speed calculated using the tool data. or Feed hold

3-40
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
250 TOOL LENGTH The extension sensor does not turn ON in spite of Stop in the single block SQ40
(F50) EXTEND SENSOR the command for extending the measuring unit. operation mode X124C
MALF. Alternatively, the extension sensor does not turn
OFF in spite of the command for retracting the
measuring unit. (20 seconds)
251 TOOL LENGTH The retraction sensor does not turn ON in spite of Stop in the single block SQ41
(F51) RETRACT SENSOR the command for retracting the measuring unit. operation mode X124D
MALF Alternatively, the retraction sensor does not turn
OFF in spite of the command for extending the
measuring unit. (20 seconds)
252 DECELERATION During tool length measurement, a skip signal Feed hold SQ43
(F52) SENSOR MALF. was received without the preceding deceleration X17C
signal.

d .
ve
253 SKIP SENSOR During tool length measurement, the skip signal Feed hold SQ42

er
(F53) MALFUNCTION was not received in time after the deceleration X17D
signal.

s
re
256 TOOL CLAMP The clamp sensor does not turn ON in spite of a Feed hold SQ11

ts
(F56) SENSOR tool clamp command. Alternatively, it does not Spindle stop X1241

gh
MALFUNCTION turn OFF in spite of a tool unclamp command.
(20 seconds)

ri
(5 seconds for HSK tool)

ll
.A
257 TOOL UNCLAMP The unclamp sensor does not turn ON in spite of Feed hold SQ10
(F57) SENSOR a tool unclamp command. Alternatively, it does Spindle stop

N
X1240
MALFUNCTION not turn OFF in spite of a tool clamp command.

O
(20 seconds)

TI
16

(5 seconds for HSK tool) A


R
04

258 ATC COVER SENSOR The open sensor does not turn ON in spite of the Stop in the single block SQ22
PO

(F58) (OPEN) MALF. command for opening the ATC cover. operation mode
30

HCN-6000,
(30 seconds) 6800: X1208
R
o.

HCN-8800,
N

10800,
al

8800, 10800:
K
ri

X1408
ZA
Se

259 ATC COVER SENSOR The close sensor does not turn ON in spite of the Stop in the single block SQ23
A

(F59) (CLOSE) MALF. command for closing the ATC cover. operation mode
IM

HCN-6000, 6800:
(30 seconds) X1209
K

HCN-8800,
ZA

10800,
8800, 10800:
A

X1409
M
YA

266 PALLET CLAMP The clamp sensor does not turn ON in spite of a Waiting for the sensor SP54
(F66) SENSOR MALF. pallet clamp command. Alternatively, it does not input signal X1248
3

turn OFF in spite of a pallet unclamp command. (Clamp detected with


01

sensor OFF)
)2

267 PALLET UNCLAMP The unclamp sensor does not turn ON in spite of Waiting for the sensor SP55
(c

(F67) SENSOR MALF. a pallet unclamp command. Alternatively, it does input signal X1249
not turn OFF in spite of a pallet clamp command (Unclamp detected with
ht

sensor OFF)
ig
yr

269 MAGAZINE STOP PIN The stop pin sensor does not turn ON although Waiting for sensor input
(F69) SENSOR MALF. magazine stop pin operation has been specified. signal
op

270 X AXIS ORIGIN Without initial zero-point return for the X-axis, a No operation start
C

(F70) RETURN UNFINISH command was given for ATC, tool length mea-
surement, pallet change, etc.
271 Y AXIS ORIGIN Without initial zero-point return for the Y-axis, a No operation start
(F71) RETURN UNFINISH command was given for ATC, tool length mea-
surement, pallet change, etc.
272 Z AXIS ORIGIN Without initial zero-point return for the Z-axis, a No operation start
(F72) RETURN UNFINISH command was given for ATC, tool length mea-
surement, pallet change, etc.
273 4 AXIS ORIGIN Without initial zero-point return for the 4th axis, a No operation start
(F73) RETURN UNFINISH command was given for ATC, tool length mea-
surement, pallet change, etc.

3-41
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
274 SPDL CANNOT ROT A spindle rotation command was given without Spindle rotation disabled SQ11, X1241
(F74) (UNCLAMPED TOOL) the tool being clamped. SQ10, X1240
275 SPDL CANNOT ROT A spindle rotation command was given with a Spindle rotation disabled
(F75) (SPECIAL TOOL) special tool (touch sensor, chip removing tool) on
the spindle.
276 SPDL CANNOT ROT The spindle cannot be started since the ATC arm Spindle rotation disabled
(F76) (ATC ARM POS) is not positioned appropriately.
280 NO ORIENT A spindle orient command was given without the Spindle orientation SQ11, X1241
(F80) (UNCLAMPED TOOL) tool being clamped. disabled SQ10, X1240
281 NO SPDL ORIENT A spindle orient command was given with a Spindle orientation
(F81) (SPECIAL TOOL) special tool (touch sensor, chip removing tool) on disabled
the spindle.

d .
ve
282 NO ORIENT (ATC A spindle orient command was given without the Spindle orientation
(F82) ARM POS. ERROR) ATC arm being positioned appropriately. disabled

er
s
283 NOT UNCLAMPED A tool unclamp command was enabled while Tool unclamp disabled M13502

re
(F83) (NOT STOP SPINDLE) tapping [SPDL JOG] or the spindle was rotating.

ts
284 NOT UNCLAMPED A tool unclamp command was enabled while the Tool unclamp disabled Y3A6

gh
(F84) (SPDL ORI. UNFIN) spindle was not oriented. X326

ri
285 NOT UNCLAMPED A tool unclamp command was enabled in other Tool unclamp disabled

ll
(F85) (NOT MANUAL than the manual mode.

.A
MODE)

N
286 NOT AUTO MODE An attempt was made to select the automatic Mode change disabled SQ11, X1241

O
(F86) (UNCLAMPED TOOL) mode with the tool still unclamped. SQ10, X1240

TI
287 NOT AUTO MODE An attempt was made to select the automatic Mode change disabled SB1000
16

(F87) (MAG. MANUAL


A
mode during manual magazine operation. X1600
R
04

OPER)
PO
30

289 NO TOOL LOAD A tool loading command was given without the Operation is disabled. HCN-6000, 6800:
R

(F89) (ARM/SFTER POS ATC arm being positioned correctly.


o.

40T
O
N

ERR) SQ26, X1200


C
al

SQ25, X1202
K
ri

ZA

80T
Se

SQ36, X1201
A

SQ37, X1202
IM

HCN-8800,
K

10800,
ZA

8800, 10800:
40T
A
M

SQ26, X1400
SQ25, X1402
YA

80T
3

SQ36, X1401
01

SQ37, X1402
)2

290 NO TOOL LOAD A tool loading command was given without the Operation is disabled.
(c

(F90) (MAGAZINE POS magazine being indexed correctly.


ERR)
ht
ig

291 NO TOOL UNLOAD A tool unloading command was given with an Operation is disabled. SQ34
yr

(F91) (TOOL IN MAG.) occupied magazine pocket being indexed. HCN-6000,


op

6800: X1204
HCN-8800,
C

10800,
8800, 10800:
X1404

3-42
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
292 NO UNLOAD A tool unloading command was given without the Operation is disabled. HCN-6000, 6800:
(F92) (ARM/SHIFTER POS ATC arm being positioned correctly. 40T
ERR) SQ26, X1200
SQ25, X1202
80T
SQ36, X1201
SQ37, X1202
HCN-8800,
10800,
8800, 10800:
40T
SQ26, X1400

d .
SQ25, X1402

ve
80T

er
SQ36, X1401

s
SQ37, X1402

re
293 NO TOOL UNLOAD A tool unloading command was given without the Operation is disabled.

ts
(F93) (MAG. POS ERROR) magazine being indexed correctly.

gh
294 NO TOOL SELECT Magazine indexing was not possible since the Operation is disabled.

ri
(F94) (INCORRECT TNo.) specified tool number was zero, or higher than

ll
the number of the magazine pockets provided.

.A
295 NO TOOL SELECT A magazine indexing command is given without Operation is disabled.

N
(F95) (ARM/SFT POS ERR) the shifter being positioned correctly.

O
TI
296 NO TOOLCHANGE An EIA program’s tool change command (which Operation is disabled.
16

(F96) (AXIS NOT ATC POS) does not include the positioning in question) is
A
not preceded by the required axis movement
R
04

PO

commands for the ATC position.


30

300 MAGAZINE SHIFTER A loading or unloading command for the Waiting for the sensor HCN-6000, 6800:
R
o.

(F100) POS.MALF. magazine shifter has not been completed within input signal
O

40T
N

10 seconds.
C

SQ26, X1200
al

The magazine shifter was not stopped at the SQ25, X1202


ri

ZA

correct stand-by position. 80T


Se

SQ36, X1201
A

SQ37, X1202
IM

HCN-8800,
K

10800,
ZA

8800, 10800:
A

40T
M

SQ26, X1400
YA

SQ25, X1402
80T
3

SQ36, X1401
01

SQ37, X1402
)2

301 MAGAZINE SHIFTER 1. An ATC command was given in the state the Operation is disabled. HCN-6000, 6800:
(c

(F101) MISS OP. magazine shifter is at the ATC side without a 40T
ht

tool in the spindle nor in the ATC standby SQ26, X1200


pocket (this is unusual state and, thus, tool
ig

SQ25, X1202
loading is impossible).
yr

80T
op

2. An ATC command was given in the state the SQ36, X1201


magazine shifter is at the magazine side with
C

SQ37, X1202
a tool held in both the spindle and the ATC
HCN-8800,
standby pocket (this is unusual state and,
thus, tool unloading is impossible). 10800,
8800, 10800:
3. In manual magazine shifter operation for
40T
maintenance, the ATC standby pocket is not
in a position allowing the shifter operation. SQ26, X1400
SQ25, X1402
80T
SQ36, X1401
SQ37, X1402

3-43
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
302 ATC WAIT POCKET A command for rotating the ATC standby pocket Waiting for the sensor HCN-6000, 6800:
(F102) PROX. MALF. has not been completed within 10 seconds. input signal SQ27, X1205
The ATC standby pocket was not stopped at the SQ28, X1206
correct stand-by position. HCN-8800,
10800,
8800, 10800:
SQ27, X1405
SQ28, X1406
303 ATC WAIT POCKET A command for rotating the ATC standby pocket Operation is disabled. HCN-6000, 6800:
(F103) MISS OP. was given although the ATC arm or the magazine SQ36, X1201
shifter was not at the correct position. SQ37, X1202
HCN-8800,

.
10800,

d
ve
8800, 10800:
SQ36, X1401

er
SQ37, X1402

s
re
304 ATC ARM POSITION The ATC arm rotation was stopped at an incor- Only display of message

ts
(F104) MALF. rect position. (10 seconds)

gh
The ATC operation has not been completed

ri
within 10 seconds.

ll
305 MAGAZINE SHIFTER The thermal relay of the magazine shifter motor Operation is disabled. FR14

.A
(F105) THERMAL TRIP was tripped (due to an overcurrent). HCN-6000,

N
The alarm state cannot be eliminated until the 6800: X1225

O
thermal relay is reset automatically. HCN-8800,

TI
(For magazines with 80/120 pockets only) 8800: X1425
16

306 ATC ARM DRIVER


A
An alarm occurred with the motor driver for ATC Operation is disabled.
R
04

PO

(F106) ALARM arm rotation.


30

307 COVER COOLANT This warning message is displayed if cover Only display of message
R
o.

OFF --> ON coolant is not discharged when the memory


O

(F107)
N

mode is selected after pressing the power ON


C
al

button.
K
ri

ZA

308 M.M.S. ALARM The skip signal for the touch sensor was turned Emergency stop Skip signal
Se

(F108) on untimely in the step of rapid traverse. X178


A
IM

309 PALLET DRIVER An alarm occurred with the motor driver for pallet Operation is disabled.
(F109) ALARM changer rotation.
K

311 SCALE AIR The scale air pressure is low. Only display of message SP14
ZA

(F111) PRESSURE DOWN X1243


A

312 PALLET ARM UP RS. The upper end sensor does not turn ON during Waiting for sensor input SQ53
M

(F112) MALF. pallet arm rotation. (Only with HCN-8800 or signal


YA

HCN- 8800,
10800) 8800: X1223
3

HCN-10800,
01

10800: X1823
)2

313 PALLET ARM DOWN The lower end sensor for the pallet arm does not Waiting for the sensor SQ52
(c

(F113) RS. MALF. come into action although the pallet arm rotation input signal HCN-6000,
ht

was completed. 6800: X122B


ig

HCN-8800,
yr

10800,
op

8800, 10800:
C

X1224
314 PALLET ARM The pallet arm rotation was stopped at an incor- Only display of message
(F114) POSITION MALF. rect position. (30 seconds)
The pallet arm rotation has not been completed
within 30 seconds.
(Adjustable with HCN-10800 only)

3-44
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
319 PC_MOP. A pallet change command was given without the Only display of message SQ23
(F119) (ATC COVER OPEN) ATC cover being closed. HCN-6000,
6800: X1209
HCN-8800,
10800,
8800, 10800:
X1409
320 PC_MOP. A pallet change command was given without the NC call stop
(F120) (NOT TABLE 0 DEG) table being in the 0° position.
321 PC_MOP. A pallet change command was given with the tool NC call stop SQ40, X124C
(F121) (M-ARM EXT.) length measuring unit being extended. SQ41, X124D
322 PC_MOP. A pallet change command was given without NC call stop

d .
(F122) (NOT Z ZERO POSI.) Z-axis positioning at the second zero point.

ve
er
323 PC_MOP. Operation error for 6-pallet changer (option) NC call stop
(F123)

s
Operation error for pallet changer (FMS option)

re
324 PC_MOP. The pallet stand is not locked at the 0° position. NC call stop HCN-6000, 6800,

ts
(F124) (NOT STAND 0 DEG.) 8800, 8800:

gh
2PC

ri
SQ57, X1228

ll
FMS

.A
SQ66, X1228

N
HCN-10800,

O
10800:

TI
2PC
16

A SQ57, X1828
R
04

FMS
PO
30

SQ66, X1828
R

325 INDEX MOP. A command for rotating the index table was given NC call stop SQ40, X124C
o.

O
N

(F125) (M-ARM EXT.) with the tool length measuring unit being ex- SQ41, X124D
C

tended.
al

K
ri

326 INDEX MOP. The angle specified in a command for rotating the NC call stop
ZA
Se

(F126) (CMD TOO LARGE) index table was out of setting range:
A

0  CMD  359.
IM

327 INDEX MISS OP. A command for rotating the index table was given Only display of message X23C
(F127) with the pallet being unclamped.
K
ZA

A command for rotating the index table was given


although NC rotary table (optional) was used.
A
M

328 PALLET 1 CYCLE A table index command was given although the Machining cycle can be
YA

(F128) STOP pallet was unclamped. started by turning on the


setup completed
3

indicator lamp by
01

pressing the setup


)2

completed key after


mounting workpieces on
(c

the pallet.
ht

329 TOOL CHANGE MISS A tool change command was given although the Arm is not at 0° position.
ig

(F129) OP. ATC arm was not in the correct position. Arm is not retracted.
yr

A manual tool change command was given Shifter is not at waiting SQ37
op

although the magazine shifter was not at the position. HCN-6000,


C

waiting position. 6800: X1202


HCN-8800,
10800,
8800, 10800:
X1402

3-45
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
330 PALLET CLAMP/ Pallet clamp or unclamp was attempted although Pallet change hook not
(F130) UNCLAMP MISS OP. the pallet changer hook was not at the required at in/out end.
position. No Z-axis positioning to
An attempt was made to unclamp a pallet without the second zero point.
positioning on the Z-axis or the 4th-axis (or for Table not at 0°.
the index table) to the pallet change position nor
the table being clamped. Table not clamped.

331 MULTI PALLET MISS Multi pallet change operation error. Only display of message
(F131) OP. See Operating Manual for Multiple Pallet
Changer for details.
332 MULTI PALLET Multi pallet change alarm Only display of message
(F132) ALARM See Operating Manual for Multiple Pallet

d .
Changer for details.

ve
333 SET UP SW.MISS.OP. The machine set up switch was set at the “I” (ON) The mode is not

er
(F133) (SP.ORIENT) position with the spindle stopped at the changed to the set up

s
re
orientation position. mode.

ts
334 ID AMP Communications with the ID controller have been Only display of message

gh
(F134) COMMUNICATION off for 60 seconds.
TIME OVER

ri
335 TABLE UNCLAMP The NC table rotation command was given Only display of message

ll
.A
(F135) MISS OP. although the pallet was not clamped.

N
336 ANALOG INPUT ERR. Analog input voltage too high. (Alarm for 0 V line Only display of message R2092 bit 5

O
(F136) (LEVEL SENSOR) disconnection)

TI
Analog input voltage too low. (Alarm for +24 V Only display of message R2092 bit 6
16

A
signal line disconnection) (option)
R
04

337 CURRENT TIME IS Current time is not set. Only display of message R2092 bit F
PO
30

(F137) NOT SET. (expanded self-diagnose function; option)


R
o.

338 PLEASE EXCHANGE Oil in the hydraulic unit must be changed. Only display of message R2092 bit 0
O
N

(F138) OIL(HYD. UNIT) (Expanded self-diagnose function; option)


C
al

339 PLEASE EXCHANGE Spindle lubricating oil must be changed. Only display of message R2092 bit 1
K
ri

ZA

(F139) OIL(SP. UNIT) (Expanded self-diagnose function; option)


Se

340 PLEASE SUPPLY OIL Slideway lubricating oil level is low. (option) Only display of message R2283
A

(F140) (WAY LUB-UNIT)


IM

341 PLEASE SUPPLY OIL Coolant level is low. Only display of message R2092 bit B
K

(F141) (COOLANT TANK) (Expanded self-diagnose function; option)


ZA

342 PLEASE SUPPLY OIL Spindle lubricating oil level is low. Only display of message R2092 bit 9
A

(F142) (SP.LUBE) (Expanded self-diagnose function; option) or C


M

344 PARAMETER ERROR A pocket number that cannot accommodate a Only display of message
YA

(F144) RS51-RS60 large diameter tool is set for parameters RS51 to


RS60.
3
01

345 CAN'T CLOSE ATC With the ATC cover open and a large diameter Only display of message
)2

(F145) COVER_BIG TOOL tool mounted in the spindle, an ATC cover close
command was specified while the X-axis was in
(c

the range where interference between the ATC


ht

cover and the large diameter tool could occur.


ig

348 PALLET UNCLAMP Pallet unclamp command was given with the Pallet unclamp SQ44
yr

(F148) MISS OP. table being unclamped. suspended. (Index table)


op

SP2
C

(NC rotary table)


X124A
349 TRANSMIT PUMP High-pressure coolant (option) Stop in the single block
(F149) OFF->ON operation mode
351 TOUCH SENSOR OFF The touch sensor does not turn ON. (option) Only display of message
(F151)
354 CHIP CONVEYOR The shock relay detected over-current of the chip Single block stop Chip conveyor
(F154) ALARM conveyor motor (option). X1315
355 OIL AIR UNIT The hydraulic pressure signal of the oil-air unit is Feed hold SP3
(F155) PRESSURE DOWN not turned ON/OFF. Spindle stop X124F

3-46
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
356 OIL AIR UNIT LEVEL Oil-air unit lubricating oil level is too low. Only display of message SL3
(F156) LOW HCN-6000, 6800,
8800, 8800:
X124E
HCN-10800,
10800: X180E
357 OIL AIR UNIT ALARM Oil-air unit lubricating oil level is left too low. Feed hold SL3
(F157) Spindle stop X124E
358 LINE FILTER Filter clogged signal does not remain ON for 5 Only display of message SP7, SP8, X1300
(F158) MALFUNCTION seconds or longer. (option)
359 LINE FILTER ALARM After the occurrence of F158, signal OFF state Stop in the single block SP7, SP8, X1300

.
(F159) has continued for more than 3 hours. (option) operation mode

d
ve
Spindle stop

er
362 HIGH PRE COOL A thermal trip alarm has occurred in the Feed hold

s
(F162) SYS.THERMAL TRIP high-pressure through-spindle coolant unit. Spindle stop

re
(option)

ts
363 HIGH PRE COOL A pressure alarm has occurred in the Feed hold

gh
(F163) SYS.PRE ALARM high-pressure through-spindle coolant unit. Spindle stop

ri
(option)

ll
365 TOOL HIVE DOOR The cycle start button was pressed while the Only display of message

.A
(F165) INTERLOCK TOOL HIVE door was open. (option)

N
366 TOOL HIVE Alarm related to TOOL HIVE (option) TOOL HIVE operation is

O
(F166) CONTROLLER disabled.

TI
ALARM
16

A
R
04

367 TOOL HIVE MOVING Manual ATC operation was attempted while the Only display of message
PO

(F167) TOOL HIVE was operating (option).


30

368 TOOL HIVE Manual TOOL HIVE interruption (option) Only display of message
R
o.

(F168) INTERRUPT
N

369 WARNING SET UP The machine set up switch is set at the “I” (ON) Only display of message SA4, X01
al

(F169) SW. ON! position in the automatic mode.


ri

ZA
Se

370 SPINDLE TRIAL Trial run is required (high-speed spindle; option). Only display of message
A

(F170) RUN !!
IM

372 HIGH PRESSURE Alarm occurred with the coolant unit (option). Feed hold
(F172) UNIT ALARM Spindle stop
K
ZA

373 WAITING TOOL In the automatic mode, 0 is displayed as the Only display of message
(F173) NUMBER ILLEGAL pocket number with the tool pot at the ATC side.
A
M

374 COOLANT LEVEL Coolant level is low (option). Feed hold X1304
(F174) TOO LOW Spindle stop
YA

375 COOLANT LEVEL Although the suction pump is turned on, coolant Only display of message
3

(F175) LOW WARNING tank level is not raised (option).


01

376 WORK NO. SEARCH The program specified for warm-up operation is Only display of message R487
)2

(F176) ERROR not found.


(c

377 WORK NO.SET The program number of the program for warm-up NC call stop R488
ht

(F177) ERROR operation is illegal: 0 or exceeding 9999. RS5 (R10984)


ig

378 WARMING UP !! (High-speed spindle option) Only display of message


yr

(F178)
op

379 SPINDLE OVER LOAD (High-speed spindle option) Only display of message
C

(F179)
380 PUSH MF1 TO READ Only display of message
(F180) SPINDLE LOAD
381 IMPOS. T-ID READ Tool ID readout was attempted though tool data Only display of message R3728
(F181) (T-DATA) exists. (R3728 = 0FF2H)
382 IMPOS. T-ID READ Tool ID readout was attempted though no tool or Only display of message R3728
(F182) (NO TOOL) a tool without tool ID was mounted. The tool ID
head not at the readout position.
(R3728 = 0FF5H)

3-47
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
383 TOOL ID READ Alarm No. 381 occurred. (R3728 = 0FF2H) Only display of message R3728
(F183) ALARM Alarm No. 382 occurred. (R3728 = 0FF5H)
Tool ID data readout not completed within the
preset time. (R3728 = 0FF1H)
Response signal remaining on.
(R3728 = 0FF4H)
Communication impossible. (Response signal
remaining off). (R3728 = 0FF6H)
Tool data exists. Tool ID exists. (Readout
according to the command from tool transport
system failed.)

d.
384 IMPOS. T-ID WRITE Tool ID data writing was attempted without tool Only display of message R3792

ve
(F184) (NO DATA) data. (R3792 = 0H)

er
385 IMPOS. T-ID WRITE Tool ID data writing was attempted without a tool Only display of message

s
(F185) (NO TOOL) or a tool not equipped with tool ID.

re
The tool ID head not at the writing position.

ts
(R2554 = 0D6CH)

gh
386 TOOL ID WRITE Alarm No. 384 occurred. (R2080 = 201H) Only display of message R2080

ri
(F186) ALARM Alarm No. 385 occurred. (R2080 = 202H)

ll
.A
Tool ID data writing not completed within the
preset time. (R2080 = 220H)

N
O
Response signal remaining on.

TI
(R2080 = 221H)
16

Read tool No. is 0 or tool large.A


R
04

(R2080 = 222H)
PO
30

Communication impossible. (Response signal


R

remaining off). (R2080 = 223H)


o.

O
N

No tool data. (Writing according to the command


C

from tool transport system failed.)


al

(R2080 = 210H)
ri

ZA
Se

388 PALLET ID ALARM Only display of message R2018


A

(F188)
IM

389 PALLET ID UP/DOWN Pallet ID head upper or lower end detection Only display of message
K

(F189) SENSOR MALF. sensor does not go ON.


ZA

390 U-AXIS ORIGIN The specified U-axis zero-point return direction is Only display of message
(F190) RETURN MISS OP. illegal.
A
M

391 THERMAL Alarm No. 392 occurred 10 times. Feed hold R4630 to R4639
YA

(F191) DISPLACEMENT Spindle stop


SYSTEM ER
3

392 THERMAL Spindle temperature alarm Feed hold R2033, D1439


01

(F192) DISPLACEMENT Temperature difference between spindle and Spindle stop


)2

OFFSET ER base became 30°C (86°F) or more. The interruption of oper-


(c

(R2033 bit 1: ON) ation by this alarm can


ht

be suppressed by set-
Parameter error
ig

ting RB10 bit 3 to “1”.


yr

Thermal displacement compensation parameter


out of specified range.
op

(R2033 bit 2: ON)


C

The thermal displacement compensation level


has exceeded 500 m.
(R2033 bit7: ON)
Hardware error
Disconnection, short circuit etc. occurred in the
temperature sensor for compensation.
(R2033: bit 3 ON)
The workpiece No. where the error occurred is
displayed at *1.

3-48
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
394 COOLANT STOP!! The cycle start button was pressed with the Only display of message
(F194) coolant stop key turned ON.
395 TOUCH SENSOR The touch sensor battery voltage has dropped. Feed hold
(F195) BATTERY LEVEL Spindle stop
LOW
396 SAVING ENERGY The machine entered the standby mode. Only display of message
(F196) MODE
397 TABLE CLAMP PRS. The table clamp sensor is not turned on although Waiting for the sensor SQ44
(F197) ALARM the table clamp command is assigned, or the input signal (Index table)
table clamp sensor is not turned off although the SP2
table unclamp command is assigned. (NC rotary table)
X124A

d .
ve
398 OPERATION SWITCH The status of any of the switches below is Emergency stop

er
(F198) MALFUNCTION abnormal before the power is turned on.

s
 Cycle start button

re
 Spindle start key

ts
 Forward key/reverse key on the magazine

gh
operating panel

ri
 Tool unclamp switch

ll

.A
Machine set up switch
 Axis movement keys

N
O
 Pallet lock pin switch (UNLOCK)

TI
399 POWER CUT OFF Power shut-off contactor malfunction Emergency stop KM1, KM2, KM3,
16

(F199) MALFUNCTION A
Improper adjustment of the door lock pin KM4, KM9, KM8,
R
04

KM7, KM17
PO

The door is not fully closed.


30

SQ9, SQ31,
SQ56
R
o.

1210 TABLE CLEANUP [TABLE CLEANUP MODE] or [TABLE Only display of message
N

(F210) MIS-OPERATION CLEANUP RELEASE] was tapped while the


al

relevant conditions were not satisfied.


ri

ZA
Se

1213 MAGAZINE POT The locking/unlocking operation of the ATC pot Only display of message
A

(F213) POS.MALF. does not complete.


IM

1214 TABLE POSITION The table has been displaced. (Only when the Feed hold
(F214) ALARM NC positioning table is equipped) Spindle stop
K
ZA

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or


Technology Center.
A
M

1217 SUPPLY LUBLICANT The number of tool unclamping operations has Only display of message
(F217) TO CLAMP CORN exceeded 36000. (option)
YA

1219 COOLANT TEMP The coolant temperature has dropped below 3C Only display of message X1311
3

(F219) CONT. FREEZE (37F). (option)


01

ALARM
)2

1220 PC_MOP.(PALLET [PC ARM CCW] has been tapped with pallet No. Pallet change is
(c

(F220) ARM CW/CCW) 1 located inside the disabled.


ht

machine or [PC ARM CW] has been tapped with


pallet No. 2 located inside the machine.
ig
yr

1221 PC_MOP. The pallet arm position has exceeded the Pallet change is
op

(F221) (PC POS. MALF.) software limit. (Only with HCN-8800 or 10800) disabled.
C

1222 PC_MOP. A pallet change command was specified with the Only display of message
(F222) (PALLET UNCLAMP) pallet unclamped.
1224 TAP RETRACT NOT [TAP RETRACT] was tapped although the Feed hold X246
(F224) POSSIBLE conditions for retracting the tap were not Spindle stop
satisfied. (option)

3-49
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
1225 POCKET NUMBER This alarm occurs when an abnormality Feed hold
(F225) REPETITION (duplication) is found in the pocket numbers Spindle stop
before or after a tool change operation. (The
pocket number specified for an overwriting
request is duplicated.)
1. If two or more instances of the same pocket
number are found before a tool change, “4” is
set for R2036.
2. If one or more of the same pocket number is
found after a tool change, “4” is set for
R2040.
Take note of the above data and contact the

.
nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology

d
ve
Center.

er
If the tool data differ from the actual tool
positions, match the data with the actual status

s
re
and start the automatic operation.

ts
1226 TOOL NUMBER This alarm occurs when an invalid tool number is Feed hold

gh
(F226) INVALIDITY found before or after a tool change operation. Spindle stop
(The specified tool number is not registered in the

ri
tool data.)

ll
.A
1. If an invalid tool number is found before a
tool change, “5” is set for R2036.

N
O
2. If an invalid tool number is found after a tool

TI
change, “5” is set for R2040.
16

A
Take note of the above data and contact the
R
04

nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology


PO

Center.
30

If the tool data differ from the actual tool


o.

positions, match the data with the actual status


N

and start the automatic operation.


al

1227 DESIGNATED This alarm occurs when the overwritten pocket Feed hold
ri

ZA

(F227) POCKET numbers coincide before and after a tool change. Spindle stop
Se

No.INCORRECT
A

 Overwritten pocket number before tool


IM

change: R2038
 Overwritten pocket number after tool change:
K

R2041
ZA

Take note of the above data and contact the


A

nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology


M

Center.
YA

If the tool data differ from the actual tool


positions, match the data with the actual status
3
01

and start the automatic operation.


)2

1229 CHILLER UNIT The spindle temperature has risen too much. NC call stop
(F229) COOLING MALF.
(c
ht

1231 FILTER ALARM The filter clogged signal does not turn ON for 5 Stop in the single block SP37, X1300
ig

(F231) seconds or longer. (option) operation mode


yr

Spindle stop
op

1240 ATC RECOVERY [ATC RECOVERY MODE] is tapped while Only display of message
C

(F240) MODE IMPOSSIBLE. automatic recovery is not possible after the ATC
operation has stopped partway.
Recover manually.
1241 PC RECOVERY [APC RECOVERY MODE] is tapped while Only display of message
(F241) MODE IMPOSSIBLE. automatic recovery is not possible after the APC
operation has stopped partway.
Recover manually.
1242 TOOL DETECT 30 seconds have elapsed after the occurrence of Operation is disabled. SQ34, X1404
(F242) SENSOR MALF. the alarm 291 NO TOOL UNLOAD.

3-50
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Alarm No. Alarm related
Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
1246 2PC HYD. PRESSURE The hydraulic pressure at the separately installed Single block stop
(F246) DOWN hydraulic unit has dropped. Then, emergency stop
(1 min. later)
1250 PC_STAND DRIVER An alarm occurred with the pallet rotation stand Operation is disabled. A36
(F250) ALARM motor driver. (Only with HCN-10800)
1251 OPEN THE ATC The ATC cover needs to be opened once using Operation is disabled. SQ22, X1408
(F251) COVER the manual operation menu. SQ23, X1409
(Only with HCN-10800)
1255 EJH LOW BATTERY The battery for the auxiliary motor is exhausted. Only display of message A30, A32, A33,
(F255) ALARM A36
1256 NOT CYCLE START 2 hours and 30 minutes has elapsed after turning NC call stop SP7, SP8, X1300
(F256) (LINE FILTER AL) off the filter clogging signal.

d .
(Only with HCN-10800)

ve
1257 TOOL HIVE DOOR The TOOL HIVE door is open. TOOL HIVE operation is

er
(F257) OPEN disabled.

s
re
1258 TOOL HIVE WAIT Waiting for a response from TOOL HIVE Waiting for input signal

ts
(F258) TIME

gh
1271 OVER LOAD A load beyond the preset value has been Feed hold

ri
(F271) detected on the X-/Y-/Z-/B-axis or the spindle. Spindle stop
(option)

ll
.A
1272 OVER LOAD DETECT A value larger than the threshold is set for NC call stop
(F272) MISS OP. overload detection. (option)

N
O
1275 PALLET LOCK PIN The unlock pin sensor does not turn ON although Operation is disabled. SQ90, X1825

TI
(F275) ALARM the pallet lock pin is unlocked. SQ57, X1828
16

A
The lock pin sensor does not turn ON although
R
04

the pallet lock pin is locked.


PO

(Only with HCN-10800)


30

1277 TOOL No.OK? This alarm message is displayed when automatic ATC operation
o.

(F277) (SPDL,NEXT, ) ------> ATC recovery is finished. The detail code prohibited
N

indicates (from the left): the spindle tool number Cycle start prohibited
al

and the standby tool number.


ri

ZA

1278 ATC RECOVERY This alarm message is displayed when ATC All axes interlock
Se

(F278) MODE SELECTED recovery mode is selected.


A

Mode change is
IM

disabled.
1280 PALLET No.OK? This alarm message is displayed when automatic PC operation prohibited
K

(F280) (IN, , ) ---------> PC recovery is finished.


ZA

Cycle start prohibited


The detail code indicates: the pallet number in
A

the machine.
M

1281 PC RECOVERY This alarm message is displayed when PC All axes interlock
YA

(F281) MODE SELECTED recovery mode is selected. Mode change is


3

disabled.
01

1288 MISS OP.(TOOL NOT The M166 or M167 command was given when Only display of message
)2

(F288) MOUNTING) there was no tool in the spindle. (option)


(c

1289 MISS OP.(RUNOUT The M166 or M167 command was given when Only display of message
ht

(F289) DET.MNL.MODE) the runout detection unit was not in the automatic
mode. (option)
ig
yr

1290 MISS OP. The M166 or M167 command was given when Only display of message
op

(F290) (SP.OVERRIDE spindle override was set to 0 at the start of


ZERO) measurement. (option)
C

1291 SPINDLE TOOL An alarm occurs with the runout detection unit. Feed hold
(F291) MOUNTING FAILURE (option) Spindle stop
1300 PLEASE CHECK THE This message is displayed when using the tool of Only display of message
(F300) TOOL DATA. which data has been changed for the first time.
(When the changed data check function is
enabled)
1301 PLEASE CHECK THE This message is displayed when using the tool of Only display of message
(F301) TOOL OFFSET. which offset has been changed for the first time.
(When the changed data check function is
enabled)

3-51
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Alarm No. Alarm related


Alarm message Description Machine status
(SQ coil No.) detector SQ No.
1302 RAPID OVERRIDE The rapid override value is clamped because tool Only display of message
(F302) LIMIT data or tool offset value has been changed.
1303 ILLEGAL M-CODE An M code unavailable due to specifications was Only display of message
(F303) specified.
1309 SELECT MODE3 This message is displayed when the mode 3 Only display of message
(F309) switch is ON. (option)
1312 SPINDLE ROTATION Spindle speed has exceeded the mode 3 Feed hold
(F312) EXCEEDED allowable speed. Spindle stop
1320 P/C WARM UP MODE This message is displayed during a pallet change Only display of message
(F320) at a low temperature (base temperature of 10C
or lower).
During the pallet changer warm up mode, the

d.
pallet change time lengthens by approximately

ve
two seconds.

er
1325 MONITORING Hardware error Only display of message D1508

s
re
(F325) SENSOR MALF. Disconnection, short circuit etc. occurred in the

ts
(*1, , ) temperature sensor for display.

gh
The workpiece No. where the error occurred is

ri
displayed at *1.

ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-52
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
3-2-5 No. 400 - No. 499, No. 1400 - No. 1499 (CNC screen operation error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
400 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

401 ILLEGAL FORMAT ( , , ) A L S Blue


The format of the input data is not an available one.
Cause
Example : Negative data has been input to an item that rejects negative data input.

d .
Tap the cancel key and then input correct data.

ve
Action

s er
re
402 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT ( , , ) A L S Blue
1. The work number of a display inhibiting program was specified.

ts
Cause

gh
2. The numeric value that has been input is out of the allowable range.

ri
1. The operation concerned cannot be performed for the program of display inhibition (Program management function).
Action

ll
2. Tap the cancel key and then input correct data.

.A
403 PROGRAM TOO LARGE ( , , ) A L S Blue

N
O
The limit of 2000 lines per program has been exceeded.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Recreate the program so that it consists of 2000 lines or less.


Action
PO
30

R
o.

404 MEMORY CAPACITY EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


O
N

1. Additional creation of a machining program is no longer possible since the memory has already been filled up to its
al

machining-program data storage capacity.


K
ri

ZA

2. Additional preparation of process control data is no longer possible since 100 sets of such data have already been
Se

Cause
stored.
A
IM

3. Additional preparation of program layout data is no longer possible since 4000 sets of such data have already been
stored.
K

Make an available storage area by either erasing an unnecessary machining program from the memory or saving a
ZA

Action machining program onto an external storage, and then create a new machining program.
A
M

405 PROGRAM No. NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


YA

An attempt has been made to select a program whose work number has not been registered.
Cause
An attempt was made to select the work number marked with [!] in the project display.
3
01

Select a program whose work number has been registered.


)2

Action
(c

406 MEMORY PROTECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht

1. Inhibiting operation (editing, erasing, renumber of work number and entry of names) has been performed for the
ig

edit-inhibiting program.
yr

Cause 2. The program protect function is set valid.


op

3. An attempt has been made to carry out “TOOL NAME ORDER” operation on the TOOL DATA display while a tool
C

remains set in the spindle.


1. The operation concerned cannot be performed for the edit-inhibiting program (program management function).
Action 2. Cancel the program protect function.
3. Remove the tool from the spindle, and then carry out the operation once again.

3-53
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
407 DESIGNATED DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue
The number or character string that has been designated does not exist in the program.
Cause

Designate an existent number or character string.


Action

408 PROGRAM ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


The memory contents in the machining-program data storage area have been destroyed.
Cause

Delete the corresponding program.


Action

.d
ve
409 ILLEGAL INSERTION ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
Program data insertion is not possible.
Cause

s
re
It is not possible to insert data before the common unit.

ts
Action

gh
ri
410 ILLEGAL DELETION ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
Program deletion is not possible.

.A
Cause
 An attempt has been made to erase the common unit during editing of the MAZATROL program.

N
O
It is not possible to delete the common unit.
Action

TI
 Edit the program only after moving the cursor to the position where the data exists.
16

A
R
411 POWER OFF DURING PROGRAM EDIT ( , , ) A L S Blue
04

PO
30

A portion of the program may have been destroyed because power has been turned off during program editing.
Cause
R
o.

O
N

Check the corresponding program for incorrect data, and correct the program data if an error(s) exists in it.
C

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

412 SUB PROGRAM NESTING EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


Se

The number of repeats of subprogram nesting has exceeded nine times.


IM

Cause
K

Correct the program so that the total number of repeats of subprogram nesting becomes nine or less.
ZA

Action
A

413 MAX. No. OF REGIST PROG EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


M
YA

The program registration has exceeded its maximum value available (Standard: 256 programs).
Cause
3
01

Reduce the total number of registered programs by deleting unnecessary programs or moving them to the backup area or
Action by saving unnecessary programs in an external storage unit and then deleting them.
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-54
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
414 AUTO CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE (No., , ) A L S Blue
Automatic determination of the data failed due to an error.
No. Cause
- Automatic determination error
1 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to tool data) used for
calculation are not set.
2 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to programs) used for
calculation are not set.
3 (1) Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because a tool for which cutting conditions cannot
be calculated automatically (special tap, special cutter, chip removal, touch sensor, ball end mill,
special threading, special turning) is selected.

d .
Cause (2) Automatic calculation of “C-SP”, “FR” or “DEP-1” failed because a unit for which cutting conditions

ve
cannot be calculated automatically (mill-turning unit, turning-drilling unit with a drilling tool (mill

er
spindle)) is selected.

s
re
4 Automatic calculation of C-SP or FR failed during automatic calculation of C-SP, FR and DEP-1 because
the data (related to parameters) used for calculation are not set.

ts
5 Automatic calculation of C-SP, FR or DEP-1 failed because the data (related to the tool file) used for

gh
calculation are not set.

ri
6 Automatic calculation of C-SP or FR failed during automatic calculation of C-SP, FR and DEP-1 because

ll
the data (related to CUTTING CONDITION display) used for calculation are not set.

.A
99 The result of calculation exceeded the setting range permitted in the program during automatic calculation

N
of C-SP, FR and DEP-1.

O
TI
16

Action
Review the setting data. A
R
04

PO
30

415 MIS-SET G CODE ( , , ) B L S Blue


R
o.

A G-code not covered by the specifications has been designated.


O
N

Cause
C
al

Check and correct the G-code addresses within the program.


ri

ZA

Action
Se

A
IM

416 AUTO PROCESS IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


Tools cannot be automatically developed because of errors of the machining-unit data.
K

Cause
ZA
A

Check and correct the machining-unit data.


Action
M
YA

417 EDITING PROHIBITED ( , , ) A L S Blue


3

1. An attempt has been made to modify a program whose editing is prohibited.


01

Cause 2. An attempt has been made to edit an EIA program whose size is 32 MB or larger on the PROGRAM display or EIA
)2

MONITOR display.
(c

1. Modify the data only after canceling the parameter setting for prohibition of editing.
ht

Action 2. EIA programs with a size of 32 MB or larger cannot be edited on the NC unit. Therefore, they need to be edited
ig

outside the NC unit.


yr

418 EIA/ISO CONVERTING ( , , ) A L S Blue


op

During EIA/ISO conversion, an attempt has been made to perform erasure, work number change or editing of the
C

Cause conversion source program. Or an attempt has been made to select the TOOL PATH CHECK display.

During EIA/ISO conversion, erasure, work number change or editing of the conversion source program cannot be done.
Action The TOOL PATH CHECK display cannot be selected.

3-55
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
419 AUTO TAP PROCESS IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue
1. The pitch or other data cannot be automatically set because of incorrectness of the tap nominal diameter in the
tapping-unit data.
Cause
2. Although the text file is referred to for the pipe tap auto-setting (D95 bit 0 = 1), the auto-setting function cannot be
executed since the auto-setting text file (Pipescdt. txt) is incorrect or contains no data.
1. Check and correct the tapping-unit data and tapping-tool sequence data of the program.
Action
2. Check and correct the auto-setting text file (Pipescdt. txt).

420 SAME DATA EXISTS ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt has been made to input the same data as that which has already been registered.
1. Pocket number in the TOOL LAYOUT display.

.
2. Machining-program number (changed)

d
Cause

ve
3. Machining priority number

er
4. Tool model name

s
re
5. Tool data suffix
Check and correct the data settings.

ts
gh
Action In case 4, this alarm indicates that the tool model name the operator has attempted registering is already present under the
same tool type (such as: drill, end mill, turning tool, or grooving tool) in other systems. Specify another tool model name.

ri
ll
421 DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue

.A
An attempt has been made to designate the data that does not exist.
Cause

N
O
TI
Check whether the designated data exists.
16

Action A
R
04

PO

422 MEMORY PROTECT (I/O BUSY) ( , , ) A L S Blue


30

An attempt has been made to edit or input the machining program, tool data, etc. during I/O operation.
R
o.

Cause
O
N

C
al

Wait until the I/O operation is completed, and then repeat the editing or input operation from the beginning.
K

Action
ri

ZA
Se

423 MAX NUMBER OF TOOLS EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


IM

During tool layout, the number of tools used in the designated program has exceeded the maximum available number.
Cause
K
ZA

Check and correct the corresponding machining program so that the maximum available number of tools is not exceeded.
Action
A
M
YA

424 ALL POCKET NUMBERS NOT ASSIGNED ( , , ) A L S Blue


It is not possible to finish the tool layout operation because the pocket number has not yet been assigned to all the required
3

Cause tools.
01
)2

Assign the pocket number(s) and then finish the tool layout operation.
Action
(c
ht

425 DATA MISSING ( , , ) A L S Blue


ig

Processing is not possible because of lack of data.


yr

1. Saving or loading has been attempted without designating any data (such as work numbers, etc.) on the DATA I/O
op

Cause
display.
C

2. The data to be input for restart operation is wanting.


Input data correctly.
Action

426 PROGRAM DATA MISSING ( , , ) A L S Blue


The tool sequence data cannot be automatically developed because of partial lack of the machining-unit data.
Cause

Fill up all the machining-unit data items with data.


Action

3-56
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
427 MEMORY PROTECT (AUTO MODE) ( , , ) A L S Blue
An attempt has been made to input unallowable data in the automatic operation mode.
Cause

Change the mode over to the manual operation mode, and then input the data.
Action

428 MEMORY PROTECT (AUTO OPERATION) ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt has been made to input unallowable data on a display (such as the TOOL DATA display) during automatic
Cause operation.

Input allowable data only after placing the NC unit in its reset state or after changing the current mode over to another
Action mode.

d .
ve
429 CANNOT PERFORM MEASUREMENT ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The following conditions were not satisfied:

s
re
Coordinate measurement

ts
1. Automatic operation must not be in progress.

gh
Cause 2. The spindle must have a tool mounted on it.

ri
3. The tool data of the tool mounted on the spindle must have already been input.

ll
Tool-length measurement

.A
1. Automatic operation must not be in progress.

N
Set the specified conditions and then make the measurement.

O
Action

TI
16

430 ILLEGAL TOOL DESIGNATED ( , , A ) A L S Blue


R
04

During creation of a machining program, an attempt has been made to input a tool name not available for the particular
PO
30

Cause program unit, in the tool sequence.


R
o.

Designate a correct tool name.


N

Action
C
al

K
ri

ZA

431 ILLEGAL PALLET No. ( , , ) A L S Blue


Se

A nonexistent pallet number has been designated.


A

Cause
IM

Designate a correct pallet number.


K

Action
ZA
A

432 ILLEGAL TOOL No. ( , , ) A L S Blue


M

A nonexistent tool number has been designated.


YA

Cause
3

Designate a correct tool number.


01

Action
)2
(c

433 SAME PROGRAM EXISTS ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht

The number of the machining program that has been designated for program reading from an external unit already exists
Cause
ig

within the NC memory.


yr

Check the number of the machining program.


op

Action
C

434 NO ASSIGNED TOOL IN TOOL FILE ( , , ) A L S Blue


The milling tools (face-mills, end-mills, chamfering cutters, and ball end-mills) that have been designated on the machining
Cause program include a one(s) that is not yet registered in the TOOL FILE display.

Register the corresponding tools in the TOOL FILE display.


Action

3-57
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
435 PROGRAM CHECK NOT ALLOWED ( , , )
An attempt has been made to restart on the TOOL PATH display during checking of the tool path.
Cause

Interrupt the tool path checking operation before restarting.


Action

436 UNREGISTERED TNo. ( , , ) A L S Blue


An unmeasurable tool number has been designated in the automatic tool-length (diameter) measurement mode.
Cause

Designate a measurable tool number.


Action

d .
ve
437 NO NOM- DATA IN PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
It has been found during tool layout that there is a tool without a nominal diameter in the designated program.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check if nominal diameters have been assigned to all tools registered in the designated program.

gh
Action

ri
438 END UNIT NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
The end unit is not included in the machining program.
Cause

N
O
Create the end unit at the end of the program.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

439 MAZATROL PROGRAM DESIGNATED ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

A MAZATROL program has been designated for copying purposes during EIA/ISO program editing.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

No MAZATROL programs can be designated for copying purposes during EIA/ISO program editing.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

440 EIA/ISO PROGRAM DESIGNATED ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

1. The machining program that has been designated on the TOOL LAYOUT, PROCESS CONTROL or SET UP
RECORD display is an EIA/ISO program.
K

Cause 2. An EIA/ISO program has been designated for copying purposes during MAZATROL program editing.
ZA

3. An EIA/ISO program has been designated as the source program of EIA/ISO conversion.
A

4. An EIA/ISO program has been designated when writing coordinate values on the MEASURE display.
M
YA

No EIA/ISO programs can be designated for operation on the TOOL LAYOUT, PROCESS CONTROL, SET UP RECORD
Action or MEASURE display or during EIA/ISO conversion or MAZATROL program editing.
3
01

441 UNREGISTERED HEAD DATA ( , , ) B L S Blue


)2

The head number that has been designated during MDI-MMS setting does not exist in the head data.
Cause
(c
ht

Review the designated head number.


ig

Action
yr
op

442 DATA RENEWAL NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) A L S Blue


C

No updates can be made to the machining program.


Cause

This message may also be displayed when the NC unit is busy processing data.
Action
Tap the alarm clear button and then carry out the operation once again.

443 HELP IS NOT AVAILABLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


No help display is prepared for the line on which the cursor is placed.
Cause

Refer to the Programming Manual (MAZATROL Program).


Action

3-58
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
444 EDITING PROHIBITED AREA ( , , ) A L S Blue
During automatic operation based on the EIA MONITOR display, an attempt has been made to move the cursor to the
Cause program section whose editing was prohibited.

The cursor cannot be moved to the area where editing is prohibited.


Action

445 ILLEGAL UNIT ( , , ) B L S Blue


An attempt has been made to set tool layout data in a MAZATROL program containing an illegal unit(s).
Cause

Review the program.


Action

d .
ve
446 RESTART TIMES EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The block to be searched for at the time of restart of the EIA/ISO program does exist, but the designated number of times of

s
Cause reappearance of the block is too large.

re
ts
Check the number of times of reappearance of the block.
Action

gh
ri
447 PROGRAM ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
A program error(s) has occurred during EIA/ISO restart search.
Cause

N
O
The program being searched for includes an error(s). Perform a tool-path check upon the program contents.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

448 RESTART SEARCH UNFINISHED ( , , ) A I P Blue


PO
30

EIA/ISO restart searching has not been executed.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

Designate the restart position and tap the [EIA/ISO SEARCH] button to search the intended restart position.
al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

449 RESTART SEARCH FINISHED ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

An attempt has been made to carry out another search operation when EIA/ISO restart searching had already been
Cause finished.
K

An attempt has been made to change the work number when EIA/ISO restart searching had already been finished.
ZA

Press the RESET key and then carry out the restart operation once again.
Action
A

Before changing the work number, press the RESET key.


M
YA

450 TOUCH SENSOR NOT IN SPINDLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


The spindle did not have a mounted touch sensor when an attempt was made to set MAZATROL coordinate measurement
3

Cause data on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.


01
)2

Mount a touch sensor in the spindle before setting the data.


Action
(c
ht

451 SAME MATERIAL ENTERED ( , , ) B L S Blue


ig

The materials name that has been designated on the CUTTING CONDITION - W.-MAT/T.-MAT. display already exists.
yr

Cause
op
C

Designate a new materials name.


Action

452 NO SHAPE DATA IN UNIT ( , , ) A L S Blue


No shape data exists in the program unit that has been designated in an attempt to make a copy of shape data.
Cause

Check the contents of the program unit for which shape copying is to be made.
Action

3-59
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
453 NO SHAPE DATA TO COPY IN UNIT ( , , ) A L S Blue
An attempt has been made to copy shape data whose type is not available for the particular program unit.
Cause

It is not possible to copy shape data of the pallet-changing unit, index unit, or other units that do not have a shape
Action sequence.

454 CURSOR POSITION INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


Processing not permissible for the current cursor position has been attempted.
Example :
Cause 1. An attempt has been made to carry out a shape copying operation with the cursor on the tool sequence line.
2. The SHAPE CHECK display has been selected on a shape sequence line not actually executed during automatic

d .
operation.

ve
Example :

er
Action 1. No shape data can be copied on the tool sequence line.

s
re
2. Review the program.

ts
455 SAME PROGRAM No. DESIGNATED ( , , ) A L S Blue

gh
The machining program currently being edited has been appointed for the particular program copying operation.

ri
Cause

ll
.A
Copying within the same program is not possible. Check the designated program number.
Action

N
O
TI
456 NO TOOL IN SPINDLE ( , , ) A L S Blue
16

The spindle does not currently have a tool mounted on it. A


R
Cause
04

PO
30

After mounting a tool on the spindle, carry out the particular operation once again.
R

Action
o.

O
N

457 DATA ADDRESS NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


al

K
ri

ZA

During creation of manual program mode unit, data setting has been attempted without addressing.
Se

Cause
A
IM

During creation of the manual program mode unit, designate an address before setting data.
Action
K
ZA

458 INTERFERING TOOL REGISTERED ( , , ) A L S Blue


A

An attempt has been made to register a tool most likely to interfere with an adjacent pocket.
M

Example :
YA

Cause 1. An attempt has been made to register tool data or tool change data on the TOOL DATA display.
3

2. An attempt has been made to set such a tool on the TOOL LAYOUT display that is likely to interfere with an adjacent
01

pocket.
)2

Select a pocket that does not cause interference with an adjacent one.
Action
(c
ht

459 DISPLAY PROTECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr

1. An attempt has been made to display a program whose display is prohibited.


op

Cause 2. An attempt has been made to display an EIA program whose size is 32 MB or larger on the PROGRAM display, EIA
MONITOR display, or POSITION display.
C

1. Display the program only after canceling the parameter setting for prohibition of display.
Action 2. EIA programs with a size of 32 MB or larger cannot be displayed. Therefore, their contents need to be checked
outside the NC unit.
460 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

3-60
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
461 PRIORITY No. OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue
The same priority number is assigned to different tools.
Cause

Within one process, the same priority number must not be assigned to different tools.
Action Change the priority number.

462 ILLEGAL PRIORITY NUMBER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue


The priority numbering order within a unit is not correct.
Cause

The machining order within one unit has been reversed by the incorrect priority numbering.
Action Change the priority numbers.

d .
ve
463 PRIORITY No. OVERFLOW ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
A priority number exceeding 99 has occurred because an attempt has been made to move a priority number(s) on the

s
Cause PROGRAM LAYOUT display.

re
ts
Set priority numbers in the correct order, and then move the desired priority number(s).

gh
Action

ri
464 ILLEGAL ADDRESS INPUT ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
An address not covered by the specifications has been designated during input of subprogram unit addresses on the
Cause PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.

N
O
Check and correct the address.

TI
Action
16

Check the specifications. A


R
04

465 EIA SHAPE DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

Although an attempt has been made to draw a workpiece shape using the selected EIA/ISO program, shape data is not
R

Cause present in that program.


o.

O
N

Review the program.


al

Action If the program is that which has been obtained by EIA/ISO conversion output, change the setting of the bit 0 of parameter
ri

ZA

F89 to 1 and then carry out the converting operation once again.
Se

466 INCORRECT EIA SHAPE DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


IM

Although an attempt has been made to draw a workpiece shape using the selected EIA/ISO program, the corresponding
Cause
K

shape data is not correct.


ZA

Review the program.


A

Action
M
YA

467 —— ( , , )
3

Cause ——
01
)2
(c

Action ——
ht

468 MAINTENANCE CHECK WARNING ( , , ) B L S Blue


ig
yr

The target time of the items which had been set on the MAINTENANCE CHECK display has been exceeded.
Cause
op
C

Carry out periodic checks, and then after completion of the checks, reset the current time of the check items of the
Action MAINTENANCE CHECK display to zero (0).

469 TPC DATA EDIT IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


The TPC data setting is not possible for the designated unit.
Cause

Check the program.


Action

3-61
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
470 ILLEGAL TPC DATA ( , , ) B L S Blue
The TPC data for the unit is not correct.
Cause
After setting the TPC data, the unit machining mode has been changed.
Delete the TPC data and set correct TPC data once again whenever required.
Action

471 TPC DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


While the cursor was on a line of unit not containing TPC data on the display, [TPC] was tapped during the program list
Cause mode.

Tap [TPC] after shifting to the programming mode.


Action

d .
ve
472 CALCULATION ERROR ( , , ) B L S Blue

er
1. The calculation expressions displayed in the desk calculator window includes expressions that result in a calculation

s
failure.

re
Cause
2. Calculating tool lengths A and B has been attempted in spite of tool nose position storage not being completed.

ts
gh
1. Review the calculation expressions, and correct nonexecutable sections, such as those which may include division by
Action 0 or result in a negative number in SQRT.

ri
2. Store the position of the tool nose.

ll
.A
473 FINAL POINT DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) B L S Blue

N
Although the end-point data of the preceding line was not yet set in the BAR or CPY unit, [NEXT] was tapped.

O
Cause

TI
16

A
Tap [NEXT] after setting the end-point data of the preceding line.
R
04

Action
PO
30

474 NO PROGRAM DISPLAY (TAPE MODE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


o.

O
N

1. During tape operation mode, an attempt has been made to select the EIA MONITOR display.
C

Cause
al

2. An attempt has been made to change the operation mode to tape operation mode when the EIA MONITOR display is
K
ri

selected.
ZA
Se

1. During tape operation mode, programs cannot be displayed on the EIA MONITOR display.
A

Action
IM

2. Select a display other than the EIA MONITOR display before changing the operation mode to tape operation mode.

475 NO EIA/ISO OPTION ( , , ) A L S Blue


K
ZA

An attempt has been made to use an EIA/ISO-option related function in spite of the absence of an EIA/ISO option.
Cause
A
M

An EIA/ISO-option related function cannot be used since the system has no EIA/ISO option.
YA

Action
3

476 NO OPTION ( , , ) A, E K, H O Red


01

An attempt has been made to use an optional function in spite of the absence of that option.
)2

Cause
(c

This function cannot be used since the system does not have the option for the function.
ht

Action
ig
yr

477 DESCRIPTION IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) B L S Blue


op

The maximum memory capacity for drawing tool paths has been consumed in the 3D mode of the TOOL PATH CHECK or
Cause
C

TRACE display.

Action ——

478 MEMORY PROTECT (MEASURING) ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt has been made to copy the coordinates data in WRITE DATA column of the MEASURE display into the
Cause designated position, while measurement using the MEASURE display is in progress.

Copy the coordinates data only after the measurement has been completed.
Action

3-62
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
479 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

480 UNIT NOT SELECTED ( No., , ) A L S Red


Items necessary for copying units on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display have not been selected.
No. Cause
Cause 0 The unit to be copied has not been selected.
1 The copy destination has not been selected.

d .
ve
Select necessary items.

er
Action

s
re
481 DIRECTORY NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue

ts
An I/O operation was attempted on a non-existing directory.

gh
Cause

ri
ll
Check whether the specified directory is present.

.A
Action

N
482 —— ( , , )

O
TI
16

Cause —— A
R
04

PO
30

Action ——
R
o.

O
N

483 —— ( , , )
C
al

Cause ——
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM

Action ——
K

484 INCORRECT SPINDLE TOOL ( , , ) A L S Blue


ZA

[LENG-OFS TEACH] has been tapped in spite of the fact that a tool not having its “Length Offset Data” item displayed on
Cause
A

the TOOL DATA display (for example, a turning tool) was mounted in the spindle.
M
YA

Check the tool mounted in the spindle.


Action
3
01

485 INCORRECT HEAD INDEX ANGLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


)2

Executing the tool nose position storage function (TEACH) has been attempted when the head index angle displayed in
Cause
(c

TOOL DATA display mode was neither 0°, 90°, nor 180°.
ht

Execute the tool nose position storage function (TEACH) when the head index angle is either 0° 90° or 180°.
ig

Action
yr
op

486 ILLEGAL JAW DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


C

The use of the jaw shape that has been specified for the program results in interference between adjacent jaws as a result
Cause of the SOLID mode PATH CHECK.

Review the jaw data or the workpiece-gripping diameter value.


Action

487 LONG BORING BAR ADAPTER EXISTS (Pocket No, , ) A L S Blue


Assigning a tool other than an inside-diameter turning tool to the magazine pocket holding the adapter for the long boring
Cause bar has been attempted.

Review the pocket number or the type of tool to be assigned.


Action

3-63
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
488 MEMORY PROTECT (MAGAZINE SETUP) ( , , ) A L S Blue
Tool data updating operations (such as editing tool data, completing the layout of tools, or downloading data on the DATA
Cause I/O display) have been attempted during magazine setup.

Perform tool data updating operations after completing the magazine setup operations.
Action
Deselect [MAGAZINE SETUP] relating to visual tool data management.

489 CANNOT SET THREAD POSITION ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt was made to set jaw dimensions without having selected the jaw type (OUT1/IN/OUT2).
Cause

Select the jaw type beforehand.


Action

d .
ve
490 REGISTRATION NUMBER EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The data registration has exceeded its maximum value available.

s
Cause An attempt was made on the TOOL FILE display to register the ninth data item of workpiece material.

re
ts
Delete unnecessary items to register the desired one.

gh
Action

ri
491 ITEM NOT SETUP ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
Data registration is not yet complete.
Cause

N
O
Check if all the data items are set as required.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

492 CANNOT EDIT 3D DATA ( , , ) B L S Blue


PO
30

Editing the CAD tool model has been attempted.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

The CAD tool model cannot be edited.


al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

493 SELECT JAW TYPE ( , , ) A L S Blue


A

Assigning dimensions to jaw data for which a shape has not been specified has been attempted.
IM

Cause
K

Specify some shape before assigning dimensions.


ZA

Action
A
M

494 CANNOT SELECT TNO (NOT MAGAZINE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


YA

Execution of tool selection has been attempted under the selected status of a non-magazine type turret.
Cause
3
01

Select a magazine type of turret before executing tool selection.


)2

Action
(c

495 INCORRECT CAD MODEL DATA (Note, , ) B L S Blue


ht
ig

Registered tool model data contains imperfections (a tool model cannot be drawn with the entered data).
Cause
yr
op

Correct the data in the corresponding section.


C

Note :
 During Parametric model entry ······················The alarm-causing section is displayed.
Action  During rotating/extruding tool model entry ·······Causes are displayed.
11: The entered shape has overlapping elements.
12: The entered shape is clockwise (CW).
13: The line connecting the starting and ending points overlaps
some other element.

3-64
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
496 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

497 HEAD ANGLE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


1. An attempt has been made to storage the tool tip position with the head not in its horizontal machining position (TOOL
DATA or TOOL OFFSET display only).
Cause 2. An attempt has been made to perform MDI-MMS or manual measurement with the head not in its horizontal or vertical
machining position.
<HV>

d .
ve
1. Tool tip position storage (tool length measurement) is possible only with the head in its horizontal machining position.
Action

er
2. MDI-MMS or manual measurement is possible only with the head in its horizontal or vertical machining position.

s
re
498 NO HEAD DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue
Offset data for the selected head is not registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Check if the selected head data is registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.
Action

ll
.A
499 ILLEGAL HEAD TYPE ( , , ) A L S Blue

N
An attempt has been made to perform tool tip position storage on the TOOL DATA or TOOL OFFSET display during use of

O
Cause

TI
the horizontal type of head.
16

A
To perform tool tip position storage for tool length measurement, mount a vertical head or a cover.
R
04

Action
PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-65
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1400 SYSTEM ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
An internal trouble has occurred in the system.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.

1401 FILE OPEN ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


Trouble has occurred in opening a file from the hard disk.
Cause

The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the

.
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.

d
ve
1402 FILE READ ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
Trouble has occurred in reading a file on the hard disk.

s
Cause

re
ts
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same

gh
Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the

ri
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.

ll
1403 FILE WRITE ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue

.A
Trouble has occurred in writing a file on the hard disk.

N
Cause

O
TI
The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
16

Action A
operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
R
04

information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
PO
30

1404 MEMORY PROTECT (DATA IN USE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


R
o.

It was attempted to edit jaw shape data of the machining program currently selected.
O

Cause
N

C
al

Change the selection of the program to edit the required data.


ri

ZA

Action
Se

1405 FILE SIZE ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


IM

The size of the loaded file is not correct.


Cause
K
ZA

The file in question might be destroyed.


A

Action Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
M

the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.


YA

1406 LOW MEMORY ( , , ) A L S Blue


3

Memory size currently available is too small.


01

Cause
)2

Exit all the unnecessary applications to make the best of the NC ones.
(c

Action If the alarm is caused again, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the
ht

particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
ig

1407 FILE CREATION ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


yr
op

Creating a file and folder on the hard disk was not successful.
Cause
C

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.

1408 DATA TRANSFER ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


Data transfer to the NC was not successful.
Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the information of the particular operation causing
Action the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.

3-66
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1409 MILLING ONLY SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue
The designated function is not available for a program of initial-point scheme (ONLY MILL).
Cause

Use the function for a program of another scheme.


Action

1410 MILL & TURN (WPC) SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue


The designated function is not available for a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting.
Cause

Use the function for a program of another scheme.


Action

.
d
ve
1411 MILL & TRN (Z-OFS) SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The designated function is not available for a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with Z-offset setting.
Cause

s
re
Use the function for a program of another scheme.

ts
Action

gh
ri
1412 INCORRECT G-CODE ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
The designated function is not available for the G-code system selected by the F30 parameter.

.A
Cause

N
O
Correct the program, or change the F30 setting.
Action

TI
16

1413 INCORRECT RUNNING MODE ( , ,


A ) A L S Blue
R
04

PO

The designated function is not available for the current operation mode or on the current display.
30

Cause
R
o.

O
N

Change the operation mode or display.


C

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

1414 PROGRAM WRITING ( , , ) A L S Blue


Se

Storing a program on the hard disk was not successful.


IM

Cause
K

The file in question might be currently being accessed by another application. Wait for a while to repeat the same
ZA

Action operation. If the alarm is not cleared, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center with the
information of the particular operation causing the alarm, and of the codes displayed in parentheses.
A
M

1415 ZERO CALCULATED TOOL LENGTH ( , , ) A L S Blue


YA

The LENGTH A item of the tool is set to zero (0).


Cause
3
01

Check the settings of tool length or tool set data and, if required, measure the tool in question again.
)2

Action
(c

1416 CANNOT INDEX TOOL ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht

The tool currently indexed on the turret is not appropriate.


ig

Cause
yr
op

Index an appropriate tool beforehand.


Action
C

1417 PARAMETER ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


The setting in a parameter is not correct.
Cause

Check and correct the parameter setting with reference to the codes displayed in parentheses.
Action

3-67
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1418 CANNOT USE LOWER TURRET ( , , ) A L S Blue
The current selection of the headstock to which the lower turret is subordinate is not correct.
Cause

Change over the headstock selection concerned.


Action

1419 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

d .
ve
1420 FILE SIZE LIMIT EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The size of the file is too large for new data to be written in it.
Cause

s
re
Delete the file, or rename the file.

ts
Action

gh
ri
1421 DATA ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
Cause ——

N
O
Action ——

TI
16

1422 PROGRAM LAYOUT ERROR ( , ,


A ) A L S Blue
R
04

PO

Creating the data for turret-by-turret display of program layout was not successful.
30

Cause
R
o.

O
N

Change the display mode.


C

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

1423 TOOL PATH CHECK NOT COMPLETE ( , , ) A L S Blue


Se

Since the program has not yet undergone tool path check, the TOOL DATA display (tool layout mode) cannot perform
IM

Cause calculations for indicating the spare tools to be additionally provided for the machining operation with the program.
K

Execute the function for tool path check on the program.


ZA

Action
A

1424 BARRIER INFORMATION NOT SET ( , , ) A L S Blue


M
YA

In the program-listing mode, [BARRIER INFORM.] has been tapped without any barrier data being registered.
Cause
3
01

Select the program-creating mode before tapping [BARRIER INFORM.].


Action
)2
(c

1425 ILLEGAL SETUP DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht

The setup data are not correct.


Cause
ig
yr

Make a copy of the program in question on the PROGRAM FILE display, and prepare the setup data for the program
op

Action copied.
C

1426 NO PROG LAYOUT FOR THIS PROCESS ( , , ) A L S Blue


The current process has no program layout information provided.
Cause

Tap the menu selector button to select a process with program layout data, or select the display mode for all processes.
Action Alternatively, select a process with program layout data on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display or PROCESS
CONTROL display and then call up the PROGRAM LAYOUT display from there.

3-68
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1427 3D INTERFRNCE CHECK MODEL ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
3D remodeling of the workpiece, fixture, or tool has failed.
Cause

Modify the entered data.


Action
Confirm the model.
1428 INCORRECT POCKET FOR LBB ( , , ) A L S Blue
A long boring bar was assigned to a position other than the special pocket for long boring bars while operating [LAYOUT
Cause FINISH] on the TOOL DATA display (tool layout mode).

Assign the long boring bar to the special pocket.


Action

d .
ve
1429 CANNOT PERFORM AUTO SET ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
Tool setup auto-setting for a tool not capable of using the tool setup auto-setting function (e.g., a magazine tool or a tool
Cause

s
facing the No. 1 turning spindle) has been attempted on the TOOL DATA display.

re
Apply the tool setup auto-setting function only to a turret tool facing the No. 2 turning spindle.

ts
Action

gh
ri
1430 NOT ACTIVE PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
1. This alarm indicates that the machine-operating program and the program selected on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL)

.A
display differ during execution of the workpiece transfer storage function on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.

N
Cause 2. When the directory selection function was enabled (parameter US1 bit 4 = 1) or the project function was enabled

O
(parameter US1 bit 5 = 1), a work number that had the same name as the work number to be executed in automatic

TI
operation from the WORK No. SELECT window but was in a different operation area was selected for WORK No. in
16

A
the COMPARISON STOP window or for SUB PROG. No. in the RESTART (EIA/ISO) window.
R
04

PO

1. Match the machine-operating program and the program selected on the PROGRAM (MAZATROL) display.
30

Action
2. Select the work number to be executed in automatic operation.
R
o.

1431 AUTO SET ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


N

The tool for which the reference tool length was set has not been found during automatic tool length setting.
al

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Set at least one tool length value before executing automatic tool length setting.
A

Action
IM

1432 TOOLMODEL NOT SELECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue


K
ZA

The tool model to be used as a reference has not been selected during tool model copying, erasing, or renaming.
Cause
A
M

Select a reference tool model before executing tool model copying, erasing, or renaming.
YA

Action
3

1433 SAME TOOL MODEL NAME IN USE ( , , ) A L S Blue


01

A registered tool name has been specified during tool model copying or renaming.
)2

Cause
(c
ht

Specify a tool name that has not been registered.


Action
ig
yr

1434 INCOR CRS POS FOR PROG LAYOUT ( , , ) A L S Blue


op

When setting the PROGRAM LAYOUT display from the MAZATROL program was attempted, the layout of program data
C

Cause up to the first end unit has been displayed since an end unit was present at a position previous to the cursor.

Move the cursor to a position previous to the end unit, and then set the PROGRAM LAYOUT display.
Action

1435 3D MONITOR MANUAL MODE ONLY ( , , ) A L S Blue


Setting the 3D MONITOR display has been attempted during automatic operation mode.
Cause

Select manual operation mode before setting the 3D MONITOR display.


Action

3-69
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1436 DIFFERENT TYPE OF PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue
A program of a different program type has been specified during MAZATROL program copying.
Cause

Specify a program of the same type.


Action

1437 CANNOT TRANSFER ACTIVE PROGRAM ( , , ) A L S Blue


Transferring the same program as the automatic operation program, from the backup area to the standard area, has been
Cause attempted.

Before conducting program transfer, select a different program for automatic operation.
Action

d .
ve
1438 NO SETUP DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
[SETUP DATA] has been tapped in the program listing mode when there was no registered setup data.
Cause

s
re
Select the programming mode before tapping [SETUP DATA].

ts
Action

gh
ri
1439 CANNOT CHANGE UNIT ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
Changing a unit has been attempted when a unit change in the MAZATROL program was prohibited.

.A
 It is not allowed to change a unit for which data other than the unit name has been set up.

N
Cause
 It is not allowed to change a unit if the current machining section is not selectable for the new unit (e.g., a unit for which

O
TI
an outside-diametral section has been selected as the machining section cannot be changed to a turning-drilling unit).
16

Action
Review the program. A
R
04

PO
30

1440 ID No. NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


R
o.

Although moving tool data from the magazine tool list to the stored-tool list has been attempted on the TOOL DATA display
N

Cause
C

(tool layout mode), an ID number has not been set up for the corresponding tool.
al

Set the ID number in the tool data.


ri

ZA

Action
Se

A
IM

1441 FILE NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


The corresponding file does not exist during file loading on the MAINTENANCE CHECK display.
K

Cause
ZA

Create “maintenance.txt” under “C:\ymw\M8Y\data\nm64mdata\(language-name)”.


A

Action
M
YA

1442 ILLEGAL TOOL- CANNOT ASSIGN ( , , ) A L S Blue


3

Registering an illegal tool in tool data has been attempted.


01

Cause
)2

Confirm the type of tool to be registered.


(c

Action
ht

1443 BACKUP INCOMPLETE ( , , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr

NC data backup has been aborted.


Cause
op
C

To conduct the backup, perform the backup operations once again.


Action

1444 PROCESS TOO LARGE -DEVIDE PROC ( , , ) A L S Blue


Assigning a priority number to the roughing tool on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display has been attempted, but the priority
Cause numbers required exceed 99. The priority number must range from 1 to 99. Otherwise, this alarm will occur.

Split the process and execute [ROUGH PRIORITY].


Action

3-70
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1445 SAME SIMULTAN. NO IN RGH & FIN ( , , ) A L S Blue
Assigning a priority number to the roughing tool on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display has been attempted, but since
Cause simultaneous machining is specified in the program and the same simultaneous machining number is specified for both
roughing and finishing. Roughing cannot be prioritized with the simultaneous machining number ignored.
Review the specified simultaneous machining number and execute [ROUGH PRIORITY].
Action

1446 CANNOT CHNG.WNo (SNGL PROC.MODE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


A work number change has been attempted in single-process mode.
Cause

Cancel the single-process mode before conducting the work number change.
Action

d .
ve
1447 RESTORE OPERATION STOPPED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
The NC data restore process has been aborted.

s
Cause

re
ts
To conduct the restore process, perform the restore operations once again.

gh
Action

ri
1448 TOOL LENGTH OVER ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
The tool length input range has been overstepped as a result of tool measurement.
Cause

N
O
Use a tool of any tool length value falling within the range defined in parameters SU110 - SU113.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

1449 NC PROGRAM MEMORY SIZE OVER (AREA, , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

This alarm indicates that during hard-disk program transfer to the program storage area (NC memory), as in a power-on
R

status, lack of the necessary NC memory space has been detected or the program storage capacity limit exceeded.
o.

O
N

Cause If AREA = 1 ........ indicates alarm during program transfer from the standard area to the NC memory
C
al

If AREA = 2 ........ indicates alarm during machine manufacturer macroprogram transfer to the NC memory
K
ri

ZA

If AREA = 3 ........ indicates alarm during GL pattern file transfer to the NC memory
Se

Use the PROGRAM FILE display to copy or move programs.


Action
IM
K

1450 SELECT LOWER TURRET ( , , ) A L S Blue


ZA

An attempt has been made to use [TEACH] for a WPC unit with the lower turret selected.
Cause
A
M

[TEACH] cannot be used for a WPC unit with the lower turret selected. Designate the upper turret.
YA

Action
3
01

1451 TILT TABLE ANGLE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


)2

Tip position memorization was attempted with the tilting table at other than the 0 position.
Cause
(c
ht

Perform tip position memory with the tilting table at the 0 position.
Action
ig
yr

1452 SPINDLE CONDITION CAUTION ( , , ) B L S Blue


op

The spindle condition check function judged that the spindle was in an alarm state.
C

Cause

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action

1453 MEMORY PROTECT (BACK UP) ( , , ) A L S Blue


Editing or setting of a machining program, tool data, or other data was attempted while saving the backup data.
Cause

Perform the editing or setting when the backup data has been saved.
Action

3-71
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1454 MEMORY PROTECT (RESTORE) ( , , ) A L S Blue
Editing or setting of a machining program, tool data, or other data was attempted while restoring from the backup data.
Cause

Perform the editing or setting when the backup data has been restored.
Action

1455 ILLEGAL MAKER NAME ( , , ) A L S Blue


Invalid characters have been used in the manufacturer name in an attempt to add a tool part model.
Cause

The characters \ / : * ? “ < > | cannot be used in the manufacturer name. Use other characters to assign the manufacturer
Action name.

d .
ve
1456 ILLEGAL MODEL NO. ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
Invalid characters have been used in the model number in an attempt to add a tool part model.
Cause

s
re
The characters \ / : * ? “ < > | cannot be used in the model number. Use other characters to assign the model number.

ts
Action

gh
ri
1457 CANNOT EDIT MAKER MADE DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
Editing or deleting the tool part model that the manufacturer created has been attempted.

.A
Cause

N
O
The tool part model that the manufacturer created cannot be edited or deleted.
Action

TI
16

1458 NO DESIGNATED PROGRAM ( , ,


A ) A L S Blue
R
04

PO

[OP.PROG. TOOL PATH] was tapped in the tape operation mode or without selecting a program for the operation.
30

Cause
R
o.

O
N

Check the operation mode and program selection status.


C

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

1459 —— ( , , )
Se

Cause ——
IM
K

Action ——
ZA
A

1460 CANNOT USE V.M. DURING AUTO OPE ( , , ) A L S Blue


M

Calling up the VIRTUAL MACHINING display was attempted during automatic operation (when the INTELLIGENT
YA

Cause SAFETY SHIELD function in automatic operation mode was valid).


3

When the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in automatic operation mode is valid, the VIRTUAL MACHINING
01

Action display cannot be presented during automatic operation. Change the display mode after automatic operation has been
)2

completed or after making the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function in automatic operation mode invalid.
(c

1461 TOOL MODEL IMPORT FAILURE ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht

Importing the CAD tool model has failed.


Cause
ig
yr

The data to be imported is incorrect or importable data is absent at the specified location. Make sure that the data to be
op

Action
imported is correct or that data is saved in the specified path.
C

1462 CANNOT USE DISPLAY SAVE DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt to display the saved data was made during condition check operation.
Cause

Display the data when the condition check operation has completed.
Action

3-72
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1463 INVALID HANDLE INTERRUPT ( , , ) A L S Blue
Manual handle pulse interruption was attempted during balance cutting.
Cause

Manual handle pulse interruption is not permitted during balance cutting.


Action

1464 DEVICE ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


Dismounting of a drive where no USB device is connected was attempted on the DATA I/O display.
Cause

Select a drive where a USB device is connected.


Action

d .
1465 —— ( , , )

ve
er
Cause ——

s
re
Action ——

ts
gh
1466 ILLEGAL ATTACHMENT No. ( , , ) A L S Blue

ri
A Non-existant attachment number was specified in the MDI mode.

ll
Cause

.A
N
Check the input data.
Action

O
TI
16

1467 SETTING RANGE EXCEEDED ( , , A ) A L S Blue


R
04

While the input error prevention function was enabled, the input data or variation of tool wear offset exceeded the
PO

Cause
parameter setting range.
30

Input the tool wear offset within the maximum variation set for parameter F125 and the maximum setting set for parameter
o.

Action
N

F126.
C
al

1468 —— ( , , )
ri

ZA
Se

Cause ——
A
IM

Action ——
K
ZA

1469 —— ( , , )
A
M

Cause ——
YA

Action ——
3
01

1470 INCORRECT DESIGNATED DATA ( , , Note) B L S Blue


)2

Note :
(c
ht

–1 : Data in the error file for space error compensation to be transferred to the NC unit does not match the machine
configuration.
ig

Cause
yr

–2 : Error components in the error file for space error compensation have exceeded the specification (single direction:
128 points, both directions: 64 points).
op

–3 : Data in the error file for space error compensation is illegal.


C

Take action below against respective causes described above.


–1 : Input the data measured on the corresponding machine.
–2 : Make measurements again so that the number of measurement points for each error component will not be greater
than 128 points (single direction) or 64 points (both directions).
Action
–3 : Match the file format (single direction/both directions) of error data with the valid mode (single direction/both
directions).
If the problem is not solved even after the action above, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology
Center.

3-73
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1471 1BLOCK SIZE OVER ( , , ) A L S Blue
The G code macro call output from the add-in EIA window has exceeded 248 characters.
Cause

Change the argument setting to make it within 248 characters.


Action

1472 INVALID REEDIT ( , , ) A L S Blue


[RE-EDIT] has been tapped when the block in the cursor position cannot be edited in the EIA/ISO program.
1. Unsuitable G code or unnecessary address for add-in EIA function is included in the block in the cursor position.
Cause
2. A comment is located toward the top of the program from the block of G code macro call.
3. The block for re-editing exceeds 248 characters.

d .
1. Delete unnecessary G codes and addresses from the block.

ve
Action 2. For blocks to be re-edited with the add-in EIA function, the comment must be added at the end of the block.

er
3. Edit the block to include 248 characters or less.

s
re
1473 NOT AUTO MODE ( , , ) A L S Blue

ts
The restart 2 non-modal function setting was attempted in a mode other than the memory operation or hard disk operation

gh
Cause mode.

ri
Perform the restart 2 non-modal function setting in the memory operation or hard disk operation mode.

ll
Action

.A
N
1474 MEASURED RESULT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) B L S Blue

O
Measurement using the INTELLIGENT BALANCE ANALYZER function did not complete normally.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Review the measurement program. Check that the dwell time is 40 seconds and that the table was rotating normally, then
Action
PO

repeat the measurement.


30

1475 ILLEGAL MEASURING CONDITION ( , , ) A L S Blue


o.

O
N

The tool measurement conditions on the TOOL DATA display are not satisfied.
C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Check the tool length measuring procedure.


Se

Action
A
IM

1476 —— ( , , )
K

Cause ——
ZA
A
M

Action ——
YA

1477 INCORRECT PROCESS SELECTION ( , , ) A L S Blue


3

A process for a head differing from the selected head has been selected in the SELECT PROCESS window for the restart
01

Cause or single process operation.


)2

(Only for MULTIPLEX series)


(c

Select a process for the selected head.


ht

Action
It is also possible to avoid the alarm by setting parameter F158 bit5 = 0.
ig
yr

( , , )
op

Cause
C

Action

1482 CANNOT LOCK (LIMIT NUMBER) ( , , ) A L S Blue


With nine messages locked, an attempt to lock a 10th message was made.
Cause

The number of messages to be locked must be nine or smaller.


Action

3-74
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1483 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

1484 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

d .
1485 DATA GUARD ALARM (No., , ) A L S Blue

ve
The allowable operation range is restricted by the data guard function.

ser
re
No. Cause

ts
Cause 0 A user having the authority level lower than RANK “1” attempted to change the custom setting.

gh
1 to 8 The access authority level is lower than the level required for changing the data.

ri
999 Deletion of a user failed.

ll
.A
Log in the system with a user having the correct authority level.

N
Action

O
TI
1486 ILLEGAL ID OR PASSWORD (No., , ) A L S Blue
16

The input user name or password is incorrect.


A
R
04

PO
30

No. Cause
R
o.

The user name or password set at the input and display filed for switching a user is incorrect.
O

Cause 0
N

1 The password set at the input and display filed for changing a password is incorrect.
al

2 The user name or password set at the input and display filed for adding a user is incorrect.
ri

ZA
Se

Check the input user name or password.


IM

Action
K

1487 ID NOT SELECT (No., , ) A L S Blue


ZA

A user name is not selected in account management operation with Data Guard.
A
M

No. Cause
YA

Cause
1 A user name is not selected at the input and display field for changing a password.
3

3 A user name is not selected at the input and display field for deleting a user.
01
)2

Select a user name.


(c

Action
ht

1488 PASSWORD MISMATCH (No., , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr

Two passwords input in account management operation with Data Guard do not match.
op
C

No. Cause
Cause
1 Mismatch of two passwords input at the input and display field for changing a password.
2 Mismatch of two passwords input at the input and display field for adding a user.

Check the input passwords.


Action

3-75
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1489 ILLEGAL CHARACTER (No., , ) A L S Blue
A character string input in the account management operation by Data Guard includes illegal characters.

No. Cause

Cause 1 A character string input at the input and display field for changing a password includes illegal
characters.
2 A character string input at the input and display field for adding a user includes illegal
characters.

Check the input characters.


Action

d .
1490 SAME ID ALREADY EXISTS (No., , ) A L S Blue

ve
A user name input in account management operation by Data Guard already exists.

s er
re
Cause No. Cause

ts
2 A user name input at the input and display field for adding a user already exists.

gh
ri
Change the input user name.
Action

ll
.A
1491 RANK NOT SELECT (No., , ) A L S Blue

N
O
In Data Guard account management operation, RANK is not selected.

TI
16

Cause No. A Cause


R
04

2 In the input and display field for adding a user, RANK is not selected.
PO
30

R
o.

Select RANK.
O

Action
N

C
al

1492 ACCOUNT NUMBER OVER (No., , ) A L S Blue


ri

ZA
Se

An attempt was made to register more than 50 users in Data Guard account management operation.
A
IM

No. Cause
Cause
K

2 An attempt was made to register more than 50 users at the input and display field for adding a
ZA

user.
A
M

Delete an unnecessary user before registering a new user.


Action
YA

1493 ILLEGAL –9999 CODE (No., , ) A L S Blue


3
01

The confirmation code input in Data Guard account management operation is incorrect.
)2
(c

No. Cause
Cause
ht

3 Mismatch of the confirmation code, input at the input and display field for deleting a user, with
ig

“–9999”.
yr
op

Check the input code.


Action
C

3-76
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1494 CANNOT EDIT SMC DATA (No., , ) A L S Blue
SMC data operation is performed while the SMC data editing is not allowed or for the data items that cannot be edited.

No. Cause
0 The edit menu was selected although the SMC data was not selected.
1 An attempt was made to edit SMC No. 0.

Cause 2 An attempt was made to edit the locked SMC data.


Or, the locked SMC data is specified as the destination of transfer.
3 An attempt was made to edit the SMC data currently used in operation.
Or, the SMC data currently used in operation was specified as the destination of transfer.
4 The “SMC data addition” operation was performed by selecting the SMC data that is already

d .
registered.

ve
ser
Edit the SMC data after arranging the conditions that allow editing of the SMC data.

re
Action

ts
1495 SMC DATA NOT SETUP (No., , ) A L S Blue

gh
The SMC data that has not been set is specified in the SMC data selection window.

ri
Cause

ll
.A
Specify the SMC data that has been set.
Action

N
O
1496 ILLEGAL ITS PARAMETER ( , , ) A L S Blue

TI
16

The INTELLIGENT THERMAL SHIELD parameters have not been set.A


Cause
R
04

PO
30

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
R
o.

O
N

( , , )
al

K
ri

ZA

Cause
Se

A
IM

Action
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-77
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-6 No. 500 - No. 599, No. 1500 - No. 1599 (I/O error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
500 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

501 ILLEGAL FORMAT ( , , ) A L S Blue


An external storage medium that contains data other than Smooth system data has been set.
Cause

d .
Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system.

ve
Action

s er
re
502 CANNOT LOAD (PROG SIZE EXCEED) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
The contents of the external storage medium are not correct.

ts
Cause

gh
(Loading of a MAZATROL program of more than 2000 lines of data has been attempted.)

ri
Either use another external storage medium, or save the program data once again. After that, carry out the load operation
Action

ll
once again.

.A
503 CANNOT LOAD (TOO MANY PROGRAMS) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue

N
O
An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be

TI
Cause registered within the NC unit.
16

A
Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the
R
04

Action
PO

particular program.
30

504 CANNOT LOAD (AUTO OPERATION) ( , , ) A L S Blue


o.

O
N

An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining programs.
C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Load the data only after completion of automatic operation.


Se

Action
A
IM

505 CANNOT LOAD (MISMATCH) ( , , ) A L S Blue


K

Loading has been attempted although the data within the external storage medium does not match to the NC unit
Cause
ZA

(Mismatching in data size, etc.).


A

Check if the data saved on the external storage medium is the data to be used for the machine currently in operation.
Action
M
YA

506 SAME PROGRAM No. DESIGNATED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


3

An attempt has been made to load the machining program that has the same work number as that of a machining program
01

Cause registered within the NC unit.


)2

Check for an overlapping work numbers.


(c

Action
ht

507 NO DESIGNATED PROGRAM (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr

The machining program whose saving has been attempted does not exist in the NC unit.
Cause
op
C

Check if the machining program with the specified work number exists in the NC unit.
Action

3-78
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
508 MEMORY CAPACITY EXCEEDED (WNo., , ) A (G) L (L) S (S) Blue (Blue)
1. An attempt has been made to load machining program data that exceeds the maximum available area for program
registration within the NC unit.
Cause
2. In the middle of saving onto the external storage medium, data saving exceeding the memory capacity has been made,
or the end-of-tape (or end-of-disk) code has been detected.
1. Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load
the particular program.
Action
2. Split the data into segments according to the particular size of the free saving area within the external storage medium,
and then carry out the saving operations once again.

509 MEMORY PROTECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


Loading has been attempted although the program protect function was set valid.

.
Cause

d
ve
er
Cancel the program protect function.
Action

s
re
ts
510 DATA DO NOT MATCH (WNo., , ) A L S Blue

gh
Comparison between the external storage medium contents and the NC memory contents has shown disparities in data
Cause

ri
size, type of file information, etc.

ll
1. Locate those disparities on the PROGRAM FILE display and correct them, and then make the comparison once again.

.A
Action
2. If the disparities exist in data other than machining program data, check if the data is for the machine being used.

N
O
511 PROGRAM DATA NOT SAME (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue

TI
Comparison between the cassette tape or floppy disk contents and the NC data has shown several disparities.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO

1. After correcting the disparities within the machining program, make the comparison once again.
30

2. If the disparities exist in data other than machining program data, locate those disparities on each display.
R
o.

Note :
N

Action
C

This alarm message may be displayed if data is saved prior to automatic operation and then subjected to comparison
al

with that after automatic operation. This is because execution of automatic operation may cause automatic data
ri

ZA

overriding.
Se

512 NO EIA/ISO OPTION (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


IM

An attempt has been made to load an EIA/ISO program in spite of the absence of an EIA/ISO option.
Cause
K
ZA

An EIA/ISO program cannot be loaded since the system has no EIA/ISO option.
A

Action
M
YA

513 PROGRAM DATA TYPE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt has been made to load a machining program different in structure from the programs within the NC memory.
3

Cause
01
)2

Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system.
(c

Action
ht

514 DATA TYPE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr

An attempt has been made to load data (other than machining program data) that differs in structure from the NC memory
Cause
op

data.
C

Check whether the contents of the external storage medium are appropriate for the Smooth system or the machine being
Action used.

515 INCORRECT DESIGNATED DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


1. During I/O operation with a memory card, an attempt has been made to load data the structure of which is not correct.
Cause
2. During I/O operation with a floppy disk, an attempt has been made to load data the structure of which is not correct.
1. Check if the data saved during I/O operation with a memory card is for the Smooth system.
Action
2. Check if the data saved during I/O operation with a floppy disk is for the Smooth system.

3-79
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
516 SYSTEM ERROR ( , , ) E L S Blue
1. When program loading was attempted, there was not a comment file (C:\MC_MachinePrograms\index.tbl).
Cause
2. An error has occurred within the system.
1. Enter any comment on the PROGRAM FILE display, and load the program. Do not edit or delete “index.tbl” since it is
the management file for NC.
Action 2. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center. (At this time, also please notify them of what kind
of operating procedure you had carried out before the alarm message appeared and what values were displayed in
parentheses.)
517 PROG. OPERATION NOT ALLOWED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
1. An attempt has been made to save a display inhibiting program. (Program management function)
Cause
2. An attempt has been made to save the program being edited or the program being loaded using another I/O unit.

d .
ve
1. Check if the specified work number is for the program of display inhibition.

er
Action 2. Carry out a saving operation only after completion of the program editing operation (or the program loading operation

s
using another I/O unit).

re
518 DATA OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) A L S Blue

ts
gh
1. An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause

ri
2. An attempt has been made to save the data being loaded using another I/O unit.

ll
3. An attempt has been made to load the data being saved using another I/O unit.

.A
Wait until automatic operation has been completed (or until the loading or saving operation using another I/O unit has been
Action

N
completed).

O
TI
519 DATA SIZE EXCEEDED (WNo., Note, ) A L S Blue
16

A
The EIA/ISO machining program includes a block that consists of more than 256 characters. (EOB or EOR does not
R
04

appear within 256 characters.)


PO
30

Cause Note :
R
o.

The number displayed next to the work number is a line number, which corresponds to the number displayed in the lower
O
N

right section of the PROGRAM display.


C
al

Correct the EIA/ISO machining program. (Insert EOB within 256 characters.)
K

Action
ri

ZA
Se

520 EIA/ISO CONVERT ERROR (WNo., , ) B L S Blue


IM

Nonconvertible sections have been found when an attempt was made to convert the MAZATROL program into an EIA/ISO
Cause program.
K
ZA

Review the MAZATROL program.


A

Action
M
YA

521 CANNOT LOAD (WRONG PROG TYPE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


The operator has attempted loading a machining program of a scheme different from the program scheme within the NC
3

Cause unit.
01
)2

Confirm the program scheme of the machining program.


Action
(c
ht

522 SAME SET No. EXISTS ( , , ) B L S Blue


ig
yr

An attempt has been made to load the GL setup data that has the same GL setup number as that of setup data registered
Cause within the NC unit.
op
C

Rename or erase the GL setup data within the NC unit before loading the data.
Action

523 IMPOSSIBLE TO CONVERT EIA (Prg. No. Processing No., , ) B L S Blue


1. The parameter file does not exist under the same directory as that of the program.
Cause 2. The G-code is other than standard G-code Series A.
3. The program is a subprogram.
1. Save the parameter file under the same directory as that of the program.
Action 2. The G code cannot be converted since it is not supported by the Smooth system.
3. The program cannot be converted since the system concerned is unknown.

3-80
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
524 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

525 HDD I/O ERROR (Cause, , ) E I S Blue


An error has occurred while outputting data of the measurement results print-out function to a local disk.
Cause

Check if the available space within the local drive is sufficient for the purpose.
Action

.d
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-81
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
526 PROFIBUS-DP COMMUNICATION ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E L M, O, Q Blue
Communication error has occurred during the PROFIBUS-DP communication using a field network expansion card.
Note :
1.

○○ 

Global error bit


Indicates the error status (hexadecimal).
01: Control error (parameter error)
02: Auto clear error
(Since an update at a slave station has failed, updates at all slave stations have

d.
stopped.)

ve
04: No-exchange error (a slave station has an update error)

er
08: Critical error (communication cannot continue due to a serious network problem)

s
re
10: Not ready (NC communication is not ready)

ts
20: Timeout error (a timeout is detected during an update with each station)

gh
Master communication status

ri
Indicates the status of the master station (hexadecimal).

ll
.A
00: Off-line (being initialized)

N
40: Stop (I/O stopped)

O
80: Clear (resetting the output data from each slave station by sending “0” data)

TI
C0: Running (I/O being updated)
16

2.
A
R
04

PO
30


R
o.

Slave communication status


N

Cause
Indicates the communication status of the slave station at which a communication error is
al

occurring (hexadecimal).
ri

ZA
Se

00: The target slave exists on the bus.


A

An appropriate data communication is being made between the master station and
IM

the target slave station.


K

01: No data communication is being made between the master station and the target
ZA

slave station.
Configuration with the target slave station may not be finished correctly.
A
M

There may be no response from the target slave station.


YA

02: No data communication may be being made between the master station and the
target slave station.
3

Diagnosis information from the target slave station may exist in the internal buffer of
01

the master station.


)2

03: The target slave exists on the bus. An appropriate data communication is being made
(c

between the master station and the target slave station.


ht

Diagnosis information from the target slave station may exist in the internal buffer of
ig

the master station.


yr
op

Slave station number


C

Indicates the number of the slave station at which a communication error is occurring
(hexadecimal).
However, if no communication is being made with the master station, “00” is displayed.
00: No communication is being made with the master station.
01: Station No. 1
02: Station No. 2



7D: Station No. 125

Check the environment of the master station or slave station at which a communication error is occurring.
Action

3-82
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
527 ETHERNET/IP COMMUNICATION ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E L M, O, Q Blue
1. Communication error has occurred during the EtherNet/IP communication using a field network expansion card.
2. EtherNet/IP connection wait time setting may not be appropriate.

Note :
1.

○○  

Adaptor status

0x00: Scanner stopped or connection failed

.d
0x01: Communication being made

ve
0x02: Communication stopped (communication with at least one adaptor station has

er
stopped)

s
re
ts
Scanner status

gh
0x01: Configuration not finished

ri
0x02: Stopped
Cause

ll
0x03: Idling

.A
0x04: Running

N
O
2.

TI
16

 A
R
04

PO
30

Communication error details


R
o.

0x0000: Scanner stopped or connection failed 0x0124: Parameter error


O
N

0x000c: Watchdog timeout 0x0125: Illegal network address


al

0x0100: Initialization failed 0x0126: No security memory


ri

ZA
Se

0x0101: Database access failed 0x0140: Network failure


A

0x0119: Configuration not executed 0x0141: Communication failure


IM

0x0120: Configuration failed 0x0142: Communication timeout


K

0x0121: Data mismatch 0x0143: Network isolation


ZA

0x0122: Data discrepancy 0x0144: Node redundancy


A

0x0123: Inadequate data license 0x0145: Cable not connected


M
YA

1. Check the environment of the scanner or adaptor at which a communication error is occurring.
Action
2. Review the EtherNet/IP connection wait time setting, and turn power off and then back on.
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-83
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
528 FIELDNETWORK SETTING ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E L M Blue
Note :
1.

Cause

1: The value at R19974 (field network output data top register) is out of the setting range.

2: The value at R19976 (field network input data top register) is out of the setting range.

3: The value specified at the register R for high-speed data input/output is out of the setting range.
Cause 4: The value of parameter F150 is out of the setting range.

d .
2.

ve
er
Field network expansion card type

s
re
0: Not connected

ts
1: PROFIBUS-DP unit

gh
ri
2: EtherNet/IP unit

ll
1. Review the value at R19974 (field network output data top register).

.A
2. Review the value at R19976 (field network input data top register).

N
Action
3. Review the value at the register R for high-speed data input/output.

O
TI
4. Review the value of parameter F150.
16

529 CC-LINK COMMUNICATION ERROR ( No., ,


A ) E L M (O) Blue
R
04

PO

A communication error has occurred in the CC-LINK communication.


30

Cause
R
o.

Check the method of connection and communication.


N

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

530 CMT MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue


Se

This message implies incorrect cable connection between CMT (cassette magnetic tape unit) or microdisk unit and the NC
IM

Cause unit, or implies a power-off status or an incorrect baud-rate setting.


In the case of microdisk unit, this message also implies incorrect setting of a floppy disk.
K
ZA

1. Check for correct cable connections.


2. Check if power is turned on.
A

Action
M

3. Check for correct baud-rate setting. (Parameter for the NC unit: Baud rate)
YA

4. For microdisk unit, check if the floppy disk is correctly set.


531 DESIGNATED FILE NOT FOUND (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
3
01

The machining program or another data that has been designated for the LOAD or COMPARE operation does not exist
Cause
)2

within the cassette tape or floppy disk.


(c

Carry out a DIRECTORY operation to check what type of data is stored on the cassette tape or floppy disk.
ht

Action
ig
yr

532 CMT NOT CONNECTED ( , , ) A L S Blue


op

A cassette tape or floppy disk drive has not been mounted.


Cause
C

Correctly mount a cassette tape or floppy disk drive.


Action

533 NO OPERABLE DATA IN CMT ( , , ) A L S Blue


The current M640 series-use cassette tape or floppy disk does not contain a saved machining program (only machining
Cause programs can be loaded from M640 series-use cassette tape or floppy disk).

The cassette tape or floppy disk that has been registered for M640 series use does not contain a registered machining
Action program.
Perform checks using the M640 series NC unit.

3-84
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
534 CMT I/O ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
A hardware error has occurred in the CMT or microdisk unit.
Cause

Check the CMT or microdisk unit baud rate setting (RS-232C setting parameter), and replace the cassette tape or floppy
Action disk.

535 CMT WRITE PROTECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


Data saving onto a write-protected cassette tape or floppy disk has been attempted.
Cause

The cassette tape or floppy disk is protected against data writing.


Action Release the write-protected state.

d .
ve
(For cassette tape, fill in the hole on the tape surface with tape.)

er
536 POWER OFF DURING CMT OPERATION ( , , ) A L S Blue

s
re
Power has been turned off during operation of the CMT or microdisk unit.
Cause

ts
gh
Check the machining program being transferred. If an anomaly is found, repeat the desired operation. If this alarm state

ri
Action has occurred during loading of a machining program, erase the loaded portion of the program and then execute the loading
again.

ll
.A
537 CMT MALFUNCTION ( , , ) G L S Blue

N
Data cannot be read because of the presence of check sum errors, for example, within the cassette tape or floppy disk

O
Cause contents.

TI
16

A
Reread the data only after setting a new cassette tape or floppy disk or after saving the corresponding data.
Action
R
04

PO
30

538 CC-LINK UNCONNECTED ( , , ) E L M (O) Blue


R
o.

Connection cables between the CC-LINK unit and each device are disconnected or broken.
N

Cause
C
al

K
ri

Check the data at registers SW0080 to SW0083 to identify the error station and check its cable connection.
ZA
Se

Action
A
IM

539 —— ( , , )
K

Cause ——
ZA
A
M

Action ——
YA

540 TAPE READER MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue


3

This message implies incorrect cable connection between tape reader or microdisk unit and the NC unit or implies a
01

Cause power-off state. In the case of microdisk unit, this message also implies incorrect setting of a floppy disk.
)2
(c

1. Check for correct cable connections.


ht

Action 2. Check if power is turned on.


ig

3. In the case of microdisk unit, check if the floppy disk is correctly set.
yr

541 TAPE PUNCHER MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue


op

This message implies incorrect cable connection between tape puncher or microdisk unit and the NC unit or implies a
C

Cause power-off state. In the case of microdisk unit, this message also implies incorrect setting of a floppy disk.

1. Check for correct cable connections.


Action 2. Check if power is turned on.
3. In the case of microdisk unit, check if the floppy disk is correctly set.
542 NO TAPE READER PUNCHER OPTION ( , , ) A L S Blue
An attempt has been made to carry out a tape I/O operation although the tape reader/puncher option is not provided.
Cause

Provide the NC unit with a tape reader/puncher option. (Only with this option, tape I/O operations can be carried out.)
Action

3-85
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
543 WNo. NOT FOUND ON PAPER TAPE ( , , ) A L S Blue
Loading or comparing is not possible since no O numbers (work numbers) are stored on the paper tape or floppy disk.
Cause

Call the DATA I/O display (TAPE) and designate a work number(s).
Action

544 SET NEW PAPER TAPE ( , , ) A L S Blue


1. The tape reader/puncher is not correctly loaded with paper tape.
Cause 2. Differences in baud-rate or other parameter settings for RS-232C exist between the tape reader/puncher (or microdisk
unit) and the NC unit.
1. Check if the tape reader/puncher is correctly loaded with paper tape.

.
Action

d
2. Check for differences in RS-232C parameter settings between the I/O unit and the NC unit.

ve
er
545 POWER OFF TAPE READ/PUNCH OPER. ( , , ) A L S Blue

s
Power has been turned off during operation of the tape reader/puncher or microdisk unit.

re
Cause

ts
gh
If power has been turned off during loading, check the machining program loaded. If an error(s) is found, delete the loaded
Action data and then reload the program. If power has been turned off during punching, re-punch the tape.

ri
ll
546 TAPE READER ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue

.A
A hardware error has occurred in the tape reader or the microdisk unit.

N
Cause

O
TI
Before operating the tape reader or microdisk unit, check that no differences in RS-232C parameter settings exist between
16

Action A
the tape reader or microdisk unit and the NC unit and replace the paper tape or floppy disk.
R
04

PO
30

547 TAPE PUNCHER ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue


R

A hardware error has occurred in the tape puncher or the microdisk unit.
o.

Cause
N

C
al

Before operating the tape puncher or microdisk unit, check that no differences in RS-232C parameter settings exist
ri

Action
ZA

between the tape puncher or microdisk unit and the NC unit and replace the paper tape or floppy disk.
Se

548 MAZATROL PROGRAM DESIGNATED ( , , ) A L S Blue


IM

An attempt has been made to punch a MAZATROL program onto paper tape.
Cause
K
ZA

Designate an EIA/ISO program.


A

Action
(Only EIA/ISO programs can be punched on paper tape.)
M
YA

549 DESIGNATED DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


The designated data was not found on the paper tape or floppy disk.
3

Cause
01
)2

Select another set of data or make a search once again from the beginning of the paper tape or floppy disk.
(c

Action
ht

550 PARITY H ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


ig
yr
op

The contents of the paper tape or floppy disk cannot be read since they include a parity-H error(s). (The
number of holes on tape must always be even for ISO; it must be odd for EIA).
C

Cause
 Sprocket

Reading must be carried out only after replacing the paper tape or floppy disk or after re-punching the program.
Action

3-86
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
551 PARITY V ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
The contents of the paper tape or floppy disk cannot be read since they include a parity-V error(s).

E E E
O O O
Cause B B B

The number of sprocket holes in this area must be even.

Make reading possible by making bit 1 of parity V-check valid/invalid parameter TAP25 invalid.
Action

552 PROGRAM END NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue

. d
ve
A machining program in which EOR precedes the end M-code (M02, M30 or M99) or the next O number (work number)
Cause was loaded.

s er
The end-of-program condition can be changed by varying the settings of the parameter (TAP27).

re
Since the machining program has already been loaded, the PROGRAM display must be called and then one of the above

ts
Action three end M-codes must be inserted in the program.

gh
553 WORK No. UNITS EXCEEDED ( , , ) B L S Blue

ri
ll
An attempt has been made to load the program of a work number of more than four digits in spite of the fact that the

.A
Cause maximum allowable number of digits in one work number is set to four.

N
Check bit 3 of parameter TAP26.

O
Action

TI
16

554 POWER OFF IN EIA/ISO CONVERT ( , ,


A) A L S Blue
R
04

PO

Power has been turned off during EIA/ISO conversion.


30

Cause
R
o.

Check the EIA/ISO program being converted. If an anomaly is found, erase the program and repeat the conversion.
N

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

555 —— ( , , )
Se

A
IM

Cause ——
K
ZA

Action ——
A

556 —— ( , , )
M
YA

Cause ——
3
01

Action ——
)2
(c

557 DESIGNATED DIRECTORY NOT FOUND ( , , ) B (A) I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht

The designated directory does not exist.


ig

Cause
yr
op

Check if the designated directory exists.


Action
C

( , , )

Cause

Action

3-87
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
563 PRINTER I/O ERROR (Cause, , ) G L S Blue
An error in printer communications has occurred during measurement result printing.
Cause

 Check the printer for correct connection.


Action
 Check for differences in the RS-232C parameter settings between the printer and NC unit.

564 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

.
d
ve
565 ID MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue

er
Erroneous cable connection has occurred during connection of the ID unit and the NC unit, or power has remained turned

s
Cause off.

re
ts
Check for incorrect cable connections.

gh
Action
Or check if the power is turned on.

ri
566 POWER STOPPED DURING ID OPER. ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
Power has been turned off during the operation of the ID unit.
Cause

N
O
Check the current tool data, and if errors are found, operate the unit once again.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

567 ID I/O ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue


PO
30

Communication between the NC unit and the ID unit has become interrupted because of hardware trouble (such as line
R

Cause noise).
o.

O
N

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

568 IBS COMMUNICATION ERROR (Note 1, Note 2, ) E I P Blue


A
IM

An error occurred in bar loader communication with the IBS (intelligent bar loader system).
Note :
K
ZA

1. Details of communication error


1: Transmission of the schedule data does not start.
A
M

Cause 2: Writing of the material length and cut-off position does not complete.
YA

3: Inconsistent work number.


4: Transmission of top-cut work number does not start.
3
01

5: Inconsistent top-cut work number


)2

2. Schedule number that caused communication error.


(c

Press the RESET key and tap [SCHEDULE OPERAT.] on the BL SCHEDULE display again to highlight it.
Action
ht
ig

569 —— ( , , )
yr
op

Cause ——
C

Action ——

570 NO DNC OPTION ( , , ) A L S Blue


DNC operation was attempted although DNC option is not provided.
Cause

Provide the NC unit with a DNC option. (Only with this option, DNC operation can be carried out.)
Action

3-88
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
571 ILLEGAL FORMAT ( , , ) A L S Blue
Data other than that of the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system has been received from the host (the format of
Cause the message is incorrect).

Check whether the received data from the host is for the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system.
Action

572 CANNOT LOAD (PROG SIZE EXCEED) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


The contents of the transmitted machining program from the host system are not correct.
Cause
(More than 2000 lines of MAZATROL program data have been transmitted.)
Check the size of the program which has been transmitted from the host system.
Action

d .
ve
573 CANNOT LOAD (TOO MANY PROGRAMS) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue

er
An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be

s
Cause registered within the NC unit.

re
ts
Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the

gh
Action particular program.

ri
574 CANNOT LOAD (AUTO OPERATION) ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause

N
O
Load such data only after completion of automatic operation.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

575 CANNOT LOAD (MISMATCH) ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

Loading has been attempted when the transmitted data from the host system does not match to the data or other
R

Cause parameter settings within the NC unit (mismatching in data size, etc.).
o.

O
N

Check if the data that has been transmitted from the host system is that which is to be used for the machine being used.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

576 SAME PROGRAM No. DESIGNATED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

An attempt has been made to load the machining program that has the same work number as that of a machining program
Cause registered within the NC unit.
K
ZA

Check for an overlapping work number. This alarm message also implies that the parameter (DNC26, bit 2) is set for the
Action priority of the old program over a new one. If the parameter is set to 0, the old data will automatically be deleted in such a
A

case as mentioned above and the new program data can be loaded with the specified work number.
M
YA

577 NO DESIGNATED PROGRAM (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


 The machining program whose transmission from the NC unit to the host system has been attempted does not exist
3

within the NC unit.


01

Cause
 The machining program that has been designated using a control command (work number search or program deletion)
)2

does not exist within the NC unit.


(c

Check if the machining program with the specified work number exists in the NC unit.
ht

Action
ig
yr

578 MEMORY CAPACITY EXCEEDED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


op

An attempt has been made to load more machining programs than the maximum number of programs that can be
C

Cause registered within the NC unit.

Delete unnecessary programs, or save the programs onto an external storage and then delete them. After that, load the
Action particular program.

579 MEMORY PROTECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


Loading has been attempted although the program protect function was set valid.
Cause

Cancel the program protect function.


Action The program protect function is valid due to the setting of parameter (DNC26 bit 3). Therefore, it is possible to make the
program protect function invalid by setting it to ON (1).

3-89
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
580 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

581 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

d .
ve
582 DESIGNATED FILE NOT TRANSFERED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
A file different from the one that has been requested from NC unit to the host system was transferred from the latter.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the details of the file that has been transferred from the host system.

gh
Action

ri
583 PROGRAM DATA TYPE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
An attempt has been made to load a machining program that is different in structure from those stored within the NC unit.
Cause

N
O
 Confirm that the program to be transferred from the host is for the MATRIX system, Smart, or the Smooth system.

TI
Action
16

 Check if the contents of the file transfer message (header block) are correct.
A
R
04

584 RECEIVED DATA TYPE INCORRECT ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

 An attempt has been made to load data other than machining program data and also different in structure from the data
R

stored within the NC unit.


o.

Cause
N

 The contents of the header block or data block in the file transfer message (including machining programs) are not
C
al

correct.
K
ri

ZA

 Check if the data that has been transferred from the host system is for use with the Smooth system or for use with the
Se

machine being used.


A

Action

IM

Check the contents of the header block (version number, etc.) or data block (sequence number, etc.) in the file transfer
message.
K

585 CABLE MIS-CONNECTED ( , , ) G L S Blue


ZA

This message implies incorrect cable connection between the host system and the NC unit or implies a power-off status.
A

Cause
M
YA

 Check if the DNC cables are correctly connected.


 Check if the host system is turned on and ready for data transmission/reception.
3

Action
01

There may be cases that although a DNC option is provided, DNC itself is not to be used for the time being and thus the
DNC cables are not yet connected. If this is the case, then set the appropriate parameter (DNC26, bit 1) to OFF (0). This
)2

will clear the alarm display.


(c

586 SYSTEM ERROR ( , , ) E L S Blue


ht

An error has occurred within the system.


ig

Cause
yr
op

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center. (At this time, also please notify them of what kind of
C

Action operating procedure you had carried out before the alarm message appeared and what values were displayed in
parentheses.)
587 PROG. OPERATION NOT ALLOWED (WNo., , ) A L S Blue
1. An attempt has been made to transmit a display inhibiting program to the host system. (Program management
function)
Cause
2. An attempt has been made to transmit to the host system the program being edited (or the program being loaded using
another I/O unit).
1. Check if the specified work number is for the program of display inhibition.
Action 2. Carry out the transfer operation only after completion of the program editing (or program loading using another I/O
unit).

3-90
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
588 DATA OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) A L S Blue
 An attempt has been made during automatic operation to load data other than machining program data.
Cause  An attempt has been made to transmit to the host system the data being loaded using another I/O unit.
 An attempt has been made to load the data being saved using another I/O unit.
Wait until automatic operation has been completed (or until the loading or saving operation using another I/O unit has been
Action completed).

589 DATA SIZE EXCEEDED (WNo., Note, ) A L S Blue


The EIA/ISO machining program includes a block that consists of more than 256 characters. (EOB or EOR is not present
within 256 characters.)
Cause Note :

d .
The number displayed next to the work number is a line number, which corresponds to the number displayed in the lower

ve
right section of the PROGRAM display.

er
Correct the machining program. (Insert EOB within 256 characters.)

s
Action

re
ts
590 DNC COMMAND IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue

gh
The particular status of the NC unit disables execution of the control command that has been requested from the host

ri
system.

ll
Cause  A request for work number search has been made during automatic operation.

.A
 During automatic operation, a request for deleting the machining program being used for the automatic operation has

N
been made.

O
Wait until the NC unit becomes ready for processing or until the automatic operation is completed, and then make the

TI
Action
16

request once again. A


R
04

591 NO OPTION (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

An attempt has been made to load (save) the data not supported by the current option of the DNC unit.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Only data supported by the option can be processed.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

592 ILLEGAL COMMAND RECEIVED ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

 The control command or file transfer command that has been requested from the host system is a nonexistent
command.
K

Cause
 The machine number that has been designated for the loading of data other than machining program data does not
ZA

agree with any of the machine numbers within the NC unit.


A

 Check the details of the command message that has been sent from the host system.
M

Action
 Check if the machine number is the same as that registered within the NC unit (parameter DNC19).
YA

593 DNC I/O ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue


3
01

 During use of DNC, processing has been aborted by line noise or other hardware factors.
)2

 RS-232C communication parameter settings (such as those of the baud-rate, etc.) between the host system and NC
Cause
unit differ.
(c

 Timer, number-of-retries or other settings are not correct.


ht
ig

 Make line checks and hardware checks of the host system and NC unit.
yr

 Match the RS-232C communication parameter settings between the host system and NC unit.
Action
op

 Set the timer, number-of-retries, or other settings to those of the host system. (Parameters for the NC unit: DNC
C

parameters)
594 SEND-RECEIVE ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
 The preset number of retries has been exceeded during transmission/reception of command messages.
 RS-232C communication parameter settings (such as those of the baud-rate, etc.) between the host system and NC
Cause
unit differ.
 Timer, number-of-retries or other settings are not correct.
 Make line checks and message checks of the host systems.
 Match the RS-232C communication parameter settings between the host system and NC unit.
Action
 Set the timer, number-of-retries or other settings to those of the host system. (Parameters for the NC unit: DNC
parameters)

3-91
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
595 FILE TRANSFER ERROR ( , , ) G L S Blue
 The preset number of retries has been exceeded during transmission/reception of the messages.
 RS-232C communication parameter settings (such as those of the baud-rate, etc.) between the host system and NC
Cause
unit differ.
 Timer, number-of-retries or other settings are not correct.
 Make line checks and message checks of the host systems.
 Match the RS-232C communication parameter settings between the host system and NC unit.
Action
 Set the timer, number-of-retries or other settings to those of the host system. (Parameters for the NC unit: DNC
parameters)
596 DNC MALFUNCTION ( , , ) G L S Blue
An irretrievable hardware error has occurred during reception of the first message (ENQ) from the host system.

d .
Cause

ve
er
After making hardware checks of the NC and host systems and line checks, turn the NC unit power back on and then

s
Action restart the receiving operation.

re
ts
597 POWER OFF DURING DNC OPERATION ( , , ) A L S Blue

gh
Power has been turned off during DNC operation.
Cause

ri
ll
.A
Check for errors in the machining program being used, and if errors are found, carry out the DNC operation once again.
Action Note, however, that if the machining program is being loaded, then loading must be carried out once again after erasing the

N
loaded contents of the program.

O
TI
598 NO EIA/ISO OPTION ( , , ) A L S Blue
16

A
An attempt has been made to transfer EIA/ISO program although the NC unit is not provided with an EIA/ISO option.
R
04

Cause
PO
30

Without an EIA/ISO option, EIA/ISO program processing is not possible.


R

Action
o.

O
N

599 DESIGNATED DATA NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


al

K
ri

The host system has issued a request for transmission/reception of data not existing within the NC unit.
ZA
Se

Cause  A drum-tool data transfer request has been issued to the NC unit though it is not provided with a drum.
A
IM

 A request for transfer of a larger volume of data than the control data stored within the NC unit has been made.
Check the contents of the command messages that have been sent from the host system.
K

Action
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-92
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
3-2-7 No. 600 - No. 699, No. 1600 - No. 1699 (MAZATROL program error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
600 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

601 SYSTEM ERROR ( , , ) E I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A processing error has occurred within the NC unit.
Cause

d.
Using data I/O operation, save the program data, tool data, tool file data, parameters, etc. that are currently being used.

ve
Action After that, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

s er
602 PROG. OPERATION NOT ALLOWED ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
An attempt has been made to start the program being transferred.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
After the transfer operation is completed, start the program.
Action

ll
.A
603 NO DESIGNATED PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
 The program having the work number that has been set in the subprogram unit does not exist within the memory.

O
TI
Cause  No work number has been set in the subprogram unit.
16

 A
The work number that has been designated as the restart position does not exist within the memory.
R
04

Review the machining programs to see if the designated program exists.


PO
30

Action
R
o.

604 NO PITCH IN MULTI WORKPIECES (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N

 Pitch X is not yet set in spite of the fact that multi-piece machining in the direction of the X-axis is to take place.
al

Cause
ri


ZA

Pitch Y is not yet set in spite of the fact that multi-piece machining in the direction of the Y-axis is to take place.
Se

Review the particular machining program and then set an appropriate multi-piece machining pitch in the common unit.
A

Action
IM
K

605 NO TOOL DATA IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA

The point-, line- or face-machining (including 3-D) unit does not contain any tool sequences.
Cause
A
M

Review the particular machining program to see if there are units that do not contain necessary tool sequences.
YA

Action
3

606 NO FIGURE IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01

The point-, line- or face-machining (including 3-D) unit does not have any shape data.
)2

Cause
(c
ht

Review the particular machining program to see if there are units that do not contain necessary shape data.
Action
ig
yr

607 MISSING INPUT DATA (POINT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

A point-machining unit lacks data.


C

Cause

Review the particular machining program, and set data if a point-machining unit lacks data.
Action

608 MISSING INPUT DATA (LINE) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A line-machining unit lacks data.
Cause

Review the particular machining program, and set data if a line-machining unit lacks data.
Action

3-93
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
609 MISSING INPUT DATA (FACE) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A face-machining unit lacks data.
Cause

Review the particular machining program, and set data if a face-machining unit lacks data.
Action

610 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A point-machining tool sequence lacks data.
Cause

Review the particular machining program, and set data if a point-machining tool sequence lacks data.
Action

.d
ve
611 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR LINE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
A line-machining tool sequence lacks data.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a line-machining tool sequence lacks data.

gh
Action

ri
612 MISSING TOOL DATA FOR FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
A face-machining (including 3-D) tool sequence lacks data.
Cause

N
O
Review the particular machining program, and set data if a face-machining tool sequence lacks data.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

613 DATA MISSING IN WPC UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The WPC unit lacks data.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the particular machining program, and set data if the WPC unit lacks data.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

614 SUB PROGRAM NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The maximum permissible number of repeats of MAZATROL program nesting has been exceeded nine.
Cause
K
ZA

Review and correct the particular machining program so that the total number of repeats of nesting does not excess nine.
Action
A
M

615 DATA MISSING IN OFFSET UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The offset unit lacks data.


Cause
3
01

Review the particular machining program, and set data if the offset unit lacks data.
)2

Action
(c
ht

616 DATA ERROR IN M CODE UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The M-code unit contains no data.


yr

Cause
op

Review the particular machining program, and input data to the M-code unit.
C

Action

617 EXECUTION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The data processing operation cannot be performed because of contradiction in data. This condition occurs if an attempt is
Cause made to start automatic operation when the specified work number is an unregistered number.

Search out the contradictory data making reference to WNo., UNo., SNo. (which are displayed together with the alarm
Action message), and then correct the data.

3-94
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
618 POINT CUTTING PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The point-machining parameter setting(s) is out of its permissible range.
Cause

Action ——

619 LINE/FACE CUTTING PAR. ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The line- or face-machining parameter settings are out of their permissible ranges.
Cause

The parameter E13 is set to “0”; change it to a value other than “0”.
Action

d.
ve
620 CUTTING SPEED ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
Of tool sequence data (except for chip removal), the surface speed (C-SP) is unset or set to “0”.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the machining program and set the desired surface speed (C-SP).

gh
Action

ri
621 FEEDRATE ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
Of tool sequence data (except for chip removal), the feedrate (FR) is unset or set to “0”.
Cause

N
O
Review the machining program and set the desired feedrate (FR).

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

622 DESIGNATED UNIT NOT FOUND ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


PO
30

The unit that has been designated as the restart position is not present in the program with the specified work number.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the machining program and designate the correct unit number.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

623 DESIGNATED SNo. NOT FOUND ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A
IM

The tool sequence that has been designated as the restart position is not present in the unit of the specified work number;
Cause two or more lines of tool sequence data are present in the line-machining chamfering unit.
K
ZA

Review the machining program and designate the correct tool sequence number.
Action
A
M

624 RESTART IMPOSSIBLE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


YA

 The unit that has been designated as the restart position is the end unit.
3

Cause  The designated number of times of reappearance (L) is too large and the corresponding restart position is not present.
01

 The restart data is incomplete.


)2

Check the contents of the restart data or the program.


(c

Action
ht
ig

625 ENDMILL DIAMETER EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr

 The value of “(groove width) – (finish allowance R) × 2” of the endmill groove unit is smaller than the “tool diameter”
op

Cause value of the rough-machining tool.


C

 The “groove width” value of the endmill groove unit is smaller than the “tool diameter” value of the finishing tool.

Action ——

626 DESIGNATED TOOL NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool(s) specified in the program is not registered in the tool data.
Cause

Carry out a tool layout operation and register the necessary tool(s) on the TOOL DATA display.
Action

3-95
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
627 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The data of the tool length or tool diameter is not yet input on the TOOL DATA display.
Cause

Review the tool data and input the tool length or tool diameter.
Action

628 NO ASSIGNED TOOL IN TOOL FILE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool specified in the program is not registered on the TOOL FILE display.
Cause

Register the tool data that is to be used in the program into the tool file.
Action

d .
ve
629 TOOL FILE INPUT PROCESS ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The tool file lacks of data.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the data on the TOOL FILE display and fill in any empty items with data.

gh
Action

ri
630 Z DEPTH OF CUT TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
Of the line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the value of the Z depth of cut is in excess of the depth of cut on the
Cause TOOL FILE display.

N
O
Review the machining program and correct the value of the Z depth of cut.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

631 STOCK REMOVAL R TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The value of “(removal allowance R) – (finish allowance R)” in the line-machining unit is larger than the value of the tool
R
o.

Cause diameter of the rough-cutting tool.


O
N

The value of removal allowance R in the line-machining unit is larger than the value of the tool diameter of the finishing tool.
C
al

Review the machining program and correct the values of removal allowance R and finishing allowance R in the
ri

Action
ZA

line-machining unit.
Se

632 RADIAL DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM

Of line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the radial depth of cut is set to zero or smaller.
Cause
K
ZA

Review the machining program and set the radial depth of cut to the correct value.
A

Action
M
YA

633 Z DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Of line- or face-machining tool sequence data, the Z depth of cut is set to zero or smaller.
3

Cause
01
)2

Review the machining program and set the Z depth of cut to the correct value.
(c

Action
ht

634 FINISH DEPTH OF CUT ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr

The finish allowance value in the line- or face-machining unit is set to zero in spite of the fact that a finishing tool is
Cause
op

registered.
C

Review the machining program and set data in the finish allowance data item.
Action

635 TOOL DIAMETER ZERO (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Of tool data, the tool diameter setting is zero.
Cause

Review the data on the TOOL DATA display and set data in the tool diameter item.
Action

3-96
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
636 STOCK REMOVAL Z TOO SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the line- or face-machining unit, removal allowance Z is smaller than finish allowance Z.
Cause

Review the line- or face-machining unit and increase removal allowance Z to a value greater than that of finish allowance Z.
Action

637 STOCK REMOVAL R TOO SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the line- or face-machining unit, removal allowance R is smaller than finish allowance R.
Cause

Review the line- or face-machining unit and increase the value of removal allowance R to a value greater than that of finish
Action allowance R.

d.
ve
638 R DEPTH OF CUT TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
Of the face-machining tool sequence data, the setting of the radial depth of cut is smaller than the tool diameter setting on

s
Cause

re
the TOOL DATA display.

ts
Review the machining program and increase the radial depth of cut to a value greater than the tool diameter setting in the

gh
Action tool data.

ri
639 DESIGNATED PALLET NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The pallet number that has been set in the pallet changing unit is larger than the maximum allowable number of pallets set
Cause in the parameter L46.

N
O
Review the machining program and set an allowable pallet number.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

640 ILLEGAL INDEX ANGLE INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The data that has been set in the angle item of the indexing unit is that which cannot be divided by the parameter L37
R

Cause
o.

setting (minimum allowable angle of index).


O
N

Review the machining program and set an allowable angle of index.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

641 MISSING INPUT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The pallet changing unit or the indexing unit lacks of unit data.
Initial point Z is not yet set in the common unit.
K
ZA

CPT-X, CPT-Z or rotational direction is not yet set in the mill-turning unit.
Cause
When "SHIFT - R.T" is set in the WPC shift unit with the machine equipped with table selection function, the rotational
A
M

center is not set in the table selection unit.


YA

The table is not set in the table selection unit.


Review the machining program and set all the necessary values in the unit.
3

Action
01
)2

642 ILLEGAL NEXT PALLET No. INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c

The same pallet number as the current pallet number has been set as the next one.
Cause
ht
ig

Review the machining program and make sure of the pallet numbers.
yr

Action
op
C

643 DATA ERROR IN MAN. PROG. UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The manual program mode unit contains a sequence that has no data.
Cause

Review the machining program, and fill in any incomplete sequence with data or erase such sequences.
Action

3-97
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
644 NOMINAL DIAMETER NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The nominal diameter item of the tool sequence data is not complete. The nominal diameter item of the MMS unit or the
Cause manual program mode unit (when a tool is set) is not complete.

Review the machining program, and set data in the nominal diameter item of the MMS unit or the manual program mode
Action unit (when a tool is set) or erase the corresponding portion.

645 PRIORITY No. OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The same priority number is assigned to different tools.
Cause

Within one process, the same priority number must not be assigned to different tools.
Action
Change the priority number.

d.
ve
(WNo., UNo., SNo.)*
646 ILLEGAL PRIORITY NUMBER B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
(LNo. 1, LNo. 2, )**

s
re
The priority numbering order within a unit is not correct.

ts
* During setting the priority numbers on the PROGRAM display.
Cause

gh
** During setting the priority numbers on the PROGRAM LAYOUT display - data in the layout lines LNo. 1 and LNo. 2 are

ri
not correct.

ll
The machining order within one unit has been reversed by the incorrect priority numbering.

.A
Action
Change the priority numbers.

N
647 END UNIT NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
TI
The end unit is not present in the program.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO

Review the machining program and set the end unit at the end of the program.
30

Action
R
o.

O
N

648 MULTI OFFSET DATA TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C
al

More than 10 sets of offset data have been input for multi-piece machining.
K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

The machining program is in an abnormal state. If the program is already saved onto cassette tape, floppy disk or other
IM

Action media, erase the program and then reload it. If the program is not yet saved, make corrections with the editing function and
fully scan for more data errors.
K
ZA

649 MEASURING SEQUENCE INCOMPLETE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The measurement sequence lacks of data.
A

Cause
M
YA

Review the machining program, and input data to the measurement sequence to make it complete.
Action
3
01

650 CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

Cutting is impossible because the chamfering cutter is likely to come into contact with the wall or bottom of the workpiece
(c

Cause during chamfering.


ht

The data of the specified chamfering cutter on the TOOL DATA or TOOL FILE display is not appropriate.
ig

Review the machining program or the tool file, and correct inappropriate data.
yr

Action
op
C

651 GEAR PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the point-, line- or face-machining MAZATROL program when the setting of
Cause parameter SA51 was “5” or more.

Change the setting of parameter SA51 to a value between 0 and 4.


Action

3-98
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
652 GEAR SHIFT DATA ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tool sequence data contains an unavailable milling spindle gear-shift M-code(s).
Cause

Change the corresponding code(s) to an available one(s).


2-gear H : M39 3-gear H : M39 4-gear H : M39
Action L : M38 M : M38 MH : M38
L : M37 ML : M37
L : M36

653 ILLEGAL TOOL DESIGNATED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tools that cannot be used have been designated.
Cause

d.
ve
Review the machining program and designate tools that are usable.

er
Action

s
re
654 TOOL DATA ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
The tool length and tool diameter settings on the TOOL DATA display are negative.

gh
Cause

ri
ll
Set positive tool length and tool diameter values.

.A
Action

N
655 PROGRAM DATA CORRUPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
TI
The program is destroyed.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO

Erase a part of the program and then re-create the destroyed part; or erase the entire program and then carry out a loading
30

Action operation using the data I/O operation once again.


R
o.

O
N

656 MEASURING SEQ. DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C
al

The measurement units include one that has no sequence data.


K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Create one or more lines of sequence data in the corresponding measurement unit, or erase the unit.
IM

Action
K

657 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA

The program contains incorrect data.


A

Cause
M
YA

Review the machining program and make data corrections.


Action
3
01

658 INITIAL Z < MATERIAL DEPTH (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

The setting of the material height in the 3-D machining unit is greater than that of initial point Z in the common unit.
Cause
(c
ht

Change the program to give a material height value smaller than the initial point Z value.
ig

Action
yr
op

659 NO TOOL PATH CHECK (I/O BUSY) (WNo., , ) A L S Blue


C

The tool path check cannot be performed since I/O operation (loading) is in progress.
Cause

Make the tool path check after the I/O operation has been completed.
Action

660 CANNOT MOVE DESIGNATED AXIS ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


The Y-axis or Z-axis of the index position has been appointed using the indexing unit when the parameter L41 is set to “2”.
Cause

Clear the Y-axis or Z-axis data of the index position by tapping the cancel key.
Action

3-99
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
661 ILLEGAL M CODE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
M195 (tool breakage detection start command code) has been set for the M-code unit or for the manual program mode
Cause sequence.

M195 cannot be executed on MAZATROL programs. Delete that command code from the program.
Action

662 NO INCLINED PLANE OPTION (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the inclined-plane machining program in the absence of an inclined-plane machining
Cause option.

Inclined-plane machining is not possible because of the absence of an inclined-plane machining option.
Action

d.
ve
663 WRONG HEAD ANGLE (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
1. A corner-face unit or plane inclination measurement has been designated in unit data other than inclined-plane

s
machining unit data.

re
2. Table rotational machining has been designated in spite of the fact that the facial angle data in the face definition

ts
sequence is not for the top plane.

gh
3. Calibration measurement has been designated for the top plane or an inclined plane.

ri
4. Groove center, hole center, boss center, and step width measurements have been designated for an inclined plane.

ll
Cause

.A
5. Machining at the work hand side “↓Z” (B-axis at 90, approach in the Z-axis) has been specified for the direction of
the geometry sequence in coordinate measurement.

N
O
6. Machining at the work hand side “↓Z” (B-axis at 90, approach in the Z-axis) has been specified for the direction of

TI
the geometry sequence in workpiece measurement.
16

A
7. Measurement at the work hand side has been attempted with the parameter setting of L106 bit5 = 0 (B-axis
R
04

user-defined angle measurement invalid).


PO
30

1. A corner-face unit and plane inclination measurement can be designated only for an inclined plane.
R
o.

2. Table rotational machining can be executed only for the top plane.
O
N

3. Calibration measurement is possible only for the side.


al

4. Only reference plane measurement and plane inclination measurement are possible for inclined planes.
ri

ZA

5. Change the direction setting of the geometry sequence in coordinate measurement to “↓X” (B-axis at 90, approach in
Se

Action the X-axis).


A
IM

Alternatively, select “↓X”, “←Z”, or “←X” for measurement with the B-axis at 0.
6. Change the direction setting of the geometry sequence in workpiece measurement to “↓X” (B-axis at 90, approach in
K

the X-axis).
ZA

Alternatively, select “↓X”, “←Z”, or “←X” for measurement with the B-axis at 0.
A

7. Change the parameter setting to L106 bit5 = 1.


M
YA

664 3-D UNIT NOT FOUND IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A 3-D machining unit has been set in the program in spite of the fact that 3-D machining option is not provided.
3

Cause
01
)2

Erase the 3-D machining unit from the machining program.


Action
(c
ht

665 ILLEGAL DATA IN 3-D UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr

The 3-D machining unit lacks of unit data.


Cause
op
C

Review the machining program and set necessary data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action

666 PLANE DATA NOT FOUND IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The 3-D machining unit lacks of plane definition data.
Cause

Review the machining program and set plane definition data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action

3-100
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
667 CHECK SURFACE DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The 3-D machining unit lacks of check surface data.
Cause

Review the machining program and set check surface data in the 3-D machining unit.
Action

668 ILLEGAL PLANE DATA IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The plane definition data in the 3-D machining unit is not complete.
Cause

Review the machining program and set data in the plane definition data item.
Action

d.
ve
669 ILLEGAL TOLERANCE DATA INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The value of the tolerance parameter that has been designated in the tool sequence is “0”.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the parameters E67 through E75, and set a value other than “0” in the parameter whose setting is “0”.

gh
Action

ri
670 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA IN PRG. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The tool sequence in the 3-D machining unit lacks of data.
Cause

N
O
Review the machining program and input data to the tool sequence.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

671 ILLEGAL MOVE SURFACE DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The coordinate conversion data in the 3-D machining unit is not complete.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the machining program and make the coordinate conversion data complete.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

672 ILLEGAL AREA DATA INPUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

In the check surface data of the 3-D machining unit, the setting of the maximum value is smaller than that of the minimum
Cause value.
K
ZA

Review the check surface data, and make corrections so that the setting of the maximum value is equal to or greater than
Action that of the minimum value for each axis.
A
M

673 FL NUMBER EXCEEDED (3-D UNIT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

In the ruled-surface unit, the number of FLs is in excess of 20, or in the line- or face-machining unit, the number of defined
Cause
3

figures is in excess of 2.
01
)2

Review the machining program and correct the shape data.


Action
(c
ht

674 NO 5FACE CUTTING OPTION (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

An attempt has been made to execute a five-surface machining program when the five-surface machining option was not
yr

Cause present.
op
C

Set the five-surface machining option to execute a five-surface machining program.


Action

675 ILLEGAL CUTTING FACE DESIGNATED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
A face that cannot be cut with the selected head has been designated.
Cause

Change either the selected face or the head.


Action

3-101
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
676 ILLEGAL UNIT (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The face definition unit or 5-face machining unit includes illegal units and measurement sequences.
Illegal units and sequences:
face definition unit, pallet change unit, process end unit, index unit, WPC unit, and measurement of workpiece
inclination.
2. An MMS unit has been set in the program that has table rotational machining designated in its face definition
sequence.
3. Executing the mill-turning unit has been attempted in a machine not having a mill-turning option.
Cause 4. An attempt was made to run a program including a table selection unit on the machine not equipped with table
selection function or the machine equipped with table selection function but while the function is invalid (parameter
D106 bit 4 = 0).
5. C-axis machining has been selected for machining at the work hand side. Or, turning has been selected for

d .
machining at the work hand side.

ve
6. Workpiece measurement has been executed with the work hand at 0 other than in the workpiece transfer unit.

er
7. An attempt was made to execute an engraving unit on a machine that does not feature the engraving function option.

s
re
8. A 5-face machining unit is contained in the program set for multiple machining.

ts
1. Remove all illegal units and sequences from the machining program.

gh
2. MMS measurement is not possible while table rotational machining is effective.

ri
3. The mill-turning unit cannot be executed without a mill-turning option.

ll
.A
4. With the machine not equipped with table selection function, correct the program into a program without table selection
unit. With the machine equipped with table selection function, make table selection valid (parameter D106 bit 4 = 1)

N
Action and check the program and tool path before starting machining.

O
TI
5. Delete the C-axis machining unit and turning unit at the work hand side.
16

A
6. Set the work hand angle to 0 in the workpiece transfer unit.
R
04

7. No engraving unit can be executed since the engraving function option is not featured.
PO
30

8. 5-face machining units cannot be executed in the program set for multiple machining.
R
o.

677 UNREGISTERED HEAD DATA (WNo., UNo., ) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
O
N

Head data corresponding to the head of the designated head number does not exist.
al

Cause
K
ri

ZA
Se

Review the designated head number.


A

Action
IM

678 NO INTERSECTION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


K
ZA

In the line- or face-machining unit, the coordinates of the intersection point of figures cannot be obtained because of
Cause shortage of, or contradiction, in the free-shape data.
A
M
YA

Action ——
3

679 CONNECTING CORNER IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01

The figures cannot be connected smoothly at corner R because of contradiction in the data of corner R or in the data of the
)2

Cause figures in front and rear of corner R.


(c

Review the machining program and check the value of corner R of the free shapes.
ht

Action
ig
yr

680 NUMBER OF HOLES EXCEEDED (>500) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

The point-machining units include one(s) that has more than 500 holes defined in it.
C

Cause

Review the point-machining units, and make corrections so that the total number of hole settings in one point-machining
Action unit in not greater than 500.

681 CORNER R/C DEFINED AT SPT/FPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Corner rounding or corner chamfering has been set at the starting or ending point of a figure when defining figures in the
Cause central linear machining, right-hand linear machining, left-hand linear machining, right-hand chamfering or left-hand
chamfering units.
Review the machining program and correct it so that the corner rounding or corner chamfering is not set at the starting or
Action ending point.

3-102
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
682 ILLEGAL REPEAT FIGURE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Contradiction presides in the figure rotation or figure shift data that has been set during defining free figures in the line- or
Cause face-machining unit.

Review and correct the corresponding shape data.


Action

683 UNDEFINED CORNER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The specified size of corner rounding or chamfering is inadmissible.
Example :
This alarm does not occur in general unless the specified size of rounding or chamfering exceeds the length of one of the
two sides of the corner concerned. As for a rectangular line- or face-machining shape described with the aid of

.
[SQUARE], in particular, the size in question for corners CN1 (starting point) and CN4 (ending point) must not exceed

d
ve
half the length of the side between them since the cutting start position will be set in actual machining to the mid-point of

er
that side.

s
Specified

re
Starting point
Cause chamfering size
Cutting start position

ts
Ending point CN1

gh
CN4

ri
Sides of the corner

ll
to be rounded or

.A
chamfered

N
O
CN3 CN2

TI
16

A
Check the shape sequence data in question to correct the size of corner rounding or chamfering.
R
04

Action
PO

In the above-mentioned particular case of rectangular shape, use [ARBITRY], instead of [SQUARE], to describe the
30

desired shape on multiple lines of shape sequence data.


R
o.

684 POINT CUTTING PATTERN ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N

The point-machining shape definition data is not appropriate.


al

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Review and correct the corresponding shape data.


A

Action
IM

685 SQUARE CANNOT BE DEFINED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA

When the shape pattern is “square”, the input data cannot be used to make shape definitions.
Cause
A
M

Review and correct the corresponding shape data.


YA

Action
3

686 NO STARTING POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01

During input of free-shape data (open-figure data) to the line-machining unit, “?” has been set as the definition of the
)2

Cause starting point.


(c
ht

Review the machining program and set the coordinates of the starting point of the free shape.
Action
ig
yr

687 NO FINISH POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

During input of free-shape data (open-figure data) to the line-machining unit, “?” has been set as the definition of the ending
C

Cause point.

Review the machining program and set the coordinates of the ending point of the free shape.
Action

688 INSUFFICIENT INPUT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The coordinates of the intersection point cannot be calculated since the free-shape input data in the line- or face-machining
Cause unit is incomplete.

Review the corresponding shape data and set data that is wanting.
Action

3-103
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
689 INPUT DATA TOO MANY (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The line- or face-machining unit contains too much free-shape input data, and there is contradiction between
Cause overlapping data.
2. Too many tool sequences have been set for the line- or face-machining unit.
1. Review the corresponding shape data and erase either one of the overlapping data sets.
Action
2. Reduce the number of tool sequences.

690 ILLEGAL RADIUS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Contradiction exists in the free-shape data that have been set to define arc in the line- or face-machining units.
Cause

Review the corresponding shape data and set correct data.

.
Action

d
ve
er
691 MOUNT (VALLEY) SHAPE ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

s
The second figures (inside figures) are not yet defined in the endmilling-mountain (STEP), pocket milling-mountain or

re
Cause pocket milling-valley unit.

ts
gh
Review the machining program, and define the second shape in the endmilling-mountain (STEP), pocket milling-mountain
Action or pocket milling-valley unit.

ri
ll
692 MAX POINT NUMBER EXCEEDED (>200) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

.A
The number of points which are necessary to define the shapes designated in the line- or face-machining unit exceeds 200.

N
Cause

O
TI
Review the machining program, and reduce the number of shapes within one line- or face-machining unit.
16

Action A
R
04

PO
30

693 NUMBER OF SHAPES TOO LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R

Among the line- or face-machining units is one(s) that contains more shapes than allowable within one unit.
o.

Cause
N

C
al

Review the corresponding shape data and check the number of shapes.
ri

ZA

Action
Se

694 FIXED FIGURE DESIGNATED ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM

Fixed shapes are included in the shape data (open figures) of the central linear machining, right-hand linear machining,
K

Cause left-hand linear machining, right-hand chamfering, left-hand chamfering or endmilling-groove units.
ZA

Change the fixed shapes to free ones.


A

Action
M
YA

695 POINT INSIDE CIRCLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3

It is not possible to draw a tangent line from point P1 since it is inside the arc.
01

Cause
)2

Review the machining program and check the free-shaped data.


(c

Action
ht
ig

696 ILLEGAL DIRECTION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr

“Left” or “right” is set for the crossing point (P), though “up” or “down” should have been set.
op

Cause
C

Review the machining program and check the value of the crossing point (P).
Action

697 DATUM <P> REQUIRED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The crossing point (P) is not yet input in spite of the fact that there are more than two points of intersection with the arc.
Cause

Review the machining program and set the crossing point (P).
Action

3-104
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
698 TWO POINTS OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The coordinate values of the start point and end point are the same.
Cause

For the pattern of straight line, the data of X/Y are set to exactly the same end point coordinate values as X/Y present on
Action the preceding line of the program; delete these data.

699 PARALLEL LINE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The two straight lines are parallel to each other, and thus the coordinates of their intersection point cannot be obtained.
Cause

Review the corresponding shape data and set correct data.


Action

d.
ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-105
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1601 ILLEGAL ATC MODE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ATC mode ID number 5 has been set in the main program.
Cause

ATC mode ID number 5 can be set only in subprograms. Set ATC mode ID number 0 to 4 in the main program.
Action

1602 SET INDEX UNIT BEFORE MACHINING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The position of W-axis is not specified in the index unit preceding the machining unit.
Cause

Review the machining program and set the position of the W-axis in the index unit.
Action

d.
ve
1603 PROGRAM IS NOT WPC. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The main MAZATROL program of the initial-point scheme has been executed under the setting of the machine model with

s
Cause

re
MAZATROL-based control of the lower turret.

ts
Re-create the main MAZATROL program into a program of the workpiece scheme.

gh
Action

ri
1604 ILLEGAL TOOL DIRECTION (INDEX B) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
There is a mismatch in workpiece scheme data settings between the machining direction for index unit POS-B and the
Cause machining direction for the machining section of the lower-turret milling tool.

N
O
Insert an index unit in front of the desired milling unit. Next, set the value to POS-B appropriate for the lower-turret milling

TI
16

Action tool machining section, or select the appropriate lower-turret milling tool according to the particular machining direction for
POS-B of the index unit.
A
R
04

PO

1605 LOW TUR CANNOT EXECUTE MIRROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
30

Either lower-turret turning unit, the measuring unit, the manual program mode unit, or subprogram EIA call has been
o.

Cause
O

executed with MIRROR of the WPC shift unit made valid in a program of the workpiece scheme.
N

C
al

Insert the WPC shift unit in front of the desired unit and then make MIRROR invalid.
K

Action
ri

ZA
Se

1606 ILLEGAL CUTTING ANGLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM

The infeed angle or relief angle during cutting is 0° or less.


Cause
K
ZA

Confirm the infeed angle or relief angle in the tool data.


A

Action
Change the B-axis machining angle.
M
YA

1607 NEED TOOL ROTATION DIRECTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


The M-SP ROT. item (which is indispensable for executing a MAZATROL program when K102 bit 6 = 1) remains unset on
3

Cause
01

the TOOL DATA display.


)2

Perform the required setting for the M-SP ROT. item.


Action
(c
ht

1608 NEED SELECT TABLE UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig
yr

When table selection is valid (parameter D106 bit 4 = 1), no table selection unit is set before the WPC, WPC shift or
Cause
op

indexing unit.
C

Set a table selection unit before the WPC, WPC shift or indexing unit.
Action

1609 CANNOT SET WPC IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A basic coordinates sytem unit (WPC) is set in the program section for the two-workpiece machining sequence.
Cause

Delete the basic coordinates system unit.


Action

3-106
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1610 SET INDEX UNIT IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Machining units in the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by an index unit.
Cause

Set an index unit.


Action

1611 SET INDEX UNIT AFTER 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Machining units after the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by an index unit.
Cause

Set an index unit.


Action

.
d
ve
1612 SET HEAD UNIT AFTER 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
Machining units after the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by a head selection unit.

s
Cause

re
ts
Set a head selection unit.

gh
Action

ri
1613 SET HEAD UNIT IN 2WORKPIECE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
Machining units in the two-workpiece machining section are not preceded by a head selection unit.
Cause

N
O
Set a head selection unit.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

1614 NO TABLE ROTATION AXIS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

Index unit is set while NO USE is selected for ROT. AXIS in table selection unit on the machine not equipped with spindle
R

Cause
o.

head of swiveling type (parameter BA48 is set to 0).


O
N

Delete the index unit.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

1615 TABLE ROTATION CENTER NOT AGREE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The ROT.CENTER setting in the table selection unit does not match the TABLE-CT. setting in the FRM unit.
Cause
K
ZA

Review either the ROT.CENTER setting in the table selection unit or the TABLE-CT. setting in the FRM unit.
Action
A
M

1616 CYLINDER CHAMFERING N/A (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program although the smooth chamfering function is not provided.
Cause
3
01

The smooth chamfering program cannot be executed because the smooth chamfering function is not provided.
)2

Action
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-107
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1617 CYLINDER CHAMFERING IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program with the machine type with which the smooth
chamfering function is not available.
2. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when the B-axis angle is other than +90° in the end
milling slot unit of WPC workpiece scheme.
3. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when the machining face is other than cylindrical
surface in the C-axis point machining unit of WPC workpiece scheme.
Cause
4. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when HOLE-DEP is set to a value other than 0 in the
chamfering tool sequence for point machining.
5. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when the cylinder radius is set to 0 or blank in the
end milling slot unit of WPC workpiece scheme.
6. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when CHMF is set to 0 or blank in the end milling

. d
slot unit or point machining unit.

ve
er
1. Delete the smooth chamfering program.

s
2. Set an index unit before the machining unit that includes smooth chamfering and set angle B to +90°.

re
3. Set the machining face to the cylindrical surface in the C-axis point machining unit.

ts
Action
4. Set HOLE-DEP in the chamfering tool sequence to 0.

gh
5. Input the correct cylinder radius value in the end milling slot unit.

ri
6. Input the correct value for CHMF.

ll
.A
1618 —— ( , , )

N
O
Cause ——

TI
16

Action ——
A
R
04

PO
30

1619 ILLEGAL APPROACH SCHEME (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.

In the selection of the approach scheme for INTELLIGENT POCKET MILLING (IPM), “TAPER” or “PECKING” was
O

Cause
N

selected.
C
al

Select “HELICAL” or “STANDARD”.


ri

ZA

Action
Se

1620 —— ( , , )
IM

Cause ——
K
ZA

Action ——
A
M
YA

1621 NO INDEX UNIT AFTER 5 FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
No index unit is set after 5-face machining.
3

Cause
01
)2

Set an index unit after 5-face machining.


Action
(c
ht

1622 NO WPC UNIT AFTER 5 FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

No WPC unit is set after 5-face machining.


yr

Cause
op

Set an WPC unit after 5-face machining.


C

Action

1623 TPC RELAY POINT SET IN 5 FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
TPC relay points are set for the subprogram called from the 5-face machining unit.
Cause

Delete the TPC relay points set for the subprogram.


Action

3-108
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1624 ILLEGAL UNIT IN 5 FACE (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The subprogram called from the 5-face machining unit contains a unit that cannot be specified during 5-face machining.
1. 5-face machining unit
2. Face definition unit
3. Pallet change unit
Cause 4. Process end unit
5. MMS unit
6. Tool measurement unit
7. Workpiece measurement unit
8. Manual program unit

. d
ve
Delete the units that cannot be specified during 5-face machining from the subprogram.
Action

s er
1625 ATTACHMENT NO. MISMATCH (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
The attachment number currently mounted and that set in the 5-face machining differ.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Mount the attachment set in the 5-face machining unit.
Action

ll
.A
1626 ILLEGAL COMMAND (ATTACHMENT) (WNo., UNo., SNo. ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
Standard machining other than 5-face machining was attempted while the attachment was mounted.

O
Cause

TI
16

Action
A
To execute standard machining other than 5-face machining, remove the attachment beforehand.
R
04

PO
30

( , , )
R
o.

O
N

Cause
C
al

K
ri

ZA

Action
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-109
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-8 No. 700 - No. 799, No. 1700 - No. 1799 (MAZATROL program error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
700 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

701 DEFINED SHAPE TOO SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue


The shape compensation clearance with respect to the shape of the endmilling-top is too large; or the tool diameter with
Cause respect to the size of the line-inside machining is too large.

d .
ve
Change the shape compensation clearance (parameter E13) to an appropriate value: or use a tool of smaller diameter.
Action

ser
re
702 FIGURE DEFINITION ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue

ts
1. The input shape is contradictory to logic, that is, the radius of the arc, for example, does not agree with the distance
from the center.

gh
Cause
2. An attempt was made to execute the smooth chamfering program when CHMF in the end milling slot unit is set to other

ri
than 0, when an arc is specified or when the shape sequence is specified in three or more lines.

ll
.A
1. Such contradiction usually results from arithmetic errors. Change the radial depth of cut by some micro, or use a tool of
smaller diameter.

N
Action

O
2. When executing the smooth chamfering program, set a linear shape, whose angle formed with the X-axis is 0 degrees,

TI
in two lines (start point line and end point line).
16

703 PROCESS DEFINITION ERROR A


(WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue
R
04

PO

The machining conditions are incorrect (for example, the radial depth of cut is zero).
30

Cause
R
o.

Change the machining conditions to correct ones.


N

Action
al

K
ri

ZA

704 TOOL INTERFERENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue


Se

In area machining, the tool diameter with respect to the figure is too large.
Cause
IM
K

Replace the tool with one that has a smaller diameter; or select the M2 mode endmilling-mountain (STEP) machining
Action
ZA

pattern with setting bit 7 of parameter E91 if this error occurs in the outside machining endmilling-mountain (STEP).
A

705 APPROACH POINT ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Red


M
YA

1. The approach point cannot be obtained.


Cause
2. The approach path or retract path may interfere with the programmed shape.
3
01

1. Reduce the tool diameter, the approach amount (parameters E1, E2) and/or the overlap amount (parameter E21).
Action
)2

2. Extend the shape toward the approach or escape side.


(c

706 ILLEGAL FIGURE DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L O Blue


ht

 The shape has been separated into three segments or more as a result of offsetting.
ig

 The inside form does not contain the center of the outside form for outside-related fixed path.
yr

Cause
 The outside form is concave for inside-related fixed path.
op

 The inside form is not adequate since it contains a concave or an intersection.


C

Change the machining pattern (from inversed type to fixed type, for example); or divide the machining shape in advance so
Action that it will not be separated by offsetting.

707 CHAMFER CUTTER INTERFERENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Blue


1. The chamfering tool interferes with the side wall or bottom.
Cause 2. The tool edge is not in perfect contact with the surface to chamfer.
3. A chamfering tool with a chamfering angle other than 45 is used for Smooth chamfering.
1. Use a tool which does not interfere with the side wall or bottom.
Action 2. Shorten the chamfering width or use a tool having a long cutting edge.
3. With Smooth chamfering, always use a chamfering tool with a chamfering angle of 45.

3-110
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
708 BLOCK DATA LIMIT EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue
In the EIA program, the total number of characters within one block is in excess of 248.
Cause

Divide the block so that one block contains 248 characters or less.
Action

709 CHECK DEPTH-R (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue


No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there is no or too short a distance between end points of the
Cause shape.

Change the radial depth of cut in the tool sequence by some micro.
Action

d.
ve
710 CORNER ROUNDING CUTTER DIA ERR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue

er
The programmed amount of round chamfering differs from the following:

s
Cause

re
(NOM- – MIN-)/2.
where NOM- and MIN- are the setting values of the selected tool on the TOOL FILE display.

ts
Select a tool appropriate to the chamfering amount.

gh
Action

ri
ll
711 UNIT DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

.A
Unset unit data exists for the unit you have made an attempt to execute.

N
Cause

O
TI
Set all data.
16

Action A
R
04

PO

712 ILLEGAL UNIT DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
30

Sequence data for the unit you have made an attempt to execute does not match to the unit data.
o.

Cause
O
N

C
al

Delete the sequence data, and then set correct sequence data.
K

Action
ri

ZA
Se

713 SEQUENCE DATA NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM

1. No sequence data exists for the unit you have made an attempt to execute.
Cause
K

2. The machine was operated or a tool path check was performed with “DEP-1” or “FR” set to “?”.
ZA

1. Set sequence data.


A

Action 2. Set a numeric value for “DEP-1” and “FR”. Or, press the [AUTO SET] menu key after checking that all setting items in
M

the unit data/sequence data are properly set.


YA

714 ILLEGAL SEQUENCE DATA (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3

Data out of the allowable setting range exists in the sequence data of the unit you have made an attempt to execute.
01

Cause
)2

Correct the sequence data.


(c

Action
ht
ig

715 ILLEGAL CUTTING POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr

The specified infeed point is outside the profile of the workpiece (approximate workpiece shape designated by common
op

Cause unit).
C

Move the infeed point into the profile of the workpiece.


Action

716 ILLEGAL CUTTING START POINT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The relative position of the starting or ending point specified by the sequence data with respect to the specified infeed point
Cause is not appropriate.

Change the position of the starting or ending point of the sequence data, or change the position of the infeed point.
Action

3-111
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
717 SHAPE EXCEEDS MATERIAL SIZE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The starting or ending point is outside the profile of the workpiece (approximate workpiece shape specified by common
Cause unit).

Change the starting or ending point.


Action

718 CUTTING DIRECTION NOT DEFINED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The direction of machining (forward/backward) cannot be determined using the specified infeed point and sequence data.
Cause

Change the position of the starting or ending point.


Action

. d
ve
719 REVERSE SHAPE CONTOUR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
Part of the defined shape is opposite in direction of machining with respect to the reference axis movement direction.

s
Cause

re
ts
Correct the position of the starting or ending point.

gh
Action

ri
720 DOUBLE SHAPE CONTOUR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The defined workpiece shape has overlaps.
Cause

N
O
Correct the position of the starting or ending point.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

721 ILLEGAL RADIUS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

Arc-drawing data you have specified is illegal.


R
o.

Cause That is, the relationship between the starting point, ending point, and radius of the arc is incorrect.
O
N

It is impossible to define an arc.


al

Correct the starting-point data, ending-point data, or radius data of the arc.
ri

ZA

Action
Se

A
IM

722 ILLEGAL CORNER DEFINITION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There are the following errors related to the designated corner C data:
K

<BAR, CPY, CORNER>


ZA

Cause The arc length of the block present before or after corner C is smaller than that of corner C.
A

<T. GROOV>
M

Added corner C is outside the workpiece profile.


YA

Correct either the length of corner C or the sequence data set before or after corner C.
Action
3
01

723 EXCEEDS NUMBER OF SHAPES


)2

(WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


(c

Defined shape of machining or of the workpiece is too complicated to be processed.


Cause
ht
ig

Simplify the shape of the machining or of the workpiece.


yr

Action
op

724 EXCEEDS NUMBER OF VALLEY SHAPES (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
C

The total number of valleys in the machining shape is in excess of 16.


Cause

Divide the machining shape in multiple units.


Action

3-112
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
725 ILLEGAL COMMON DATA (RADIAL) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
OD-MAX and ID-MIN in the common unit do not satisfy the following condition:
Cause
OD-MAX > ID-MIN  0
Set correct data to OD-MAX, or ID-MIN.
Action

726 ILLEGAL COMMON DATA (AXIAL) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
LENGTH, WORK FACE and FIN-LENGTH do not satisfy the following condition:
Cause
LENGTH  WORK FACE + FIN-LENGTH > 0
Set correct data to LENGTH, WORK FACE and FIN-LENGTH.
Action

. d
ve
727 MATERIAL SHAPE CROSSING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
There is a data overlap between the inside diameter side (IN) and outside diameter side (OUT) of the workpiece shape

s
Cause

re
which has been designated in the MATERIAL unit.

ts
Change the IN or OUT shape data.

gh
Action

ri
728 EXCESSIVE FINISH ALLOWANCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The area to be rough-cut does not exist since the designated finishing allowance is larger than the shape defined by the
Cause sequence data.

N
O
Either change the finishing allowance or cancel rough-cutting.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

729 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (CNR) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

In the CORNER unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Set the correct data to SPT and FPT.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

730 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (EDG) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

In the FACING unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause
K
ZA

Set the correct data to SPT and FPT.


Action
A
M

731 ILLEGAL NUM. OF PATHS (THR) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The designated number of cutting times for #0, #3 thread type is less than 3.
Cause
3
01
)2

Change the number of cutting times to 3 or more, or change the thread type.
Action
(c
ht

732 ACCELERATION DISTANCE EXCEED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The calculated distance of threading acceleration is in excess of the allowable value.


yr

Cause
op
C

Change the related parameter setting value or reduce the surface speed to its minimum permissible value.
Action

733 ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGNATED (GRV) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the T. GROOV unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause

Set the correct data to SPT and FPT.


Action

3-113
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
734 ILLEGAL SHAPE EXCEEDS MTRL SIZE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
For machining of multiple grooves, the second and subsequent grooves are outside the workpiece profile defined by
Cause common unit.

Reduce the number of grooves.


Action

735 ILLEGAL DESIGNATED TL WID (GRV) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The designated tool width does not match to the groove shape specified in the T. GROOV unit.
Cause

Designate some other tool, or correct the width of the designated tool.
Action

d .
ve
736 ILLEGAL OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The parameter-set amount of grooving overlap is larger than the width or diameter of the designated tool.

s
Cause

re
ts
Either designate some other tool, correct the width or diameter of the designated tool, or change the parameter setting

gh
Action (TC75).

ri
737 ILLEGAL DRILLING DIRECTION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
In the T-DRILL or T-TAP unit data, the relationship between the starting point and the ending point is wrong.
Cause

N
O
Set the correct data to SPT-Z and FPT-Z.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

738 CORNER (R/C) DESIGNATED OVERLAP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

In the unit (BAR, CPY, etc.), different types of corners (R and C) have been designated for portions that are identical in
R

Cause
o.

shape.
O
N

Check the designated corner portions and delete one of the corners.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

739 ILLEGAL FINISHING ALLOWANCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

In the #0, #0 type of THREAD unit data, the following condition exists:
K

(Finishing allowance) > (First depth-of-cut/4)


ZA

Cause
A

Calculated from the height (HGT) and the number of times (NUMBER) in unit data.
M

Specified by parameter TC78.


YA

Change either the thread height or the setting of parameter TC78.


Action
3
01
)2

740 ILLEGAL ANGLE IN FIRST SEQUENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c

The relationship between the thread shape and threading angle that are defined by the first sequence data of the THREAD
Cause unit is incorrect.
ht
ig

Change the threading angle, or change the coordinates of the starting or ending point of the first sequence.
yr

Action
op
C

741 ILLEGAL THREAD ANGLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the machining type that requires the designation of a threading angle, the following condition is not satisfied.
Cause
(Tool tip angle)  (Threading angle)
Change either the threading angle or the data of the tool to be used.
Action

3-114
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
742 ILLEGAL THREAD HEIGHT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In the THREAD unit data, the following condition is not satisfied.
(Finishing allowance)  (Thread height)
Cause
Designated in the unit data.
Set using parameter TC78.
Change the thread height or the setting of parameter TC78.
Action

743 INTERSECTION NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are shape sequence data disparities.

.
Cause

d
ve
er
Correct the shape sequence data.
Action

s
re
744 DATA MISSING (INTERSECTION) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
gh
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are lack of data to automatically calculate a point of
Cause intersection.

ri
ll
Correct the unit data or the sequence data.

.A
Action

N
O
745 INTERSECTION CALCULATE IMPOSS. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

TI
No automatic calculations of intersection were obtained since there are illegal data in the program.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO
30

Correct the unit data or the sequence data.


Action
R
o.

O
N

746 NO DEPTH OF CUT INFO. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
al

A cutting depth cannot be determined for the tool since the DEPTH or CUT ANGLE data item on the TOOL DATA display
ri

ZA

Cause is left blank.


Se

Set data in DEPTH or CUT ANGLE, or use some other tool.


IM

Action
K

747 CHIP BREAKING CYCLE N/A (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA

Executing the chip-cutting cycle program has been attempted in spite of the chip-cutting cycle option being absent.
A

Cause
M

(3 or 4 has been assigned to PAT. in the roughing tool sequence.)


YA

The chip-cutting cycle option must be present before the chip-cutting cycle program can be executed.
Action
(Assign either 0, 1, or 2 to PAT. in the roughing tool sequence.)
3
01

748 CANNOT MAKE T-PATH (CHK DEPTH) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

1. A normal path cannot be created since the cutting area is wider than twice the depth of cut per pass.
(c

2. When the cutting area is equal to the clearance, a normal path cannot be created since the cutting area is wider than
ht

Cause the depth of cut per pass.


ig

3. A normal path cannot be created since the cutting area overlaps the deceleration distance and is wider than the depth
yr

of cut per pass.


op

1. Increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence, or narrow down the cutting area.
C

2. Increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence, or reduce the clearance.
Action
3. Two overlapping areas must not be present. Narrow down PRE-DIA (deceleration distance) to be set in the tool
sequence, or narrow down the cutting area, or increase the cutting depth to be set in the tool sequence.
749 CANNOT DRAW FIGURE ( , , ) A L S Blue
1. Shape drawing of the program set with workpiece placement error correction was attempted on the TRACE display.
Cause 2. Shape drawing of a main program that does not contain turning operation but calls a subprogram containing turning
operation was attempted on a VARIAXIS machine featuring the turning function.

Action ——

3-115
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
750 ——

Cause ——

Action ——

751 CURVE DEFINITION ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue
A curved surface that cannot be machined has been defined.
Cause

No corrective actions can be taken against this error; define a curved surface that can be machined.
Action

d.
ve
752 DESIGNATED AREA DATA IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue

er
The check surface values are incorrect.

s
re
1. For rough-machining 1 or 2: Check surface Z min.  material height
Cause

ts
2. For finishing: Check surface Z min.  initial Z

gh
3. Check surface X min.  X max., or Y min.  Y max., or Z min.  Z max.

ri
Set the check surface values as follows:

ll
1. For rough-machining 1 or 2: Check surface Z min.  material height

.A
Action
2. For finishing: Check surface Z min.  initial Z

N
3. Check surface X min.  X max., and Y min.  Y max., and Z min.  Z max.

O
TI
753 SMALL TOOL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Blue
16

A
In rough-machining 2, the tool diameter is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined 3-D figure.
R
04

Cause
PO
30

Use tools whose diameters are no less than 1/100 of the distance between the maximum and minimum dimensions of the
R
o.

Action
O

3-D figure.
N

C
al

754 LARGE TOOL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ri

ZA

Tool interference has occurred.


Se

Cause
A
IM

Set the approach path and the tool size so that the interference does not occur.
Action
K
ZA

755 R DIRECTION PITCH SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A

In rough-machining 2, the pitch in the radial direction is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined
M

Cause 3-D figure.


YA

Set the radial-direction pitch to a value no less than 1/200 of the distance between the maximum and minimum dimensions
3

Action of the 3-D figure.


01
)2

756 Z DIRECTION PITCH SMALL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c

In rough-machining 2, the pitch in the Z direction is extremely small in comparison with the dimensions of the defined 3-D
ht

Cause figure.
ig
yr

Set the Z-direction pitch to a value no less than 1/250 of (material height – height of the Z bottom of the 3-D figure).
Action
op
C

757 CURVE DEFINITION LARGE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. For rough-machining 2 with designation of workpiece size, the dimensions of the defined figure are larger than those of
the workpiece.
Cause 2. For rough-machining 2, a material height smaller than “(height of the Z bottom of the 3-D figure) + (height of a
machining area outside the figure)” [parameters E84, E89] has been set irrespective of designating the offset amount
or the workpiece size.
Change the E84 and E89 parameter settings so that: for the offset amount designation, “(height of the bottom of the 3-D
Action figure) + E84 < material height”, and; for the workpiece size designation, “(height of the bottom of the 3-D figure) + E89 <
material height”.

3-116
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
758 INITIAL POINT SET ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In rough-machining 1 or 2, initial Z  material height.
Cause

Change settings to give initial Z > material height.


Action

759 WPC UNIT NOT FOUND (MILL & TURN) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The workpiece shape cannot be defined since, in a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, no
Cause WPC unit is prepared before machining units.

Create a WPC unit before the machining units and then enter the correct data.
Action

.
d
ve
760 NO T. CENTER POINT IN WPC UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
1. In a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, the workpiece origin specified in the WPC unit

s
re
Cause which precedes C-axis point/line machining or turning units does not correspond to the axis of turning.
2. Additional basic coordinate system or work offset value is set in the WPC unit preceded by the common unit.

ts
gh
1. Before creating C-axis machining or turning unit, create a WPC unit with reference to the axis of turning.
Action

ri
2. Instead of additional basic coordinate system or work offset value, specify T. CENTER to set the WPC-zero point to the
turning center in the WPC unit preceded by the common unit.

ll
.A
761 HEAD ANGLE INCORRECT (C-AXIS) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
In a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC setting, the machining section specified in a C-axis point/line

O
Cause machining or turning unit does not correspond to the B-axis angle specified in an index unit.

TI
16

A
Before creating C-axis machining or turning unit, create an index unit to specify the B-axis angle appropriate for the section
R
04

Action to be machined.
PO
30

762 PROGRAM IS NOT MILL & TURN TYPE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.

It was attempted to set a turning or C-axis point/line machining unit in a program of initial-point scheme (ONLY MILL).
N

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Delete the turning or C-axis point/line machining unit, or set it in a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with WPC
Se

Action setting.
A
IM

763 START PROCESS ILLEGAL (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K

It was attempted to execute restart operation from, or single-process operation of, an unsuitable unit.
Cause
ZA
A

Specify an appropriate unit for the desired mode of operation.


M

Action
YA

764 MAIN PRG/SUB PRG TYPE MISMATCH (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
01

There are programming units of workpiece scheme with WPC setting and of the same scheme with Z-offset setting
Cause prepared in one and the same program.
)2
(c

Delete the incompatible units to create a program of the required scheme.


Action
ht
ig

765 Z-OFFSET NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr
op

The indispensable Z-offset is not yet set for a program of workpiece scheme (MILL & TURN) with Z-offset setting.
Cause
C

Set the Z-offset item externally in the setup data page.


Action

766 MAXIMUM NO.OF LAYOUTS EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
It was attempted to run a program which contains a process with more than 4000 layout data items.
Cause The number of repetitions exceeds 9999990 for a program (CONTI. = 1 in the END unit) without workpiece transfer unit.

Reduce the number of layout data items for one process to no larger than 4000.
Action Modify the program to reduce the number of repetitions to no larger than 9999990.

3-117
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
767 ILLEGAL ESCAPE TOOL No. (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The setting in the parameter for the retraction tool is not correct.
Cause

Check the parameter concerned.


Action

768 4 AXIS MACHINING PROGRAM ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The setting for simultaneous machining is not correct.
Cause (Example : Only the upper or the lower turret is specified for simultaneous machining.)

Review the program and perform corrections as required (e. g. to change the turret to be used for the particular tool
Action sequence of the unit concerned).

. d
ve
769 ILLEGAL TOOL DIRECTION/SPDL ROT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The specification of the direction of turning spindle rotation differs between those tools on the upper and lower turrets which

s
Cause

re
are to be used for simultaneous machining.

ts
Select another tool, or change the specification in question, on either side for the same direction of turning spindle rotation

gh
Action as for the other tool.

ri
770 FIN LEN ERROR (CHECK COM UNIT) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
For the execution of a composite program: The settings in the common unit do not satisfy the following condition:
Cause FIN-LENGTH  LENGTH – WORK FACE.

N
O
Reduce the FIN-LENGTH setting to satisfy the above condition.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

771 ILLEGAL LOW TUR COMMON UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

A unit of machining with the lower turret (or including a command for its retraction) is created within a program whose
R

Cause
o.

common unit declares (under LOW TURR) that the lower turret is “not used”.
O
N

Change over the LOW TURR setting, or modify the machining unit concerned in the turret selection.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

772 NO HEAD UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

1. For the execution of a composite program: Machining units are not preceded by a head selection unit (HEAD).
Cause
2. For the execution of a composite program: The workpiece transfer unit (TRANSFER) is not followed by a HEAD unit.
K
ZA

1. Set a HEAD unit to specify the turning spindle to be used for the succeeding machining units.
Action
A

2. Set a HEAD unit after the TRANSFER unit to specify the turning spindle to be used for the succeeding machining units.
M

773 TRANSFER UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

For the execution of an independent program: A workpiece transfer unit (TRANSFER) is erroneously set in a program to be
Cause
3

run independently on either HD side.


01
)2

Delete the inappropriate TRANSFER unit from the program.


Action
(c
ht

774 HEAD UNIT IN PROGRAM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

For the execution of an independent program: A head selection unit (HEAD) is erroneously set in a program to be run
yr

Cause independently on either HD side.


op
C

Delete the inappropriate HEAD unit from the program.


Action

775 TOOL CANNOT PERFORM FACING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
For tool selection on a turret-type tool-post: The section to be machined by the selected tool differs from the corresponding
Cause setting in the unit data line.

Change the setting in the unit data line with respect to the tool, or select another tool as required.
Action

3-118
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
776 NO Y-AXIS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A Y-axis machining unit is created for a turret not correspondingly executed.
Cause

Delete the inappropriate machining unit from the program, or describe the particular machining process without using the
Action Y-axis control.

777 INCORRECT POSIT. CANNOT RESTART (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The restarting function has been started from the balanced-cutting with the lower turret.
Cause

Specify the upper turret to execute the restarting function from balanced cutting.
Action

. d
ve
778 INCORRECT POSIT. CANNOT START (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The single-process function has been applied to the balanced-cutting with the lower turret.

s
Cause

re
ts
Specify the upper turret to execute the single-process function for balanced cutting.

gh
Action

ri
779 —— ( , , )

ll
.A
Cause ——

N
O
TI
Action ——
16

A
R
04

780 APPROACH PATH INTERFERENCE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The programmed shape of the approach path and/or retraction path interferes with the workpiece (programmed machining
R

Cause
o.

shape + machining allowance).


O
N

Reduce the amount of approach and/or the amount of overlap or the tool diameter.
al

Action
Or specify another position as the approach point.
ri

ZA
Se

781 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TUR ASIGN (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

In a 2 WORKPC unit the selection of the turret in the tool sequence does not correspond to the selection of the spindle
Cause (SP1 or SP2) in the unit data line.
K
ZA

Select the correct turret in the tool sequence data in question.


Action
A
M

782 DBL SPDL OPER NO TRANS UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The 2 WORKPC machining unit is not preceded by a workpiece transfer unit.


Cause
3
01
)2

Set a TRANSFER unit as required.


Action
(c
ht

783 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL SIMUL OP (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

There is an instruction of simultaneous machining given in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.


yr

Cause
op
C

Clear the tool sequence concerned of the instruction of simultaneous machining.


Action

784 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL BALANCE CUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is an instruction of balanced cutting given in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause

Clear the tool sequence concerned of the instruction of balanced cutting.


Action

3-119
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
785 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TUR ESC (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is an instruction of retraction given in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause

Clear the tool sequence concerned of the instruction of retraction.


Action

786 DBL SPDL OP ILLEGAL MEASUREMENT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
There is a measurement unit inserted in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.
Cause

Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute the required in-process measurement.
Action

. d
ve
787 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL TRANSFER (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
There is a workpiece transfer unit inserted in the flow of “2 Workpiece” machining.

s
Cause

re
ts
Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute the required workpiece transfer.

gh
Action

ri
788 DBL SPDL OPER ILLEGAL HEAD UNIT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The head selection unit in the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining has another setting than SINGLE under TYPE.
Cause

N
O
Temporarily cancel the mode of “2 Workpiece” machining to execute synchronous rotation of both spindles (by selecting

TI
Action
16

SYNCH.). A
R
04

789 DBL SPDL OPER UNIT ERROR (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

1. For a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining an end instruction is given before the start instruction.
R
o.

2. For a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining a restart instruction is given before the end instruction.
O

Cause
N

3. In a flow of “2 Workpiece” machining, only one spindle is specified in the head selection unit and machining instruction
al

is given for only one spindle.


ri

ZA

1. Set the “2 Workpiece” machining units in correct order.


Se

2. Set the “2 Workpiece” machining units in correct order.


Action
IM

3. Review the program for “2 Workpiece” machining. In a “2 Workpiece” machining unit, be sure to set two head selection
units so that machining is performed with two spindles.
K
ZA

790 ILLEGAL BALANCE CUT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A

1. Only a single line of tool sequence is created for balanced cutting.


M

Cause 2. Tools different in shape (nose angle, infeed angle and nose R) are designated for the upper and lower turret in
YA

balanced cutting.
1. Add another tool sequence line to use the other turret symmetrically for balanced cutting.
3
01

Action 2. Specify tools identical in shape (nose angle, infeed angle and nose R) for the upper and lower turret in balanced
)2

cutting.
(c

791 MUST INPUT CUTTING SPEED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht

The surface speed data set in the tool sequence contains an invalid value.
Cause
ig
yr

Set correct surface speed data in the tool sequence.


op

Action
C

792 MUST INPUT FEEDRATE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The feed data set in the tool sequence contains an invalid value.
Cause

Set a correct feed data in the tool sequence.


Action

3-120
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
793 ILLEGAL MILL SPINDLE RPM (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
If DRILL is selected as the turning drilling unit tool:
1. The milling spindle speed is less than the turning spindle speed when the rotation direction set in the tool sequence is
the same as that of the milling spindle.
2. The milling spindle speed has exceeded the maximum rotation speed (SA1 to SA8) when the rotation direction set in
Cause the tool sequence is the same as that of the milling spindle.
3. The milling spindle speed is set to a negative value when the rotation direction set in the tool sequence is opposite to
that of the milling spindle.
4. When the direction of rotation in the tool sequence is the opposite of the direction of mill spindle rotation, the turning
spindle speed matches the relative speed calculated from the surface speed.
1. Reduce the spindle speed for the turning spindle.

. d
2. Set the milling spindle speed to a value lower than its maximum spindle speed.
Action

ve
3. Reduce the spindle speed for the turning spindle.

er
4. Reduce the spindle speed for the turning spindle.

s
re
794 INCORRECT B AXIS POSITION (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
For ATC (BA47 = 0) turret type machines with B-axis (BA48 = B), the direction of “part to be machined” set with the turning

gh
Cause drilling unit does not match with the B-axis angle set with the index unit.

ri
Reset the B-axis angle for the index unit defined prior to setting the turning drilling unit to either 0 or 180°.

ll
Action

.A
N
795 SHIFT-Y TOO LARGE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
When the amount of SHIFT-Y is not equal to zero in the mill-turning unit, the amount of SHIFT-Y is smaller than the radius

TI
Cause
16

of the tool or greater than (workpiece radius + tool radius). A


R
04

Modify the program so that the amount of SHIFT-Y is equal to or greater than the radius of the tool or equal to or smaller
PO

Action
30

than (workpiece radius + tool radius).


R
o.

796 NO MAZATROL L TURRET OPT (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N

An attempt was made to execute a MAZATROL program with lower turret control enabled although the MAZATROL lower
al

Cause turret control option is unavailable.


ri

ZA
Se

The MAZATROL program cannot be executed because the MAZATROL lower turret control option is unavailable.
A

Action
IM

797 BARRIER CANCEL ON (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA

The cycle start button has been pressed when the barrier was canceled.
Cause
A
M

Disable the “Cancel Barrier” setting.


YA

Action
3
01

798 JAW NO NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

The cycle start button has been pressed when a jaw No. was not assigned.
Cause
(c
ht

Set the jaw No.


Action
ig
yr

799 —— ( , , )
op
C

Cause ——

Action ——

3-121
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure

1700 LAYOUT UNABLE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


Program editing was attempted after editing the layout.
Cause

Set the layout again on the PROCESS LAYOUT screen.


Action

( , , )

Cause

. d
Action

ve
er
1705 AVOIDANCE DISTANCE EXCEEDED (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

s
re
For the reciprocating grooving pattern, any of the conditions indicated below is met.

ts
1. The value “tool nose width + 2  (finishing allowance)” is larger than the value “groove width – tool load avoidance

gh
distance (TC156)”.

ri
Cause 2. The value “2  nose R” is larger than the value “groove width – tool load avoidance distance (TC156)”.

ll
3. The value “tool nose width – 2  nose R” is larger than the value “groove width – rear corner  factor – tool load

.A
avoidance distance (TC156)”.

N
4. The tool load avoidance distance (TC156) is larger than the depth of cut.

O
Review the program or change the value set at parameter TC156 smaller.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

PO

1706 UNCUT EXIST (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue


30

In intelligent pocket milling (IPM), the engage angle is too large for the tool nose R.
o.

Cause
O
N

C
al

Change the programmed engage angle smaller.


ri

Action
ZA

Or, make the uncut check function invalid by setting E108 bit 1 = 0.
Se

A
IM

1707 UNCUT INCREASING (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B L S Blue


Uncut amount increases if corner rounding path is automatically inserted in INTELLIGENT POCKET MILLING (IPM).
K

Cause
ZA
A

Set a corner rounding path, larger than the value set at E115, to the shape.
M

Action
YA

1708 IPM PATH IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B K O Red (Blue)


3
01

In intelligent pocket milling (IPM), a tool path that has a constant engage angle cannot be generated.
Cause
)2
(c

Change the approach point or engage angle.


ht

Action
ig
yr

1709 ILLEGAL CUTTING FACE (C-AXIS) (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
op

A machining face where machining is not possible is specified in the C-axis machining unit.
C

Cause

Change the machining face specification.


Action

( , , )

Cause

Action

3-122
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1713 SELECT HELICAL APPROACH (WNo., UNo., SNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

Either “taper approach” or “pecking approach” was selected in intelligent pocket milling (IPM).
Cause

Select “helical approach” or “none”.


Action

( , , )

Cause

. d
Action

ve
s er
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-123
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-9 No. 800 - No. 899, No. 1800 - No. 1899 (EIA/ISO program error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
800 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

801 SIMULTANEOUS AXIS EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The number of axis motion commands given in one block is in excess of the number of simultaneously controllable axes.
Cause

d.
Modify the program with respect to the specification concerned.

ve
Action

s er
802 ILLEGAL AXIS NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
1. The axis address names assigned in the program are different from those which have been parametrized.

ts
Cause

gh
2. Bit 4 of parameter M17 for the shaping control axis (the axis specified in parameter K3) is set to ‘0’ (linear axis).

ri
1. Correct the axis address names in the program.
Action

ll
2. Set bit 4 of parameter M17 for the shaping control axis (the axis specified in parameter K3) to ‘1’ (rotational axis).

.A
803 DIVIDED COMMAND ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
O
A distance of axis movement that cannot be divided by the preset command unit has been assigned.
Cause

TI
16

Review the program.


A
R
04

Action
PO
30

804 PARITY H ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
o.

O
N

On paper tape, the number of holes per character is even for EIA code or odd for ISO code.
C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Check the paper tape and the tape reader.


Se

Action
A
IM

805 PARITY V ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K

On paper tape, the number of holes per block is odd.


ZA

Cause
A
M

Make even the hole quantity per block on the paper tape; or turn off the bit 1 of the parameter TAP25 used for parity-V
Action selection.
YA

806 ILLEGAL ADDRESS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3
01

An address that is not covered in the specifications has been used.


Cause
)2
(c

Check and correct the corresponding address in the program, and also check the specifications.
ht

Action
ig
yr
op
C

3-124
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
807 ILLEGAL FORMAT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The format in which the data has been designated in the program is incorrect.
2. Under the condition of workpiece placement error correction, or tool tip point control, an axis address other than those
for the five controlled axes concerned (as specified in parameters K114, K115, K116, K121, and K125) was used in a
motion command block.
Cause 3. The engraving program contains a format error.
 A text string containing 100 characters or more was specified.
 A character that cannot be engraved was specified.
 Engraving was specified with another command in the same block.
1. Review the program.
2. Do not use an axis address other than those for the five controlled axes concerned (as specified in parameters K114,

.
d
Action K115, K116, K121, and K125) in a motion command block under the condition of workpiece placement error

ve
correction, or tool tip point control.

er
3. Review the program.

s
re
808 MIS-SET G CODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
A G-code that is not covered in the specifications has been designated.

gh
Cause

ri
Check and correct the corresponding G-code address in the program.

ll
Action

.A
N
809 ILLEGAL NUMBER INPUT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
The assigned data for the address is out of the allowable setting range.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Review the program.


PO

Action
30

R
o.

810 PROGRAM END NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N

“EOR” has been detected during tape or memory operation.


al

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

For the main program, set M02 or M30 at the end of the program. For subprograms, set M99 at the end of the program.
A

Action
IM

811 ILLEGAL O/N NUMBER (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA

Zeroes have been designated as program or sequence numbers.


Cause
A
M

Delete zero from N (sequence) or O (program) numbers of the program; or change O-No. (program numbers) to between 1
YA

Action and 99999999, N-No. (sequence numbers) to between 1 and 99999.


3

812 ERROR IN BUFFER BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
01
)2

An error has been found to exist in the pre-read block during execution of tool diameter offset.
Cause
(c
ht

Review the program.


Action
ig
yr

813 INCH/METRIC OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

The inch/metric selection command has been issued using the G-code although a G-code inch/metric selection function is
C

Cause not provided.

Check the specifications.


Action

814 INTERPOLATION OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The specified moving distance is too long.
Cause

Specify a shorter distance.


Action

3-125
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
815 G60 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Program command G60 has been designated although a unidirectional positioning function is not provided.
Cause

Check the software specifications and change the program command G60 to G00.
Action

816 FEEDRATE ZERO (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The feedrate command has not been input.
Cause

Specify feedrate F for the movement command. (Since modal move command G01 is automatically set at power-on, axis
Action movement in the modal mode is started by input of a move command, even if G01 is not designated in the program).

d.
ve
817 INCORRECT ARC DATA (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The relationship between the starting and ending points of the arc and the center of the arc is not appropriate.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the values of the starting/ending points and the address values of center of the arc in the program, and check the

gh
Action address values for the correct direction (minus or plus).

ri
818 MISSING CENTER (NO DATA) (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
 For arc interpolation by R designation, the coordinates of the center of the arc cannot be calculated.

N
Cause  Axis moving by manual interruption is specified in immediate front of the arc command. The arc cannot be defined

O
since the relationship between the starting point, ending point, and radius of the arc becomes incorrect.

TI
 Correct the value of each address in the program.
16

Action
 Restart the program after pressing the RESET key.
A
R
04

PO
30

819 HELICAL OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R

The helical interpolation command has been issued although such an interpolation function is not provided.
o.

Cause
N

C
al

Check the specifications, and if such an interpolation function is not available, correct the data of the block in which the arc
ri

ZA

Action interpolation command has been issued with designation of three axes.
Se

820 G02.1, G03.1 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
IM

The spiral interpolation command (G02.1 or G03.1) has been issued although such an interpolation function is not
K

Cause provided.
ZA

Delete the G02.1 or G03.1 command.


A

Action
M
YA

821 G07 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3

The virtual-axis command (G07) has been issued although there are not virtual-axis specifications.
01

Cause
)2

Check the specifications, and then change the G07 command.


(c

Action
ht
ig

822 ILLEGAL MODAL (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr

A G-code command has been specified in illegal modal data.


op

Cause
C

Review the program.


Action

823 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN M98 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been issued during figure rotation.
Cause

Delete the plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) from the figure rotation subprogram.
Action

3-126
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
824 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN G68 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been specified in the coordinates rotation command (G68).
Cause

IF G68 has been issued, execute the coordinates rotation cancel command (G69) before specifying the plane selection
Action command (G17, G18 or G19).

825 G17 - G19 COMMAND IN G38 - G42 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) has been specified during tool diameter offset (G41 or G42).
Cause

Specify the plane selection command after the tool diameter offset command has been canceled by G40.
Action

d .
ve
826 G95 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The synchronous feed command (G95) has been specified although such feed specifications are not provided.

s
Cause

re
ts
After checking the specifications, change the synchronous feed command (G95) to the feed-in-minutes command (G94).

gh
Action Also change the F command value.

ri
827 F0 COMMAND IN G02, G03 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The F 1-digit rapid-feed command (F0) has been specified during arc interpolation (G02 or G03).
Cause

N
O
Since rapid feed cannot be ordered for arc interpolation, specify an F 1-digit command other than F0. Specify G0 or G1 if

TI
Action
16

the type of interpolation is not arc interpolation. A


R
04

828 NO AUTO CORNER OVERRIDE OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The automatic corner override command (G62) has been specified although such an override function is not available.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Check the specifications, and delete the G62 command from the program.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

829 ILLEGAL 2ND M CODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The secondary auxiliary function address that has been specified in the program is different from the corresponding
Cause address that has been parameterized.
K
ZA

Check and correct the secondary auxiliary function address that has been specified in the program.
Action
A
M

830 G96 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The constant surface speed command (G96) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
3
01

–1
)2

Check the specifications and change the constant surface speed command (G96) to the speed command (min ).
Action
(c
ht

831 G45, 46, 47, 48 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

A tool-position compensation command (G45 to G48) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
yr

Cause
op
C

Check the specifications.


Action

832 G45 - G49 COMMAND IN G98 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tool-position compensation has been specified during figure rotation or coordinates rotation.
Cause

Review the program.


Action

3-127
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
833 1/4, 3/4 CIRCLES IN G45 - G48 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An arc command that is not available for tool-position compensation has been specified.
Cause

Review the program.


Action

834 G40, G41, G42 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A tool diameter offset command (G41 or G42) has been specified although such specifications are not provided.
Cause

Check the specifications.


Action

d .
ve
835 G41, G42, FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
A compensation command (G40, G41, G42) has been specified during the arc mode (G02 or G03 command).

s
Cause

re
ts
Set either the linear command (G01) or the rapid-feed command (G00) into the compensation command block or the

gh
Action cancellation block. (That is, set the modal status to linear interpolation).

ri
836 NO INTERSECTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
In tool diameter offset (G41 or G42), the coordinates of the intersection point existing when a block was skipped in
Cause processing of interference blocks cannot be calculated.

N
O
Review the program.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

837 TOOL OFFSET INTERFERENCE ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

An interference error has occurred during execution of tool diameter offset (G41 or G42).
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the program.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

838 3-D OFFSET OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The three-dimensional compensation command has been designated although such compensation specifications are not
Cause provided.
K
ZA

Check the specifications.


Action
A
M

839 ILLEGAL OFFSET No. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

A compensation command (G41 or G42) has been designated without a compensation number (D); or the
Cause
3

compensation number is larger than the maximum number of sets of compensation numbers available in the specifications.
01
)2

Check the maximum available number of sets of compensation numbers, and designate a compensation number smaller
Action than that.
(c
ht

840 CANNED CYCLE OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

A fixed-cycle G-code has been designated although fixed-cycle specifications are not provided.
yr

Cause
op
C

Check the specifications and correct the program.


Action

841 DESIGNATED TOOL NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The tools that are not yet registered on the TOOL DATA display are specified using T-code command in an EIA/ISO
Cause program.

Check the program and register the necessary tools on the TOOL DATA display.
Action

3-128
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
842 SUB PROGRAM NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. The total number of sequential calls of subprogram has exceeded eight.
2. Execution of a program that includes an “M99” command was attempted in the direct operation mode using HD or
Cause
Ethernet.
3. The program in the HD or host called a program stored in the HD or host.
1. Check the number of subprogram calls, and correct the program so that the number of calls does not exceed eight.
Action 2. Do not include an “M99” command in the main program to be executed in the direct operation mode.
3. Do not call a subprogram stored in the HD or host from a program stored in the HD or host.
843 DESIGNATED SNo. NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The sequence number for subprogram call, for return from a subprogram or for the GOTO designation is not yet set.
Cause

.
d
ve
Set the sequence number in the appropriate block.

er
Action

s
re
844 PROGRAM No. NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
An attempt was made to call a subprogram which was not yet registered.

gh
Cause

ri
ll
Register the subprogram.

.A
Action

N
845 ILLEGAL VARIABLE COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
TI
A variables number has been designated although variables number (#) specifications are not provided.
16

Cause A
R
04

PO

Check the specifications.


30

Action
R
o.

846 DESIGNATED NUMBER NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
N

C
al

The designated variables number is larger than the maximum variables number permitted by the specifications.
K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Check the specifications and the variables numbers in the program.


Action
IM
K

847 NO “=” CODE IN PROGRAM (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA

“=” was not designated in the definition of a variable.


Cause
A
M
YA

Set “=” in the variables definition.


Action
3
01

848 M98 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K O Blue


)2

A figure rotation command has been designated although figure rotation specifications are not provided.
Cause
(c
ht

Check the specifications.


ig

Action
yr
op

849 FIGURE ROTATE NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K O Blue


C

One figure rotation command has been designated during execution of another such command.
Cause

Check the program.


Action

850 G68 AND M98 COMMANDS SAME BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A figure rotation command and a coordinates rotation command are designated at the same time.
Cause

Check the program.


Action

3-129
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
851 G68 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The coordinates rotation command (G68) has been designated although coordinates rotation specifications are not
Cause provided.

Check the specifications.


Action

852 USER MACRO OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Macro specifications have been designated although such specifications are not provided.
Cause

Check the specifications.


Action

d .
ve
853 EXTERNAL MACRO OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
A user macro interruption command has been designated although such interruption specifications are not provided.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the specifications.

gh
Action

ri
854 INCORRECT USERMACRO PROGRAMMING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
An NC statement and a macro statement are present in one block.
Cause

N
O
Review the program and give the NC statement and the macro statement in separate blocks.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

855 USER MACRO NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The maximum permissible degree of multiplicity of user macro calls has been exceeded.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the program and correct it so that the number of user macro calls does not exceed the maximum number of calls
al

Action permitted by the specifications.


ri

ZA
Se

856 USER MACRO ARGUMENT EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The number of sets of user macro call arguments of type  is too large.
Cause
K
ZA

Review the program.


Action
A
M

857 INCORRECT USER MACRO G67 PROG. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

Command G67 has been designated when G66 command modal state was not yet set.
Cause
3
01
)2

The G67 command is the call cancellation command; after reviewing the program, designate firstly the G66 command and
Action then the G67 command.
(c
ht

858 USER MACRO “[“ NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The total number of “[” and “]” within one block has become more than five.
yr

Cause
op
C

Review the program, and correct it so that the total number of “[“ and “]” within one block does not exceed five.
Action

859 NUMBER OF PARENTHESIS MIS-MATCH (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The total number of “[” and “]” within one block differ.
Cause

Review the program, and correct it so that the total number of “[“ and of “]” become the same.
Action

3-130
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
860 CALCULATION IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The operation expression is not correct.
Cause

Review the program and correct the operation expression.


Action

861 DIVISION BY ZERO (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The denominator in the division expression is zero.
Cause

Review the program and correct it so that the denominator in the division expression does not become zero.
Action

.
d
ve
862 INTEGER VALUE OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
31 31
The integral value has overstepped –2 (2 –1) in the operation process.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the operation expression written in the program, and correct it so that after operation, the value of the integer does

gh
Action 31
not overstep –2 .

ri
863 REAL VALUE OVERFLOW (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The variables data is overflowing.
Cause

N
O
Review the variables data in the program.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

864 “IF” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The statement of IF [<conditional expression>] GOTO is wrong.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the program.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

865 “WHILE” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The statement of WHILE [<conditional expression>] DO ~ END is wrong.


Cause
K
ZA

Review the program.


Action
A
M

866 “SETVN” STATEMENT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The SETVN statement containing the variables name is wrong.


Cause
3
01
)2

Review the program and correct it so that the variables name in the SETVN statement consists of seven characters or less.
Action
(c
ht

867 DO-END NESTING EXCEEDED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

Of WHILE [<conditional expression>] DO ~ END, DO ~ END has appeared more than 27 times (degree of multiplicity).
yr

Cause
op
C

Review the program and correct it to reduce the degree of multiplicity of DO ~ END to no larger than 27 (27 times).
Action

868 DO-END MIS-MATCH (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The DO's and END's are not formed in pairs.
Cause

Review the program and correct it to give DO's and END's in pairs.
Action

3-131
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
869 NO USER MACRO IN TAPE MODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
During tape operation, macro command (WHILE, DO, END, IF, GOTO, POPEN, PCLOS, BPRNT or DPRNT) has been
Cause found to exist in the tape contents.

Execute the program in the memory operation mode since blocks containing a macro command (WHILE, DO, END, IF,
Action GOTO, POPEN, PCLOS, BPRNT or DPRNT) cannot be executed during tape operation.

870 ILLEGAL VARIABLE NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The designated variables name is not correct.
Cause

Review the variables names in the program and correct the corresponding variables name.
Action

d.
ve
871 VARIABLE NAME EXISTS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
There are overlapping variables names.

s
Cause

re
ts
Correct the program so that variables names do not overlap.

gh
Action

ri
872 G51 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
A scaling command (G50 or G51) has been designated although scaling specifications are not provided.
Cause

N
O
Check the specifications.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

873 G51.1 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

A mirror image command (G50.1 or G51.1) has been designated although programmable mirror image specifications are
R

Cause
o.

not provided.
O
N

Check the specifications.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

874 CORNER R/C OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

Corner chamfering or corner rounding/ has been designated although such specifications are not provided.
Cause
K
ZA

Check the specifications and delete corner rounding or corner chamfering from the program.
Action
A
M

875 NOT FOUND GEOMETRIC OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The geometric command has been designated although geometric specifications are not provided.
Cause
3
01
)2

Check the specifications.


Action
(c
ht

876 NOT FOUND GEOMETRIC OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The geometric setting format is wrong.


yr

Cause
op
C

Review the program.


Action

877 G15 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The polar coordinates command (G16) has been designated although such command specifications are not provided.
Cause

Check the specifications.


Action

3-132
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
878 ADDRESS CHANGE OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Absolute/incremental axis address conversion has been designated although such conversion specifications are not
Cause provided.

Check the specifications.


Action

879 G10 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Program data input has been designated although such input specifications are not provided.
Cause

Check the specifications.


Action

d.
ve
880 AXIS NOT ZERO RETURNED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
A move command other than that for reference-point return has been designated for the axis that was not returned to its

s
Cause

re
reference point.

ts
Manually return the axis to its reference point.

gh
Action

ri
881 G30 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
Second, third or fourth reference-point return has been designated although such reference-point returning specifications
Cause are not provided.

N
O
Check the specifications.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

882 ILLEGAL COMMAND CROSS MACHINING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The program section under the mode of cross machining contains an incompatible G-code.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Review the program.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

883 ILLEGAL CROSS MACHINING COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

1. A G110 command is given under modal conditions not suitable to cross machining control.
Cause
2. An unsuitable axis (since it cannot be used successfully for the counterpart) is specified for cross machining control.
K
ZA

Review the program.


Action
A
M

884 REFERENCE POINT RETURN CHECK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

An axis had not returned to the zero-point when the zero-point check command (G27) was executed.
Cause
3
01
)2

Review the program.


Action
(c
ht

885 G22 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The before-movement stroke check function (G22) has been designated although such function specifications are not
yr

Cause provided.
op
C

Check the specifications.


Action

886 BEYOND AREA OF G22 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
This alarm message is displayed before execution of a movement block to indicate that the ending point of the axis
Cause movement designated in the block is likely to enter the forbidden area which has been designated using the
before-movement stroke check function (G22).
Review the axis-address coordinate values in the program.
Action

3-133
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
887 TAPE I/O ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B (G) I O Red (Blue)
1. An error occurred at the tape reader, or on the printer during macro printing.
2. Calling of a program inside the host computer failed during Ethernet operation.
3. The size of the output text file exceeded the value set for DPR8.
Cause
When the cause is either No. 1 or 2 above, WNo., UNo. and BNo. will be displayed in the parentheses.
When the cause is No. 3 above, the error type, detailed error code and “0” will be displayed in the parentheses.
* Error types 110: File open error, 111: File write error, 112: File size over error
1. Check the parameter.
2. Check the network connection between the NC and the host computer that stores the specified program.
3. Take actions below.

. d
Action  Change the file size setting at parameter DPR8 to a value larger than the text file.

ve
er
 Reduce the size of the text file to be output to within the file size setting at parameter DPR8.

s
 If a value other than “0” is displayed for the detailed error code in the parentheses, note the number and contact

re
the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

ts
888 FILE I/O ERROR ( , , ) E I O Red (Blue)

gh
The machining program file cannot be read.

ri
Cause

ll
.A
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

N
Action

O
TI
889 G37 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
16

A
The automatic tool-length measurement command (G37) has been designated although such measurement specifications
R
04

Cause are not provided.


PO
30

Check the specifications.


R
o.

Action
O
N

C
al

890 G31 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K
ri

ZA

The skip command (G31) has been designated although skip specifications are not provided.
Se

Cause
A
IM

Check the specifications.


Action
K
ZA

891 G31.1 - G31.3 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A

A multi-step skip command (G31.1, G31.2 or G31.3) has been designated although such skip specifications are not
M

Cause provided.
YA

Check the specifications.


3

Action
01
)2

892 AUTO PROGRAMMING FAILURE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c

A trouble has occurred with the software of auto program during the operation.
ht

Cause
ig
yr

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


Action
op
C

893 PROGRAM DATA MISSING ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


Argument P was not designated in the macro call command (G65, G66, G66.1).
Cause

Review the program and set the number of the macro program to be called to argument P.
Action

3-134
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
894 MAZATROL PROGRAM DESIGNATED ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. An attempt has been made to call a MAZATROL program from an EIA/ISO program which was designated as a
subprogram of MAZATROL program.
Cause
2. A MAZATROL program has been specified using G65 command (subprogram call) in the manual program mode unit of
the MAZATROL program.
In cases 1 and 2 above, a MAZATROL program cannot be called as a subprogram. Review the program.
Action

895 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

.d
ve
Action ——

er
896 ILLEGAL CHAMFERING ( , , ) B J P Red

s
re
1. In the thread cutting cycle command, designation for chamfering is incorrect.

ts
Cause
2. The current plane differs from the plane of chamfering.

gh
1. Set chamfering data that ensures termination of the operation of the tool within the cycle.

ri
Action
2. Select the same plane as that of chamfering.

ll
.A
897 LAP CYCLE BLOCK NUMBER EXCEED ( , , ) B J P Red

N
The number of blocks in the shape data of the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273) exceeds 100 blocks.

O
Cause

TI
16

A
Reduce below 100 the number of blocks in the shape data of the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273).
R
04

Action
PO
30

898 LAP CYCLE ILLEGAL SHAPE DESIGN. ( , , ) B J P Red


R
o.

The shape defined in the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273) is not the shape for correct cutting.
N

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Recheck the shape data specified by the turning fixed-cycle (G270 through G273).
Se

Action
A
IM

899 ILLEGAL TAPER LENGTH ( , , ) B J P Red


K

In the fixed-cycle (G290, G294), designation for the taper length or the taper height is incorrect.
ZA

Cause
A

Set the taper length or the taper height for the fixed-cycle (G290, G294) smaller than the travel of the axis.
M

Action
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-135
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1800 CANNOT CHANGE TIME CONSTANT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red
The G-command has been set in the block containing a time constant changeover/cancellation command.
The time constant changeover/cancellation command has been set in the fixed cycle.
Cause
The time constant changeover/cancellation command has been set during MAZATROL programmed simultaneous
machining or MAZATROL programmed “2 workpiece” machining.
Review and correct the program.
Action

1801 ILLEGAL COMMD TIME CONST. CHANGE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red
The G10 command has been set during time constant changeover (non-M880 mode).
Cause

. d
Review and correct the program.

ve
Action

s er
1802 ILLEGAL STARTUP CONDITION G12.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
1. The G12.1 command is set when the current position of the No. 1 axis (linear axis) on the plane is present on the

ts
Cause negative side.

gh
2. The No. 2 axis (rotational axis) on the plane is not a rotating type of rotational axis.

ri
1. Move the current position of the No. 1 axis (linear axis) on the plane into the positive side before setting the G12.1

ll
command.

.A
Action
2. Specify a rotating type of rotational axis as the No. 2 axis on the plane.

N
Example : G17X_C_; G12.1; …

O
TI
1803 ILL GCODE (2ND SPDL POS ONLY) (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
16

A
A G-code whose usage for the secondary spindle is prohibited has been entered when the secondary spindle
R
04

Cause high-accuracy index option was valid.


PO
30

When the secondary spindle high-accuracy index option is valid, an interpolation command cannot be issued for the
o.

Action
O

secondary spindle; only a positioning command can be used.


N

C
al

1804 NO Z-OFFSET (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red


ri

ZA

With F165 bit 6 = 1 (Z-offset data presence check for EIA automatic operation), Z-offset value was missing in setup data
Se

Cause when the G53.5 command (initial G53.5 included) was entered for EIA automatic operation.
A
IM

Set the Z-offset value in the setup data or change the setting of F165 bit 6 from 1 to 0.
Action
K
ZA

1805 G68.2 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A

Executing the program has been attempted despite an inclined-surface machining option being absent.
M

Cause
YA

The program for inclined-surface machining cannot be executed without the inclined-surface machining option.
3

Action
01
)2

1806 ILLEGAL CMD TILTED PLANE CMD (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
(c

A command (G-command or T-command) that cannot be used for inclined-surface machining has been specified during
ht

Cause inclined-surface machining.


ig

Cancel inclined-surface machining before executing a G-command or T-command that cannot be used during
yr

Action inclined-surface machining.


op
C

1807 CANNOT USE G68.2 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. Inclined-surface machining has been specified in the mode that prohibits the specification of inclined-surface
machining.
Cause
2. A G68.4 command (for incremental coordinate system establishment) was given with the inclined-surface machining
mode being cancelled.
1. Cancel the mode that prohibits the specification of inclined-surface machining.
Action 2. With the inclined-surface machining mode being cancelled, use G68.2, instead of G68.4, to establish a particular
coordinate system for ease of programming.

3-136
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1808 CANNOT USE G53.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Inclined-surface machining has been specified in the mode that prohibits the specification of tool axial control.
Cause

Cancel the mode that prohibits the specification of tool axial control.
Action

1809 TILTED PLANE CMD FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A L S Blue
The inclined-surface machining command address is wrong.
Cause

Correct the program.


Action

d.
ve
1810 TILTED PLANE CANNOT BE DEFINED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A L S Blue

er
The inclined surface cannot be defined with the specified data.

s
Cause

re
ts
Correct the program.
Action

gh
ri
1811 CANNOT USE G43.1 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B L O Red

ll
.A
“Tool length correction in the tool axial direction” has been specified in the mode that does not permit that command.
Cause

N
O
Cancel modes that cannot be used with “Tool length correction in the tool axial direction”.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

1812 ILLEGAL CMD IN G43.1 MODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B L O Red


PO
30

An incorrect command (such as a G-command or a T-command) has been entered during “Tool length correction in the
Cause
R

tool axial direction”.


o.

O
N

Cancel “Tool length correction in the tool axial direction” to execute the G- or T-command.
al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

1813 G54.4 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The workpiece placement error correction option is not present.


Cause
K
ZA

The workpiece placement error correction cannot be used without the workpiece placement error correction option.
Action
A
M

1814 ILLEGAL CMD IN G54.4 MODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

An incorrect command (such as a G-command or a T-command) has been entered during the workpiece placement error
Cause correction.
3
01

Cancel the workpiece placement error correction to execute the G- or T-command.


)2

With parameter F156 bit 2 set to 1, even when the movement is separated between rotary axis and linear axis during the
(c

Action workpiece placement error correction, this separation is not possible if tool radius compensation is used concurrently.
ht

With parameter F156 bit 2 set to 1, when the movement of rotary axis and linear axis is separated during the workpiece
ig

placement error correction, the MSTB command cannot be included in the same block.
yr

1815 CANNOT USE G54.4 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

The workpiece placement error correction has been specified in the mode that does not permit the workpiece placement
C

Cause error correction.

Cancel modes that cannot be used with the workpiece placement error correction.
Action

1816 CANNOT USE G18.1/G18.2/G18.3 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The mode existing during plane selection (with G18.2/G18.3/G18.4) for turning, or during plane cancellation (with G18.1)
Cause for turning is not valid.

Review and correct the program.


Action

3-137
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1817 ILLEGAL CMD IN G18.2/G18.3 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An incorrect command has been specified during the plane selection (with G18.2/G18.3/G18.4) for turning.
Cause

Review and correct the program.


Action

1818 ILLEGAL COMMAND (SAFETY SHIELD) ( , , ) B L N Red


An invalid cutting command was issued for the material model when interference checking of the material model was valid.
Cause

Specify the material model cutting invalid M-code in the program.


Action

d.
ve
1819 ILLEGAL C/S (SAFETY SHIELD) ( , , ) B L N Red

er
1. The program of either the hard disk operation or Ethernet operation area was specified as subprogram when automatic

s
operation interference check was valid.

re
Cause
2. The program to be called up as a subprogram is not registered in the memory.

ts
gh
1. Make the Automatic Operation INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD function invalid, or before specifying the program of
either the hard disk operation or Ethernet operation area as subprogram, set the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD

ri
Action function invalid M-code in the main program, to make the automatic operation interference check function invalid.

ll
.A
2. Register the required program.
B I (L) O (S)

N
1820 ILLEGAL COMMD IN G54.4 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) Red (Blue)

O
1. Such a command has been assigned that the travel on a rotational axis exceeds an angle of 180° before or after the

TI
correction of the tool direction.
16

Cause A
2. The distance of correcting motion on the primary or secondary rotational axis for workpiece placement error correction
R
04

is beyond the limit particularly set for MAZATROL programs.


PO
30

1. Divide the move command so that the angular motion, whether it be before or after being corrected, will be up to 180°
R
o.

in terms of the travel per block.


O

Action
N

2. Modify the settings of angular errors (a, b, c) in order that the distance of correcting motion on the primary or
C
al

secondary rotational axis may not exceed the limit concerned.


K
ri

ZA

1821 UNWRITABLE SYSTEM VARIABLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Se

Writing into a write-protected system variable has been attempted.


IM

Cause
K

Correct the program.


ZA

Action
A

1822 —— ( , , )
M
YA

Cause ——
3
01

Action ——
)2
(c

1823 NOT POSSIBLE SETTING ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ht

The workpiece setup error correction command has been issued in a MAZATROL program under inadequate conditions.
ig

Cause
yr
op

Confirm the followings:



C

Action Parameter K113 = 1 (Machine type: Tool tilt type)


 Workpiece setup error correction for MAZATROL program (option) valid
1824 UNWRITABLE SYSTEM VARIABLE(ISS) (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red
An attempt was made to change the part count data by changing the system variables (#3901 and #3902) during automatic
Cause operation with the SAFETY SHIELD function set valid.

Set the part count value before starting the operation, or perform automatic operation with the SAFETY SHIELD function
Action set invalid.

3-138
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1825 ILLEGAL M CODE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
M711 to M714 was specified in the manual program unit, TPC, or tool sequence.
Cause

Review the program.


Action

1826 HEAD-AXIS ILLEGAL COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O (S) Red (Blue)
A G-code command that cannot be used for the head indexing axis has been specified.
Cause

Review and correct the program.


Action Use G00 to index the head.

. d
ve
1827 HEAD-AXIS ANGLE INCORRECT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O (S) Red (Blue)

er
The angular value given for indexing the head cannot be divided by the L17 parameter setting (minimum angle of head

s
Cause index command).

re
ts
Review and correct the program.
Action

gh
ri
1828 —— ( , , )

ll
.A
Cause ——

N
O
TI
Action ——
16

A
R
04

1829 NO 5 AXIS SPLINE CUTTING OPTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


PO
30

Tool tip point control or high-speed smoothing control is made valid in the G61.2 mode when the 5-axis spline interpolation
Cause
R

option is not provided.


o.

O
N

When the 5-axis spline interpolation is not provided, 5-axis spline interpolation is not available.
al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

1830 CANNOT USE 5AXIS SPLINE CUTTING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

The 5-axis spline interpolation mode is made valid during the uniaxial rotation interpolation (when bit 3 of parameter F85 is
Cause set to 0).
K
ZA

To use the 5-axis spline interpolation, select the joint interpolation (set bit 3 of parameter F85 to 1).
Action
A
M

1831 ILLEGAL CHOPPING CONDITION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

1. The top dead point and the bottom dead point are the same.
3

2. The chopping feed rate command specifies zero.


01

3. The chopping command is given in the chopping command inhibiting mode.


)2

Cause 4. An illegal value (other than 0 to 2) is set for the chopping offset method.
(c

5. An illegal value (other than 0 to 7) is set for the chopping offset number.
ht

6. The chopping record M-code is issued when the offset update method is selected.
ig

7. An overflow occurs when writing the chopping speed value.


yr

Take action below to remove the cause, and press the RESET key or tap the alarm clear button.
op
C

1. Review the command for the top dead point or bottom dead point.
2. Review the chopping feed rate command.
3. Issue the chopping command in the chopping command possible mode.
Action
4. Set a correct value (0 to 2) for the chopping offset method.
5. Set a correct value (0 to 7) for the chopping offset number.
6. Do not issue the chopping record M-code when the offset update method is selected.
7. Specify the chopping speed value so that on overflow will not occur during writing.

3-139
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1832 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN CHOPPING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A command that is inhibited during chopping is issued.
Cause

Change the program so that the inhibited command is not issued during chopping.
Action
Then press the RESET key or tap the alarm clear button.

1833 ILLEGAL COND. CORRECT LENGTH.C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
Tool length compensation G43P3 is issued under any of the following conditions.
1. Pinch cut or Y-axis turning option is invalid.
2. The machine is not equipped with tool length C compensation, or tool length C compensation is made invalid.
Cause
(Parameter BA131 bit 1 = 0)

d .
3. MAZATROL tool length is invalid. (Parameter F93 bit 3 = 0)

ve
4. Tool length A, B or C is not set for the current tool in MAZATROL tool data.

er
1. Pinch cut or Y-axis turning option must be purchased.

s
re
2. If the machine is not equipped with tool length C compensation, correct the program so that the G43P3 command is not

ts
used. If the machine is equipped with tool length C compensation, make tool length C compensation valid. (Parameter
Action

gh
BA131 bit 1 = 1)

ri
3. Make MAZATROL tool length valid. (Parameter F93 bit 3 = 1)

ll
4. Set tool length A, B and C for the current tool in MAZATROL tool data.

.A
1834 CORRECTING LENGTH.C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
1. The X-, Y- or Z-axis movement command is issued before the head rotary axis (B-axis) is turned to the 90-degree

O
position after the tool length compensation G43P3 command was issued (or after tool change to a tool with tool length

TI
Cause
16

C setting).
A
R
04

2. A G-code command that is prohibited in the tool length compensation G43P3 mode is issued.
PO
30

1. When the axis movement command is issued with tool length C compensation valid, the head rotary axis (B-axis) must
Action be turned to the 90-degree position in advance.
R
o.

2. Review the program and delete prohibited G-codes.


N

1835 FILE ACCESS ERROR (Cause, , ) G I P Red


al

K
ri

ZA

1. Before reading the program for the control path in which the alarm occurred, a process was executed in response to a
Se

Cause command specified in another control path.


A

2. Access to the program file used for the hard disk or Ethernet operation did not complete within the preset time.
IM

1. Add a queuing command before the following commands.


K

Cross machining command (G110), C-axis selection M code, synchronization cancellation M code
ZA

Action 2. Set a larger value for parameter SU55 and check if the alarm reoccurs.
A

When running the machine using Ethernet, review the network environment.
M

If the problem cannot be solved by these checks, note the numbers in the parentheses and contact the nearest Mazak
YA

Technical Center or Technology Center.

1836 CANNOT USE CUTTING PT CTRL (WNo., NNo. , BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
3
01

1. In the mode in which a cutting point command cannot be specified, a cutting point command was specified.
)2

2. A cutting point command was specified although a workpiece coordinate system was selected as the coordinate
(c

system for programming.


ht

Cause 3. A cutting point command was specified although the shape offset is processed by sifting the coordinates (F161 bit1 =
ig

0).
yr

4. A circular interpolation command was specified although cutting point command mode or a table coordinate system
op

was selected.
C

Take action below to remove the cause, and press the RESET key or tap the alarm clear button.
1. In the cutting point command mode, check other selected modes and cancel those that cannot be used.
2. If a G43.9 command is specified in the state a workpiece coordinate system is selected as the coordinate system for
Action
programming, specify a G43.8 command or select a table coordinate system for the programming coordinate system.
3. Set F161 bit1 = 0 to specify a cutting point command.
4. Specify a G43.8 command or select a workpiece coordinate system for the programming coordinate system.

3-140
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1837 ILLEGAL CMD CUTTING PT CTRL (WNo., NNo. , BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
In the cutting point command mode, an unusable command was specified.
Cause

To execute a command that cannot be used in the cutting point command mode, cancel the cutting point command once.
Action

1838 CUTTING PT CTRL FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
1. In the G43.8 mode, an I/J/K address was specified or in the G43.9 mode, an address of a rotary axis was specified.
2. In a block that contains a G49 command, other commands were specified.
3. A rotary axis command was specified in circular interpolation mode.

.
d
4. In the G43.8 or G43.9 mode, an axis feed command of other than the controllable axes (axes specified with K114,
Cause

ve
K115, K116, K121 and K125) was specified.

er
5. For argument P, a value other than 0, 1 and 2 was specified.

s
re
6. For argument Q, a value other than 1, 2 and 3 was specified.
7. There was no argument H although argument Q was specified.

ts
gh
Correct the program.

ri
1. In the G43.8 mode an I/J/K address cannot be specified, and in the G43.9 mode a rotary axis command cannot be

ll
specified.

.A
2. Specify a G49 command in a block without other commands.
Action

N
3. A rotary axis command cannot be specified in circular interpolation mode.

O
4. In the G43.8 or G43.9 mode, specify an axis feed command of only the controllable axes (axes specified with K114,

TI
K115, K116, K121 and K125).
16

5. Specify 0, 1 or 2 for argument P.


A
R
04

PO
30

1839 CUTTING PT CONTROL N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.

An attempt was made to execute a program although the cutting point control function is not selected.
O

Cause
N

C
al

A cutting point control command program cannot be executed unless the cutting point control function option is selected.
ri

ZA

Action
Se

A
IM

( , , )
K

Cause
ZA
A
M

Action
YA

1845 CORNER SMOOTH CONTROL N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
3
01

An attempt was made to execute a program although the corner smoothing control function option is not selected.
)2

Cause
(c

A program that uses the corner smoothing control function cannot be executed unless the corner smoothing control
ht

Action function option is selected.


ig
yr

1846 VARIABLE ACCELERATION CTRL N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
op

An attempt was made to execute a program although the variable acceleration control function option is not selected.
C

Cause

A program that uses the variable acceleration control function cannot be executed unless the variable acceleration control
Action function option is selected.

( , , )

Cause

Action

3-141
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-10 No. 900 - No. 999, No. 1900 - No. 1999 (EIA/ISO program error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
900 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

901 INCORRECT FIXED CYCLE COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The fixed-cycle command has been set in the program during the tool diameter offset (G41 or G42) modal status.
Cause

.d
Set the tool diameter offset cancellation command (G40) before the fixed-cycle command.

ve
Action

s er
902 G10 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
The G10 command has been designated although this command is not available with the system.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Check the specifications.
Action

ll
.A
903 ILLEGAL G10 L NUMBER (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
An unallowable L number has been designated during input of G10 program command.

O
Cause

TI
16

Correct the L number in the program. A


R
04

Action
PO
30

904 ILLEGAL G10 OFFSET No. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R
o.

Compensation numbers other than the number of sets permitted by the specifications have been designated during input of
N

Cause G10.
al

K
ri

ZA

After checking the number of compensation sets permitted by the specifications, change the setting of address P to a value
Se

Action smaller than the permissible number of sets.


A
IM

905 G11 OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The G11 command has been designated although this command is not available with the system.
K

Cause
ZA
A

Check the specifications.


M

Action
YA

906 NO S DIRECTIVE IN FIXED CYCLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
3

The spindle speed for the fixed cycle has not yet been set in the program.
01

Cause
)2

Program the spindle speed command in the block which precedes the block with the fixed cycle command.
(c

Action
ht
ig

907 DIFFERENT SPINDLE TYPE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
yr

An attempt has been made to machine the workpiece using the synchronous tapping method in spite of the spindle
op

Cause controller being an SE type.


C

Use the appropriate tapping method for the particular type of the spindle controller.
Action

908 NO PITCH IN FIXED CYCLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The pitch or the number of threads has not been designated for the tapping cycle (G74 or G84) of the drilling fixed cycles.
Cause

Designate the pitch using address F or E.


Action

3-142
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
909 ILLEGAL PITCH IN FIXED CYCLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K S Blue
The pitch or the number of threads designated for the tapping cycle (G74 or G84) of the drilling fixed cycles is wrong.
Cause

Check and correct the pitch or the number of threads.


Action

910 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

d .
ve
911 CORNER R/C OPTION NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K S Blue

er
Corner chamfering/corner rounding has been designated although such specifications are not provided.

s
Cause

re
ts
Check the specifications and delete corner rounding or corner chamfering from the program.

gh
Action

ri
912 NO MOTION COMMAND AFTER R/C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K S Blue

ll
.A
The block that is to succeed the corner rounding or corner chamfering command does not consist of a move command.
Cause

N
O
Give the G01 command in the corresponding block.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

913 INCORRECT R/C COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K S Blue


PO
30

The length of the corner rounding or corner chamfering that has been designated in the corner rounding or chamfering
R

Cause
o.

command is larger than the distance of movement.


O
N

Reduce the length of the corner rounding or chamfering to a value smaller than the distance of movement.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

914 INCORRECT COMMAND AFTER R/C (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K S Blue


A
IM

The movement distance designated in the next block is shorter than the length of the corner rounding or corner chamfering.
Cause
K
ZA

Reduce the length of the corner rounding or chamfering to a value smaller than the moving distance of the next block.
Action
A
M

915 ANGLE < 1 DEGREE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K O Blue


YA

In the geometric command, the difference in angle between the two straight lines which intersect with each other is less
Cause
3

than 1°.
01
)2

Increase the angle difference in the geometric command.


Action
(c
ht

916 GEOMETRIC COMMAND NOT ABSOLUTE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K O Blue


ig

The second block of the geometric command is an incremental command.


yr

Cause
op
C

The second block must always consists of absolute data. Program it in units of absolute coordinates.
Action

917 NO LINEAR COMMAND IN 2ND BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K O Blue


The second block of the geometric command is not given the linear command (G1).
Cause

Correct the program so that the linear command (G1) and the feedrate command (F) are given to the second block.
Action

3-143
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
918 INCORRECT ANGLE DATA (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
In address designation of the geometric command, the angle in the first block, ending point coordinates and angle in the
Cause second block are incorrectly given.

Check and reprogram the corresponding data.


Action

919 INCORRECT PLANE SELECTION CMD. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) was given in the geometric command block.
Cause

Program the plane selection command (G17, G18 or G19) in the block that precedes the geometric command block.
Action

.
d
ve
920 G27, M COMMANDS SAME BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
An M independent command (M0, M1, M2 or M30) has been programmed in the same block as the G27 command.

s
Cause

re
ts
Correct the program so that the G27 command and the M independent command are contained in separate blocks.

gh
Action

ri
921 G29, M COMMANDS SAME BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
An M independent command (M0, M1, M2 or M30) and the G29 command (start-position return) have been programmed in
Cause the same block.

N
O
Correct the program so that the G29 command and the M independent command are contained in separate blocks.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

922 SKIP SPEED ZERO (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The feedrate F has not been programmed in the G31 (skip) command block.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Set the skip feedrate F into the G31 program block.


al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

923 ILLEGAL COMMAND G37 AXIS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

No axis settings are included in the automatic tool-length measurement block; or more than one axis setting have been
Cause made.
K
ZA

Designate only one axis.


Action
A
M

924 G37, H COMMANDS SAME BLOCK (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

The H-code is in the same block as the automatic tool-length measurement command.
Cause
3
01
)2

Set the H-code into a block preceding the automatic tool-length measurement block.
Action
(c
ht

925 H CODE REQUIRED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

The H-code is not yet set for automatic tool-length measurement.


yr

Cause
op

Set an H-code into a block preceding the automatic tool-length measurement block.
C

Action

926 ILLEGAL G37 SIGNAL (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O Red


The signal of measuring-position arrival has been turned on before the tool reaches the area designated through either a
Cause D-code or the parameter for deceleration area “d”; or the signal has not been turned on at all.

Check the program and parameters.


Action

3-144
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
927 SKIP COMMAND IN CORRECTING DIA (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The skip command (G31) was given during tool diameter offset (G41 or G42).
Cause

Correct the program so that the skip command is executed only after the cutter-diameter compensation cancellation
Action command (G40) has been executed.

928 ILLEGAL HEAD DATA No. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The offset number that has been designated in the program is outside the range from 0 to 10.
Cause

Review the machining program and set an allowable offset number.


Action

. d
ve
929 HEAD DATA No. NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
An “H_” number is missing in the “G45.1H_” part of the EIA/ISO program.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the machining program and set an allowable offset number.

gh
Action

ri
930 ILLEGAL HEAD TYPE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
The head type does not match to the face that has been designated in the program.
Cause

N
O
Review the machining program and set the correct head type.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

931 NO HEAD DATA (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The head number that has been designated in the program is not registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

1. Review the designated head number.


al

Action
2. Check if the designated head number is registered on the HEAD OFFSET display.
ri

ZA
Se

932 RETURN R POINT IN CUTTING SIDE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

Return to reference point has been designated during the surface-machining mode (G17.2 to G17.5) of the program.
Cause
K
ZA

Return to reference point cannot be executed during the surface-machining mode (G17.2 to G17.5). Review the cutting
Action program.
A
M

933 NO 5FACE CUTTING OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

An attempt has been made to execute a five-surface machining program when the five-surface machining option was not
Cause
3

present.
01
)2

Set the five-surface machining option to execute a five-surface machining program.


Action
(c
ht

934 NO HIGH-SPEED MODE OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ig

An attempt has been made to execute the high-speed mode program when the high-speed mode option was not set.
yr

Cause
op
C

Without the high-speed mode option, the high-speed mode program cannot be executed.
Action

935 NO PRE-INTERP ACCEL/DECEL OPT. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the high-accuracy mode program when the high-accuracy mode option was not set.
Cause

Without the high-accuracy mode option, the high-accuracy mode program cannot be executed.
Action

3-145
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
936 OPTION NOT FOUND (Option No., 0, 0) E I (L) O Red
The machine does not feature required options given below.
No. Option Name
1 NURBS interpolation
2 Shaving
5 Cutting load detection type auto-pecking
6 Ethernet operation
7 Cylinder interpolation
10 Polar coordinate interpolation or dynamic offset
Cause
11 Hob machining

.
15 Polygon machining

d
ve
16 Tool radius offset for EIA simultaneous 5-axis machining

er
19 Spindle/servo inertia estimation

s
20 Tool length offset in tool axial direction

re
23 Spindle attachment

ts
gh
70 Override variable thread cutting

ri
Check the specifications.

ll
Action

.A
N
937 ILLEGAL TOOL DESIGNATED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
The designated tool cannot be used.

TI
Cause
16

A
R
04

Check the TOOL DATA display to see if the designated tool is an unusable one.
PO
30

Action
R
o.

938 PARAMETER ERROR ( , , ) A K P Red


N

An attempt was made to start automatic operation although the setting at parameter F40, the operation selection parameter
al

Cause in tape mode, was “2”.


ri

ZA
Se

Do not change the setting value of parameter F40.


A

Action
IM

939 NO THREAD CUTTING OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) A (A) K (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
K
ZA

An attempt has been made to execute operation or tool path check of the program that contains G33 command (threading),
Cause although G33 option is not provided.
A
M

Without G33 option, G33 threading command cannot be used.


YA

Action
3
01

940 NO INVERSE TIME OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

Inverse time feed program was attempted although inverse time feed option is not provided.
Cause
(c
ht

Inverse time feed program cannot be executed because inverse time feed option is not provided.
Action
ig
yr

941 G93 MODE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op
C

G-code of inhibition during G93 mode has been designated.


Cause

Review the program and delete prohibited G-codes.


Action

942 NO 3-D CONVERSION OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to execute the three-dimensional coordinate conversion program in the absence of a
Cause three-dimensional coordinate conversion option.

Three-dimensional coordinate conversion is not possible because of the absence of a three-dimensional coordinate
Action conversion option.

3-146
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
943 CONVERTING IN 3-D COORDINATES (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An illegal G-code in the G68 mode has been designated.
Cause

Review the program, and delete the illegal G-code.


Action

944 WRONG CMD. IN 3-D COORDINATES (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A G68 command has been designated during the modal information that does not permit G68 to be set.
Cause

Review the program, and modify the modal information existing when the G68 command was designated.
Action

.d
ve
945 NO HV MACHINING FUNC. OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
An attempt has been made to execute A-axis/B-axis automatic, sequential control or A-axis direct programming in the

s
Cause

re
absence of an HV machining option.

ts
Neither A-axis/B-axis automatic, sequential control, nor A-axis direct programming is possible because of the absence of

gh
Action the option.

ri
946 NO MAZ. SUB PROGRAM OPTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
An attempt has been made to call up a MAZATROL program from the EIA/ISO program in spite of the absence of a
Cause MAZATROL call option.

N
O
Since a MAZATROL call option is not present, MAZATROL programs cannot be called up from EIA/ISO programs using

TI
Action
16

the subprogram call function. A


R
04

947 NO BLOCK SKIP OPTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


PO
30

An attempt has been made to carry out block skip operations in spite of the absence of a block skip option.
R

Cause
o.

O
N

Block skipping is not possible because of the absence of a block skip option.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

948 NO G54.1 OPTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A
IM

An attempt has been made to use a G54.1 code in spite of the absence of a G54.1 (additional workpiece coordinate
Cause system) option.
K
ZA

A G54.1 code cannot be used because of the absence of a G54.1 (additional workpiece coordinate system) option.
Action
A
M

949 NO G52 IN G54.1 MODE ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


YA

An attempt has been made to use an additional workpiece coordinate system and a local workpiece coordinate system at
Cause
3

the same time.


01
)2

An additional workpiece coordinate system and a local workpiece coordinate system cannot be used at the same time.
Action
(c
ht

950 NO SPLINE CUTTING OPTION ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


ig

An attempt has been made to specify a spline interpolation command in spite of the absence of a spline interpolation
yr

Cause option.
op
C

A spline interpolation command cannot be used because of the absence of a spline interpolation option.
Action

951 NO CORNER C/R COMMAND IN G0/G33 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A corner chamfering/rounding command has been designated in the G0 or G33 mode.
Cause

A corner chamfering/rounding command cannot be designated in the G0 or G33 mode.


Action

3-147
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
952 NO SYNCHRONIZED TAP OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
An attempt has been made to perform synchronized tapping in spite of the absence of a synchronized tapping option.
Cause

Synchronized tapping cannot be performed because of the absence of a synchronized tapping option.
Action

953 TOOL DATA INPUT PROCESS ERROR ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
During EIA/ISO program or MDI execution, data is not entered in the tool data item LENGTH or ACT- (NOM-).
Cause (Only when the MAZATROL tool length and tool diameter are valid and parameter F84 bit 7 = 1)

Review the tool data and enter necessary data if missing. (Related parameters: F84 bit 7, F92 bit 7, F93 bit 3)
Enter a value in ACT- (NOM-) if the MAZATROL tool diameter is valid (F92 bit 7 = 1).

d.
Action

ve
Enter a value in LENGTH if the MAZATROL tool length is valid (F93 bit 3 = 1).

er
If F84 bit 7 = 0, any missing data is ignored and the program and MDI are executed.

s
re
954 SCREW PITCH ERR ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The thread lead (thread pitch) that has been designated in the threading command data is not correct.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Set the correct thread lead in the threading command data.
Action

ll
.A
955 START AND END POINT NOT AGREE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) E I (L) O Red

N
O
The ending point of the block immediately preceding the G06.2 command data, and the command data in the starting block

TI
Cause of G06.2 do not match.
16

A
R
04

Modify the program so that the coordinate command data in the starting block of G06.2 matches the ending point of the
PO

Action immediately preceding block.


30

R
o.

956 RESTART OPERATION NOT ALLOWED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) E I (L) O Red
O
N

1. Restarting from the block containing the G06.2/G43.4 mode data has been attempted.
al

2. During the control of cross machining, restarting the program containing another cross machining command has been
ri

ZA

attempted in the corresponding command sequence or subsequent.


Se

3. During the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD for automatic operation is valid, EIA modal restarting from the block
IM

preceded by the M660 block has been attempted.


4. When 1 is set for bit 3 of parameter F93 or bit 7 of parameter F94 with a turning tool mounted, restarting has been
K

Cause attempted from the following block.


ZA

 A block in the G68 mode


A

 A block after G68 mode cancellation before execution of the X-/Z-axis positioning in the absolute data command
M

5. Operation was restarted from a block specified in the orbit machining mode.
YA

6. Operation was restarted from a block between G124 and G125.


3

7. Operation was restarted from a block specified in the cutting point command mode.
01

1. Restart from a block not containing G06.2/G43.4 mode data.


)2

2. Modify the program so that the control of cross machining is canceled before another cross machining command is
(c

executed.
ht

3. Cancel the INTELLIGENT SAFETY SHIELD for automatic operation and execute EIA modal restarting search.
ig

Action 4. Mount a milling tool and restart the program again or set 1 for bit 6 of parameter SU156.
yr

However, when 1 is set for bit 6 of parameter SUS156, the return to the restarting position is not conducted.
op

5. Restart the operation from a block specified in other than the orbit machining mode.
C

6. Restart the operation from a block outside the range between G124 and G125.
7. Restart the operation from a block specified in other than the cutting point command mode.
957 MANUAL INTERRUPT NOT ALLOWED (WNo., NNo., BNo.) E I (L) O Red
Manual handle or MDI interruption from the block containing the G06.2 mode data has been attempted.
Cause

Perform manual interruptions only at blocks not containing G06.2 mode data.
Action

3-148
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
958 AUTO PECKING IMPOSSIBLE (WNo., NNo., BNo.) E I (L) O Red
1. The threshold value for load detection-based auto-pecking is not set to 0 or no such value is set.
Cause
2. The parameter is not set appropriately.
1. Set the appropriate threshold value either in the drill monitoring mode of the MACHINING-MONITORING display or on
Action the TOOL DATA display.
2. For parameter setting, contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
959 WORKPIECE COORDINATE ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The origin of the workpiece coordinate system does not lie on the axis of rotation of the table.
Cause

Review the settings on the WORK OFFSET display.

.
Action

d
ve
er
960 SUPERPOSIT CTRL ILLEGAL COMMAND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

s
The program section under the mode of superposition control contains an incompatible G-code.

re
Cause

ts
gh
Review the program.
Action

ri
ll
961 ILLEGAL COMMAND 5X RADIUS COMP. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

.A
1. A command was given which is incompatible with the current mode of tool radius compensation for 5-axis machining.

N
O
2. An arc having central angle of 180or larger was specified in a circular interpolation command (G2/G3) in the tool

TI
radius compensation mode for 5-axis machining.
Cause
16

A
3. A rotary axis was specified in a circular interpolation command (G2/G3) in the tool radius compensation mode for
R
04

5-axis machining.
PO
30

4. The 5-axis fairing function was specified in the tool radius compensation mode for 5-axis machining.
R

1. Cancel the tool radius compensation for 5-axis machining if the command in question (a G-code or T-code) must
o.

O
N

absolutely be given.
C
al

2. For the circular interpolation command (G2/G3) in the tool radius compensation mode for 5-axis machining, specify an
K

arc with the central angle of 180or larger by combining arcs which have the central angle smaller than 180.
ri

Action
ZA
Se

3. In the tool radius compensation mode for 5-axis machining, a rotary axis command cannot be specified in a circular
A

interpolation command (G2/G3).


IM

4. In the tool radius compensation mode for 5-axis machining, the 5-axis fairing function cannot be specified.
K

962 CANNOT USE 5X RADIUS COMP. (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
ZA

A command of tool radius compensation for five-axis machining has been designated under incompatible modal conditions.
A

Cause
M
YA

Check the modal conditions for compatibility with the tool radius compensation for five-axis machining to cancel all the
Action interlocking modes.
3
01

963 TURRET MIRROR IMAGE N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
)2

The optional mirror image function for the opposed turret is not provided.
Cause
(c
ht

Provide the NC unit with the mirror image option.


ig

Action
yr
op

964 DESIGNATED PNo NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I O (S) Red
C

When bit 0 of parameter F329 (operation on specification of an undefined SMC data number) is set to “1”:
Cause 1. An SMC data number outside the permissible range (0 to 20) was specified with G61.1P or G61.2P.
2. An undefined SMC data number was specified with G61.1P or G61.2P.
1. Specify an SMC data number within the permissible range (0 to 20).
Action
2. Specify a defined SMC data number.

3-149
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
965 DESIGNATED PNo NOT FOUND (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B L O (S) Blue
When bit 0 of parameter F329 (operation on specification of an undefined SMC data number) is set to “0”:
Cause 1. An SMC data number outside the permissible range (0 to 20) was specified with G61.1P or G61.2P.
2. An undefined SMC data number was specified with G61.1P or G61.2P.
1. Specify an SMC data number within the permissible range (0 to 20).
Action
2. Specify a defined SMC data number.
966 NO ORBIT MACHINING OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
G148 (orbit machining mode ON) was specified although the machine does not feature the orbit machining option.
Cause

Orbit machining is not possible with the machine since it does not feature the orbit machining option.

d.
Action

ve
er
967 ILLEGAL CMD IN ORBIT MACHINING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

s
re
1. In the orbit machining mode, a G code that is not allowed in the mode was specified.

ts
2. An axis other than the X- or Z-axis was specified in the orbit machining mode.

gh
3. In the block specifying G148 (orbit machining mode ON), another G code or an MSTB command was specified.
Cause

ri
4. In the block specifying G149 (orbit machining mode OFF), another G code or an MSTB command was specified.

ll
5. A tool change command was specified in the orbit machining mode.

.A
6. G148 was specified without setting parameter K242 (axis name of the spindle to be rotated in orbit machining).

N
1. Specify only the G codes that are allowed in orbit machining.

O
TI
2. Specify only the X- or Z-axis in orbit machining.
16

3. Specify a G148 command in a block without other commands. A


R
Action
04

4. Specify a G149 command in a block without other commands.


PO
30

5. Specify a tool change while the orbit machining mode is OFF.


R
o.

6. Set the axis name for the spindle to be rotated in orbit machining for parameter K242.
O
N

968 CANNOT USE ORBIT MACHINING (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
al

1. G148 (orbit machining mode ON) was specified in an operation mode where orbit machining is not allowed.
ri

ZA
Se

2. G148 was specified in the G17 or G19 plane.


A
IM

Cause 3. The current Y-axis position differs from the Y-axis coordinate of the center of rotation specified with G148.
4. G148 was specified in the second or subsequent control path.
K
ZA

5. G149 was specified in the orbit machining mode while G40 was not in the modal state.
1. Check the operation modes that allow orbit machining and cancel the operation modes where orbit machining is not
A
M

allowed.
YA

2. Specify G148 in the G18 plane.


Action
3. Move the Y-axis to the center of rotation before specifying G148.
3
01

4. Specify G148 in the first control path.


)2

5. Specify G149 while G40 is in a modal state.


(c

969 —— ( , , )
ht
ig

Cause ——
yr
op

Action ——
C

970 TOOL TIP CTRL PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The parameter settings on the composition of controlled axes for the following modes are not correct: tool tip point control,
Cause inclined-surface machining, tool radius compensation for five-axis machining, and workpiece placement error correction.

Correct the parameter settings concerned.


Action

3-150
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
971 CANNOT USE TOOL TIP PT CONTROL (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. A command of tool tip point control is given under incompatible modal conditions.
2. A G43.5 command is given in spite of the selection of the workpiece coordinate system for programming.

Cause 3. Under selection of the G-code system for turning machines, a command of tool tip point control is given with the
parameter setting “F161 bit 1 = 0 (Geometric offset by logically shifting the coordinate system).”
4. A command of circular interpolation is given under the mode of G43.5 or with the table coordinate system selected for
programming.
1. Check the current modal conditions and cancel the unsuitable mode.
2. Use the other preparatory function G43.4, or select the table coordinate system for programming.
Action
3. Set F161 bit 1 to “1” (Geometric offset by physically shifting the tool).
4. To use circular interpolation, give a G43.4 command, or select the workpiece coordinate system for programming.

. d
ve
972 ILLEGAL CMD TOOL TIP PT CTRL (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
An unavailable command (of preparatory or tool function) is given in the mode of tool tip point control.
Cause

s
re
ts
Cancel the mode of tool tip point control to give the required command with G- or T-code.
Action

gh
ri
973 ILLEGAL TOOL AXIS VECTOR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
A command that causes an incorrect tool axial direction vector was specified in the tool center point control or cutting point

.A
command mode.

N
1. In the mode of G43.4/G43.8 with single-axis interpolation selected, commands were specified in such a way that the

O
resulting tool path will not pass through the singular point although the sign of the angular position of the primary rotary

TI
Cause
16

axis is to be reversed. A
R
04

2. The command of the vector of tool axis is not correct (as it will reverse the direction of the tool).
PO

3. With single-axis interpolation selected, the command in a single block will cause a motion through more than 180° on
30

the rotary axis of linear type.


R
o.

1. Modify the program for a tool path through the singular point, or select joint interpolation.
N

2. Divide the command block concerned in order that the resulting rotation of the tool direction per block will not exceed
al

Action 180°.
ri

ZA
Se

3. Modify the program for a per-block motion angle of 180° or less on the rotary axis of linear type, or select joint inter-
A

polation.
IM

974 TOOL TIP PT CTRL FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
K

1. Arguments I, J, and K are specified in the mode of G43.4, or a command of rotary axis motion is given under G43.5.
ZA

2. The code G49 is given in a block with other commands.


A

Cause 3. A rotary axis is specified in the mode of circular interpolation.


M

4. Under the modal condition of G43.4 or G43.5, an axis address other than those for the five controlled axes concerned
YA

(as specified in parameters K114, K115, K116, K121, and K125) was used in a motion command block.
3

1. The attitude of the tool cannot be specified with I, J, and K in the G43.4 mode, nor can a rotary axis be explicitly
01

specified in the G43.5 mode.


)2

2. Give the cancellation command G49 in a single-command block.


Action
(c

3. A rotary axis cannot be specified in the mode of circular interpolation.


ht

4. Do not use an axis address other than those for the five controlled axes concerned (as specified in parameters K114,
ig

K115, K116, K121, and K125) in a motion command block under the modal condition of G43.4 or G43.5.
yr

975 TOOL TIP PT CTRL N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
op

The optional function for tool tip point control is not provided.
C

Cause

The program with a command for tool tip point control can only be executed on a correspondingly executed machine.
Action

3-151
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
976 ILLEGAL COMMAND IN G124 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. A command prohibited in the parallel axes composite control was specified.
Cause 2. A command for the parallel axis was specified during the parallel axes composite control.
3. Measurement was attempted during the parallel axes composite control
1. Specify only the commands that are permitted in parallel axes composite control.
Action 2. Do not specify commands for the parallel axes during parallel axes composite control.
3. Do not carry out measurement during parallel axes composite control.
977 CANNOT USE G124/G125 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. Another G code was specified together with G124/G125 in the same block.
Cause
2. G124 was specified in a mode in which parallel axes composite control is not permitted.

d.
1. Specify G124/G125 in a block without other commands.

ve
Action
2. In the parallel axes composition control mode, check other selected modes and cancel those that cannot be used.

s er
978 G124/G125 PARAMETER ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

re
G124/G125 was specified while the parallel axes composite control function was disabled.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Parallel axes composite control cannot be used since the parallel axes composite control function option is not featured.
Action

ll
.A
979 MACRO USER ALARM ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

N
O
#3000 = n (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed. n  21
Cause

TI
16

A
Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
R
04

Action
PO
30

980 MACRO USER ALARM 1 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


o.

O
N

#3000 = 1 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Se

Action
A
IM

981 MACRO USER ALARM 2 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


K

#3000 = 2 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


ZA

Cause
A
M

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action
YA

982 MACRO USER ALARM 3 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


3
01

#3000 = 3 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


)2

Cause
(c

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
ht

Action
ig
yr

983 MACRO USER ALARM 4 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


op

#3000 = 4 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


C

Cause

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

984 MACRO USER ALARM 5 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


#3000 = 5 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

3-152
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
985 MACRO USER ALARM 6 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
#3000 = 6 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

986 MACRO USER ALARM 7 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


#3000 = 7 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

d.
ve
987 MACRO USER ALARM 8 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
#3000 = 8 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.

s
Cause

re
ts
Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.

gh
Action

ri
988 MACRO USER ALARM 9 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
#3000 = 9 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

N
O
Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

989 MACRO USER ALARM 10 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


PO
30

#3000 = 10 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
al

Action
ri

ZA
Se

990 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 1 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A
IM

1. During execution of the coordinate measurement program, the touch sensor did not come into contact with the
workpiece (the skip signal has not turned on) when the maximum feed distance permitted for the skipping speed has
K

been exceeded.
ZA

Cause
2. During execution of the tool measurement program, the tool did not come into contact with the measuring table (the
A

skip signal did not turn on) when the maximum feed distance permitted for the skipping speed has been exceeded.
M

3. #3000 = 11 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


YA

1. Check the machining program.


3

Action 2. Check the tool measurement program.


01

3. Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
)2

991 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 2 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


(c

1. During execution of the coordinate measurement program, the touch sensor came into contact with the workpiece (the
ht

skip signal turned on) when the axes were being fed at other than the skipping speed.
ig

Cause 2. During execution of the tool measurement program, the tool came into contact with the measuring table (the skip signal
yr

turned on) when the axes were being fed at other than the skipping speed.
op

3. #3000 = 12 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


C

1. Check the machining program. Also check the touch sensor for proper mounting on the spindle.
Action 2. Check the tool measurement program. Also check that the tools are correctly mounted on the turret.
3. Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.

3-153
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
992 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 3 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
1. Correct signals were not output due to an error in the coordinate measurement program for the touch sensor, receiver,
etc.
Cause
2. #3000 = 13 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
3. An attempt has been made to perform MDI-MMS with the head not in its horizontal or vertical machining position.
1. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
Action 2. Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
3. MDI-MMS is possible only with the head in its horizontal or vertical machining position.
993 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 4 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
#3000 = 14 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

.
d
ve
Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.

er
Action

s
re
994 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 5 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ts
#3000 = 15 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.

gh
Cause

ri
ll
Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

.A
N
995 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 6 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

O
TI
#3000 = 16 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause
16

A
R
04

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
PO
30

Action
R
o.

996 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 7 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


N

1. #3000 = 17 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


al

K
ri

Cause
ZA

2. In a coordinate measurement unit (plane inclination C measurement), the C-axis inclination angle of the measurement
Se

plane is greater than the value set for parameter K221 (maximum C-axis angle variation).
A

1. Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
IM

Action 2. Check that the touch sensor is in contact with the measurement plane during measurement. In addition, review the
K

value set for parameter K221 (maximum C-axis angle variation).


ZA

997 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 8 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


A

1. #3000 = 18 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


M

Cause
YA

2. The number of measurements in a coordinate measurement unit (plane inclination C measurement) has exceeded the
value set for K222 (number of re-measurements).
3

1. Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
01

Action 2. Check that the touch sensor is in contact with the measurement plane during measurement. In addition, review the
)2

value set for parameter K223 (permissible difference for skip coordinates X).
(c

998 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 9 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


ht
ig

#3000 = 19 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.


Cause
yr
op

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
C

Action

999 MACRO MEASUREMENT ALARM 10 ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


#3000 = 20 (alarm message) in the user macroprogram was executed.
Cause

Refer to the relevant user macroprogram instruction manual to check the alarm.
Action

3-154
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1900 2 CHARACTER AXIS ILLEGAL FORMAT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I P Red
An axis assigned with a 2-character axis name was specified with an illegal G code.
Cause

Review the program.


Action

1901 ILLEGAL ABSOLUTE AXIS NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I N Red


Parameter setting is incorrect for an axis assigned with a 2-character axis name.
Cause

Review the parameter setting.


Action

d .
ve
1902 ILLEGAL INCREMENT AXIS NAME (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I N Red

er
Parameter setting is incorrect for an axis assigned with a 2-character axis name.

s
Cause

re
ts
Review the parameter setting.
Action

gh
ri
1903 NO INVOLUTE OPTION (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
G02.2 or G03.2 was specified while the machine was not equipped with the involute interpolation option.
Cause

N
O
Review the program.

TI
Action
16

Or, purchase the relevant option. A


R
04

1904 ILLEGAL CMD DURING G2.2/G3.2 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

In the involute interpolation mode, an unusable command was specified.


Cause
R
o.

O
N

Cancel involute interpolation before specifying a command that cannot be used in the involute interpolation mode.
al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

1905 THIS MODE CANNOT CMD G2.2/G3.2 (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
A
IM

An involute command was specified in a modal status in which involute commands cannot be used.
Cause
K
ZA

Before specifying an involute command, check other selected modes and cancel those that cannot be used.
Action
A
M

1906 G2.2/G3.2 FORMAT ERROR (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
YA

1. Any of the addresses I, J, K and R is omitted.


3

2. 0 was specified for all addresses I, J and K.


01

Cause
3. 0 was specified for address R.
)2

4. An address I, J or K other than for the selected plane was specified.


(c

Review the program.


ht

Action
ig
yr

1907 5AXIS PARAM SELECT N/A (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
op

A 5-axis configuration parameter selection command (M641/M642) was specified although the machine was not equipped
Cause
C

with the 5-axis machining multiple axis sets selection function option.

5-axis configuration parameter selection commands (M641/M642) cannot be executed because the machine is not
Action equipped with the 5-axis machining multiple axis sets selection function option.

1908 CANNOT USE 5AXIS PARAM SELECT (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B K (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
1. A 5-axis configuration parameter selection command (M641/M642) was specified during 5-axis control.
Cause
2. A value other than from 1 to 3 is set for K113 or K225.
1. Specify 5-axis configuration parameter selection commands (M641/M642) while not in 5-axis control.
Action
2. Set a value from 1 to 3 for K113 and K225.

3-155
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
1909 SAFETY SHIELD SYNC FAILURE ( , , ) B I O Red
An M code for canceling the disabled status of the automatic operation safety shield is specified at a position where
Cause synchronization for the interference check function of the automatic operation safety shield cannot be executed properly.

Review the program and change the position of the M code for canceling the disabled status of the automatic operation
Action safety shield.

1910 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

d.
ve
1911 ENGRAVING N/A (WNo.,NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

er
An attempt was made to execute a program although the engraving function option was not featured.

s
Cause

re
ts
Purchase the engraving function option.
Action

gh
ri
1912 CANNOT USE ENGRAVING (WNo.,NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)

ll
.A
An engraving command was specified in the mode in which the engraving function cannot be executed.
Cause

N
O
Check the modes selected while executing the engraving function and cancel those that cannot be used.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

1913 ILLEGAL ARC RADIUS OF ENGRAVING (WNo.,NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
PO
30

The text string contains an arc whose diameter is smaller than a half of the character height or smaller than the character
Cause
R

pitch.
o.

O
N

Specify the text string such that all the arcs have a diameter greater than a half of the character height and greater than the
Action
al

character pitch.
K
ri

ZA
Se

1914 TEXT HEIGHT INVALID OF ENGRAV. (WNo.,NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
A

No character height is specified.


IM

Cause
K

Set the character height parameter (F276) or specify the character height using address h with G140.
ZA

Action
A
M

1915 POS ADJUST OF G124 INCOMPLETE (WNo.,NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
YA

During parallel axes composite control, an attempt was made to move the fundamental axis using a command other than
Cause G00/G01 while the position adjustment had not completed.
3
01

Use G00/G01 to move the fundamental axis after specifying G124.


)2

Action
(c

1916 HOB AXIS PARAMETER ERROR ( , , ) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)


ht

Hobbing (G114.3) was specified with parameter K259 bit 0 set to 1 (hobbing: axis configuration discrimination function
ig

enabled) and in any of the following statuses.


yr
op

 The axis set for parameter BA54 (hobbing: workpiece axis) does not exist in the first control path.
C

Cause  The axis set for parameter BA54 (hobbing: workpiece axis) is not a rotary axis.
 The axis set for parameter BA54 (hobbing: workpiece axis) does not match the axis set for either K121 (first rotary
axis) or K125 (second rotary axis).
 Any of the axes set for K114, K115 and K116 does not exist in the first control path.
Review the parameter settings.
Action

3-156
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
1917 ILLEGAL TOOL DATA CUT PT CTRL ( , , ) B J (L) P (S) Red (Blue)
1. When MAZATROL tool data are enabled, there are missing data for a barrel tool in the MAZATROL tool data.
 For a tool whose tool type is set to BARREL (TYPE1), any of LENGTH, ACT-1, R1 and R2 is blank or “0”.
 For a tool whose tool type is set to BARREL (TYPE2), any of LENGTH, ACT-1, R1, R2, TEETH LG and ACT-2 is
blank or “0”.
 For a tool whose tool type is set to BARREL (TYPE3), any of LENGTH, ACT-1, R1, R2, TEETH LG and R
HEIGHT is blank or “0”.
2. When MAZATROL tool data are disabled and argument Q is specified for a cutting point command, there is a
Cause
parameter or tool offset that is not set (0).
 When Q1 is specified, F306, F307 or F308 is not set (0).
 When Q2 is specified, F306, F307, F308, F309 or F310 is not set (0).

. d
 When Q3 is specified, F306, F307, F308, F309 or F311 is not set (0).

ve
 When Q1 to Q3 is specified, the tool length offset is not set (0).

er
3. The shape of the barrel tool cannot be generated from the offset settings (ACT-1, R1, R2, TEETH LG, ACT-2, R

s
re
HEIGHT).

ts
1. Set values for MAZATROL tool data that are blank or “0”.

gh
Action 2. Set values for the parameters and tool offsets that are not set (0).

ri
3. Review the tool data or parameters.

ll
( , , )

.A
N
Cause

O
TI
16

Action A
R
04

PO
30

1991 NOT POSSIBLE CROSS MACHINING (WNo., NNo., Cause) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
R

During the tool path check, the system in which the crossing command was set and/or the remote system for which the
o.

crossing command was to be executed has been set to the following status:
N

1: The specified axis does not exist in the remote system.


al

K
ri

ZA

2: The local system is specified as the system for which the crossing command was to be executed.
Cause
Se

4: A crossing control command is set for the axis currently undergoing the crossing command.
A
IM

16: The G110 command is set when the local system/remote system is in the modal environment that does not allow
crossing control.
K

32: The crossing control command is set under the prohibited status of recalculation.
ZA

Review and correct the program.


A

Action
M
YA

1992 ILLEGAL AXES QTY. FOR CROSS (WNo., NNo., BNo.) B I (L) O (S) Red (Blue)
The number of axes in the remote system became zero during the tool path check when the crossing command was
3

Cause
01

executed.
)2

Review and correct the program.


Action
(c
ht

( , , )
ig
yr

Cause
op
C

Action

3-157
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-11 No. 2000 - No. 2099 (3D setup error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2001 CAD FILE FORMAT ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
Loading an incorrect CAD file has been attempted.
Cause

Load the correct CAD file.


Action

( , , )

Cause

d .
ve
Action

s er
2028 ILLEGAL WORKPIECE DIMENSION ( , , ) A L S Blue

re
Incorrect dimensions have been entered in the material database or there are sections in which dimensions are missing.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Enter the correct dimensions.
Action

ll
.A
2029 ILLEGAL FIXTURE DIMENSION ( , , ) A L S Blue

N
O
Incorrect dimensions have been entered in the fixture database or there are sections in which dimensions are missing.
Cause

TI
16

Enter the correct dimensions.


A
R
04

Action
PO
30

2030 CANNOT REGISTER (NUMBERS FULL) ( , , ) A L S Blue


o.

O
N

Despite 9999 sets of data already existing, registering further data has been attempted.
C

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Up to 9999 sets of data can be registered. Delete unnecessary data to register desired one.
Se

Action
A
IM

2031 SELECT REGISTERED DATA ( , , ) A L S Blue


K

Adding (copying) data has been attempted without selecting source data when editing the material database or the fixture
ZA

Cause database.
A
M

Select source data before adding (copying) data.


Action
YA

2032 SELECT DATA TO CHANGE ( , , ) A L S Blue


3
01

Changing data has been attempted without selecting source data when editing the material database or the fixture
Cause
)2

database.
(c

Review the machining program.


ht

Action
ig
yr

2033 SELECT DATA TO DELETE ( , , ) A L S Blue


op

Deleting data has been attempted without selecting source data when editing the material database or the fixture
Cause
C

database.

Select data before deleting the data.


Action

2034 CANNOT ADD WORKPCE MATERIAL ( , , ) A L S Blue


Adding data to the material database has been attempted when an existing number was selected.
Cause

Specify a new number to add data.


Action

3-158
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2035 CANNOT ADD FIXTURE ( , , ) A L S Blue
Adding data to the fixture database has been attempted when an existing number was selected.
Cause

Specify a new number to add data.


Action

2036 SURFACE SELECTION ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


Selecting the shape surface to be moved or disposed has been attempted during surface matching when a shape was not
Cause selected.

Select the shapes to be surface-matched.


Action

d .
ve
2037 DATA NOT REGISTERED ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
Adding (copying) data or deleting data has been attempted when no data was present in the material database or the

s
Cause fixture database.

re
ts
Add new data.
Action

gh
ri
2038 FILE WITH SAME NAME EXISTS ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
The file name that has been entered during the name changing or copying process of model management is the same as
Cause the selected file name.

N
O
Enter a file name different from the selected file name.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

2039 FILE NAME TOO LONG ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

Too long a file name has been entered during the model saving, renaming, or copying process of material model
Cause
R

management or fixture model management.


o.

O
N

Enter a file name in less than 256 characters.


al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

2040 WRITING ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

The model saving process of material model management or fixture model management has failed.
Cause
K
ZA

Confirm the capacity of the HDD and save the model properly.
Action
A
M

( , , )
YA

Cause
3
01
)2

Action
(c

2049 NUMBER OF JAWS = 0 ( , , ) A L S Blue


ht
ig

Displaying jaws has been attempted when the number of jaws was zero.
Cause
yr
op

Specify one to nine jaws.


C

Action

2050 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

3-159
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2051 MODEL SELECTION ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue
Parallel move surface matching, X-axis rotation surface matching, Y-axis rotation surface matching, or Z-axis rotation
Cause surface matching has been attempted when the shape to be moved or the surface of the shape to be moved was not
selected.
Select the shape to be moved.
Action

2052 MODEL SELECTION ERROR ( , , ) A L S Blue


Parallel move surface matching, X-axis rotation surface matching, Y-axis rotation surface matching, or Z-axis rotation
Cause surface matching has been attempted when the shape to be disposed or the surface of the shape to be disposed was not
selected.
Select the shape to be disposed.

.
Action

d
ve
er
2053 ILLEGAL SURFACE TYPE ( , , ) A L S Blue

s
Parallel move surface matching, X-axis rotation surface matching, Y-axis rotation surface matching, or Z-axis rotation

re
Cause surface matching has been attempted when a surface other than a plane or cylindrical surface was selected.

ts
gh
Select a plane or a cylindrical surface.
Action

ri
ll
2054 ILLEGAL SURFACE ORIENTATION ( , , ) A L S Blue

.A
Parallel move surface matching has been attempted when surfaces that are not parallel were selected.

N
Cause X-axis rotation surface matching, Y-axis rotation surface matching, or Z-axis rotation surface matching has been attempted

O
when a surface perpendicular to the rotational axis was selected.

TI
16

Action
Select surfaces whose relationship in position is correct. A
R
04

PO
30

2055 NO PARALLEL PLANE ( , , ) A L S Blue


R
o.

The parallel surfaces to be moved in parallel for surface matching do not exist.
N

Cause
C
al

K
ri

Parallel moving cannot be executed without parallel surfaces.


ZA

Action
Se

A
IM

2056 ILLEGAL FILE NAME ( , , ) A L S Blue


Illegal characters or symbols are included in the file name.
K

Cause
ZA
A

Enter the characters and symbols that can be used in the file name.
Action
M
YA

2057 NUMBER ALREADY REGISTERED ( , , ) A L S Blue


3

A registered number has been designated during database registration.


01

Cause
)2

Designate a new number.


(c

Action
ht
ig

( , , )
yr
op

Cause
C

Action

2061 WORK MATL. LARGER THAN BARRIER ( , , ) A L S Blue


The specified parametric model or CAD model is outside the workpiece information of the common unit.
Cause

Dispose the parametric model or the CAD model so as to stay internally to the workpiece information.
Action Even if the model is outside the information, the specification itself of that model is possible.

3-160
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2062 FIXTURE LARGER THAN BARRIER ( , , ) A L S Blue
The specified CAD model is outside the jaw shape based on the setup information.
Cause

Dispose the CAD model so as to stay internally to the setup information.


Action Even if the model is outside the information, the specification itself of that model is possible.

2063 CANNOT MOVE MODEL ( , , ) A L S Blue


It is not possible to manually dispose a material model that has been created from the workpiece information, or a fixture
Cause model that has been created from setup information.

Modify the Z-offset or WPC-Z to move the material model.


Action Modify the settings of BA19 and BA20 to move the fixture model.

d .
ve
2064 —— ( , , )

ser
Cause ——

re
ts
Action ——

gh
ri
2065 NO 2ND SPINDLE ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
The menu for the secondary spindle was tapped although the machine does not have the secondary spindle.
Cause

N
O
The menu function for the secondary spindle should be used only on the machine equipped with the secondary spindle.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

2066 CANNOT CHANGE MATERIAL ORDER ( , , ) A L S Blue


PO
30

Material order change to an illegal position was attempted.


Cause
R
o.

O
N

Review the target position for the material order change.


al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

2067 ILLEGAL BOOLEAN OPERATION ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
IM

The calculation result of the combined material is illegal.


The following shows the possible causes.
K

 The material is intricately separated into multiple pieces.


ZA

Cause  Cavities will be generated inside the geometry.


A

 The material will vanish as the result of calculation.


M
YA

 Models are in contact to each other (non-manifold geometry).


 The CAD model contains an illegal geometry.
3
01

Review the combined material.


Action
)2
(c

( , , )
ht
ig

Cause
yr
op

Action
C

2074 CANNOT CHANGE TABLE AXIS ( , , ) A L S Blue


An attempt was made to change the rotary axis of the table of a table whose rotary axis cannot be changed.
Cause

Change the table rotary axis while the additional table is selected.
Action

3-161
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2075 SETUP DATA DO NOT MATCH ( , , ) A L S Blue
When a saved program was input to a machine that has a different axis configuration, an arrangement of material and
Cause fixture models that the axis configuration of the machine does not allow such a setup was detected.

Change the setup data setting for the axis configuration of the machine to input the data to before inputting/outputting the
Action data.

2076 CANNOT SELECT FEATURE POINT ( , , ) A L S Blue


Selection of feature points failed due to any of the following causes.
 There is no reference point. (reference point selection)
Cause  No material/fixture geometry is arranged. (geometric feature point selection)
 Grids cannot be displayed. (grid selection)

d .
ve
 A type of feature point that cannot be selected is specified.

er
Review the setting for feature points to be selected. Check also that the selectable type of feature point is specified.
Action

s
re
ts
2077 SELECT SET FEATURE POINT ( , , ) A L S Blue

gh
The setting target of feature point data is not selected.
Cause

ri
ll
Select the target for setting the feature point data.

.A
Action

N
O
2078 CANNOT ADD BASE POINT ( , , ) A L S Blue

TI
16

Addition of a reference point failed due to any of the following causes.


A
R

04

Cause A reference point with the same name already exists.


PO
30

 The coordinate value for the reference point is illegal.


R

Review the input values.


o.

Action
N

C
al

2079 ILLEGAL GRID VIEW SETTING ( , , ) A L S Blue


ri

ZA
Se

Data input for grid display settings are illegal.


Cause
A
IM

Review the input values.


Action
K
ZA

2080 ILLEGAL WORK OFFSET SETTING ( , , ) A L S Blue


A
M

The following shows the possible causes for the workpiece offset write error.
YA

 Feature points are not selected.


Cause
 The workpiece offset value to be written is illegal.
3
01

 The WRITE button was tapped without tapping the SET button.
)2

Review the procedure for writing the data and the data to be set.
Action
(c
ht

( , , )
ig
yr

Cause
op
C

Action

2084 CANNOT CHANGE ASSEMBLE ( , , ) A L S Blue


A combination order change to an illegal position was attempted.
Cause

Review the target position for the combination order change.


Action

3-162
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2085 CANNOT SELECT PLANE ( , , ) A L S Blue
A menu item for plane selection was tapped with no selectable material/fixture geometry arranged.
Cause

Select a plane with material/fixture geometries arranged.


Action

2086 SELECT ROTATE AXIS ( , , ) A L S Blue


A menu item for angle measurement was tapped with no rotary axis selected.
Cause

Select the rotary axis before performing angle measurement.


Action

.d
ve
2087 CANNOT CONVERT WORKPCE ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
1. [WORKPCE CAD FILECONVERT] was tapped during operation.

s
Cause

re
2. [WORKPCE CAD FILECONVERT] was tapped with parametric material set.

ts
1. Perform material model conversion after completing the operation.
Action

gh
2. Material model conversion is not required for parametric material.

ri
2088 WORKPCE CONVERTING ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
[SELECT WORKPIECE MATERIAL] or [LOCATE MANUALLY] for changing material settings was tapped during material
Cause model conversion.

N
O
When changing material settings, perform the operation after completing material model conversion.

TI
Action
16

A
R
04

( , , )
PO
30

Cause
R
o.

O
N

C
al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-163
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-12 No. 2100 - No. 2199 (Interference error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2100 MACN INTRF (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue
Execution of the machining program results in the interference occurring between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering
Cause section 2>.

Review and correct the program.


Action

2101 NEAR MISS (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue


Execution of the machining program results in <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering section 2> being present within the
Cause specified interference distance.

d .
Review and correct the program.

ve
Action

s er
2102 WORK INTRF (WNo., UNo., SNo.) A L S Blue

re
Execution of the machining program results in the interference occurring between <Interfering section 1> and <Interfering

ts
Cause section 2>.

gh
ri
Review and correct the program.
Action

ll
.A
( , , )

N
O
Cause

TI
16

A
R
04

Action
PO
30

2110 ILLEGAL FORMAT ( , , ) A L S Blue


o.

O
N

The entered data is incorrect.


Cause
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

Review the range of the data to be entered.


Action
A
IM

2111 NO SOLID CHECK IN AUTO OPER ( , , ) A L S Blue


K

Execution of Virtual Machining has been attempted during automatic operation of the NEXUS machine.
ZA

Cause
A
M

Terminate automatic operation before executing Virtual Machining.


Action
YA

2112 Z-OFFSET NOT FOUND (WNo., , ) B L S Blue


3
01

A Z-offset is not set in the program of Z-offset scheme.


)2

Cause
(c

Set the Z-offset.


ht

Action
ig
yr

2113 JAW NO NOT FOUND (WNo., , ) B L S Blue


op

Jaw No. is not set.


Cause
C

Set Jaw No.


Action

( , , )

Cause

Action

3-164
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2120 RESTART PT SEARCH INTERRUPTED ( , , ) A L S Blue
The restart position search function has been aborted.
Cause

Action

2121 RESTART POINT NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


The restarting point is not found.
Cause

Review the restrictions on the restart or review the machining program itself.
Action

d .
ve
( , , )

ser
Cause

re
ts
gh
Action

ri
2130 CANNOT CHECK WORKPIECE MODEL ( , , ) A L S Blue

ll
.A
1. Lack of available memory space

N
2. Arithmetical incapability

O
3. Entered data imperfections
Cause

TI
4. A program containing a chain from a MULTIPLEX program to a non-MULTIPLEX program has been checked in the
16

solid mode.
A
R
04

PO

(Only for MULTIPLEX series)


30

1. Divide the program.


R
o.

2. Confirm parameters.
N

Action
C

3. Confirm tool data.


al

4. Review the program.


ri

ZA
Se

( , , )
A
IM

Cause
K
ZA

Action
A
M

2140 CANNOT DISPLAY MACHINE MODEL ( , , ) A L S Blue


YA

1. Lack of available memory space


3

Cause 2. Arithmetical incapability


01

3. The machine model file is missing.


)2

1. Divide the program.


(c

Action 2. Confirm parameters.


ht

3. Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


ig
yr

( , , )
op

Cause
C

Action

2150 CANNOT DISPLAY TOOL MODEL ( , , ) A L S Blue


The shape cannot be created since the entered tool data is insufficient or incorrect.
Cause

Review and correct the tool data.


Action

3-165
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2151 CANNOT DISPLAY T/S CENTER ( , , ) A L S Blue
The shape cannot be created since the entered machine parameters on the tailstock shape are incorrect.
Cause

Modify the data settings of machine parameters BA12 to BA14.


Action

( , , )

Cause

Action

d .
ve
2160 ILLEGAL CYCLE START ( , , ) A I S Blue

er
The file “C:\ymw\M8Y\data\MC_Machine DataBase\lisp” is corrupted.

s
Cause

re
ts
The software needs to be reinstalled.

gh
Action
Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

ri
( , , )

ll
.A
Cause

N
O
TI
Action
16

A
R
04

2190 NO MACHINE MODEL ( , , ) B L N Blue


PO
30

A machine model is not registered.


R

Cause
o.

O
N

Register a machine model and then turn power back on.


al

Action
K
ri

ZA
Se

2191 CANNOT SELECT CHECK UNITS ( , , ) B L Q Blue


A
IM

In spite of the setting for a material piece to be mounted on the machine table, it was attempted to selectively turn off the
Cause function of checking for interference with respect to the material piece.
K
ZA

Clear the setup setting for the material piece in question beforehand.
Action
A
M

2192 CHECK UNITS SET ERROR ( , , ) B L Q Blue


YA

A machining program is searched for, or selected, for which a material piece is arranged in a position where the function of
Cause checking for interference is currently specified as being cancelled for the material piece.
3
01

Turn on the function of interference check for the material piece in the particular mounting position.
)2

Action
(c
ht

2193 —— ( , , )
ig

Cause ——
yr
op
C

Action ——

2194 CONVERTED WORKPCE DO NOT EXIST ( , , ) B L S Blue


There is no material model conversion data.
Cause

Tap [WORKPCE CAD FILECONVERT] on the 3D SETUP display to convert the material model.
Action

3-166
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2195 NEED CONVERT WORKPCE AGAIN ( , , ) B L S Blue
The material model has been updated after conversion.
Cause

Tap [WORKPCE CAD FILECONVERT] on the 3D SETUP display to convert the material model.
Action

( , , )

Cause

Action

d .
ve
ser
re
ts
gh
ri
ll
.A
N
O
TI
16

A
R
04

PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-167
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-13 No. 2200 - No. 2299 (CAM data output error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2201 READ-ONLY MEDIA ( , , ) G L S Blue
The external memory is write-protected.
Cause

Remove the write protection from it.


Action

2202 NETWORK LOGON FAILED ( , , ) A L S Blue


A user failed to log on to another PC when storing data on it.
Cause

d .
Check if the user in question is allowed to log on to the PC specified as the destination device.

ve
Action

s er
2203 NETWORK PATH NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue

re
The folder specified as the destination folder is not found on the network.

ts
Cause

gh
ri
Check again if the destination folder on the network is correctly specified.
Action

ll
.A
2204 HARDWARE NOT INSTALLED ( , , ) A L S Blue

N
The memory device is not inserted correctly.

O
Cause

TI
16

Insert the device correctly and make a retry. A


R
04

Action
PO
30

2205 CANNOT ACCESS FILE ( , , ) A L S Blue


R
o.

The user does not have the authority to access the PC specified.
N

Cause
al

K
ri

ZA

Check if the user in question has the authority to access the PC specified.
Se

Action
A
IM

2206 FILE CONFIGURATION ERROR ( , , ) E L S Blue


The file is not found or it is corrupted.
K

Cause
ZA
A

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


M

Action
YA

2207 CANNOT ACCESS CNC ( , , ) E L S Blue


3

A communication error occurred between the NC and the PC.


01

Cause
)2

Check if NC displays can be smoothly switched from one to another.


(c

If this alarm is displayed again after the NC has been turned off and back on, check what operation was performed when
ht

Action
the error occurred and also the value displayed in ( , , ), and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or
ig

Technology Center.
yr

2208 MACHINE DATA TRANSFER ERROR ( , , ) E L S Blue


op
C

An error occurred while machine data was being transferred.


Cause

Make a retry.
Action If this alarm is displayed again after a retry, check what operation was carried out when the error was occurred and also the
value displayed in ( , , ), and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

3-168
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2209 CANNOT SAVE MACHINE DATA (Note, , ) G L S Blue
Note :

Cause Sub error codes related to the storage of machine data


300 to 399: Error in storing data on the destination device caused by lack of storage space
400 to 499: Error in extracting or compressing machine data
For sub error codes of 300’s:
Check if there is enough free space in the memory device, and if the device is correctly recognized.
For sub error codes of 400’s:
Action
Check if there is enough free space on the hard disk and make a retry if there is no problem.
If this alarm is displayed again after a retry, check what operation was carried out when the error was occurred and also the
value displayed in ( , , ), and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.

.
2210 INVALID DRIVE SPECIFIED ( , , ) E L S Blue

d
ve
An invalid drive is specified.

er
Cause

s
re
Specify a drive available.
Action

ts
gh
2211 FILE SAVINGFAILURE ( , , ) G L S Blue

ri
A user failed to write data on the destination device specified.

ll
Cause

.A
N
Check if you have the authority to write data to the destination. If the authority is present, check the presence or absence of
Action

O
invalid folders or files, the free space left in the destination device, and if the device is correctly recognized.

TI
16

2212 FILE NOT FOUND ( , , A ) B L S Blue


R
04

Some are missing from the files to be saved as CAM machine data.
PO

Cause
30

R
o.

The data you want to copy may be corrupted.


O
N

Action If this alarm is displayed again after a retry, check what operation was carried out when the error was occurred and also the
C

value displayed in ( , , ), and then contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.
al

K
ri

ZA

( , , )
Se

Cause
IM
K

Action
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-169
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

3-2-14 No. 2600 - No. 2699 (CNC screen operation error)

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2600 —— ( , , )

Cause ——

Action ——

( , , )

Cause

d.
ve
Action

s er
2604 TAP SIZE OVER ( , , ) A L S Blue

re
The cutting power anticipated from the cutting conditions during tapping exceeds the threshold. Machining with these

ts
Cause conditions may cause the cutting power to exceed the spindle capacity. (This alarm is only for warning and does not affect

gh
the program operation.)

ri
When carrying out machining with these conditions, carefully check safety before starting the machining.

ll
Action
Consider other machining methods.

.A
N
2605 —— ( , , )

O
TI
Cause ——
16

A
R
04

Action ——
PO
30

R
o.

O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

3-170
Serial No. 300416

ALARM 3
Type of Stopped Clearing
No. Message Display
error status procedure
2606 LICENSE IMPORT ERROR (No. , Type , ) A L S Blue
Importing of an add-on option license has failed.
No. Cause
-1 No folder path is specified in the license file import window.
-2 There is no license file in the folder specified in the license file import window.
-3 There is no license file that matches the serial number of the machine in the folder specified in the license
file import window.
-4 An incorrect license file that contains the license code for a machine different from the one used to import
the license has been read.
Cause -5 An incorrect license file that contains a license code for an option number other than Y-1 to Y-80 has been
read.

d .
-6 Analysis of the license code written in the license file has failed.

ve
er
-7 Reading of the license code written in the license file has failed.

s
re
ts
The “type” field indicates the type of the license file read.

gh
Type Cause

ri
1 Machine serial number license

ll
.A
Take the following countermeasures.

N
No. Action

O
-1 Specify the path to the folder that contains the license file matching the serial number of the machine in the

TI
license file import window.
16

-2
A
Check the location of the folder that contains the license file matching the serial number of the machine
R
04

PO

-3 and specify the path to the folder in the license file import window.
30

Action
R

-4
o.

O
N

-5
C

Contact the nearest Mazak Technical Center or Technology Center.


al

-6
ri

ZA
Se

-7
A
IM

2607 —— ( , , )
K

Cause ——
ZA
A
M

Action ——
YA

2608 —— ( , , )
3
01

Cause ——
)2
(c

Action ——
ht
ig

2609 MEMORY PROTECT (TRIAL MODE) ( , , ) A L S Blue


yr

An attempt was made to change the trial mode setting while the trial mode was enabled.
op

Cause
C

Disable the trial mode before changing the setting.


Action

2610 TOOL DATA MEASURING ( , , ) A L S Blue


TOOL EYE measurement was attempted on the TOOL OFFSET screen while TOOL EYE measurement initiated from the
Cause TOOL DATA screen was in progress.

End the TOOL EYE measurement initiated from the TOOL DATA screen.
Action

3-171
Serial No. 300416

3 ALARM

Type of Stopped Clearing


No. Message Display
error status procedure
2611 TOOL OFFSET MEASURING ( , , ) A L S Blue
TOOL EYE measurement was attempted on the TOOL DATA screen while TOOL EYE measurement initiated from the
Cause TOOL OFFSET screen was in progress.

End the TOOL EYE measurement initiated from the TOOL OFFSET screen.
Action

2612 DESIGNATED TOOL NOT FOUND (WNo., UNo, SNo.) A L S Blue


A non-registered tool was found in the required tool list in the tooling mode.
Cause

Register the tool data.


Action

d .
ve
2613 ILLEGAL PROGRAM AREA ( , , ) A L S Blue

er
When the project function was enabled (parameter US1 bit 5 = 1), the work number in other than the standard operation
Cause

s
area was specified for WORK No. in the end unit of a MAZATROL program in the WORK No. SELECT window.

re
Work numbers in other than the standard operation area cannot be specified. Select a work number in the standard

ts
Action operation area.

gh
ri
2614 PROGRAM STOP WHILE WAITING (Head No., , ) A L S Blue

ll
With opposed-spindle lathes (MULTIPLEX), the cursor sometimes fails to move to the correct restarting position in the

.A
smooth restart function when the program is stopped in a queuing state between systems in a composite program.

N
Head No. Cause

O
Cause

TI
1 Program stop while head 1 is in the queuing state
16

2 Program stop while head 2 is in the queuing state A


R
04

PO

The correct restarting position may have not been selected in the stop position search. Specify the correct position
30

Action manually.
R
o.

O
N

2615 PROJECT NOT FOUND ( , , ) A L S Blue


C
al

No project has been selected or a project that does not exist has been specified.
K

Cause
ri

ZA
Se

Delete unnecessary projects.


Action
IM
K

2616 MAX NUMBER OF PROJECTS EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


ZA

The number of registered projects has exceeded the maximum number of projects that can be registered.
Cause
A
M

Delete unnecessary projects.


YA

Action
3
01

2617 SAME PROJECT EXISTS ( , , ) A L S Blue


)2

The specified project name already exists.


Cause
(c
ht

Check the project name.


Action
ig
yr

2618 CANNOT DISPLAY CROSS SECTION ( , , ) A L S Blue


op

When reading a CAD model using the 3D ASSIST function, generation of a cross-section shape has failed.
C

Cause

It is not possible to display the cross-section shape of the specified CAD model. Review the CAD model.
Action

2619 ANALYZED DATA SIZE EXCEEDED ( , , ) A L S Blue


 An attempt was made to display QUICK EIA for a complicated machining shape.
Cause
 An attempt was made to analyze the program or NC commands for a completed machining shape.
Split the program to be displayed or analyzed and try the operation again.
Action

3-172 E
Serial No. 300416

M-CODE LIST 4
4 M-CODE LIST
M-code Function
M00 Programmed stop
Stops reading and execution of a program; the PROGRAM STOP in the CNC Signal window goes on.
At this time, the spindle will also stop rotating.
M01 Optional stop
When [OPTIONAL STOP] is selected (blue), a function similar to that of M00 will be performed.
M01 will be ignored when [OPTIONAL STOP] is deselected (white).
M02 End of program
Stops the spindle, coolant, air blast and oil mist. The NC functions are all reset and the machine stops.
Except in tape operation mode, a function similar to that of M30 is performed.

d.
M03 Spindle forward rotation

ve
Starts the spindle rotation in the forward direction.

s er
M04 Spindle reverse rotation

re
Starts the spindle rotation in the reverse direction.

ts
M05 Spindle stop

gh
Stops spindle rotation started by M03 or M04.

ri
M06 Tool change

ll
.A
Mounts the specified tool in the spindle and returns the tool of the spindle to the magazine.

N
If the next tool command is specified, the next tool is loaded from the magazine to the ATC arm.

O
Sample program:

TI
16

1. M06 T T A


 
R
04

PO

Specified tool Next tool


30

2. T;
R
o.

M06;
O
N

T
C

M06;
al

K
ri

ZA

Machining program
Se

3. M06 T
A
IM


Valid/invalid is selected by parameter setting. (Standard: Invalid)
K

M07 Mist coolant ON (Optional)


ZA

Starts the oil-mist coolant system.


A

M08 Flood coolant ON


M
YA

Starts the flood coolant system to discharge coolant from the nozzles.
M09 All coolant OFF
3
01

Turns off all coolant systems and air blast system.


It is not allowed to specify a coolant supply M-code preceding M09 in the same block.
)2

M10 Tool clamp


(c
ht

Clamps a tool.
ig

M11 Tool unclamp


yr

Unclamps a tool.
op

For this operation, the spindle must be stopped in the oriented position.
C

M17 Tool unload


Moves the ATC shifter to the magazine.
For this operation, the magazine must be indexed correctly.
M18 Tool load
Moves the ATC shifter to the spindle.
For this operation, the magazine must be indexed correctly.
M19 Spindle orientation
Stops the spindle in the oriented stop position (tool change angular position).

4-1
Serial No. 300416

4 M-CODE LIST

M-code Function
M23 Error detect ON
Selects the exact stop mode.
For details of the exact stop mode, refer to the Operating Manual for the NC unit.
M24 Error detect OFF
Cancels the M23 mode.
M30 Reset and rewind
Stops the machine similarly to M02, resets the function of the NC unit, and returns control to the beginning of
the program.
M33 Tool length measuring device extend (Optional)
Sets the tool length measuring device to the measurement position for tool breakage detection or tool length
measurement.

.
M34 Tool length measuring device retract (Optional)

d
ve
Returns the tool length measuring device to the standby position for tool breakage detection or tool length

er
measurement cycle.

s
M35 Tool breakage detection (Valid only for MAZATROL programs) (option)

re
Calls the tool breakage detection cycle.

ts
gh
In the first ATC cycle after the execution of the M35 command, the selected tool is checked for breakage. For
details of this function, refer to the Operating Manual of the NC unit.

ri
M42 Index table reverse rotation

ll
.A
Rotates the index table in reverse. Use this M-code with an argument B for indexing the table by a reverse
turn.

N
O
M46 4th axis table unclamp (Optional)

TI
Keeps the 4th-axis table unclamped. Use this M-code for contouring, for example, by continuous cutting feed
16

on the 4th axis. A


R
04

PO

M47 4th axis table clamp (Optional)


30

Clamps the 4th-axis table.


R
o.

M48 M49 cancel


N

Cancels the override cancel function which is specified by M49. In the M48 mode, the override function is
al

valid.
ri

ZA
Se

M49 Override cancel


A

Cancels the override function (for feed rate and spindle speed). Therefore, the machine operates with
IM

programmed data.
Note : When power is switched on or after emergency stop, the NC is (re)set in the M48 mode.
K
ZA

M50 Air blast ON (Optional)


A

Starts the air blast system.


M

To stop the air blast system, execute M09.


YA

M51 Through-spindle coolant ON (Optional)


3

Discharges coolant through the through-hole in the tool if oil-hole attachment is used.
01

To stop the air blast system, execute M09.


)2

M52 Tap coolant ON (Optional)


(c

Discharges tap coolant if the tap coolant unit is installed.


ht

To top the tap coolant, execute M09.


ig

M58 Tool life check


yr
op

Brings the machine to a single-block stop if an alarm is displayed to indicate that the life of the tool mounted
in the spindle has expired.
C

To continue the operation, tap the alarm clear button and then press the cycle start button.
M68 Pallet clamp
Clamps a pallet.
M69 Pallet unclamp
Unclamps a pallet.
M71 Pallet No. 1 selection
Selects pallet No. 1 for pallet change operation.
M72 Pallet No. 2 selection
Selects pallet No. 2 for pallet change operation.

4-2
Serial No. 300416

M-CODE LIST 4
M-code Function
M73 Pallet No. 3 selection (Optional)
Selects pallet No. 3 for pallet change operation (for the machine with 6PC).
M74 Pallet No. 4 selection (Optional)
Selects pallet No. 4 for pallet change operation (for the machine with 6PC).
M75 Pallet No. 5 selection (Optional)
Selects pallet No. 5 for pallet change operation (for the machine with 6PC).
M76 Pallet No. 6 selection (Optional)
Selects pallet No. 6 for pallet change operation (for the machine with 6PC).
M90 Mirror image cancel
Cancels the mirror image function called by M91, M92, or M93.
M91 X-axis mirror image ON

d .
Makes mirror image for the X-axis valid.

ve
When this function is active, axis motion direction is reversed for the X-axis.

er
M92 Y-axis mirror image ON

s
re
Makes mirror image for the Y-axis valid.

ts
When this function is active, axis motion direction is reversed for the Y-axis.

gh
M93 B-axis (4th) mirror image ON (Optional)

ri
Makes mirror image for the 4th axis valid.

ll
Reverses the sign (plus, minus) for the rotation amount of the table (4th axis).

.A
M98 Subprogram call

N
Calls a subprogram. For details of this function, refer to the Operating Manual for the NC.

O
TI
M99 Return to main program
16

A
Indicates the end of a subprogram. For details of this function, refer to the Operating Manual for the NC.
R
04

M119 Multi-point orientation (optional)


PO
30

Orients the spindle at the desired angular position when specified with an S code in the same block.
R
o.

It is specified in the format of “M119 S***”.


O
N

Note : “S***” specifies the angular position of the spindle in the range from 0 to 359 in 1 units.
al

M120 Automatic power shut-off


ri

ZA
Se

Shuts off the main power to the machine if the AUTO POWER OFF switch is set to the “ON” position.
A

M122 Gap eliminator ON (Optional)


IM

Selects the function to increase the rate of feed during air cutting by multiplying the programmed rate by the
K

parameter-set value to reduce the air cut time.


ZA

M123 Gap eliminator OFF (Optional)


A

When the power is switched on, the gap eliminator function is OFF.
M

This M-code is used to cancel the gap eliminator function selected by M122.
YA

M130 NIAGARA coolant ON (Optional)


3

Starts the NIAGARA coolant system if equipped.


01

M132 Through-spindle air ON (Optional)


)2

Discharges through-spindle air.


(c

M134 IN station pallet ID read (Optional)


ht

Reads the pallet data stored in the data carrier on the pallet placed at the IN station.
ig
yr

M137 IN station pallet ID write (Optional)


op

Writes the pallet data to the data carrier on the pallet placed at the IN station.
C

M138 OUT station pallet all ID data write (Optional)


Writes all the pallet data to the data carrier on the pallet placed at the OUT station.
M139 Heavy tool mode cancel
Cancels the heavy tool mode.
M140 Heavy tool mode designation
Designates the heavy tool mode.
M149 Magazine indexing
Indexes the magazine for the specified tool.
Give an M149 T command to select the tool No. .

4-3
Serial No. 300416

4 M-CODE LIST

M-code Function
M155 Thermal displacement compensation cancel
Stops updating of thermal displacement compensation.
The M155 mode is cancelled by resetting, M06 (tool change), or switching-off.
M160 M161, M162 cancel
Sets the spindle speed arrived completion level at 85% of the specified spindle speed.
M161 Spindle speed arrived setting at 70%
Sets the spindle speed arrived completion level at 70% of the specified spindle speed.
M162 Spindle speed arrived setting at 50%
Sets the spindle speed arrived completion level at 50% of the specified spindle speed.
M169 M170 cancel
Makes the AFC function valid. (AFC is usually valid.)

d .
M170 AFC cancel

ve
Cancels the AFC function.

er
M173 Dynamic offsetting ON (Optional)

s
re
Selects the dynamic offsetting function (for the NC rotary table).

ts
M174 M173 cancel

gh
Cancels the dynamic offsetting function.

ri
M178 Zero point return for the index table

ll
.A
Returns the index table to the 0° position.
M179 Zero point return for the magazine

N
O
Returns the magazine to the indexing reference position (for pocket No. 1).

TI
M180 M181 cancel
16

Cancels the function called out by M181.


A
R
04

PO

M181 Next tool indexing invalid


30

Neglects the next tool command in order to prevent an evil effect of the vibration associated with magazine or
o.

ATC shifter operation on the surface finish.


N

M195 Tool breakage detection ON (option)


al

K
ri

Executes a tool breakage detection cycle. This command is automatically specified right before the ATC
ZA
Se

cycle when M35 is entered in a MAZATROL program.


A

Usually, this command is not used by the customer.


IM

M196 Fully-automatic tool length measurement mode ON (Optional)


K

M197 Fully-automatic tool length measurement mode OFF (Optional)


ZA

After the execution of M196, automatic tool length measurement cycle (mounting the specified tool to the
A

spindle, measuring the tool’s length, and registering the measurement result) is carried out in response to
M

each T-code until the M196 mode is canceled by M197 or resetting. In this fully-automatic mode, it is not
YA

possible to measure the length of tools such as a face milling cutter which do not have their nose on the
center line. These M-codes are automatically outputted when “automatic tool measurement [T MSR AUTO]”
3

is selected in the MDI mode. M197 includes the retraction of the measuring device.
01

M198 Semi-automatic tool length measurement (Optional)


)2

In this mode, the length of the tool presently mounted in the spindle is measured. Since the measurement
(c

cycle starts from the present position, this cycle can be used to measure the length of tools which do not have
ht

their nose on the center line. This M-code is automatically outputted when “semi-automatic tool measurement
ig

[T MSR SEMI AUTO]” is selected in the MDI mode.


yr

M199 Fully-automatic tool length measurement (Optional)


op

In this mode, the length of the tool presently mounted in the spindle is measured.
C

M380 NIAGARA coolant on the spindle side ON


Starts NIAGARA coolant feed on the spindle side.
(Only with HCN-10800)
M381 NIAGARA coolant on the pallet changer side ON
Starts NIAGARA coolant feed on the pallet changer side.
(Only with HCN-10800)

4-4
Serial No. 300416

M-CODE LIST 4
Note 1: Simultaneous processing impossible M-codes
Up to 4 M-codes can be entered in one block. However, if M-codes which cannot be
processed simultaneously are entered in the same block, the following message is
displayed and operation is suspended.
227 SIMULTANEOUS M CODE OPERATION
This alarm occurs in the following cases:
 Any combination of M03, M04, M05 and M19
 M23 and M24 (opposing operation)
 M33 and M34 (opposing operation)
 M48 and M49 (opposing operation)

.
d
 M15 and M33 (opposing operation)

ve
er
 M06 and M149 (opposing operation)

s
re
 Any combination of M71 to M80 (for pallet changer specification)

ts
 M195 to M198, specified with other M-code

gh
Note 2: When entering more than one M-code in the same block, there is a restriction on entry

ri
order when entering M-codes related with coolant and air blast system (M09, M07,

ll
.A
M08, M50, M51, M52, M130, M131, M132, etc.).

N
An M-code starting the coolant system or air blast system must not be entered before

O
M09.

TI
16

A
To enter M08 before M09, for example, enter M08 in a block preceding the M09 block.
R
04

PO

M08, M09, M51, ...... 


30

M08
R
o.

M09, M51, ......


O
N

C
al

K
ri

ZA
Se

A
IM
K
ZA
A
M
YA
3
01
)2
(c
ht
ig
yr
op
C

4-5
4

C
op
M-CODE LIST

yr
ig
ht
(c
)2
01
3
YA
M
A Se
ZA
K ri
al
IM
N
A o.
ZA 30
K

4-6 E
04
C
O 16
Serial No. 300416

R
PO
R
A
TI
O
N
.A
ll
ri
gh
ts
re
ser
ve
d.

You might also like